Survey
* Your assessment is very important for improving the workof artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project
* Your assessment is very important for improving the workof artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project
The General Theory of Relativity Anadijiban Das • Andrew DeBenedictis The General Theory of Relativity A Mathematical Exposition 123 Anadijiban Das Simon Fraser University Burnaby, BC Canada Andrew DeBenedictis Simon Fraser University Burnaby, BC Canada ISBN 978-1-4614-3657-7 ISBN 978-1-4614-3658-4 (eBook) DOI 10.1007/978-1-4614-3658-4 Springer New York Heidelberg Dordrecht London Library of Congress Control Number: 2012938036 © Springer Science+Business Media New York 2012 This work is subject to copyright. All rights are reserved by the Publisher, whether the whole or part of the material is concerned, specifically the rights of translation, reprinting, reuse of illustrations, recitation, broadcasting, reproduction on microfilms or in any other physical way, and transmission or information storage and retrieval, electronic adaptation, computer software, or by similar or dissimilar methodology now known or hereafter developed. Exempted from this legal reservation are brief excerpts in connection with reviews or scholarly analysis or material supplied specifically for the purpose of being entered and executed on a computer system, for exclusive use by the purchaser of the work. Duplication of this publication or parts thereof is permitted only under the provisions of the Copyright Law of the Publisher’s location, in its current version, and permission for use must always be obtained from Springer. Permissions for use may be obtained through RightsLink at the Copyright Clearance Center. Violations are liable to prosecution under the respective Copyright Law. The use of general descriptive names, registered names, trademarks, service marks, etc. in this publication does not imply, even in the absence of a specific statement, that such names are exempt from the relevant protective laws and regulations and therefore free for general use. While the advice and information in this book are believed to be true and accurate at the date of publication, neither the authors nor the editors nor the publisher can accept any legal responsibility for any errors or omissions that may be made. The publisher makes no warranty, express or implied, with respect to the material contained herein. Printed on acid-free paper Springer is part of Springer Science+Business Media (www.springer.com) Dedicated to the memory of Professor J. L. Synge Preface General relativity is to date the most successful theory of gravity. In this theory, the gravitational field is not a conventional force but instead is due to the geometric properties of a manifold commonly known as space–time. These properties give rise to a rich physical theory incorporating many areas of mathematics. In this vein, this book is well suited for the advanced mathematics or physics student, as well as researchers, and it is hoped that the balance of rigorous mathematics and physical insights and applications will benefit the intended audience. The main text and exercises have been designed both to gently introduce topics and to develop the framework to the point necessary for the practitioner in the field. This text tries to cover all of the important subjects in the field of classical general relativity in a mathematically precise way. This is a subject which is often counterintuitive when first encountered. We have therefore provided extensive discussions and proofs to many statements, which may seem surprising at first glance. There are also many elegant results from theorems which are applicable to relativity theory which, if someone is aware of them, can save the individual practitioner much calculation (and time). We have tried to include many of them. We have tried to steer the middle ground between brute force and mathematical elegance in this text, as both approaches have their merits in certain situations. In doing this, we hope that the final result is “reader friendly.” There are some sections that are considered advanced and can safely be skipped by those who are learning the subject for the first time. This is indicated in the introduction of those sections. The mathematics of the theory of general relativity is mostly derived from tensor algebra and tensor analysis, and some background in these subjects, along with special relativity (relativity in the absence of gravity), is required. Therefore, in Chapter 1, we briefly provide the tensor analysis in Riemannian and pseudoRiemannian differentiable manifolds. These topics are discussed in an arbitrary dimension and have many possible applications. In Chapter 2, we review the special theory of relativity in the arena of the fourdimensional flat space–time manifold. Then, we introduce curved space–time and Einstein’s field equations which govern gravitational phenomena. vii viii Preface In Chapter 3, we explore spherically symmetric solutions of Einstein’s equations, which are useful, for example, in the study of nonrotating stars. Foremost among these solutions is the Schwarzschild metric, which describes the gravitational field outside such stars. This solution is the general relativistic analog of Newton’s inverse-square force law of universal gravitation. The Schwarzschild metric, and perturbations of this solution, has been utilized for many experimental verifications of general relativity within the solar system. General solutions to the field equations under spherical symmetry are also derived, which have application in the study of both static and nonstatic stellar structure. In Chapter 4, we deal with static and stationary solutions of the field equations, both in general and under the assumption of certain important symmetries. An important case which is examined at great length is the Kerr metric, which may describe the gravitational field outside of certain rotating bodies. In Chapter 5, the fascinating topic of black holes is investigated. The two most important solutions, the Schwarzschild black hole and the axially symmetric Kerr black hole, are explored in great detail. The formation of black holes from gravitational collapse is also discussed. In Chapter 6, physically significant cosmological models are pursued. (In this arena of the physical sciences, the impact of Einstein’s theory is very deep and revolutionary indeed!) An introduction to higher dimensional gravity is also included in this chapter. In Chapter 7, the mathematical topics regarding Petrov’s algebraic classification of the Riemann and the conformal tensor are studied. Moreover, the Newman– Penrose versions of Einstein’s field equations, incorporating Petrov’s classification, are explored. This is done in great detail, as it is a difficult topic and we feel that detailed derivations of some of the equations are useful. In Chapter 8, we introduce the coupled Einstein–Maxwell–Klein–Gordon field equations. This complicated system of equations classically describes the selfgravitation of charged scalar wave fields. In the special arena of spherically symmetric, static space–time, these field equations, with suitable boundary conditions, yield a nonlinear eigenvalue problem for the allowed theoretical charges of gravitationally bound wave-mechanical condensates. Eight appendices are also provided that deal with special topics in classical general relativity as well as some necessary background mathematics. The notation used in this book is as follows: The Roman letters i , j , k, l, m, n, etc. are used to denote subscripts and superscripts (i.e., covariant and contravariant indices) of a tensor field’s components relative to a coordinate basis and span the full dimensionality of the manifold. However, we employ parentheses around the letters .a/; .b/; .c/; .d /; .e/; .f /, etc. to indicate components of a tensor field relative to an orthonormal basis. Greek indices are used to denote components that only span the dimensionality of a hypersurface. In our discussions of space–time, these Greek indices indicate spatial components only. The flat Minkowskian metric tensor components are denoted by dij or d.a/.b/. Numerically they are the same, but conceptually there is a subtle difference. The signature of the space–time metric is Preface ix C2 and the conventions for the definitions of the Riemann, Ricci, and conformal tensors follow the classic book of Eisenhart. We would like to thank many people for various reasons. As there are so many who we are indebted to, we can only explicitly thank a few here, in the hope that it is understood that there are many others who have indirectly contributed to this book in many, sometimes subtle, ways. I (A. Das) learned much of general relativity from the late Professors J. L. Synge and C. Lanczos during my stay at the Dublin Institute for Advanced Studies. Before that period, I had as mentors in relativity theory Professors S. N. Bose (of Bose– Einstein statistics), S. D. Majumdar, and A. K. Raychaudhuri in Kolkata. During my stay in Pittsburgh, I regularly participated in, and benefited from, seminars organized by Professor E. Newman. In Canada, I had informal discussions with Professors F. Cooperstock, J. Gegenberg, W. Israel, and E. Pechlaner and Drs. P Agrawal, S. Kloster, M. M. Som, M. Suvegas, and N. Tariq. Moreover, in many international conferences on general relativity and gravitation, I had informal discussions with many adept participants through the years. I taught the theory of relativity at University College of Dublin, Jadavpur University (Kolkata), Carnegie-Mellon University, and mostly at Simon Fraser University (Canada). Stimulations received from the inquiring minds of students, both graduate and undergraduate, certainly consolidated my understanding of this subject. Finally, I thank my wife, Mrs. Purabi Das. I am very grateful for her constant encouragement and patience. I (A. DeBenedictis) would like to thank all of the professors, colleagues, and students who have taught and influenced me. As mentioned previously, there are far too many to name them all individually. I would like to thank Professor E. N. Glass of the University of Michigan-Ann Arbor and the University of Windsor, who gave me my first proper introduction to this fascinating field of physics and mathematics. I would like to thank Professor K. S. Viswanathan of Simon Fraser University, from whom I learned, among the many things he taught me, that this field has consequences in theoretical physics far beyond what I originally had thought. I would also like to thank my colleagues whom I have met over the years at various institutions and conferences. All of them have helped me, even if they do not know it. Discussions with them, and their hospitality during my visits, are worthy of great thanks. During the production of this work, I was especially indebted to my colleagues in quantum gravity. They have given me the appreciation of how difficult it is to turn the subject matter of this book into a quantum theory, and opened up a fascinating new area of research to me. The quantization of the gravitational field is likely to be one of the deepest, difficult, and most interesting puzzles in theoretical physics for some time. I hope that this text will provide a solid background for half of that puzzle to those who choose to tread down this path. I would also like to thank the students whom I have taught, or perhaps they have taught me. Whether it be freshman level or advanced graduate level, I can honestly say that I have learned something from every class that I have taught. x Preface Not least, I extend my deepest thanks and appreciation to my wife Jennifer for her encouragement throughout this project. I do not know how she did it. We both extend great thanks to Mrs. Sabine Lebhart for her excellent and timely typesetting of a very difficult manuscript. Finally, we wish the best to all students, researchers, and curious minds who will each in their own way advance the field of gravitation and convey this beautiful subject to future generations. We hope that this book will prove useful to them. Vancouver, Canada Anadijiban Das Andrew DeBenedictis Contents 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.1 Differentiable Manifolds.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2 Tensor Fields Over Differentiable Manifolds .. . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.3 Riemannian and Pseudo-Riemannian Manifolds . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.4 Extrinsic Curvature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 1 16 40 88 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.1 Review of the Special Theory of Relativity . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.2 Curved Space–Time and Gravitation .. . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.3 General Properties of Tij . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.4 Solution Strategies, Classification, and Initial-Value Problems .. . . . . . 2.5 Fluids, Deformable Solids, and Electromagnetic Fields . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105 105 136 174 195 210 3 Spherically Symmetric Space–Time Domains . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.1 Schwarzschild Solution .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2 Spherically Symmetric Static Interior Solutions . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.3 Nonstatic, Spherically Symmetric Solutions . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229 229 246 258 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.1 Static Axially Symmetric Space–Time Domains ... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.2 The General Static Field Equations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.3 Axially Symmetric Stationary Space–Time Domains .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.4 The General Stationary Field Equations . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277 277 290 317 331 5 Black Holes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.1 Spherically Symmetric Black Holes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2 Kerr Black Holes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.3 Exotic Black Holes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 351 351 384 403 6 Cosmology . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.1 Big Bang Models.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.2 Scalar Fields in Cosmology . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.3 Five-Dimensional Cosmological Models . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 419 419 440 456 xi xii Contents 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 465 7.1 The Petrov Classification of the Curvature Tensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 465 7.2 Newman–Penrose Equations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 503 8 The Coupled Einstein–Maxwell–Klein–Gordon Equations . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.1 The General E–M–K–G Field Equations . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.2 Static Space–Time Domains and the E–M–K–G Equations . . . . . . . . . . 8.3 Spherical Symmetry and a Nonlinear Eigenvalue Problem for a Theoretical Fine-Structure Constant . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 537 537 542 551 Appendix 1 Variational Derivation of Differential Equations .. . . . . . . . . . . . 569 Appendix 2 Partial Differential Equations . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 585 Appendix 3 Canonical Forms of Matrices .. . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 605 Appendix 4 Conformally Flat Space–Times and “the Fifth Force” . . . . . . 617 Appendix 5 Linearized Theory and Gravitational Waves . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 625 Appendix 6 Exotic Solutions: Wormholes, Warp-Drives, and Time Machines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 633 Appendix 7 Gravitational Instantons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 647 Appendix 8 Computational Symbolic Algebra Calculations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 653 References .. .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 661 Index . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 669 List of Figures Fig. 1.1 Fig. 1.2 Fig. 1.3 Fig. 1.4 Fig. 1.5 Fig. 1.6 Fig. 1.7 Fig. 1.8 Fig. 1.9 Fig. 1.10 Fig. 1.11 Fig. 1.12 Fig. 1.13 Fig. 1.14 Fig. 1.15 Fig. 1.16 Fig. 1.17 Fig. 1.18 Fig. 1.19 Fig. 1.20 A chart .; U / and projection mappings . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Two charts in M and a coordinate transformation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . The polar coordinate chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Spherical polar coordinates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tangent vector in E 3 and R3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A parametrized curve into M .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reparametrization of a curve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . The Jacobian mapping of tangent vectors . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E A vector field U.x/ along an integral curve . ; x/ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A classification chart for manifolds endowed with metric.. . . . . . . . Parallel propagation of a vector along a curve .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Parallel transport along a closed curve . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Parallel transport along closed curves on several manifolds. Although all manifolds here are intrinsically flat, except for the apex of (c), the cone yields nontrivial parallel transport of the vector when it is transported around the curve shown, which encompasses the apex. The domain enclosed by a curve encircling the apex is non-star-shaped, and therefore, nontrivial parallel transport may be obtained even though the entire curve is located in regions where the manifold is flat. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Two-dimensional surface generated by geodesics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Geodesic deviation between two neighboring longitudes . . . . . . . . . A circular helix in R3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A two-dimensional surface †2 embedded in R3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A smooth surface of revolution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . The image †N 1 of a parametrized hypersurface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Coordinate transformation and reparametrization of hypersurface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 3 4 5 6 11 13 22 36 65 74 76 76 79 81 83 89 92 94 95 xiii xiv List of Figures Fig. 1.21 Change of normal vector due to the extrinsic curvature . . . . . . . . . . . 98 Fig. 2.1 Fig. 2.2 A tangent vector vE p0 in M4 and its image vE x0 in R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Null cone Nx0 with vertex at x0 (circles represent suppressed spheres).. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A Lorentz transformation inducing a mapping between two coordinate planes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Images S ; T , and N of a spacelike, timelike, and a null curve .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . The three-dimensional hyperhyperboloid representing the 4-velocity constraint .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A world tube and a curve representing a fluid streamline . . . . . . . . . A doubly sliced world tube of an extended body . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mapping of a rectangular coordinate grid into a curvilinear grid in the space–time manifold .. . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . OC A coordinate transformation mapping half lines L O O O . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . and LO into half lines LO and L 106 Fig. 2.3 Fig. 2.4 Fig. 2.5 Fig. 2.6 Fig. 2.7 Fig. 2.8 Fig. 2.9 4 Fig. 2.10 Fig. 2.11 Fig. 2.12 Fig. 2.13 Fig. 2.14 Fig. 2.15 Fig. 2.16 Fig. 2.17 Fig. 2.18 Fig. 2.19 Fig. 2.20 Fig. 3.1 Fig. 3.2 Fig. 3.3 Fig. 3.4 C 108 109 112 114 118 120 128 129 Three massive particles falling freely in space under Earth’s gravity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (a) Space and time trajectories of two geodesic particles freely falling towards the Earth. (b) A similar figure but adapted to the geodesic motion of the two freely falling observers in curved space–time M4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Qualitative representation of a swarm of particles moving under the influence of a gravitational field . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (a) shows the parallel transport along a nongeodesic curve. (b) depicts the F–W transport along the same curve . . . . . . . Measurement of a spacelike separation along the image . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A material world tube in the domain D.b/ . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Analytic extension of solutions from the original domain D.e/ into DQO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Five two-dimensional surfaces with some peculiarities . . . . . . . . . . . (a) shows a material world tube. (b) shows the EP field over ˙ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . continuous U A doubly sliced world tube of an isolated, extended material body . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Domain D WD D.0/ .0; t1 / R4 for the initial-value problem .. 188 203 Two-dimensional submanifold M2 of the Schwarzschild space–time. The surface representing M2 here is known as Flamm’s paraboloid [102].. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rosette motion of a planet and the perihelion shift . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . The deflection of light around the Sun . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Two t-coordinate lines endowed with ideal clocks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233 238 240 241 138 139 140 147 149 165 168 169 184 List of Figures Fig. 3.5 Fig. 3.6 Fig. 4.1 Fig. 4.2 Fig. 4.3 Fig. 5.1 Fig. 5.2 Fig. 5.3 Fig. 5.4 Fig. 5.5 Fig. 5.6 Fig. 5.7 Fig. 5.8 Fig. 5.9 Fig. 5.10 Fig. 5.11 Fig. 5.12 Fig. 5.13 Fig. 5.14 Fig. 5.15 Fig. 5.16 Fig. 5.17 Fig. 5.18 Fig. 5.19 Fig. 5.20 Fig. 5.21 xv Qualitative representation of a spherical body inside a concentric shell . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248 A convex domain D in a two-dimensional coordinate plane .. . . . . 260 The two-dimensional and the corresponding axially symmetric three-dimensional domain . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279 Two axially symmetric bodies in “Euclidean coordinate spaces” .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281 A massive, charged particle at x.1/ and a point x in the extended body . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308 Qualitative picture depicting two mappings from the Lemaı̂tre chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . The graph of the semicubical parabola .rO /3 D .O /2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . The mapping X and its restrictions Xj:: . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . The graph of the Lambert W-function .. . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Four domains covered by the doubly null, u v coordinate chart .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . The maximal extension of the Schwarzschild chart.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Intersection of two surfaces of revolution in the maximally extended Schwarzschild universe . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Eddington–Finkelstein coordinates .Ou; vO / describing the black hole. The vertical lines rO D 2m and rO D 0 indicate the event horizon and the singularity, respectively . . . . . . . Qualitative graph of M.r/.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Collapse of a dust ball into a black hole in a Tolman-Bondi-Lemaı̂tre chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Collapse of a dust ball into a black hole in Kruskal–Szekeres coordinates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Qualitative representation of a collapsing spherically symmetric star in three instants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Boundary of the collapsing surface and the (absolute) event horizon .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Various profile curves representing horizons in the submanifold ' D =2; t D const in the Kerr space–time .. . . . . . . . Locations of horizons, ergosphere, ring singularity, etc., in the Kerr-submanifold x 4 D const. . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . The region of validity for the metric in (5.100iii) and (5.99) .. . . . . The region of validity for the metric in (5.101) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . The submanifold M2 and its two coordinate charts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . The maximally extended Kerr submanifold MQ 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Qualitative representation of an exotic black hole in the T -domain and the Kruskal–Szekeres chart.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Collapse into an exotic black hole depicted by four coordinate charts .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 353 355 360 361 364 365 369 370 372 373 375 376 377 387 389 396 396 397 398 409 413 xvi List of Figures Fig. 5.22 Qualitative graphs of y D Œ.s/ 1 and the straight line y D ˝.s/ WD y0 C .1=3/ .s s0 / . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 418 Fig. 6.1 Qualitative graphs for the “radius of the universe” as a function of time in three Friedmann (or standard) models . . . . . . . . Qualitative representation of a submanifold M2 of the spatially closed space–time M4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Qualitative graphs of y D Œ.s/ 1 and the straight line y D y0 C 13 .s s0 / . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Comparison of the square of the cosmological scale factor, a2 .t/. The dotted lines represent the numerically evolved Cauchy data utilizing the scheme outlined in Sect. 2.4 to various orders in t t0 (quadratic, cubic, quartic). The solid line represents the analytic result .e2t / . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Qualitative graphs of two functions .ˇ/ and z.ˇ/ corresponding to the particular function h.ˇ/ WD " ˇ 1 . . . . . . . . . The qualitative graph of the function .ˇ/ for 0 < ˇ < 1 .. . . . . . . . Qualitative graphs of a typical function h.ˇ/ and the curve comprising of minima for the one-parameter family of such functions .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Graphs of evolutions of functions depicting the scale O w/. (Note that at late times O w/ and ˇ.t; factors A.t; the compact dimension expands at a slower rate than the noncompact dimensions) .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 6.2 Fig. 6.3 Fig. 6.4 Fig. 6.5 Fig. 6.6 Fig. 6.7 Fig. 6.8 426 426 435 452 460 461 462 464 Fig. 7.1 A tetrad field containing two spacelike and two null vector fields . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 468 Fig. 8.1 A plot of the function in (8.39) with the following parameters: c0 D 1, e D 1, 0 D 1 and x0 D 0 .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A plot of the function W .x 1 / D x 1 V .x 1 / subject to the boundary conditions W .0/ D 0, @1 W .x 1 /jx 1 D0 D 0:5; 1; and 5 representing increasing frequency respectively. The constant .0/ is set to unity .. . . . . . . . . . The graph of the function r D coth x 1 > 0 .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Graphs of the eigenfunctions U.0/ .x/, U.1/ .x/ and U.2/ .x/. . . . . . . . (a) Qualitative graph of eigenfunction u.0/ .r/: (b) Qualitative plot of the radial distance R.r/ versus r: (c) Qualitative plot of the ratio of circumference divided by radial distance. (d) Qualitative two-dimensional projection of the three-dimensional, spherically symmetric geometry .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Qualitative plots of three null cones representing radial, null geodesics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 8.2 Fig. 8.3 Fig. 8.4 Fig. 8.5 Fig. 8.6 550 552 556 560 564 565 List of Figures xvii Fig. 8.7 (a) Qualitative graph of the eigenfunction u.2/ .r/: (b) ˇ ˇ plot of the radial distance R r Qualitative R.r/ WD 0C ˇu.2/ .w/ˇ dw: (c) Qualitative plot of the ratio of circumference divided by radial distance. (d) Qualitative, two-dimensional projection of the three-dimensional, spherically symmetric geometry.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 566 Fig. A1.1 Fig. A1.2 Two twice-differentiable parametrized curves into RN .. . . . . . . . . . . 570 The mappings corresponding to a tensor field y .rCs/ D .rCs/ .x/ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 573 Two representative spacelike hypersurfaces in an ADM decomposition of space–time . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 583 Fig. A1.3 Fig. A2.1 Fig. A2.2 Classification diagram of p.d.e.s .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 588 Graphs of nonunique solutions.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 603 Fig. A5.1 An illustration of the quantities in (A5.13) in the three-dimensional spatial submanifold. The coordinates xs , known as the source points, span the entire source (shaded region). O represents an arbitrary origin of the coordinate system . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 628 The C (top) and (bottom) polarizations of gravitational waves. A loop of string is deformed as shown over time as a gravitational wave passes out of the page. Inset: a superposition of the two most extreme deformations of the string for the C and polarizations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 630 The sensitivity of the LISA and LIGO detectors. The dark regions indicate the likely amplitudes (vertical axis, denoting change in length divided by mean length of detector) and frequencies (horizontal axis, in cycles per second) of astrophysical sources of gravitational waves. The approximately “U”-shaped lines indicate the extreme sensitivity levels of the LISA (left) and LIGO (right) detectors. BH D black hole, NS D neutron star, SN D supernova (Figure courtesy of NASA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 631 Fig. A5.2 Fig. A5.3 Fig. A6.1 A possible picture for the space–time foam. Space-time that seems smooth on large scales (left) may actually be endowed with a sea of nontrivial topologies (represented by handles on the right) due to quantum gravity effects. (Note that, as discussed in the main text, this topology is not necessarily changing.) One of the simplest models for such a handle is the wormhole . . . 634 xviii Fig. A6.2 Fig. A6.3 Fig. A6.4 Fig. A6.5 Fig. A6.6 Fig. A6.7 Fig. A6.8 Fig. A6.9 List of Figures A qualitative representation of an interuniverse wormhole (top) and an intra-universe wormhole (bottom). In the second scenario, the wormhole could provide a shortcut to otherwise distant parts of the universe . . . . . . Left: A cross-section of the wormhole profile curve near the throat region. Right: The wormhole is generated by rotating the profile curve about the x 3 -axis.. . . . . . . . . A “top-hat” function for the warp-drive space–time with one direction (x 3 ) suppressed. The center of the ship is located at the center of the top hat, corresponding to s r D 0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . The expansion of spatial volume elements, (A6.12), for the warp-drive space–time with the x 3 coordinate suppressed. Note that, in this model, there is contraction of volume elements in front of the ship and an expansion of volume elements behind the ship. The ship, however, is located in a region with no expansion nor compression . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A plot of the distribution of negative energy density in a plane (x 3 D 0) containing the ship for a warp-drive space–time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Two examples of closed timelike curves. In (a) the closure of the timelike curve is introduced by topological identification. In (b) the time coordinate is periodic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . The embedding of anti-de Sitter space–time in a five-dimensional flat “space–time” which possesses two timelike coordinates, U and V (two dimensions suppressed).. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . The light-cone structure about an axis % D 0 in the Gödel space–time. On the left, the light cones tip forward, and on thepright, they tip backward. Note that at % D ln.1 C 2/ the light cones are sufficiently tipped over that the ' direction is null. At greater %, the ' direction is timelike, indicating the presence of a closed timelike curve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 634 635 639 640 641 642 643 644 List of Tables Table 1.1 The number of independent components of the Riemann–Christoffel tensor for various dimensions N . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 Table 2.1 Correspondence between relativistic and nonrelativistic physical quantities .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127 Table 4.1 Comparison between Newtonian gravity and Einstein static gravity outside matter.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292 Table 7.1 Complex Segre characteristics and principal null directions for various Petrov types .. . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 497 Table 8.1 Physical quantities associated with the first five eigenfunctions of U.j /.x/. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 567 xix Symbols1; 2 WD, DW j:: 2 r s 0, O E O [j k; i] i jk Œc $ d , f $ g, etc. a E kAk A[B A\B AB d’Alembertian operator, completion of an example Q.E.D., completion of proof Central dot denotes multiplication (used to make crowded equations more readable) Identity Definition, which is an identity involving new notation Hodge star operation, tortoise coordinate designation Constrained to a curve or surface Belongs to .r C s/th order zero tensor. (In the latter the number of dots indicate r and s.) Zero vector Christoffel symbol of the 1st kind Christoffel symbol of the 2nd kind Represents the previous term in brackets of an expression but with the given indices interchanged Angular momentum parameter, expansion factor in F–L–R–W metric Norm or length of a vector Union of two sets Intersection of two sets Cartesian product of two sets 1 For common tensors, only the coordinate component form is shown in this list. Occasionally the symbols listed here will also have other definitions in the text. We tabulate the most common definitions here as it should be clear in the text where the meanings differ from those in this list. 2 xxi xxii Symbols AB E B/ E B/ E g g:: .A; E .A pA ^ q B E B EB E E WD A E B EA [A; A Ai ˛ B ˇ c C Cr Ci u r v CŒs T C ij kl C .; U / .p/ D x .x 1 ; x 2 ; : : : ; x N / ij D Di @D ri D @t r2 ıji p p ı; i ;:::;i ı 1 j1p;:::;jp df , dŒp W dij xN / @.b x 1 ; : : : ;b 1 @.x ; : : : ; x N / e Eij , EQij , E lij k E E˛ E; EN fEe.a/ gN 1 WD fEe.1/ ; : : : ; Ee.N / g A is a subset of B Inner product between two vectors Wedge product between a p-form and a q-form Lie bracket or commutator Electric potential, (also a function used in fivedimensional cosmologies) Components of the electromagnetic 4-potential Affine parameter for a null geodesic, Newman–Penrose spin-coefficient Magnetic potential, bivector set Expansion coefficient for 5th dimension, Newman– Penrose spin-coefficient Speed of light (usually set to 1) Conformal group, causality violating region Differentiability class r Coordinate conditions Contraction operation of a tensor field rs T Components of Weyl’s conformal tensor The set of all complex numbers Coordinate chart for a differentiable manifold Local coordinates of a point p in a manifold. In some places x 2 R. Extended extrinsic curvature components A domain in RN (open and connected) Gauge covariant derivative .N 1/-dimensional boundary of D Covariant derivatives Covariant derivative along a curve Laplacian in a manifold with metric, determinant of ij Laplacian in a Euclidean space Components of Kronecker delta (or identity matrix) Generalized Kronecker delta Exterior derivative of f or p W Components of flat space metric Jacobian of a coordinate transformation Electric charge, exponential Components of Einstein equations (in various forms) Electric field and its components N -dimensional Euclidean space A basis set for a vector space Symbols xxiii E .a/ g4 fE n 1 A complex null basis set for Newman–Penrose formalism o E El; kE E m; WD m; " "i1 i2 ;:::;iN i .a/.b/ i1 ;i2 ;:::;iN f˛ fij .x; u/ Fi Fij g; jgj G gij Gji X WD ı Lij .a/.b/.c/ .a/.b/.c/ kij „ hi , hij , hkij E H˛ H; H I J Ji J ik E k ki k0 K.u/ E Ki K; K A small number, Newman–Penrose spin coefficient, coefficient of a perturbation Totally antisymmetric permutation symbol (Levi-Civita) Components of the geodesic deviation vector Components of metric tensor relative to a complex null tetrad Totally antisymmetric pseudo (or oriented) tensor (Levi-Civita) Newtonian force Finsler metric components 4-force components Electromagnetic tensor field tensor components Metric tensor determinant and its absolute value Gravitational constant (usually set to 1) Metric tensor components Einstein tensor components A parametrized curve into a manifold, Newman–Penrose spin coefficient A parametrized curve into RN The image of a parametrized curve into RN , characteristic matrix Characteristic matrix components Complex Ricci rotation coefficients Ricci rotation coefficients Independent connection components in Hilbert-Palatini variational approach Reduced Planck’s constant (usually set to 1) Variations of vector, second-rank tensor, Christoffel connection respectively Magnetic field and its components Relativistic Hamiltonian Identity tensor Action functional or action integral 4-current components Total angular momentum components Real null tetrad vector Wave vector (or number) components Curvature of spatial sections of F–L–R–W metric Gaussian curvature A Killing vector and corresponding components Extrinsic curvature components of a hypersurface xxiv Symbols .A/ , .0/ El l ij , Lij ŒL T L LVE L L.I/ .i / E .A/ .s/ i .a/ , .a/ i m, M.s/ E E m m; M , MN M Mi , Mi N ni N˛ O.p; nI R/ IO.p; nI R/ p p# pk , p? pi ; P i .0/ k P ij ˚ ˛ (ext) ij ' ˚.A/.B/ ˚ i1 ;:::;ij1r;:::;js Einstein equation constant (D 8G=c 4 in common units) Ath curvature, Newman–Penrose spin coefficient Real null tetrad vector Components of a generalized Lorentz transformation Transposed matrix A Lagrangian function Lie derivative Lagrangian density Lagrangian function from super-Hamiltonian Eigenvalue, Lagrange multiplier, electromagnetic gauge function, Newman–Penrose spin coefficient i th eigenvalue Ath normal vector to a curve Components of orthonormal basis Cosmological constant Mass, mass function Complex null tetrad vectors A differentiable manifold, N dimensional differentiable manifold “Total mass” of the universe Maxwell vector (and dual) components Mass density, Newman–Penrose spin coefficient Dimension of tangent vector space, lapse function in A.D.M. formalism Unit normal vector components Shift vector in A.D.M. formalism Frequency, Newman–Penrose spin coefficient Generalized Lorentz group Generalized Poincaré group Point in a manifold, polynomial equation, pressure Polynomial equation for invariant eigenvalues Parallel pressure and transverse pressure respectively 4-momentum components Newman–Penrose spin coefficient Projection mapping Projection tensor field components Characteristic surface function of a p.d.e., scalar field Born-Infeld (or tachyonic) scalar field, (also a function used in five-dimensional cosmologies) External force density Complex electromagnetic field tensor components Complex Ricci components (A; B 2 f0; 1; 2g) Components of an oriented, relative tensor field of weight w Symbols xxv .J / Q.a/.d / Complex Klein-Gordon field Complex J th Weyl components (J 2 f0; : : : ; 4g) Complex Weyl tensor with second and third index projected in a timelike direction Ricci curvature scalar (or invariant) Components of Ricci tensor Components of Cotton–Schouten–York tensor Components of Riemann-Christoffel tensor The set of real numbers, complex Ricci scalar Cartesian product of N copies of the set R R Rij Rij k Rij kl R RN WD „ R R ƒ‚ R … N s ij ; S ij Sij kl s S2 ˛ˇ ij P , ;˙ Etx Tx TQx T ij T:: ; T ij k r sT T i1 ;:::;irj1 ;:::;js .a1 /;:::;.ar / .b1 /;:::;.bs / .a1 /;:::;.ar / T .b1 /;:::;.bs / p r sT ˝ q S i T T r sT .Tx .RN // ij r s U U.a/.b/ ; V.a/.b/ ; W.a/.b/ Mass density, proper energy density, Newman–Penrose spin coefficient Components of relativistic stress tensor (special and general respectively) Components of symmetrized curvature tensor Arc separation parameter Two-dimensional spherical surface Electrical charge density, Newman–Penrose spin coefficient, separation of a vector field, Klein-Gordon equation Stress density, shear tensor components Arc separation function, function in Kerr metric, summation Tangent vector of the image at the point x Tangent vector space of a manifold Cotangent (or dual) vector space of a manifold Components of energy–momentum–stress tensor Torsion tensor and the corresponding components Tensor field of order .r C s/ Coordinate components of the (same) tensor field Orthonormal components of the (same) tensor field Complex tensor field components Tensor (or outer product) of two tensor fields Conservation law components Affine parameter along geodesic (usu. proper time), Newman–Penrose spin coefficient Tensor bundle Expansion tensor components, T -domain energy– momentum–stress tensor Components of a relative tensor field an open subset of a manifold Components of complex bivector fields (see definitions (7.48i–vi)) xxvi ui ; U i ; U i V ˛ .t/, V ˛ W,w W W p W; Wi1 ;:::;ip !ij ˝ x D X .t/; x i D X i .t/ x D .u/; x i D i .u1 ; : : : ; uD / Y z; z Z; ZC Symbols 4-velocity components Newtonian or Galilean velocity Effective Newtonian potential Lambert’s W-function, (symbol also used for other functions in axi-symmetric metrics) Work function p-form and its antisymmetric components Vorticity tensor components Synge’s world function A parametrized curve in RN A parametrized submanifold Coefficient of spherical line element in Tolman-Bondi coordinates A complex variable and its conjugate The set of integers, the set of positive integers Chapter 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds 1.1 Differentiable Manifolds We will begin by briefly defining an N -dimensional differentiable manifold M . (See [23, 38, 56, 130].) There are a few assumptions in this definition. A set with a topology is one in which open subsets are known. Furthermore, if for every two distinct elements (or points) p and q there exist open and disjoint subsets containing p and q, respectively, then the topology is called Hausdorff. A connected Hausdorff manifold is paracompact if and only if it has a countable basis of open sets. (See [1, 130, 132].) 1. The first assumption we make about an applicable differentiable manifold M is that it is endowed with a paracompact topology. (Remark: This assumption is necessary for the purpose of integration in any domain.) We also consider only a connected set M for physical reasons. Moreover, we mostly deal with situations where M is an open set. Now we shall introduce local coordinates for M . A chart .; U / or a local coordinate system is a pair consisting of an open subset U M together with a continuous, one-to-one mapping (homeomorphism) from U into (codomain) D RN . Here, D is an open subset of RN with the usual Euclidean topology.1 For a point p 2 M , we have x .x 1 ; x 2 ; : : : ; x N / D .p/ 2 D. The coordinates .x 1 ; x 2 ; : : : ; x N / are the coordinates of the point p in the chart .; U /. Each of the N coordinates is obtained by the projection mappings k W D N R ! R, k 2 f1; : : : ; N g. These are defined by k .x/ k .x 1 ; : : : ; x N / DW x k 2 R. (See Fig. 1.1.) 1 We can visualize the coordinate space RN as an N -dimensional Euclidean space. A. Das and A. DeBenedictis, The General Theory of Relativity: A Mathematical Exposition, DOI 10.1007/978-1-4614-3658-4 1, © Springer Science+Business Media New York 2012 1 2 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds Fig. 1.1 A chart .; U / and projection mappings b / such that the point Consider two coordinate systems or charts .; U / and .b ; U b p is in the nonempty intersection of U and U . From Fig. 1.2, we conclude that b x D .b ı 1 /.x/; O x D . ı b 1 /.x/; (1.1) b s D. b where x 2 Ds D and b x2D From the preceding considerations, the mappings b ı 1 and ı b 1 are continuous and one-to-one. By projection of these points, we get b k .x/ X b k .x 1 ; : : : ; x N /; ı 1 .x/ DW X b x k D Œ k ı b x k D Œ k ı ı b 1 .b x / DW X k .b x / X k .b x 1 ; : : : ;b x N /: (1.2) b k and X k are continuous. However, for a differentiable The 2N functions X b k and X k are differentiable functions of N real manifold, we assume that X variables. In this context, we introduce some new notations. In case a function f W D RN ! RM can be continuously differentiated r times with respect to every variable, we define the function f to belong to the class C r .D RN I RM /, r 2 f0; 1; 2; : : : g. In case the function is Taylor expandable (or a real-analytic function), the symbol C w .D RN I RM / is used for the class. 1.1 Differentiable Manifolds 3 Fig. 1.2 Two charts in M and a coordinate transformation By the first assumption of paracompactness, we can conclude [38,130] that open S subsets Uh exist2 such that M D Uh . The second assumption about M is the h following: 2. There exist countable charts .h ; Uh / for M . Moreover, wherever there is a nonempty intersection between charts, coordinate transformations as in (1.2) of class C r can be found. Such a basis of charts for M is called a C r -Atlas. A maximal collection of C r related atlases is called a maximal C r -Atlas. (It is also called the complete atlas.) Finally, we are in a position to define a differentiable manifold. 3. An N -dimensional C r -differentiable manifold is a set M with a maximal C r atlas. (Remark: For r D 0, the set M is called a topological manifold.) A differentiable manifold h isk said i to be orientable if there exists an atlas .h ; Uh / @b X .x/ such that the Jacobian det is nonzero and of one sign everywhere. @x j Example 1.1.1. Consider the two-dimensional Euclidean manifold E 2 . One global chart .; E 2 / is furnished by x D .x 1 ; x 2 / D .p/; p 2 E 2 ; D D R2 . Let .; E 2 / be one of infinitely many Cartesian coordinate systems. chart, .; O UO /, is given by xO .xO 1 ; xO 2 / .r; '/ D .p/I O DO WD ˚ Another 1 2 2 1 2 .xO ; xO / 2 R W xO > 0; < xO < . 2 Some authors depict the boundary of an open subset by a dashed curve. 4 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds p E2 χ ^ χ x2 x2 ^ χ −1 χ π x^ x x1 x1 2 χ χ^ −1 −π 2 Fig. 1.3 The polar coordinate chart The transformation to the polar coordinate chart is characterized by x 1 D X 1 .x/ O DxO 1 cos xO 2 ; 2 2 x D X .x/ O DxO 1 sin xO 2 ; and the inverse transformation by p xO 1 D XO 1 .x/ D C .x 1 /2 C .x 2 /2 DW r; 8 Arctan.x 2 =x 1 / for x 1 > 0; ˆ ˆ ˆ < sgn.x 2 / for x 1 D 0 and x 2 ¤ 0; xO 2 D XO 2 .x/ D arc.x 1; x 2 / ' WD 2 ˆ ˆ Arctan.x 2=x 1 /C sgn.x 2 / for x 1< 0 :̂ and x 2¤ 0: Note that =2 < Arctan.x 2 =x 1 / < =2, so that < arc.x 1 ; x 2 / < . (See Fig. 1.3.) Example 1.1.2. The two-dimensional (boundary) surface S 2 of the unit solid sphere can be constructed in the Euclidean space E 3 by one constraint expressible in terms of the Cartesian coordinates as .x 1 /2 C .x 2 /2 C .x 3 /2 D 1. Equivalently, the same constraint is expressible in the spherical polar coordinates as the radial coordinate b x 1 D 1. The remaining spherical polar angular coordinates .b x 2 ;b x 3 / DW .; '/ can be used as a possible coordinate system over an open subset of S 2 , which is a 1.1 Differentiable Manifolds 5 Fig. 1.4 Spherical polar coordinates two-dimensional differentiable manifold in its own right. This coordinate chart is characterized by x D .; '/ D .p/; p 2 U S 2 I ˚ D W D .; '/ 2 R2 W 0 < < ; < ' < R2 : Another distinct spherical polar chart is furnished by b b '/ WD Arc cos. sin sin '/; D .; b ' D nb̊ .; '/ WD arc. sin cos '; cos /; o b W D .b D ; b ' / 2 R2 W 0 < b < ; < b ' < R2 : b D S 2 . Thus, the Neither of the two charts is global. However, the union U [ U b / constitutes an atlas for S 2 . (The minimum collection of two charts .; U / and .b ; U 2 number of charts for an atlas of S is two.) See Fig. 1.4 for the illustration. (For future use, a vector vE p at p is shown.) Let us now consider the space in the arena of Newtonian physics. It is mathematically represented by the three-dimensional Euclidean space E 3 . This space admits infinitely many global Cartesian charts. Physically, vectors in the tangent space describe velocities, accelerations, forces, etc. Each of these vectors has a (homeomorphic) image in R3 of a Cartesian chart. To obtain an intuitive 6 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds Fig. 1.5 Tangent vector in E 3 and R3 definition of a tangent vector vE p or its image vE x in R3 , we shall visualize an “arrow” in R3 with the starting point x .x 1 ; x 2 ; x 3 / in R3 and the directed displacement vE .v1 ; v2 ; v3 / necessary to reach the point .x 1 C v1 ; x 2 C v2 ; x 3 C v3 / in R3 . (See Fig. 1.5.) Example 1.1.3. Let us choose the following as standard (Cartesian) basis vectors at x in R3 : Eix Ee1x WD .1; 0; 0/x ; Ejx Ee2x WD .0; 1; 0/x ; kE x Ee3x WD .0; 0; 1/x : Let a three-dimensional vector be given by vE WD 3Ee1 C 2Ee2 C eE3 D .3; 2; 1/. Let us choose a point x .x 1 ; x 2 ; x 3 / D .1; 2; 3/. Therefore, the tangent vector vEx D .3; 2; 1/.1;2;3/ starts from the point .1; 2; 3/ and terminates at .4; 4; 4/. However, such a simple definition runs into problems in a curved manifold. An example of a simple curved manifold is the spherical surface S 2 we have previously discussed and as shown in Fig. 1.4. We have drawn an intuitive picture of a tangent vector vE p on S 2 . The starting point p of vE p is on S 2 . However, the end point of vE p is not on S 2 . The problem is how to define a tangent vector intrinsically on S 2 , without going out of the spherical surface. One logical possibility is to introduce directional derivatives of a smooth function F defined at p in a subset of S 2 . Such a definition involves only the point p and its neighboring points all on S 2 . Thus, we shall represent tangent vectors by the directional derivatives. This concept appears to be very abstract at the beginning. (See [56, 121, 197].) Before proceeding, it is useful to introduce the Einstein summation convention. In a mathematical expression, wherever two repeated indices are present, automatic sums over the repeated index is implied. For example, we denote 1.1 Differentiable Manifolds uk vk WD 7 N X u k vk gij a b WD u j vj D u j vj ; j D1 kD1 i j N X N N X X gij a b i j i D1 j D1 N N X X gkl ak b l D gkl ak b l : kD1 lD1 The summation indices are also called dummy indices, since they can be replaced by another set of repeated indices over the same range, as demonstrated in the above equations. Now, let us define generalized directional derivatives. We shall use a coordinate chart .; U / instead of the abstract manifold M . Let x .x 1 ; : : : ; x N / D .p/. Let an N -tuple of vector components be given by .v1 ; : : : ; vN /. Then, the tangent vector vE x in D RN is defined by the generalized directional derivative: @ ; @x i @f .x/ vE x Œf W D vi : @x i vE x W D vi (1.3) Here, f belongs to C 1 .D RN I R/. (Note that in the notation of the usual calculus, vE x Œf D vE grad f .) The set of all tangent vectors vE x constitutes the N -dimensional tangent vector space Tx .RN / in D RN . It is an isomorphic image of the tangent vector space Tp .M /. The coordinate basis set fEe1x ; : : : ; EeN x g for Tx .RN / is defined by the differential operators @ @ ; : : : ; EeN x WD N I 1 @x @x @f .x/ Eekx Œf W D : @x k Ee1x W D (1.4) (See [23, 197].) Now, we shall define a tangent vector field vE.p/ in U M or equivalently the tangent vector field vE.x/ in D RN . It involves N real-valued functions v1 .x/; : : : ; vN .x/. The tangent vector field is defined by the operator @ ; @x j @f .x/ vE .x/Œf W D vj .x/ : @x j vE .x/ W D vj .x/ Here, f 2 C 1 .D RN I R/. (1.5) 8 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds Example 1.1.4. Let D WD f.x 1 ; x 2 / 2 R2 2 f .x/ WD x 1 Œ.x 2 /x and W x 1 2 R; 1 < x 2 g. Moreover, let 2 ex @ @ .2 cosh x 1 / 2 : 2 @x 1 @x vE.x 1 ; x 2 / WD Therefore, by (1.5), we get " # x2 e 2.x 1 cosh x 1 /.1 C ln x 2 / ; vE .x 1 ; x 2 /Œf D Œ.x 2 / 2 e ˚ C e 1 : lim lim vE.x 1 ; x 2 /Œf D 2 x 1 !1 x 2 !1C x2 The Kronecker delta is defined by the (real) numbers: ( 1 for i D j; i ı j WD 0 for i ¤ j: (1.6) The N N matrix with entries ı ij is the unit matrix ŒI D Œı ij . Example 1.1.5. Consider a vector ˛ E D .˛ 1 ; ˛ 2 ; : : : ; ˛ N /. Using the summation convention, ı 1j ˛ j D ı 11 ˛ 1 C ı 12 ˛ 2 C C ı 1N ˛ N D ˛ 1 ; ı ij ˛ j D ˛ i ; j j ı ij ı k D ı ik ; ı ij ı k ı kl ı li D N: Example 1.1.6. The coordinate basis vectors from (1.4) can be expressed as Eej .x/ D @ : @x j Therefore, for the function f .x/ WD x i , @.x i / D ıi j ; @x j @ vE .x/Œx i D vj .x/ j .x i / D vj .x/ı i j D vi .x/ : @x Eej .x/Œx i D (1.7) The main properties of tangent vector fields can be summarized in the following theorem: E are tangent vector fields in D RN , and f; g; h 2 Theorem 1.1.7. If vE and w 1 N C .D R I R/, then 1.1 Differentiable Manifolds 9 .i / E E Œf .x/Ev.x/ C g.x/w.x/Œh D f .x/.Ev.x/Œh/ C g.x/.w.x/Œh/; (1.8) .ii/ vE.x/Œcf C kg D c.Ev.x/Œf / C k.Ev.x/Œg/; for all constants c and k .iii/ vE.x/Œfg D .Ev.x/Œf /g.x/ C f .x/.Ev.x/Œg/ : (1.9) (1.10) The proof is left as an exercise. Now we shall define a cotangent (or covariant) vector field. Consider a function Qf.x/ which maps the tangent vector space Tx .RN / into R such that h h i i Qf.x/ g.x/Ev.x/ C h.x/w.x/ E E D g.x/ Qf.x/ vE.x/ C h.x/ Qf.x/ w.x/ (1.11) E for all functions g.x/; h.x/ and all tangent vector fields vE .x/; w.x/ in Tx .RN /. Such a function is called a cotangent (or covariant) vector field. Q Example 1.1.8. The (unique) zero covariant vector field 0.x/ is defined by Q 0.x/ vE.x/ WD 0 for all vE .x/ in Tx .RN /. (Remark: In Newtonian physics, the gradient of the gravitational potential is a covariant vector field.) We define the linear combinations of covariant vector fields as .x/Qf.x/C˝.x/Qg.x/ vE .x/ WD .x/ Qf.x/.Ev.x// C˝.x/ gQ .x/.Ev.x// (1.12) for all functions .x/, ˝.x/ and all tangent vectors vE.x/ in Tx .RN /. Under such a rule, the set of all covariant vector fields constitutes an N -dimensional cotangent (or dual) vector space TQx .RN /. Now we shall introduce the notion of a 1-form which will be identified with a covariant vector field. We need to define a (totally) differentiable function f over D RN . In case f satisfies the following criterion, i9 8h < f .x 1 C h1 ; : : : ; x N C hN /f .x 1 ; : : : ; x N /hj @[email protected]/ = j lim p D 0; ; .h1 ;:::;hN /!.0;:::;0/ : .h1 /2 C C .hN /2 (1.13) 10 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds for arbitrary .h1 ; : : : ; hN /, we call the function f a totally differentiable function at x. The usual condensed form for denoting (1.13) is to write df .x/ D @f .x/ j dx : @x j (1.14) Each side of (1.14) is called a 1-form. It is customary to identify a 1-form, df .x/, with a covariant vector field, Qf.x/, with the following rule of operation: @f .x/ : df .x/ŒEv.x/ Qf.x/ vE.x/ WD vj .x/ @x j (1.15) Here, vE.x/ is an arbitrary vector field. 2 Example 1.1.9. Let f .x/ f .x 1 ; x 2 / WD .1=3/Œ.x 1 /3 3e x , .x 1 ; x 2 / 2 R2 . Therefore, by (1.14) and (1.15), 2 df .x/ D .x 1 /2 dx 1 e x dx 2 ; 2 df .x/ŒEv.x/ D .x 1 /2 v1 .x/ e x v2 .x/; df .0; 0/ŒEv.0; 0/ D v2 .0; 0/: Example 1.1.10. Consider the function f .x/ WD x k . Then df .x/ D dx k ; @ j @ D ıi j : @x i @x Furthermore, by (1.15), dx k @ @x i j D ıi @ xk D ı j i ı k j D ı ki : @x j Therefore, we identify the coordinate covariant basis field for TQx .RN / as ˚ (1.16) fQe1 .x/; : : : ; eQ N .x/g DW dx 1 ; : : : ; dx N ; eQ k .x/ eEi .x/ D ı ki : (1.17) Thus, every covariant vector (or 1-form) admits the linear combination Q W.x/ D Wj .x/dx j (1.18) in terms of the basis covariant vectors dx j ’s. The (unique) functions, Wj .x/, are called covariant components. 1.1 Differentiable Manifolds 11 Fig. 1.6 A parametrized curve into M Example 1.1.11. Consider the two-dimensional Euclidean manifold and a Cartesian coordinate chart. Let another chart be given by xO 1 D XO 1 .x/ WD .x 1 /3 ; xO 2 D XO 2 .x/ WD .x 2 /3 ; .x 1 ; x 2 / 2 R2 f.0; 0/g I .xO 1 ; xO 2 / 2 R2 f.0; 0/g : Then, by direct computations, we deduce that @ @ 1 @ 1 @ D ; D ; @xO 1 3.x 1 /2 @x 1 @xO 2 3.x 2 /2 @x 2 dxO 1 D 3.x 1 /2 dx 1 ; dxO 2 D 3.x 2 /2 dx 2 : It can now be verified that dxO i @ @xO j D dx i @ @x j D ı ij : Now we shall discuss a different topic, namely, a parametrized curve . Consider an interval Œa; b R. (Remark: Open or semiopen intervals are also allowed. Moreover, unbounded intervals are permitted too.) The parametrized curve is a function from the interval Œa; b into a differentiable manifold. (See Fig. 1.6.) 12 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds (Note that the function is called the parametrized curve.) The image of the composite function X WD ı in D RN is denoted by the symbol . The coordinates on are furnished by x D Œ ı .t/ D X .t/; x j D Œ j ı ı .t/ D j ı X .t/ DW X j .t/: (1.19) Here, t 2 Œa; b R. The functions j are usually assumed to be differentiable and piecewise twice-differentiable. The condition of the nondegeneracy (or regularity) is N 2 X dX j .t/ > 0: (1.20) dt j D1 In Newtonian physics, t is taken to be the time variable and M D E 3 , the physical space. Moreover, is a particle trajectory relative to a Cartesian coordinate system. The nondegeneracy condition (1.20) implies that the speed of the motion is strictly positive. Example 1.1.12. Let the image in R3 be given by x D X .t/ WD .2 cos2 t; sin 2t; 2 sin t/I 0 < t < =2: The curve is nondegenerate and the coordinate functions are real-analytic. Consider a circular cylinder in R3 such that it intersects the x 1 x 2 plane on the unit circle with the center at .1; 0; 0/. Now, consider a spherical surface in R3 given by the equation .x 1 /2 C .x 2 /2 C .x 3 /2 D 4. The image lies in the intersection of the cylinder and the sphere. Let us consider the tangent vector Etx of the image at the (see Fig. 1.7). In calculus, the components of the tangent vector 1 N to be dX .t / ; : : : ; dX .t / . Therefore, the tangent vector EtX .t / dt dt point x in RN EtX .t / are taken 0 E .t/ along X (according to (1.3)) must be defined as the generalized directional derivative: j 0 @ E .t/ WD dX .t/ EtX .t / X : ˇ dt @x j ˇX .t / (1.21) The above tangent vector field belongs to the tangent vector space TX .t /.R3 / along . Example 1.1.13. Let a real-analytic, nondegenerate curve X into R4 be defined by x D X .t/ WD ..t/3 ; t; e t ; sinh t/; 1 < t < 1I X .0/ D .0; 0; 1; 0/: 1.1 Differentiable Manifolds 13 Fig. 1.7 Reparametrization of a curve The corresponding tangent vector field along directional derivative: 0 E .t/ D .3t 2 / X 0 E .0/ D X is furnished by the generalized @ @ @ @ C .e t / ; ˇ C ˇ ˇ C .cosh t/ ˇ 1 2 3 @x ˇX .t / @x ˇX .t / @x ˇX .t / @x 4 ˇX .t / @ @ @ C C : ˇ ˇ ˇ @x 2 ˇX .0/ @x 3 ˇX .0/ @x 4 ˇX .0/ 0 E .t/ can act on a differentiable function f (restricted to The tangent vector X by (1.22) to follow. On this topic, we state and prove the following theorem. ) Theorem 1.1.14. Let a parametrized curve X W Œa; b R ! RN be differentiable and nondegenerate. Let f W D RN ! R be a (totally) differentiable function. Then 0 E .t/Œf .X .t// D d Œf .X .t//: (1.22) X dt Proof. By (1.15) and the chain rule of differentiation, the left-hand side of the above equation yields dX j .t/ @ dX j .t/ @f .x/ d Œf .X .t// D Œf .X .t//: ˇ ˇ dt @x j ˇX .t / dt @x j ˇX .t / dt Now, we shall discuss the reparametrization of a curve. Let h be a differentiable and one-to-one mapping from Œc; d R into R. (See Fig. 1.7.). The image in RN is given by the points t D h.s/; x D X .t/; a t b; a D h.c/; b D h.d /; x D X # .s/; c s d: 14 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds Here, X # WD X ı h (1.23) is the reparametrized curve into RN . Theorem 1.1.15. If X # is the reparametrization of the differentiable curve X by the function h, then the tangent vector #0 0 E .h.s//: E .s/ D dh.s/ X X ds (1.24) Proof. By (1.23), we get X #j .s/ D X j .h.s//: By the assumption of differentiabilities and the chain rule, we obtain dX j .t/ dX #j .s/ dh.s/ ˇ D : ˇ ds dt ds t Dh.s/ Therefore, the tangent vector #j #0 @ dh.s/ dX j .t/ E .s/ D dX .s/ @ ˇ X D ˇ ˇ j ds @x ˇX # .s/ ds dt ˇt Dh.s/ @x j ˇX .h.s// dh.s/ E 0 X .h.s//: ds Example 1.1.16. Consider the Euclidean plane E 2 and a parametrized (realanalytic) curve X WD ı given by X .t/ WD .cos t; sin t/; 2 t 2: The image is a unit circle in R2 with self-intersections. The winding number of this circle is exactly two. Let a reparametrization be defined by t D h.s/ WD 2s; s I dh.s/ 2 > 0: ds The reparametrized curve X # is furnished by X # .s/ D X .2s/ D .cos.2s/; sin.2s//: 1.1 Differentiable Manifolds 15 The new tangent vector is given by #0 E .s/ D 2 .sin 2s/ @ C .cos 2s/ @ ˇ X @x 1 @x 2 ˇX # .s/ 0 E .2s/: D 2X Exercises 1.1 1. Consider the three-dimensional Euclidean manifold and a global Cartesian chart .; E 3 / given by x D .x 1 ; x 2 ; x 3 / D .p/; x in D D R3 : The spherical polar chart .; O UO / is given by O xO D .xO 1 ; xO 2 ; xO 3 / .r; ; '/ D .p/; ˚ 1 2 3 3 1 DO WD .xO ; xO ; xO / 2 R W xO > 0; 0 < xO 2 < ; < xO 3 < : The coordinate transformation is characterized by O WD xO 1 sin xO 2 cos xO 3 ; x 1 D X 1 .x/ x 2 D X 2 .x/ O WD xO 1 sin xO 2 sin xO 3 ; x 3 D X 3 .x/ O WD xO 1 cos xO 2 : Obtain the inverse functions XO 1 .x/; XO 2 .x/; XO 3 .x/ explicitly. 2. Prove (1.10) in the text. 3. Consider a function of two variables given by 8 1 2 .x / sin.1=x 1 / C .x 2 /2 sin.1=x 2 / for x 1 x 2 ¤ 0; ˆ ˆ ˆ ˆ < .x 1 /2 sin.1=x 1 / for x 1 ¤ 0 and x 2 D 0; f .x 1 ; x 2 / WD ˆ .x 2 /2 sin.1=x 2 / for x 1 D 0 and x 2 ¤ 0; ˆ ˆ :̂ 0 for x 1 D x 2 D 0: (i) Prove that f is totally differentiable at the origin .0; 0/. 1 2 1 2 (ii) Prove that @f .x@x ;1x / and @f .x@x ;2 x / exist but are discontinuous at the origin. 16 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds E Q 4. Evaluate the 1-form w.x/ WD ıij x i dx j on the tangent vector field V.x/ WD PN j 5 @ E Q .x / . Prove that w.x/Œ V.x/ 0. j D1 @x j 5. Consider the semicubical parabola in R2 given by X .t/ WD .t 2 ; t 3 /; t 2 R: The curve is degenerate at X .0/ D .0; 0/. Prove that reparametrization of this curve cannot remove the degeneracy. (Remark: The degenerate point is called a cusp.) Answers and Hints to Selected Exercises 1. xO 1 D XO 1 .x/ D p .x 1 /2 C .x 2 /2 C .x 3 /2 ; i h p xO 2 D XO 2 .x/ D Arccos x 3 = .x 1 /2 C .x 2 /2 C .x 3 /2 ; xO 3 D XO 3 .x/ D arc.x 1 ; x 2 /: 3. 1 2 8 < 2x 1 sin @f .x ; x / D : @x 1 0 1 1 cos x1 x1 for x 1 D 0 I 8 < 2x 2 sin 1 cos 1 @f .x 1 ; x 2 / x2 x2 D : @x 2 0 for x 2 D 0: for x 1 ¤ 0; for x 2 ¤ 0; (See [112].) 1.2 Tensor Fields Over Differentiable Manifolds Consider a point x0 .x01 ; : : : ; x0N / D .p0 / 2 RN. The corresponding tangent vector space and the cotangent (or covariant) vector space are denoted by Tx0 RN and TQx0 RN , respectively. An .r C s/th order (or rank) mixed tensor rsTx0 is 1.2 Tensor Fields Over Differentiable Manifolds 17 a function3 from the Cartesian product TQx0 TQx0 Tx0 Tx0 into R. „ ƒ‚ … „ ƒ‚ … r s Moreover, it has to satisfy the following multilinearity conditions: uQ 1x0 ; : : : ; uQ kx0 C vQ kx0 ; : : : ; uQ rx0 I aE 1 x0 ; : : : ; aE s x0 D rs Tx0 uQ 1x0 ; : : : ; uQ kx0 ; : : : ; uQ rx0 I aE 1 x0 ; : : : ; aE s x0 C rs Tx0 uQ 1x0 ; : : : ; vQ kx0 ; : : : ; uQ rx0 I aE 1 x0 ; : : : ; aE s x0 ; (1.25i) E j x0 ; : : : ; aE s x0 uQ 1x0 ; : : : ; uQ rx0 I aE 1 x0 ; : : : ; aE j x0 C b D Tx0 uQ 1x0 ; : : : ; uQ rx0 I aE 1 x0 ; : : : ; aE j x0 ; : : : ; aE s x0 h i r 1 r E Q Q E E C u ; T ; : : : ; u I a ; : : : ; b ; : : : ; a 1 x0 j x0 s x0 s x0 x0 x0 (1.25ii) r s Tx0 r s Tx0 j for all , in R, all uQ 1x0 ; : : : ; uQ rx0 I vQ kx0 in TQx0 RN , all aE 1 x0 ; : : : ; aE s x0 I bE x0 in N Tx0 R , all k in f1; : : : ; rg, and all j in f1; : : : ; sg. Here, the nonnegative integer r represents the contravariant order and the nonnegative integer s represents the covariant order. Note that the function rs Tx0 is linear in each of the r C s slots in the argument. (See [23, 56, 195, 197].) Example 1.2.1. The (unique) .r C s/th order zero tensor is defined by r s 0 x0 1 uQ x0 ; : : : ; uQ rx0 I aE 1 x0 ; : : : ; aE s x0 WD 0 (1.26) for all uQ 1x0 ; : : : ; uQ rx0 in TQx0 RN and all aE 1 x0 ; : : : ; aE s x0 in Tx0 RN . Let bQ kx0 WD ˇ k1 eQ 1x0 C CˇNk eQ N and aE j x0 ˚ 1 x0 N EeN x0 and eQ x0 ; : : : ; eQ x0 are basis sets Example 1.2.2. ˚ (Here, Ee1 x0 ; : : : ; respectively.) Let a function be defined by r s Fx0 bQ 1x0 ; : : : ; bQ rx0 I aE 1 x0 ; : : : ; aE s x0 WD ˇ 11 ˇ 22 ˇ rr ˛ 11 ˛ 22 ˛ ss : The function rs Fx0 can be proved to be a mixed tensor of order .r C s/. 3 D ˛ 1j Ee1 x0 C C˛ Nj EeN x0 . for Tx0 .RN / and TQx0 .RN /, The rank of a tensor is different from the rank of a matrix. The rank of a matrix is defined as the number of linearly independent rows or columns of a matrix. (These two numbers are the same if the elements are commutative.) Because of this, one sometimes uses the term “tensor order” or “degree of the tensor” when referring to tensor rank to avoid confusion. The tensor order or degree is the dimension of the minimum array required to represent the tensor. In index notation, this is equivalent to the number of indices required to represent the tensor. (See [8].) 18 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds The linear combination of two mixed tensors are defined by: uQ 1x0 ; : : : ; uQ rx0 I aE 1 x0 ; : : : ; aE s x0 WD rs Tx0 uQ 1x0 ; : : : ; uQ rx0 I aE 1 x0 ; : : : ; aE s x0 C rs Wx0 uQ 1x0 ; : : : ; uQ rx0 I aE 1 x0 ; : : : ; aE s x0 r s Tx0 C r s Wx0 (1.27) for all , in R, all uQ 1x0 ; : : : ; uQ rx0 in TQ x0 .RN / and all aE 1 x0 ; : : : ; aE s x0 in Tx0 .RN /. (Note that addition between two tensors of different order is not permitted.) It can be proved via (1.27) that the set of all mixed tensors of order .r C s/ constitutes a (real) vector space of dimension N rCs . The tensor product (or outer product) between two tensors rs Tx0 and p p N N r Q Q q Wx0 is defined by the function s Tx0 ˝ q Wx0 from Tx0 .R / Tx0 .R / „ ƒ‚ … rCp Tx0 .RN / Tx0 .RN / into R such that „ ƒ‚ … sCq r s Tx0 1 p uQ x0 ;: : : ; uQ rx0 I q Wx0 ˝ DW r s Tx0 p vQ 1x0 ;: : : ; vQ x0 I aE 1 x0 ;: : : ; aE s x0 I bE 1 x0 ; : : : ; bE q x0 1 p p E E uQ x0 ; : : : ; uQ rx0 I aE 1 x0 ; : : : ; aE s x0 q Wx0 vQ 1x0 ; : : : ; vQ x0 I b 1 x0 ;: : : ; bq x0 (1.28) E 1 x0 ; : : : ; b E q x0 in Tx0 .RN / and all uQ 1x ; : : : ; uQ rx I vQ 1x ; : : : ; for all aE 1 x0 ; : : : ; aE s x0 I b 0 0 0 p p vQ x0 in TQx0 .RN /. Note that rs Tx0 ˝ q Wx0 is a tensor of order .r C p/ C .s C q/. ˚ Example 1.2.3. Let N D 2 and Ee1 x0 ; Ee2 x0 be a basis set for Tx0 .RN /. Let two covariant tensors, 01 Tx0 and 02 Wx0 , be defined by E 1 x0 D ˇ 1 Ee1 x0 C ˇ 2 Ee2 x0 ; bE 2 x0 D ˇ 1 Ee1 x0 C ˇ 2 Ee2 x0 ; aE x0 D ˛ 1 Ee1 x0 C ˛ 2 Ee2 x0 ; b 1 1 2 2 Ecx0 D 1 Ee1 x0 C 2 Ee2 x0 I 0 a x0 / 1 Tx0 .E WD ˛ 1 ; 0 E 2 Wx0 .b1 x0 ; bE 2 x0 / WD ˇ 11 ˇ 22 : Then, by the tensor product rule (1.28), we derive that 0 1 Tx0 ˝ 0 2 Wx0 E 1 x0 ; b E 2 x0 D ˛ 1 ˇ 11 ˇ 22 2 R: aE x0 I b 1.2 Tensor Fields Over Differentiable Manifolds 19 Moreover, 0 E 2 x0 aE x0 C Ecx0 I bE 1 x0 ; b ˝ 02 Wx0 D ˛ 1 C 1 ˇ 11 ˇ 22 D ˛ 1 ˇ 11 ˇ 22 C 1 ˇ 11 ˇ 22 h i 0 0 E 1 x0 ; bE 2 x0 aE x0 I b D 1 Tx0 ˝ 2 Wx0 h i 0 0 E 2 x0 : Ecx0 I bE 1 x0 ; b C 1 Tx0 ˝ 2 Wx0 1 Tx0 Similarly, we can deduce that 0 1 Tx0 ˝ 0 2 Wx0 h D 0 1 Tx0 1 Tx0 0 1 Tx0 ˝ 0 2 Wx0 h D 0 1 Tx0 C ˝ h C 0 h 0 2 Wx0 ˝ ˝ 0 1 Tx0 aE x0 I E 1 x0 C Ecx0 ; b E 2 x0 b 0 2 Wx0 E 2 x0 aE x0 I bE 1 x0 ; b ˝ 0 2 Wx0 i i aE x0 I Ecx0 ; bE 2 x0 ; aE x0 ; bE 1 x0 ; 0 2 Wx0 E 2 x0 C Ecx0 b E 2 x0 aE x0 ; bE 1 x0 ; b i i aE x0 ; bE 1 x0 ; Ecx0 : Thus, by (1.28), the tensor product 01 Tx0 ˝ 02 Wx0 is a tensor of order Œ0 C .1 C 2/. Now we shall introduce the concept of a tensor field in D R . A (tangent) tensor field rs T is a function that assigns a tensor rs T.x/ for each point x in D RN . (A more rigorous definition of a tensor field is as a section of the tensor (fiber) bundle. See [38, 56, 267].) Lower order tensors have special names and abbreviated notations. For example, 0 T.x/ 2 R is called a scalar field. 10 T.x/ is a tangent vector field (or contravariant 0 vector field), whereas 01 T.x/ is a cotangent (or covariant) vector field. We denote lower order tensors by the following simplified notations: N 0 0 T.x/ DW T .x/; 0 2 g.x/ DW g:: .x/; 1 3 R.x/ DW R::: .x/; etc. (1.29) 20 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds ˚ N ˚ N Let Eei .x/ 1 and eQ i .x/ 1 be basis sets for Tx .RN / and TQx .RN /, respectively. ˚ It can be proved that Eei1 .x/ ˝ Eei 2 .x/ ˝ ˝ Eei r .x/ ˝ eQ j1 .x/ ˝ eQ j 2 .x/ ˝ N ˝ eQ js .x/ 1 is a basis set for the set of all .r C s/th order tensor fields. Let us choose coordinate basis sets Eei .x/ D @x@ i and eQ j .x/ D dx j as in (1.7) and (1.16). Therefore, a tensor field rs T.x/ can be expressed as a linear combination r s T.x/ r D T i1 ;:::;i j1 ;:::;js .x/ @ @ ˝ ˝ i ˝ dx j1 ˝ ˝ dx js : @x i1 @x r (1.30) The N rCs real-valued functions r i1 ir r T i1 ;:::;i j1 ;:::;js .x/ WD s T dx ; : : : ; dx I @ @ ; :::; @x j1 @x js (1.31) are called the coordinate components of the tensor field rs T.x/ (relative to the chosen coordinate chart). There exist other distinct but isomorphic (exactly similar) tensors of the same order .r 0 D r; s 0 D s/. For example, we can define an isomorphic tensor by Tj01 ;:::;jsi1 ;:::;ir .x/ dx j1 ˝ ˝ dx js ˝ @ @ ˝˝ i @x i1 @x r D rs I.x/ rs T.x/ WD T i1 ;:::;irj1 ;:::;js .x/ dx j1 ˝ ˝ dx js ˝ @ @ ˝˝ i : i 1 @x @x r The linear combination in (1.27) and the tensor product in (1.28) yield, respectively, .x/ rs T.x/ C .x/ rs W.x/ h i1 ;:::;ir r .x/T i1 ;:::;i j1 ;:::;js .x/C .x/W j1 ;:::;js .x/ ˝ pq B.x/ i h u1 ;:::;up r D T i1 ;:::;i j1 ;:::;js .x/B v1 ;:::;vq .x/ i @ @ ˝ ˝ i ˝ dx j1 ˝ ˝ dx js ; i 1 @x @x r (1.32i) r s T.x/ @ @ @ @ ˝ ˝ i ˝ u ˝ ˝ ip i 1 r 1 @x @x @x @x ˝ dx j1 ˝ ˝ dx js ˝ dx v1 ˝ ˝ dx vq : (1.32ii) 1.2 Tensor Fields Over Differentiable Manifolds 21 Now, we shall define the contraction operation. It is defined by u vC r s T.x/ h i i ;:::;i ci ;:::;ir WD T 1 u1 uC1 j1 ;:::;j .x/ v1 cjvC1 ;:::;js @ @ @ @ ˝˝ i ˝ i ˝ ˝ i ˝ dx j1 ˝ i 1 u1 uC1 @x @x @x @x r ˝ dx jv1 ˝ dx jvC1 ˝ ˝ dx js : It can be proved that uv C r s T.x/ (1.33) is a tensor field of order .r 1/ C .s 1/. Example 1.2.4. Let us choose a two-dimensional manifold and a coordinate chart. Let a basis field and its conjugate covariant field be expressed as @ q ; eQ q .x/ D EQ j .x/ dx j I @x i ˚ q EQ i .x/E ip .x/ D ı pq ; i; j 2 f1; 2g I x 2 D WD x 2 R2 W jx 1 j < 1; jx 2 j < 1 : Eep .x/ WD E ip .x/ Let a scalar field be defined by .x/ WD exp x 1 x 2 : Furthermore, let two tensor fields be furnished by (suspending the summation convention temporarily in this example) T .x/ WD " 2 X # p t ıqt x x Eep .x/ ˝ eQ q .x/; t D1 W .x/ WD 2 2 X X ıvs .x 4 /3 .x s /3 Eeu .x/ ˝ eQ v .x/: uD1 sD1 Then, by (1.32i), (1.32ii), and (1.33), we get p p .x/T q .x/ C W q .x/ D 2 X ıqt exp.x 1 x 2 /x p x t C .x p /3 .x t /3 ; t D1 2 2 X X pu p u T .x/ ˝ W .x/ qv D T q .x/W v .x/ D ıqt ıvs x p x t .x u /3 .x s /3 ; sD1 t D1 1 1C 1 1C T .x/ D T cc .x/ D ıcq x c x q 0; 1 T 0; 2 D 1 : 4 22 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds Fig. 1.8 The Jacobian mapping of tangent vectors Now we shall discuss the transformation of tensor components under a general coordinate transformation discussed in (1.2). To reiterate briefly, xO k D XO k .x/ XO k .x 1 ; : : : ; x N /; x / X k .xO 1 ; : : : ; xO N /; x k D X k .b x 2 Ds RN I xO 2 DO s RN : The functions XO k and X k are assumed to be differentiable. The above coordinate b E 0 from Tx RN into TxO RN (see transformation induces a one-to-one mapping X Fig. 1.8). This mapping is called the Jacobian mapping or derivative mapping. It is furnished by h i EO 0 .Et.x// Œf .x/ X O WD Et.x/ f ı XO .x/ ; 1 E0 D X EO 0 : X (1.34) EO 0 Et.x/ is in TxO RN and f is a real-valued differentiable Here, Et.x/ is in Tx .RN /, X O RN . function from Ds OQ 0 from The coordinate transformations XO and X D XO 1 induce the mapping X TQx .RN / into TQxO .RN / by the following rule: h OQ 0 .!.x// X Q i EO x/ EO x/ E 0 V. O V. O WD !.x/ Q X : (1.35) Example 1.2.5. Let us choose Et.x/ D @x@ i in Tx .RN /. Moreover, we choose f D j , the projection mapping in (1.2). By (1.34), we obtain 1.2 Tensor Fields Over Differentiable Manifolds EO 0 X @ @x i i @ h @XO j .x/ j .x/ O D i j ı XO .x/ D : @x @x i O Now, choosing !.x/ Q D dx i and VE .x/ O D h OQ 0 .dx i / X i @ @xO j E0 D dx i X @ @xO j , we derive, from (1.35), that @ @xO j O @ @X k .x/ @xO j @x k D dx i 23 D @X k .x/ O @ dx i @xO j @x k D @X i .x/ O : @xO j But we have @X i .x/ O dxO k k @xO @ @xO j D @X i .x/ O @ dxO k j k @xO @x D @X i .x/ O : j @xO Comparing both equations, we conclude that i O OQ 0 .dx i / D @X .x/ dxO k : X @xO k The coordinate transformations XO and X induce transformations from rs T.x/ into They are explicitly defined as r O O s T.x/. rO O s T.x/ O0 WD rs X r s T.x/ ; hO0 i O0 O0 OQ 0 .w r O0 r E E Q E E Q Q v v X T.x/ . w .x// ; : : : ; X .x// I X .x/ ; : : : ; X .x/ X 1 r 1 s s s WD r s T.x/ Q 1 .x/; : : : ; w Q r .x/I vE 1 .x/; : : : ; vE s .x/ ; w (1.36) Q 1 .x/; : : : ; w Q r .x/ in TQx .RN /. for all vE 1 .x/; : : : ; vEs .x/ in Tx .RN / and all w We shall now derive the transformation rules for the (coordinate) components of the tensor field in (1.30). Theorem 1.2.6. The transformation rules of the .r C s/th order tensor field r components T i1 ;:::;i j1 ;:::;js .x/ under a general coordinate transformation (1.2) are furnished by O O @XO k1 .x/ @XO kr .x/ @X j1 .x/ @X js .x/ r r TO k1 ;:::;k . x/ O D ; : : : ; ; : : : ; T i1 ;:::;i j1 ;:::;js .x/; l1 ;:::;ls i i l l 1 r 1 s @x @x @xO @xO (1.37) where x 2 Ds D RN and xO 2 DO s DO RN . 24 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds Proof. By Definition (1.36) and (1.34) and (1.35), we obtain r s T.x/ D D h dx i1 ; : : : ; dx ir I r O O s T.x/ @ @ ;:::; j j @x 1 @x s i @X i1 .x/ O @XO ls .x/ @ dxO k1 ; : : : ; k @xO 1 @x js @xO ls ! i @X i1 .x/ @XO ls .x/ hr O @ O k1 T. x/ O ; : : : ; ; : : : ; d x O s @xO k1 @x js @xO ls or r T i1 ;:::;i j1 ;:::;js .x/ D O O @XO l1 .x/ @X i1 .x/ @X ir .x/ @XO ls .x/ O k1 ;:::;kr T l1 ;:::;ls .x/: ; : : : ; ; : : : ; O @xO k1 @xO kr @x j1 @x js Inverting the above equation by using @XO k .x/ @X m .x/ O O @XO m .x/ @X j .x/ j k D ı ; D ıl ; i m i m l @x @xO @xO @x we obtain the transformation in (1.37). (1.38) Example 1.2.7. Consider the case of N D 2 and D D Ds D R2 . Let a (real) analytic transformation be provided by xO 1 D XO 1 .x/ WD x 1 C x 2 ; xO 2 D XO 2 .x/ WD x 1 x 2 ; " # @ xO 1 ; xO 2 @XO i .x/ det 2: @ .x 1 ; x 2 / @x j Let a .2 C 0/th order tensor field be furnished by @ @ T .x/ WD .x i x j / i ˝ j ; @x @x T ij .x/ D x i x j : The transformed components TO kl .x/ O are given by (1.37) as " TO 11 .x/ O D @XO 1 .x/ @x 1 #2 " " # #2 @XO 1 .x/ @XO 1 .x/ @XO 1 .x/ 12 T .x/C2 T 22 .x/ T .x/C @x 1 @x 2 @x 2 11 D .x 1 C x 2 /2 D .xO 1 /2 : 1.2 Tensor Fields Over Differentiable Manifolds 25 Similarly, we can deduce that O D xO k xO l : TO kl .x/ In many physical applications, the components of a tensor restricted to a special curve are of interest. The values of TO kl .x/ O restricted to a special curve XO 1 .t/ WD t; XO 2 .t/ WD t; t 2 R; are furnished by TO 11 .x/ O jXO .t / D .t/2 TO 22 .x/ O jXO .t / TO 12 .x/ O jXO .t / TO 21 .x/ O jXO .t / : p Evaluated p at a particular point, corresponding to t D 1= 2 say, and the image point XO .1= 2/, the values of the tensor’s components are p p p p TO 11 1= 2; 1= 2 D TO 22 1= 2; 1= 2 p p p p D TO 12 1= 2; 1= 2 D TO 21 1= 2; 1= 2 D 1=2: Now we shall define the transformation rules for the components of a relative tensor field rs .x/ of weight w (sometimes called a tensor density field of weight w). These are furnished by O @X m .x/ O i1 ;:::;ij1r ;:::;js .x/ O D det n @xO w @XO i1 .x/ @XO ir .x/ ; : : : ; @x k1 @x kr O O @X l1 .x/ @X ls .x/ r ; : : : ; k1 ;:::;k l1 ;:::;ls .x/ : j j 1 s @xO @xO (1.39) In case w D 0, (1.39) reduces to (1.37). In case w D 1, the relative tensor r i1 ;:::;i j1 ;:::;js .x/ is called a tensor density field. (See [244].) Another generalization of tensor fields is possible. An oriented relative tensor field of weight w is characterized by the transformation rules: O @X m .x/ ˚O i1 ;:::;ij1r;:::;js .x/ O D sgn det @xO n det @X m .x/ O @xO n w O O @X l1 .x/ @X ls .x/ r ; : : : ; ˚ k1 ;:::;k l1 ;:::;ls .x/: @xO j1 @xO js @XO i1 .x/ @XO ir .x/ ;:::; k @x 1 @x kr (1.40) Example 1.2.8. Suppose that Tij .x/ are coordinate components of the tensor field T:: .x/. By the transformation rules (1.37), we deduce that 26 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds O O @X k .x/ @X l .x/ TOij .x/ O D T .x/ : kl i j @xO @xO Taking the determinant of both sides, we obtain h i O O @X k .x/ @X l .x/ det TOij .x/ det ŒT O D det .x/ det kl i j @xO @xO 2 O @X m .x/ D det det ŒTkl .x/ : @xO n Extracting the positive square root of both sides, we get rˇ h iˇ ˇˇ O @X m .x/ ˇ ˇ O O ˇ D ˇˇdet ˇdet Tij .x/ n @xO D sgn det ˇ ˇ p ˇ jdet ŒTkl .x/j ˇ @X m .x/ O n @xO p @X m .x/ O jdet ŒTkl .x/j : n @xO det p Comparing the above with (1.40), we conclude that jdet ŒTkl .x/j transforms as an oriented relative scalar field of weight 1. It is also called an oriented scalar density field. Now we shall generate some new tensor fields out of the old tensor fields 0p T.x/. The symmetrization operation is defined by p T.x/ Symm WD p T.x/ 1 pŠ aE 1 .x/; : : : ; aE p .x/ X p T.x/ aE E .p/ .x/ .1/ .x/; : : : ; a (1.41) 2Sp for all aE 1 .x/; : : : ; aEp .x/ in Tx RN . Here, denotes a permutation of .1; 2; : : : ; p/ into . .1/; .2/; : : : ; .p//. The corresponding (coordinate) components must satisfy: Symm p T.x/ aE E .p/ .x/ .1/ .x/; : : : ; a Symm p T.x/ aE 1 .x/; : : : ; aE p .x/ : (1.42) Example 1.2.9. Consider p D 2; N 2. There exist two distinct permutations of .1; 2/. These are given by 1 .1; 2/ WD .1; 2/ and 2 .1; 2/ D .2; 1/. Therefore, by (1.41), we obtain 1.2 Tensor Fields Over Differentiable Manifolds 27 Symm ŒT:: .x/ aE 1 .x/; aE 2 .x/ 1˚ ŒT:: .x/ aE 1 .x/; aE 2 .x/ C ŒT:: .x/ aE 2 .x/; aE 1 .x/ ; 2 @ @ 1 ; Tij .x/ C Tj i .x/ : Symm ŒT:: .x/ D i j @x @x 2 D (1.43) In case the tensor components satisfy Ti1 :::ip :::iq ::: .x/ Ti1 :::iq :::ip ::: .x/ (in any dimension), the tensor is said to be symmetric in the pth and qth index. If a second rank tensor satisfies Tij .x/ Tj i .x/, the tensor T:: .x/ is called a symmetric tensor. A symmetric second-order tensor field in an N -dimensional manifold has N.N C 1/=2 linearly independent components. Antisymmetrization is defined by the alternating operation Alt p T.x/ aE 1 .x/; : : : ; aE p .x/ WD 1 pŠ X Œsgn. / p T.x/ aE E .p/ .x/ .1/ .x/; : : : ; a (1.44) 2Sp for all aE 1 .x/; : : : ; aEp .x/ in Tx RN . We can prove that Alt p T.x/ aE E .p/ .x/ .1/ .x/; : : : ; a Œsgn. / Alt p T.x/ aE 1 .x/; : : : ; aE p .x/ : (1.45) The tensor Alt p T.x/ is called a totally antisymmetric tensor. (See [56, 195, 237].) Example 1.2.10. Consider the case of N D p D 2. The permutations have sgn. 1 / D 1 and sgn. 2 / D 1. Therefore, by (1.44), ŒAlt T:: .x/ 1 and 2 1 ŒT12 .x/ T21 .x/ ; 2 1 Tij .x/ Tj i .x/ ŒAlt T:: .x/j i ; ŒAlt T:: .x/ij D 2 @ @ ; 1 @x @x 2 D ŒAlt T:: .x/11 D ŒAlt T:: .x/22 0: In case the tensor components satisfy Ti1 :::ip :::iq ::: .x/ Ti1 :::iq :::ip ::: .x/ (in any dimension), the tensor is said to be antisymmetric in the pth and qth index. If a second rank tensor satisfies Tij .x/ Tj i .x/, the tensor T:: .x/ is called an antisymmetric tensor. The number of linearly independent components of such a tensor in N -dimensions is exactly N.N 1/=2. 28 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds Now we are ready to define the exterior or wedge product. Let p W.x/ and q U.x/ be two totally antisymmetric tensor fields (antisymmetric on the interchange of any two indices). Then, the wedge product is defined by p W.x/ ^ q U.x/ WD p W.x/ ^ q U.x/ aE 1 .x/; : : : ; aE p .x/I aE pC1 .x/; : : : ; aE pCq .x/ 1 .pŠ/.qŠ/ D .p C q/Š Alt p W.x/ ˝ q U.x/ ; .pŠ/.qŠ/ aE X sgn. / p W.x/ ˝ q U.x/ 2SpCq E .p/ .x/I .1/ .x/; : : : ; a aE E .pCq/ .x/ .pC1/ .x/; : : : ; a (1.46) for all aE 1 .x/; : : : ; aEpCq .x/ in Tx RN . Example 1.2.11. Let the dimension N 3. There are six distinct permutations of .1; 2; 3/. These can be listed as follows: 1 .1; 2; 3/ WD .1; 2; 3/, 2 .1; 2; 3/ WD .2; 1; 3/, 3 .1; 2; 3/ WD .1; 3; 2/, 4 .1; 2; 3/ WD .3; 2; 1/, 5 .1; 2; 3/ WD .2; 3; 1/, 6 .1; 2; 3/ WD .3; 1; 2/. The permutations 2 ; 3 ; 4 are odd and the permutations 1 ; 5 ; 6 are even. Let us consider the wedge product between w:: .x/ Q and u.x/. By (1.46), it is given by Q Œw:: .x/ ^ u.x/ aE 1 .x/; aE 2 .x/I aE 3 .x/ 1˚ Q w:: .x/ aE 1 .x/; aE 2 .x/ uQ aE 3 .x/ w:: .x/ aE 2 .x/; aE 1 .x/ u.x/ aE 3 .x/ D 2 Q Q w:: .x/ aE 1 .x/; aE 3 .x/ u.x/ aE 2 .x/ w:: .x/ aE 3 .x/; aE 2 .x/ u.x/ aE 1 .x/ Q Q aE 1 .x/ C w:: .x/ aE3 .x/; aE 1 .x/ u.x/ aE 2 .x/ Cw:: .x/ aE 2 .x/; aE 3 .x/ u.x/ Q ^ w:: .x/ aE 1 .x/; aE 2 .x/I aE 3 .x/ : D .1/.21/ Œu.x/ Now we state the important properties of the wedge product in the following theorem. Theorem 1.2.12. The wedge product satisfies the following rules: p A.x/ C p B.x/ ^ q C.x/ D p A.x/ ^ q C.x/ C p B.x/ ^ q C.x/ ; (1.47i) p A.x/ ^ q B.x/ C q C.x/ D p A.x/ ^ q B.x/ C p A.x/ ^ q C.x/ ; .x/ p U.x/ ^ .x/ q W.x/ D Œ .x/ .x/ p U.x/ ^ q W.x/ ; (1.47ii) (1.47iii) 1.2 Tensor Fields Over Differentiable Manifolds p A.x/ 29 ^ q B.x/ ^ Œ r C.x/ D p A.x/ ^ q B.x/ ^ r C.x/ DW p A.x/ ^ q B.x/ ^ r C.x/; q U.x/ ^ p W.x/ D .1/pq p W.x/ ^ q U.x/ : (1.47iv) (1.47v) The proof is left as an exercise for the reader. Next we shall introduce a .p C p/th order .2 p N / totally antisymmetric p numerical tensor. It is called the generalized Kronecker tensor, p ı. It is defined by p pı ı a1 ;:::;ap b1 ;:::;bp Example 1.2.13. WD ı a1 ;:::;ap b1 ;:::;bp ˇ a1 a1 ˇı b ıb ˇ 1 2 ˇ: WD ˇ :: ˇ ap ap ˇı ı b1 b2 @ @ ˝ ˝ ap ˝ dx b1 ˝ ˝ dx bp ; @x a1 @x ˇ : : : ı ab1p ˇˇ ˇ (1.48) ˇ: a ˇ ::: ı p ˇ bp ıba11ba22 D ı ab11 ıba22 ıba21 ıba12 are the components of 22 ı ı :: . p The pertinent properties of p ı are listed below. p Theorem 1.2.14. The components of p ı satisfy the following rules: .i / ı a1 ;:::;ap b1 ;:::;bp 8 ˆ < 1 if .b1 ; : : : ; bp / is an even permutation of .a1 ; : : : ; ap /; D 1 if .b1 ; : : : ; bp / is an odd permutation of .a1 ; : : : ; ap /; :̂ 0 otherwise: (1.49) .ii/ ı a1 ;:::;aq aqC1 ;:::;ap b1 ;:::;bq aqC1 ;:::;ap D Œ.N q/Š=.N p/Š ı a1 ;:::;aq b1 ;:::;bq for 1 q < p N: (1.50) The proof will be left as an exercise. Another totally antisymmetric permutation symbol is that of Levi-Civita. The corresponding components are defined by: "a1 ;:::;aN WD ı 1;:::;N a1 ;:::;aN ; (1.51) N : "b1 ;:::;bN WD ı b1 ;:::;b1;:::;N (1.52) Only N Š among N N components are nonzero. 30 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds Example 1.2.15. "123:::N D "213:::N D ı 12:::N12:::N D 1; "113:::N D 0; etc. (1.53) The main properties of the permutation symbols are summarized in the following theorem. Theorem 1.2.16. The components of the permutation symbols satisfy the following rules: .i/ "a1 ;:::;aN D "a1 ;:::;aN 8 ˆ < 1 if .a1 ; : : : ; aN / is an even permutation of .1; : : : ; N /; D 1 if .a1 ; : : : ; aN / is an odd permutation of .1; : : : ; N /; :̂ 0 otherwise: .ii/ "a1 ;:::;ap apC1 ;:::;aN "b1 ;:::;bp apC1 ;:::;aN D .N p/Š ı .iii/ b1 a1 ; : : : ; bN aN "b1 ;:::;bN ˚ D det c d a1 ;:::;ap b1 ;:::;bp : "a1 ;:::;aN : (1.54) (1.55) (1.56) The proof will be left as an exercise. (See [171, 195].) Example 1.2.17. Consider a two-dimensional vector space. In this case, the permutation symbols satisfy "11 D "11 D "22 D "22 D 0; "12 D "12 D "21 D "21 D 1 I "ab "cd D ı ab12 ı 12 cd ; "ab "ab D 2 I "ab D det a b 1 1 2 2 : (1.57) (This example is relevant in the theory of spin- 21 particles in nature.) Now we shall define a differential form of various orders. The simplest examples of differential forms are 0-forms and 1-forms. A 0-form is defined by a scalar field (or .0 C 0/th order tensor field) f .x/. A 1-form is defined by a covariant vector 1.2 Tensor Fields Over Differentiable Manifolds 31 Q field T.x/ D Tj .x/dx j . Consider now a totally antisymmetric covariant tensor field, p W.x/. According to (1.46), we can express p W.x/ as p W.x/ D Wi1 ;:::;ip .x/ dx i1 ˝ ˝ dx ip D D 1 Wi1 ;:::;ip .x/ dx i1 ^ : : : ^ dx ip pŠ N X Wi1 ;:::;ip .x/ dx i1 ^ : : : ^ d ip : (1.58) 1i1 <<ip 1 The antisymmetric tensor pŠ Wi1 ;:::;ip .x/ dx i1 ^ : : : ^ dx ip is called a pth order differential form or a p-form. (See [23, 38, 56, 104, 237, 267].) Example 1.2.18. Choosing p D q D 1 in N -dimensions, we obtain, from (1.47v), that the two-form dx j ^ dx i has the property dx j ^ dx i D dx i ^ dx j ; which implies that dx 1 ^ dx 1 D dx 2 ^ dx 2 D : : : D dx N ^ dx N D 0:: .x/: (The components of 0:: .x/ are all identically zero.) (1.59) Now we shall introduce the concept of an exterior derivative. In case f is a (totally) differentiable function from D RN into R, the exterior derivative is defined by: df .x/ WD @f .x/ j dx ; @x j h i @f .x/ E df .x/ V.x/ D V j .x/ : @x j (1.60) (Compare with (1.14) and (1.15).) Therefore, df .x/ is a 1-form field. In case Q T.x/ D Tj .x/dx j is a differentiable 1-form, its exterior derivative is defined as: Q dT.x/ WD ŒdTi .x/ ^ dx i D D @Ti .x/ dx j ^ dx i @x j 1 @Ti .x/ @Tj .x/ dx j ^ dx i : 2 @x j @x i The above is obviously a 2-form. (1.61) 32 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds In general, the exterior derivative of a p-form is furnished by: d p W.x/ WD 1 dWj1 ;:::;jp .x/ ^ dx j1 ^ : : : ^ dx jp pŠ D 1 pŠ @Wj1 ;:::;jp .x/ dx k ^ dx j1 ^ : : : ^ dx jp : @x k (1.62) The exterior derivative possesses the following wedge product rule: d p A.x/ ^ q B.x/ D d p A.x/ ^ q B.x/ C .1/p p A.x/ ^ d q B.x/ : (1.63) Example 1.2.19. Consider a differentiable 2-form F:: .x/ 2 F.x/ D 1 Fij .x/ dx i ^ dx j : 2 (1.64) The exterior derivative of 2 F.x/ is the 3-form 1 2 d Œ2 F.x/ D D @Fij .x/ dx k ^ dx i ^ dx j @x k @Fj k .x/ 1 @Fij .x/ @Fki .x/ dx k ^ dx i ^ dx j : C C 6 @x k @x i @x j (1.65) (Remark: The above example is relevant in electromagnetic field theory.) Now we shall state and prove a useful lemma of Poincaré. Lemma 1.2.20. Let p W.x/ be a (continuously) twice-differentiable p-form in D RN . Then ˚ d2 p W.x/ WD d d p W.x/ pC2 O.x/: (1.66) Proof. By (1.62), d2 p W.x/ D N X @Wj1 ;:::;jp .x/ dx l ^ dx k ^ dx j1 ^ : : : ^ dx jp @x l @x k 1j1 <<jp D N @Wj1 ;:::;jp .x/ @Wj1 ;:::;jp .x/ 1 X dx l ^ dx k ^ dx j1 ^ : : : ^ dx jp 2 1j <<j @x l @x k @x k @x l 1 pC2 O.x/ p : 1.2 Tensor Fields Over Differentiable Manifolds 33 The exterior derivative operator, acting on a p-form, is therefore a nilpotent operator . A differential p-form p W.x/ is called a closed form in case d p W.x/ pC1 O.x/. A p-form p A.x/ is called an exact form provided there exists a form p1 B.x/ such that p A.x/ D d p1 B.x/ . Poincare’s lemma shows that every exact form is closed. We naturally ask whether or not the converse statement is true. That is, are all closed forms exterior derivatives of lower rank forms? In the following theorem, we answer that question. Theorem 1.2.21. Let D be an open domain which is star-shaped with respect to an interior let p W.x/ be a differentiable p-form point x0 2 D . Moreover, satisfying d p W.x/ pC1 O.x/ in D . Then, there exists a continuously twicedifferentiable .p 1/-form p1 A.x/ in D such that p W.x/ Dd p1 A.x/ : (1.67) (For the proof, the reader is asked to consult Flander’s book [104].) Remark: The .p 1/th form p1 A.x/ in (1.67) is not unique. We can replace it by the .p 1/th form O p1 A.x/ D p1 A.x/ d p2 .x/ : (1.68) Here p2 .x/ is an arbitrary .p 2/th form of differentiability class C 3 . Example 1.2.22. Let us choose N D 4 and the electromagnetic field tensor F:: .x/ identified with the 2-form: 2 F.x/ D 1 Fij .x/dx i ^ dx j : 2 Four out of the eight Maxwell’s equations can be cast into tensor field equations: d Œ2 F.x/ D 0: : : .x/; @Fj k .x/ @Fij .x/ @Fki .x/ C C D 0: k i @x @x @x j (1.69) In a star-shaped domain D R4 (corresponding to space–time), the above Q equations imply, by (1.67), the existence of a one-form A.x/ such that 2 F.x/ h i Q D d A.x/ ; Fij .x/ D @Aj .x/ @Ai .x/ : @x i @x j (1.70) 34 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds Q The 1-form A.x/ is called the electromagnetic 4-potential. By (1.68), we can make the following transformation: OQ Q A.x/ D A.x/ d .x/; (1.71i) @ .x/ ; AOi .x/ D Ai .x/ @x i (1.71ii) such that the electromagnetic field tensor’s components remain unchanged. Equations (1.71i) and (1.71ii) represent what are known as gauge transformations of the 4-potential. Now we shall briefly discuss the integration of a p-form in (an open, connected) domain D of RN . Suppose that f is a Riemann (or Lebesgue) integrable function over D [ @D. Then, we define Z Z f .x/ dx 1 ^ : : : ^ dx N WD f .x 1 ; : : : ; x N / dx 1 ; : : : ; dx N : (1.72) D D The right-hand side of (1.72) indicates a standard multiple integral. For a general N -form N A.x/, we define Z N A.x/ WD D 1 NŠ Z Ai1 ;:::;iN .x/ dx i1 ; : : : ; dx iN D X D 1i1 <<iN Z Ai1 ;:::;iN .x/ dx i1 ; : : : ; dx iN : (1.73) D This allows us to state the generalized Stokes’ theorem: Theorem 1.2.23. Let DpC1 be an open, star-shaped .p C1/th dimensional domain N of R .p C 1 N / with a continuous, piecewise differentiable, orientable p-dimensional boundary @DpC1 . Then, for any continuously differentiable p-form p W.x/, Z Z d p W.x/ D (1.74) p W.x/: DpC1 @DpC1 (For the proof of this theorem, we refer to the book by Spivak [237].) Example 1.2.24. Let us choose N D 2 and p D 1. Moreover, we choose D2 R2 to be the rectangle .a; b/ .c; d /. The boundary @D2 of the rectangle is to be traversed counterclockwise in manner (to maintain the right orientation). For a Q continuously differentiable 1-form A.x/, (1.74) yields 1.2 Tensor Fields Over Differentiable Manifolds 35 h i Z Q d A.x/ D Z .a;b/.c;d / Z or, .a;b/.c;d / Q A.x/; @Œ.a;b/.c;d / @A2 .x/ @A1 .x/ dx 1 dx 2 @x 1 @x 2 Z D A1 .x/ dx 1 C A2 .x/ dx 2 : @Œ.a;b/.c;d / The above is just Stokes’ theorem in two-dimensional vector calculus. Definition (1.62) shows that the exterior derivative produces a .p C 1/th order antisymmetric tensor field out of a pth order antisymmetric tensor. There exists another derivative of tensor fields, generating higher order tensor fields. This is called the Lie derivative. E Consider a continuous vector field V.x/ in D RN and a system of ordinary differential equations: 0 E .t/ D V E ŒX .t/ ; X or, dX j .t/ DV j X 1 .t/; : : : ; X N .t/ I dt t 2 Œa; a R: (1.75) In case the Lipschitz condition is satisfied [38], the system of (1.75) admits a unique solution of the initial value problem X .0/ D x0 . The solution is called the integral curve of the system (1.75) passing through x0 . We now consider the family of integral curves passing through various initial points by putting x D .t; x0 /; (1.76i) x0 .0; x0 /: (1.76ii) Changing the notation in (1.76i) and (1.76ii), we write xO D .t; x/; (1.77i) x .0; x/: (1.77ii) The original differential equations yield @ .t; x/ E . .x; t// : DV @t (1.78) 36 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds E Fig. 1.9 A vector field U.x/ along an integral curve . ; x/ Now we introduce the related mapping: t 0 WD .t; / W x 7! x; O .0; / D Identity: (1.79) This mapping takes the point x in xO along an integral curve. Moreover, the mapping O along integral curves. t takes the neighborhood Nı .x/ into the neighborhood NıO .x/ Furthermore, the mapping t induces a derivative mapping 0t from the tangent space N N N x T .R / into TxO .R / T t .x/ .R /. (See (1.34).) E We define the Lie derivative of a vector field U.x/ by the following rule: h i 9 8 0 E x/ E = < .E t /1 U. h i O U.x/ E WD lim : (1.80) LVE U.x/ ; t !0 : t (See Fig. 1.9.) Example 1.2.25. Let us work out the Lie derivative of the coordinate basis field By Example 1.2.5 and (1.77i) and (1.78), we obtain h 0 i1 E t @ @xO i j D .t; x/ O @ : i @xO @x j Therefore, by (1.80), we get LVE @ @x i D lim 8 h i1 0 @ ˆ < E t @xO i t !0 :̂ D lim t t !0 t 1 @ @x i 9 > = > ; @ j .t; x/ O j ıi i @xO @ @x j @ @x i . 1.2 Tensor Fields Over Differentiable Manifolds D lim t 1 t !0 D @xO j t @xO i 37 O @ @ j .t; x/ i @.t/ @xO C O.t / 2 j ıi @ @x j @ j .t; x/ O @ ˇ @.t/ ˇt D0 @x j @ @xO i @V j .x/ @ O @ @V j Œ .t; x/ D : ˇ @xO i @x i @x j ˇt D0 @x j D Using the above example and the definition E LVE Œf .x/ WD V.x/ Œf ; (1.81) we can derive the vector field component n h ioi @U i .x/ j @V i .x/ j E LVE U.x/ D V .x/ U .x/: j @x @x j (1.82) We can generalize definition (1.80) for a general tensor field rs T.x/ by the following: LVE r s T.x/ ( WD lim r 0 1 s t t !0 r O s T.x/ rs T.x/ ) t : (1.83) (Here, we assumed (1.36).) We can work out the components of LVE rs T.x/ which are furnished by ˚ r i ;:::;i LVE s T.x/ j1 ;:::;jr D 1 @ T i1 ;:::;ir .x/ V k .x/ @x k j1 ;:::;js s r h X i ;:::;i T j11 ;:::;j˛1 s k i˛C1 ;:::;ir .x/ i @V i˛ .x/ ˛D1 C s h X r T ji11;:::;i ;:::;jˇ1 k jˇC1 ;:::;js .x/ ˇD1 @x k i @V k .x/ : @x jˇ (1.84) Example 1.2.26. Consider a .1 C 1/th order mixed tensor field T .x/. From (1.84), ˚ i LVE T .x/ j D " @T ji .x/ @x k # V k .x/ T jk .x/ @V i .x/ @V k .x/ C T ki .x/ : k @x @x j 38 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds The contraction of the above equation yields i ˚ @T ii .x/ k V .x/ D LVE T ii .x/ ; LVE T .x/ i D k @x ˚ ˚ C 11 LVE T .x/ D LVE C 11 T .x/ : (Note that the contraction operation commutes with the Lie derivative.) Exercises 1.2 r 1. Let T i1 ;:::;i j1 ;:::;js .x/ be the differentiable coordinate components of an .r C s/th r tensor field rs T.x/ in D RN . Prove that the partial derivatives @x@ k T i1 ;:::;i j1 ;:::;js .x/ do not transform as tensor components under a general twice-differentiable coordinate transformation. 2. Let Tj k .x/ be the components of a .0 C 2/th order tensor field in D RN . Show that the cofactors C j k .x/ of the entries Tj k .x/ in det Tj k .x/ transform as components of a relative, second-order contravariant tensor field of weight C2. 3. Consider the numerical identity tensor field in D RN defined by @ I .x/ WD ı ij i ˝ dx j : @x Prove that ˚1 Q w.x/; vE .x/ N wj .x/vj .x/ 1 C I .x/ ˝ I .x/ Q for every pair of fields w.x/ and vE .x/ in D RN . 4. Prove the following equations: h ;:::;h N D .N r/Š"j1 ;:::;jr hrC1 ;:::;hN . (i) "j1 ;:::;jr jrC1 ;:::;jN ı rC1jrC1 ;:::;j N (ii) det aij D "j1 ;:::;jN a1 j1 ; : : : ; aN jN . 5. Let n be a nonnegative integer such that 2n C 1 N . Show that every .2n C 1/form 2nC1 W.x/ satisfies 2nC1 W.x/ ^ 2nC1 W.x/ 4nC2 0.x/: 1.2 Tensor Fields Over Differentiable Manifolds 39 6. Consider a 1-form defined by Q W.x/ WD x2 x1 1 C dx dx 2 ; .x 1 /2 C .x 2 /2 .x 1 /2 C .x 2 /2 .x 1 ; x 2 / 2 R2 f.0; 0/g : Q (i) Prove that dW.x/ 0:: .x/ in R2 f.0; 0/g. (ii) Show the nonexistence of a differentiable function, f .x/, in R2 f.0; 0/g Q such that W.x/ D df .x/. Explain. N 7. Consider the differentiable symmetric tensor field S:: .x/ in D R with det Sij .x/ ¤ 0. (i) Prove that ˚ LVE ŒS:: .x/ ij D @ @V k .x/ @V k .x/ k S .x/ V .x/CS .x/ CS .x/ : ij kj i k @x k @x i @x j (ii) In case Sij .x/ D cij , a constant-valued tensor, prove that the partial differential equations ˚ LVE ŒS:: .x/ ij D 0 are solved by cj k V k .x/ D tj C wj k x k ; wkj wj k : Here, the tj ’s and wj k ’s represent N C N.N 1/=2 arbitrary constants of integration. (Remark: The right-hand side in the last equation constitutes a rigid motion.) E E 8. Let a Lie bracket for differentiable vector fields U.x/, V.x/ h (or commutator) i E E E V.x/ E E U.x/. E be defined by U.x/; V.x/ WD U.x/ V.x/ Prove that for twicedifferentiable functions f .x/ and h.x/, E E E E U.x/ Œf U.x/; V.x/ Œf . (i) V.x/; E E E (ii) LVE U.x/ D V.x/; U.x/ . E E E E E E (iii) U.x/; ŒV.x/; W.x/ C V.x/; ŒW.x/; U.x/ E E E E C W.x/; ŒU.x/; V.x/ 0.x/. ˚ ˚ E E E E E E (iv) f V.x/; hW.x/ D f .x/V.x/Œh W.x/ h.x/W.x/Œf V.x/ E E f .x/h.x/ V.x/; W.x/ . k k (v) Eei ; Eej eQ DW ij .x/ kj i .x/. .c/ .c/ (vi) Ee.a/ ; Ee.b/ eQ .c/ DW .a/.b/ .x/ .b/.a/ .x/. 40 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds Answers and Hints to Selected Exercises 4. (ii) "j1 ;:::;jN a1 j1 ; : : : ; aN jN D X Œsgn. / a1 .1/ a2 .2/ ; : : : ; aN .N / D det aij : 2SN 5. Use (1.47v). 7. (ii) The partial differential equations reduce to @ @ ckj V k .x/ C j ci k V k .x/ D wij C wj i 0: i @x @x 8. (i) h i E E E E U.x/ D U i .x/ @i ; V.x/ D V j .x/ @j ; V.x/; U.x/ Œf D 0 C V j .@j U i / @i f U i .@i V j / @j f : (ii) Using (1.84), h i E D V j @j U i U j @j V i @i LVE U E U.x/ E E V.x/ E DV.x/ U.x/ h i E E D V.x/; U.x/ : 1.3 Riemannian and Pseudo-Riemannian Manifolds In the preceding section, for the real tangent vector space Tx .RN /, no other additional structure was assumed. Now we shall impose an interesting structure, namely, the inner-product (or dot product) to Tx .RN /. This is accomplished by assuming the existence of a second-order tensor field g:: .x/ in D RN . The corresponding axioms are as follows: E E E E I1 g:: .x/.A.x/; B.x// 2 R for all A.x/; B.x/ 2 Tx .RN /: (1.85i) E E E E I2 g:: .x/.B.x/; A.x// g:: .x/.A.x/; B.x// E E for all A.x/; B.x/ 2 Tx .RN /: (1.85ii) 1.3 Riemannian and Pseudo-Riemannian Manifolds 41 E E E I3 g:: .x/. .x/A.x/ C .x/B.x/; C.x// E E E E D .x/g:: .x/.A.x/; C.x// C .x/g:: .x/.B.x/; C.x//: (1.85iii) E E E E E I4 g:: .x/.A.x/; V.x// 0 for all V.x/ 2 Tx .RN / iff A.x/ D 0.x/: (1.85iv) Axioms I1, I2, and I3 imply that g:: .x/ is a symmetric second-order tensor field. Axiom I4 is the condition of nondegeneracy. The tensor g:: .x/ is known as the metric tensor. (See [56, 195].) E The separation of a vector field V.x/ is given by rˇ ˇ ˇ ˇ E E E V.x// .V.x// WD C ˇg:: .x/.V.x/; ˇ: (1.86) It satisfies the rules E .V.x// 0; E E . .x/V.x// D j .x/j .V.x//: (1.87) E A unit vector field U.x/ satisfies E .U.x// 1: (1.88) E E Two orthogonal vector fields, A.x/ and B.x/, satisfy E E g:: .x/.A.x/; B.x// 0: (1.89) An orthonormal basis set consists4 of vectors Ee.a/ .x/ and is denoted by ˚ ˚ N Ee.1/ .x/; : : : ; Ee.N / .x/ DW Ee.a/ .x/ 1 . These vectors must satisfy 1 0 g:: .x/.Ee.a/ .x/; Ee.b/ .x// DW d.a/.b/ WD diag @ 1; 1 ; 1; : : : ; 1A ; „ƒ‚… „ ƒ‚ … p n p C n D N; ˇ ˇ ˇd.a/.b/ˇ D ı.a/.b/ ; sgn .g:: .x// WD p n 0: 4 Some authors call it a pseudoorthonormal basis set. (1.90) 42 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds The integer p n of the metric tensor is known as the signature of the metric. In the conventions of this book, an N -dimensional manifold endowed with metric whose signature is N 2 (p D N 1; n D 1) is said to possess Lorentz signature.5 We use lowercase Latin letters from the beginning of the alphabet, and in parentheses, to denote the indices of a tensor relative to an orthonormal frame ..a/; .b/; .c/; .d /; .e/; .f /; etc./. We use lowercase Latin letters from the middle of the alphabet (i; j; k; l; m; n, etc.) to denote the indices of a tensor relative to a coordinate basis set. In cases where the metric is positive-definite (n D 0), axiom I4 is replaced by the stronger axiom: I4C E E g:: .x/.V.x/; V.x// 0I E E E E g:: .x/.V.x/; V.x// 0 iff V.x/ D 0.x/: (1.91) For such a case, the norm or length associated with a vector field is furnished by: q E E E V.x//: (1.92) k V.x/ kWD C g:: .x/.V.x/; The norm satisfies the rules: E k V.x/ k 0; E E k .x/V.x/ k D j .x/j k V.x/ k; E E E E k A.x/ C B.x/ k k A.x/ k C k B.x/ k: (1.93) Comparing (1.87) and (1.93), we conclude that separation and norm (or length) are not equivalent. In the case of a positive-definite metric, the angle field between two non-zero E can be defined by E vector fields, U.x/ and V.x/, h cosŒ.x/ WD E E g:: .U.x/; V.x// i E E k U.x/ k k V.x/ k : (1.94) By the Cauchy–Schwarz inequality, we must have 1 cosŒ.x/ 1: 5 (1.95) Some relativity texts use a metric which is the negative of the one used here, so that a Lorentz signature metric has a signature of 2 N . Caution must be applied when comparing the equations in this text with those in texts utilizing the opposite sign convention. 1.3 Riemannian and Pseudo-Riemannian Manifolds 43 E E However, we can prove that for the separation .U.x// > 0 and .V.x// > 0, the pseudoangle is unbounded, that is, h i E E g:: .U.x/; V.x// 1< < 1: (1.96) E E .U.x// .V.x// Comparing (1.95) and (1.96), we conclude that for a non-positive-definite metric, the usual angle between two vectors is not defined! ˚ N Relative to a coordinate basis set @x@ i 1 , the metric tensor components are gij .x/ D g:: .x/ @ @ ; i @x @x j gj i .x/: (1.97) The nondegeneracy axiom (1.85iv) implies that g D g.x/ WD detŒgij .x/ ¤ 0; jgj D jg.x/j > 0: (1.98) The inverse matrix of gij .x/ yields the contravariant second-order tensor components ij 1 g .x/ WD gij .x/ ; g ij .x/ g j i .x/; @ @ ˝ j: (1.99) @x i @x The above tensor is called the conjugate metric tensor or contravariant metric tensor (sometimes called the inverse metric tensor). g:: .x/ D g ij .x/ Example 1.3.1. Let EN be the N -dimensional Euclidean manifold. Let .; EN / be ˚ N one of the global Cartesian charts. Relative to the corresponding basis @x@ i 1 , the corresponding components of the metric tensor are: gij .x/ ıij ; g ij .x/ ı ij ; E k V.x/ k2 D ıij V i .x/V j .x/ D N P i D1 V i .x/ 2 0: Example 1.3.2. Let M be an N -dimensional (flat) manifold with the Lorentz metric g:: .x/. (We choose N 2.) In a global pseudo-Cartesian chart .; M /, this metric field is furnished by g:: .x/ D dij dx i ˝ dx j WD dx 1 ˝ dx 1 C C dx N 1 ˝ dx N 1 dx N ˝ dx N: d ij D dij ; detŒdij D 1: sgn.g:: .x// D N 2: 44 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds In the sequel, we shall deal primarily with two types of basis sets. These are ˚ N ˚ N the coordinate basis set @x@ i 1 and the orthonormal basis set Ee.a/ .x/ 1 . By (1.30), (1.92), and (1.99), we can express g:: .x/ D gij .x/ dx i ˝ dx j D d.a/.b/eQ .a/ .x/ ˝ eQ .b/ .x/: (1.100) The components of the conjugate (contravariant) metric tensor field g:: .x/ are given by g:: .x/ D gij .x/ @ @ ˝ j D d .a/.b/ Ee.a/ .x/ ˝ Ee.b/ .x/; @x i @x g i k .x/gkj .x/ ı ij ; d .a/.c/ d.c/.b/ ı .a/ .b/ : (1.101) Now we will consider the transformation from one basis set to another. For two coordinate basis sets, transformations have been furnished in (1.34) and (1.35) which we repeat succinctly as EO 0 X @ @x i D @XO k .x/ @ OQ 0 i @X i .x/ O ; X dx D dxO k : i k @x @xO @xO k (1.102) The transformation from one orthonormal basis set to another can be summarized as: .b/ eEO .a/ .x/ D L .a/ .x/Ee.b/ .x/; .a/ eOQ .a/ .x/ D A .b/ .x/Qe.b/ .x/; h i h i1 .b/ .a/ A .a/ .x/ WD L .b/ .x/ ; .a/ .c/ L .b/ .x/d.a/.c/ L .e/ .x/ D d.b/.e/ : (1.103) This last equation defines a generalized Lorentz transformation (at x 2 RN ). The set of all generalized Lorentz transformations, at a particular point x 2 RN , constitutes a Lie group denoted by O.p; nI R/, (p C n D N ). (See [114, 123].) The (nonsingular) transformation from one coordinate basis to an orthonormal basis is furnished by Ee.a/ .x/ D @ D @x i eQ .a/ .x/ D i .a/ .x/ @ ; @x i .a/ e.a/ .x/; i .x/E .a/ i i .x/ dx ; 1.3 Riemannian and Pseudo-Riemannian Manifolds 45 dx i D i.a/ .x/Qe.a/ .x/; h i h i1 .a/ i : .a/ .x/ i .x/ W D (1.104) It follows from (1.25i), (1.25ii), (1.100), and (1.104) that d.a/.b/ D g:: .x/.Ee.a/ .x/; Ee.b/ .x// D gij .x/ gij .x/ D g:: .x/ @ @ ; i @x @x j D d.a/.b/ .a/ .b/ i .x/ j .x/; d .a/.b/ D g:: .x/.Qe.a/ .x/; eQ .b/ .x// D g ij .x/ g ij .x/ D g:: .x/.dx i ; dx j / D d .a/.b/ @ ı ij D g:. .x/ dx i ; @x j j i .a/ .x/ .b/ .x/; .a/ .b/ i .x/ j .x/; j i .a/ .x/ .b/ .x/; @ WD I .x/ dx i ; @x j D .a/ i .a/ .x/ j .x/; .a/ ı .b/ D g:. .x/.Qe.a/ .x/; Ee.b/ .x// D I .x/.Qe.a/ .x/; Ee.b/ .x// D .a/ i i .x/ .b/ .x/: (1.105) Here, I .x/ is the identity tensor. Example 1.3.3. Consider the two-dimensional spherical surface S 2 of unit radius and the usual spherical polar coordinate chart. (See Example 1.1.2.) The metric tensor field is characterized by g:: .x/ D dx 1 ˝ dx 1 C sin2 .x 1 / dx 2 ˝ dx 2 D eQ .1/ .x/ ˝ eQ .1/ .x/ C eQ .2/ .x/ ˝ eQ .2/ .x/ D ı.a/.b/eQ .a/ .x/ ˝ eQ .b/ .x/; sgnŒg:: .x/ D 2; g D detŒgij .x/ D sin2 .x 1 / > 0; g:: .x/ D 2 @ @ @ @ ˝ 1 C sin.x 1 / ˝ 2 1 2 @x @x @x @x D Ee.1/ .x/ ˝ Ee.1/ .x/ C Ee.2/ .x/ ˝ Ee.2/ .x/; ˚ D WD x 2 R2 W 0 < x 1 < ; < x 2 < : ˚ Here, the coordinate basis set is @x@ 1 ; @x@ 2 , whereas the natural orthonormal ˚ basis set is Ee.1/ .x/; Ee.2/ .x/ . The transformation between the two basis sets is governed by 46 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds 1 @ @ ; Ee.2/ .x/ D sin.x 1 / ; @x 1 @x 2 eQ .1/ .x/ D dx 1 ; eQ .2/ .x/ D sin.x 1 / dx 2 ; i i i 1 1 i ı .2/ ; .1/ .x/ D ı .1/ ; .2/ .x/ D sin.x / Ee.1/ .x/ D .1/ i .x/ .1/ .2/ i .x/ D ıi ; .2/ D sin.x 1 / ı i : A tensor field rs T.x/ can, by (1.30) and (1.36), be expressed in terms of various basis sets as: r s T.x/ r D T i1 ;:::;i j1 ;:::;js .x/ DT @ @ ˝ ˝ i ˝ dx j1 ˝ ˝ dx js @x i1 @x r .a1 /;:::;.ar / e.a1 / .x/ .b1 /;:::;.bs / .x/ E ˝ ˝ Ee.ar / .x/ ˝ eQ .b1 / .x/ ˝ ˝ eQ .bs / .x/: (1.106) By (1.37), (1.103), (1.104), and (1.106), we have the transformation rules for the tensor field components: O O @XO k1 .x/ @XO kr .x/ @X j1 .x/ @X js .x/ r TO k1l;:::;k . x/ O D ; : : : ; ; : : : ; ˇ i i l l 1 ;:::;ls 1 r 1 s @x @x @xO @xO ˇxD O O X.x/ r T i1 ;:::;i j1 ;:::;js .x/; (1.107i) .a1 /;:::;.ar / .a / .a / .d / .d / TO .b1 /;:::;.bs / .x/ D A .c1 1 / .x/; : : : ; A .cr r / .x/L .b1 1 / .x/; : : : ; L .bs s / .x/ T T .a1 /;:::;.ar / .b1 /;:::;.bs / .x/ D .c1 /;:::;.cr / .d1 /;:::;.ds / .x/; .a1 / i1 .x/; : : : ; (1.107ii) .ar / j1 ir .x/ .b1 / .x/; : : : ; js i1 ;:::;ir .bs / .x/T j1 ;:::;js .x/: (1.107iii) r T i1 ;:::;i j1 ;:::;js .x/D i1 .a1 /.x/; : : : ; ir .ar / .x/ .b1 / j1 .x/; : : : ; .a1 /;:::;.ar / .bs / .b1 /;:::;.bs / .x/: js .x/ T (1.107iv) The components T tensor rs T.x/. .a1 /;:::;.ar / .b1 /;:::;.bs / .x/ are called the orthonormal components of the Example 1.3.4. Let us consider the spherical surface S 2 of unit radius and the spherical coordinate chart of the preceding example. Let a second-order symmetric tensor field defined by 1.3 Riemannian and Pseudo-Riemannian Manifolds T ij .x/ 47 @ @ @ @ ˝ j WD .x i x j / i ˝ j : @x i @x @x @x The corresponding orthonormal components, from (1.107iii) are furnished by T .a/.b/ .x/ D .a/ i .x/ D .x i x j / .b/ ij j .x/T .x/; .a/ .b/ i .x/ j .x/: From the preceding example, .1/ i .x/ .1/ D ıi ; .2/ i .x/ .2/ D sin.x 1 / ı i ; we obtain T T .1/.1/ .2/.2/ .x/ D .x 1 /2 ; T .1/.2/ .x/ T .2/.1/ .x/ D sin.x 1 /.x 1 x 2 /; 2 .x/ D sin.x 1 / .x 2 /2 : Evaluated at the “equator” (except one point), the above yields: T T .1/.1/ .1/.2/ =2; x 2 .=2/2 ; T =2; x 2 D .=2/ x 2 ; .2/.2/ =2; x 2 D .x 2 /2 for all x 2 2 .; /: Thus, for a sphere of unit radius, the coordinate and corresponding orthonormal components of T .x/ coincide on the equator. For the interested reader, tensor bundles rs T .Tx .RN // are discussed in [38, 56, 267]. The metric tensor g:: .x/ and the conjugate metric tensor g::.x/ induce a tensor space isomorphism Ig .x/ from the tangent tensor bundle rs T Tx .RN / into r0 N 0 0 s 0 T Tx .R / for r C s D r C s . This isomorphism is brought about by the raising and lowering of indices of tensor components. The rules are elaborated for two different tensors in the following: h i @ Ig T ij1 ;:::;js .x/ i ˝ dx j1 ˝ ˝ dx js D Tkj1 ;:::;js .x/ dx k ˝ dx j1 ˝ ˝ dx js @x DW gki .x/T ij1 ;:::;js .x/ dx k ˝ dx j1 ˝ ˝ dx js ; (1.108i) @ Ig Tj1 ;:::;js .x/ dx j1 ˝ ˝ dx js D T kj2 ;:::;js .x/ k ˝ dx j2 ˝ ˝ dx js @x @ DW g kj1 .x/Tj1 ;j2 ;:::;js .x/ k ˝ dx j2 ˝ ˝ dx js ; (1.108ii) @x 48 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds h .a/ i Ig T .b1 /;:::;.bs / .x/ Ee.a/ .x/ ˝ eQ .b1 / .x/ ˝ ˝ eQ .bs / .x/ D T .c/.b1 /;:::;.bs / .x/ eQ .c/ .x/ ˝ eQ .b1 / .x/ ˝ ˝ eQ .bs / .x/ DW d.c/.a/ T .a/ Q .c/ .x/ .b1 /;:::;.bs / .x/ e ˝ eQ .b1 / .x/ ˝ ˝ eQ .bs / .x/; (1.108iii) Ig T .b1 /;:::;.bs / .x/ eQ .b1 / .x/ ˝ ˝ eQ .bs / .x/ DT .a/ e.a/ .x/ .b2 /;:::;.bs / .x/ E ˝ eQ .b2 / .x/ ˝ eQ .bs / .x/ DW d .a/.b1 / T .b1 /.b2 /;:::;.bs / .x/ Ee.a/ .x/Qe.b2 / .x/ ˝ ˝ eQ .bs / .x/: (1.108iv) Example 1.3.5. Let us work out the raising and lowering of a second-order tensor field from (1.108i)–(1.108iv): j T ij .x/ D g j k .x/T ik .x/ D g i k .x/g i l .x/Tkl .x/ D g i k .x/Tk .x/; Tij .x/ D gi k .x/T kj .x/ D gi k .x/gj l .x/T kl .x/ D gj k .x/Ti k .x/; .x/ D d .b/.c/T .a/ .c/ .x/ D d .a/.c/ d .b/.f / T .c/.f / .x/ D d .a/.c/ T .c/ .x/; T .a/.b/ .x/ D d.a/.c/ T .c/ .b/ .x/ D d.a/.e/ d.b/.f / T T .a/.b/ .b/ .e/.f / .f / .x/ D d.b/.f / T .a/ .x/: (1.109) In the sequel, we shall drop the bar from the orthonormal components. For the metric tensor components, we obtain from (1.101), g ij .x/ D g i k .x/gkj .x/ ı ij ; d .a/ .b/ D d .a/.c/ d.c/.b/ ı .a/ .b/ : Now we will generalize the totally antisymmetric permutation symbols of (1.51) and (1.52). We define the totally antisymmetric (oriented) tensor components of Levi-Civita by: p (1.110i) i1 ;:::;iN .x/ WD jg.x/j "i1 ;:::;iN ; sgn Œg.x/ i1 ;:::;iN i1 ;:::;iN .x/ WD p ; " jg.x/j (1.110ii) .a1 /;:::;.aN / .x/ WD ".a1 /;:::;.aN / ; (1.110iii) ˚ .a1 /;:::;.aN / .x/ WD sgn det d.a/.b/ ".a1 /;:::;.aN / : (1.110iv) Note that .a1 /;:::;.aN / .x/ and .a1 /;:::;.aN / .x/ are constant-valued, whereas i1 ;:::;iN .x/ and i1 ;:::;iN .x/ are not necessarily constant-valued. 1.3 Riemannian and Pseudo-Riemannian Manifolds 49 The choice in (1.110ii) is reasonable since it can be proved that i1 ;:::;iN .x/ D g i1 j1 .x/; : : : ; g iN jN .x/ j1 ;:::;jN .x/: (1.111) The transformation properties of the components i1 ;:::;iN .x/ and i1 ;:::;iN .x/ under coordinate transformations (1.2) are furnished by O i1 ;:::;iN .x/ O D sgn det O @X k .x/ @xO l O i1 ;:::;iN .x/ O D sgn det O @X k .x/ l @xO @X j1 .x/ O O @X jN .x/ ;:::; j1 ;:::;jN .x/; (1.112i) i @xO 1 @xO iN @XO i1 .x/ @XO iN .x/ j1 ;:::;jN ; : : : ; .x/: (1.112ii) @x j1 @x jN These are components of oriented tensor fields. We shall define now the Hodge star-operation (or Hodge- operation). The Hodge- function maps an antisymmetric tensor field p W.x/ into an antisymmetric oriented tensor field N p W.x/ by the following rules: Wi1 ;:::;iN p .x/ WD j1 ;:::;jp i1 ;:::;iN p .x/ 1 j1 ;:::;jp i1 ;:::;iN p .x/Wj1 ;:::;jp .x/; pŠ WD g j1 k1 .x/; : : : ; g jp kp .x/k1 ;:::;kp i1 ;:::;iN p .x/: (1.113) (See [38, 56, 104].) Example 1.3.6. Consider a four-dimensional manifold of Lorentz signature C2. Let an antisymmetric tensor field be given by F:: .x/ D 1 Fij .x/ dx i ^ dx j : 2 The Hodge star mapping will generate the antisymmetric components F kl .x/ D 1 ij kl .x/Fij .x/: 2 Thus, for the Lorentz metric, we have 1 F 12 .x/ D p F34 .x/; jgj 1 F 23 .x/ D p F14 .x/; jgj 1 F 31 .x/ D p F24 .x/; jgj 1 F 14 .x/ D p F23 .x/; jgj 1 F 24 .x/ D p F31 .x/; jgj 1 F 34 .x/ D p F12 .x/: jgj 50 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds This example is relevant in electromagnetic field theory, where Fij .x/ represents the components of what is known as the electromagnetic field strength tensor. We have noticed in Problem # 1 of Exercises 1.2 that partial derivatives of a differentiable tensor field do not transform in general as tensor fields. We can remedy that situation in a well-known manner. First we will need to introduce some new notations and definitions. Partial derivatives of a differentiable function will often be denoted in the sequel by @j f WD @.a/ f WD @ f .x/ D Eej .x/Œf ; @x j j .a/ .x/ @ f .x/ D @x j j .a/ .x/@j f (1.114i) Ee.a/ .x/ Œf : (1.114ii) Now we shall introduce a new concept of differentiations of tensor fields. It is called connection (sometimes written as connexion) or covariant6 derivative and E will be denoted by r. The operator r assigns to each V.x/ 2 Tx .RN / of class r E of class C r1 . The covariant C .r 1/ an .1 C 1/th order tensor field r V.x/ derivative satisfies the following two rules: I: II: h i h i h i E E E E r V.x/ C W.x/ D r V.x/ C r W.x/ ; (1.115i) h i h i E E E r f .x/V.x/ D V.x/ ˝ df .x/ C f .x/ r V.x/ : (1.115ii) ˚ N ˚ N ˚ N Eei .x/ 1 and @.a/ 1 Ee.a/ .x/ 1 . ˚ N ˚ N Moreover, the corresponding covariant basis fields are dx i 1 and eQ .a/ .x/ 1 ˚ .a/ i N i .x/dx 1 in (1.104). The corresponding basis fields for .1 C 1/-order tensors N N ˚ ˚ are @i ˝ dx j 1 and @.a/ ˝ eQ .b/ 1 . Therefore, we can express the mixed tensors rEei and rEe.a/ by the linear combinations j .x/ @j ˝ dx k ; (1.116i) r .@i / D ki Let us consider basis fields f@i gN 1 .b/ r @.a/ D .c/.a/ .x/ @.b/ ˝ eQ .c/ .x/: (1.116ii) 6 The term covariant has several meanings in tensor analysis. One meaning relates to the transformation properties of a tensor and, in terms of component indices, refers to an index written as a subscript (vs. superscript, which is contravariant). Another meaning refers to independence from any coordinate system. In the latter sense, all tensor equations are covariant. Up until this point in the book, we have only used the former meaning (index-down). Here, we refer to the latter meaning (coordinate independence). 1.3 Riemannian and Pseudo-Riemannian Manifolds n o Here, j ki .x/ and 51 .b/ .c/.a/ .x/ are some suitable coefficient functions. The following n o .b/ should be noted: (1) The components kj i .x/ and .c/.a/ .x/ are not tensor field components in general. (2) The negative sign in (1.116ii) is a historical convention. (3) In the we shall often omit (x) from these symbols. (4) At this stage, the o n sequel, j symbols k i are more general than the Christoffel symbols of (1.134). By rules (1.115i), (1.115ii), (1.116i), and (1.116ii), we obtain E r V.x/ D r V i .x/ Eei .x/ D Eei .x/ ˝ dV i .x/ C V i .x/ rEei .x/ i i D @i ˝ dV .x/ C V k .x/dx j jk i D @j V i C V k .x/ @i ˝ dx j DW rj V i @i ˝ dx j : jk E r V.x/ D r.b/ V .a/ @.a/ ˝ eQ .b/ .x/ h i .a/ WD @.b/ V .a/ .c/.b/ V .c/ .x/ @.a/ ˝ eQ .b/ .x/ : (1.117i) (1.117ii) E of order Note that rj V i and r.b/ V .a/ are components of the tensor field r V.x/ .1 C 1/. E The directional covariant derivative of a vector field V.x/ in the direction of the E vector field U.x/ is defined by projecting the covariant derivative in the direction of E E U.x/. The directional derivative is denoted by rUE V.x/ . The operator rUE maps a E vector field V.x/ of class C r into another vector field of class C r1 . The definition is furnished by: h i h i E Q E Q E rUE V.x/ W.x/ WD r V.x/ W.x/; U.x/ (1.118) Q for all W.x/ 2 TQx .RN /. (See [38, 56, 267].) The main properties of the operator rUE are summarized in the following theorem. Theorem 1.3.7. The covariant derivatives along directions of vector fields under suitable differentiability conditions must satisfy: h i h i h i E E E E .i / rVE Y.x/ C Z.x/ D rVE Y.x/ C rVE Z.x/ I (1.119i) h i h i h i E E E V.x/ D r V.x/ C r V.x/ I rYC E Z E E E Y Z (1.119ii) .ii/ 52 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds .iii/ h i h i E E D f .x/rVE Y.x/ I rf VE Y.x/ (1.119iii) .iv/ h i n o n h io E E E E rVE h.x/Y.x/ D V.x/Œh Y.x/ C h.x/ rVE Y.x/ : (1.119iv) Proof is left to the reader. Example 1.3.8. From (1.117i), (1.117ii), and (1.118), we derive that n h io E r@i V.x/ .dx i / D ri V j ; h io n E eQ .b/ .x/ D r.a/ V .b/ : [email protected]/ V.x/ The definition of the covariant derivative along a vector field in (1.119i) can be extended to the covariant derivative of a tensor field rs T.x/. The corresponding properties are the following: I: In case rs T.x/ is of class C r ; the tensor rVE r s T.x/ is of the same order and of class C r1 .r 1/: (1.120i) E II: rVE Œf .x/ WD V.x/Œf ; (1.120ii) III: rVE rs T.x/ Crs B.x/ D rVE rs T.x/ C rVE rs B.x/ ; (1.120iii) r r m r m IV: rVE s T.x/ ˝ m E s T.x/ ˝ n G.x/ C s T.x/ ˝ rV E n G.x/ ; n G.x/ D rV (1.120iv) V: rVE n p r q C s T.x/ o ˚ D pq C rVE rs T.x/ : (1.120v) Example 1.3.9. Now we shall work out the covariant derivative of a dual vector field: k Q @j D @i Wj Wk .x/; (1.121) r@i W.x/ ij .c/ Q eQ .b/ .x/ D @.a/ W.b/ C .b/.a/ W.c/ .x/: [email protected]/ W.x/ (1.122) We can generalize the definition of the covariant derivative in (1.117i) and (1.117ii) for a general tensor field rs T.x/. It is furnished by 1 ˚ r Q .x/; : : : ; W Q r .x/; U E 1 .x/; : : : ; U E s .x/I V.x/ E W r s T.x/ 1.3 Riemannian and Pseudo-Riemannian Manifolds 53 ˚ 1 Q .x/; : : : ; W Q r .x/; U E 1 .x/; : : : ; U E s .x/ WD rVE rs T.x/ W (1.123) Q 1 .x/; : : : ; W Q r .x/; U E 1 .x/; : : : ; U E s .x/ fields. for all W In terms of the explicit components of rs T.x/, the covariant derivative is expressed below. Theorem 1.3.10. Let rs T.x/ be a differentiable tensor field of class C r .r 1/ in D 2 RN . The covariant derivative is furnished by ˚ r r@k rs T.x/ dx i1 ; : : : ; dx ir ; @j1 ; : : : ; @js D rk T i1 ;:::;i j1 ;:::;js r X i˛ i ;:::;i li ;:::;ir r WD @k T i1 ;:::;i C T 1 ˛1 ˛C1j1 ;:::;j j1 ;:::;js s kl ˛D1 s X l r T i1 ;:::;i j1 ;:::;jˇ1 ljˇC1 ;:::;js ; k jˇ ˇD1 (1.124i) ˚ .a /;:::;.ar / [email protected]/ rs T.x/ eQ .a1 / ; : : : ; eQ .ar / ; @.b1 / ; : : : ; @.bs / D r.c/ T 1.b1 /;:::;.b s/ WD @.c/ T .a1 /;:::;.ar / .b1 /;:::;.bs / r X .a1 /;:::;.a˛1 /.d /.a˛C1 /;:::;.ar / .a˛ / .b1 /;:::;.bs / .d /.c/ T ˛D1 C s X .d / .a1 /;:::;.ar / .bˇ /.c/ T .b1 /;:::;.bˇ1 /.d /.bˇC1 /;:::;.bs / : (1.124ii) ˇD1 The proof follows from (1.117i), (1.117ii), (1.120ii), (1.120iii), (1.120iv), (1.121)– (1.123). (See [56, 90, 266].) Example 1.3.11. Let the coordinate components of a constant-valued tangent vector E field V.x/ be given by V 1 .x/ 1; V 2 .x/ D D V N .x/ 0 in a nonCartesian basis: k k ri V D 6 0: i1 Example 1.3.12. Consider the identity tensor .a/ I .x/ D ı ij @i ˝ dx j D ı .b/ @.a/ ˝ eQ .b/ : i l i i l ıj rk ı j D @k ı j C ı il 0; kl kj 54 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds r.c/ ı .a/ .b/ .a/ .a/ .d / .d / .a/ D @.c/ ı .b/ .d /.c/ ı .b/ C .b/.c/ı .d / 0; rVE I .x/ 0 .x/: E V E and its properties in Problem # 8 of We have defined the Lie bracket U; Exercise 1.2. With the help of the Lie bracket, we can define the torsion tensor field in the following: Q E E T:: .x/ W.x/; U.x/; V.x/ n h i h i h io Q E E E E WD W.x/ rUE V.x/ rVE U.x/ U.x/; V.x/ Q E E T :: .x/ W.x/; V.x/; U.x/ : (1.125) .a/ Example 1.3.13. Now, T :: .x/ D T .b/.c/ .x/ @.a/ ˝ eQ .b/ .x/ ˝ eQ .c/ .x/ D T ij k .x/ @i ˝ dx j ˝ dx k . Using (1.124i), (1.124ii), and (1.125), we also deduce that T .a/ .b/.c/ .x/ D T :: .x/ eQ .a/ .x/; @.b/ ; @.c/ ˚ ˚ D eQ .a/ .x/ [email protected]/ @.c/ eQ .a/ .x/ [email protected]/ @.b/ .a/ .a/ .a/ eQ .a/ .x/ @.b/ ; @.c/ D .b/.c/ .x/ .c/.b/.x/ .b/.c/ .x/: (1.126) E Using Œ@i ; @j 0.x/, we derive that i i T ikj .x/: T ij k .x/ D jk kj (1.127) The above equations reveal the antisymmetry properties of the torsion tensor. Next we shall introduce an important tensor field. Namely, the (1 C 3)th order curvature tensor R: : : .x/ which is defined by i n h E Q E E E Q Y.x/; U.x/; V.x/ WD W.x/ rUE rVE Y.x/ R : : : .x/ W.x/; h h io i E E : rŒU; rVE rUE Y.x/ E V E Y.x/ (1.128) (See [38, 56, 90, 130, 171, 244, 266].) 1.3 Riemannian and Pseudo-Riemannian Manifolds 55 Example 1.3.14. The components of R: : : .x/ will be computed relative to the basis ˚ N 4 sets @i ˝ dx j ˝ dx k ˝ dx l 1 : Rij mn .x/ D R: : : .x/ dx i ˝ @j ˝ @m ˝ @n ˚ D dx i r@m rn @j @n r@m @j rŒ@m ; @n @j : Using (1.123), (1.124i) and the fact Œ@m ; @n Œf 0 (for any C 2 -function f ), we obtain that i i i h i h Rij mn.x/ D @m @n C nj mj mh nj nh mj Rij nm .x/: (1.129) (If the connection is known, the above formula is the most straightforward method to calculate the curvature tensor.) .a/ Example 1.3.15. Let us compute the orthonormal components R .b/.c/.d /.x/ of ˚ the tensor R: : : .x/ relative to the orthonormal basis set Ee.a/ .x/ ˝ eQ .b/ .x/ ˝ eQ .c/ .x/ ˝ eQ .d / .x/ : R .a/ .b/.c/.d / .x/ D R: : : .x/ eQ .a/ .x/; Ee.b/ .x/; Ee.c/ .x/; Ee.d / .x/ ˚ D eQ .a/ .x/ [email protected]/ r@d Ee.b/ .x/ @@.d / [email protected]/ Ee.b/ .x/ rŒ@.d / ; @.c/ Ee.b/ .x/ : .f / .c/.d / .x/ @.f / , Using (1.123), (1.124ii), and Œ@.c/ ; @.d / D R .a/ .b/.c/.d / .x/ we derive that h i n .f / .f / D eQ .a/ .x/ Ee.c/ .b/.d / eE.f / C .b/.c/ [email protected]/ Ee.f / h i o .f / .f / .f / Ee.d / .b/.c/ Ee.f / .b/.c/[email protected] / Ee.f / .c/.d /[email protected] / Ee.b/ .a/ R .b/.d /.c/.x/: (Note the antisymmetry with respect to the last two indices.) (1.130) 56 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds We shall n odiscuss the geometrical significance of the curvature tensor later. If j i k 0 for x 2 D RN, then Rij mn .x/ 0. However, Rij mn .x/ 0 does n o not imply j i k 0 as will be shown in a later example. Note that (1.85i)–(1.113) deal with the metric and orthonormality. However, (1.115i)–(1.130) investigate various properties of connections or covariant derivatives. A closer inspection of (1.115i)–(1.130) will reveal that nowhere are the metric tensor or orthonormality explicitly used. (In fact, there exist differential manifolds with connections devoid of a metric tensor employing similar equations!) However, the definition of a Riemannian or pseudo-Riemannian manifold demands some relationships between the metric and the connection. In the following, we discuss such properties. Theorem 1.3.16. In the domain D RN corresponding to a domain of a manifold endowed with a differentiable metric, there exists a unique connection such that: .i/ The torsion tensor T :: .x/ 0 :: .x/: .ii/ The covariant derivative of the metric identically vanishes: rg:: .x/ 0: : : .x/: (1.131i) (1.131ii) Proof. Let the coordinate basis f@i gN 1 be used to investigate (1.131i) and (1.131ii). By (1.131i) and (1.128), we deduce i i i T j k .x/ D 0; (1.132) jk kj and that i i : jk kj Using (1.131ii) and (1.124i), we derive ri gj k .x/ D @i gj k l l glk gj l 0: ij ik With cyclic permutations of the indices i , j , and k in (1.133), we obtain @j gki C @k gij @i gj k D gi l D 2gi l l l C C0C0 jk kj l : jk (1.133) 1.3 Riemannian and Pseudo-Riemannian Manifolds Therefore, 57 1 l D g li @j gki C @k gij @i gj k : jk 2 By this unique expression for l , the proof is established. jk (1.134) We define a related entity by Œj k; i WD 1 @j gki C @k gij @i gj k Œkj; i ; 2 l D g li Œj k; i : (1.135) jk n o The symbols Œj k; i and j l k 0 are called Christoffel symbols of the first and second kind, respectively. These connections possess N 2 .N C 1/=2 linearly independent components. They are not components of a tensor field under general coordinate transformations. The salient properties of these symbols are listed here: gi l l D Œj k; i ; jk (1.136i) @j gi k D Œij; k C Œj k; i ; (1.136ii) @k g ij D g i b g lj @k gbl D g i l j i C gj l ; kl kl g g i l gij D g ı lj ; @k g D g g ij @k gij ; j ij h p i D @i ln jgj : (1.136iii) (1.136iv) (1.136v) Example 1.3.17. Consider the polar chart for a subset of the Euclidean plane E 2 . (See Example 1.1.1). The metric tensor is furnished by g:: .x/ D dx 1 ˝ dx 1 C .x 1 /2 dx 2 ˝ dx 2 ; ˚ D WD x 2 R2 W x 1 > 0; < x 2 < ; gij .x/ D 1 0 ; g D .x 1 /2 > 0: 0 .x 1 /2 58 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds The nonvanishing Christoffel symbols from (1.134) and (1.135) are given by Œ12; 2 D Œ22; 1 D x 1 ; 2 D .x 1 /1 ; 12 1 D x 1 ; 22 h p i 2 jgj : D D @i ln x 1 D @i ln i2 n o In this example, one can show that Rij mn .x/ 0 in spite of j i k 6 0. j ij ˚ N The investigations of (1.131i) and (1.131ii) in an orthonormal basis set eE.a/ 1 lead to the unique expression for connection coefficients as i 1 h .c/ .f / .f / .b/.a/ C d .c/.e/ d.b/.f / .a/.e/ C d.a/.f / .b/.e/ ; 2 .c/ .b/.a/ .x/ D .b/ .c/.a/ .x/ .b/ .a/.c/ .x/ .b/ .c/.a/ .x/: D (1.137) The Ricci rotation coefficients are defined by7 .a/.b/.c/.x/ WD d.a/.e/ .e/ .b/.c/ .x/; .b/.a/.c/.x/ .a/.b/.c/.x/: (1.138) The number of linearly independent components of .a/.b/.c/ .x/ is N 2 .N 1/=2. (See [56, 90].) The important properties of the Ricci rotation coefficients are listed here: .a/.b/.c/ .x/ D g:: .x/ @.a/ ; [email protected]/ @.a/ ; .a/.b/.c/ .x/ D gj l .x/ rk gj l .x/ ri l .a/ D .a/.b/.c/.x/ l .a/ j k .b/ .x/ .c/ .x/; .b/ .c/ j .x/ i .x/; @.a/ ; @.b/ Œf D d .c/.e/ .e/.a/.b/ .e/.b/.a/ @.c/ f: (1.139i) (1.139ii) (1.139iii) (1.139iv) Example 1.3.18. Consider the spherical surface of unit radius, S 2 . (See Example 1.1.2.) In the spherical polar coordinate chart, the metric is provided by 7 The Ricci rotation coefficients, analogous to the Christoffel symbols Œij; k, do not transform tensorially in general. 1.3 Riemannian and Pseudo-Riemannian Manifolds 59 2 g:: .x/ D dx 1 ˝ dx 1 C sin x 1 dx 2 ˝ dx 2 D eQ .1/ .x/ ˝ eQ .1/ .x/ C eQ .2/ .x/ ˝ eQ .2/ .x/; ˚ D WD x 2 R2 W 0 < x 1 < ; < x 2 < : (1.140) The natural orthonormal basis is furnished by eQ .1/ .x/ D dx 1 ; eQ .2/ .x/ D sin x 1 dx 2 ; 1 Ee.1/ .x/ @.1/ D @1 ; Ee.2/ .x/ @.2/ D sin x 1 @2 ; i i i 1 1 i ı .2/ ; .1/ .x/ D ı .1/ ; .2/ .x/ D sin x .2/ .1/ .1/ .2/ 1 ıi : i .x/ D ı i ; i .x/ D sin x Using (1.139ii), we obtain the nonzero components of the Ricci rotation coefficients as .1/.2/.2/.x/ D cot x 1 .2/.1/.2/.x/: The curvature tensor R: : : .x/ in (1.128), (1.129), and (1.130) is called the Riemann– Christoffel curvature tensor, provided the connection satisfies (1.131i,ii), (1.134), and (1.137). The components of the Riemann–Christoffel curvature tensor satisfy, from (1.129), (1.130), (1.135), and (1.137): Rij kl .x/ D @k i i i h i h @l C ; lj kj kh lj lh kj (1.141i) h h Rij kl .x/ D @k Œlj; i @l Œkj; i C Œi l; h Œi k; h ; (1.141ii) jk jl R .a/ .b/.c/.d / .x/ D @.d / .a/ .b/.c/ @.c/ .a/ .b/.d / .a/ C .h/.c/ .a/ .h/ .h/ C .b/.h/ .c/.d / .d /.c/ ; .h/ .b/.d / .a/ .h/ .h/.d / .b/.c/ (1.141iii) R.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/ D @.d / .a/.b/.c/ @.c/ .a/.b/.d / C d .h/.e/ .h/.a/.d / .e/.b/.c/ .h/.a/.c/ .e/.b/.d / C .a/.b/.h/ .e/.c/.d / .e/.d /.c/ : (1.141iv) The algebraic identities of the Riemann–Christoffel tensor are as follows: 60 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds Table 1.1 The number of independent components of the Riemann–Christoffel tensor for various dimensions N N 2 3 4 5 10 Number of independent components 1 6 20 50 825 Theorem 1.3.19. The algebraic identities of the Riemann–Christoffel tensor components are furnished by Rj i kl .x/ Rij kl .x/; (1.142i) Rij lk .x/ Rij kl .x/; (1.142ii) Rklij .x/ Rij kl .x/; (1.142iii) Rij kl .x/ C Ri klj .x/ C Ri lj k .x/ 0: (1.142iv) R.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/ R.b/.a/.c/.d /.x/; (1.142v) R.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/ R.a/.b/.d /.c/.x/; (1.142vi) R.c/.d /.a/.b/.x/ R.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/; (1.142vii) R.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/ C R.a/.c/.d /.b/.x/ C R.a/.d /.b/.c/.x/ 0: (1.142viii) The proof may be found in many of the textbooks in [56, 244, 267]. The algebraic identities in the previous theorem imply that the number of linearly independent components of the Riemann–Christoffel curvature tensor for a manifold of dimension N is N 2 .N 2 1/=12. The number of independent components for various dimensions of importance in physics is listed in Table 1.1. (Of particular importance to general relativity is the case N D 4.) Now, we shall state Bianchi’s differential identities for the curvature components. Theorem 1.3.20. Let the Riemann–Christoffel curvature tensor R: : : .x/ be of class C 1 .D RN /. Then the corresponding components satisfy the following differential identities: rj Rhi kl C rk Rhi lj C rl Rhij k 0; r.d / R .e/ .a/.b/.c/ C r.b/ R .e/ .a/.c/.d / C r.c/ R (1.143i) .e/ .a/.d /.b/ 0: (1.143ii) 1.3 Riemannian and Pseudo-Riemannian Manifolds 61 The proof may be found in many of the textbooks in the references.8 Example 1.3.21. Consider a two-dimensional manifold M with positive-definite metric. In an orthogonal coordinate chart, the metric is expressible as: g:: .x/ D g11 .x/ dx 1 ˝ dx 1 C g22 .x/ dx 2 ˝ dx 2 D eQ .1/ .x/ ˝ eQ .1/ .x/ C eQ .2/ .x/ ˝ eQ .2/ .x/: We can derive that g.x/ D g11 .x/ g22 .x/ > 0; eQ .1/ .x/ D i .1/ .x/ p p g11 dx 1 ; eQ .2/ .x/ D g22 dx 2 ; 1 D p ı i.1/ ; g11 i .2/ .x/ 1 D p ı i.2/ ; g22 1 1 @.1/ D p @1 ; @.2/ D p @2 : g11 g22 (1.144) Using (1.141i) and (1.141ii), we obtain for one independent component: p g 1 1 @1 p @1 g22 C @2 p @2 g11 ; R1212 .x/ D 2 g g p h p p p i g p R.1/.2/.1/.2/.x/ D g11 @2.1/ g C g22 @2.2/ g11 : 2 Now we shall state the general rule for commutators or Lie brackets of two covariant derivatives. These are known as the Ricci identities . Theorem 1.3.22. Let rs T.x/ be a tensor field of class C 2 .D RN /. Then, the following commutation rules hold: r .rk rl rl rk / T i1 ;:::;i j1 ;:::;js D r h X T i1 ;:::;i˛1 hi˛C1 ;:::;ir i˛ j1 ;:::;js R hkl i ˛D1 s h X i h r T i1 ;:::;i R jˇ kl ; j1 ;:::;jˇ1 hjˇC1 ;:::;js (1.145i) ˇD1 The number of linearly independent Bianchi’s identities is furnished by 1=24 N 2 .N 2 1/ .N 2/. In case N D 4, this number is exactly 20. (See [229].) 8 62 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds .a /;:::;.ar / r.c/ r.d / r.d / r.c/ T 1 .b1 /;:::;.bs / D r h X T .a1 /;:::;.a˛1 /.e/.a˛C1 /;:::;.ar / .a˛ / .b1 /;:::;.bs / R .e/.c/.d / i ˛D1 s h X T .a1 /;:::;.ar / .e/ .b1 /;:::;.bˇ1 /.e/.bˇC1 /;:::;.bs / R .bˇ /.c/.d / i : (1.145ii) ˇD1 The above can be proved by induction. Example 1.3.23. Consider a twice-differentiable tensor field T::.x/ in D RN . Equation (1.145i) yields: .rk rl rl rk / Tij D Thj Rhi kl Tih Rhj kl : In case T:: .x/ D g:: .x/, the left-hand side of the above equations is zero by (1.133), whereas the right-hand side vanishes by (1.142i). Now we shall discuss contractions of the Riemann–Christoffel curvature tensor. The Ricci tensor R:: .x/ Ric.x/ is defined by the single contraction9 Ric.x/ R:: .x/ WD R:: .x/ D R 1 C R : : : .x/ D Rkij k .x/ dx i ˝ dx j DW Rij .x/ dx i ˝ dx j ; 3 (1.146i) .c/ e.a/ .x/ .a/.b/.c/ .x/Q ˝ eQ .b/ .x/ DW R.a/.b/ .x/Qe.a/ .x/ ˝ eQ .b/ .x/: (1.146ii) By (1.141i,iii) and (1.146i,ii), we deduce k k k l l @k C Rij .x/ D @j ki ij il kj lk p p 1 k k or, Rij .x/ D @i @j ln jgj p @k jgj C ij il jgj R.a/.b/ .x/ D @.c/ .c/ .a/.b/ R.b/.a/ .x/: @.b/ .c/ .a/.c/ C .c/ .d / .a/.d / .b/.c/ k ; (1.147i) ij l Rj i .x/; kj (1.147ii) .c/ .d / .d /.c/ .a/.b/ (1.147iii) Thus, the Ricci tensor R:: .x/ is symmetric and has N.N C1/=2 linearly independent components. 9 Some texts define the Ricci tensor as the contraction of the Riemann tensor on the first and third indices. In texts using that convention, the Ricci tensor is opposite in sign to what is presented here. 1.3 Riemannian and Pseudo-Riemannian Manifolds 63 The curvature scalar (or curvature invariant) is defined by the contraction R.x/ WD Rii .x/ D g ij .x/ Rij .x/; .a/ R.x/ D R .a/ .x/ D d .a/.b/ R.a/.b/ .x/: (1.148i) (1.148ii) Of particular importance to general relativity theory is the Einstein tensor, G:: .x/. It is defined by 1 G:: .x/ WD R:: .x/ R.x/ g:: .x/; 2 (1.149i) 1 Gij .x/ D Rij .x/ R.x/ gij .x/; 2 (1.149ii) 1 G.a/.b/ .x/ D R.a/.b/ .x/ R.x/ d.a/.b/: 2 (1.149iii) The Einstein tensor is a .0C2/th order symmetric tensor and possesses N.N C 1/=2 linearly independent components. There exist more differential identities involving the tensor fields R: : : .x/; R:: .x/, and G:: .x/. Theorem 1.3.24. Let a metric field g:: .x/ be of class C 3 in D RN . Then the following differential identities hold: j (1.150i) j (1.150ii) rj R i kl C rk Ri l rl Ri k 0; rj G i 0; with similar identities in the orthonormal frame. Proof. The identities (1.150i) follow from Bianchi’s identities (1.143i,ii) by a single contraction. The second set of identities follows by a further contraction. Remarks: (i) Identities (1.150i) are known as the first contracted Bianchi’s identities. (ii) Identities (1.150ii) are called the second contracted Bianchi’s identities. We will see that these identities yield differential conservation laws in Einstein’s theory of gravitation. Now we shall define the covariant differentiation of a relative and oriented relative tensor field of weight w. (See (1.39) and (1.40).) It is defined (in both cases) by: i1 ;:::;ir r rk ˚ i1 ;:::;i ji ;:::;js WD @k ˚ j1 ;:::;js C r X i˛ i ;:::;i li ;:::;ir ˚ 1 ˛1 ˛C1j1 ;:::;j s kl ˛D1 64 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds s X l l r r w ˚ i1 ;:::;i ˚ i1 ;:::;i j1 ;:::;js ; j1 ;:::;jˇ1 ljˇC1 ;:::;js kl k jˇ ˇD1 (1.151i) r.c/ ˚ .a1 /;:::;.ar / .b1 /;:::;.bs / D @.c/ ˚ .a1 /;:::;.ar / .b1 /;:::;.bs / r X .a1 /;:::;.a˛1 /.d /.a˛C1 /;:::;.ar / .a˛ / .b1 /;:::;.b/s/ .d /.c/ ˚ ˛D1 C s X .d / .a1 /;:::;.ar / .bˇ /.c/ ˚ .b1 /;:::;.bˇ1 /.d /.bˇC1 /;:::;.bs / : (1.151ii) ˇD1 (See [56, 90, 171, 244].) p Example 1.3.25. The transformation property of jgj is that of an oriented scalar density field (see Example 1.2.8). Therefore, by (1.151i,ii), and w D 1, we obtain: p p p l jgj D @k jgj jgj 0: rk kl r.c/ q jdetŒd.a/.b/ j D @.c/ .1/ 0: (1.152i) (1.152ii) A manifold M with metric g:: satisfying (1.131i,ii) is called a Riemannian manifold in case the metric is positive-definite.10 If (1.131i,ii) hold, and the metric is not positive-definite, the manifold is called a pseudo-Riemannian manifold. We shall now classify various manifolds. In case R: : : .x/ 0 : : : .x/ in D N R , the domain D (and corresponding U M ) is called a flat domain. In case R: : : .x/ 6 0: : : .x/ in D RN , the domain D (and corresponding U M ) is called a curved domain in some sense. For a positive-definite metric, sgnŒg:: .x/ D N . For a Lorentz metric, sgnŒg:: .x/ D N 2. For an indefinite, non-Lorentz metric, 0 sgnŒg:: .x/ N 4. We represent the classification of manifolds with metrics in Fig. 1.10. Remarks: (i) In Newtonian physics, a three-dimensional Euclidean manifold represents space. (ii) In the special theory of relativity, a four-dimensional flat manifold with Lorentz metric represents the space–time continuum. (iii) In the general theory of relativity, a four-dimensional curved manifold with Lorentz metric represents the space–time continuum. We shall briefly discuss some integral theorems. Firstly, we define the oriented volume of a domain D RN by the multiple integral 10 It should be noted that in much of the literature involving relativistic physics, the term Euclidean is often synonymous with Riemannian. In this text, Euclidean and Riemannian refer to two distinct properties. 1.3 Riemannian and Pseudo-Riemannian Manifolds 65 Manifolds (with metrics) Riemannian (Positive definite) Pseudo−Riemannian (Indefinite) Lorentz Non−Euclidean (Curved) Euclidean (Flat) (Flat) Non−Lorentz (Curved) (Flat) (Curved) Fig. 1.10 A classification chart for manifolds endowed with metric Z V .D/ D dN V WD D 1 NŠ Z i1 ;:::;iN .x/ dx i1 ^ : : : ^ dx iN D Z p jgj dx 1 ; : : : ; dx N : D (1.153) Example 1.3.26. Consider a sphere in three-dimensional Euclidean space E 3 and the spherical polar coordinate chart (see Example 1.1.2). The metric tensor is provided by: g:: .x/ D dx 1 ˝ dx 1 C .x 1 /2 dx 2 ˝ dx 2 C sin2 .x 2 /dx 3 ˝ dx 3 ; ˚ D WD x 2 R3 W 0 < x 1 < a; 0 < x 2 < ; < x 3 < : (1.154) Therefore, the volume of a sphere, as given by (1.153), is Z V .D/ D a Z 0C 0C Z .x 1 /2 sin.x 2 / dx 1 dx 2 dx 3 D C 4.a/3 : 3 Now we shall state the generalized Gauss’ theorem. Theorem 1.3.27. Let D be a star-shaped domain in RN with a continuous, piecewise-differentiable, orientable, closed, nonnull boundary, @D , with unit E outward normal nj . Moreover, let A.x/ be a differentiable vector field in D [@D . Then, the following integral relation holds: Z D rj Aj dN v D Z @D Aj nj dN 1 v: (1.155) For proof, consult textbooks [38, 56, 130, 171, 237, 244, 266] in the references. 66 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds Example 1.3.28. Consider the Newtonian theory of gravitation in the Euclidean space E 3 . The gravitational potential W .x/, which is of class piecewise-C 2 , satisfies: ( 4G .x/ in D 2 R3 ; i ri r W D (1.156) 0 in R3 D : Here, G is the Newtonian constant of gravitation (G D 6:67 108 cm3 gm1 s in the c.g.s. system of units), .x/ > 0 is the mass density (which is assumed to be a piecewise-continuous function). By Gauss’ theorem, we obtain: 2 Z D ri r i W .x/ d3 v D 4GM WD 4G Z Z Z D .x/ d3 v D r i W .x/ ni d2 v; r i W .x/ ni d2 v: @D @D (1.157) Here, M is the total mass of the body inside D . Moreover, the integral on the right-hand side is called the total normal flux of the gravitational field across the boundary surface @D . (Remark: At a distance r from the center of a spherically symmetric source (such as the Earth), the Newtonian gravitational potential is given by W .r/ D GM=r, where M is the total mass located inside radius r.) Now we shall discuss briefly special coordinate charts. The metric field at a particular point x0 of a chart is given by: g:: .x0 / D gij .x0 / dx i ˝ dx j DW sij dx i ˝ dx j : Here, the symmetric matrix ŒS WD sij has p positive-definite eigenvalues and n negative-definite eigenvalues. In a different coordinate chart, by (1.37), we derive sOij WD gO ij .xO 0 / D O @X l .x/ O @X k .x/ gkl .x0 /; @xO i jxO 0 @xO j jxO 0 or, in the language of matrices, h i SO D ŒT ŒS Œ ; Œ WD O @X l .x/ @xO j : jxO 0 In linear algebra, there is a theorem [113] asserting the existence of a matrix Œ such that h i SO D ŒD DW dij : 1.3 Riemannian and Pseudo-Riemannian Manifolds 67 Thus, there are coordinate charts for which gO ij .xO 0 / dxO i ˝ dxO j D dij dxO i ˝ dxO j : Now we mention another important coordinate chart. At the point x0 2 D RN of a chart, there exists a Riemann normal coordinate chart such that xO 0 D XO .x0 / D .0; 0; : : : ; 0/ ; @O k gO ij j.0; 0;:::;0/ D 0; ˚1 k ij j.0; 0;:::;0/ D 0: (1.158) (For a proof, see textbooks [56, 90] in the references.) There exists another coordinate chart such that the metric field is expressible as gO :: .x/ O D gO ˛ˇ .x/ O dxO ˛ ˝ dxO ˇ C gO NN .x/ O dxO N ˝ dxO N ; O ¤ 0; ˛; ˇ 2 f1; 2; : : : ; N 1g : gO NN .x/ (1.159) Here, the coordinate xO N is called a normal or hypersurface orthogonal coordinate. (For the proof of (1.159), see textbooks [56, 90, 244] in the references.) The normal coordinate curve x N intersects orthogonally with each of x 1 ; : : : ; x N 1 -coordinate curves. (We have assumed that xO N is a nonnull coordinate.) There exists a special type of normal coordinate chart, namely, a Gaussian normal or geodesic normal coordinate chart. In this chart, the metric field is furnished by g:: .x/ D g˛ˇ .x/ dx ˛ ˝ dx ˇ C dNN dx N ˝ dx N DW g˛ˇ .x/dx ˛ ˝ dx ˇ C "N dx N ˝ dx N ; "N D ˙1: (1.160) Now we shall touch upon briefly some special Riemannian and pseudoRiemannian manifolds. A domain D RN (corresponding to the open subset U M ) is a flat domain provided R: : : .x/ 0 : : : .x/; or, equivalently: Rij kl .x/ 0; or, R .a/ .b/.c/.d / .x/ 0: (1.161) 68 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds Eisenhart, in his book on Riemannian geometry [90], proves that the metric tensor components gij .x/ of a prescribed signature p n solves the system of nonlinear (1.161) if and only if gij .x/ D dkl @i f k .x/ @j f l .x/: (1.162) Here, N functions f k .x/ are of class C 3 in D and otherwise arbitrary. If we make a C 3 -coordinate transformation xO i D f i .x/; then (1.162) yields gO :: .x/ O D dkl dxO k ˝ dxO l : (1.163) In the above equation, the metric tensor components are diagonal as well as constant-valued. The corresponding coordinate chart is often denoted by the following nomenclature: In case g:: .x/ is positive-definite (thus dij D ıij ), the special coordinate system is called a Cartesian coordinate chart. In case g:: .x/ is not positive-definite, the chart is called a pseudo-Cartesian chart. Note that, relative to a Cartesian or pseudo-Cartesian chart, the covariant derivative of an arbitrary differentiable tensor field simplifies to r r rOk TO i1 ;:::;i O @O k TO i1 ;:::;i O j1 ;:::;js .x/ j1 ;:::;js .x/: A Riemannian or pseudo-Riemannian manifold is called a space of constant curvature K0 , provided: Rlij k .x/ D K0 glj .x/gi k .x/ glk .x/gij .x/ ; R.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/ D K0 d.a/.c/ d.b/.d / d.a/.d / d.b/.c/ : (1.164i) (1.164ii) Note that in a space of constant curvature, the orthonormal components of the Riemann tensor are constant-valued. Example 1.3.29. In a two-dimensional Riemannian surface of constant curvature, we consider a Gaussian normal coordinate chart 2 g:: .x/ D dx 1 ˝ dx 1 C h.x 1 ; x 2 / dx 2 ˝ dx 2 : Equation (1.164i) reduces to the partial differential equation @2 h.x 1 ; x 2 / C K0 h.x 1 ; x 2 / D 0; .@x 1 /2 .x 1 ; x 2 / 2 D R2 : 1.3 Riemannian and Pseudo-Riemannian Manifolds 69 For the flat case, K0 D 0, and the general solution of the partial differential equation is furnished by h.x 1 ; x 2 / D f .x 2 /x 1 C g.x 2 /: Here, f and g are arbitrary C 2 -functions of integration. For the sake of this example, let us solve the initial value problem: h.0; x 2 / 1; @ h.x 1 ; x 2 /jx 1 D0 0: @x 1 Thus, we finally obtain g:: .x/ D dx 1 ˝ dx 1 C dx 2 ˝ dx 2 : That is, the domain is locally isometric to a Euclidean plane. In case K0 > 0 (constant positive curvature), we can prove that the domain p is locally isometric to a spherical surface (with radius of curvature 1= K0 ). Furthermore, for K0 < 0 (constant negative curvature), the domain is locally isometric to the surface of revolution in the shape of a bugle. Now we shall furnish the canonical form of the metric tensor for a space of constant curvature. Theorem 1.3.30. Let M be a manifold of space of constant curvature with N 2 and of differentiability class C 2 . Then, there exists locally a coordinate chart such that g:: .x/ D 1 C K0 dkl x k x l 4 2 dij dx i ˝ dx j ; x 2 D RN : (For the proof, consult textbooks [56, 90] in the references.) Now we shall define an Einstein space. It is a C 3 -manifold with the following conditions: R:: .x/ D R.x/ g:: .x/; N (1.165i) Rij .x/ D R.x/ gij .x/; N (1.165ii) R.a/.b/ .x/ D R.x/ d.a/.b/ : N (1.165iii) 70 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds Example 1.3.31. Consider the following Gaussian normal metric for N 2: g:: .x/ WD N 1 X 2 h.˛/ .x N / dx ˛ ˝ dx ˛ dx N ˝ dx N ; ˛D1 1 ˇ˛ h.˛/ .x N / WD sin.kx N / N 1 tan kx N =2 ; k D const.; ˇ˛ D const. such that: N 1 X ˇ˛ D 0 and ˛D1 N 1 X ˛D1 ˇ˛2 D N 2 : N 1 The above metric locally represents an Einstein space, as can be verified by calculating the Ricci tensor and Ricci scalar ((1.147ii) and (1.148i)) and showing that (1.165i) holds. (See [210].) A Ricci flat space is one for which the components of the Ricci tensor vanish. Note that for Einstein spaces with vanishing curvature scalar, the Ricci tensor components also vanish via (1.165i–iii), and hence, Einstein spaces with vanishing curvature scalar are Ricci flat. In the general theory of relativity, a four-dimensional Ricci flat domain indicates a space–time devoid of material sources (although “gravitational fields” may be present). We shall provide plenty of examples of such spaces later on! We shall now investigate conformal mappings. This term is well known in complex analysis. We generalize this concept to the mapping of a regular domain M into M . It is assumed that M and M have identical atlases. The conformal mapping is defined by g:: .x/ WD exp Œ2 .x/ g:: .x/; .a/ eQ .x/ D exp Œ .x/ eQ .a/ .x/: (1.166i) (1.166ii) Here, is assumed to be a C -function into R . We note that by (1.166i,ii), we can obtain E E g:: .x/ vE.x/; w.x/ D exp Œ2 .x/ g:: .x/ vE .x/; w.x/ (1.167) 3 N E for an arbitrary pair of vector fields vE.x/ and w.x/. The above equation clearly shows that for a positive-definite metric, the angle (see (1.94)) between two nonzero vectors is exactly preserved. By (1.166i,ii), we also derive (after a long calculation) the transformed curvature components as i R j kl .x/ D Rij kl .x/ C ı il rk rj .@k /.@j / ı ik rl rj .@l /.@j / C ı il gj k ı ik gj l Œg mn .@m /.@n / ˚ C g i m gkj Œrl rm .@l /.@m / glj Œrk rm .@k /.@m / ; (1.168i) 1.3 Riemannian and Pseudo-Riemannian Manifolds e2 .x/ R .a/ .b/.c/.d / .x/ DR .a/ .b/.c/.d / .x/ Cı .a/ .d / r.c/ r.b/ 71 [email protected]/ /[email protected]/ / .a/ ı .c/ r.d / r.b/ [email protected] / /[email protected]/ / .a/ .a/ C ı .d / d.b/.c/ ı .c/ d.b/.d / d .e/.f / [email protected]/ /[email protected] / / ˚ C d .a/.e/ d.b/.c/ r.d / r.e/ [email protected] / /[email protected]/ / d.b/.d / r.c/ r.e/ [email protected]/ /[email protected]/ / : (1.168ii) (See [56, 90, 171, 266].) Now we shall define Weyl’s conformal tensor.11 For N 3, the Weyl conformal tensor’s components are defined by: i h 1 C lij k .x/ WD Rlij k .x/ C ı lj Ri k ı lk Rij C gi k Rlj gij Rlk .N 2/ C C .d / .a/.b/.c/ .x/ i h R.x/ ı lk gij ı lj gi k ; .N 1/.N 2/ .d / WD R .a/.b/.c/.x/ C (1.169i) 1 .N 2/ i h .d / .d / .d / .d / ı .b/ R.a/.c/ ı .c/ R.a/.b/ C d.a/.c/ R .b/ d.a/.b/ R .c/ C i h R.x/ .d / .d / ı .c/ d.a/.b/ ı .b/ d.a/.c/ : .N 1/.N 2/ (1.169ii) An important theorem regarding the conformal tensor is the following: Theorem 1.3.32. Consider a conformal mapping g:: .x/ D expŒ2 .x/g:: .x/ of class C 3 in a domain D RN .N 3/. The components of the conformal tensor remain invariant under the conformal transformations, that is, C l ij k .x/ C lij k .x/: (1.170) Proof. The proof follows from calculating all parts of the conformal tensor in (1.169i), via (1.166i), (1.168i), (1.147ii), and (1.148i) using both g:: .x/ and g:: .x/. A domain of M is conformally flat provided the corresponding chart satisfies g:: .x/ D expŒ2 .x/ g:: .x/; 11 There exists another tensor called Weyl’s projective tensor. It is defined in [90]. 72 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds with i R j kl .x/ 0: We shall now state an important theorem regarding conformal flatness. Theorem 1.3.33. A domain of M for N 4 is conformally flat if and only if C ij kl .x/ 0 in the corresponding domain D RN . (For a proof, consult textbooks [56, 90, 171].) The symmetries or isometries of a Riemannian or pseudo-Riemannian manifold E are obtained from the existence of Killing vectors, K.x/ satisfying LKE Œg:: .x/ D 0:: .x/; (1.171i) @l gij K l .x/ C glj .x/@i K l C gi l .x/@j K l D 0; (1.171ii) ri Kj C rj Ki D 0: (1.171iii) (Compare with Problem # 7 of Exercises 1.2.) Example 1.3.34. Consider the surface S 2 of the unit sphere. (See Examples 1.1.2 and 1.3.18.) Recall (1.155) which states 2 g:: .x/ D dx 1 ˝ dx 1 C sin x 1 dx 2 ˝ dx 2 : (1.172) The corresponding Killing equation (1.171ii) yields @1 K 1 D 0; (1.173i) @2 K 2 C cotx 1 K 1 .x/ D 0; (1.173ii) 2 @2 K 1 C sin x 1 @1 K 2 D 0: (1.173iii) The general solutions of the above system of partial differential equations are furnished by K 1 .x/ D A sin x 2 C B cos x 2 ; K 2 .x/ D C cot x 1 A cos x 2 C B sin x 2 ; @ @ E K.x/ D A sin x 2 1 C cot x 1 cos x 2 2 @x @x C B cos x 2 @ @ cot x 1 sin x 2 2 @x 1 @x CC @ : @x 2 1.3 Riemannian and Pseudo-Riemannian Manifolds 73 Here, A; B, and C are arbitrary constants of integration. Thus, there exist three linearly independent Killing vectors: E h1i .x/ WD sin x 2 @ C cot x 1 cos x 2 @ ; K @x 1 @x 2 E h2i .x/ WD cos x 2 @ C cot x 1 sin x 2 @ ; K @x 1 @x 2 E h3i .x/ WD @ : K @x 2 (Multiplying the above by the imaginary number i yields the orbital angular momentum operators of quantum mechanics!) In other words, it is said that S 2 admits a three-parameter (rotation) group of motion. E Remarks: (i) Suppose that K.x/ is a Killing vector field in Ds D RN . Then, there exists a coordinate chart such that @gO ij .x/ O KO i .x/ O D ı i.N / ; 0 for all xO 2 DO s DO RN : @xO N (1.174) (ii) An N -dimensional Riemannian or pseudo-Riemannian manifold can admit at most an N.N C 1/=2-parameter group of motion. Such a space must be a space of constant curvature given by (1.164i). (Proofs of the above remarks are available in the textbook by Eisenhart [90].) We have discussed a parametrized curve X .t/ in (1.19). Furthermore, we have defined a tensor field rs T.x/ and its components in (1.30) and (1.31). Now, we shall investigate a tensor field restricted to the curve. We denote this by rs T.x/jX .t / D rs T.X .t // r s T .X .t//. The components of the .r C s/th order derived tensor field dt restricted to the curve are furnished by: r D T i1 ;:::;i j1 ;:::;js .X .t// dt i h r WD rk T i1 ;:::;i j1 ;:::;js D r d T i1 ;:::;i j1 ;:::;js dt jX .t / " C dX k .t/ dt r X i˛ i ;:::;i li ;:::;ir T 1 ˛1 ˛C1 j1 ;:::;j s kl ˛D1 # s X dX k .t/ l i1 ;:::;ir : T j1 ;:::;jˇ1 ljˇC1 ;:::;js ˇ k jˇ ˇX .t / dt ˇD1 (1.175) (See [56, 90, 171, 244].) 74 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds Fig. 1.11 Parallel propagation of a vector along a curve Example 1.3.35. Equation (1.175) for a vector field restricted to a curve yields h i i DV .a/ .X .t// E .X .t// D DV .X .t// @ ˇ Ee.a/ .X .t// ; rXE 0 V D dt @x i ˇX .t / dt (1.176i) d V i .X .t// D V i .X .t// D C dt dt d X j .t/ i V k .x/ ˇ ; jk ˇX .t / dt h i D V .a/ .X .t// .a/ D @.b/ V .a/ .x/ .c/.b/ .x/V .c/ .x/ ˇˇ X 0.b/ .t/: X .t / dt (1.176ii) (1.176iii) If we choose the vector field as the tangent vector to the twice-differentiable i parametrized curve, then V i .X .t// D dXdt.t / . Also, (1.176ii) implies d2 X i .t/ dX j .t/ dX k .t/ D V i .X .t// i D : (1.177) C j k ˇˇX .t / dt dt dt 2 dt In case the manifold is the three-dimensional Euclidean space E 3 , and t is the time parameter, (1.177) denotes the Newtonian acceleration of a particle in a general coordinate chart. A vector field V.X .t// along a curve X .t/ is said to be parallelly propagated provided h i E .t//; E .t// D O.X (1.178i) rXE 0 V.X dV i .X .t// dX k .t/ i j C D 0: V .X .t// j k ˇˇX .t / dt dt (See Fig. 1.11.) (1.178ii) 1.3 Riemannian and Pseudo-Riemannian Manifolds 75 (Remark: The averaging of tensorial quantities at different space–time points requires the concept of parallel propagation between the points. (See [29].)) E Suppose that a differentiable vector field V.x/ is defined in D RN . Let there be a differentiable curve X with image in D. Moreover, let the vector field E .t// restricted to the curve, be parallelly propagated over . Then, by (1.178ii), V.X we obtain the difference Zb V .X .b// V .X .a// D i i dV i .X .t// dt D dt a Z D Z i V j .x/dx k : kj @k V i dx k (1.179) In case is a simple closed curve and it is the boundary of a star-shaped surface D2 interior to D, we can apply Stokes’ Theorem 1.2.23. By (1.74), (1.179), and (1.141i), we obtain that the jump discontinuity V i i V j .x/ dx k kj I WD Z D .1=2/ D2 @k i Vj lj @l i Vj kj Z h i R ij kl .x/V j .x/ dx l ^ dx k : D .1=2/ dx l ^ dx k (1.180) D2 (See Fig. 1.12.) Note that for a flat manifold, (1.180) yields V i 0, or parallel transportation is integrable. Figure 1.13 illustrates a subtle issue between parallel transport around a closed curve and flatness. Figure 1.13a represents a flat sheet, and transporting the vector around the closed curve shown yields trivial parallel transport. In a similar manner, if the sheet is folded into a cylinder as in Fig. 1.13b, transport around the cylinder (or any closed path) also yields trivial parallel transport, indicating that the cylinder is also intrinsically flat. If the sheet is folded into a cone as in Fig. 1.13c, the sheet is everywhere intrinsically flat, save for the apex. However, there are closed paths which will yield nontrivial parallel transport of the vector. Specifically, these are paths which enclose the apex. If we excise a section near the top of the cone (creating a truncated cone), we now have an everywhere flat manifold but vectors transported around the truncated region will still possess nontrivial parallel transport. This is 76 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds Fig. 1.12 Parallel transport along a closed curve Fig. 1.13 Parallel transport along closed curves on several manifolds. Although all manifolds here are intrinsically flat, except for the apex of (c), the cone yields nontrivial parallel transport of the vector when it is transported around the curve shown, which encompasses the apex. The domain enclosed by a curve encircling the apex is non-star-shaped, and therefore, nontrivial parallel transport may be obtained even though the entire curve is located in regions where the manifold is flat not in contradiction with the above arguments for flatness since the surface which is bound by this curve is not star-shaped, and therefore, the above argument does not apply. Paths on the cone which do not enclose the apex still yield trivial parallel transport. A geodesic X is a nondegenerate, twice-differentiable curve into D RN such that h i E 0 .t/; E 0 .t/ D .t/X rXE 0 X (1.181i) dX i .t/ d2 X i .t/ dX j .t/ dX k .t/ i D .t/ C ˇ 2 j k ˇX .t / dt dt dt dt (1.181ii) for some continuous function over Œa; b R. The geometrical implication of (1.181i) is that the tangent vector along the curve is parallelly transported. 1.3 Riemannian and Pseudo-Riemannian Manifolds 77 Equation (1.181ii) can be simplified by a reparametrization discussed in (1.23). Changing the notation, we express the reparametrization as Z Z D T .t/ WD k1 exp .t/dt dt C e k2 ; b ./: x D X .t/ D X (1.182) Here, k1 ¤ 0 and k2 are arbitrary constants. It can be proved that under the reparametrization, (1.181ii) reduces to b k ./ b j ./ dX b i ./ d2 X dX i D 0: C ˇ j k ˇXO . / d d 2 d (1.183) These are the geodesic equations. Remark: The parameter in (1.182) is called an affine parameter along a geodesic. A nonhomogeneous linear transformation O D c1 C c2 ; c1 ¤ 0 produces another affine parameter. Equation (1.183) admits the first integral b .// gij .X b j ./ b i ./ dX dX D k D const. d d (1.184) In case k D 0, we call the curve a null geodesic. For a nonnull geodesic, we introduce another (affine) reparametrization by p s D S./ WD jkj ./; b ./ D X # .s/; xDX dX #i .s/ dX #j .s/ sgn .k/ D ˙1: ds ds The parameter s is called an arc separation parameter. gij .X # .s// (1.185) (1.186) Example 1.3.36. Consider the Euclidean plane E 2 and the polar coordinate chart. (See Example 1.1.1.) We have g:: .x/ D dx 1 ˝ dx 1 C .x 1 /2 dx 2 ˝ dx 2 ; 1 1 2 2 D D D D 0; 11 12 11 22 1 2 1 D x ; D .x 1 /1 : 22 12 78 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds The geodesic equations (1.183) and (1.186) in arc separation parameter s yield 2 d2 X #1 .s/ dX #2 .s/ #1 X .s/ D 0; ds 2 ds d #1 2 dX #2 .s/ D 0; X .s/ ds ds dX #1 .s/ ds 2 2 dX #2 .s/ C X #1 .s/ ds 2 D 1: The second of the above equations yields X #1 .s/ 2 dX #2 .s/ D h; ds where h is an arbitrary constant of integration. (The above equation implies Kepler’s law of the constancy of areal velocity). In case h D 0, the general solutions of the equations are furnished by r x 1 D X #1 .s/ D s C c1 ; ' x 2 D X #2 .s/ D c2 : Here, c1 and c2 are two arbitrary constants of integration. Note that the above geodesic, in the polar coordinate chart of E 2 , represents a portion of a radial straight line. In case h ¤ 0, we can prove that geodesics are portions of straight lines not passing through origin. The geodesic equations (1.183) for a nonnull curve can be derived from the Euler–Lagrange variational equations [171]: ) ( @L.x; u/ ˇ d @L.::/ D 0; ˇ ˇ @x k ˇˇxDX # .s/ ds @uk ˇ:: ˇ dX # .s/ ˇuD ds L.x; u/ WD q jgij .x/ui uj j > 0: (1.187) Therefore, along a geodesic curve, the total arc separation attains any of the minimum, or maximum, or stationary value. (See Appendix 1.) Now we shall derive the equations for the geodesic deviation. Consider a twodimensional parametric surface into D RN furnished by x D .; v/; 2 C 3 .D 2 R2 I RN /; x i D Rank (See Fig. 1.14.) @ i @ i ; @ @v D 2: i .; v/; (1.188) 1.3 Riemannian and Pseudo-Riemannian Manifolds 79 Fig. 1.14 Two-dimensional surface generated by geodesics Let a typical parametric curve .; v0 / be a geodesic in D RN , with as an affine parameter. Therefore, we have 0i D @ i .; v/ ; @ .; v/ WD 0i @ .; v/ D @ @ 0i i .; v/ C j k ˇˇ 0j .; v/ 0k .; v/ D 0: (1.189) .;v/ Let us consider the other coordinate curve x D .0 ; v/. This curve is nondegenerate, differentiable, and need not be a geodesic. The tangent vector components along .0 ; v/ is given by i .; v/ WD i .o ; v1 / i @ i .; v/ ; @v (1.190i) .0 ; v0 / D .v1 v0 / i .0 ; v0 / C v# WD v0 C .v1 v0 /; 1 @i 2 ˇ .v1 v0 / ; 2 @v ˇv# 0 < < 1: (1.190ii) Therefore, jv1 v0 j E .0 ; v0 / is the first approximation of the separation between two neighboring geodesics .; v0 / and .; v1 / at 0 . The vector field .;v0 / is the approximate relative velocity between two neighboring .v1 v0 / DE@ geodesics. Similarly, the approximate relative acceleration between two geodesics 2 2 i E .;v/ . Now, we shall furnish an exact equation for D @.;v/ is given by .v1 v0 / D @ 2 2 and it is given by 80 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds D 2 i .; v/ ˇ ˇ @ 2 .;v/ C R ilj k . .; v// 0l .; v/ j .; v/ 0k .; v/ D 0: (1.191) Remark: The above equations are called the geodesic deviation equations. (For the proof of (1.191), see textbooks [56, 244] in the references.) Example 1.3.37. Consider the surface S 2 of the unit sphere embedded in R3 . (See Examples 1.1.2, 1.3.3, 1.3.18, and 1.3.34.) The metric tensor, the nonzero Christoffel symbols, and the nonzero Riemann–Christoffel tensor components are provided by: g:: .x/ D dx 1 ˝ dx 1 C .sin x 1 /2 dx 2 ˝ dx 2 d ˝ d C .sin /2 d' ˝ d'; 1 2 2 D sin cos ; D D cot ; 22 12 21 R1212 R1221 D sin2 ; R2112 R2121 1: Consider the one-parameter family of geodesic congruence (or great circles) provided by the longitudes as .; '/ WD .; '/; .; '/ 2 .0; / .; / R2 I 0i gij . .; '// gij . .; '// 0i .; '/ D ı i.1/ ; .; '/ 0i 0j i .; '/ D ı i.2/ ; .; '/ 1; gij . .; '//i .; '/j .; '/ sin2 > 0; .; '/j .; '/ 0: (See Fig. 1.15.) The geodesic deviation (1.191) reduces to D 2 ı i.2/ @ 2 C R i121 .; '/ i D C ı k.2/ cot C R2121 ı i.2/ 1k D ı i.2/ cosec2 C cot2 C 1 0: Œ@1 .cot / ı i.2/ Thus, the geodesic deviation equations are identically satisfied. Note that in this example, 1.3 Riemannian and Pseudo-Riemannian Manifolds 81 Fig. 1.15 Geodesic deviation between two neighboring longitudes k E .; '/ k WD .E .; '// D sin ; E .; '/ k D 0 D lim k E .; '/ k : lim k !0C ! Longitudinal geodesics do meet at the north and south poles (which are not covered by the coordinate chart). These two points are called conjugate points on a geodesic .; '0 /. Geodesics are “straightest curves” in a differentiable manifold. Now we shall deal with differentiable curves which are not necessarily geodesic. A nonnull differentiable curve is characterized by: h rˇ iˇ 0 E 0 .t/ ˇˇ > 0: E 0 .t/; X E .t/ D ˇˇg:: .X .t// X X (1.192) We shall reparametrize the curve according to (1.23) and (1.24) as Zt s D S.t/ WD E 0 .u/ du; X a sˇ ˇ ˇ dS.t/ dX i .t/ dX j .t/ ˇˇ ˇ D ˇgij .X .t// ; dt dt dt ˇ sˇ ˇ ˇ dX #i .s/ dX #j .s/ ˇˇ #0 # ˇ E X .s/ D ˇgij .X .s// ds ds ˇ 1: (1.193) 82 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds By (1.186), it is clear that s is an arc separation parameter. (In case of a positivedefinite metric, s is called an arc length parameter.) Also, by (1.185) and (1.186), we can express dS.t/ dt 2 ˇ ˇ ˇ dX i .t/ dX j .t/ ˇˇ ˇ > 0: D ˇgij .X .t// dt dt ˇ (1.194) A popular way to write the above equation is ds 2 D gij .x/dx i dx j : (1.195) Mathematically, (1.195) is somewhat dubious. However, for popular demand, we shall keep on using (1.195) in the sequel. In this chapter, we shall usually use the parameter s for a nonnull curve and drop # from X # . (However, for a null curve, we use an affine parameter ˛ and drop O from XO .˛/.) Now we shall state an important theorem regarding a nonnull differentiable curve. Theorem 1.3.38. Let X be a parametrized, nonnull curve of differentiability class C N C1 .Œs1 ; s2 ; RN /. Moreover, let the following finite sequence of N non-null vector fields, recursively defined, exist along the curve: i .1/ .s/ .A/ .s/ i .AC1/ .s/ WD WD dX i .s/ ; ds D i .A/ .s/ ds C d.A1/.A1/ d.A/.A/ .A1/ .s/ i .A1/ .s/; .0/ .s/ D .N / .s/ 0; d.A/.A/ D ˙ 1; A 2 f1; 2; : : : ; N g: (1.196) ˚ E .A/ .s/ N is an orthonormal basis set along the curve. Then, the set of vector fields 1 (For the proof, consult textbooks [56, 244] in the references.) Remarks: (i) The equations (1.196) are called the generalized Frenet-Serret formulas. E .A/ .s/ D E .A1/ .s/ becomes (ii) In case any of the vectors ds C d.A1/.A1/ d.A/.A/.A/ null, the procedure breaks down. (For a geodesic curve, the above expression is zero for A D 1, implying .1/ .s/ 0.)) (iii) The subscript .A/ is not summed. Example 1.3.39. Let us choose the Euclidean space E 3 and a Cartesian coordinate chart. We use the alternate notations 1.3 Riemannian and Pseudo-Riemannian Manifolds 83 Fig. 1.16 A circular helix in R3 x3 o s x2 x1 T i .s/ WD i .1/ .s/; B i .s/ WD i .3/ .s/; .s/ WD .1/ .s/; N i .s/ WD i .2/ .s/; .s/ WD .2/ .s/: The generalized Frenet-Serret formulas (1.196) yield dT i .s/ D .s/ N i .s/; ds dN i .s/ D .s/ T i .s/ C .s/ B i .s/; ds dB i .s/ D .s/ N i .s/: ds (These are the usual Frenet-Serret formulas.) Let us consider a circular helix in space furnished by p p p X .s/ WD cos s= 2 ; sin s= 2 ; s= 2 ; s 2 Œ0; 1/: (See Fig. 1.16.) (1.197) 84 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds In this case, we compute explicitly as p p 1 @ 1 @ 1 E T.s/D p sin.s= 2/ ˇ C p cos.s= 2/ ˇ Cp 1 2 @x ˇ.s/ @x ˇ:: 2 2 2 p E N.s/ D cos.s= 2/ p @ @ ˇ sin.s= 2/ ˇ ; 1 @x ˇ:: @x 2 ˇ:: p p @ 1 @ 1 1 E p cos.s= 2/ B.s/ D p sin.s= 2/ Cp ˇ 1 2 ˇˇ @x @x ˇ 2 2 2 .s/ :: .s/ @ ˇ ; @x 3 ˇ:: 1 ; .s/ 2 1 : 2 @ ˇ ; @x 3 ˇ:: (1.198) (See [95, 197, 266].) Exercises 1.3 1. Compute the Christoffel symbols of the second kind and Ricci rotation coefficients for the two-dimensional metric of constant curvature g:: .x/ D .x 1 C x 2 /2 dx 1 ˝ dx 2 ; where the domain of validity D WD f.x 1 ; x 2 / W x 1 C x 2 > 0g. .a/ 2. Let the components R ij k .x/ WD R:::: .x/ eQ .a/ .x/; @i ; @j ; @k . Express .a/ R ij k .x/ in terms of Christoffel symbols, Ricci rotation coefficients, and their first derivatives. 3. The Laplacian operator is defined by the second-order differential operator WD g ij .x/ri rj DW r i ri D r .a/ r.a/ : Prove that for a twice-differentiable scalar field .x/, i p hp jgj g ij @j D 1= jgj @i h i .c/ D d .a/.b/ @.b/ @.a/ C .a/.b/ .x/@.c/ : Remark: In the case the manifold is Riemannian, DW r 2 . Moreover, in the case where the metric is Lorentzian (possesses Lorentz signature), DW .) 4. Prove that in a regular domain of a two-dimensional pseudo-Riemannian manifold Gij .x/ 0: 1.3 Riemannian and Pseudo-Riemannian Manifolds 85 5. The double Hodge-dual of Riemann–Christoffel curvature tensor in four dimensions is defined by Rij kl .x/ WD .1=4/ ij mn.x/Rmnpq .x/ pqkl .x/: Prove that Rij ki .x/ D Gj k .x/: 6. Suppose that the metric tensor field g:: .x/ is of class C 4 in a domain D RN . Show that the following second-order differential identities hold in D: ri rj Rklmn rj ri Rklmn C rl rk Rmnj i rk rl Rmnj i C rm rn Rij kl rn rm Rij kl 0: 7. Prove that for differentiable Ricci coefficients, the following differential identities hold: .c/ .c/ .c/ @.c/ .a/.b/ .b/.a/ C @.a/ .b/.c/ @.b/ C .c/ .a/.c/ C .c/ .d / .a/.d / .b/.c/ .c/ .d /.c/ .d / .d / .b/.a/ .a/.b/ .c/ .d / .b/.d / .a/.c/ 0: 8. Show that the arc separation function ˇ Zt2 sˇ ˇ P dX i .t/ dX j .t/ ˇˇ ˇ .X / WD dt ˇgij .X .t// dt dt ˇ t1 for a differentiable curve X is invariant under a reparametrization. 9. Consider the Euclidean space E 3 and a Cartesian coordinate chart. Let X be a twice-differentiable curve from the arc length parameter s into R3 . Assuming .s/ WD .1/ .s/ > 0, prove that X is a plane curve if and only if .s/ WD .2/ .s/ 0. 10. Consider a locally flat manifold and a Cartesian or a pseudo-Cartesian chart with R: : : .x/ 0: : : .x/. A one-parameter family of geodesics congruence spanning a ruled 2-surface is provided by xi D i .; v/ D F i .v/ C G i .v/: Here, F i .v/ and G i .v/ are differentiable. Prove that the geodesic deviation equations (1.191) are identically satisfied. 11. Let a twice-differentiable geodesic X in terms of an affine parameter be expressed as 86 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds x D X ./ 2 D RN ; x i D X i ./; 2 Œ1 ; 2 R: Synge’s world function ˝ is defined by ˝.x2 ; x1 / ˝ .X .2 /; X .1 // Z2 WD .1=2/.2 1 / gij .X .// dX i ./ dX j ./ d: d d 1 Prove that for a flat manifold with the metric gij .x/ D dij , @˝.x2 ; x1 / j j D dij x2 x1 : i @x1 12. Show that the Kretschmann invariant for a space of constant curvature K0 is given by Rij kl .x/ Rij kl .x/ D R.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/ R.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/ D 2N.N 1/.K0 /2 : 13. Prove that in a regular domain of a three-dimensional manifold, the conformal tensor C: : : .x/ 0: : : .x/. 14. Show that the number of linearly independent components of the conformal 2 2 tensor C ij kl .x/ for N 3 is N .N12 1/ N.N2C1/ . 15. (i) Show that r.e/ d.a/.b/ d.c/.d / 0: (ii) Prove by explicit computation that @.a/ @.b/ f D r.a/ r.b/ f .d / .b/.a/ ./ @.d / f: (iii) Show that under a general Lorentz transformation (1.103), the Ricci rotation coefficients undergo the following transformations: .c/ .a/.b/ .x/ b .c/ .r/ .x/ DA .r/ .b/ .x/ CL .p/ .a/ .x/ L .q/ .b/ .x/ L h i .c/ Ee.a/ .x/ A .r/ .x/ : b .r/ .p/.q/ .x/ 1.3 Riemannian and Pseudo-Riemannian Manifolds 87 (iv) Prove the particular Ricci identity: .a/ r.c/ r.d / r.d / r.c/ T.b/ D R .b/.c/.d / T.a/ ; for an arbitrary differentiable covector field T.a/ . Answers and Hints to Selected Exercises 5. 6. 7. 8. 11. Use (1.145i). Use Ricci identities (1.145i,ii). Identities follow from (1.147iii). Use (1.23) and (1.24). j j ˝.x2 ; x1 / D .1=2/ dij .x2i x1i /.x2 x1 /. (For more applications of the world function, consult [243].) 13. Use an orthogonal coordinate chart (suspending summation convention) to express g:: .x/ D g11 .x/ dx 1 ˝ dx 1 C g22 .x/ dx 2 ˝ dx 2 C g33 .x/ dx 3 ˝ dx 3 : Obtain for distinct indices i; j; k, Ri i D 1 1 Rijj i C Ri kki ; gjj gkk Rij D 1 Ri kkj ; gkk RD 3 3 X X i D1 j D1 1 Rijj i : gi i gjj Use the definition in (1.169i) for N D 3. 15. (ii) By (1.124ii), it follows that .d / r.a/ r.b/ f D @.a/ r.b/ f C .b/.a/ ./ r.d / f : (iii) Use (1.104), (1.107ii), and 1.116ii to obtain .c/ .a/.b/.c/ .x/ b n h io h i b b E E D rb .x/ e .x/ e .x/ : .b/ .a/ .c/ eQ (Remark: Note that in general, the transformation under consideration is not tensorial.) 88 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds (iv) Using (1.124ii), (1.139iv), and (1.141iii), the L.H.S. of the equation yields: n o .a/ .a/ @.c/ r.d / T.b/ C .d /.c/ r.a/ T.b/ C .b/.c/ r.d / T.a/ n o .a/ .a/ @.d / r.c/ T.b/ C .c/.d / r.a/ T.b/ C .b/.d / r.c/ T.a/ D nh i .e/ .a/ @.c/ @.d / T.b/ C @.c/ .b/.d / T.e/ C .b/.d / @.c/ T.a/ h i .a/ .a/ .e/ C .d /.c/ @.a/ T.b/ C .d /.c/ .b/.a/ T.e/ h io .a/ .a/ .e/ C .b/.c/ @.d / T.a/ C .b/.c/ .a/.d / T.e/ Œc $ d : n .e/ .e/ .a/ .a/ .e/ D @.c/ .b/.d / @.d / .b/.c/ C .d /.c/ .c/.d / .b/.a/ C D R .a/ .b/.c/ .e/ .b/.c/.d / .e/ .a/.d / .a/ .b/.d / .e/ .a/.c/ o T.e/ C 0 T.e/ : (Here, and throughout this book, the notation Œc $ d or fc $ d g represents the previous term but with the indices c and d interchanged.) 1.4 Extrinsic Curvature P Consider a two-dimensional surface 2 embedded in the three-dimensional Eu3 clidean space P E 3 . We denote the nondegenerate mapping of class C which has the image 2 . Let be furnished in a Cartesian coordinate chart by the equations x D .u/ 2 R3 ; xi D i .u/ i .u1 ; u2 /; .u1 ; u2 / 2 D2 R2 I @ i .u1 ; u2 / ; @u Rank @ i D 2 I @ i WD 2 f1; 2g; i 2 f1; 2; 3g: The mapping is called the parametric surface. (See [56, 95].) (1.199) 1.4 Extrinsic Curvature 89 Fig. 1.17 A two-dimensional surface P 2 embedded in R3 The three-dimensional vectors Et. / . .u// WD @ i @ @x i j (1.200) .u/ P are tangential to the coordinate curves on 2 . (See Fig. 1.17.) 3 These two vectors span a two-dimensional vector P subspace2 of T .u/ .R /. It is isomorphic to the intrinsic tangent planes T .u/ 2 and Tu .R /. Any two vectors E .u// and W. E .u// in the two-dimensional vector subspace can be expressed by V. the linear combinations E .u// D v .u/@ V. i E .u// D w .u/@ W. @ @x i j i @ @x i j ; .u/ : (1.201) .u/ Now, the inner product for three-dimensional vectors is provided by g:: .x/ @ @ ; j i @x @x I:: .x/ @ @ ; i @x @x j WD ıij : (1.202) / DW g .u/; (1.203) By (1.200), (1.201), and (1.202), we derive that I:: . .u// Et. / . .u//; Et./ . .u// D ıij .@ i /.@ j E .u//; W. E .u// D g .u/ v .u/ w .u/: I:: . .u// V. (1.204) 90 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds From the above equations, we identify g:: .u/ WD g .u/ du ˝ du (1.205) P as the intrinsic metric for the (image) surface 2 . E . .u// (using the cross product) as We can express the unit outer normal vector n h i. E . .u// D Et.1/ . .u// Et.2/ . .u// n k Et.1/ . .u// Et.2/ . .u// k h i .p D Et.1/ . .u// Et.2/ . .u// g.u/; g.u/ WD det g .u/ > 0; h ik Et.1/ ./ Et.2/ ./ D ı kj "j i l @1 i @2 l : (1.206) (See [95].) Now, consider the rate of change of vector fields Et. / . .u// along the coordinate P curves on 2 . For that purpose, we define vector fields Et. / . .u// WD .@ @ i / @ @x i j .u/ Et. / . .u//: (1.207) n o E . .u// is a basis set for the vector space T Since Et.1/ . .u//; Et.2/ . .u//; n we can express the vector field Et. Et. / . / . 3 /, .u// as a linear combination: E .u/ t. / . .u// D C .u/ .R E . .u//: .u// C K .u/ n (1.208) Here, C .u/ and K .u/ are some suitable coefficients. By (1.207), we can prove the symmetries C .u/ C .u/; (1.209) K .u/ K .u/: LetP us try to determine coefficients C of 2 . It can be proved that C .u/ D (See [56, 95].) D .1=2/ g .u/ and K .u/ in terms of known quantities @ g C @ g @ g : (1.210) 1.4 Extrinsic Curvature 91 Moreover, (1.207) and (1.208) yield E . .u//; n E . .u// K .u/ D I:: . .u// K .u/ n ! Et. / . .u//; nE . .u// D I:: . .u// Et. / . .u// D ıij .@ @ i / nj . .u// 0: (1.211) The symmetric tensor K:: .u/ WD K .u/ du ˝ du (1.212) is called the extrinsic curvature tensor. The first fundamental form ˚I ds 2 D g .u/ du du determines the intrinsic geometry of the surface. The second fundamental form ˚II WD K .u/ du du reveals how the surface curves in the external three-dimensional embedding space. Now we shall consider the invariant eigenvalue problem posed in the following equations: det K .u/ k.u/ g .u/ D 0; (1.213) g k 2 g K k C det K D 0: Since g:: .u/ is positive-definite, (1.213) always yield two real roots k.1/ .u/ and k.2/ .u/. These roots are the invariant eigenvalues. The Gaussian curvature and the mean curvature of the surface are furnished by ı g.u/; (1.214) K.u/ WD k.1/ .u/k.2/ .u/ D det K .u/ .u/ WD .1=2/ k.1/ .u/ C k.2/ .u/ D .1=2/ g .u/K .u/: (1.215) Example 1.4.1. We shall investigate a smooth surface of revolution. Consider a nondegenerate, parametrized curve of class C 3 given by x D X .u1 / WD f .u1 /; 0; h.u1 / ; u1 2 .a; b/ R; f .u1 / > 0; 0 1 2 0 1 2 f .u / C h .u / > 0: (1.216) The image of X is called the profile curve and it is totally contained in the x 1 x 3 plane of R3 . In case the profile curve is revolved around the x 3 -axis, the resulting surface of revolution is furnished by x D .u1 ; u2 / D f .u1 / cos u2 ; f .u1 / sin u2 ; h.u1 / ; ˚ D2 WD u 2 R2 W a < u1 < b; < u2 < : (1.217) (See Fig. 1.18.) 92 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds Fig. 1.18 A smooth surface of revolution By (1.217), (1.200), and (1.203), we obtain Et.1/ . .u// D f 0 .u1 / cos u2 @ @ C sin u2 2 @x 1 @x Et.2/ . .u// D f .u1 / sin u2 @ @ C cos u2 2 1 @x @x C h0 .u1 / ˇ ˇ @ ˇ @x 3 ˇ ; .u/ ; .u/ 2 2 g 11 .u/ D f 0 .u1 / C h0 .u1 / > 0; 2 g 22 .u/ D f .u1 / > 0; g 12 .u/ D g 21 .u/ 0; 2 n 0 1 2 0 1 2 o f .u / C h .u / > 0: g.u/ D f .u1 / (1.218) The unit normal from (1.206) is given by 1=2 nE . .u// D .f 0 /2 C .h0 /2 @ 2 @ 0 1 @ C f .u / 3 ˇ h .u / cos u C sin u @x 1 @x 2 @x ˇ 0 1 2 Using (1.217), (1.218), and (1.207), we deduce that : .u/ (1.219) 1.4 Extrinsic Curvature Et.11/ . .u// D 93 @ 2 @ 00 1 @ C h .u / 3 ˇ f .u / cos u C sin u @x 1 @x 2 @x ˇ 00 1 2 Et.22/ . .u// D f .u1 / cos u2 @ @ C sin u2 2 ˇ @x 1 @x ˇ Et.12/ . .u// Et.21/ . .u// D f 0 .u1 / sin u2 ; .u/ ; .u/ @ @ C cos u2 2 ˇ 1 @x @x ˇ : (1.220) .u/ Now, by (1.220), (1.219), and (1.211), the extrinsic curvature components are 1=2 0 1 00 1 f .u / h .u / f 00 .u1 / h0 .u1 / ; K11 .u/ D .f 0 /2 C .h0 /2 1=2 f .u1 / h0 .u1 /; K22 .u/ D .f 0 /2 C .h0 /2 K12 .u/ K21 .u/ 0: (1.221) (In many problems of physics or engineering, one deals with metallic or ceramic surfaces of revolution.) Now we shall discuss the embedding of an .N1/th dimensional manifold MN 1 into a manifold MN . The differentiable manifold MN 1 is said to be embedded in MN provided there exists a one-to-one mapping F W MN 1 ! MN such that F is of class C r .r 2 ZC /. (In the case when mapping F is not assumed to be globally one-to-one, it is defined as an immersion.) The image F .MN 1 / is called the embedded manifold. By restricting P the coordinate charts, we define a parametrized hypersurface with the image N 1 in D RN . (See Fig. 1.19.) We explain various mappings in Fig. 1.19 by the following equations: q D F .p/; j:: WD jU \F .M N 1 / ; i h x D j:: .q/ D j:: ı F ı 1 .u/ DW .u/; .u/ i .u1 ; : : : ; uN 1 /; Rank @ i D N 1 > 0; xi D i 2 C r .DN 1 RN 1 I RN / I r 3: (1.222) Here, Roman indices are taken from f1; : : : ; N g and the Greek indices are taken from f1; : : : ; N 1g. The summation convention is followed for both sets of indices. (See [56, 90].) 94 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds Fig. 1.19 The image P N 1 of a parametrized hypersurface The metric g:: .x/ and the induced metric g:: .u/ are furnished (as in (1.203)) respectively by: g:: .x/ D gij .x/ dx i ˝ dx j ; g:: .u/ D g .u/ du ˝ du DW gij . .u// @ P An outer normal to N 1 is provided by k . .u// WD i @ j du ˝ du : (1.223) @.x j2 ; : : : ; x jN / 1 g kj . .u// "jj2 :::jN : .N 1/Š @.u1 ; : : : ; uN 1 / (1.224) Here, indices j2 ; : : : ; jN are summed. (See [56, 171].) In the sequel, we assume that gkj ./ k ./ j ./ ¤ 0. Thus, we can define the unit normal as .q jgij . .u// i . .u// j . .u//j ; nk . .u// WD k . .u// E/ ; gkl ./ nk ./ nl ./ ˙1 DW ".n/; ".n/ D sgn g:: .En; n gij ./ ni ./ @ j 0: (1.225) j j2 jN ; x ; :::; x / 0 for 2 The last equation in (1.225) follows from the fact that @.x @.u ; u1 ; :::; uN 1 / f1; : : : ; N 1g because the Jacobian matrix rank is N 1. Recall the coordinate transformations in (1.2) for MN . We can have a similar coordinate transformation, called a reparametrization, in MN 1 . (See Fig. 1.20.) 1.4 Extrinsic Curvature 95 Fig. 1.20 Coordinate transformation and reparametrization of hypersurface The mappings occurring in Fig. 1.20 are elaborated below: u# D U # .u/; Rank @u#˛ @uˇ D N 1; 1 U WD U # ; (1.226i) (1.226ii) ı .U # /1 .u# /; (1.226iii) h i bP b ı .u/ DW b.u/; b xDX .x/ D X j N 1 (1.226iv) i h b ı ı .U # /1 .u# / DW Q .u# /: b xD X (1.226v) x D .u/ D # .u# / WD Let us consider the transformation properties of @ i under each of (1.226iii), (1.226iv), and (1.226v). By the chain rules of differentiation, we obtain @ .u# / @U .u# / @ i .u/ D ; @u# @u# @u (1.227i) b i .x/ @X @bi .u/ D @u @x k j (1.227ii) #i .u/ @ k .u/ ; @u b i .x/ @ Q i .u# / @ k .u/ @U .u# / @X D : @u# @x k j:: @u @u# (1.227iii) 96 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds Therefore, we conclude that: (1) under a reparametrization, @ i behaves like components of a covariant vector field; (2) under a coordinate transformation, @ i behaves as components of a contravariant vector field, and (3) under a combined transformation, @ i behaves like components of a mixed second-order (hybrid) tensor field. These transformation rules prompt us to define formally hybrid tensor field [56] components by the following transformation rules: TQ 1 ;:::; p i1 ;:::;ir 1 ;:::;q j1 ;:::;js D .u# ; Q .u# // @u# p @up1 @upq @b x i1 @b x ir @x l1 @x ls @u# 1 # #q k k j j @u 1 @u @x 1 @x r @b x1 @b xs @u p @u 1 T 1 ;:::; p k1 ;:::;kr p1 ;:::;pq l1 ;:::;ls .u; .u//: (1.228) Example 1.4.2. Consider N D 3 and MN D E 3 , the Euclidean space. A smooth, nondegenerate parametrized surface is given by .u/ WD ˛ 1 .u1 / C u2 X 1 .u1 /; ˛ 2 .u1 / C u2 X 2 .u1 /; ˛ 3 .u1 / C u2 X 3 .u1 / ; .u1 ; u2 / 2 .a; b/ .c; d / R2 I Rank @ i D 2: At each point .u0 / on rulings are furnished by P 2, a line segment or ruling passes through P 2. These X.0/ .u2 / WD ˛ 1 .u10 / C u2 X 1 .u10 /; ˛ 2 .u10 / C u2 X 2 .u10 /; ˛ 3 .u10 / C u2 X 3 .u10 / ; u2 2 .c; d /: Such a surface is called a ruled 2-surface. Let us consider a reparametrization u#1 D u1 ; u#2 D 2u2 : For the purpose of this example, we introduce a translation of Cartesian axes given by x 2 D x 2 C 2; b x 3 D x 3 C 3: b x 1 D x 1 C 1; b Transformation (1.227iii) can be obtained explicitly by the matrix equation " @ Q i .u# / @u# .32/ # 2 ˛ 10 .u#1 / C .1=2/u#2X 10 .u#1 /; .1=2/X 1.u#1/ 3 6 7 20 #1 #2 20 #1 2 #2/ 7 D6 4 ˛ .u / C .1=2/u X .u /; .1=2/X .u 5 : ˛ 30 .u#1 / C .1=2/u#2X 30 .u#1 /; .1=2/X 3.u#3/ 1.4 Extrinsic Curvature 97 Now we shall define a suitable covariant derivative for a hybrid tensor field. The covariant derivative is given by the components rQ T 1 ;:::; p i1 ;:::;ir 1 ;:::;q j1 ;:::;js C@ k rk T h .u; .u// WD r T 1 ;:::; p i1 ;:::;ir 1 ;:::;q j1 ;:::;js 1 ;:::; p i1 ;:::;ir 1 ;:::;q j1 ;:::;js i .u; x/ ˇˇ xD .u/ : .u; x/ (1.229) Note that on the right-hand side, the covariant derivative acts on the Greek indices in the first term and only on the Roman indices in the second term. Moreover, the left-hand side constitutes components of a higher order hybrid tensor. To clarify, we now provide some examples of covariant differentiations. Example 1.4.3. We shall discuss here covariant derivatives of hybrid scalar fields, vector fields, and tensor fields: h i rQ .u; .u// D r .u; x/ C @ k rk .u; x/ ˇˇ xD .u/ D @ .u; x/ C @ @u k @.u; x/ ˇ @x k ˇxD @V .u/ rQ V .u/ D r V .u/ D @u rQ Tj . .u// D @ k D@ k rQ @ i h i rk Tj .x/ ˇˇ xD .u/ D r @ i i C k l ˇˇ V .u/ I k h i rk gij .x/ ˇˇ xD (1.230ii) @ Ti .x/ ˇ ˇxD k @ l I I (1.230iii) .u/ (1.230iv) .u/ rQ g .u/ D r g .u/ 0 I rQ gij . .u// D @ (1.230i) .u/ @Tj .x/ i .u/ k kj @x I .u/ (1.230v) .u/ 0: (1.230vi) 98 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds Fig. 1.21 Change of normal vector due to the extrinsic curvature Now we generalize (1.211) to define the extrinsic curvature as K .u/ WD gij . .u// ni . .u// rQ @ j : (1.231) By (1.225), (1.231), and (1.230iv) we have rQ @ j D ".n/ nj . .u// K .u/; @ @ j D j @ j i k ˇˇ (1.232i) @ i @ k .u/ C ".n/ nj . .u// K .u/; (1.232ii) K .u/ K .u/: (1.232iii) Since by (1.225) gij ./ h rQ @ i nj C @ i i rQ ni 0; (1.233) we obtain from (1.231) K .u/ D gij . .u// rQ ni @ j D ri nj j .u/ @ i @ j : (1.234) Using (1.234) and (1.230iii), we can prove that rQ ni D @ k rk ni j .u/ D g .u/ K .u/ @ i : (1.235) The above equations are the generalizations of Weingarten’s equations. These equations allow the following geometrical interpretation: In Fig. 1.21, the dotted vector at .U.t C t// is the parallelly transported normal vector. The difference vector En indicates the change due to the extrinsic curvature. Now, we need to digress and discuss briefly integrability conditions of partial differential equations. Consider the system of N 1 partial differential equations @ V .u/ D P .u/; (1.236) 1.4 Extrinsic Curvature 99 N 1 in a star-shaped domain DN . In (1.236), the prescribed functions P .u/ 1 R 1 are of class C . We define a one-form Q w.u/ WD P .u/ du : By (1.236), Q w.u/ D @ V .u/ du D dV .u/: Using Poincaré’s lemma (1.66), we deduce that Q D d2 V .u/ 0:: .u/: d P .u/ du D dw.u/ (1.237) Therefore, by Theorem 1.2.21, there exists a C 1 -function F .u/ such that Q dV .u/ D w.u/ D d .F .u// : Integrating along a continuous and piecewise differentiable curve of image DN 1 , we obtain the solution of (1.236) as Z P .y/ dy D F .u/ F u.0/ : u V .u/ D (1.238) u.0/ Œ The conditions (1.237), yielding @ P .u/ @ P .u/ D 0; (1.239) are called the integrability conditions for (1.236). Suppose that we are confronted with the question of existence of a hypersurface of class C r .r 3/ for a prescribed extrinsic curvature K .u/. In that case, we have to investigate the integrability conditions of partial differential equations (1.232i) or (1.232ii). These conditions can be summarized in the following lemma. Lemma 1.4.4. Suppose that is an .N 1/th dimensional parametrized hypersurface embedded in RN according to (1.222). Then, the integrability conditions of partial differential equations (1.232i) or (1.232ii) are furnished by the following hybrid tensor equation: i h .u; .u// WD R h C Rij lk . .u// @ D 0: i .u/ C ".n/ K K K K @ j @ l @ k C ".n/ rQ K rQ K i ni . .u// i (1.240) 100 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds Proof. The integrability of partial differential equations (1.232i) or (1.232ii) are h i rQ ni K : rQ rQ @ i rQ rQ @ i D ".n/ rQ ni K By the Leibniz rule of differentiation and the Weingarten equations (1.235), we derive that rQ K ni rQ ni K D rQ K rQ K ni C K K K K @ i : With the above equations and the following: rQ rQ @ i rQ rQ @ i D R .u/ @ i C Rij kl . .u// @ j @ k @ l ; (1.241) Equation (1.240) is established. (See Problem # 3 of Exercises 1.4.) The above lemma leads to the following generalizations of Gauss’ equations and the Codazzi-Mainardi equations. Theorem 1.4.5. Let be a nondegenerate, .N 1/-dimensional parametric hypersurface of class C r .r 3/ into RN . Then, the integrability conditions of partial differential equations (1.232i) or (1.232ii) imply that .i/ R .u/ D ".n/ K K K K C Rij kl . .u// @ .ii/ rQ K rQ K i @ D Rij kl . .u// @ j j @ @ k k @ @ l l I ni . .u// : (1.242i) (1.242ii) Proof. By (1.240), (1.223), and (1.225), we deduce that the “tangential component” yields 0 D gij @ j i D g g R C ".n/ K K K K gih @ h Rij kl @ j @ l @ k C 0: Thus, (1.242i) follows. By (1.240) and (1.225), we derive that the “normal component” implies 0 D gih nh i D 0 gih nh Rij kl @ Therefore, (1.242ii) follows. j @ k @ l h C rQ K rQ K i : Now we shall provide some examples. Example 1.4.6. Consider the three-dimensional P Euclidean space, a Cartesian coordinate chart, and an embedded surface 2 . In this case, Rij kl . .u// 0. 1.4 Extrinsic Curvature 101 Equations (1.242i,b) reduce respectively to R1212 .u/ D K11 K22 .K12 /2 D det K .u/ ; (1.243i) r K (1.243ii) r K 0: (Equations (1.243i) and (1.243ii) were first discovered by Gauss in 1828 and Codazzi-Mainardi (in 1868 and 1856), respectively.) Using (1.243i) and (1.214), it follows that the Gaussian curvature ı K.u/ D R1212 .u/ g.u/: (1.244) The left-hand side of (1.244) is related to the extrinsic curvature, whereas the righthand side is given by the intrinsic curvature of the surface. The surprising equality of these two was called by Gauss as Theorema Egregium. Example 1.4.7. Consider an N -dimensional differential manifold with a local coordinate chart such that g:: .x/ D gij .x/ dx i ˝ dx j ; g NN .x/ ¤ 0: (1.245) (In this example, the index N is not summed.) Let an .N 1/-dimensional hypersurface be furnished by x D xN D .u/ WD u ; .u/ WD c D const.; .u/ .x/ WD x 1 ; : : : ; x N 1 ; @ N D ı ; @ N 0: (1.246) The intrinsic metric is provided by g .u/ g .x/ WD g .x/ˇˇx N Dc ; and the unit normal to the hypersurface is furnished by h .p i jg NN .x/j ˇˇ N : ni .x/ˇˇx N Dc D g iN .x/ x Dc (1.247) (1.248) 102 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds Equation (1.231), by (1.246)–(1.248), shows that " 1 K .u/ K .x/ D p jg NN .x/j # N : ˇ ˇx N Dc (1.249) In the case of a geodesic normal coordinate chart, it is assumed that g NN .x/ "N ; g N .x/ 0: (1.250) The extrinsic curvature components in (1.249) reduce by (1.250) to "N @g .x/ ˇ : 2 @x N ˇx N Dc (1.251) (The above equations will be applied in the next chapter.) Finally, we shall now define a parameterized submanifold by a mapping C r .DD RD I RN /. We generalize (1.222) by the following: 2 K .x/ D x D .u/ 2 RN ; x i D i .u/ Rank @ i D D; i .u1 ; : : : ; uD /; 1 < D < N; g .u/dx ˝ dx WD gij . .u// @ i @ j du ˝ du ; ; 2 f1; :; Dg : (1.252) (For a detailed treatment, see [56, 90, 121].) Exercises 1.4 1. Consider a nondegenerate Monge surface embedded in a three-dimensional Euclidean space E 3 . Let it be parametrically specified by x D .u/ WD u1 ; u2 ; f .u1 ; u2 / ; u .u1 ; u2 / 2 D2 R2 : (Assume that f is of class C 4 .) (i) Prove that the extrinsic curvature components are furnished by 1=2 .@ @ f /: K .u/ D 1 C ı .@ f /.@ f / (ii) Show that the vanishing of the Gaussian curvature K.u/ in a domain implies the existence of a nonconstant differentiable function F such that F .@1 f; @2 f / 0. 1.4 Extrinsic Curvature 103 2. Suppose that a nondegenerate, twice-differentiable parametrized surface given by (1.199). Prove that the extrinsic curvature is provided by 2 1 @ @ 2 @ @ 3 @ @ p 6 g.u/ K .u/ D det 6 4 @1 1 @1 2 @1 3 @2 1 @2 2 @2 3 is 3 7 7: 5 3. Prove (1.241) of the text. 4. Suppose that MN is a space of constant curvature. (See (1.164i).) Prove that the Gauss equation (1.242i) and the Codazzi-Mainardi equation (1.242ii) reduce respectively to C K0 g g g g R .u/ D ".n/ K K K K and r K r K D 0: Answers and Hints to Selected Exercises 1. (ii) The condition K.u/ D 0 is satisfied if and only if the determinant det.@ @ f / D 0: Denoting by g.u/ WD @1 f and h.u/ WD @2 f , the preceding condition yields the Jacobian ˇ ˇ ˇ @1 g @2 g ˇ @.g; h/ ˇ ˇ WD ˇ ˇ D 0: ˇ @1 h @2 h ˇ @.u1 ; u2 / Thus, the functions g and h are functionally related. Therefore, there exists a nonconstant differentiable function F such that F .g; h/ 0. 3. Using (1.228), (1.141i), and (1.230i–vi), we derive that h rQ rQ rQ rQ D r h i rQ @ 8 2 < D r 4r r : i i @ i C @ k h i C f $ g i .u/ ˇˇ f $ g :: 3 2 i @ l 5 C@ k 40C rQ @ k j ˇˇ:: rk rQ @ i @ k l ˇˇ:: k i 39 = j5 ; 104 1 Tensor Analysis on Differentiable Manifolds D r r r r r C DR i jk .u/ @ i C @j i kl ˇ ˇ @ j i l @ k @ .u/ C Rij kl . .u// @ k @ h @ j @ k @ l .u/ j @ ˇ l h ˇ:: @ l j @ @ k k @ l : (Here, and throughout this book, the notation f $ g or Œ $ represents the previous term but with the indices and interchanged.) Chapter 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 2.1 Review of the Special Theory of Relativity We shall provide here a brief review of the special theory of relativity. Since the emphasis of this book is general relativity, we will state some of the results in this section without proof, for future application. For more details, the reader is referred to the references provided within this chapter. The arena of this theory is the four-dimensional flat pseudo-Riemannian space– time manifold M4 endowed with a Lorentz metric. (See [55,189,242].) Let us choose a global pseudo-Cartesian or Minkowskian chart for the flat manifold M4 . A typical tangent vector is depicted in Fig. 2.1. In Fig. 2.1, the vector vE x0 is drawn on a sheet of paper with inherent Euclidean geometry. However, in the pseudo-Riemannian manifold M4 with Lorentz metric, we obtain from Examples 1.2.1 and 1.3.2 (also from (1.85i–iv)) that @ ˇ ; @x i ˇx0 2 2 2 2 g:: .x0 / vE x0 ; vEx0 D dij vi vj WD v1 C v2 C v3 v4 ; q vE x0 D jdij vi vj j: vEx0 D vi (2.1) Note that the components vi of a tangent vector vE x0 are the same either for a positivedefinite metricp or for a Lorentz metric. The length .v1 /2 C .v2 /2 C .v3/2 C .v4 /2 of the vector vE x0 , as drawn in Fig. 2.1, is different from the separation vE x0 in (2.1). Moreover, from the discussions after (1.95), it is clear that the angular inclination of the vector vE x0 in Fig. 2.1 is not meaningful. Therefore, it is judicious to exercise caution in interpreting lengths and angles of space–time vectors drawn on a piece of paper! A. Das and A. DeBenedictis, The General Theory of Relativity: A Mathematical Exposition, DOI 10.1007/978-1-4614-3658-4 2, © Springer Science+Business Media New York 2012 105 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 106 vp p0 χ 0 M 4 x0 vx 0 4 Fig. 2.1 A tangent vector Evp0 in M4 and its image Evx0 in R4 The tangent vector space Tx0 .R4 / splits into three distinct proper subsets. The subset of vectors ˚ WS .x0 / WD Esx0 W g:: .x0 / Esx0 ; Esx0 > 0 (2.2i) is called the subset of spacelike vectors. The subset o n WT .x0 / WD Etx0 W g:: .x0 / Etx0 ; Etx0 < 0 (2.2ii) is called the subset of timelike vectors. Finally, the subset ˚ E x0 W g:: .x0 / nE x0 ; nE x0 D 0 WN .x0 / WD n (2.2iii) is the subset of null vectors. ˚ 4 Example 2.1.1. Let Ee.a/x0 1 be an orthonormal basis set or tetrad. (See (1.87) and (1.88).) Therefore, g:: .x0 / Ee.a/x0 ; Ee.b/x0 D d.a/.b/: (2.3) Let a tangent vector be given by the equation Esx0 WD 2 Ee.1/x0 . Therefore, g:: .x0 / Es ; Es D 4 and Esx0 are spacelike. Let another vector be furnished by Etx0 WD px0 x0 3 Ee.4/x0 . In this case, g:: .x0 / Etx0 ;Etx0 D 3. Thus, Etx0 is timelike. Finally, let E x0 WD Ee.2/x0 Ee.4/x0 . Thus, g:: .x0 / n E x0 ; nEx0 D 0. Therefore, nE x0 is a nonzero null n vector. Now, we shall state several theorems and a corollary regarding various tangent vectors. b Theorem 2.1.2. Let Etx0 and Etx0 be two timelike vectors in Tx0 .R4 /. Then g:: .x0 / b .Etx0 ; Etx0 / ¤ 0. 2.1 Review of the Special Theory of Relativity 107 b Corollary 2.1.3. Let two timelike tangent vectors Etx0 and Etx0 have for their b components t 4 > 0 and tO 4 > 0. Then, g:: .x0 / Etx0 ; Etx0 < 0. E x0 be a nonzero null vector in Theorem 2.1.4. Let Etx0 be a timelike vector and n 4 E E x0 ¤ 0. Tx0 .R /. Then, g:: .x0 / tx0 ; n Next, we state a very counterintuitive theorem. E x0 and b Theorem nE x0 are orthogonal .i:e:; 2.1.5. Two nonzero null vectors n b E x0 ; nE x0 D 0/, if and only if they are scalar multiples of each other. g:: .x0 / n Proofs of above theorems and corollary are available in books [55, 243]. Now, we shall briefly discuss the physical significance of the flat manifold M4 in special relativity. Firstly, we choose physical units so that the speed of light c D 1. (In the popular c.g.s. units, c D 2:998 1010 cm.s1 ) Roman indices take from f1; 2; 3; 4g, whereas Greek indices take from f1; 2; 3g. The summation convention is followed for both sets of indices. An element p 2 M4 represents an idealized point event in the space–time continuum. In a global Minkowskian coordinate chart, x D .p/ .x 1 ; x 2 ; x 3 ; x 4 / stands for the coordinates of an event. The coordinates x 1 ; x 2 ; x 3 represent the usual Cartesian coordinates of the spatial point associated with the event. The fourth coordinate x 4 stands for the time coordinate of the event. (Remark: The time coordinate x 4 need not provide the actual temporal separation!) In units where the speed of light is not set to unity, x 4 is the time coordinate multiplied by c. Therefore, in the Minkowskian chart, the time coordinate x 4 possesses the same units as the spatial coordinates. (On the other hand, a spatial coordinate x ˛ divided by c possesses the same unit as time.) The three-dimensional hypersurface given by o n j Nx0 WD x W dij x i x0i x j x0 D 0 (2.4) is called the null cone (or “light cone”) with vertex at x0 . (See Fig. 2.2.) The points inside and on the upper half of the null cone represent future events relative to x0 . Similarly, points inside and on the lower half of the cone represent past events relative to x0 . The events outside the cone are the (relativistic) present events relative to x0 . The causal cone relative to x0 is represented by the proper subset o n j Cx0 WD x W dij x i x0i x j x0 0 : (2.5) Events in Cx0 can either causally affect or be affected by the event in x0 . This statement incorporates one of the physical postulates of the special relativity, namely, physical actions cannot propagate faster than light. We shall motivate this statement shortly. The global Minkowskian charts are very useful in the special theory of relativity. The coordinate transformation (see Fig. 1.2) from one such chart to another is furnished by the equations 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 108 x4 Nx0 Future x0 Present Present Past x2 x3 x1 4 Fig. 2.2 Null cone Nx0 with vertex at x0 (circles represent suppressed spheres) b i .x/ D c i C l ij x j ; xO i D X (2.6i) l ki dkm l mj D dij ; x i D aij xO j c j ; (2.6ii) (2.6iii) l mi aik D ı mk : (2.6iv) Here, c i and l ij are ten independent constants, or, parameters. The set of all transformations in (2.6i–iv) constitutes a Lie group denoted by IO.3; 1I R/. It is usually called the Poincaré group. The subgroup characterized by c 1 D c 2 D c 3 D c 4 D 0, is denoted by O.3; 1I R/. It is usually known as the six-parameter Lorentz group [55, 114]. Example 2.1.6. Assuming jvj < 1, a Lorentz transformation is provided by xO 1 D x 1 ; xO 2 D x 2 ; x 3 vx 4 xO 3 D p ; 1 .v/2 vx 3 C x 4 xO 4 D p : 1 .v/2 (2.7) 2.1 Review of the Special Theory of Relativity 109 x^ 4 x4 ^ N0 N0 L4 ^ L4 π/4 L3 π/4 x^ 3 x3 ^ L3 2 2 Fig. 2.3 A Lorentz transformation inducing a mapping between two coordinate planes Suppressing two dimensions characterized by the x 1 -axis and x 2 -axis, we shall exhibit qualitatively the transformation (2.7) in Fig. 2.3. (We assume 0 < v < 1.) In Fig. 2.3, the x 3 -axis and x 4 -axis are mapped into two straight lines LO 3 and 4 O b 0 . Thus, N0 remains invariant L respectively. The line N0 is mapped into N under the mapping. (This line physically represents the trajectory of a photon, or other massless particle, in space–time!) The preimages of xO 3 -axis and xO 4 -axis are lines L3 and L4 , respectively. In the inherent Euclidean geometry of the plane of Fig. 2.3, two lines L3 and L4 do not intersect orthogonally! However, in the relativistic Lorentz metric, two lines L3 and L4 do intersect orthogonally! The Lorentz transformation in (2.7) mediates, physically speaking, the transformation from one (inertial) observer to another (inertial) observer moving with velocity v along the x 3 -axis. (A popular name for the Lorentz transformation in (2.7) is a boost.) This mapping induces the phenomena of length contraction and time dilation between observers in relative motion [55, 89]. Now, we shall discuss (Minkowskian) tensor fields in the flat space–time manifold. We use a global Minkowskian coordinate chart so that g:: .x/ D dij dx i ˝ dx j D dx 1 ˝ dx 1 C dx 2 ˝ dx 2 C dx 3 ˝ dx 3 dx 4 ˝ dx 4 D ı˛ˇ dx ˛ ˝ dx ˇ dx 4 ˝ dx 4 ; g:: .x/ D d ij @ @ ˝ j ; @x i @x sgn .g:: .x// D C2: (2.8) 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 110 The natural orthonormal basis set or tetrad is provided by Ee.a/ .x/ D i.a/ .x/ @ @ i WD ı.a/ : @x i @x i (2.9) (See (1.104).) A tensor field rs T.x/ and its Minkowskian components satisfy r s T.x/ D T i1 ;:::;ijr1 ;:::;js .x/ @ @ ˝ ˝ i ˝ dx j1 ˝ ˝ dx js : i @x 1 @x r (2.10) (Compare the above with (1.30).) The transformations of tensor field components under a Poincaré transformation in (2.6i–iv) are provided by j j b T k1 ;:::;klr1 ;:::;ls .x/ O D l k1i1 ; : : : ; l krir a 1l1 ; : : : ; a sls T i1 ;:::;ijr1 ;:::;js .x/: (2.11) (Compare the above with (1.37).) It should be noted that covariant derivatives in Minkowskian charts are equivalent to partial derivatives, as the Christoffel symbols are identically zero in Minkowskian charts in flat space–time. Example 2.1.7. Consider the Lorentz metric tensor in (2.8). Under a Poincaré transformation, using (2.11), we deduce that dOij D aki alj dkl D dij : (For the derivation of the last step, we have used (2.6ii, iv).) Therefore, the Lorentz metric tensor behaves as a numerical tensor under Poincaré transformations. (Consult [56] for discussions on numerical tensors.) One of the mathematical axioms of the special relativity is that every natural law must be expressible as a tensor field equation r s T.x/ or D rs O.x/; T i1 ;:::;ijr1 ;:::;js .x/ D 0: (2.12) (Sometimes, such tensor equations are restricted on a curve.) By a Poincaré transformation, (2.12) simply imply that bk1 ;:::;kr O D 0: T l1 ;:::;ls .x/ (2.13) Therefore, a natural law, as formulated by one inertial (i.e., experiencing no net force) observer, must be exactly similar to that of another moving (inertial) observer. This is the principle of special relativistic “covariance.” (Later, other types of objects, spinor fields, had to be added on.) 2.1 Review of the Special Theory of Relativity 111 Now, we shall deal with differentiable, parametric curves in space–time. We shall consider a nondegenerate parametric curve X of class C 2 . (See Fig. 1.6.) We reiterate (1.19) and (1.20) as x D X .t/; x i D X i .t/; 2 4 X dX j .t/ j D1 dt > 0; t 2 Œa; b R: (2.14) Now, we explore the invariant values of i h 0 i j 0 E .t/ D dij dX .t/ dX .t/ : E .t/; X g:: .X .t// X dt dt (2.15) A spacelike curve satisfies dij dX i .t/ dX j .t/ > 0: dt dt (2.16i) A timelike curve is characterized by dij dX i .t/ dX j .t/ < 0: dt dt (2.16ii) Moreover, a (nondegenerate) null curve satisfies dij dX i .t/ dX j .t/ D 0: dt dt (2.16iii) Qualitative pictures, together with an upper null cone, are exhibited in Fig. 2.4. Note that the slope of timelike curves is everywhere steeper than that of the null cone, the slope of null curves is coincident with the slope of the null cone, and the slope of spacelike curves is shallower than the null cone. From relativistic physics, it is known that (1) an (idealized) massive point particle travels along a timelike curve; (2) a massless point particle (like a photon) traverses along a null curve; (3) and moreover, hypothetical superluminal particles called tachyons possess trajectories which are represented by spacelike curves. Now, we shall introduce the arc separation along a timelike curve. (See (1.193).) It is furnished by Zt r dX i .u/ dX j .u/ s D S.t/ WD du: (2.17) dij du du a 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 112 x4 ΓT N0+ ΓS ΓN a t b x1 x2 x3 Fig. 2.4 Images S ; T , and N of a spacelike, timelike, and a null curve The above arc separation s (sometimes popularly denoted by also) is called the proper time along the timelike curve. It is assumed1 to provide the actual time separation between the events X .a/ and X .t/ as an idealized, standard point clock traverses along the timelike curve X (or, the world line). The arc separation along a null curve is exactly zero. An inertial observer in special relativity theory traverses a timelike, straight line satisfying d2 X i .t/ D 0: (2.18) dt 2 The above equation is that of a geodesic in flat space–time with a Minkowskian coordinate chart. (Compare with (1.183).) An inertial observer is an idealized, massive point being carrying a (point) standard clock and four orthogonal directions inherent in a tetrad. He or she is also capable of sending photons outward and to receive them at later times after reflections from other specular point objects travelling on timelike world lines. In this process, the observer can assign operational Minkowskian coordinates to the events around him/her. Such a method of measurements is called Minkowskian chronometry. (Consult the book by Synge [242].) A non-inertial, idealized observer 2 i .t / follows a timelike world line with d X ¤ 0. dt 2 Remark: It should be mentioned that the world line of an inertial (or else noninertial) observer violates the uncertainty principle of quantum mechanics, which prohibits the simultaneous existence of exact position and velocity. (The arguments here are for classical idealized objects where quantum corrections are negligible for these purposes.) 1 There are strong physical arguments for this assumption which are beyond the scope of this brief review of special relativity. The interested reader is referred to [55]. 2.1 Review of the Special Theory of Relativity 113 Now, we shall study the equations of motion of a massive particle of constant mass. In prerelativistic physics, Newton’s equations of motion are furnished by m d2 X ˛ .t/ dV ˛ .t/ dX ˛ .t/ D f ˛ .x; t; v/jx ˛ DX ˛ .t / ; V ˛ .t/ D : DW m 2 dt dt dt (2.19i) Here, m > 0 is the mass parameter and t is the (absolute) time. Moreover, x D .x 1 ; x 2 ; x 3 / are Cartesian coordinates; V ˛ .t/ and f ˛ .x; t; v/j:: are the Cartesian components of instantaneous velocity and the net external force vector, respectively. One consequence of (2.19i) is that d d .m=2/ı˛ˇ V ˛ .t/V ˇ .t/ D k C .m=2/ı˛ˇ V ˛ .t/V ˇ .t/ dt dt D ı˛ˇ V ˛ .t/ f ˇ ./j:: : (2.19ii) The above equation can be physically interpreted as “the rate of increase of the kinetic energy plus an undetermined energy constant k is equal to the rate of work performed by the external force.” In special relativity, using a Minkowskian chart, we represent the motion curve by x ˛ D X #˛ .s/; t x 4 D X #4 .s/: (2.20) Here, s 2 Œ0; s1 and X #k are C 2 -functions. Furthermore, we have chosen s to be the arc separation parameter or proper time. (See (1.193).) It is also assumed that the motion curve is timelike and future pointing, that is, dkl dX #k .s/ dX #l .s/ 1; ds ds dX #4 .s/ > 0; ds dkl (2.21i) (2.21ii) dX #k .s/ d2 X #l .s/ 0: ds ds 2 (2.21iii) We denote the four-velocity components by ui D U i .s/ WD dX #i .s/ ; ds (2.22i) dij ui uj D 1; (2.22ii) ju4 j 1: (2.22iii) In the four-dimensional space of four-velocity components, the quadratic constraint (2.22ii) yields a three-dimensional hyperhyperboloid of two disconnected subsets. (See Fig. 2.5.) 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 114 u4 (0, 0, 0, 1) u3 (0, 0, 0, −1) u2 u1 4 Fig. 2.5 The three-dimensional hyperhyperboloid representing the 4-velocity constraint To compare relativistic velocity components with nonrelativistic velocity components, we need to reparametrize the motion curve by (2.17). Thus, we obtain x ˛ D X #˛ .S.t// D X ˛ .t/; x 4 D X #4 .s/ D X 4 .t/ D t; dX ˛ .t/ ; dt q E k WD C ı V .t/V .t/ : k V.t/ V ˛ .t/ WD (2.23) (Note that V ˛ .t/ are not spatial components of a relativistic 4-vector.) Using (1.24), (2.17), (2.22i), and (2.23), we derive that dS.t/ 1 dX ˛ .t/ V ˛ .t/ dX #˛ .s/ U .s/ D D Dq ; ds dt dt E 1 k V.t/ k2 dS.t/ 1 dX 4 .t/ 1 dX #4 .s/ 4 D Dq U .s/ D : ds dt dt E 1 k V.t/ k2 ˛ (2.24) 2.1 Review of the Special Theory of Relativity 115 E The above equations are mathematically valid only for k V.t/ k< 1. Or, in other words, the nonrelativistic speed of a massive material particle must be strictly less than the speed of light. Now, we shall generalize Newton’s equations of motion (2.19i, ii) to the appropriate relativistic equations. For a particle with constant mass m > 0, we assume that the relativistic equations are furnished by: m d2 X #i .s/ D F i .x; u/ˇˇ dX # .s/ : xDX # .s/; uD ds ds 2 (2.25) Here, the 4-force vector components F i ./ are continuous functions of eight variables. (See [55] and [243].) Note that from (2.21iii), we obtain dij dX #i .s/ j F ./j:: 0; ds dX #˛ .s/ ˇ dX #4 .s/ 4 F ./j:: D ı˛ˇ F ./j:: : ds ds (2.26) Thus, by Theorems 2.1.2 and 2.1.4, a nonzero 4-force vector must be spacelike. Relativistic equations (2.25) yield, using (2.23) and (2.24), the equations 2 3 q ˛ V .t/ d 6 7 E k2 F ˛ ./jxDX .t /; (2.27i) m 4q 5 D 1 k V.t/ dt E 1 k V.t/ k2 3 2 q m d 6 7 E D q 1 k V.t/ k2 F 4 ./j:: : (2.27ii) 5 4 dt 2 E 1 k V.t/ k E k 1 regime, the equations in (2.27i) reduce to Newton’s In the low speed k V.t/ equations of motion (2.19i), provided we equate q ˛ E k2 F ˛ ./j:: : f ./j:: D 1 k V.t/ (2.28) From (2.28) and (2.26), we derive that q E 1 k V.t/ k2 F 4 ./j:: D ı˛ˇ V ˛ .t/f ˇ ./j:: : (2.29) Substituting (2.29) into (2.27ii), we deduce that 2 d 6 4q dt 3 i d h 7 E k4 m C .m=2/ı˛ˇ V ˛ .t/V ˇ .t/ C 0 k V.t/ 5D dt E 1 k V.t/ k2 m D ı˛ˇ V ˛ .t/f ˇ ./j:: : (2.30) 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 116 Comparing (2.30) with (2.19ii), we are prompted to express the energy of the particle as m E k vE k WD p ; (2.31i) 1 k vE k2 lim E k vE k D E.0C / D m: (2.31ii) kEvk!0C Explicitly reinstating (temporarily) the speed of light c, (2.31ii) reveals the rest energy as E.0C / D mc 2 . (This is arguably the most celebrated equation in modern #4 science! [87].) Since energy E./ was derived from the expression m dXds .s/ , it is logical to define the (kinetic) 4-momentum of a massive particle as p i D P i .s/ WD m dX #i .s/ ; ds pi D Pi .s/ D dij P j .s/; p˛ D p ˛ ; p4 D p 4 : (2.32) The constraint (2.22ii) yields a similar constraint on 4-momentum components in (2.32), and it is furnished by dij p i p j D d ij pi pj D .m/2 : (2.33) The above yields a three-dimensional hyperhyperboloid in the four-dimensional momentum space. (Compare with the corresponding Fig. 2.5.) This hypersurface is known as the mass shell in relativistic physics. Example 2.1.8. Let us investigate the timelike motion of a constant mass particle under a nonzero, constant-valued 4-force vector. By (2.25), we write m d2 X #i .s/ D K i D const.; ds 2 (2.34i) Ki d2 X #i .s/ DW C i D const. D ds 2 m (2.34ii) By the Theorems 2.1.2 and 2.1.4, we conclude that dij C i C j > 0: (2.35) Solving differential equations (2.34ii) under the initial values X #i .0/ D x0i , dX #i .s/ D ui0 , we obtain the solution as ds jsD0 X #i .s/ D x0i C ui0 s C .1=2/C i .s/2 : (2.36) 2.1 Review of the Special Theory of Relativity 117 Using the identity (2.21i), we deduce from (2.36) that 0 dX #i .s/ d2 X #j .s/ d dij D dij C i C j : ds ds ds 2 (2.37) Equation (2.37) yielding dij C i C j D 0 obviously violates the strict inequality (2.35). Therefore, we conclude that such a particle motion with constant 4-acceleration is impossible.2 Now, we shall investigate the motions of particles inside an extended body. It is the theme of the usual nonrelativistic continuum mechanics. The scope of this branch of applied mathematics encompasses fluids, elastic materials, visco-elastic materials, plasmas, and so on. (Usually, the relativistic effects, which are dominant at high velocities, are neglected in these disciplines.) Let us consider a nonrelativistic fluid motion in Euler’s approach. There is a three-velocity field V ˛ .x; t/ which is a measure of the instantaneous fluid velocity of a particle at the spatial point x D .x 1 ; x 2 ; x 3 / and time t. The nonlinear equations of motion of streamlines are governed by @V ˛ ./ C V ˇ .x; t/ @ˇ V ˛ ./ D Œ .x; t/1 @ˇ ˛ˇ C @t ˛ (ext) .x; t/: (2.38) Here, .x; t/ > 0 is the mass density, ˇ˛ .x; t/ ˛ˇ .x; t/ is the stress density, and ˛ .x; t/ is the force density due to external influences. (See [244].) The streamlines (ext) are furnished by solutions or integral curves of the differential equations dX ˛ .t/ D V ˛ .x; t/j:: ; dt (2.39) where V ˛ .x; t/ satisfy (2.38). (Compare with (1.75).) Restricting the vector field equations (2.38) on a streamline x ˛ D X ˛ .t/, we obtain d ˛ ˛ ŒV ./j:: D @ˇ ˛ˇ C (ext) (2.40) ./ j:: : .x; t/j:: dt It is obvious that Newton’s equations of motion (2.19i) have motivated (2.40). In the absence of an external force, (2.38) reduce to ./ @V ˛ ./ C V ˇ ./ @ˇ V ˛ ./ @ˇ ˛ˇ D 0: @t (2.41) Now, in the relativistic theory, we need to visualize a (bounded) compact fluid body as a world tube in space–time. (See the Fig. 2.6.) 2 Often, the term “constant acceleration” in the relativity literature refers to the condition dU i .s/ dU j .s/ dU i .s/ d2 X #i .s/ D const., which may be satisfied with nonconstant ds D ds 2 . dij ds ds 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 118 x4 χ# U x s x3 x1 4 x2 Fig. 2.6 A world tube and a curve representing a fluid streamline E The timelike, future-pointing 4-velocity vector field U.x/ satisfies Ui .x/U i .x/ D dij U i .x/U j .x/ 1; U 4 .x/ 1: (2.42) A fluid streamline or curve of class C 2 is characterized by integral curves of the differential equations dX #i .s/ D U i .x/jxDX # .s/ : (2.43) ds (Compare with (2.39).) The appropriate relativistic generalizations of the equations of motion in (2.41) are furnished by .x/ U j .x/ @j U i ı ik C U i .x/Uk .x/ @j s kj D 0: (2.44) Here, .x/ > 0 is the proper energy density (including mass energy density). Moreover, U i .x/ are components of the 4-velocity field of streamlines, and s j i .x/ s ij .x/ are components of the relativistic symmetric stress tensor field of differentiability class C 1 . Now, we are in a position to define the relativistic, symmetric energy– momentum–stress tensor field by 2.1 Review of the Special Theory of Relativity 119 @ @ T .x/ WD T ij .x/ i ˝ j ; @x @x T ij .x/ WD .x/U i .x/U j .x/ s ij .x/ T j i .x/: (2.45) Remarks: (i) Some authors call the above tensor the stress–momentum–energy tensor, or stress–energy tensor, or simply the stress tensor. (ii) In relativistic quantum field theory, T ij .x/ sometimes represents components of the canonical energy–momentum–stress tensor for which T j i .x/ 6 T ij .x/. In this text, we will not be utilizing the canonical variant of this tensor. Note that T ij .x/ in (2.45) possesses ten linearly independent components. Now, we shall state and prove a theorem about the energy–momentum–stress tensor field. Theorem 2.1.9. Let a symmetric energy–momentum–stress tensor field T .x/ be defined by (2.45) in D R4 representing a fluid world tube. Furthermore, let the tensor field components T ij .x/ be of differentiability class C 1 . Then, the four partial differential equations @j T ij D 0 (2.46) imply the relativistic equations of streamline motion in (2.44). Moreover, (2.46) implies one additional differential equation @j U j C Ui .x/ @j s ij D 0: (2.47) Proof. By (2.45) and (2.46), we obtain @j U i U j s ij D .x/ U j .x/ @j U i C U i .x/ @j U j @j s ij D 0: (2.48) Multiplying the above by Ui .x/ and contracting, we derive that .1=2/ U j @j Ui U i C Ui U i @j U j Ui @j s ij D 0: Now, substituting Ui .x/U i .x/ 1 from (2.42) into the preceding equation, we deduce (2.47). Putting (2.47) into (2.48), we derive the equations of motion for the streamlines in (2.44). Remark: The equation @j T ij D 0 in (2.46) is called the differential conservation of energy–momentum. Now, we shall try to understand physically the energy–momentum–stress tensor in (2.45). Suppose that an idealized inertial observer passes through the fluid and intersects a streamline at the event x in Fig. 2.6. Assume that this test observer does ˚ 4 not disturb any of the streamlines. He carries an orthonormal basis Ee.a/ .x/ 1 or a tetrad. Imagine that this observer manages to measure numbers associated with 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 120 x4 n t2 ∂2D n ∂3D t1 n ∂1D x3 x1 4 x2 Fig. 2.7 A doubly sliced world tube of an extended body the orthonormal components (or physical components) T .a/.b/ .x/ of the energy– momentum–stress tensor T .x/. In such a scenario, physical interpretations can be 2 furnished. T .4/.4/ .x/ is the sum of the material energy density .x/ U 4 .x/ and .4/.4/ .˛/.4/ the internal energy density s .x/. T .x/ are the sums of kinetic momentum density .x/U ˛ .x/U 4 .x/ and internal momentum density s .˛/.4/ .x/. (T .˛/.4/ .x/ is often called the energy flux or energy flux vector, although it is not truly a vector.) Finally, T .˛/.ˇ/ .x/ are sums of material stress components .x/U ˛ .x/U ˇ .x/ and the negative of the usual internal stress components s .˛/.ˇ/ .x/. A thorough discussion of the physical interpretation of the energy–momentum–stress tensor may be found in [230, 243]. Now, we are in a position to investigate the integral conservation or total conservation of energy–momentum of a fluid or other extended bodies. We provide another figure of a material world tube with two “horizontal caps” in Fig. 2.7. Now, we shall state and prove the integral conservation laws. (See Fig. 2.7.) Theorem 2.1.10. Let T .x/ 6 0 .x/ and be of class C 1 inside a material world tube. Furthermore, let T .x/ 0 .x/ outside the world tube. Let x 4 D t 1 and x 4 D t2 yield three-dimensional cross sections of the world tube denoted by @1 D and @2 D, respectively. Moreover, let @3 D be the three-dimensional boundary “wall” around the domain D of the tube. Furthermore, let boundary conditions T ij .x/nj .x/j@3 D D 0, where ni denotes components of unit outer 2.1 Review of the Special Theory of Relativity 121 normal, be satisfied. Let the overall boundary @D WD @1 D [ @2 D [ @3 D be non-null, continuous, piecewise differentiable, and orientable. Then, the differential conservation equations (2.46) imply the integral conservation equations Z P i WD T 4i .x 1 ; x 2 ; x 3 ; t1 / dx 1 dx 2 dx 3 @1 D Z D T 4i .x 1 ; x 2 ; x 3 ; t2 / dx 1 dx 2 dx 3 @2 D Z D T 4i .x 1 ; x 2 ; x 3 ; t/ dx 1 dx 2 dx 3 @D.t / D const. (2.49) Proof. Applying Gauss’ Theorem 1.3.27 and differential conservation equations (2.46), we obtain Z 0D @j T ij dx 1 dx 2 dx 3 dx 4 D Z Z D Z T nj dx dx dx C ij 1 2 3 @1 D T ij nj dx dx dx C 1 2 3 @2 D Z Z T i 4 dx 1 dx 2 dx 3 C D @1 D T ij nj d3 v @3 D T i 4 dx 1 dx 2 dx 3 C 0: @2 D Thus, (2.49) is validated. i The constant-valued components P represent the conserved total 4-momentum of the extended body. We can define the relativistic total angular momentum of an extended body relative to the event x0 , by the following equations: Z J i k WD .x i x0i / T k4 .x 1 ; x 2 ; x 3 ; t/ @D.t / .x k x0k / T i 4 .x 1 ; x 2 ; x 3 ; t/ dx 1 dx 2 dx 3 ; J ki D J i k D const. (2.50) The proof for the constancies of J i k will be left as Problem #7 in Exercise 2.1. 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 122 Example 2.1.11. Consider the case of the incoherent dust (pressureless fluid) which happens to be one of the simplest of all materials. The definition is summarized in the energy–momentum–stress tensor T ij .x/ WD .x/U i .x/U j .x/: (2.51) Equation (2.47) yields Uj D 0 @j (2.52) and is known as the relativistic continuity equation for the dust. The equations for streamline motion (2.44) reduce to .x/ U j .x/@j U i D 0; or, U j .x/@j U i jxDX # .s/ D d2 X #i .s/ D 0: ds 2 (2.53) Therefore, it is evident that the dust particles, in the absence of external forces, move along timelike straight lines (or geodesics) in the flat space–time. (It is an expected result, as the absence of pressure and shears implies that adjacent elements of the dust cannot exert any forces on each other.) The special theory of relativity emerged from investigations of the speed of light, which is also the speed of electromagnetic wave propagation. Therefore, the electromagnetic field equations are of particular interest in special relativity theory. The classical electromagnetic field is governed by Maxwell’s equations.3 As three-dimensional vector field equations, they are (in the absence of sources): E E t/ D @E.x; t/ ; r H.x; @t E r E./ D 0; (2.54ii) E r H./ D 0; (2.54iii) E r E./ D E @H./ : @t (2.54i) (2.54iv) Here, t is the time variable, x D .x 1 ; x 2 ; x 3 / represents Cartesian coordinates, and r E E is the (spatial) gradient operator. Moreover, E./ and H./ are electric and magnetic fields, respectively. The above equations can be cast neatly into Minkowskian tensor 3 We are using Lorentz–Heaviside units. Especially, we have set c, the speed of light, to be unity to be consistent with units used throughout most of the book. 2.1 Review of the Special Theory of Relativity 123 field equations. To achieve this, we have to identify the electric and magnetic threevectors with an antisymmetric, second-order Minkowskian tensor as shown below: 2 Fij .x/ 44 0 H3 .x/ H2 .x/ E1 .x/ 3 7 6 6H3 .x/ 0 H1 .x/ E2 .x/7 7 6 WD 6 7 7 6 H2 .x/ H1 .x/ 0 E .x/ 3 5 4 E1 .x/ E2 .x/ E3 .x/ 0 Fj i .x/ : (2.55) Maxwell’s equations (2.54i–iv) are (exactly) equivalent to the four-dimensional tensor field equations: @j F ij D 0; and @k Fij C @i Fj k C @j Fki D 0: (2.56i) (2.56ii) Thus, Maxwell’s equations (2.54i–iv), which were discovered approximately 40 years before the advent of the special theory of relativity, were already relativistic! Example 2.1.12. We assume here the tensor field F:: .x/ is of class C 2 . Differentiating the mixed tensor form of (2.56ii), we obtain 0 D @i @k F ij C d i l @i @l Fj k @i @j F ik h i D @k @i F ij C Fj k @j @i F ik D 0 C Fj k 0 2 @ @2 @2 @2 D Fj k .x/: C C .@x 1 /2 .@x 2 /2 .@x 3 /2 .@x 4 /2 Note that these equations are wave equations with a speed of unity. Therefore, the above equations show that electromagnetic wave fields travel with the speed of light. The wave operator remains invariant under Poincaré transformations (2.6i), particularly under the Lorentz transformation (2.7). Therefore, the speed of light (or a photon) remains unchanged for a moving inertial observer. Equations (2.56i,ii) can be expressed succinctly in terms of differential 2-forms as introduced in (1.64). Let us repeat the 2-form here as F:: .x/ D .1=2/Fij .x/ dx i ^ dx j : 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 124 By (1.69), we can express Maxwell’s equations (2.56ii) as d ŒF:: .x/ D 0::: .x/: (2.57) (Glance through (1.70) for the electromagnetic 4-potential Ai .x/ dx i and for gauge transformations.) We repeat the Hodge-star operation in (1.113). (See also Example 1.3.6.) Thus, we express F:: .x/ D .1=2/ h ij kl i Fij .x/ dx k ^ dx l : (2.58) Therefore, Maxwell’s equations (2.56i), by the use of Example 1.3.6, reduce to d Œ F:: .x/ D 0::: : (2.59) In the presence of electrically charged matter, the Maxwell–Lorentz equations (using Lorentz–Heaviside units) are @k F i k D J i .x/; (2.60i) @k Fij C @i Fj k C @j Fki D 0; (2.60ii) @i J i D @i @k F i k 0: (2.60iii) In physical terms, J 4 .x/ and J ˛ .x/ represent the electrical charge density and current density, respectively. We introduce the Hodge-star operation (1.113) on the 4-charge-current vector J i .x/ to express J::: .x/ D h l ij k i Jl .x/ dx i ^ dx j ^ dx k : (2.61) Therefore, the electromagnetic equations (2.60i–iii) reduce to d Œ F:: .x/ D J::: .x/; d ŒF:: .x/ D 0::: .x/; d Œ J::: .x/ D d2 Œ F:: .x/ 0:::: .x/: (2.62i) (2.62ii) (2.62iii) (The Poincaré lemma in (1.66) is evident for (2.62iii).) Now, we shall introduce the electromagnetic energy–momentum–stress tensor as the following: j (em) T ij .x/ WD F i k .x/F k .x/ .1=4/d ij Fkl .x/F kl .x/ (em) T j i .x/: (2.63) 2.1 Review of the Special Theory of Relativity 125 Example 2.1.13. It will be instructive to work out the divergence @j (em)T ij , which represents the force density experienced by the charged material due to the electromagnetic field. By (2.63), (2.60i), and (2.60ii), we derive that h i j j j @j (em) T ij D F i k .x/@j F k C .1=2/ @j F i k F k .x/ C @j F i k F k .x/ .1=2/ d ij @j Fkl F kl .x/ j D F i k .x/@j Fk C .1=2/ d i l F j k .x/ @j Flk C @k Fj l C @l Fkj D F i k .x/Jk .x/ C 0: Now, we shall explore properties of a charged dust with assumptions J i .x/ WD .x/U i .x/; (2.64i) T ij .x/ D .x/U i .x/U j .x/ C (em) T ij .x/: (2.64ii) Here, .x/ is the (proper) electrical charge density and the 4-velocity field components U i .x/ satisfy (2.42). A pertinent consequence for a charged dust model will be furnished now. Theorem 2.1.14. Let the functions .x/, .x/, and U i .x/ be of class C 1 and Fij .x/ be of class C 2 in a domain D R4 . Then, the differential conservation equations, @j T ij D 0, imply the equations: .x/U j .x/@j U i D .x/F i k .x/Uk .x/: (2.65) Proof. Using (2.64ii), (2.60i,ii), (2.42), and Example 2.1.13, we obtain that 0 D @j T ij D @j U i U j C @j D .x/U j .x/@j U i C U i .x/@j (em) T ij U j .x/F i k .x/Uk .x/: Multiplying the above by Ui .x/ and using Ui .x/U i .x/ 1, F i k .x/Ui .x/Uk .x/ 0, we deduce the continuity equation @j U j D 0: Therefore, (2.65) follows. Restricting on a charged stream line, we derive the equations of motion as # d2 X #i .s/ dX #k .s/ : X .s/ D X # .s/ F ik .x/ j:: 2 ds ds (2.66) 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 126 For comparison, we cite here that the relativistic Lorentz equations of motion of a charged particle of mass m and charge e are known to be m d2 X #i .s/ dX #k .s/ i : D e F .x/ k j :: ds 2 ds (2.67) The similarity between (2.66) and (2.67) is unmistakable. Example 2.1.15. The three spatial components of the equations of motion (2.67) yield, by (2.24): 2 3 m d 6 V ˛ .t/ 7 ˛ˇ 4q 5 D eı Fˇ .x; t/jX ˛ .t / V .t/ C Fˇ4 ./j:: : dt E 1 k V.t/ k2 Using (2.54i–iv) and the antisymmetric permutation symbol in (1.54), the preceding equations imply that 3 2 m d 6 V ˛ .t/ 7 ˛ ˛ˇ 5 D e E .x; t/j:: C ı "ˇ V .t/H ./j:: : 4q dt 2 E 1 k V.t/ k (2.68) Similarly, the fourth equation in (2.67) yields 3 2 m d 6 4q dt 1 E 1 k V.t/ k2 7 ˛ ˇ 5 D eı˛ˇ V .t/E ./j:: : (2.69) The right-hand side of the above equation represents the rate of work done by the external electric field. The rate of work done by the magnetic field is exactly zero. We shall now summarize the main theoretical accomplishments of the special theory of relativity in the following: 1. The special theory of relativity explains the puzzle about the speed of light arising out of the Michelson-Morley experiments [181], which indicated that the speed of light is invariant. As a consequence, it is established that the maximal speed of propagation of physical actions is the speed of light. 2. There is an equivalence of all inertial observers or frames in regards to the formulation of natural laws. 3. Length contraction of a moving rod and time dilation of a moving clock are predicted (see [55, 89, 230]). 4. The rest mass m > 0 of a body possesses potential energy E D mc 2 . This enormously potent equation was first discovered by Einstein [87]. In Table 2.1, we elaborate on some aesthetic aspects of the special theory of relativity in regards to the unification of distinct physical entities occurring in the nonrelativistic regime. 2.1 Review of the Special Theory of Relativity 127 Table 2.1 Correspondence between relativistic and non-relativistic physical quantities Physical entities in nonrelativistic physics Corresponding unification in special relativity Absolute space E 3 and absolute time R Flat space–time manifold M4 3-momentum p˛ and energy E 4-momentum pi with pi p i D m2 4-wave numbers ki with ki k i D 0 For electromagnetic wave, 3-wave numbers k˛ and the frequency E and magnetic field vector Electric field vector E Second-order, antisymmetric electromagnetic E field tensor Fij H For a fluid or a deformable body: energy density Symmetric energy–momentum–stress tensor , momentum density V ˛ , and symmetric T ij WD U i U j s ij ˛ˇ stress tensor So far, we have used only pseudo-Cartesian or Minkowskian coordinate charts for the flat space–time manifold M4 . Sometimes, more general coordinate charts are necessary. For example, to derive the energy levels of a hydrogen atom, the relativistic Dirac equation is investigated in the spherical polar coordinates for spatial dimensions. Let us go back to the equations pertaining to a general coordinate chart in (1.1) and Figs. 1.1 and 1.2. We shall apply such mappings to the flat space– b ! R4 and b b ! M4 . If time manifold M4 . Consider the mappings b W U 1 W D ˚ 1 b .2/ WD b b we restrict the mapping b to the two-dimensional domain D x 2 D R4 W b x1 D b x 2 D 0 , then the corresponding restricted mapping b 1 can be D2 jb qualitatively exhibited as in Fig. 2.8. By (1.1) and (1.37), we conclude that k x / @X l .b x/ @X .b 0 b x i ˝ db g:: .b x/ D dkl db xj ; 2 X Œg:: .x/ D b @b xi @x j k x/ i .a/ @X .b b eQ .a/ .b x/ D ı k db x; @b xi ˚1 i (2.70i) (2.70ii) 6 0; (2.70iii) b.a/.b/.c/ .b x / 6 0: (2.70iv) jk Equations (1.163), (1.161), and (2.70i–iv) imply that b R::: .b x/ b 0::: .b x /: (2.71) b R4 indicates the flatness The vanishing of the curvature tensor in the domain D b M4 in the curvilinear coordinate chart b b (in spite of of the domain U ; U ˚1 i jk 6 0 and b.a/.b/.c/.b x / 6 0). 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 128 U(2) M4 ^ χ −1 .. x4 D(2) x3 2 Fig. 2.8 Mapping of a rectangular coordinate grid into a curvilinear grid in the space–time manifold Example 2.1.16. Consider the flat Minkowskian chart .; M4 / given by space–time manifold and a global x x 1 ; x 2 ; x 3 ; x 4 D .p/ 2 D D R4 : Consider the coordinate transformation to spherical polar and time coordinates which is furnished by p b 1 .x/ WD C .x 1 /2 C .x 2 /2 C .x 3 /2 r; b x1 D X i h ıp b 2 .x/ WD Arccos x 3 .x 1 /2 C .x 2 /2 C .x 3 /2 ; b x2 D X b 3 .x/ WD arc.x 1 ; x 2 / '; b x3 D X b x 4 D x 4 t; ˚ bs D D b WD b D x 2 R4 W b x 1 > 0; 0 < b x 2 < ; < b x 3 < ; 1 < b x4 < 1 : (See Problem # 1 in Exercise 1.1.) It can be noted that the above chart is not global. 2.1 Review of the Special Theory of Relativity 129 t−r=const. x2 L+ v u=const. L+ X Ds x x x1 r t+r=const. x1 v=const. L− u 2 L− OO and L OO O C and L O into half lines L Fig. 2.9 A coordinate transformation mapping half lines L C The metric tensor in (2.70i) reduces to the orthogonal form b0 Œg:: .x/ D b g:: .b x / D db x 1 ˝ db x 1 C .b x 1 /2 db x 2 ˝ db x 2 C .b x 1 sinb x 2 /2 db x 3 ˝ db x3 2X db x 4 ˝ db x4; x 2 /2 C .sin b x 4 /2 x 1 /2 C .b x 1 /2 .db x 2 /2 .db x 3 /2 .db ds 2 D .db dr 2 C r 2 .d/2 C sin2 .d' 2 / dt 2 : (See (1.195).) Example 2.1.17. Let us make another coordinate transformation from the preceding chart in Example 2.1.16. Let it be furnished by equations b b x1 D b x4 b x 1 u; b b x2 D b x4 C b x 1 v; b b x3 D b x 2 ; b b x4 D b x 3 '; n o b b s WD b b x 2 < 1; 0 < b b x2 b b x1 ; 0 < b b x 3 < ; < b b x4 < : D b x 2 R4 W 1 < b See Fig. 2.9 depicting the transformation (suppressing angular coordinates). 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 130 The oriented half lines b LC and b L represent possible trajectories of outgoing and incoming photons for an observer pursuing the b x 4 -coordinate line, respectively. Since the null lines (or photon paths) are expressed by u D const. and v D const., these pair of coordinates are called double-null coordinates, as u and v coordinate lines are coincident with the paths of null (light) rays. The metric in the preceding Example 2.1.17 is transformed into i2 h b b0 b b g:: .b x/ D b g:: b b x D db b x 1 ˝ db b x 2 C .1=4/ b b x1 b x2 b i h 2 4 db b x 3 ˝ db b x 3 C sin b b x 3 db b x ˝ db b x4 ; 2X ds 2 D du dv C .1=4/.v u/2 d 2 C sin2 d' 2 : Consider a three-dimensional null hypersurface specified by n o b x 2 R4 W b b x 2 D k; 0 < k b b x 1 < 1; 0 < b b x 3 < ; < b b x4 < : N3 WD b The induced metric on N3 , by (1.224), is furnished as i 2 h 3 2 4 b b b x ˝ db g:: .b x /jN3 D .1=4/ k b b x 1 db b x 3 C sin b b x 3 db b x ˝ db b x4 ; ds 2j:: D .1=4/.k u/2 d 2 C sin2 d' 2 : (Although (1.223) was pursued later for nonnull hypersurfaces, it is still valid for a null hypersurface.) The preceding equation yields a two-dimensional metric for a three-dimensional hypersurface N3 ! There is a loss of one dimension because a null coordinate line has a zero separation. A tensor field equation r s T.x/ D rs 0.x/; x 2 D.e/ R4 in a Minkowskian chart implies that rb x/ s T.b b R4 b .e/ D D rsb 0.b x /; b x2D (2.72) in a general coordinate chart and vice-versa. Under a successive general transformation, (2.72) yields an equivalent tensor field equation b r b b b b b b bs D b R4 : b .e/ D b x D sb 0 b x ; b x2D rb b sT (2.73) The equivalence of tensor field equations (2.72) and (2.73) is called the general covariance of the tensor field equations. The special theory of relativity therefore, 2.1 Review of the Special Theory of Relativity 131 by demanding that physically relevant formulae be expressible as tensor equations, is covariant under the group of general coordinate transformations. This reflects the fact that physical effects must be independent of the coordinate system with which they are measured. Let us cast some of the tensor field equations in a general coordinate chart characterized by (2.70i,ii). The metric in (2.70i) and the orthonormal 1-forms in (2.70ii) will yield Christoffel symbols and Ricci rotation coefficients which are not necessarily zero. We can define covariant derivatives from the definitions in (1.124i), (1.124ii), (1.134), and (1.139ii). It is useful to transform some of the special relativistic equations we have studied into general coordinate systems. Equation (2.42) implies that b .a/ .b b i .b b j .b b .b/ .b b gij .b x/ U x/ U x / D d.a/.b/ U x/ U x/ 1: (2.74) The equations of motion for stream lines in (2.44) go over into h i h i bj U bj b b j .b b i ı ik C U b i .b b k .b b .b x/ U x /r x/ U x/ r s kj D 0: (2.75) The energy–momentum–stress tensor in (2.45) and the differential conservation equation (2.46) transform into b i .b b j .b bij .b x / D b .b x/ U x/ U x / b s ij .b x/ b T j i .b x /; T (2.76i) b.a/.b/ .b b .a/ .b b .b/ .b b.a/.b/ .b T x / D b .b x/ U x/ U x / b s .a/.b/ .b x/ T x /; (2.76ii) bj b T ij D 0; r (2.76iii) b.b/ T b.b/.a/ D 0: r (2.76iv) Finally, the Maxwell–Lorentz (electromagnetic) field equations (2.60i–iii) transform into i ıp @ h p bk F bi k D 1 bi k D b J i .b jb gj jb gj F x /; r k @b x b b ij C b bj k C b b ki D 0; @i F @j F @k F (2.77ii) bi b r J i D 0; (2.77iii) (2.77i) b.c/ F b .a/.c/ D b J .a/ .b x /; r (2.78i) b.a/ F b.b/ F b.c/ F b .a/.b/ C r b .b/.c/ C r b .c/.a/ D 0; r (2.78ii) b.a/b J .a/ D 0: r (2.78iii) 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 132 Remarks: (i) Equations (2.75), (2.76i–iv), (2.77i–iii), and (2.78i–iii) all possess “general covariance” under the set of general coordinate transformations. (ii) Special relativistic equations, expressed as tensor equations in general coordinates, are already “general relativistic”! In the sequel, the space–time continuum will be treated as a curved manifold, so that b R::: .b x / 6 b 0::: .b x /. Fortunately, (2.75), (2.76i–iv), (2.77i–iii), (2.78i–iii), and others, pass over smoothly into the arena of curved space–time. Exercises 2.1 1. Determine whether or not any of the subset of vectors among WS .x0 /, WT .x0 /, or WN .x0 / defined in (2.2i–iii) is a vector subspace. b 2. Let Etx0 and Etx0 be two future-pointing timelike vectors. Prove the reversed Schwarz inequality b Etx0 Etx0 ˇ ˇ b ˇˇg:: .x0 / Etx0 ; Etx0 ˇ ˇ ˇ: ˇ 3. Define a 4 4 Lorentz matrix by ŒL WD Œl ij , where entries l ij satisfy (2.66). (i) Prove that (2.66) can be expressed as the matrix equation ŒLT ŒD ŒL D ŒD: .Here, ŒD WD Œdij .) (ii) Deduce that det ŒL D ˙1. (iii) Prove that under the composition rule as the matrix multiplication, the set of all .4 4/ Lorentz matrices constitutes a group. Remark: This group, which is called the Lorentz group, is denoted by O.3; 1I R/.) 4. Consider a special relativistic tensor wave equation l1 ;:::;ls WD d ij @i @j l1 ;:::;ls D 0: Let 2 .4/s functions f.l1 ;:::;ls / ; g.l1 ;:::;ls / 2 C 2 .D.e/ R4 I R/. These functions are otherwise arbitrary. Prove that l1 ;:::;ls .x/ where .k/ WD WD f.l1 ;:::;ls / k1 x 1 C k2 x 2 C k3 x 3 .k/ C g.l1 ;:::;ls / k1 x 1 C k2 x 2 C k3 x 3 C .k/ ; p ı ˛ˇ k˛ kˇ , solves the wave equation. 2.1 Review of the Special Theory of Relativity 133 5. Consider the upper branch of the three-dimensional hyperhyperbola Fig. 2.5. A parametric representation is furnished by P 3 in u1 D 1 w1 ; w2 ; w3 WD sinh w1 sin w2 cos w3 ; u2 D 2 w1 ; w2 ; w3 WD sinh w1 sin w2 sin w3 ; u3 D 3 w1 ; w2 ; w3 WD sinh w1 cos w2 ; u4 D cosh w1 ; ˚ D3 WD w1 ; w2 ; w3 2 R3 W 1 < w1 < 1; 0 < w2 < ; < w3 < : P Prove that the hypersurface 3 is a three-dimensional space of constant curvature. 6. Suppose that a particle with possibly variable mass (like a radioactive particle or exhaust-emitting rocket) is moving under an external force. The relativistic equations of motion (2.25) are generalized to dX #i .s/ d M.s/ D F i .x; u/ˇˇ dX # .s/ ; xDX # .s/; uD ds ds ds M.s/ > 0: (i) Using the equations above, prove that M.s/ is constant-valued if and only #j if the orthogonality dij F i ./j:: dXds .s/ 0 holds. q 2 #i 2 #j (ii) Prove that the separation dij d Xds 2 .s/ d Xds 2 .s/ of the 4-acceleration vector d Xds 2 .s/ @x@ i j:: is constant-valued if and only if ŒM.s/1 dij F j ./j:: is constant-valued. 2 #i d2 X #i .s/ ds 2 7. Prove the integral conservation laws for the relativistic total angular momentum given in (2.50). 8. Consider the electrically charged dust model discussed in (2.64i,ii) and Theorem 2.1.14. (i) Assuming the junction conditions U i ni j::: D 0 D U i ni j::: , prove the following integral conservation laws regarding the total mass and the total charge: Z M WD .x; t/ U 4 .x; t/ dx 1 dx 2 dx 3 D const.; D.t / Z .x; t/ U 4 .x; t/ dx 1 dx 2 dx 3 D const. Q WD D.t / 134 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 (ii) Show the existence of two fixed spatial points x.1/ ; x.2/ 2 D.t / such that .x.2/ ; t/ U 4 .x.2/ ; t/ Q D D const. M .x.1/ ; t/ U 4 .x.1/ ; t/ b / for M4 such that 9. Consider a coordinate chart .b ; U 2 4 1 b g:: .b x / D ı˛ˇ dxO ˛ ˝ dxO ˇ b x Cb x2 C b x 3 db x ˝ db x4; ˚ b WD b D x 2 R4 W b x1 C b x2 C b x 3 1; b x4 2 R : b R4 . Prove by explicit computations that b R::: .b x/ b 0::: .b x / for b x2D 10. Consider the spherical polar coordinate chart dealt with in Example 2.1.16. In this chart, check Maxwell’s equation (2.57) for the following two cases: (i) The electromagnetic 2-form field for an electric dipole of strength p.1/ given by sinb x2 2 2 cosb x2 1 4 4 b F:: .b x / D p.1/ db x ^ db x C db x ^ db x .b x 1 /3 .b x 1 /2 (ii) The electromagnetic 2-form field for a vibrating electric dipole with frequency , furnished by ( " 1 i i .b x 1 b x4/ b F:: .b x / D Real part of p.1/ e x2 1 2 db x 1 ^ db x4 2 cos b .b x 1 /3 .b x / C sin b x2 1 i 1 .b x 1 /2 b x sin b x i C b x1 2 2 2 x 2 ^ db x4 db #) x ^ db x db 1 2 : 11. Using a Minkowskian coordinate chart, solve for the Killing vector fields of flat M4 with help of (1.171ii). Answers and Hints to Selected Exercises 1. None of the subsets of WS .x0 /, WT .x0 /, or WN .x0 / is a vector subspace. 3. (ii) Taking determinants of both sides of the matrix equation, it can be shown that ˚ det ŒLT .1/ fdet ŒLg D 1; or fdet ŒLg2 D 1: 2.1 Review of the Special Theory of Relativity 5. The intrinsic metric of the hypersurface 135 P 3 is given by 2 g:: .w/ D dw1 ˝ dw1 C .sinh w1 /2 dw2 ˝ dw2 C .sinh w1 /.sin w2 / dw3 ˝ dw3 ; R˛ˇ ı .w/ D .1/ g ˛ .w/ g ˇı .w/ g ˛ı .w/ g ˇ .w/ : #j 6. (i) Multiplying equations of motion by dij dXds .s/ and contracting, it can be proved that dM.s/ dX #j .s/ d2 X #i .s/ dX #j .s/ i C M.s/ dij : D d F ./ ij j :: ds ds ds 2 ds 0 7. Introduce a .3 C 0/th order tensor field by j T ij k .x/ WD x i x0i T j k .x/ x j x0 T i k .x/: Derive, using T j i .x/ T ij .x/ and @j T ij D 0, that @k T ij k D 0. 8. (ii) Use the mean value theorem of integrals. (See [32].) 9. Often, for such calculations, it is time-saving to use computational symbolic algebra programs as in Appendix 8. 10. (i) 2 sinb x2 2 2 sinb x2 1 1 4 2 4 b d F:: .b x / D p.1/ db x ^ db x ^ db x db x ^ db x ^ db x .b x 1 /3 .b x 1 /3 b 0::: .b x /: 11. Ten Killing vector fields are: E .r/ .x/ WD ı l.r/ @ ; K @x l E .s/.r/.x/; E .r/.s/ .x/ WD d.r/i ı j d.s/i ı j x i @ K K .s/ .r/ @x j r; s 2 f1; 2; 3; 4g: (Remarks: (i) Compare the above with the answers for Problem # 7(ii) in Exercise 1.2. (ii) These Killing vectors are also called generators for the Poincaré group IO.3; 1I R/.) 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 136 2.2 Curved Space–Time and Gravitation In the preceding section on special relativity theory, the set of all inertial observers (observers moving relative to each other with constant three-velocities) forms a privileged class of observers. In Minkowskian coordinate charts, natural laws are expressed by each of the inertial observers with exactly similar (Minkowskian) tensor field equations. Naturally, the next investigations focus on natural laws 2 ˛ expressible by an observer moving with constant three-acceleration (i.e., d Xdt 2 .t / D const:) relative to an inertial observer. Our familiar experiences of objects moving with constant three-accelerations include apples (or other massive objects) falling under Earth’s gravity. (We are neglecting air resistance due to Earth’s atmosphere, and we are assuming the fall is taking place over distances where changes in the strength of the gravitational field can be neglected.) Recall that Newton’s equations of motion in an external gravitational field are provided by m or, d2 X ˛ .t/ @W .x/ Df ˛ .::/j:: DW mı ˛ˇ ; dt 2 @x ˇ jx ˛ DX ˛ .t / (2.79i) d2 X ˛ .t/ D ı ˛ˇ @ˇ Wj:: : dt 2 (2.79ii) (See (2.19i).) In (2.79i, ii), W .x/ represents the Newtonian gravitational potential. From (2.79ii), it is clear that the motion curve in a gravitational field is independent of the mass m > 0 of the particle.4 Very near the Earth’s surface, the potential may be well approximated by W .x/ D gx 3 C const:, where the x 3 -axis is coincident with the vertical direction. (Here, g denotes the constant gravitational acceleration which must not be confused with det gij .) Integrating the equations of motion (2.79ii) in Earth’s gravity yields X 1 .t/ D .i / x 1 C X .t/ D .i / x 2 X 3 .t/ D .i / x 3 2 .i / v 1 t; C .i / v 2 t; C .i / v 3 t 1 g .t/2 : 2 (2.80) Here, .i / x 1 ; .i / x 2 ; .i / x 3 represent the initial position of the particle whereas .i / v1 ; 2 3 .i / v ; .i / v represent the initial three-velocity components. Let a second idealized 4 The equivalency between gravitational mass and inertial mass is assumed. Current experimental limits place the equivalency of these two types of mass to within 1012 [226], and it is widely believed that they are equivalent. 2.2 Curved Space–Time and Gravitation 137 (point) observer start initially from ..0/ x 1 ; .0/ x 2 ; .0/ x 3 / and with zero initial three-velocity. Her trajectory, falling freely under gravity, will be given by XO 1 .t/ D .0/ x 1 ; XO 2 .t/ D .0/ x 2 ; XO 3 .t/ D .0/ x 3 1 g .t/2 : 2 (2.81) The relative three-velocity components, between two falling particles, are furnished by d2 dt 2 dX ˛ .t/ dXO ˛ .t/ D .i / v˛ D const.; dt dt i d2 h ˛ .t/ WD 2 X ˛ .t/ XO ˛ .t/ 0: dt (2.82) Or, in other words, nearby objects free-falling near the surface of the Earth move from each other with constant 3-velocities. However, the relative 3-acceleration d2 ˛ .t / 0. dt 2 Now, consider an idealized observer inside a freely falling elevator in Earth’s gravitational field. Let him throw some massive particles inside the falling elevator. In free fall, he experiences no effects of gravity; moreover, he sees the particles move around him with constant 3-velocities (ignoring bounces off the walls). He can well conclude that gravitational forces have disappeared. Consider another example: Astronauts inside the international space station work under conditions similar to the observer in the elevator.5 Therefore, these astronauts are experiencing conditions valid in the special theory of relativity in inertial frames. On the other hand, it is well known that in instants after a rocket launching, the astronauts inside the rocket experience an apparent enhancing of gravity. Thus, one may conclude that 3-accelerations of an observer in space can apparently generate or annihilate gravitation (at least in the local sense). This surprising fact is known as the principle of equivalence. Let us investigate more critically the scenarios involving constant 3-accelerations on a nonlocal scale. Consider three massive point objects falling freely under the influence of gravity near the surface of the Earth where the acceleration is 5 The apparent zero-gravity effects experienced by astronauts in orbit are exactly analogous to the elevator example. The “zero-gravity” effects are due to the fact that the astronauts and the orbiting vehicle are in free fall and not due to the fact that gravity is too weak to have any appreciable effects. A quick calculation, using (2.79ii) and the remark after Example 1.3.28, reveals that the gravitational acceleration at 320 km above the Earth’s surface (low Earth orbit) is approximately 91% of its value at the surface of the Earth. 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 138 (1)l (0)l Earth (2)l 3 (3)l Fig. 2.10 Three massive particles falling freely in space under Earth’s gravity approximately constant (with no angular motion). The particles are initially located at three different locations. Each of the particles follows trajectories governed by (2.81). (See Fig. 2.10 where the 3-acceleration vectors are highlighted.) It is obvious from Fig. 2.10 that the three 3-acceleration vectors have distinct directions. Therefore, the observers falling freely along the lines .0/ l; .2/ l and .3/ l possess nonzero relative 3-accelerations. Thus, gravitational effects cannot be eliminated (or enhanced) nonlocally! That is to say, there is no global accelerating reference frame which will yield apparent weightlessness for all observers. Let us quote Synge’s comments on this topic [242]: The principle of equivalence performed the essential office of midwife at the birth of general relativity, but, as Einstein remarked, the infant would never have got beyond its long-clothes had it not been for Minkowski’s concept. I suggest that the midwife now be buried with appropriate honours and the facts of absolute space–time faced. Let us go back to Fig. 2.10 and furnish a space and time version of the same phenomenon. (Recall that (2.81) yields a parabola in space and time.) Thus, we put forward Fig. 2.11, ignoring the third particle pursuing .3/ l. In Fig. 2.11, parabolic world lines .0/ L and .2/ L have constant 3-accelerations and a nonzero relative 3-acceleration. Moreover, we included a vertical world line .e/ L WD .1/ L representing a static idealized observer on the Earth’s surface. However, each of the two 2.2 Curved Space–Time and Gravitation a 139 b t M4 χ x1 η (2)L 3 x2 (2) (0)L (e)L:=(1)L (e) x γ (0) γ γ:=(1)γ 3 Fig. 2.11 (a) Space and time trajectories of two geodesic particles freely falling towards the Earth. (b) A similar figure but adapted to the geodesic motion of the two freely falling observers in curved space–time M4 observers pursuing trajectories .0/ L and .2/ L experience no apparent gravitational force. Thus, they rightfully consider themselves as inertial observers following geodesic world lines. (Such world lines have zero 4-accelerations.) However, the Earth-bound observer, following the straight world line (in the sense depicted in the figure) .e/ L, experiences his own weight under gravity. Therefore, he concludes that he is not an inertial observer and is pursuing a nongeodesic trajectory in space and time. Now, in a Minkowskian coordinate chart of a flat space–time, neither of the parabolic curves .0/ L and .2/ L could be considered geodesics. As well, neither could the straight line .e/ L be nongeodesic. Hence, we are confronted with a dilemma. The only logical way out is to recognize the Fig. 2.11a as the arena of a coordinate chart for a curved pseudo-Riemannian space–time manifold. (See the Fig. 2.11b where we qualitatively represent a similar diagram but with the two geodesic observers pursuing straight lines.) Furthermore, the fact that relative 42 i acceleration components D d 2. / between two geodesics .0/ L and .2/ L are not all zero, implies, by the geodesic deviation equations (1.191), that Rilj k 6 0. In Einstein’s theory of gravitation, either there is an intrinsic gravitational field or there is none, according to whether the Riemann curvature tensor of space–time vanishes or not. This is an absolute property; it has nothing to do with apparent gravitational effects such as those due to nongeodesic motion of observers. In other words, both the astronauts in the international space station, experiencing apparent weightlessness, and Einstein, standing in the Prussian Academy of Sciences experiencing his weight, are immersed in a nonzero gravitational field since Rilj k ¤ 0 in their vicinities. However, very far away from gravitating bodies, straight lines in a Minkowskian coordinate chart are geodesics, Rilj k ! 0, and gravitational effects are vanishingly small. So we conclude, symbolically speaking, intrinsic gravitation nonzero Riemann curvature tensor. It is well known that the Newtonian theory of gravitation explains usual phenomena involving terrestrial and planetary motions under gravitation. We naturally 140 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 t Fig. 2.12 Qualitative representation of a swarm of particles moving under the influence of a gravitational field t2 xα=ξα(t,v) x3 t1 x2 x1 ask: “What is the significance of the nonzero curvature tensor of Einstein’s theory of gravitation in terms of the Newtonian gravitational potential?” We answer this legitimate question in the following example. Example 2.2.1. Consider a swarm of massive particles in a gravitational field following Newtonian equations of motion (2.79ii) and subject only to gravity. Let these particles span a very smooth world surface in space and time. Moreover, let this surface be parametrically represented by the equations x ˛ D ˛ .t; v/; t 2 Œt1 ; t2 ; v 2 Œv1 ; v2 ; (see Fig. 2.12). We assume that the functions ˛ are of class C 3 and that the potential W is of class C 2 . By Newton’s equations of motion (2.79ii), we have @2 ˛ .t; v/ @W .x/ ˇ C ı ˛ˇ D 0: @t 2 @x ˇ ˇx D ./ (2.83) Differentiating the above equation with respect to v and commuting the order of differentiations, we obtain 2 @3 ˛ .t; v/ @ .t; v/ ˛ˇ @ W ./ C ı D 0: (2.84) ˇ @t 2 @v @x ˇ @x ˇ:: @v ˛ Denoting the relative separation components by ˛ .t; v/ WD @ @v.t;v/ , (2.84), goes over into 2 @2 ˛ .t; v/ ˛ˇ @ W ./ C ı (2.85) ˇ .t; v/ D 0: @t 2 @x ˇ @x ˇ:: 2.2 Curved Space–Time and Gravitation 141 The second term in the equation above gives rise to the usual tidal forces caused by gravitation. Now, going back to the pseudo-Riemannian space–time M4 , the spatial components of the geodesic deviation equation (1.192) yield D2 i @ l ./ .; v/ h ˛ C R ./ lj k j:: @ 2 @ ˛ j ./ @ k ./ D 0: @ (2.86) Comparing (2.85) and (2.86), we conclude that nonzero curvature components represent relativistic tidal forces of the intrinsic gravitation. Now, let us explore another line of reasoning. In case tidal forces vanish, @2 W .x/ (2.84) implies that @x D 0. Solving the partial differential equations, we ˇ @x P obtain the general solution as W .x/ D c.0/ C 3D1 c./ x . (Here, c.0/ ; c./ ’s are arbitrary constants of integration.) Thus, equations of motion (2.79ii) yields d2 X ˛ .t / D ı ˛ˇ c.ˇ/ D const. Therefore, we are back to the scenario of constant 3dt 2 acceleration! By free fall, the apparent gravity can be eliminated. Thus, as expected, the intrinsic gravitation, equivalently the curvature tensor, must vanish. We shall now elaborate on the curved pseudo-Riemannian space–time M4 . (It is suggested to glance through the definition of a differentiable manifold in p. 1–3.) The first assumption on the pseudo-Riemannian manifold M4 is that it is a connected, four-dimensional, Hausdorff, C 4 -manifold with a Lorentz metric (of signature C2). The assumptions of Hausdorff topology and Lorentz metric imply that M4 is paracompact. Thus, M4 has a countable basis of open sets [150] providing a C 4 -atlas. In mathematical physics, the mathematical treatments should be rigorous and the mathematical symbols should be ultimately related to experimental observations. Consider an idealized event p 2 U M4 . The corresponding coordinates in the chart .; U / are provided by x i D i .p/ WD i ı .p/ D i .x/ 2 R for x 2 D R4 . We have to construct devices and methods to measure these four numbers x i . For that purpose, we shall first investigate idealized histories of particles in U M4 , equivalently in D R4 , by parametrized curves called world lines. In the sequel, we shall use arc separation parameters in (1.186) and (1.187) for timelike curves, which are furnished by x i D X i .s/. (We drop the symbol #.) For a null curve, we express x i D X i .˛/, where we use an affine parameter ˛. We assume the parametrized curve X to be of class C 3 . Therefore, we can express from (1.186) that gij .X .s// gij .X .˛// dX i .s/ dX j .s/ 1; ds ds dX i .˛/ dX j .˛/ 0: d˛ d˛ (2.87) 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 142 As a consequence of the above equation, we derive that 2 3 dX k .s/ dX l .s/ 5 dX i .s/ 4 d2 X j .s/ j gij .X .s// C 0: k l ˇˇ:: ds ds ds 2 ds (2.88) Therefore, 4-velocity is always orthogonal to 4-acceleration, whether or not the curve is a geodesic. Now, we investigate the proper time and proper length along a nonnull differentiable curve. By (1.186) and (2.17), the proper time along a timelike curve is furnished by Zt r s D S.t/ WD gij .X .u// dX i .u/ dX j .u/ du: du du (2.89) t0 (The proper time is also denoted by by some authors.) The proper length along a spacelike curve is given by s Zl dX i .w/ dX j .w/ dw: s D S.l/ WD gij .X .w// dw dw (2.90) l0 (The arc separation along a null curve is exactly zero.) Example 2.2.2. Consider the pseudo-Riemannian space–time manifold M4 and an orthogonal coordinate chart .; U /. Let the corresponding domain D R4 contain the origin .0; 0; 0; 0/. Moreover, let the metric tensor components satisfy g11 .x/> 0; g22 .x/ > 0; g33 .x/ > 0, and g44 .x/ < 0. Then, the proper time along the x 4 -axis is given by Zx 4 p sD g44 .0; 0; 0; t/ dt: (2.91) 0 The proper length along the x 1 -axis is furnished by Zx 1 p g11 .w; 0; 0; 0/ dw: l1 s D 0 Similar equations hold for the x 2 -axis and x 3 -axis. (2.92) 2.2 Curved Space–Time and Gravitation 143 The proper two-dimensional area of the coordinate rectangle .0; x 1 / .0; x 2 / is given by A WD Zx 1 Zx 2 p 0 .u1 ; u2 / du1 du2 ; 0 # " .u1 ; u2 / WD det g11 .u1 ; u2 ; 0; 0/ g12 .u1 ; u2 ; 0; 0/ g12 .u1 ; u2 ; 0; 0/ g22 .u1 ; u2 ; 0; 0/ : (2.93) (We assume that .u1 ; u2 / > 0.) The proper three-dimensional volume of the “coordinate rectangular solid” .0; x 1 / .0; x 2 / .0; x 3 / on the spacelike three-dimensional hypersurface x 4 D 0 is furnished by Zx 1 Zx 2 Zx 3 p V WD g.u1 ; u2 ; u3 / du1 du2 du3 ; 0 0 0 g.u ; u ; u / WD det g˛ˇ .u1 ; u2 ; u3 ; 0/ : 1 2 3 (2.94) (We assume that g.u1 ; u2 ; u3 / > 0.) In a flat space–time, relative to a Minkowskian coordinate chart, the righthand sides of (2.91)–(2.94) will reduce to x 4 ; x 1 ; x 1 x 2 , and x 1 x 2 x 3 , respectively. (We have tacitly assumed in this example that the matrix Œgij .x/ has four real eigenvalues .1/ .x/ > 0; .2/ .x/ > 0; .3/ .x/ > 0, and .4/ .x/ < 0.) Now, we discuss an idealized observer following a future-pointing timelike world line. He or she carries a regular (point) clock to measure the proper time along the world line. An orthonormal basis set or a tetrad is transported along with the observer. He or she may be an inertial or noninertial observer. The inertial observer obviously follows a timelike geodesic furnished by U i .s/ WD dX i .s/ ; ds (2.95i) DU i .s/ D 0; ds (2.95ii) gij .X .s// U i .s/ U j .s/ 1; gij .X .s// U i .s/ (2.95iii) j DU .s/ 0: ds (2.95iv) 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 144 Equation (2.95i) defines the 4-velocity components U i .s/. The geodesic equation (2.95ii) indicates that 4-velocity components U i .s/ undergo parallel transportations. (See (1.175) and (1.178i,ii).) It is convenient to choose the timelike unit vector Ee.4/ .X .s// of the orthonormal i tetrad as e.4/ .X .s// D U i .s/. The choice of the other three spacelike unit vectors of the tetrad is arbitrary up to a rotation or a reflection induced by an element of the orthogonal group O.3; R/. Let the choice of orthonormality be made at the initial event X .0/. Therefore, j i gij .X .0// e.a/ .X .0// e.b/ .X .0// D d.a/.b/ : (2.96) Assume now that each of the four 4-vectors is transported parallelly along the geodesic, that is, i .X .s// De.a/ ds By the Leibniz rule for the derivative D ds D 0: (2.97) in (1.175), we deduce that i d h j i gij .X .s// e.a/ .X .s// e.b/ .X .s// ds i Dh j i ./ e.b/./ D gij ./ e.a/ ds D i D j j i e.a/ ./ e.b/ ./ C e.a/ e.b/ ./ D gij ./ ./ ds ds D 0; or, j i gij .X .s// e.a/ .X .s// e.b/ .X .s// D const. By the initial conditions (2.96), the constants must be d.a/.b/ . Thus, the orthonormality of the tetrad is preserved under parallel transport along a geodesic. Such a tetrad is essential for the inertial observer to measure physical components like T.a/.b/ .X .s// and physical (or orthonormal) components of other tensor fields. Now, let us investigate a noninertial observer pursuing a nongeodesic timelike world line. An obvious example is an idealized (point) scientist working in a fixed location of a laboratory on Earth’s surface. What kind of orthonormal tetrad can this observer carry along their world line? We can explore the Frenet-Serret orthonormal tetrad introduced in (1.196). Recapitulating the formulas, we provide the following equations: i.1/ .s/ WD Di.1/ .s/ ds dX i .s/ U i .s/; ds D .1/ .s/i.2/ .s/; 2.2 Curved Space–Time and Gravitation Di.2/ .s/ ds Di.3/ .s/ ds Di.4/ .s/ ds 145 D .2/ .s/i.3/ .s/ C .1/ .s/i.1/ .s/; D .3/ .s/i.4/ .s/ .2/ .s/i.2/ .s/; D .3/ .s/i.3/ .s/: (2.98) Here, .1/ .s/ is the principal or first curvature. Moreover, .2/ .s/ and .3/ .s/ are the second and third curvature, respectively. The spacelike unit vectors E .2/ .s/; E .3/ .s/, and E .4/ .s/ are the first, second, and third normal to the curve. For a nongeodesic curve, .1/ .s/ ¤ 0. Therefore, by (2.98), the orthonormal FrenetE .a/ .s/g4 is not parallelly transported. Thus, we look for another Serret tetrad f 1 mode of transportation of an orthonormal tetrad or frame along a nongeodesic curve (or an accelerating observer). We define the Fermi derivative of a vector field along a curve by the following string of equations: U i .s/ D dX i .s/ ; ds .1/ .s/N i .s/ WD DU i .s/ ; ds h i E .s// E .s// D V.X DF V.X E V E U.s/ E WD .1/ .s/ g:: .X .s// N; ds ds h i E V E N.s/: E C .1/ .s/ g:: .X .s// U; (2.99) (Consult [126, 243].) The Fermi-Walker transport (F–W transport in short) is defined by E .s// DF V.X E .s// D O.X ds or DV i .X .s// D .1/ .s/ U i .s/N j .s/ U j .s/N i .s/ Vj .X .s// ds DU j .s/ DU i .s/ i j U .s/ Vj .X .s// : D U .s/ ds ds (2.100) An important property of F–W transport is discussed next. Theorem 2.2.3. Let X be a parametrized timelike curve of class C 2 with the image ˚ 4 D R4 . Let a differentiable tetrad Ee.a/ .X .s// 1 be orthonormal at the initial point X .0/. Furthermore, let each of the vectors Ee.a/ .X .s// be subjected to F–W ˚ 4 transport along the curve. Then, the orthonormality of the tetrad Ee.a/ .X .s// 1 is preserved for all s 2 Œ0; s1 . 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 146 Proof. By the assumptions made and (2.100), it follows that j i .X .0// e.b/ .X .0// D d.a/.b/; gij .X .0// e.a/ i .X .s// De.a/ ds k D .1/ .s/ gj k ./ U i .s/N j .s/ U j .s/N i .s/ e.a/ .X .s// : (2.101) Therefore, we obtain by (1.175) and the Leibniz property, that i d h j i gij .X .s// e.a/ .X .s// e.b/ .X .s// ds i D h j i gij ./ e.a/ ./ e.b/./ D ds (" " # #) i k De.a/ De.b/ ./ ./ k i D gi k ./ e.b/ ./ C e.a/ ./ ds ds h i k l k l D .1/ .s/ gi k ./ gj l ./ e.b/ ./ e.a/ ./ C e.a/ ./ e.b/ ./ U i ./N j ./ U j ./N i ./ 0: The zero on the right-hand side resulted from the double contraction of a symmetric tensor with an antisymmetric one. Thus, we conclude that j i .X .s// e.b/ .X .s// D const. D d.a/.b/ : gij .X .s// e.a/ It can be noted by (2.100), (2.95iv), and (2.98) that the tangent vector field U i .s/ undergoes F–W transport automatically. Moreover, in the limit .1/ .s/ ! 0, the F–W transport ! parallel transport. In Fig. 2.13, we compare and contrast parallel transport versus F–W transport. i In Fig. 2.13b, the tangent vector U i .s/ D e.4/ .X .s// remains a tangent vector to the nongeodesic curve under F–W transport. Thus, F–W transport provides a noninertial observer with an orthonormal tetrad. Furthermore, it also provides an orthonormal (spatial) triad orthogonal to the 4-velocity vector U i .s/. This triad forms a spatial frame of reference for the observer. It is this frame of reference which provides us a correct generalization of the Newtonian concept of a nonrotating moving frame. Example 2.2.4. Consider a conformally flat space–time M4 . (Consult Theorem 1.3.33 and Appendix 4.) The metric is furnished by ds 2 D Œ .x/2 dij dx i dx j ; 2 C 3 .D R4 I R/; .x/ > 0; @4 ¤ 0: (2.102i) 2.2 Curved Space–Time and Gravitation Fig. 2.13 (a) shows the parallel transport along a nongeodesic curve. (b) depicts the F–W transport along the same curve 147 a i e(4) i b ui = e(4) ui Γ Γ χ(0) χ(0) g:: .x/ D Œ .x/2 dij dx i ˝ dx j ; i Ee.a/ .x/ D Œ .x/1 ı.a/ @ ; @x i (2.102ii) (2.102iii) j i .x/ e.b/ .x/ D d.a/.b/ : gij .x/ e.a/ (2.102iv) Consider the image of a differentiable curve given by x ˛ D X ˛ .s/ 0; x 4 D X 4 .s/ D S 1 .s/; Zx 4 s D S.x 4 / WD .0; 0; 0; t/ dt: (2.103) 0 4 / (The existence of S 1 is assured by the fact that dS.x D .0; 0; 0; x 4 / > 0.) dx 4 Therefore, is a portion of the x 4 -axis. The unit tangential vector along is given by (2.103) and (2.102iii) as U i .s/ D dX i .s/ i i D Œ .X .s//1 ı.4/ D e.4/ .X .s//; ds U ˛ .s/ 0; U 4 .s/ > 0: (2.104) Now, from the metric (2.102ii), the Christoffel symbols can be computed as i (2.105) D Œ .x/1 d i l dj l @k C dlk @j dkj @l : jk 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 148 Thus, by (2.104) and (2.105), we obtain n o DU i .s/ i ˇ D Œ .x/3 ı.4/ @4 C d ij @j ˇxDX .s/ : ds (2.106) The above equation demonstrates that the principle curvature .1/ .s/ (and therefore the 4-acceleration) is nonzero, unless @˛ 0. Equation (2.100) implies that the tangential vector U i .s/ @x@ i j:: automatically undergoes F–W transport along . i .X .s//, the left-hand side of For the other three spacelike vector fields e.˛/ (2.100), by consequences of (2.104), (2.102iii), and (2.105), yields i ./ De.˛/ ds i k ./ U j .s/ e.˛/ j k ˇˇ:: ds n o i D Œ .x/3 ı.4/ @˛ ˇˇ : :: D i ./ de.˛/ C (2.107) On the other hand, the right-hand side of (2.100), by use of (2.2.4,ii), (2.104), and (2.106), implies that DU k .s/ DU i .s/ j i j k gj k ./ U .s/ e.˛/ ./ U .s/ e.˛/ ./ ds ds n o i (2.108) D Œ .x/3 ı.4/ @˛ ˇˇ : :: Comparing (2.107) and (2.108), we conclude that the orthonormal tetrad ˚ 4 Ee.a/ .X .s// 1 indeed undergoes the F–W transport along . (Conformally flat space–times are discussed in detail in Appendix 4.) We shall now consider an operational method for measurement of thePproper length of a spacelike curve. Recall that the arc separation function of a differentiable curve X was discussed in # 8 of Exercise 1.3. It is defined by X Z .X / WD t.2/ t.1/ sˇ ˇ i j ˇ ˇ ˇgij .X .t// dX .t/ dX .t/ ˇ dt: ˇ dt dt ˇ (2.109) (The integral above is invariant under reparametrization as well as under a general coordinate transformation.) Consider an observer with an orthonormal tetrad, clock, and extremely small devices to emit and receive photons. (See the Fig. 2.14.) In Fig. 2.14, .1/ and .2/ are images of curves X.1/ and X.2/ representing the same observer. Null curves (or photon trajectories) are represented by X.3/ and X.4/ with images .3/ and .4/ respectively. Moreover, is the image of a spacelike 2.2 Curved Space–Time and Gravitation 149 Fig. 2.14 Measurement of a spacelike separation along the image x(3) Γ(2) Γ(4) Γ x(2) x(4) Γ(1) Γ(3) x(1) curve X under scrutiny. In special relativity, the measurement of a spacelike distance is much simpler to analyze than in the case of curved space–time. The procedure was briefly mentioned after (2.18). Now, we shall deal with the problem in flat space–time in greater detail. (This will allow us to have better insight into the corresponding analysis when the space–time is curved.) Let us choose Minkowskian coordinates and each of the five curves in Fig. 2.14 as geodesic or straight lines. We choose proper time parameter s for the inertial observer, proper length parameter l for the spacelike straight line X , and an affine parameter ˛ for the null straight lines X.3/ and X.4/ . Therefore, we can express j i i i i X.1/ .s/ D t.1/ s C c.1/ ; s 2 Œs1 ; s2 /; dij t.1/ t.1/ D 1 I j i i i i i i X.2/ .s/ D t.2/ s C c.2/ ; s 2 Œs2 ; s3 ; dij t.2/ t.2/ D 1; t.2/ D t.1/ I X i .l/ D t i l C c i ; l 2 Œl1 ; l2 ; dij t i t j D 1 I j i i i i X.3/ .˛/ D t.3/ ˛ C c.3/ ; ˛ 2 Œ˛1 ; ˛2 /; dij t.3/ t.3/ D 0 I j i i i ˛ C c.4/ ; ˛ 2 .˛2 ; ˛3 ; dij t.4/ t.4/ D 0: X.4/ .˛/ D t.4/ (2.110) Here, t.i/ ’s and c.i/ ’s are const. By (2.109), (2.110) yields X X .X.1/ / D q r i j dij t.1/ t.1/ r .X.2/ / D .s2 s1 / D j j i i x.2/ x.1/ ; dij x.2/ x.1/ j j i i x.3/ x.2/ ; dij x.3/ x.2/ 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 150 X .X / X X D r q dij .l2 l1 / D j j i i x.4/ x.2/ ; dij x.4/ x.2/ r j j i i x.4/ x.1/ D 0; dij x.4/ x.1/ r j j i i x.3/ x.4/ D 0: dij x.3/ x.4/ .X.3/ / D .X.4/ / D ti tj (2.111) Now, we can express i i i i i i x.3/ ; x.4/ x.3/ D x.4/ x.2/ x.2/ i i i i i i C x.2/ ; x.4/ x.1/ D x.4/ x.2/ x.1/ i i i i x.2/ ; x.1/ D x.3/ x.2/ ı WD .s2 s1 / .s3 s2 / > 0: (2.112) Putting the above equations into the null separations of (2.111), we obtain ( dij h j j j j i i i i x.2/ x.2/ x.4/ x.4/ x.2/ C x.3/ x.3/ x.2/ ) i j j i i D 0; 2 x4/ x.2/ x.3/ x.2/ dij h j j j j i i i i x.4/ x.4/ x.2/ C 2 x.3/ x.3/ x.2/ x.2/ x.2/ i j j i i x.3/ x.2/ D 0: C 2 x.4/ x.2/ (2.113) Adding the above equations and cancelling the factor .1 C / > 0, we deduce that j j j j i i i i x.4/ x.2/ D dij x.3/ x.3/ x.2/ ; x.2/ x.2/ dij x.4/ (2.114) 2.2 Curved Space–Time and Gravitation 151 or, P .X / 2 D P X.2/ 2 D P P X.1/ X.2/ : Therefore, the (inertial) observer can measure spatial distances by the readings of his clock! [55, 242]. Now, let us try to compute the spacelike separation along the image (Fig. 2.14), in the case when the curvature tensor is nonzero. We employ Riemann normal coordinates for the point x.2/ in Fig. 2.14. (See p. 67 for the definition.) Let the domain of validity D R4 encompass the space–time diagram in Fig. 2.14. So, we assume that x.2/ D .0; 0; 0; 0/; gij .0; 0; 0; 0/ D dij ; @k gij .x/j.0;0;0;0/ D 0: (2.115) From the point of view of physics, we refer to this coordinate chart as local Minkowskian coordinates. Let us assume that the observer is inertial. In such a case, geodesics originating at x.2/ are furnished by straight lines [55, 242] i i X.1/ .s/ D t.1/ s; s 2 Œs1 ; 0/; j i i i dij t.1/ t.1/ D 1; X.1/ .0/ D .0; 0; 0; 0/ D x.2/ I i i i X.2/ .s/ D t.2/ s D t.1/ s; s 2 Œ0; s3 I X i .s/ D t i l; l 2 Œ0; l2 : (2.116) In the first of the above equations, we have admitted negative values of the parameters, indicating that it is a signed arc separation parameter. The null geodesics with images .3/ and .4/ are not necessarily straight lines. They are governed by equations i d2 X.3/ .˛/ d˛ 2 i d2 X.4/ .˛/ d˛ 2 C j k .˛/ dX.3/ .˛/ dX.3/ i D 0; ˛ 2 Œ˛1 ; ˛2 / I ˇ j k ˇX .˛/ d˛ d˛ .3/ C j k .˛/ dX.4/ .˛/ dX.4/ i D 0; ˛ 2 .˛2 ; ˛3 : (2.117) ˇ j k ˇX .˛/ d˛ d˛ .4/ 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 152 (Recall that ˛ is an affine parameter.) Now, computing arc separations along various curves, we obtain X Z0 X.1/ D s gij .X .t// s1 D q i .t/ dX j .t/ dX.1/ dt dt dt i j gij X.1/ .0/ t.1/ t.1/ .s1 / r j j i i x.2/ x.1/ ; dij x.2/ x.1/ D X X X.2/ r j j i i D dij x.3/ x.2/ x.3 x.2/ ; r .X / D j j i i x.4/ x.2/ : dij x.4/ x.2/ (2.118) Comparing the above equations with the corresponding equations in (2.111), we conclude that the agreements are exact. However, null curves, which are assumed to be of class C 3 , pose some complications. Expressing the 4-velocity components i .˛/ D U.3/ i dX.3/ .˛/ d˛ i .˛/ d U.3/ d˛ along the null curve X.3/ , we derive from (2.117) that D i j k U.3/ .˛/ U.3/ .˛/; j k ˇˇX .˛/ .3/ ˛ 2 Œ˛1 ; ˛2 /: (2.119) By the mean value theorem [32], we can deduce from (2.119) that i X.3/ .˛/ D i x.1/ C .˛ i ˛1 / U.3/ .˛1 / " # i d U.3/ .˛/ 1 2 C .˛ ˛1 / ˇ ; 2 d˛ ˇ ˇ ˇ WD ˛1 C .˛ ˛1 /; 0 < < 1: (2.120) Using (2.119) in (2.120), we conclude that i i i .˛1 / D x.3/ x.1/ r i j˛2 ˛1 j ; @k gij jˇ ; .˛2 ˛1 / U.3/ 2 r i ./ WD .˛2 ˛1 /2 2 i j k U.3/ U.3/ ˇ : jk ˇˇ (2.121) ˇ ˇ For a “small” domain andˇ“weak” intrinsic gravitation, the remainder term ˇr i ./ˇ ˇ i i ˇ is very small compared to ˇx.3/ x.1/ . It should be remarked, however, that (2.121) 2.2 Curved Space–Time and Gravitation 153 is exact. Since we are dealing with geodesic triangles in a curved manifold [266], we do expect some deviations from the conclusions in the flat manifold. (We have tacitly assumed here that there are no conjugate points for geodesics in the domain of consideration.) Example 2.2.5. Consider a Riemannian normal or local Minkowskian coordinate chart. By the conditions gij .0; 0; 0; 0/ D dij ; @k gij .x/j.0;0;0;0/ D 0; we can derive from (1.141ii) Rij kl .0; 0; 0; 0/ D .1=2/ @j @k gi l C @i @l gj k @j @l gi k @i @k gj l j.0;0;0;0/ : (2.122) With the above equations, we can easily prove the algebraic identities of the Riemann–Christoffel tensor stated in Theorem 1.3.19. We can furthermore prove that ˚ @l @k gij @i Œkl; j @j Œkl; i j.0;0;0;0/ D Ri kj l C Ri lj k j.0;0;0;0/ DW 3Sij kl .0; 0; 0; 0/: (See Problem # 4 of Exercise 2.2.) (2.123) Synge, in his book [243], dealt extensively with the problem of physical measurements with help of the world function, ˝.x2 ; x1 / of p. 86, the symmetrized curvature tensor (in (2.123)), the principal curvature of observer’s world line, etc. The book [184] by Misner et al. also deals with such topics from slightly different perspectives. We shall now turn our attention to the equations of motion of a particle in curved space–time. We consider the general case of a possibly variable mass M.s/ > 0 for the particle. We generalize the special relativistic equations given in # 6 of Exercise 2.1. From the definition of force as the rate of change of momentum, we postulate the equations of motion along a future-pointing timelike curve as 2 3 2 i j k dX d dX X .s/ .s/ .s/ dM.s/ dX i .s/ i 5 M.s/ 4 C C j k ˇˇ:: ds ds 2 ds ds ds D F i .x; u/ˇˇ ˇx k DX k .s/ ˇ ˇ k dX k .s/ ˇu D ds or ; (2.124) D M.s/U i .s/ D F i .x; u/j:: : ds On the right-hand sides of (2.124), the 4-force vector components F i ./j:: are solely due to nongravitational effects. 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 154 In terms of physical (or orthonormal ) components, (2.124) yields h M.s/ U .b/ .s/ @.b/ u.a/ .x/ .a/ .d /.b/ .x/ u.d / .x/ i ˇ ˇ k ˇx DX k .s/ ˇ ˇ .e/ ˇu DU .e/ .s/ dM.s/ U .a/ .s/ D F .a/ .x; u/j:: ; ds (2.125i) dM.s/ D d.a/.b/ F .a/ ./ j:: U .b/ .s/: ds (2.125ii) C .a/ Here, .d /.b/ .x/ are components of the Ricci rotation coefficients in (1.124ii). Although (2.124) and (2.125i) are mathematically equivalent, (2.125i) are preferable from the point of view of observation, as they correspond to the physical frame. Equation (2.125ii) is the relativistic generalization of the Newtonian power law (2.19ii). With help from (2.125ii), we can prove that the mass function M.s/ is constant-valued if and only if vector fields U i .s/ and F i ./j:: are orthogonal. (Compare with Problem # 6(i) of Exercise 2.1.) In such a scenario, (2.124), (2.98), and (2.99) yield M.s/ D m D positive const.; (2.126) DU i .s/ D .m/1 F i ./j:: D .1/ .s/ N i .s/: ds (2.127) Therefore, nongeodesic or 4-accelerated motions of particles and observers, with .1/ .s/ ¤ 0, must be caused by nongravitational forces. There is a special class of nongravitational forces called monogenic forces [159]. A monogenic force is derivable from a single work function W.x; u/ of class C 2 such that ) d @W./ F ./j:: WD g .X .s// rj W./j:: ˇ : ds @uj ˇ:: ( i ij (2.128) We elaborate on the consequences of a monogenic force in the following example. Example 2.2.6. We can derive equations of motion (2.127) with (2.128) from a variational principle. (See (1.187) and Appendix 1.) Consider the Lagrangian function L of eight variables in the following: q L.x; u/ WD m gij .x/ ui uj C W.x; u/: (2.129) 2.2 Curved Space–Time and Gravitation 155 Therefore, taking partial derivatives, we obtain m .@i gj k /uj uk @W./ @L./ D p C ; k l @x i 2 @x i gkl u u mgij ./uj @L./ @W./ D p C : k l @ui @ui gkl u u (2.130) The Euler–Lagrange equations, derived from (2.130), yield d @L./ @L./ ˇ 0D ˇ i ds @u @x i ˇ:: ˇ:: d U j .s/ d D m gij .X .s// C @k gij j:: U j .s/ U k .s/ C W./j:: ds ds m @i gj k j:: U j .s/ U k .s/ @i W./j:: ; 2 d U j .s/ d @W j k C j k; i j:: U .s/ U .s/ D @i Wj:: m gij ./ ˇ ; ds ds @ui ˇ:: ( ) @W DU i .s/ d D g ij ./j:: rj Wj:: (2.131) m ˇ : ds ds @uj ˇ:: or, or, We shall now consider a useful class of monogenic forces by requiring that the work function W.x; u/ is a positive, homogeneous function of degree one. That is, for an arbitrary positive number > 0, we must have from (2.129), W.x; u/ D W.x; u/ I L.x; u/ D L.x; u/: (2.132) (Consult [55, 171, 242].) By Euler’s theorem on homogeneous functions [176], we derive from (2.132) that @W.x; u/ D W.x; u/ I @ui @L.x; u/ D L.x; u/: ui @ui ui (2.133) 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 156 We may assume another condition on the above Lagrangian, namely, det @2 ŒL.x; u/2 @ui @uj ¤ 0: (2.134) Equation (2.133), along with the inequality (2.134) and the differentiability L 2 C 2 .D R8 I R/, leads to a Finsler metric [2], fij .x; u/ WD .1=2/ @2 ŒL.x; u/2 fj i .x; u/; @ui @uj det fij ./ ¤ 0: (2.135) Now, we shall define conjugate 4-momentum vector components from (2.130) and (2.132) as pi D Pi .x; u/ WD mgij uj @L.x; u/ @W.x; u/ D p C : k l @ui @ui gkl u u (2.136) We can deduce from the equations above that @W.x; u/ @W.x; u/ p D m2 : g ij .x/ pi j @ui @uj (2.137) This equation is the generalization of the special relativistic quadratic constraint (2.33). It is the generalized mass-shell condition. For a massless particle like the photon, we can put m D 0 on the right-hand side of (2.137). We shall now investigate the arena of relativistic Hamiltonian mechanics. First, we will follow nonrelativistic Hamiltonian mechanics in order to introduce the relativistic version of the Legendre transformation. Thus, we define the relativistic Hamiltonian as b p/ WD pi ui L.x; u/ D ui @L./ L./: H.x; @ui (2.138) Let us assume now (2.128) and (2.132). Therefore, by the conditions (2.136) and b p/ 0. Thus, the obvious approach fails! So, we (2.133), we conclude that H.x; look for another definition of a relativistic Hamiltonian. We notice that by (2.136) and (2.133), the 4-momentum function Pi .x; u/ is a homogeneous polynomial of degree zero in the variables ui . Therefore, for the positive number WD .u4 /1 , and the variables v˛ WD u˛ .u4 /1 , we obtain pi D Pi .x; u/ D Pi .x; .u4 /1 u/ D Pi .xI v1 ; v2 ; v3 ; 1//: (2.139) 2.2 Curved Space–Time and Gravitation 157 The above equations locally yield a parametrized seven-dimensional hyperspace in the eight-dimensional “covariant phase space” [55] coordinatized by the .x; u/chart. Alternatively, the elimination of three variables v˛ in (2.139) will result locally in a holonomic constraint H.x; p/ D 0: (2.140) Since we have already derived such a constraint in (2.137), we identify the relativistic Hamiltonian, or super-Hamiltonian, as 1 @W.x; u/ @W.x; u/ ij 2 H.x; p/ WD g .x/ pi pj C m ; (2.141i) 2m @ui @uj @ @W.x; u/ @W.x; u/ ij g p 0: (2.141ii) .x/ p i j @uk @ui @uj Remark: The super-Hamiltonian above is, of course, different from that in (2.138). The variationally derived equations of motion in (2.131) are obtainable by an alternative Lagrangian that involves the super-Hamiltonian H.x; p/. Let a parametrized curve of class C 2 in a domain of a 13-dimensional space be specified by: i i x D X .t/; i dX .t/ ; u D dt i pi D P i .t/; D .t/; t 2 Œt1 ; t2 : (2.142) L.I/ .x; uI pI / WD pi ui H.x; p/: (2.143) (Here, t is just a parameter.) Let a Lagrangian of class C 2 be furnished by Here, is the Lagrange multiplier. The corresponding nine Euler–Lagrange equations are given by @L.I/ ./ @L.I/ ./ ˇ ˇ @ui @x i ˇ:: ˇ:: @H./ dPi .t/ D ˇ ; dt @x i ˇ:: d 0D dt i @L.I/ ./ @H./ d X .t/ C 0D0 ˇ D ˇ ; @pi dt @pi ˇ:: ˇ:: @L.I/ ./ 0D0 ˇ D H.x; p/j:: : @ ˇ:: (2.144i) (2.144ii) (2.144iii) 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 158 We reparametrize the curve by setting Zt s D S.t/ WD .w/ dw; t1 i X i .s/ D X .t/; Pi .s/ D P i .t/: (2.145) Equations (2.144i–iii) go over into @H./ dPi .s/ ˇ ; D ds @x i ˇ:: (2.146i) @X i .s/ D ds (2.146ii) @H./ ˇ ; @pi ˇ:: and H.x; p/j:: D 0 : (2.146iii) The equations above are called the relativistic Hamiltonian equations of motion or relativistic canonical equations of motion. (See [243].) We assert that the equations of motion in (2.146i–iii) are equivalent to those in (2.131). Example 2.2.7. We explore the motion of a massive, charged particle in an external electromagnetic field. (See Example 1.2.22 and (2.67).) We choose for the work function as W.x; u/ WD e Ak .x/ uk ; W.x; u/ D W.x; u/; @W.x; u/ D eAk .x/: @uk (2.147) Equations (2.129), (2.130), and (2.136) yield L.x; u/ D m pi D q gij .x/ui uj C e Ak .x/ uk ; m gij .x/ uj @L.x; u/ D p C e Ai .x/; @ui gkl uk ul pi e Ai .x/ j:: D m gij .X .s// U j .s/: (2.148) The relativistic super-Hamiltonian function from (2.141i) is furnished by ˚ H.x; p/ D .2m/1 g kl .x/ pk e Ak .x/ pl e Al .x/ C m2 : (2.149) 2.2 Curved Space–Time and Gravitation 159 Hamilton’s canonical equations of motion (2.146i,ii) yield ˚ ij @H./ dX i .s/ 1 i D ˇ D m g .x/ pj e Aj .x/ j:: D U .s/ I ds @pi ˇ:: ˚ @H./ dPi .s/ ˇ D .2m/1 @i g kl pk eAk pl eAl D ds @x i ˇ:: 2e g kl @i Ak pl eAl j:: D .m/ or, or, 1 lm k n m2 uk ul g g @i gmn 2 C e mg @i Ak ul kl ; j:: i hm d m gi k ui C eAi j:: D @i gkl uk ul C e@i Ak uk ; ds 2 j:: 2 3 2 i j k dX dX X .s/ .s/ .s/ d i 5 C m4 j k ˇˇ:: ds ds 2 ds dX k .s/ ˚ D e g ij .x/ @j Ak @k Aj j:: ds D e g ij .x/ Fj k .s/ j:: dX k .s/ : ds (2.150) The above equations are the correct generalization of the relativistic Lorentz equations of motion in (2.67) to curved space–time. There exist alternative Lagrangians for the variational derivation of Hamilton’s canonical equations (2.146i,ii). We cite two such Lagrangians in the following: L.II/ .xI p; p 0 I / WD x i pi0 C H.x; p/; L.III/ .x; uI p; p 0 I / WD .1=2/.pi ui x i pi0 / H.x; p/: (2.151i) (2.151ii) / (Here, the prime denotes the derivative pi0 j::: WD dP.t dt .) The Lagrangian function L.III/ in the equation above explicitly reveals the symplectic structure of the canonical equations (2.146i–iii). (See Problem # 8(ii) of Exercise 2.2.) So far, in this chapter, we have assumed that the space–time is a pseudoRiemannian manifold M4 and has, in general terms, attributed its curvature to the intrinsic gravitation. However, we have set up no field equations by which the curvature of space–time is made to depend on material sources. That is, we do not yet have the relativistic analog of (1.156). Now, we shall pursue this project. 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 160 Recall the Newtonian equations of motion in an external gravitational field furnished by (2.79ii). In a curvilinear coordinate chart of the Euclidean space E 3 , these equations go over into g:: .x/ D g ˛ˇ .x/ dx ˛ ˝ dx ˇ ; (2.152i) R ::: .x/ O ::: .x/; (2.152ii) dX ˇ .t/ dX .t/ d2 X ˛ .t/ ˛ D g ˛ˇ .x/ @ˇ W .x/j:: C ˇ ˇ ˇ:: dt 2 dt dt ˛ D r W .x/j:: : (2.152iii) The equations of motion (2.152iii) is variationally derivable from the Lagrangian L.N / .x; v/ WD .m=2/ g ˛ˇ .x/ v˛ vˇ 2W .x/ : (2.153) On the other hand, in the absence of nongravitational forces, a particle follows a geodesic world line in the curved space–time. Such a geodesic is variationally derivable from the Lagrangian in (2.129) as q L.x; u/ D m gij .x/ui uj : (2.154) If we use any affine parameter, including s, an alternative Lagrangian for the geodesic curve is provided by L.2/ .x; u/ WD .m=2/ gij .x/ ui uj D .m=2/ g˛ˇ .x/ u˛ uˇ C 2g˛4 .x/ u˛ u4 C g44 .x/.u4 /2 : (2.155) Defining coordinate 3-velocity components by v˛ WD u˛ =u4 , the Lagrangian above can be expressed as L.2/ ./ D .m=2/ g˛ˇ .x/v˛ vˇ C 2g˛4 .x/v˛ C g44 .x/ .u4 /2 : (2.156) Comparing Lagrangians L.N / ./ in (2.153) and L.2/ ./ in (2.156), we conclude that in the low velocity regime, the metric tensor component g44 .x/ corresponds to twice the Newtonian potential W .x/ plus an undetermined constant. In a weak gravitational field, this relationship is (approximately) given by g44 .x/ D Œ1 C 2W .x/ < 0. Now, we shall explore the field equation for the Newtonian potential inside material sources. We choose physical units such that the Newtonian constant of gravitation G D 1. (Recall that we have already chosen units so that the speed of light c D 1.) In such units, physical quantities are expressible as powers of the spatial unit of “length ” or else “time.”) 2.2 Curved Space–Time and Gravitation 161 The Newtonian potential W .x/, in curvilinear coordinates (2.152i,ii), is governed by Poisson’s equation 2 r W .x/ WD g ˛ˇ .x/r˛ rˇ W D 4 .x/ (2.157i) 2 or, r Œ.1 C 2W .x// D 8 .x/: (2.157ii) Here, .x/ is the nonrelativistic mass density. In the last row of the table in p. 127, the nonrelativistic mass density, momentum density, and stress density are all unified in relativity theory by the symmetric energy–momentum–stress tensor Tij .x/. Therefore, in the right-hand side of the relativistic gravitational field equations, we would like to have 8 Tij .x/, instead of just 8 .x/ as in (2.157ii). This choice forces us to consider a symmetric tensor ij ./ for the left-hand side of the field equations. Since the left-hand side of (2.157ii) is (approximately) given 2 by r g44 ./, our tensor ij ./ should contain up to and including second partial derivatives of gij .x/. Moreover, the curvature tensor plays an important role in the intrinsic gravitation. Therefore, we would like ij ./ to be expressible by various contractions of the curvature tensor. Moreover, the energy–momentum–stress tensor satisfies the useful differential conservation equations rj T ij D 0. Therefore, we shall also require ij ./ to satisfy rj ij D 0. Now, we have accumulated enough criteria to derive ij ./ explicitly in the following theorem [90]. Theorem 2.2.8. Let the metric field components gij .x/ be of class C 3 in a domain D.e/ D R4 . Let a symmetric, differentiable tensor field ij .x/ in D.e/ be defined by ˚ ij .x/ WD k Rij .x/ C g ij .x/ Œ .x/ R.x/ C .x/ : Here, k is a nonzero constant, Rij ./ are components of the Ricci tensor, R./ is the curvature invariant, .x/ and .x/ are two differentiable scalar fields. Then, rj ij D 0, if and only if ij .x/ D k G ij .x/ g ij .x/ , where G ij .x/ are components of the Einstein tensor and is a constant. Proof. (i) Assume that ij .x/ D k G ij .x/ g ij .x/ . Then, rj ij D k rj G ij rj g ij 0 by (1.150ii) and (1.131ii). (ii) Now, assume that rj ij D 0. Then, from the definition of ij .x/, we conclude that ˚ 0 D k rj Rij C g ij .x/ @j Œ .x/ R.x/ C .x/ : Using rj Rij D .1=2/ g ij .x/ @j R, we obtain that 0 D g ij .x/ @j Œ.1=2/ R.x/ C .x/ R.x/ C .x/ : Therefore, .1=2/ R.x/ C .x/ R.x/ C .x/ D D const. 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 162 Thus, ij .x/ D k G ij .x/ g ij .x/ : Choosing the constant k D 1 for physical reasons (e.g., an acceptable Newtonian law for weak fields), we assume that the gravitational field equations are furnished by ij .x/ D Gij .x/ gij .x/ D 8 Tij .x/; x 2 D.e/ D R4 : (2.158) These field equations constitute the second assumption of the gravitational theory of this book. The constant is called the cosmological constant, due to the fact that it was useful to Einstein in yielding a static universe when applying his field equations to the universe as a whole. The right-hand side of (2.158) will read, in the common c.g.s. units, as Tij .x/, where WD 8G=c 4 D 2:07 1048 gm1 cm1 s2 . In the sequel, we shall continue to use the constant , although we shall still employ geometrized units where c D G D 1. (Thus, in these units, D 8.) Einstein did not consider the cosmological constant in his original papers. He published as field equations the following (or equivalent): ( inside material sources, Gij .x/ D Tij .x/ (2.159i) 0 outside material sources ( or G.a/.b/ .x/ D T.a/.b/.x/ inside material sources, (2.159ii) 0 outside material sources. The Einstein field equations above are great intellectual achievements of the twentieth century! Outside material sources, the vacuum field equations reduce to or, Rij .x/ D 0; (2.160i) R.a/.b/ .x/ D 0: (2.160ii) (Recall that the above are the conditions for Ricci flatness as discussed in p. 70.) Now, alternative versions of field equations (2.159i,ii) will be provided. Following Lichnerowicz [166], we shall assign “names” to the field equations. Denoting by T .x/ WD g ij .x/ Tij .x/, we furnish the alternative versions as Eij .x/ WD Gij .x/ C Tij .x/ D 0; E.a/.b/.x/ WD G.a/.b/ .x/ C T.a/.b/.x/ D 0 I (2.161i) (2.161ii) EQij .x/ WD Rij .x/ C Tij .x/ .1=2/ gij .x/ T .x/ D Rkij k .x/ C Tij .x/ .1=2/ gij .x/ T .x/ D 0; (2.162i) 2.2 Curved Space–Time and Gravitation 163 EQ.a/.b/ .x/ WD R.a/.b/ .x/ C T.a/.b/.x/ .1=2/ d.a/.b/ T .x/ DR .c/ .a/.b/.c/ .x/ C T.a/.b/ .x/ .1=2/ d.a/.b/ T .x/ D 0 I (2.162ii) E lij k .x/ WD Rlij k .x/ C lij k .x/ n C .=2/ ı lk Tij .x/ ı lj Ti k .x/ C gij .x/ T lk .x/ gi k .x/ T lj .x/ h i o C .2=3/ ı lj gi k .x/ ı lk gij .x/ T .x/ D 0; E .d / .a/.b/.c/.x/ WD R .d / .a/.b/.c/.x/ C (2.163i) .d / .a/.b/.c/.x/ n .d / .d / C .=2/ ı .c/ T.a/.b/ .x/ ı .b/ T.a/.c/ .x/ C d.a/.b/ T .d / .c/ .x/ d.a/.c/ T .d / .b/ .x/ h i o .d / .d / C .2=3/ ı .b/ d.a/.c/ ı .c/ d.a/.b/ T .x/ D 0: (2.163ii) .d / Here, C lij k .x/ (and C .a/.b/.c/.x/) are components of Weyl’s conformal tensor, as defined in (1.169i, ii). In the material “vacuum”, Tij .x/ 0 (or, T.a/.b/.x/ 0). Therefore, the field equations in (2.161i)–(2.163ii) reduce to their vacuum (sourceless) versions .0/ EQ ij .x/ WD Rij .x/ D 0; (2.164i) .0/ EQ .a/.b/ .x/ WD R.a/.b/ .x/ D 0 I (2.164ii) .0/l EQ ij k .x/ WD Rlij k .x/ C lij k .x/ D 0; (2.165i) .0/.d / .d / .d / EQ .a/.b/.c/ .x/ WD R .a/.b/.c/ .x/ C .a/.b/.c/ .x/ D 0: (2.165ii) The system of field equations (2.161i)–(2.163ii) must be further augmented by the following equations: T i .x/ WD rj T ij D 0; T .a/ .x/ WD r.b/ T .a/.b/ D 0 I rj E ij T i .x/; r.b/ E .a/.b/ T .a/ .x/ I (2.166i) (2.166ii) (2.167i) (2.167ii) 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 164 C i gj k ; @l gj k D 0; C .a/ e i.b/ ; @j e i.b/ D 0: (2.168i) (2.168ii) The equations C i ./ D 0 (or C .a/ ./ D 0) stand for four possible coordinate conditions. (e.g., four equations g˛4 .x/ 0 and g44 .x/ 1 can be locally imposed to obtain a geodesic normal (or Gaussian normal) coordinate chart, (as discussed in (1.160)).) The field equations (2.161i), (2.166i), (2.167i), and (2.168i) (or their orthonormal counterparts) constitute a system of semilinear, second-order, coupled, partial differential equations in the domain D.e/ D R4 . (See Appendix 2.) It is useful to take a count of the number of unknown functions versus the number of (algebraically and differentially) independent equations. The counting process reveals whether the system is underdetermined, overdetermined, or determinate. (In an underdetermined system, we can prescribe suitably some unknown functions.) In the most general case, we assume that the ten functions Tij .x/ are unknown, although often physical considerations may place constraints on them. In the scenario where the Tij .x/ are unknown, the counting will be symbolically expressed as the following: No. of unknown functions: 10.gij / C 10.Tij / D 20: No. of equations: 10.Eij D 0/ C 4.T i D 0/ C 4.C i D 0/ D 18: No. of differential identities: 4.rj E ij T i / D 4: No. of independent equations: 18 4 D 14: Therefore, the most general system is underdetermined and six out of the twenty unknown functions can at most be prescribed. Now, we shall explore an isolated material body surrounded by the vacuum. Let it be represented by the world tube D.b/ D.e/ D R4 . (See Fig. 2.15.) The relevant field equations from (2.159i,ii) are Gij .x/ D ( Tij .x/ for x 2 D.b/ D.e/ R4 ; for x 2 D.e/ D.b/ : 0 (2.169) We assume certain jump discontinuities Tij .x/ 6 0 are allowed across the timelike three-dimensional boundary hypersurface @D.b/ . (We do not deal with infinite discontinuities.) There are two common jump conditions available in the literature. Synge’s junction conditions [243] are the following: gij .x/ [email protected]/ Tij .x/ nj D @k gij [email protected]/ D 0: [email protected]/ 0; (2.170) 2.2 Curved Space–Time and Gravitation 165 Fig. 2.15 A material world tube in the domain D.b/ D ∂D(b) Γ D(b) D(e) 4 Here, ni @x@ i j@D denotes the unit, spacelike normal vector to the hypersurface .b/ @D.b/ . Moreover, the notation [. . . ] indicates the measure of the jump discontinuity. Physically, this condition may be interpreted as implying that there should be no flux of matter or energy off of the junction surface (which, however, may not be static). The other popular junction conditions are due to Israel, Sen, Lanczos, and Darmois [45, 140, 156, 234]. We shall call these conditions the I–S–L–D jump conditions to match the nomenclature often used in the literature. Suppose that the intrinsic metric components of @D.b/ are given by g .u/ of (1.223). Moreover, the extrinsic curvature is furnished by the components K .u/ D .1=2/ ri nj C rj ni @ i @ j in (1.234). Then, the I–S–L–D junction conditions are characterized by gij .x/ [email protected]/ ri nj C rj ni 0; [email protected]/ 0: (2.171) This junction condition implies the absence of surface layers (thin “ı-function” shells) of matter and will be further motivated when we consider the variational principle applied to gravitation. (See Appendix 1.) Remark: The conditions (2.170) and (2.171) also apply to junctions separating different types of material (not just matter-vacuum boundaries). Now, let us consider an (not necessarily inertial) observer with world line as in Fig. 2.15. This observer is penetrating the material world tube D.b/ with a parallelly transported (or F–W transported) orthonormal tetrad. The observer has devices to measure the physical components G.a/.b/ .X .s// (via measurements of R.a/.b/.c/.d /) 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 166 and T.a/.b/ .X .s// along the world line x i D X i .s/. Thus, he or she can validate field equations (2.169) along the world line by actual experiments. Therefore, from the point of view of physics, the field equations (2.161ii), (2.164ii), (2.166ii), etc., in terms of physical components are more relevant than the corresponding coordinate components! Next, consider a special coordinate chart, namely, Riemann normal coordinates or local Minkowskian coordinates in Example 2.2.5. The vacuum equations (2.164i), in this chart, yields Rj k .0; 0; 0; 0/ D g i l .x/ Rij kl .x/ j.0;0;0;0/ ˚ D .1=2/ gj k .x/ C @j @k d i l gi l @i @j gi k @l @k gj l j.0;0;0;0/ D 0: (2.172) Here, the wave operator (or D’Alembertian) is defined as WD d i l @i @l . This linearized reduction is at the single point .0; 0; 0; 0/. However, (2.172) is exact. Moreover, there is a glimpse of gravitational waves in (2.172). (Gravitational waves shall be briefly discussed in Appendix 5.) The vacuum equations Gij .x/ D 0 (or, Rij .x/ D 0) are a also derivable from variational principle involving the Lagrangian density L gij ; @k gij ; @l @k gij WD p g.x/ R.x/, known as the Einstein-Hilbert Lagrangian density (see the Appendix 1). (Hilbert discovered the vacuum equations independently [131], after attending Einstein’s earlier seminars on the problem of gravitation.) Tensorial field equations (2.161i), (2.162i), (2.163i), (2.166i), etc., retain their forms intact under a general coordinate transformation in (1.37). Similarly, field equations (2.161ii), (2.162ii), (2.163ii), (2.166ii), etc., preserve their forms under a variable Lorentz transformation of the tetrad fields. Both of these “covariances” are called “general covariances” of the field equations. We have already mentioned general covariances of (2.74)–(2.78iii) in the theory of special relativity. However, historically, the notion of general covariance or general relativity has been used only in the context of the curved space–time. We shall also continue to use “general relativity” only in curved space–time (by popular demand)! Example 2.2.9. Consider a (static) metric of class C ! in the following [243]: g:: .x/ WD Œ1 2W .x/ ı˛ˇ dx ˛ ˝ dx ˇ Œ1 C 2W .x/ dx 4 ˝ dx 4 ; ds 2 D Œ1 2W .x/ ı˛ˇ dx ˛ dx ˇ Œ1 C 2W .x/ .dx 4 /2 ; .x/ .x; x 4 / 2 D R DW D R4 ; jW .x/j < .1=2/: (2.173) 2.2 Curved Space–Time and Gravitation 167 Computation of the Einstein tensor components from (2.173), by (1.141i), (1.147ii), (1.148i), and (1.149i), leads to G˛ˇ ./ D 4W ./ ı˛ˇ r 2 W @˛ @ˇ W Œ1 4W 2 1 C 4W C 12W 2 2 @˛ W @ˇ W .1 4W 2 /2 3 C 4W C 12W 2 C ı˛ˇ ı @ W @ W .1 4W 2 /2 DW T˛ˇ .x/; (2.174i) G˛4 ./ 0 DW T˛4 .x/; (2.174ii) 1 C 2W 1 C 2W r 2W 3 ı @ W @ W G44 ./ D 2 1 2W /2 .1 2W /3 DW T44 .x/; (2.174iii) r 2 W WD ı @ @ W: (2.174iv) It turns out that the above energy–momentum–stress components satisfy Tij ./ D ./ ui ./ uj ./ C pij ./; ui ./ WD Œ1 C 2W 1=2 ı i.4/ ; gij ./ ui ./ uj ./ 1; pij ./ uj ./ 0; .x/ WD ı @ W @ W 1 2 : 2r W C 3 .1 2W /2 .1 2W / (2.175) The above energy–momentum–stress tensor represents a complicated visco-anisotropic fluid, which may or may not exist in nature. (We are just exploring a mathematical model.) Further, let W .x/ in the metric (2.173) satisfy the Newtonian gravitational equations r 2W D ( .=2/ .x/ > 0 for x 2 D.1/ [ [ D.n/ ; ˚ 0 for x 2 D D.1/ [ [ D.n/ I Z W .x/ D D.1/ [[D.n/ .y/ dy 1 dy 2 dy 3 : k xy k (2.176) 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 168 ^ D ^ X ^ D(e) x x^ ^ D D(e) D 4 4 QO Fig. 2.16 Analytic extension of solutions from the original domain D.e/ into D Therefore, the Newtonian potential W .x/ is due to superposition of gravitational potentials of n static, massive, extended bodies. These bodies are in equilibrium by virtue of mutual cancellations of gravitational attractions and visco-anisotropic repulsions. The metric (2.173), with help of (2.176), depicts the exact general relativistic generalization of this Newtonian phenomenon. The field equations (2.161i)–(2.163ii), (2.164i)–(2.165ii), and (2.166i,ii), which are partial differential equations involving metric tensor components or tetrad components, are posed in a suitable domain D.e/ D R4 . If we can solve these equations in the domain D.e/ , then we can try to extend the solutions analytically to the whole coordinate domain D R4 . In cases where we succeed in this endeavor, b R4 , where the we make a suitable coordinate transformation to the domain D solutions are automatically known by virtue of the transformation laws in (1.107i– iii). In the hatted coordinate chart, we try to analytically extend the solutions into a Q b “larger” domain D R4 . (See Fig. 2.16.) We can try to extend solutions for the metric components into more and more coordinate charts and hope to finally construct an atlas for the differentiable pseudoRiemannian space–time manifold M4 . We may or may not succeed in this endeavor. Global extensions and global analysis of the space–time continuum are quite involved as they require knowledge of the entire history and future of all gravitating bodies involved. (See the book by Hawking and Ellis [126] on this subject.) Here, we merely cite some toy models of two-dimensional curved surfaces, embedded in three-dimensional Euclidean space, to illustrate myriads of strange possibilities that global structures of space–time may acquire. (See Fig. 2.17.) In Fig. 2.17a, the surface is that of a “bugle.” It is a surface of negative Gaussian curvature, and it is geodesically incomplete. (For a geodesically complete manifold, geodesics can be extended for all (real) values of affine parameters. 2.2 Curved Space–Time and Gravitation 169 Fig. 2.17 Five two-dimensional surfaces with some peculiarities (See [56, 126, 266].)) The surface in Fig. 2.17b represents a circular cone with a “hair” or singularity on the bottom which is not a differentiable manifold. Figure 2.17c represents a manifold with a “throat” and identifications. Figure 2.17d depicts a surface with self-intersection. It is an example of a Riemannian variety [90], which is not a Riemannian manifold. The closed surface in Fig. 2.17e has one handle, or equivalently, it is a surface of genus 1 [266]. In general relativity, 2.17a can qualitatively represent a submanifold of the space outside of a spherical star. Figure 2.17b can qualitatively represent the gravitational collapse of a spherical matter distribution to form a singularity, and Fig. 2.17c can be a spatial representation of an exotic object known as a wormhole. (See Appendix 6.) Finally, let us be reminded again of two aspects of gravitational forces. Firstly, apparent gravity is always due to the 4-acceleration of the observer. Secondly, intrinsic gravity (the actual gravitational field) is always caused by tidal forces or the (nonzero) curvature of the space–time. To be honest, we have to admit that in the general theory of relativity, the notion of “gravitational forces” is just a myth! The curvature effects of the space–time are erroneously misinterpreted as “gravitational forces.” (In the sequel, whenever we use the word gravitation, we really imply curvature effects.) We conclude this section with Wheeler’s quotation: “Matter tells space how to curve, space tells matter how to move.” (Note that in the quotation above, the word “gravitation” is conspicuously absent!) Exercises 2.2 1. Consider the Newtonian potential W .x/ WD .1=2/ .a C b/.x 1 /2 a.x 2 /2 b.x 3 /2 ; where a > 0; b > 0 are constants. Integrate differential equations (2.85) for the components relative separation vector field. ˛ .t; v/ of the 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 170 2. Consider the generalized Frenet-Serret formula (2.98). In the case of a hyperbola of constant curvature, we put .1/ .s/ D b D const. ¤ 0; .2/ .s/ 0; .3/ .s/ 0. In the case where the space–time is flat, obtain a class of general solutions to differential equations (2.98). 3. Let a differential tensor field rs T.x/ be restricted to a differentiable timelike curve x i D X i .s/. The Fermi derivative of the tensor field is defined by DF T i1 ;:::;ijr1 ;:::;js .X .s// ds WD DT i1 ;:::;ijr1 ;:::;js ./ ds C r X Uk ˛D1 C DU i˛ dUk r T i1 ;:::;k;:::;i U i˛ j1 ;:::;js ds ds s X DUjˇ DU l T i1 ;:::;ijr1 ;:::;l;:::;js : Ul Uj ˇ ds ds ˇD1 Prove the Leibniz property: DF h i k ;:::;k Ai1 ;:::;ijr 1 ;:::;js B 1 lp1 ;:::;lq ds " D DF Ai1 ;:::;ijr 1 ;:::;js # B ds 2 C Ai1 ;:::;ijr 1 ;:::;js 4 k1 ;:::;kp l1 ;:::;lq DF B k1 ;:::;kp l1 ;:::;lq ds 4. The symmetrized curvature tensor S:::: .x/ is defined by the components Sij kl .x/ WD .1=3/ Ri kj l .x/ C Ri lj k .x/ : (i) Prove that Sij lk .x/ Sij kl .x/ Sj i kl .x/ Sklij .x/ I Sij kl .x/ C Si klj .x/ C Si lj k .x/ 0: (ii) Compute the number of linearly independent components of S:::: .x/. 5. Show that the relativistic equation of motion (2.124) implies Zs M.s/ D M.0/ gij .X .t// F i ./j:: 0 dX j .t/ dt: dt 3 5: 2.2 Curved Space–Time and Gravitation 171 (Remarks: The equation above proves that external gravitational forces, or combined external gravitational and electromagnetic forces alone, cannot alter the proper mass or rest energy of a (classical) particle.) 6. Consider the following Lagrangian function [55]: L.x; u/ WD 1 C c.0/ V .x/ q C c.2/ 3 j q eAi .x/ui m jgij .x/ui uj j ij k .x/u i uj uk j q C c.3/ 4 j ij kl .x/u i uj uk ul j : Here, c.0/ ; e; m > 0; c.2/ ; c.3/ , are constants. The functions V .x/; Ai .x/; gij .x/; 3 4 ij k .x/; ij kl .x/ are of class C in D R . Moreover, tensor fields gij .x/; .x/, and .x/ are symmetric and totally symmetric fields. Using the ij k ij kl fact that L.x; u/ D L.x; u/ for > 0, construct the corresponding Finsler metric fij .x; u/, according to (2.135). 7. Prove the differential identities (2.141ii) involving the super-Hamiltonian function H./. 8. Consider the 4 4 identity matrix Œ I WD Œı ij . Define an antisymmetric, " numerical 8 8 matrix by ŒA WD # 0 I . I 0 Consider a general, differentiable coordinate transformation in the extended phase space (or cotangent bundle [38, 55, 56]) as i .xI p/; xO i D b pOi D bi .xI p/; ŒJ WD 88 " ı ı # x i @pj @b x i @x j @b ; det ŒJ ¤ 0: ı ı @b p i @x j @b p i @pj Let the (extended) Jacobian matrix satisfy ŒJ ŒAŒJ T D ŒA. Prove that under such a transformation, relativistic canonical equation (2.146i,ii) remains intact (or “covariant”). (Remarks: (i) Transformations satisfying ŒJ ŒAŒJ T D ŒA are called relativistic canonical transformations. (ii) The subset of linear, homogeneous, canonical transformations constitutes a Lie group called the symplectic group Sp .8I R/. (See [123, 160].)) 9. Consider gravitational field equations (2.162ii), (2.164ii), and (2.166ii). Show that in terms of directional derivatives, Ricci rotation coefficients, and the physical (or tetrad) components T.a/.b/ .x/, the field equations are equivalent to the following: 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 172 @.c/ .c/ .a/.b/ @.b/ .c/ .a/.c/ .c/ .a/.d / C .d / .b/.c/ .c/ .d /.c/ .d / .a/.b/ 8 = < T.a/.b/ .x/ .1=2/ d.a/.b/ d .c/.d / T.c/.d / .x/ ; inside matter :0; @.b/ T .a/.b/ outside matter I .a/ .d /.b/ .x/ .d /.b/ T .b/ .a/.b/ .x/ .d /.b/ T D 0; inside matter. 10. Harmonic coordinate conditions p (or the harmonic gauge) are characterized by four differential equations @j jgj g ij D 0. (See [155].) (i) Consider a differentiable scalar field defined by .x/ WD x i . (Here, the index i takes one of the values in f1; 2; 3; 4g.) Prove that in the harmonic gauge, WD g ij .x/ri rj D 0: (ii) Prove that in the harmonic gauge, gravitational field equations reduce to 1 kl i g .x/ @k @l g ij kp 2 D j lq g kl .x/ g pq .x/ ( T ij .x/ 12 g ij .x/ T kk .x/ inside material sources; 0 outside material sources: (Remarks: The harmonic p gauge conditions are analogous to the Lorentz gauge condition ri Ai D p1 @i Œ jgj Ai D 0 in electromagnetic field theory.) jgj Answers and Hints to Selected Exercises 1. 1 .t; v/ D A1 .v/ cos 2 .t; v/ D A2 .v/ e 3 .t; v/ D A3 .v/ e p p p p a C b t C B 1 .v/ sin aCbt ; at bt p C B 2 .v/ e C B 3 .v/ e at ; p bt : Six arbitrary functions Ai .v/; B i .v/ resulted from integration. 2.2 Curved Space–Time and Gravitation 173 2. X 1 .s/ D .b/1 cosh .bs/ C c 1 ; X 2 .s/ D c 2 ; X 3 .s/ D c 3 ; X 4 .s/ D b 1 sinh .bs/ C c 4 : There are four arbitrary constants c i ’s of integration. 4. (ii) The number is 20, which is the same number of independent components for Rij kl .x/. 7. Using (2.133), we get or ui @W./ D W./; @ui ui @2 W./ 0: @uk @ui Now, employing (2.136), we obtain @W./ @W./ g ij .x/ pi p j @ui @uj @2 W./ @W./ D 2g ij .x/ k i pj @u @u @uj 2 2m i @ W./ 0: D p u gmn um un @uk @ui @ @uk 8. Write canonical equations (2.146i,ii) as block-matrix equations [243]: 2 3 dX i .s/ # " 6 ds 7 0 I 6 7 4 dP .s/ 5 D I 0 i ds 81 88 2 3 @H./ 6 @x i j:: 7 6 7 6 7 4 @H./ 5 = ŒA 88 @pi j:: 81 2 @H./ 3 6 @x i 7 6 7 4 @H./ 5 @pi 81 : 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 174 Transforming into hatted coordinates by the chain rule, the equations above imply that @x i 6 @b 6 xj 6 4 @pi @b xj or, 32 2 j 3 b j .s/ pj @b x @b dX 6 @x i @x i 76 7 6 7 6 ds 7 76 7 D ŒA 6 j 4 @b 5 4 dP 5 pj x @b bj .s/ @p @p i i ds 2 3 2 3 b b j .s/ @H./ dX 6 7 6 7 6 @b x j j:: 7 6 ds 7 7; ŒJ 1 6 7 D ŒAŒJ T 6 6 b 7 4 dP b .s/ 5 4 @H./ 5 2 @x i @b pj @pi @b pj 3 32 b @H./ 7 76 @b x j j:: 7 76 6 7; 76 7 b 5 4 @H./ 5 @b p j j:: j 2 or, ds 3 2 3 @b p j j:: b @H./ b j .s/ dX 6 7 6 7 6 @b x j j:: 7 6 ds 7 6 7: 6 7 D ŒA 6 7 b 4 dP bj .s/ 5 @ H./ 4 5 @b p j j:: ds 2.3 General Properties of Tij We shall now explore the algebraic classification of orthonormal components of the energy–momentum–stress tensor field T.a/.b/.x/ at a particular event, corresponding to x0 2 D R4 . The 4 4 real, symmetric matrix T.a/.b/.x0 / has the (usual) characteristic polynomial equation p./ WD det T.a/.b/ .x0 / ı.a/.b/ D 0: (2.177) The corresponding roots, which are the usual eigenvalues, are all real but nonrelativistic! However, physically relevant, relativistic invariant eigenvalues are furnished by another polynomial equation p # ./ WD det T.a/.b/ .x0 / d.a/.b/ D 0: h i .a/ .a/ or det T .b/ .x0 / ı .b/ D 0: (2.178) As discussed in Appendix 3, the relativistic or Lorentz-invariant eigenvalues need neither be real nor the 4 4 matrix T.a/.b/ .x0 / be diagonalizable. In the special cases where T.a/.b/ .x0 / admits only real invariant eigenvalues, the classification of the matrix is provided by the following types. (See Example A3.8 for more details.) 2.3 General Properties of Tij 175 2 Type-I: T.a/.b/ .x0 / .J / .1/ 6 0 D6 4 0 0 0 .2/ 0 0 0 0 .3/ 0 3 0 0 7 7: 0 5 .4/ (2.179) This matrix is already diagonalized. The 4 1 column vectors representing the 23 23 23 23 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 relativistic eigenvectors are (obviously) 4005, 4105, 4015, and 4005. These vectors ˚ 4 are isomorphic to the (natural) orthonormal basis vectors in eE.a/ .x0 / 1 . The energy– momentum–stress tensor is expressible as T .x0 / D 4 X .a/ Ee.a/ .x0 / ˝ Ee.a/ .x0 / ; aD1 j j i i .x0 /e.1/ .x0 / C .2/ e.2/ .x0 /e.2/ .x0 / T ij .x0 / D .1/ e.1/ j j i i .x0 /e.3/ .x0 / C .4/ e.4/ .x0 /e.4/ .x0 /: C .3/ e.3/ (2.180) In case invariant eigenvalues .1/ ; .2/ ; .3/ ; .4/ are all distinct, the Segre characteristic is6 Œ1; 1; 1; 1. (See (A3.4).) This type of the energy–momentum–stress tensor is known as Type-I.a/. In the case of Type-I.b/, we assume that .1/ D .2/ and .1/ ; .3/ ; .4/ are distinct. The Segre characteristic is Œ.1; 1/; 1; 1. The components T ij .x0 / are given by h i j j i i T ij .x0 / D .1/ e.1/ .x0 /e.1/ .x0 / C e.2/ .x0 /e.2/ .x0 / j j i i .x0 /e.3/ .x0 / C .4/ e.4/ .x0 /e.4/ .x0 / C .3/ e.3/ j i .x0 /e.3/ .x0 / D .1/ g ij .x0 / C .3/ .1/ e.3/ j i C .1/ C .4/ e.4/ .x0 /e.4/ .x0 /: (2.181) i Here, we have used equations (1.105) and the notation e.a/ .x0 / i.a/ .x0 /. The Type-I.c/ is characterized by .1/ D .2/ , .3/ D .4/ , and .1/ ¤ .4/ . The Segre characteristic is Œ.1; 1/; .1; 1/. 6 Consult Appendix 3 for the definition of a Segre characteristic. 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 176 For the Type-I.d /, .1/ D .2/ D .3/ and .1/ ¤ .4/ . The Segre characteristic is furnished by Œ.1; 1; 1/; 1. The energy–momentum–stress components are given by h i j j j i i i T ij .x0 / D .1/ e.1/ .x0 /e.1/ .x0 / C e.2/ .x0 /e.2/ .x0 / C e.3/ .x0 /e.3/ .x0 / j i .x0 /e.4/ .x0 / C .4/ e.4/ j i D .1/ g ij .x0 / C .1/ C .4/ e.4/ .x0 /e.4/ .x0 /: (2.182) Here, we have made use of (1.105). The Type-I.e/ is characterized by .1/ D .2/ D .3/ D .4/ . (See (A3.4).) The Segre characteristic is Œ.1; 1; 1; 1/. The energy–momentum–stress tensor field is provided by h j j i i T ij .x/ D .1/ e.1/ .x/e.1/ .x/ C e.2/ .x/e.2/ .x/ j j i i .x/e.3/ .x/ e.4/ .x/e.4/ .x/ C e.3/ i D .1/ g ij .x/: (2.183) The Type-II is characterized by 3 0 0 .1/ 0 6 0 .2/ 0 0 7 7; T.a/.b/ .x0 / D 6 4 0 0 .3/ C 1 1 5 0 0 1 1 .3/ 2 3 0 0 .1/ 0 h i 6 0 iT h 0 0 7 .a/ .2/ 7 ¤ T .a/ .x0 / : T .b/ .x0 / D 6 .b/ 4 0 0 .3/ C 1 1 5 0 0 1 .3/ 1 2 or, (2.184) The relativistic eigencolumn vectors for the above matrix are isomorphic to spacelike vectors Ee.1/ .x0 /; Ee.2/ .x0 /, and the null vector Ee.3/ .x0 / Ee.4/ .x0 /. In the case when .1/ ; .2/ , and .3/ are distinct, the Segre characteristic is furnished by Œ1; 1; 2. (See (A3.5).) For Type-II.b/, assume that .1/ D .2/ , .1/ ¤ .3/ . The Segre characteristic is provided by Œ.1; 1/; 2. For Type-II.c/, assume that .1/ ¤ .3/ and .2/ D .3/ . The Segre characteristic is furnished by Œ1; .1; 2/. For Type-II.d /, assume that .1/ D .2/ D .3/ . The Segre characteristic is Œ.1; 1; 2/. 2.3 General Properties of Tij 177 The Type-III.a/ is characterized by 2 .1/ i 6 0 h .a/ T .b/ .x0 / D 6 4 0 0 1 .1/ 0 0 0 0 .2/ 0 3 0 0 7 7: 1 5 .2/ (2.185) Here, we assume that .1/ ¤ .2/ and the Segre characteristic is Œ2; 2. For the Type-III.b/, we assume that .1/ D .2/ and the Segre characteristic is Œ.2; 2/. The Type-IV.a/ is characterized by 2 .1/ h i 6 0 .a/ T .b/ .x0 / D 6 4 0 0 0 .2/ 0 0 0 1 .2/ 0 3 0 0 7 7: 1 5 .2/ (2.186) In this case, .1/ ¤ .2/ and the corresponding Segre characteristic is Œ1; 3. For Type-IV.b/, we assume that .1/ D .2/ . The Segre characteristic is Œ.1; 3/. Type-V is characterized by 2 .1/ h i 6 0 .a/ T .b/ .x0 / D 6 4 0 0 1 .1/ 0 0 0 1 .1/ 0 3 0 0 7 7: 1 5 .1/ (2.187) The Segre characteristic is Œ4. (Consult (A3.4)–(A3.10) of Appendix 3.) Example 2.3.1. Consider the case of a perfect fluid defined by the energy– momentum–stress tensor field T ij .x/ WD p.x/g ij .x/ C Œ .x/ C p.x/ U i .x/U j .x/ Œ .x/ C p.x/ U i .x/U j .x/ C p.x/g ij .x/; gij .x/U i .x/U j .x/ 1: (2.188) Here, .x/ is the proper mass density and p.x/ is the pressure. (See (2.45).) By (2.182), it is clear that the Segre characteristic of Tij .x/ in (2.188) throughout the space–time domain of consideration is Œ.1; 1; 1/; 1. 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 178 We can deduce from (2.188) that Tij .x/U j .x/ D .x/gij .x/U j .x/; Tij .x/V j .x/ D p.x/gij .x/V j .x/: (2.189) Here, V j .x/ represents an arbitrary, nonzero spacelike vector field satisfying the orthogonality Ui .x/V i .x/ 0. Therefore, we conclude that p.x/ and .x/ are the invariant eigenvalues of the energy–momentum–stress tensor field Tij .x/. (Note that in this example, Tij .x/U i .x/U j .x/ D .x/.) In a macroscopic domain of the space–time universe, we usually experience that the proper mass density is nonnegative, or .x/ 0. To generalize this concept, invariant criteria on Tij .x/, called energy conditions, are introduced. (See [126].) I. The Weak/Null Energy Condition: This condition is furnished by the weak inequality Tij .x/W i .x/W j .x/ 0 (2.190) for every timelike/null vector field W i .x/ @x@ i . Physically speaking, this inequality, for timelike W i .x/ @x@ i , implies that the energy density of a material source as measured by any observer pursuing a timelike curve, must be nonnegative. II. The Dominant Energy Condition: This condition is characterized by (i) Tij .x/W i .x/W j .x/ 0 (2.191) and (ii) T ij .x/Wj .x/ @x@ i is nonspacelike. (W i .x/ @x@ i is an arbitrary timelike or null vector field.) The above conditions may be physically interpreted as the local energy density is always nonnegative and the local energy flux is always nonspacelike. III. The Strong Energy Condition: This condition is governed by the weak inequality Tij .x/W i .x/W j .x/ .1=2/T ii .x/W j .x/Wj .x/ (2.192) for every timelike (or null) vector field W i .x/ @x@ i . The energy conditions are reasonable in a space–time domain containing regular, macroscopic, matter distribution. However, these conditions likely do not hold in the neighborhood of an extreme pressure and density, such as close to a singularity. Moreover, in the microcosm, the arena of quantum effects, these conditions are not meaningful. An investigation on the energy conditions may be found in [14]. In the case of a diagonalizable energy–momentum–stress tensor field given in (2.180), the energy conditions can be considerably sharpened. 2.3 General Properties of Tij 179 Theorem 2.3.2. Let the energy–momentum–stress tensor field T ij .x/ be diagonalizable as T ij .x/ D .x/U i .x/U j .x/ C 3 X j i p./ .x/V./ .x/V./ .x/; D1 U i .x/Ui .x/ 1; i Ui .x/V./ .x/ 0; j i gij .x/V./ .x/V. / .x/ ı./. /: (2.193) Then, the weak energy condition (2.190) is equivalent to .x/ 0 I .x/ C p./ .x/ 0; 2 f1; 2; 3g; (2.194i) and the null energy condition is equivalent to only the second condition in (2.194i). The dominant energy condition (2.191) is equivalent to ˇ ˇ ˇp./ .x/ˇ .x/; 2 f1; 2; 3g: (2.194ii) Furthermore, the strong energy condition is equivalent to .x/ C p./ .x/ 0 and .x/ C 3 X p./ .x/ 0: (2.194iii) D1 We shall skip the proof. (See [126, 257].) Remarks: (i) The invariant eigenvalues p./ .x/ are called principal pressures. (ii) The negative of principal pressures, namely, ./ .x/ WD p./ .x/ are called principal tensions. (iii) A cosmological constant source can violate energy conditions. Example 2.3.3. One can enforce the energy inequalities in (2.194i–iii) with help of four, arbitrary, slack functions. Let five functions q; f; h.1/ ; h.2/ ; h.3/ be arbitrary continuous functions in x 2 D R4 . The weak/null energy inequality (2.194i) is solved by putting .x/ WD q.x/; p./ .x/ WD h./ .x/ 2 q.x/: In the case of the weak energy condition, the function q.x/ is subject to the extra restriction q.x/ D Œf .x/2 to ensure a nonnegative energy density. The dominant energy condition (2.194ii) is solved by substituting .x/ WD Œf .x/2 ; p./ .x/ WD Œf .x/2 cos ./ .x/ : Here, f; .1/ ; .2/ ; .3/ are four, arbitrary, continuous functions. 180 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 The strong energy condition (2.194iii) is solved by expressing .x/ WD Œf .x/ sinh .x/2 ; p.1/ .x/ WD 2 Œf .x/ cosh .x/ sin .x/ cos .x/2 Œf .x/ sinh .x/2 ; p.2/ .x/ WD 2 Œf .x/ cosh .x/ sin .x/ sin .x/2 Œf .x/ sinh .x/2 ; p.3/ .x/ WD 2 Œf .x/ cosh .x/ cos .x/2 Œf .x/ sinh .x/2 : Here, four continuous functions f; ; ; are otherwise arbitrary. Now we shall investigate macroscopic materials in general. Constituent particles of such materials follow a timelike 4-velocity field U i .x/ @x@ i satisfying the invariant eigenvalue equations: Tij .x/U j .x/ D .x/Ui .x/; Ui .x/U i .x/ 1: (2.195) E The vector field U.x/ D U i .x/ @x@ i is tangential to motion curves representing stream lines. (See (2.42) and Fig. 2.6.) It can be proved that the energy–momentum– stress tensor field Tij .x/ in (2.195) must be of Type-I in (2.179). (See Problem # 2 of Exercise 2.3.) We define a symmetric tensor field by Sij .x/ WD .x/Ui .x/Uj .x/ Tij .x/: (2.196) Sij .x/U j .x/ D .x/Ui .x/ Tij .x/U j .x/ 0: (2.197) It follows that We call Sij .x/ the general relativistic stress-tensor field. (The special relativistic version was discussed in (2.45).) We now define the projection tensor field P ij .x/ WD ı ij C U i .x/Uj .x/; P ij .x/U j .x/ 0: (2.198) For an arbitrary, nonzero vector field V i .x/ @x@ i , the projected vector P ij .x/ V j .x/ @x@ i is spacelike and orthogonal to U i .x/ @x@ i . (See Theorems 2.1.2 and 2.1.4.) 2.3 General Properties of Tij 181 We shall now analyze the relativistic kinematics of material streamlines. We need to define several vector and tensor fields derived from the 4-velocity field U i .x/ @x@ i . Assuming that streamlines are curves of class C 3 , we define the 4-acceleration field, vorticity tensor, expansion tensor, expansion scalar, and shear tensor, respectively, by UP i .x/ WDU j rj U i ; (2.199i) 2!ij .x/ WD .rl Uk rk Ul / P ki .x/ P lj .x/; (2.199ii) 2ij .x/ WD .rl Uk C rk Ul / P ki .x/ P lj .x/; (2.199iii) .x/ WD kk .x/ D rk U k ; ij .x/ WDij .x/ .1=3/.x/ Pij .x/: (2.199iv) (2.199v) Remarks: (i) The expansion scalar .x/ provides the expansion (or contraction) of a material domain (or body) containing streamlines. (ii) The symmetric shear tensor ij .x/ represents change of the shape of a material body, without any change of 3-volume content. (Caution: ij is not to be confused with the nonrelativistic stress ˛ˇ of (2.38).) (iii) The vanishing of the antisymmetric vorticity tensor !ij .x/ 0 represents irrotational motions of stream lines. (In such a case, we can prove that a family of three-dimensional hypersurfaces exists such that U i .x/ @x@ i are unit normals [86, 257].) (iv) In the case where we have .x/ 0, ij .x/ 0, and !ij .x/ ¤ 0, the streamlines experience (relativistic) rigid motions. (See [86].) Now, we shall state and prove a theorem about UP i .x/; !ij .x/; ij .x/; .x/, and ij .x/ fields. Theorem 2.3.4. Let the various fields UP i .x/; !ij .x/; ij .x/; .x/, and ij .x/ be defined according to (2.199i–v) for x 2 D R4 . Then, the following identities hold: UP j .x/U j .x/ D !ij .x/U j .x/ D ij .x/U j .x/ D ij .x/U j .x/ 0I (2.200) rj Ui !ij .x/ C ij .x/ C .1=3/.x/ Pij .x/ UP i .x/Uj .x/: (2.201) Proof. Equation (2.200) follows from definitions (2.199i–v) and the identity P ij .x/ U j .x/ 0 in (2.198). The right-hand side of (2.201) yields R.H.S. D .1=2/ rj Ui ri Uj C UP i Uj UP j Ui C.1=2/ rj Ui C ri Uj C UP i Uj C UP j Ui UP i Uj rj Ui : Now, we shall derive the Raychaudhuri-Landau equation. (See [214, 215, 257].) 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 182 Theorem 2.3.5. Let the 4-velocity field U i .x/ @x@ i be of class C 2 in the domain D R4 . Then, the following differential equations hold: U j .x/rj D rj UP j C ! j k .x/ !j k .x/ j k .x/ j k .x/ .1=3/ Œ.x/2 C Rj k .x/ U j .x/ U k .x/; (2.202i) n d .X .s// D rj UP j C ! j k .x/ !j k .x/ j k .x/ j k .x/ ds o .1=3/ Œ.x/2 C Rj k .x/ U j .x/ U k .x/ ˇˇ i i : (2.202ii) x DX .s/ Proof. We start from the Ricci identity (1.145i) to express .rk rl rl rk / Uj D Rhj lk .x/ Uh .x/: Contracting with g j l .x/ U k .x/, we deduce that ˚ g j l U k rk rl Uj D g j l rl U k rk Uj rl U k rk Uj C Rhk U h U k D rj UP j r j U k rk Uj C Rhk U h U k : Now, we use (2.201) for rk Uj . Substituting this expression in the middle term of the last equation and simplifying, we derive (2.202i). Restricting (2.202i) into the i streamline given by dXds.s/ D U i .X .s//, we obtain the other equation (2.202ii). Remark: Equation (2.202ii) is called the Raychaudhuri-Landau equation, and it is very relevant in proving the singularity theorems which will be discussed briefly later in the book. Example 2.3.6. In this example, we deal with incoherent dust (pressureless fluid) characterized by T ij .x/ WD .x/U i .x/U j .x/; Ui .x/U i .x/ 1: (2.203) (See Example 2.1.11.) The proper mass density .x/ is assumed to be strictly positive. By the conservation equations (2.166i), we obtain that 0 D rj T ij D .x/U j .x/rj U i C U i .x/rj Multiplying the above by Ui .x/ and contracting, we get .1=2/ U j rj Ui U i C Ui U i rj D 0 rj or, rj Uj : (2.204) Uj U j D 0; U j D 0: (2.205) 2.3 General Properties of Tij 183 The above is the general relativistic continuity equation. Substituting (2.205) into (2.204) and dividing by .x/ > 0, we derive U j .x/rj U i DUP i .x/ D 0; U j .x/rj U i jx i DX i .s/ D D DU i .s/ ds (2.206i) (2.206ii) d2 X i .s/ dX j .s/ dX k .s/ i D 0: (2.206iii) C j k ˇˇ:: ds 2 ds ds Therefore, by (2.95ii), the streamlines follow timelike geodesics (as expected for a free pressureless fluid). Thus, the geodesic equations of motion of dust particles emerged from conservation equations ( which are consequences of the gravitational field equations (2.159i).) Now, supplementing the above condition of UP i .x/ D 0, we assume further that the dust particles are undergoing irrotational motion, that is, !ij .x/ 0: (2.207) The gravitational field equation (2.162i) yields, from (2.203), Rij .x/ D .x/Ui .x/Uj .x/ C .1=2/gij .x/ .x/ ; Rij .x/U i .x/U j .x/ D .=2/ .x/ < 0: (2.208) Substituting (2.206ii), (2.207), and (2.208) into (2.202ii), we derive, assuming j k .x/j k .x/ 0, that ˚ d./ D j k .x/j k .x/ C .1=3/Œ./2 C .=2/ .x/ jx i DX i .s/ < 0: (2.209) ds The above inequality demonstrates that the rate of expansion of the dust body (with particles following timelike geodesics) slows down with (proper) time. That fact proves the attractive aspects of gravitational forces. (Remarks: Consult # 5(ii) of Exercise 2.3 for the proof of j k .x/j k .x/ 0.) Now, we shall investigate the streamlines of a general material continuum. The energy–momentum–stress tensor is furnished by (2.196) and (2.197). The differential conservation equation (2.166i) yields 0 D rj T ij D rj U i U j S ij D U j rj U i C U i rj U j rj S ij : (2.210) Multiplying the above by Ui .x/ and using Ui .x/U i .x/ 1, we derive that rj U j C Ui rj S ij D 0: (2.211) 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 184 a U b U Γ Σ n U U U ∂Σ D Σ ∂D n U U EP field over ˙ Fig. 2.18 (a) shows a material world tube. (b) shows the continuous U Substituting the equation above into (2.210), we deduce that U j rj U i D ı ik C U i Uk rj S kj ; ŒX .s/ (2.212i) DU i .s/ D UP i j:: D P ik .x/ rj S kj j:: : ds (2.212ii) This expression provides the governing equations for the time evolution of streamlines. In Example 2.3.6 involving incoherent dust, we concluded that streamlines pursue timelike geodesics. The proof for this fact emerged just from the gravitational field equations. Research has been pursued on the question of motion of an extended isolated material body [79]. We shall now provide some insight into such a problem under simplified assumptions. We assume the usual field equations and junction conditions: Gij .x/ D 0 .x/Ui .x/Uj .x/ Sij .x/ inside D, outside D ; Gij .x/ nj .x/j@D D 0: (2.213i) (2.213ii) (See Fig. 2.18a.) We define another scalar field on @˙ by Œ˚.x/j@˙ WD .x/ni .x/UP i .x/ j@˙ : (2.214) Theorem 2.3.7. Let the world tube of a material continuum be contained in the domain D R4 . Let the field equations and the junction conditions (2.213i) and (2.213ii) hold. Moreover, let the timelike 4-velocity tangent vector field U i .x/ @x@ i 2.3 General Properties of Tij 185 E be of class C 1 and UP i .x/ @x@ i j@˙ ¤ O.x/ j@˙ . Furthermore, let the streamlines be irrotational so that !ij .x/ 0 in D. Then there exists at least one timelike continuous geodesic curve inside D. Proof. Irrotational motion implies the existence of a one-parameter family of orthogonal, three-dimensional hypersurfaces [86, 126, 257]. One of these hypersurfaces, ˙, is shown in both of Figs. 2.18a, b. Since the 4-acceleration UP i .x/ @x@ i is orthogonal to timelike 4-velocity vector U i .x/ @x@ i , it must be either the zero 4-vector or else a spacelike 4-vector inside ˙. Assuming .x/ > 0 in (2.213i), we conclude from (2.214) that sgn Œ˚.x/j@˙ D sgn ni .x/UP i .x/ j@˙ . By the E assumption UP i .x/ @x@ i j@˙ ¤ O.x/ j@˙ , we conclude that ˚.x/j@˙ ¤ 0. Therefore, either ˚.x/j@˙ > 0 or else ˚.x/j@˙ < 0. Assume that ˚.x/j@˙ > 0. (The case of ˚.x/j@˙ < 0 can be treated in a similar fashion.) Now, the condition ˚.x/j@˙ > 0 implies that the 4-vector UP i .x/ @x@ i j@˙ points outward everywhere on the continuous, piecewise-differentiable closed boundary curve on @˙. (See Fig. 2.18b.) It is clear that the winding number, or index, of the continuous 4-vector field UP i .x/ @x@ i j@˙ around the closed contour @˙ is exactly one. Therefore, the fixed-point theorem7 tells us that the 4-vector field UP .x/ @x@ i j˙ must be zero at an interior point of ˙. Since the world tube D contains a one-parameter family of spacelike hypersurfaces ˙, we have inside the world tube D, the image of a continuous curve of zero 4-acceleration, or a geodesic. Remarks: (i) The image of a curve inside the material tube need not be a stream line. (ii) A spinning body might not possess an interior geodesic. (See [46].) Q Example 2.3.8. Consider the 1-form U.x/ WD Ui .x/ dx i . Assume that it is a closed Q form, or, d U.x/ D O:: .x/. By (1.61), @i Uj @j Ui D 0. Thus, the vorticity tensor components !ij .x/ 0. By Theorem 1.2.21, there exists a differentiable function such that Ui .x/ D @i . The function must satisfy the Hamilton–Jacobi equation g ij .x/@i @j 1. (See Example A2.3.) The one-parameter spacelike hypersurfaces ˙ are provided by .x/ D k D const. A typical two-dimensional boundary is @˙ D ˙ \@D. Now, consider the equation N i .x/@i j@˙ D 0. Solving this underdetermined system, we arrive at a set of solutions: @ @ .@1 / 4 ; @x 1 @x @ @ / 2 .@2 / 4 ; @x @x E .1/ .x/ WD .@4 / N E .2/ .x/ WD .@4 N E./ for any point x on E E Let V./ be a continuous vector field defined on ˙ such that V./ ¤ 0 E @˙. If the index or winding number of V./ around @˙ is not zero, then there exists at least one E 0 / D E0.x0 / . (See [37].) x0 2 ˙ such that V.x 7 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 186 E .3/ .x/ WD .@4 / @ .@3 / @ ; N @x 3 @x 4 3 h i X nE .x/j@˙ D c ./ .x/NE./ .x/ ; j@˙ X Xh D1 j i c ./ .x/ c . / .x/ gij .x/N./ .x/N. / .x/ i j@˙ 1: The last algebraic equation is underdetermined and solution functions c ./ .x/ exist. By (2.214) and (2.199i), ˚.x/j@˙ D h i .x/ ˙ c ./ .x/N./ .x/ g j k .x/rk rj ri i ˇ : ˇ@˙ In case ˚.x/j@˙ ¤ 0, Theorem 2.3.7 asserts the existence of an interior geodesic. The complicated expression of ˚.x/ can be considerably reduced for a special case. We assume the metric may be cast in the form g:: .x/ D g˛ˇ .x/ dx ˛ ˝ dx ˇ C g44 .x/ dx 4 ˝ dx 4 ; ds 2 D g˛ˇ .x/ dx ˛ dx ˇ jg44 .x/j .dx 4 /2 : Moreover, we make a simple choice of ˙ as ˙W .x/ WD x 4 D k D const. Therefore, U˛ .x/ 0; U4 .x/ 1; g .x/Ui .x/Uj .x/ D g 44 .x/ 1; ij or, g44 .x/ 1: E ./ .x/ and n E .x/j@˙ satisfy The vectors N E ./ .x/ D @ ; N @x XX nE .x/j@˙ D X c ./ .x/ g .x/c ./ .x/c . / .x/ j@˙ 1: @ ; @x 2.3 General Properties of Tij 187 The function ˚.x/j@˙ reduces to " .x/ X # c ./ .x/ı i g j k .x/rk rj ri X j@˙ i D .x/ c .x/g .x/ 0 @i j " # X 4 ./ 0: D .x/ c .x/ 4 ˇ ˇ:: ./ j4 ˇ ˇ:: Therefore, streamlines on @˙ are all timelike geodesics. If we analyze the metric under consideration ds 2 D g˛ˇ .x/ dx ˛ dx ˇ .dx 4 /2 ; it turns out to be a geodesic normal coordinate chart. (Compare with (1.160).) Therefore, the streamlines coincide (inside and on the boundary of the whole domain D) with x 4 -coordinate curves, which are all timelike geodesics. We have defined and discussed in Theorem 2.1.10, the total 4-momentum of an extended body in flat space–time. We would like to generalize those definitions for curved space–time. We can still use the Fig. 2.7 for the present purpose. The main difficulty in this endeavor is the problem of tensor transformations for a spatial integral under a general coordinate transformation in (1.2) and (1.37). The only logical choice is to express these integrals as tensorially invariant entities. We start from four conservation equations (2.166i) explicitly stated as E rj T ij D 0. We introduce an additional differentiable vector field V.x/ satisfying 2rj T ij Vi DT ij .x/ rj Vi C ri Vj D 0 (2.215i) or G ij .x/ rj Vi C ri Vj D0: (2.215ii) The above equation (2.215ii) generalizes the Killing vector equations (1.171iii). E The existence of each of the vector fields V.x/, satisfying (2.215i), gives rise to a conserved integral. Before we prove such a statement, consider the material world tube in Fig. 2.19. (Compare with Fig. 2.7.) Now we shall state and prove the following theorem on integral conservations. Theorem 2.3.9. Let the components T ij .x/ of the differentiable energy-momentum-stress tensor field be nonzero inside the domain D of the world tube and vanish outside. Let the nonnull boundary @D WD @D.3/ [ ˙.0/ [ ˙ be continuous, piecewise-differentiable, orientable, and closed. Moreover, let the junction 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 188 Fig. 2.19 A doubly sliced world tube of an isolated, extended material body Σ V n D ∂(3)D ∂(3)D Σ(0) conditions T ij .x/nj .x/[email protected]/ D 0 hold. Furthermore, let a differentiable vector field E V.x/ exist inside D satisfying (2.215ii). Then, there exists an invariant, conserved integral: Z T ij .x/Vj .x/ni .x/ j˙ d3 v D const: P WD (2.216) ˙ Proof. Applying Gauss’ Theorem 1.3.27, and the differential equation (2.215i), we obtain Z Z 0 D ri T ij Vj d4 v D T ij Vj ni j@D d3 v D @D Z D Z T Vj ni j˙.0/ d v C ij 3 ˙.0/ or, Z T Vj ni j˙ d v C ij 3 ˙ @D.3/ Z Z T ij Vj ni j˙ d3 v C 0 D ˙ T ij Vj ni [email protected]/ d3 v: T ij Vj ni j˙.0/ d3 v ˙.0/ D const. Consider the scenario where the space–time domain D has some symmetries, or, E admits groups of motion. Then, there will exist some Killing vector K.x/ satisfying rj Ki C ri Kj D 0. (See (1.171iii).) Therefore, in a domain with symmetry, one E E possible solution of (2.215i) is V.x/ D K.x/. 2.3 General Properties of Tij 189 Example 2.3.10. Consider the flat space–time and a global Minkowskian chart with gij .x/ D dij . It is mentioned in p. 135 that there exist ten Killing vector fields furnished by @ i E .A/ .x/ WD ı.A/ ; K @x i (2.217i) @ i E .A/.B/.x/ WD d.A/i ı j x i @ d.B/j ı.A/ xj i ; K .B/ j @x @x (2.217ii) Here, A; B 2 f1; 2; 3; 4g are just labels. (We still use the summation convention for capital Roman indices.) According to (2.216), there exist the following ten conserved invariant integrals: Z P.A/ D Z J.A/.B/ WD d.A/i T ij .x/nj .x/ j˙ d3 v; (2.218i) ˙ d.A/k d.B/j ˚ x j T ki .x/ x k T j i .x/ ni .x/ j˙ d3 v: (2.218ii) ˙ (Compare the equations above with (2.49) and (2.50).) Consider a constant-valued Lorentz transformation given by [55] b E E .A/ D l .B/ K K .A/ .B/ .x/; l .A/ .B/ d.A/.C / l l .4/ 1: .4/ .C / .E/ D d.B/.E/ ; (2.219) (This class of transformation is known as orthochronus.) Note that for constantb .A/ E .A/ .x/ is also a Killing vector field. valued l .B/ , the transformed vector K Therefore, by (2.217i), (2.218i), and (2.219), we derive transformation rules: b .A/ D l .B/ P.B/ : P .A/ Thus, we identify invariant constants P.A/’s and J.A/.B/’s as components of the total 4-momentum and the total relativistic angular momentum of an extended material body. Example 2.3.11. Assume that T ij .x/ has an invariant eigenvalue .x/ ¤ 0 satisfying T ij .x/ej .x/ D .x/e i .x/. Moreover, assume that Vj .x/ D .x/ej .x/; .x/ ¤ 0: 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 190 Equation (2.215i) yields 0 D T ij ri ej C .ri / ej D ri T ij ej C .ri / .e i / D ri e i C e i ri C .e i / ri : or, e i ri .ln jj/ C .rj e j / C e j rj .ln jj/ D 0: The above equation is a linear, first-order p.d.e. with the unknown function ln j.x/j. By the discussions in Appendix 2, especially by the equations in (A2.13), solutions of this equation exist in principle. Therefore, the corresponding conserved integral is Z P WD .x/.x/e i .x/ni .x/ j˙ d3 v: ˙ Now, we shall investigate the generalization (2.215i,ii) of Killing vector equation (1.171iii). A very general class of solutions of (2.215i,ii) is furnished by8 G ij .x/Vj .x/ D T ij .x/Vj .x/ D r i h C rj Aij ; h ri r i h D 0; Aj i .x/ Aij .x/: (2.220) Here, the scalar wave field h.x/ and the antisymmetric field Aij .x/ are of class C 2 and otherwise arbitrary. There are infinitely many solutions in (2.220). The physical implications of the solutions (2.220) are not obvious. 8 E 1. The Helmotz theorem [159] on differentiable vector field W.x/ in a three-dimensional domain allows the decomposition W ˛ .x/ D r ˛ h C ˛ˇ .x/ r Aˇ rˇ A˛ : 2. For a closed, differential p-form of (1.58), the Hodge decomposition theorem [104] asserts that Wi1 ;:::;ip .x/ dx i1 ^ : : : ^ dx ip D hi1 ;:::;ip .x/ dx i1 ^ : : : ^ dx ip C d ˛i1 ;:::;ip1 .x/ dx i1 ^ : : : ^ dx ip1 ; rj r j hi1 ;:::;ip D 0: 2.3 General Properties of Tij 191 Exercises 2.3 1. Consider the flat metric in double-null coordinates of Example 2.1.17. In a similar fashion, the metric can be expressed as ds 2 D dij dx i dx j D .dx 1 /2 C .dx 2 /2 C .dx 3 dx 4 /.dx 3 C dx 4 / 1 2 2 2 C db x C 2 db x 3 db x 4 DW ij db x i db xj: DW db x Consider an energy–momentum–stress tensor matrix Tij .x0 / of Segre class Œ1; 3. Show that the transformed energy–momentum–stress tensor matrix 2 .1/ h i 6 0 bij .b T x 0 / WD 6 4 0 0 0 .2/ 1 0 0 1 0 .2/ 3 0 0 7 7 .2/ 5 0 remains of Segre class Œ1; 3 (for .1/ ¤ .2/ ). Moreover, prove that 2 3the invariant 0 triple eigenvector with respect to ij 607 7 is along the null direction 6 405, t ¤ 0. t 2. Let the matrix T.a/.b/ .x0 / admit a timelike eigenvector U .b/ .x0 / satisfying T.a/.b/ .x0 /U .b/ .x0 / D .x0 /U.a/ .x0 /, d.a/.b/ U .a/ .x0 /U .b/ .x0 / D 1. Consider the case that every invariant eigenvalue of T.a/.b/ .x0 / is real. Prove that the matrix belongs to the Type-I of (2.179). 3. Prove Theorem 2.3.2. 4. (i) Let a projection tensor be defined as: P ij .x/ WD ı ij ".v/V i .x/Vj .x/; Vi V j D ".v/ D ˙1: Show that P ik .x/P kj .x/ D P ij .x/. (ii) Deduce that the invariant eigenvalues of Pij .x/ are exactly zero and one. 5. (i) Derive that g ij .x/ij .x/ D d .a/.b/.a/.b/ .x/ 0. (ii) Prove that !ij .x/ ! ij .x/ 0 and ij .x/ ij .x/ 0. 6. Show that in the case of vanishing expansion, .x/ 0, and shear tensor ij .x/ dx i ˝dx j O:: .x/, the Lie derivative of the projection tensor P:: .x/ WD gij .x/ C Ui .x/Uj .x/ dx i ˝ dx j reduces to LUE ŒP:: .x/ O:: .x/. 7. Deduce that U k rk rl Uj C rj Ul D rl UP j C rj UP l i h !j k C jk UP k Uj !kl C kl UP k Ul 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 192 !l k C lk UP k Ul !kj C kj UP k Uj C Rhj lk C Rhlj k U h U k : 8. Consider a domain of material continuum with T ij .x/ D .x/U i .x/U j .x/ S ij .x/, Ui .x/U i .x/ 1. Prove that along a streamline, the rate of change of the proper mass density is given by d ŒX .s/ D .x/ .ri U i / C Ui .x/ rj S ij j:: : ds 9. Consider the material world tube depicted in Fig. 2.18a. Let the 4-acceleration spacelike vector on the boundary be given by UP i .x/j@˙ D C i D const.; jC 1 j C jC 2 j C jC 3 j > 0: EP is continuous in ˙ [ @˙, In the case where the 4-acceleration vector field U determine whether or not there exists a geodesic inside the world tube. 10. An anti-de Sitter space–time domain (of constant negative curvature) is characterized by the metric (with cosmological constant set equal to 3 for notational convenience, since this corresponds to a radius of curvature of 1): g:: .x/ WD 1 C .x 1 /2 1 dx 1 ˝ dx 1 C .x 1 /2 dx 2 ˝ dx 2 C .x 1 /2 .sin x 2 /2 dx 3 ˝ dx 3 1 C .x 1 /2 dx 4 ˝ dx 4 ; ds 2 D .1 C r 2 /1 dr 2 C r 2 d 2 C sin2 d' 2 .1 C r 2 / dt 2 : Prove that the following conserved integrals, representing the total energy and total “angular momentum components,” respectively, exist: Z P.t / WD Z T 44 ./.1 C r 2 / r 2 sin dr d d' D const. ; D.t / sin ' T 24 ./ C sin cos cos ' T 34 ./ r 4 sin dr d d'; J.1/ WD D.t / Z J.2/ WD cos ' T 24 ./ sin cos sin ' T 34 ./ r 4 sin dr d d'; D.t / Z J.3/ WD T 34 ./ r 4 sin3 dr d d': D.t / 2.3 General Properties of Tij 193 Answers and Hints to Selected Exercises 1. The 4 4 matrix to be investigated is given by: 2 3 .1/ 0 0 0 i h 6 7 1 0 0 .2/ 7: b T ij .b x 0 / ij WD 6 4 0 1 0 .2/ 5 0 0 .2/ 0 2. From (2.196) and (2.197), S.a/.b/ WD .x0 / U.a/ .x0 / U.b/ .x0 / T.a/.b/.x0 /, S.a/.b/ .x0 / U .b/ .x0 / D 0. Let .x0 / be a real, nonzero invariant eigenvalue so that S.a/.b/.x0 / e.b/ .x0 / D .x0 / e.a/ .x0 /. Therefore, .x0 / Œe.a/ .x0 / U .a/ .x0 / D ŒS.a/.b/ .x0 / U .a/ .x0 / e.b/ .x0 / D 0. Thus, for .x0 / ¤ 0, the corresponding eigenvector e.a/ .x0 / is spacelike and orthogonal to U .a/ .x0 /. In case S.a/.b/ .x0 / has three nonzero invariant eigenvalues, there exist three spacelike eigenvectors orthogonal to U .a/ .x0 /. Thus, T .a/.b/ .x0 / D .x0 / U .a/ .x0 / U .b/ .x0 / C 3 X .a/ .b/ ./ .x0 / e./ e./ : D1 Therefore, ŒTab .x0 / is of Type-I (even if some or all of ./ .x0 / D 0.) 4. (i) h i ı ik ".v/U i Uk ı kj ".v/U k Uj D ı ij C .1 1 C 1/ ".v/ U i Uj : 5. (ii) Consider the vector field transformation equations b i .x/ @X b i .b U x/ D U j .x/: @x j Choosing three spatial equations from above, investigate b ˛ .b 0DU x / D U j .x/ b ˛ .x/ @X : @x j Considering the equations above as linear, first-order, partial differential b ˛ .x/ conclude that solutions exist equations for unknown functions, X b i .b locally. (See Appendix 2.) In new coordinates, the condition U x/ h i2 i 4 b .b b .b U x / 1 yields b g 44 .b x/ U x / 1. Therefore, b g 44 .b x / < 0 and b 4 .b b 4 .b U x / ¤ 0. (The choice U x / > 0 is the usual one.) Such coordinates constitute a comoving coordinate chart. Choosing the orthonormal tetrad 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 194 n o 1 eE.1/ ; eE.2/ ; eE.3/ ; Œjg44 j 2 ı i.4/ @i , the components b ! .˛/.4/ .b x / 0. Thus, !ij .x/ ! ij .x/ D b ! .a/.b/ .b x/ b ! .a/.b/ .b x/ D b ! .˛/.ˇ/ .b x/ b ! .˛/.ˇ/ .b x/ C 0 o n 2 2 2 0: x/ C b ! .2/.3/ .b x/ C b ! .3/.1/ .b x/ D2 b ! .1/.2/ .b 7. By the Ricci identity (1.145i), obtain .rk rl rl rk / Uj D Rhj lk U h ; U k rk rl Uj D rl UP j rl U k rk Uj C Rhj lk U h U k : 8. Use (2.211). EP 9. The winding number or the index of U.x/ around @˙ is exactly zero. There P E E exist no x0 2 ˙ such that U.x0 / D 0.x0 /. 10. There exist ten generators for the Killing vector fields [129]. Out of these, for the present problem, the following four are relevant (with cosmological constant set equal to 3): E .t / ./ WD @ ; K @t E .1/ ./ WD sin ' @ C cot cos ' @ ; K @ @' E .2/ ./ WD cos ' @ cot sin ' @ ; K @ @' E .3/ ./ WD @ : K @' E E ./ ./ in (2.216). Substitute the above vectors for V.x/ DK Remark: The remaining Killing vectors for the anti-de Sitter space–time (again with cosmological constant set equal to 3) are the following: E .4/ ./ WD r sin.t/ sin cos ' .1 C r 2 / 12 @ K @t 1 @ C .1 C r 2 / 2 cos.t/ sin cos ' @r sin ' @ 1 @ ; C r 1 .1 C r 2 / 2 cos.t/ cos cos ' @ sin @' 2.4 Solution Strategies, Classification, and Initial-Value Problems 195 E .5/ ./ WD r sin.t/ sin sin ' .1 C r 2 / 12 @ K @t @ 1 C .1 C r 2 / 2 cos.t/ sin sin ' @r cos ' @ @ 1 2 12 C ; C r .1 C r / cos.t/ cos sin ' @ sin @' E .6/ ./ WD r sin.t/ cos .1 C r 2 / 12 @ K @t 1 1 @ @ r 1 .1 C r 2 / 2 cos.t/ sin ; C .1 C r 2 / 2 cos.t/ cos @r @ E .7/ ./ WD r cos.t/ sin cos ' .1 C r 2 / 12 @ K @t @ 1 C .1 C r 2 / 2 sin.t/ sin cos ' @r @ sin ' @ 1 2 12 C r .1 C r / sin.t/ cos cos ' ; @ sin @' E .8/ ./ WD r cos.t/ sin sin ' .1 C r 2 / 12 @ K @t 1 @ C .1 C r 2 / 2 sin.t/ sin sin ' @r cos ' @ 1 @ ; C r 1 .1 C r 2 / 2 sin.t/ cos sin ' @ sin @' E .9/ ./ WD r cos.t/ cos .1 C r 2 / 12 @ K @t 1 1 @ @ r 1 .1 C r 2 / 2 sin.t/ sin : C .1 C r 2 / 2 sin.t/ cos @r @ 2.4 Solution Strategies, Classification, and Initial-Value Problems Let us consider a differentiable coordinate transformation (1.2) in a regular domain D R4 : b i .x/; b xi D X b g ij .b x/ D x / @X l .b x/ @X k .b gkl .x/ : i j @b x @b x (2.221) 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 196 We pose four reasonable coordinate conditions or, b g ij .b Cm b x / D 0; k @X .b x / @X l .b x/ b Cm g .x/ D 0: kl @b xi @b xj (2.222i) (2.222ii) The four nonlinear partial differential equations in (2.222ii), for the four unknown functions X k .b x /, will locally admit solutions. (See Appendix 2.) That is why, in a four-dimensional pseudo-Riemannian (or Riemannian) manifold, coordinate charts exist which admit at most four (reasonable) coordinate conditions.9 We recapitulate Einstein’s interior field equations (2.161i), (2.166i), and differential identities (2.167i): Eij .x/ WD Gij .x/ C Tij .x/ D 0; T .x/ WD rj T i ij D 0; rj E ij T i .x/: (2.223i) (2.223ii) (2.223iii) As in p. 164, we count the number of unknown functions versus the number of independent equations (without including coordinate conditions). No. of unknown functions: .10gij / C 10.Tij / D 20: No. of differential equations: 10.Eij D 0/ C 4.T i D 0/ D 14: No. of differential identities: 4.rj E ij T i 0/ D 4: No. of independent equations: 14 4 D 10: The system of semilinear, second- and first-order partial differential equations (2.223i,ii) is definitely underdetermined. We are allowed to prescribe ten out of twenty unknown functions to make the system determinate. We can make such choices in 11 distinct ways. Remarks: (i) In strategy-I, ten functions of Tij .x/ are prescribed and ten functions of gij .x/ are treated as unknown. It is the most difficult strategy mathematically. However, from the perspective of physics, it is the most useful. This method is sometimes called the T -method [243]. (ii) In strategy-II, ten functions of gij .x/ are prescribed and ten functions of Tij .x/ WD ./1 Gij .x/ are treated as unknown. Thus, mathematically, it is 9 In an N -dimensional domain, at most N (reasonable), coordinate conditions hold. Therefore, a two-dimensional metric can be locally reduced to a conformally flat form. A three-dimensional metric can be locally brought to an orthogonal form. However, coordinates may not orthogonal Cm b g ij b x D 0 are not tensor field exist in dimensions N > 3. The coordinate conditions b equations. 2.4 Solution Strategies, Classification, and Initial-Value Problems 197 the simplest method. Although energy conditions (2.190) or (2.191) or (2.192) may be difficult to satisfy, there may arise occasion when this strategy is useful. This method is sometimes called the g-method [243]. (iii) In strategy-III there exist nine mixed methods [18] where 10 s of functions among the Tij .x/ and s of the metric functions are prescribed for 1 s 9. Moreover, 10 s functions among the gij .x/ and s functions among the Tij .x/ are treated as unknown. (iv) In the case of the vacuum field equations (2.159i), the addition of the four coordinate conditions C i .gkl ; @l gj k / D 0, makes the system determinate. (v) In the case when the space–time domain has some symmetries (or admits groups of motions), the counting has to be completely revised, as the symmetries impose extra conditions. The general scheme, however, remains the same. We will address some specific cases in later sections. It should be noted that there is a relation among the coordinate conditions C i .gkl ; @l gj k / D 0 and the prescription of metric functions gij .x/. In case four coordinate conditions are imposed, the above strategies undergo revisions. Example 2.4.1. We shall furnish an example of the g-method. Let the metric tensor components be prescribed as gij .x/ WD dkl @f k .x/ @f l .x/ : @x i @x j (2.224) Here, four prescribed functions f k .x/ are of class C 4 . By (1.161), the space–time domain is flat. Therefore, Tij .x/ WD ./1 Gij .x/ 0: Thus, the choice (2.224) of gij .x/ has annihilated the possibility of material sources completely. Another example of the g-method has been given in Example 2.2.9. Example 2.4.2. In the domain of consideration, we choose four coordinate conditions as g˛4 .x/ 0 and g44 .x/ 1. Thus, the metric is expressible as g:: .x/ D g˛ˇ .x/ dx ˛ ˝ dx ˇ dx 4 ˝ dx 4 ; ds 2 D g˛ˇ .x/ dx ˛ dx ˇ .dx 4 /2 : (2.225) This is the geodesic normal or Gaussian normal coordinate chart of (1.160). On the three-dimensional spacelike hypersurface characterized by x 4 D T , the intrinsic metric is furnished by (2.225) as g:: .x; T / D g˛ˇ .x; T / dx ˛ ˝ dx ˇ DW g ˛ˇ .x; T / dx ˛ ˝ dx ˇ : (2.226) Here, we have a slight difference of notation with (1.223). (Compare (A1.35i) and (A1.35ii).) 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 198 ˛ The Gauss’ equations (1.242i) in this example (with notations A ./ WD ˛ˇ A ./) yield the following equations: g ./Aˇ ./ and rˇ A˛ WD @ˇ A˛ ˛ˇ R DR C K K DR C K K 1 @4 g @4 g 4 @4 g @4 g I (2.227) 1 ˛ @4 @4 g K K C 2K K˛ 2 1 2 ˛ˇ C g K 3K K C g @4 @4 g ˛ˇ 2 G D G 1 1 1 @4 @4 g g @4 g @4 g C g ˛ˇ @4 g ˇ g ˛ 2 4 2 h1 2 3 C g g @4 g g ˛ˇ g @4 g ˛ @4 g ˇ 8 8 i 1 C g @4 @4 g D T I (2.228) 2 D G h i G4 D @ K r K D 1 @ g 2 1 R 2 1 D R 2 G44 D @4 g 1 r @4 g D T4 I 2 1 2 1 K C K K 2 2 2 1 1 g @4 g C g g 8 8 D T44 : @4 g @4 g (2.229) (2.230) In this strategy, we prescribe six T˛ˇ ./ and define T44 WD ./1 G44 and T4 WD ./1 G4 . Moreover, we solve ten differential equations (2.228) and T i D 0 for six unknown functions g ˛ˇ ./. (In these ten differential equations, there exist four differential identities.) Thus, this strategy is mathematically simpler than Strategy-I (the T -method). In this method, energy condition iT44 .x; T / 0 depends on the sign of h the main 2 1 1 1 the expression 2 R 2 K C 2 K K . The field equation (2.230) is supposed to be a refinement on Poisson’s equation (2.157i) of the Newtonian potential W .x/. Therefore, the Newtonian potential must be well hidden in the six metric components g ˛ˇ .x; T /! 2.4 Solution Strategies, Classification, and Initial-Value Problems 199 The six field equations (2.228) happen to be subtensor field equations [55, 244]. These are covariant under the (restricted) transformations of spatial coordinates alone. Let us go back to the system of the first- and second-order semilinear partial differential equations (2.223i, ii) representing field equations. The most general solutions of the system will involve 24 arbitrary functions of integration! Out of these 24 functions, four arbitrary functions can be absorbed by coordinate functions. The most general solutions of the vacuum field equations contain 20 arbitrary functions of integration. These arbitrary functions can be adjusted to match the prescribed initial-boundary value problems. Example 2.4.3. Consider the space–time domain corresponding to ˚ D WD x W a < x 1 < b; x 2 2 R; x 3 > 2; x 4 2 R : We investigate the vacuum field equations Rij .x/ D 0 in this domain. A class of (nonflat) general solutions, [3, 205], is furnished by h i g:: .x/ WD ln jx 3 j exp F .x 1 / dx 1 ˝ dx 1 2 h i C x 3 exp 2˛.x 2 / dx 2 ˝ dx 2 C dx 3 ˝ dx 3 h i C exp 2ˇ.x 4 / dx 1 ˝ dx 4 C dx 4 ˝ dx 1 ; or, 2 2 2 h i h i ds 2 D ln jx 3 j exp F .x 1 / dx 1 C x 3 exp 2˛.x 2 / dx 2 2 h i C dx 3 C 2 exp 2ˇ.x 4 / dx 1 dx 4 ; o n D WD .x 1 ; x 2 ; x 3 ; x 4 / W 1 < x 1 < 1; 1 < x 2 < 1; 0 < x 3 ; 1 < x 4 < 1 : Here, F .x/; ˛.x 2 /, and ˇ.x 4 / are assumed to be arbitrary functions of class C 2 . The arbitrary functions ˛.x 2 / and ˇ.x 4 / can be absorbed by the coordinate transformation: Z 2 b x1 D x1 ; b x 2 D e˛.x / dx 2 ; xb3 D x 3 ; Z b x D 4 4 e2ˇ.x / dx 4 : 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 200 Thus, the vacuum solution involving one arbitrary function is given by 1 2 3 2 2 2 ds 2 D ln jb x 3 j exp F .b x 1 / db x C b x db x C 2 db x 1 db x4 : The “initial-value problem” x/ @b g 11 .b ˇ b g 11 0;b x 2 ;b x 3 ;b x4 D D ln jb x3j 1 @b x ˇ.0;b x 2 ;b x 3 ;b x4/ yields one possible metric (not involving arbitrary functions) as x 1 1 2 3 2 2 2 3 2 ds 2 D ln jb x 3 j eb db x C b x db x C db x C 2 db x 1 db x4: The classification of a semilinear (or a quasi-linear) second-order partial differential equation has been discussed in Appendix 2 after (A2.44). The classification of a system of first-order, semilinear (or quasi-linear) partial differential equations has been touched upon in (A2.51). (For a detailed treatment, we refer to the book by Courant and Hilbert [43].) To illustrate briefly, we deal with a couple of toy models in the following: Example 2.4.4. Consider a domain of the flat space–time and the wave equation V D d ij @i @j V D 0: (2.231) (See Problem # 4 of Exercise 2.1.) By the discussions after (A2.44), it is clear that (2.231) is hyperbolic. The second-order, linear p.d.e. (2.231) is equivalent to the following system of four first-order p.d.e.s: @4 !˛ @˛ !4 D 0; (2.232i) d @i !j D 0; (2.232ii) !j D @j V: (2.232iii) ij (Compare with (A2.48).) We can combine (2.232ii) and (2.232i) into the following form: ij k @k !j D 0; 1j k WD d j k ; 21 4 D 32 4 D 43 4 WD 1; 24 1 D 34 2 D 44 3 WD 1 I otherwise, ij k 0: (2.233) (Here, the index j is also summed.) Compare (2.233) with (A2.49). Caution: The components ij k are not tensorial. 2.4 Solution Strategies, Classification, and Initial-Value Problems 201 The characteristic matrix of (2.233) is provided by 2 h ij WD ij k @k 44 i @1 @2 @3 @4 6 D6 0 0 @1 6 @4 4 0 @4 0 @2 0 0 @4 @3 3 7 7 7 5 detŒij D .@4 /2 .@1 /2 C .@2 /2 C .@3 /2 .@4 /2 D .@4 /2 d ij @i @j : (2.234) (See (2.51).) Therefore, for the case @4 ¤ 0, the equation detŒij D 0 yields the characteristic (three-dimensional ) hypersurfaces governed by d ij @i @j D 0: (2.235) By the criteria in [43], the system (2.233) is hyperbolic. The p.d.e. (2.235) stands for a null hypersurface (like a null cone). (Shock waves of the wave equation (2.231) travel along such a hypersurface [43].) Example 2.4.5. Consider the analogous problem in a domain of the fourdimensional Euclidean manifold. A harmonic function V .x/ satisfies the potential equation: (2.236) ı ij @i @j V D 0: The equivalent first-order system is furnished by ijk @k !j D 0: (Here, we have set !j D @j V .) The characteristic matrix is provided by 2 3 @4 ij D @1 @2 @3 6 7 6 @4 44 0 0 @1 7 6 7: 4 0 @4 0 @2 5 0 0 @4 @3 (2.237) (2.238) The equation for the characteristic criterion is: detŒij D .@4 /2 .@1 /2 C .@2 /2 C .@3 /2 C .@4 /2 D 0: (2.239) Therefore, for the case @4 ¤ 0, the solutions are given by .x/ D k D const. There exists no nondegenerate characteristic hypersurface. The system (2.237) is called elliptic [43]. (The harmonic function V .x/ must be real-analytic.) 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 202 Example 2.4.6. Now, we shall classify gravitational field equations (2.223i). We use harmonic coordinates (or the harmonic gauge) to simplify calculations. (Recall the harmonic coordinate chart as introduced in Problem #10 of Exercise 2.2.) The corresponding field equations are given by g kl .x/ @k @l g ij 2 i kp j g kl .x/ g pq .x/ lq 2 T ij .x/ 12 g ij .x/T kk .x/ inside material sources; (2.240) 0 outside material sources: D Now, let us obtain a system of first-order quasi-linear p.d.e.s which is equivalent ij to the second-order system in (2.240). Following Example 2.4.4, and putting ! k D ij @k g , we arrive at the following system of 40 equations: ij ji ! k .x/ ! k .x/; @˛ ! ij 4 @4 ! ij˛ D 0; ij g kl @k ! l hij .g kl ; ! klp / D 2 T ij 12 g ij T kk inside; 0 outside: (2.241) 3 g 4k @k @1 7 7: @2 5 @3 (2.242) We define the 4 4 submatrix as Œ DŒ 44 k ij @k WD 2 g 1k @k 6 @4 6 4 0 0 g 2k @k 0 @4 0 g 3k @k 0 0 @4 The characteristic matrix and its determinant for the system (2.241) are furnished by 3 2 Œ WD 6 7 7 6 4040 7 6 7 6 7 6 7 6 0 7 6 7 6 7 6 7; 6 (2.243i) 7 6 7 6 7 6 0 7 6 7 6 7 6 7 6 7 6 5 4 detŒ D .@4 /2 .g ij @i @j / 10 : (2.243ii) 2.4 Solution Strategies, Classification, and Initial-Value Problems 203 x4 D(t1) D D(t) x3 x2 D(0) x1 Fig. 2.20 Domain D WD D.0/ .0; t1 / R4 for the initial-value problem In the case @4 ¤ 0, the equation detŒ D 0 yields g ij .x/ @i @j D 0: (2.244) Above is the governing equation for a three-dimensional null hypersurface in the space–time metric of signature C2. Obviously, the system (2.241) is hyperbolic. We shall now explore the initial-value problem (or the Cauchy problem) of gravitational field equations (2.159i). However, we firstly examine a toy model of one hyperbolic p.d.e., namely, the usual wave equation: ri r i V D 0: (2.245) Let the domain of validity D WD D.0/ .0; t1 / have one boundary D.0/ as the initial hypersurface x 4 D 0. (See Fig. 2.20.) The corresponding Cauchy-Kowalewski theorem is stated below: Theorem 2.4.7. Let metric components g ij .x/ be real analytic with g 44 .x/ < 0 in a space–time domain D WD D.0/ .0; t1 / R4 with one boundary at x 4 D 0. Moreover, let this boundary hypersurface contain the origin .0; 0; 0; 0/. Furthermore, let D.0/ be the projection of D onto the hypersurface x 4 D 0. Given real-analytic functions f .x/ and h.x/ in x 2 D.0/ , there exists a half-neighborhood NıC .0; 0; 0; 0/ with a unique solution V .x/ of theh partial idifferential equation (2.245) such that lim V .x; x 4 / D f .x/ and lim x 4 !0C For the proof, consult [43]. x 4 !0C @V .x;x 4 / @x 4 D h.x/. 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 204 As a preliminary to the investigation of initial-value problems for general relativity, we state the following Lichnerowicz-Synge lemma [166, 243]: Lemma 2.4.8. Consider gravitational field equations (2.223i,ii) in a domain D WD D.0/ .0; t1 /. Then, the following two statements are mathematically equivalent: .A/ Eij .x/ D 0 .B/ E˛ˇ .x/ and rj E ij D 0 with E 4i .x; 0/ D 0 in x 2 D: (2.246i) 1 g˛ˇ .x/ E ii .x/ D 0 2 (2.246ii) x2D (2.246iii) for x 2 D.0/ : (2.246iv) in For the proof, see [243]. Now, we shall state and prove a theorem on the solution of the initial-value problem in general relativity. Theorem 2.4.9. Let the energy–momentum–stress tensor components Tij .x/ and metric tensor components gij .x/ be real analytic with g44 .x/ < 0 in a space–time domain D WD D.0/ .0; t1 / R4 with one boundary hypersurface at x 4 D 0. Given # 30 real-analytic functions, gij# .x/; ij .x/, T˛ˇ .x/, and i .x/ D T4i# .x/ for x 2 D.0/ be prescribed. Moreover, let the initial constraints G 4i .x/ C T 4i .x/ jx 4 D0 D 0 hold. Then, there exist 20 unique solutions gij .x/ and Tij .x/ of the field equations Eij .x/ D 0 in D.0/ .0; t1 / such that lim gij .x/ D gij# .x/, lim @4 gij D ij .x/, lim T˛ˇ .x/ D x 4 !0C x 4 !0C # T˛ˇ .x/, and lim Ti 4 .x/ D i .x/. x 4 !0C x 4 !0C Proof. Instead of using (2.246i), we use the equivalent equations (2.246ii), (2.246iii), and (2.246iv). Moreover, instead of using the T -method of p. 197, we use a mixed method of the p. 197 to solve the field equations. Therefore, by Example 2.4.2, we make use of geodesic normal coordinates (2.225) yielding g:: .x/ D g ˛ˇ .x/ dx ˛ ˝ dx ˇ dx 4 ˝ dx 4 : Moreover, we prescribe T˛ˇ .x/ in D and solve for g ˛ˇ .x/ and Ti 4 .x/ from (2.246ii–iv). The field equations (2.246ii) and (2.246iii) yield, respectively, 1 1 @4 @4 g g @4 g @4 g C R .x/ 2 4 1 ˛ˇ C T g g T˛ˇ T44 D 0; 2 i ˛ @4 Tj 4 .x/ D @˛ T j .x/ C T kj .x/ ik 1 ˛ˇ g @4 g ˛ @4 g 2 ˇ (2.247i) k T ik .x/: ij (2.247ii) 2.4 Solution Strategies, Classification, and Initial-Value Problems 205 From (2.247i,ii), we derive the following string of partial differential equations by successive differentiations: 1 @4 @4 g .x/ D 2R .x/ g @4 g @4 g C g ˛ˇ @4 g ˛ @4 g 2 1 ˛ˇ C 2 T .x/ g g T˛ˇ T44 ; 2 @4 @4 @4 g D @4 f : : : : : : : : : : : : : : g; :: : :: : ˇ (2.248i) :: : :: : i k T kj .x/ T ik .x/; ik ij @4 Tj 4 .x/ D @˛ T ˛j .x/ C @4 @4 Tj 4 .x/ D @4 f : : : : : : : : : : : : : : g; :: : :: : (2.248ii) :: : :: : Now, we prescribe 16 real-analytic initial values # g ˛ˇ .x; 0/ D g˛ˇ .x/; @4 g ˛ˇ .x/jx 4 D0 D ˛ˇ .x/ # 2K˛ˇ .x/; Tj 4 .x; 0/ D j .x/: (2.249) The field equations (2.248i,ii) yield on the initial hypersurface x 4 D 0, 1 @4 @4 g jx 4 D0 D 2R# .x/ g # .x/ 2 C g #˛ˇ .x/ ˛ .x/ .x/ .x/ 1 # #˛ˇ # # # g .x/ C 2 T T T g ˇ ˇ ˛ˇ 44 2 ˇx 4 D0 D (initial values); @4 @4 @4 g jx 4 D0 D (initial values); :: :: : : :: :: : : (2.250i) @4 Tj 4 jx 4 D0 D (initial values) @4 @4 Tj 4 jx 4 D0 D (initial values) :: : :: : :: : :: : (2.250ii) 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 206 The prescribed functions in (2.249) have to satisfy partial differential equations (2.246iv) on the initial hypersurface. These are explicitly provided by: or, @˛ g # .x/ .x/ r # Œ ˛ .x/ C 2 ˛ .x/ D 0; h i @˛ K # .x/ r # ŒK˛ .x/ C ˛ .x/ D 0; and R# .x/ or, 1 # 1 # 2 g C g g # C 2 4 .x/ D 0; 4 4 h i2 R# .x/ K # .x/ C K # .x/ K # .x/ C 2 4 .x/ D 0: (2.251) (Here, K# .x/ are components of the extrinsic curvature as given in (1.251).) Assuming that (2.251) is satisfied, the corresponding Taylor series are expressed as: 1 4 2 x @4 @4 g ˛ˇ jx 4 D0 C ; 2 1 4 2 x @4 @4 T4j jx 4 D0 C : (2.252) T4j .x/ D j .x/ C x 4 @4 T4j jx 4 D0 C 2 # g ˛ˇ .x/ D g˛ˇ .x/ C x 4 ˛ˇ .x/ C Using (2.250i,ii), one can explicitly construct the series in (2.252). The condition of real analyticity guarantees the absolute convergence of series in (2.252) for 0 x 4 < t1 WD min ˛ˇ .x/; i .x/ . Moreover, it is clear from (2.252) that # lim g ˛ˇ .x/ D g˛ˇ .x/; lim @4 g˛ˇ D ˛ˇ .x/, and lim T4j .x/ D j .x/. x 4 !0C x 4 !0C x 4 !0C Thus, the initial-value problem of general relativity is solved, and Theorem 2.4.9 is proved. Example 2.4.10. Consider the initial-value problem for vacuum equations. These are summarized from (2.248i) as @4 @4 g .x/ D 2R .x/ 1 g 2 @4 g @4 g C g ˛ˇ @4 g ˛ @4 g ˇ : (2.253) The initial data (or Cauchy data) g .x; 0/ D g# .x/ and @4 g jx 4 D0 D must satisfy, by (2.251), the following equations: r˛# 4R# .x/ h # h i2 #˛ ˇ C h ı ˛ˇ # i # # i .x/ D 0; (2.254i) D 0: (2.254ii) Equations (2.254i,ii) are physically important for gravitational waves. (See Appendix 5.) This system of four equations for 12 unknown functions is undetermined. It seems as if it would be easy to solve these, but in fact, it is not! 2.4 Solution Strategies, Classification, and Initial-Value Problems 207 Example 2.4.11. Consider a specific scenario for the initial-value problem for vacuum equations. We choose the initial data as # # .x/ D ı˛ˇ ; R˛ˇ .x/ 0; R# .x/ 0 I g˛ˇ 2 3 2c.1/ 0 0 i h 0 5 D 2K# .x/ ; ˛ˇ .x/ WD 4 0 2c.2/ 0 0 2c.3/ h i h i # r˛# #˛ ˇ 0; rˇ# 0: Here, the constants c.1/ ; c.2/ ; c.3/ are assumed to satisfy the constraints: c.1/ C c.2/ C c.3/ D 1 D c.1/ 2 C c.2/ 2 C c.3/ 2 : In this case, (2.254i,ii) are identically satisfied. Moreover, solving (2.253), we arrive at the special Kasner metric [147] 2c 2c g:: .x/ D 1 C x 4 .1/ dx 1 ˝ dx 1 C 1 C x 4 .2/ dx 2 ˝ dx 2 2c C 1 C x 4 .3/ dx 3 ˝ dx 3 dx 4 ˝ dx 4 ; 2c 2 2c 2 ds 2 D 1 C x 4 .1/ dx 1 C 1 C x 4 .2/ dx 2 2c 2 2 C 1 C x 4 .3/ dx 3 dx 4 : (2.255) We shall provide another example of the initial-value scheme in Example 6.2.3. Exercises 2.4 p 1. Consider four harmonic coordinate conditions @j Œ jgj g ij D 0. Obtain a class of general solutions of these differential equations in terms of arbitrary functions. 2. Let six metric components be g12 .x/ D g13 .x/ D g14 .x/ D g23 .x/ D g24 .x/ D g34 .x/ 0 yielding an orthogonal coordinate chart: 2 2 g:: .x/ D h.1/ .x/ dx 1 ˝ dx 1 C h.2/ .x/ dx 2 ˝ dx 2 2 2 C h.3/ .x/ dx 3 ˝ dx 3 h.4/ .x/ dx 4 ˝ dx 4 ; XX h.i / h.j / dij dx i dx j : ds 2 D i j (Summation convention is temporarily suspended.) Express a special class of vacuum field equations Rij .x/ D 0 in terms of four functions h.i / .x/ > 0 which are of class C 3 . 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 208 3. Consider the conformal tensor components of definition (1.169i) i 1 h l ı j Ri k ı lk Rij C gi k Rlj gij Rlk 2 h i R.x/ l ı k gij ı lj gi k C 6 C lij k .x/ WD Rlij k .x/ C in a space–time domain. Solve for ten functions gij .x/ in the system of ten independent quasi-linear second-order partial differential equations C lij k .x/ D 0. 4. Recall n o the vacuum field equations Rij .x/ D 0. Using 50 functions gij .x/ and k ij , express an equivalent system of first-order partial differential equations. 5. Let the metric be expressed as: g:: .x/ WD a.x 4 / 2 ı˛ˇ dx ˛ ˝ dx ˇ dx 4 ˝ dx 4 ; 2 2 ds 2 D a.x 4 / ı˛ˇ dx ˛ dx ˇ dx 4 ; x 2 D WD D .t0 ; t1 / R4 ; t0 > 1: Moreover, the function a.x 4 / > 0 is of class C 3 . For the initial-value problem, the prescribed functions are assumed to be as follows: In D R4 ; T˛ˇ .x/ 0. On the initial hypersurface at x 4 D t0 , # (i) g˛ˇ .x/ D .˛/2 ı˛ˇ D const.; (ii) ˛ˇ .x/ D ˇ ı˛ˇ D const.; (iii) ˛ .x/ 0; (iv) 4 .x/ D 0 D const. Prove that, with the notation a.x P 4 / WD da.x 4 / , dx 4 (2.247i,ii) and (2.251) reduce to h 2 i a.x 4 / R 4 / C 2 a.x P 4/ C a.x 4 / a.x 2 @4 T˛4 0; and, 3 2 @4 T44 D ˇ ˛2 2 T44 .x 4 / D 0; 3Œa.x P 4 / T44 .x 4 /; a.x 4 / 2 C 2 0 D 0: Answers and Hints to Selected Exercises 1. Consider fields with the following symmetries: j i kl .x/ ij kl .x/ ij lk .x/ i lj k .x/: 2.4 Solution Strategies, Classification, and Initial-Value Problems 209 The functions ij kl .x/ are of class C 4 . A class of general solutions is furnished by p jgj g ij .x/ D @k @l ij kl : (Remarks: (i) Harmonic coordinate conditions and the class of general solutions are not tensor field equations. (ii) In fact, no coordinate condition is expressible as a tensor field equation.) 2. Suspend summation convention in this answer [56, 90]. For l ¤ k, and i ¤ k, n X0 1 h.i / .x/ @l @k h.i / @l h.i / @k ln h.l/ Rlk .x/ D i ¤k;l @k h.i / @l ln h.k/ Rkk .x/ D dkk h.k/ .x/ X0 o D 0I h.i / .x/ 1 h i d i i @i h1 .i / @i h.k/ i ¤k Cd kk @k h h1 .k/ i @k h.i / C X0 d ll h h2 .l/ @l h.i / @l h.k/ i D 0: l¤i;k (Remarks: (i) There exist four differential identities among ten equations above. However, the system is still overdetermined and difficult to solve. (ii) The above equations hold in an N -dimensional manifold. (iii) Orthogonal coordinates may not exist for N > 3.) 3. The most general solution of the system of p.d.e.s is provided by: gij .x/ D exp Œ2.x/ dkl @i f k @j f l : Here, .x/ is of class C 3 . Moreover, the four functions f k .x/ are of class C 4 , and they are functionally independent. These five functions are otherwise arbitrary. (Consult Theorem 1.3.32 and (1.162).) (Remark: By the coordinate transformation b x i D f i .x/, the metric components can be reduced to b g ij .b x / D exp Œ2b .b x / dkl .) 4. h h C gih .x/ ; @k gij D gj h .x/ ki kj h h C gih Œl $ k D 0; @l gj h ki kj i i i h i h @k @i C D 0: ij kj kh ij ih kj 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 210 5. Use (2.247i,ii) and (2.252). Also, recall that the metric g#:: D .˛/2 I:: is flat. (Remarks: Integration of the above equations leads to the flat Friedmann model of cosmology in Chap. 6.) 2.5 Fluids, Deformable Solids, and Electromagnetic Fields We start with a pressureless incoherent dust or a dust cloud. In a flat space–time, we introduced the topic in Example 2.1.11. In a curved space–time, Example 2.3.6 dealt with such a material. The pertinent equations are the following: Tij .x/ WD .x/ Ui .x/ Uj .x/; .x/ > 0; Ui .x/ U i .x/ 1; ri U i D 0; d U .a/ .s/ UP .a/ ŒX .s/ D ds .a/ .d /.b/ U .d / .s/ U .b/ .s/ D 0: (2.256) The last equation shows that streamlines follow timelike geodesics. Now, we shall investigate a perfect fluid (or, an ideal fluid). This fluid was already introduced in Example 2.3.1. The field equations, from Equations (2.161i), (2.166i), and (2.168i), are given by the following: T ij .x/ WD .x/ C p.x/ U i .x/ U j .x/ C p.x/ g ij .x/; (2.257i) ˚ E ij .x/ WD G ij .x/ C .x/ C p.x/ U i .x/ U j .x/ (2.257ii) C p.x/ g ij .x/ D 0; ˚ .x/ C p.x/ U i .x/ U j .x/ C p.x/ g ij .x/ D 0; (2.257iii) T i .x/ WD rj U.x/ WD gij .x/ U i .x/ U j .x/ C 1 D 0; C i gkj ; @l gkj D 0: (2.257iv) (2.257v) The counting of the number of unknown functions versus the number of independent equations is provided by the following: No. of unknown functions: 10.gij / C 4.U i / C 1. / C 1.p/ D 16: No. of equations: 10.E ij D 0/ C 4.T i D 0/ C 1.U D 0/ C 4.C i D 0/ D 19: No. of identities: 4.rj E ij T i / D 4: No. of independent equations: 19 4 D 15: 2.5 Fluids, Deformable Solids, and Electromagnetic Fields 211 Therefore, the system is underdetermined. To make the system determinate, it is permissible to impose an equation of state F . ; p/ D 0; @F ./ 2 @F ./ 2 C > 0: @ @p (2.258) Remark: Choosing four coordinate conditions C i ./ D 0 is a usual practice. However, in p. 197, it is mentioned that there exist three other strategies of solutions. In each strategy, the counting has to be done separately. Let the world tube of the fluid body be exhibited in Fig. 2.19. Synge’s junction conditions (2.170) across the hypersurface @.3/ D of jump discontinuities, with U i .x/ni .x/[email protected]/ D D 0, reduce to gij .x/ j@ D D 0 D @k gij j@ D I .3/ .3/ Œp.x/[email protected]/ D D 0: (2.259) Energy conditions from Theorem 2.3.2 reduce in this case to the following: (i) Weak energy conditions: .x/ 0; (ii) .x/ C p.x/ 0: (2.260i) Dominant energy conditions: jp.x/j .x/: (iii) (2.260ii) Strong energy conditions: .x/ 0; .x/ C p.x/ 0; .x/ C 3p.x/ 0: (2.260iii) The four differential conservation equations (2.257iii), by (2.211) and (2.212i,ii), yield the following constitutive equations: rj .x/ U j .x/ D p.x/ rj U j ; P.x/ WD U .x/ rj D j .x/ C p.x/ UP i .x/ D (2.261i) .x/ C p.x/ rj U ; j .x/ C p.x/ U j .x/ rj U i D g ij .x/ C U i .x/ U j .x/ rj p; .x/ C p.x/ jX .s/ (2.261ii) (2.261iii) ˚ D U i .s/ D g ij .x/ C U i .x/ U j .x/ rj p j:: : ds (2.261iv) The last equations (2.261iv) govern streamlines of a perfect fluid flow. 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 212 Now, we shall introduce physical (or orthonormal ) components of the nonrelativistic 3-velocity vector field analogous to those of (2.24). These are provided by V .˛/ .x/ WD U .˛/ .x/ ; U .4/ .x/ ŒV.x/2 WD ı.˛/.ˇ/ V .˛/ ./ V .ˇ/ ./; .p 1 V 2 ./; U .˛/ .x/ D V .˛/ .x/ .p U .4/ .x/ D 1 1 V 2 ./: (2.262) Remark: Components V .˛/ .x/’s are not actual components of any four-dimensional vector or tensor. Example 2.5.1. Consider the relativistic equations of motion (2.261iii). In terms of physical (or orthonormal) components and Ricci rotation coefficients of (1.138), the spatial components of (2.261iii) can be expressed as ( " p .x/ C p.x/ 1 V 2 ./ @.4/ .˛/ .4/.4/ ./ .˛/ .4/.ˇ/ C V .˛/ p ::: .˛/ .ˇ/.4/ ! C V .ˇ/ @.ˇ/ V .˛/ p ::: !# ) V .ˇ/ .˛/ .ı/.ˇ/ V .ı/ V D 1 V 2 ./ ı .˛/.ˇ/ @.ˇ/ p @.4/ p C V .ˇ/ @.ˇ/ p V .˛/ : .ˇ/ (2.263) The equation above is the exact general relativistic version of Euler’s equation of (perfect) fluid flow [243]. A simplistic interpretation of (2.263) is that (mass) (acceleration) D (gradient of pressure): Now, we shall deal with a 4 4 matrix Tij .x/ of Segre characteristic Œ.1; 1/; 1; 1. Physically speaking, this class includes (1) an anisotropic fluid, (2) a deformable solid with symmetry, (3) a perfect fluid plus a tachyonic dust [62], and many other usual or exotic materials. By (2.181), we express Tij .x/ D .x/ C p? .x/ Ui .x/ Uj .x/ C p? .x/ gij .x/ C pk .x/ p? .x/ Si .x/ Sj .x/: The corresponding gravitational field equations are furnished by Eij .x/ WD Gij .x/ C Tij .x/ D 0; T i .x/ WD rj T ij D 0; (2.264) 2.5 Fluids, Deformable Solids, and Electromagnetic Fields 213 U.x/ WD Ui .x/ U i .x/ C 1 D 0; S.x/ WD Si .x/ S i .x/ 1 D 0; P.x/ WD Ui .x/ S i .x/ D 0; C i gj k ; @l gj k D 0: (2.265) The above system is underdetermined and four subsidiary conditions can be imposed to make the system determinate. The constitutive equations for the anisotropic fluid flow can be derived from T i .x/ D 0; Ui .x/ T i .x/ D 0, and Si .x/ T i .x/ D 0. These are explicitly given by U i rj . C p? / U j C . C p? / U j rj U i C r i p? C S i rj .pk p? /S j C .pk p? / S j rj S i D 0; (2.266i) rj . C p? /U j C Ui r i p? C .pk p? / Ui S j rj S i D 0; (2.266ii) . C p? / Si U j rj U i C Si r i p? C rj .pk p? /S j D 0: (2.266iii) Substituting (2.266ii,iii) into (2.266i), we finally deduce that . C p? / .ı ik S i Sk / U j rj U k C .pk p? / .ı ik C U i Uk / S j rj S k C .ı ij C U i Uj S i Sj / r j p? D 0: (2.267) The equation above provides the streamlines of an anisotropic fluid flow. The energy conditions of Theorem 2.3.2 reduce in this case to the following: 1. Weak energy conditions: C p? 0; 0; 2. (2.268i) Dominant energy conditions: jp? j; 3. C pk 0: jpk j: (2.268ii) Strong energy conditions: 0; C p? 0; C pk 0; C 2p? C pk 0: (2.268iii) Synge’s junction conditions (2.170) for jump discontinuities on the hypersurface @D.3/ , with U i ./ni ./j:: D 0, reduce to gij j@ D D 0; .3/ @k gij j@ D D 0; .3/ p? ı ij C .pk p? / S i Sj nj [email protected]/ D D 0: (2.269) 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 214 We shall provide some special examples of the anisotropic fluid in the next chapter. Also, see [63, 66] for a detailed treatment of fluids. Now, we shall investigate the case of a deformable solid body. It is characterized by the energy–momentum–stress tensor components: T ij .x/ WD .x/ U i .x/ U j .x/ S ij .x/; S ij .x/ WD 3 X j i .˛/ .x/ e.˛/ .x/ e.˛/ .x/: (2.270) ˛D1 (We have already mentioned such equations in (2.183), (2.193), and (2.196).) The gravitational field equations are furnished by E ij .x/ WD G ij .x/ C T i .x/ WD rj U i U j S ij .x/ D 0; U i U j S ij D 0; (2.271i) (2.271ii) U.x/ WD Ui .x/U i .x/ C 1 D 0; (2.271iii) i P.˛/ .x/ WD Ui .x/ e.˛/ .x/ D 0; (2.271iv) j i N.˛/.ˇ/ .x/ WD gij e.˛/ e.ˇ/ ı.˛/.ˇ/ D 0; C i gj k ; @l gj k D 0: (2.271v) (2.271vi) The above system is underdetermined and five subsidiary conditions can be imposed. The constitutive equations are " rj U j C Ui rj 3 X # .˛/ i e.˛/ j e.˛/ D 0; (2.272i) ˛D1 " 3 # X i j i k U rj U D ı k C U Uk rj .˛/ e.˛/ e.˛/ : j i (2.272ii) ˛D1 (Compare the above equations with (2.211) and (2.212i).) The energy conditions are provided by (2.194i–iii), and Synge’s junction conditions (2.170), with U i ./ni ./j:: D 0, in this case reduce to gij j@ D D 0; @k gij j@ D D 0; .3/ .3/ " 3 # X j i .˛/ e.˛/ e.˛/ nj ˇ D 0: ˇ ˛D1 @ D ˇ .3/ (2.273) 2.5 Fluids, Deformable Solids, and Electromagnetic Fields 215 Example 2.5.2. Consider the physical or orthonormal components of equations of motion (2.272ii). The spatial components, with help of (2.262) and (2.263), yield ( .x/ " 1 @.4/ p 1 V 2 ./ 1 1 V 2 ./ V .˛/ p ::: ! CV .ˇ/ .˛/ .4/.4/ ./ C @.ˇ/ V .˛/ p ::: .˛/ .4/.ˇ/ C ! .˛/ .ˇ/.4/ V .ˇ/ #) C .˛/ .ˇ/.ı/ V .ˇ/ V .ı/ i h 1=2 .˛/ .˛/ D ı .b/ C 1 V 2 V U.b/ r.c/ S .b/.c/ : (2.274) (Compare with (2.41) and (2.125i).) For a class of equilibrium of the deformable body, we assume that V ˛ .x/ 0. Thus, the conditions 1 0 D U.a/ S .a/.b/ D 0 p S .4/.b/; ::: S .4/.b/ .x/ 0 or, holds. Substituting the above into (2.274), we derive that 0 D .x/ .˛/ .4/.4/ ./ Cı .˛/ .ˇ/ r./ S .ˇ/./ : (2.275) The equation above can be physically interpreted as “the gravitational forces exactly balance the elastic forces.” Now, we shall explore electromagnetic fields in a curved space–time manifold. We have already touched upon electromagnetic fields in Examples 1.2.19, 1.2.22, 1.3.6, 2.1.12, and 2.1.13 and (2.56i,ii), (2.60i–iii), (2.63), (2.67), (2.77i–iii), and (2.78i– iii). All these equations allow for a straight forward generalization in a domain of curved space–time. Recall that the electromagnetic field is represented by an antisymmetric tensor field F:: .x/ D Fij .x/ dx i ˝ dx j D .1=2/Fij .x/ dx i ^ dx j: (2.276) Outside charged material sources, Maxwell’s equations for an electromagnetic field in a curved, background space–time, are governed by rj F ij D 0; (2.277i) ri Fj k C rj Fki C rk Fij @i Fj k C @j Fki C @k Fij D 0: (2.277ii) 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 216 By (1.69) and (1.70), we deduce from (2.277ii) and (1.145i) that Fij .x/ D @i Aj @j Ai ri Aj rj Ai ; (2.278i) rk r j Aj r j rk Aj D Rhk .x/ Ah .x/: (2.278ii) Denoting the generalized wave operator (or the generalized D’Alembertian) by WD rj r j , Maxwell’s equations (2.277i,ii) reduce to r i rj Aj Rij .x/ Aj .x/ Ai D 0: (2.279) Now under a gauge transformation of (1.71ii), namely, b Ai .x/ D Ai .x/ @i D Ai .x/ ri ; (2.280) b ij .x/ Fij .x/. Let us choose a the electromagnetic field remains unchanged, or F special class of .x/ such that D ri r i D ri Ai : (2.281) ri b Ai D ri Ai D 0: (2.282) By (2.280) and (2.281), E The above is called the Lorentz gauge condition on the vector field b A.x/. Maxwell’s equations (2.279) simplify into b Ai C Rij .x/ b Aj .x/ D 0: (2.283) Electromagnetic field equations (2.277i,ii) possess an additional covariance under the conformal transformation (1.166i). We shall state and prove the following theorem on this topic. Theorem 2.5.3. Let a conformal transformation be furnished by g:: .x/ D exp Œ2.x/ g:: .x/; F:: .x/ WD F:: .x/; ij F .x/ WD g i k .x/ g j l .x/Fkl .x/: Then, the electromagnetic field equations (2.277i,ii) remain unchanged. Proof. By (2.284), it follows that det g ij D exp Œ8 det gij ; ij F .x/ D exp Œ4 F ij .x/; (2.284) 2.5 Fluids, Deformable Solids, and Electromagnetic Fields rj F ij 217 hp i 1 ij @j Dp g F g D e4 rj F ij : Therefore, (2.277i) remains intact. Since (2.277ii) can be expressed without the metric tensor, it remains valid automatically. Example 2.5.4. Let us investigate electromagnetic field equations (2.277i,ii) in a conformally flat, background domain characterized by g ij .x/ D exp Œ2.x/ dij : (2.285) Equation (2.277i) still implies that F ij .x/ D @i Aj @j Ai Fij .x/. The equations j rj F i D 0 yield j rj Fi D @i @j Aj d kj @k @j Ai D 0: (2.286) Assuming the Lorentz gauge condition: rk Ak @k Ak D 0; (2.287) the equations reduce to the wave equation d kl @k @l Ai D 0: (2.288) A general class of solutions of (2.287) and (2.288) is furnished (by the superposition of plane waves) as [55]: Z Aj .x/ D ˚ Re ˛ j .k/ exp i kl x l .k/ d3 k; R3 q ı ˛ˇ k˛ kˇ ; ı ˛ 4 .k/ WD k ˛ .k/ .k/ for k4 D .k/ WD ˛ .k/ ¤ .k/ k : .k/ > 0; (2.289) Here, we have assumed that the integrals in (2.289) converge absolutely and uniformly. Moreover, we assume that differentiations commute with integrals [32]. The five functions ˛ j .k/ and .k/ are otherwise arbitrary. The classification of electromagnetic field equations (2.277i,ii) in flat space–time has been carried out in Appendix 2, Example A2.9. In case, @4 Fij ¤ 0, the system is hyperbolic. 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 218 Now, we shall discuss the effects of electromagnetic energy–momentum–stress tensor on the curvature of the space–time manifold. The appropriate field equations for this investigation are the coupled Einstein–Maxwell equations as furnished in the following: j T ij .x/ WD F i k .x/F k .x/ .1=4/g ij .x/Fkl .x/F kl .x/; (2.290i) Mi .x/ WD rj F ij D 0; (2.290ii) Mi .x/ WD 1 3Š ij kl .x/ rj Fkl C rk Flj C rl Fj k D 0; E ij .x/ WD G ij .x/ C T ij .x/ D 0; T i .x/ WD rj T ij 0; C i gj k ; @l gj k D 0: (2.290iii) (2.290iv) (2.290v) (2.290vi) Remarks: (i) The special relativistic electromagnetic energy–momentum–stress was introduced in (2.63). (ii) In (2.290iii), the definition of the Hodge-star operation in (1.113) is used. (iii) A domain of space–time, in which (2.290i–vi) hold, is called an electromagneto-vac domain. (iv) Equation (2.290i) implies that T ii .x/ 0. Therefore, (2.290iv) yields that R.x/ 0. The number of unknown functions versus the number of independent equations in the system (2.290i–vi) is exhibited below: (i) (ii) (iii) (iv) No. of unknown functions: 6.Fij / C 10.gij / D 16. No. of equations: 4.Mi D 0/C4.Mi D 0/C10.E ij D 0/C4.C i D 0/ D 22. No. of identities: 1.ri Mi 0/ C 1.ri Mi 0/ C 4.rj E ij 0/ D 6. No. of independent equations: 22 6 D 16. Therefore, the system of (2.290i–vi) is exactly determinate! Now, we shall discuss the variational derivation of the field equations (2.290i–vi). (Appendix 1 deals with variational derivation of differential equations.) Example 2.5.5. Equations (2.290iii) yield (2.278i), which is Fij .x/ D @i Aj @j Ai ri Aj rj Ai : It turns out that the variational derivation demands the use of the 4-potential Ai .x/, rather than Fij .x/. Using (A1.25), we write the Lagrangian function for the coupled fields as 2.5 Fluids, Deformable Solids, and Electromagnetic Fields 219 ij L ai ; y ij ; kij I aij ; y k ; kij l h i WD y ij kkij kij k llk kij C li k klj C .=2/ y ij y kl alj aj l .aki ai k / DW ij ./ C .=2/ y ij y kl alj aj l .aki ai k / ; L. /ˇˇ ij ˇ y ij Dg ij .x/; y k D@k g ij ; ˇ n o n ˇ k k ˇ k ; kij l D@l ˇ ij D ˇ ij ij ˇ ˇ ˇ alj D@j Al : D R.x/ C .=2/ F ij .x/ Fij .x/: o ; (2.291) The corresponding action integral is provided by Z J.F / WD L. /j p g.x/ d4 x; D4 ai D i ı F .x/ DW Ai .x/: (2.292) k D (See Fig. A1.2.). We vary independently b y D g .x/ C "h .x/; ij C "hkij .x/, and b a i D Ai .x/ C "hi .x/. Then, the vanishing of the variational derivative, that is, ij lim "!0 ij ij b y kij J.F / D 0; " yields, by (A1.26), etc., the field equations (2.290ii) and (2.290iv). Moreover, the boundary terms from (2.291), (A1.20ii), and (A1.29ii) imply that Z n o j g ij .x/ hkki .x/ g ki .x/ h ki .x/ C 2 F ij .x/hi .x/ nj .x/ d3 v D 0: @D4 (2.293) Therefore, variations on the boundary @D4 satisfying nh i o j g ij .x/ hkki .x/ g ki .x/ h ki .x/ C 2 F ij .x/hi .x/ nj .x/ ˇˇ @D4 D 0; (2.294) 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 220 imply (2.293). (But the converse is not true!). A popular way to write (2.293) is as follows: Z k j ij ki ij g .x/ ı g ı C 2 F .x/ ıAi .x/ nj .x/ d3 v D 0: ki ki @D4 (2.295) k Usually, boundary variations ı D 0; ıAi .x/j:: D 0 are chosen (for the j i j:: Dirichlet problem), but there exist many more initial-boundary problems admitted by the variational principle, as exhibited in (2.293) or (2.295). Now, we shall explore coupled gravitational and electromagnetic fields, generated by the distribution of a charged dust cloud (or a primitive plasma). In the flat space–time, we have already investigated incoherent, charged dust in (2.64i,ii). The pertinent field equations here are expressed in the following: j T ij .x/ WD .x/U i .x/U j .x/ C F i k .x/F k .x/ .1=4/g ij .x/Fkl .x/F kl .x/; (2.296i) Mi .x/ WD rj F ij .x/U i .x/ D 0; 1 ij kl .x/ rj Fkl C rk Flj C rl Fj k D 0; 3Š J .x/ WD ri U i D 0; Mi .x/ WD (2.296ii) (2.296iii) (2.296iv) E ij .x/ WD G ij .x/ C T ij .x/ D 0; (2.296v) T i .x/ WD rj T ij D 0; (2.296vi) U.x/ WD Ui .x/U i .x/ C 1 D 0; C i gj k ; @l gj k D 0: (2.296vii) (2.296viii) We shall now count the number of unknown functions versus the number of independent equations. No. of unknown functions: 6.Fij / C 1./ C 1. / C 4.U i / C 10.gij / D 22. No. of equations: 4.Mi D 0/ C 4.Mi D 0/ C 1.J D 0/ C 10.E ij D 0/ C 4.T i D 0/ C 1.U D 0/ C 4.C i D 0/ D 28. No. of identities: 1.ri Mi 0/ C 1.ri Mi 0/ C 4.rj E ij T i / D 6. 2.5 Fluids, Deformable Solids, and Electromagnetic Fields 221 No. of independent equations: 28 6 D 22. Thus, the system is determinate. Now, we shall derive the constitutive equations for the system in (2.296i–viii). The differential conservation equations (2.296vi) yield 0 D rj h D U i rj or j U i U j C F i k F k .1=4/g ij Fkl F kl i j U i C U j rj U i C F i k rj F k C .1=2/g i l F j k rj Flk C rl Fkj C rk Fj l 0 D U i rj U j C U j rj U i F i k Uk C 0: Multiplying the equation above by Ui .x/, we deduce that rj U j D 0: (2.297) (2.298) Thus, the continuity of the material current still holds. Substituting (2.298) into (2.297), we derive that .x/UP i .x/ D .x/U j .x/rj U i D .x/F i k .x/Uk .x/ or ŒX .s/ D U i .s/ D .x/F ik .x/ j:: U k .s/: ds (2.299) The above equation of a streamline is the appropriate (curved space–time) generalization of the Lorentz equation of motion (2.66) and (2.67) in the flat space–time scenario. Here, we emphasize that the relativistic equations of motion for streamlines in (2.256), (2.261iv), and (2.267) and equations of motion (2.272ii) for a solid particle are all consequences of Einstein’s gravitational field equations. These equations are not added on as required in the corresponding non-general relativistic theories. Now, we shall touch upon briefly the algebraic properties of the antisymmetric electromagnetic tensor field F:: .x/ D .1=2/Fij .x/ dx i ^ dx j D F.a/.b/ .x/ eQ .a/ .x/ ˝ eQ .b/ .x/: The 4 4 antisymmetric matrix F.a/.b/ .x0 / does not possess any real, nonzero, usual eigenvalues. However, the same matrix has invariant, (real) eigenvalues. The invariant eigenvalue probelm can be posed as: F.a/.b/ .x0 / .b/ .x0 / D d.a/.b/ .b/ .x0 /: (2.300) 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 222 (Compare the above equation with equations in Example A3.5 of Appendix 3) It follows from (2.300) that d.a/.b/ .a/ .x0 / .b/ .x0 / D 0: (2.301) Therefore, either the (invariant) eigenvalue D 0 or the “invariant eigenvector” .a/ .x0 / Ee.a/ .x0 / is null or both. Now, consider two fields defined by I.1/ .x/ WD F.a/.b/ .x/ F .a/.b/ .x/; (2.302i) I.2/ .x/ WD F.a/.b/ .x/ F .a/.b/ .x/: (2.302ii) (Here, the star stands for the Hodge-star operation in (1.113).) The field I.1/ .x/ is 2 a scalar or invariant. However, the field I.2/ .x/ is a pseudoscalar and I.2/ .x/ is invariant. We shall now introduce the physical or orthonormal components of the electric and magnetic field vectors. These are furnished by E.˛/ .x/ WD F.˛/.4/ .x/; (2.303i) H.˛/ .x/ WD ".˛/.ˇ/. / F .ˇ/. / .x/: (2.303ii) (Compare the equations above with (2.55).) Remark: The components E.˛/ .x/ and H.˛/ .x/ are not components of relativistic vector fields. The invariant in (2.302i) and the pseudoscalar in (2.302ii) can be expressed in terms of electric and magnetic vectors as I.1/ .x/ D 2ı .˛/.ˇ/ E.˛/ .x/E.ˇ/ .x/ H.˛/ .x/H.ˇ/ .x/ i h E E k2 ; DW 2 k E.x/ k2 k H.x/ h i E E I.2/ .x/ D 4ı .˛/.ˇ/ E.˛/ .x/H.ˇ/ .x/ DW 4 E.x/ H.x/ : (2.304i) (2.304ii) The energy–momentum–stress tensor of an electromagnetic field from (2.290i) is expressed as T .a/.b/ .x/ WD F .a/.c/ .x/F .b/ .c/ .x/ .1=4/ d .a/.b/F.c/.d / .x/F .c/.d / .x/: (2.305) ˚ We now choose the orthonormal tetrad Ee.1/ .x/; eE.2/ .x/; Ee.3/ .x/; Ee.4/ .x/ in a speE E cial way so that the vector Ee.3/ .x/ is orthogonal to both E.x/ and H.x/. (Rotation 2.5 Fluids, Deformable Solids, and Electromagnetic Fields 223 ˚ of spatial vectors eE.1/ .x/; eE.2/ .x/; eE.3/ .x/ can always achieve this simplification.) Therefore, relative to this special class of frames, E.3/ .x/ D H.3/ .x/ D 0: (2.306) Therefore, (2.304i,ii) simplify into i h 2 2 2 2 F.a/.b/ .x/F .a/.b/ .x/ D 2 E.1/ ; C E.2/ H.1/ H.2/ (2.307i) F.a/.b/ .x/ F .a/.b/ .x/ D 4 E.1/ H.1/ C E.2/ H.2/ : (2.307ii) Moreover, the simplified version of (2.305) yields the nonzero components as i h 2 2 2 2 T.1/.1/ .x/ D T.2/.2/ .x/ D .1=2/ H.2/ ; H.1/ C E.2/ E.1/ i h 2 2 2 2 ; T.3/.3/ .x/ D T.4/.4/ .x/ D .1=2/ H.1/ C H.2/ C E.1/ C E.2/ T.1/.2/ .x/ D E.1/ E.2/ C H.1/ H.2/ ; T.3/.4/ .x/ D H.1/ E.2/ E.1/ H.2/ : (2.308) The 4 4 symmetric matrix T.a/.b/ .x0 / becomes block diagonal. Now, we shall explore the invariant eigenvalue problem for the matrix T.a/.b/.x0 / . Theorem 2.5.6. The invariant eigenvalues from the equation det T.a/.b/ .x0 / d.a/.b/ D 0 are furnished by four real numbers: D 0 ; 0 ; 0 ; 0 I n 0 D .1=4/ F.a/.b/ .x0 /F .a/.b/ .x0 / 2 C F.a/.b/ .x0 / F .a/.b/ .x0 / o 2 1=2 : (2.309) Proof. The determinantal equation for eigenvalues splits into two equations " det " and det T.1/.1/ T.1/.2/ T.1/.2/ T.2/.2/ T.3/.3/ T.3/.4/ # D0 (2.310i) D 0: (2.310ii) # T.3/.4/ T.4/.4/ C Equations (2.310i,ii) yield, respectively, 2 D T.1/.1/ 2 C T.1/.2/ ; 2 2 D T.4/.4/ 2 T.3/.4/ 2 : (2.311i) (2.311ii) 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 224 By (2.308) and (2.307i,ii), the right-hand sides of (2.311i) and (2.311ii) coincide so that 2 2 2 i2 C E.2/ H.1/ H.2/ C 4 E.1/ H.1/ C E.2/ H.2/ o n 2 2 D .1=4/ F.a/.b/ .x0 /F .a/.b/ .x0 / C F.a/.b/ .x0 / F .a/.b/ .x0 / : 42 D h E.1/ 2 2 Since the right-hand side of the equation is an invariant, the equation is valid in general for any other orthonormal tetrad. Thus, (2.309) is proved. Remarks: (i) The proof for the similar theorem in flat space–time is exactly the same. (ii) For 2 > 0, the Segre characteristic of T.a/.b/ .x0 / is Œ.1; 1/; .1; 1/. We define a null electromagnetic field by the condition D 0, which implies from (2.309) that F.a/.b/ .x0 /F .a/.b/ .x0 / D 0; and, F.a/.b/ .x0 / F .a/.b/ .x0 / D 0: (2.312) (The Segre characteristic is Œ.1; 1; 2/.) In terms of electric and magnetic field vectors, (2.5) yields from (2.304i,ii) E 0 / k D k H.x E 0 / k; k E.x E 0 / H.x E 0 / D 0: E.x (2.313) Therefore, a null electromagnetic field physically represents the analog of a plane electromagnetic wave in flat space–time. Exercises 2.5 1. Using (2.256), (2.298), and the junction condition existence of the conserved, total (proper) mass U i ni j:: D 0, prove the Z M WD .x/ U i .x/ ni .x/ j:: d3 v: ˙ 2. RConsider D R.p/; .p/ WD ı a perfect fluid with the equation of state: dp p C R.p/ ; .x/ WD p.x/ . Introduce a conformal transformation 2.5 Fluids, Deformable Solids, and Electromagnetic Fields 225 i g ij .x/ D e2.x/ gij .x/; Wi .x/ WD e Ui .x/; W .x/ D e U i .x/. Prove that the equations of motion (2.261iii) reduce to . C p/ U j r j U i D U i U j r j p: 3. Consider a perfect fluid whose energy–momentum–stress tensor is given by (2.257i) which obeys the conservation law (2.257iii). (i) Consider the projection of the conservation law in the direction of the fluid 4-velocity (i.e., T i Ui D 0). Show that this equation yields the relativistic continuity equation for a perfect fluid: ri U i C p ri U i D 0: (ii) Consider now a projection which is orthogonal to the fluid 4-velocity. By projecting the conservation law in an orthogonal direction (i.e., T i Pij D 0, with Pij being the perpendicular projection tensor of (2.198)), show that this implies the relativistic Euler equations for a perfect fluid: . C p/ U i ri Uj C rj p C U i Uj ri p D 0: E .x/ is characterized by: 4. A relativistic fluid with the heat flow vector q T ij ./ WD . C p/U i U j C pg ij C U i q j C U j q i C ij ; qi U i D 0; ij U j D 0; ii D 0; ij D j i : Prove that the constitutive equations are furnished by (i) P C . C p/ C ri q i Ui qP i C ij ij D 0, (ii) . C p/UP i C ı ij C U i Uj r j p C qP j C rk kj Cqj ij C ! ij C .4=3/ q i D 0. 5. Consider a deformable solid body in general relativity characterized by T ij ./ WD U i U j S ij U i U j X Sij U j D 0: Prove that the constitutive equations are provided by (i) P D C S ij ij C .1=3/ gij , (ii) UP i D rj S ij U i S j k j k C .1=3/ gj k . j i ./ e./ e./ ; 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 226 6. Maxwell’s equations and the Lorentz gauge condition are given in (2.283) and (2.282). Let the background metric satisfy Gij .x/ D gij .x/. (Here, is the nonzero cosmological constant.) Show that the electromagnetic 4-potential E A.x/ satisfies a massive vector-boson equation Ai Ai .x/ D 0: 7. Consider electromagneto-vac equations (2.290i–iv) with the Lorentz gauge E condition (2.282). Derive that the 4-potential vector A.x/ satisfies gauge-field type of equations i h Ai F i k Fj k .1=4/ ı ij Fkl F kl Aj D 0: 8. The Hodge-dual operation in Example 1.3.6 yielded ij F .x/ D .1=2/ ij kl .x/ Fkl .x/: Define a complex-valued, antisymmetric field by ' kj .x/ WD F kj .x/ i F kj .x/: (i) Deduce that Maxwell’s equations (2.277i,ii) reduce to rj ' kj D 0. j (ii) Prove that the energy–momentum–stress tensor (2.290i) yields T k .x/ D .1=2/ ReŒ' j l .x/ 'kl .x/. (Here, the bar denotes complex-conjugation.) 9. A global, electromagnetic duality rotation is furnished by b ' kj .x/ D ei ˛ ' kj .x/: Here, ˛ is a real constant. Show that electromagneto-vac equations (2.290ii,iii) are covariant and (2.290iv) are invariant under the duality rotation. 10. Prove that in terms of orthonormal or physical components, field equations (2.296v) for an incoherent charged dust are equivalent to R h .d / .d / C .=2/ ı .b/ T.a/.c/ ı .c/ T.a/.b/ i .d / .d / .d / .d / C d.a/.c/ T .b/ d.a/.b/ T .c/ C .2=3/ .x/ ı .b/ d.a/.c/ ı .c/ d.a/.b/ : .d / .a/.b/.c/ .x/ DC .d / .a/.b/.c/ .x/ 11. Consider a null electromagnetic field given by (2.3.12). (i) Prove that the corresponding stress–energy–momentum tensor can be written as 2.5 Fluids, Deformable Solids, and Electromagnetic Fields T.a/.b/ .x0 / D .x0 / .x0 / > 0; with: .a/ 227 .a/ .x0 / .b/ .x0 /; .x0 / .a/ .x0 / D 0: (ii) Show that the 4 4 matrix T.a/.b/ .x0 / belongs to the Segre characteristic Œ.1; 1/; 2. Answers and Hints to Selected Exercises 1. See Fig. 2.19 and use (2.216). 2. ı @i D @i p Œp C R.p/ I k k D C ı ki @j C ı kj @i gij g kl @l : ij ij 3. Note that U i Ui D 1 and that U i rj Ui D 0 (show this). 4. (i) Use (2.199i–v) and the consequent equation (2.201) as 1 rk Uj D !j k C j k C Pj k UP j Uk ; D rk U k : 3 Moreover, apply the following equations: rj Ui ij D 0; or, Ui rj ij D 0 ij rj Ui D ij ij C !ij C .1=3/ Pij UP i Uj D ij ij 0 0 0: 5. (i) Use (2.211). Moreoever, 0 D rk S j k Uj ; or, Uj rk S j k D S j k rk Uj D S j k !j k C j k C .1=3/ Pj k UP j Uk D S j k 0 C j k C .1=3/ gj k 0 : 7. Use (2.283) and Rij .x/ D T ij .x/. 2 The Pseudo-Riemannian Space–Time Manifold M4 228 8. (ii) abj l .x/ cd kl .x/ j j j D ı ac ı bd ı k ı bk ı d C ı ad ı bk ı jc ı bc ı k j C ı ak ı bc ı d ı bd ı jc : 10. Use field equations (2.163ii) and (2.296v). 11. (i) Choose a special orthonormal tetrad such that E.2/ .x0 / D E.3/ .x0 / D H.1/ .x0 / D H.3/ .x0 / D 0; .x/ WD .E.1/ .x0 //2 D .H.2/ .x0 //2 > 0:Suppose E.1/ .x0 / D CH.2/ .x0 /: Eigenvalue equations T.a/.b/.x0 / .b/ .x0 / D 0 reduce, from (2.308), to one independent equation .3/ .4/ D 0. The null eigenvector can be chosen as E D Œı i.3/ C ı i.4/ @x@ i . In terms of its covariant components, T.a/.b/ .x0 / D .x0 / .a/ .x0 / .b/ .x0 /. Chapter 3 Spherically Symmetric Space–Time Domains 3.1 Schwarzschild Solution The first exact nontrivial solution of Einstein’s (vacuum) field equations (2.160i) was obtained by Schwarzschild [231]. This solution turned out to be very important in regard to experimental verifications of the theory of general relativity. Schwarzschild investigated a metric similar to i 2 2 h 1 g:: .x/ D e˛.x / dx 1 ˝ dx 1 C x 1 dx 2 ˝ dx 2 C sin x 2 dx 3 ˝ dx 3 1 e.x / dx 4 ˝ dx 4; ds 2 D e˛.r/ .dr/2 C r 2 .d/2 C .sin /2 .d'/2 e.r/ .dt/2: (3.1) The above metric incorporates both spherical symmetry and the condition of staticity. With this metric, two unknown functions ˛.r/ and .r/ (of class C 3 ) are required to satisfy the vacuum equations Rij .x/ D 0. i The nonzero components of the Christoffel symbols are computed from jk (3.1) and (1.134) as: 1 2 1 D .1=2/ @1 ˛ ; D .r/1; D re˛ ; 11 12 22 3 1 D .r/1 ; D r sin2 e˛ ; 13 33 3 2 D cot ; D sin cos ; 23 33 4 1 (3.2) D .1=2/ @1 ; D .1=2/ e ˛ @1 : 14 44 A. Das and A. DeBenedictis, The General Theory of Relativity: A Mathematical Exposition, DOI 10.1007/978-1-4614-3658-4 3, © Springer Science+Business Media New York 2012 229 230 3 Spherically Symmetric Space–Time Domains The vacuum equations (2.16i), by (3.2) and (1.147ii) reduce to the following system of ordinary differential equations: ı R11 ./ D .1=2/@1@1 .1=4/ @1 ˛ @1 C .1=4/.@1 /2 @1 ˛ r D 0; (3.3i) R22 ./ D e˛ 1 C .r=2/ .@1 @1 ˛/ 1 D 0; (3.3ii) R33 ./ sin2 R22 ./ D 0; R44 ./ D e ˛ .1=2/ @1 @1 C .1=4/ @1 ˛ @1 ı .1=4/ .@1 /2 @1 r D 0 : (3.3iii) (3.3iv) Computing R11 ./ C e˛ R44 ./ D 0 from above, we obtain .1=r/ @1 .˛ C / D 0 ; or ˛.r/ C .r/ D k D const. (3.4) Here, k is the arbitrary constant of integration. Substituting (3.4) into (3.3ii), we arrive at the nonlinear differential equation e˛ Œ1 r @1 ˛ D 1 : (3.5) The above equation is a disguised linear equation (as mentioned in Appendix 2). It can be expressed as the linear differential equation r @1 .e˛ / C .e˛ / D 1 : Integrating the above, we obtain e ˛.r/ e.r/ 2m D 1 r 2m D 1 r (3.6) > 0; ek > 0 : (3.7) Here, m is another arbitrary constant of integration. (From physical considerations, we choose m > 0.) Equation (3.7) automatically solves (3.3i) and (3.3iv). Thus, the metric (3.1) can be specified as 2m ds 2 D 1 r 1 2m .dr/2 C r 2 .d/2 C .sin /2 .d'/2 1 r e k .dt/2 : (3.8) 3.1 Schwarzschild Solution 231 By a coordinate transformation b r Dr; b D; b ' D'; b t D e k=2 t; and dropping hats in the sequel, we obtain the famous Schwarzschild metric as1 2m ds D 1 r 2 1 2m 2 2 2 .dt/2 : (3.9) .dr/ C r .d/ C .sin / .d'/ 1 r 2 2 The space–time domain of validity for (3.9) corresponds to ˚ D W D .r; ; '; t/ W 0 < 2m < r < 1; 0 < < ; < ' < ; 1 < t < 1 : (3.10) Example 3.1.1. The natural orthonormal tetrad corresponding to (3.9) is furnished by 2m 1=2 @ Ee.1/ ./ D 1 ; r @r Ee.2/ ./ D .r/1 @ ; @ Ee.3/ ./ D .r sin /1 2m Ee.4/ ./ D 1 r @ ; @' 1=2 @ : @t (3.11) The corresponding (nonzero) orthonormal or physical components of the curvature tensor of (1.141iv) are provided by R.2/.3/.2/.3/./ D R.1/.4/.1/.4/./ D 2m ; r3 R.2/.4/.2/.4/./ D R.3/.4/.3/.4/./ D R.1/.2/.1/.2/./ D R.1/.3/.1/.3/ D m : (3.12) r3 We note here several properties from the above equations. First, that lim m!0C R.a/.b/.c/.d /./ 0. Therefore, the mass, m, of the central body is solely responsible for the nonzero curvature of the surrounding space–time domain. Secondly, we conclude that lim R.a/.b/.c/.d /./ D 0. Thus, the Schwarzschild universe is r!1 asymptotically flat in some sense. Remark: The asymptotic symmetry group is not the Poincaré group of flat Minkowski space–time but instead a larger group known as the Bondi–Metzner– Sachs group which preserves the asymptotic structure of the metric [25, 223]. 1 The line element in this form is found in (14) of Schwarzschild’s original paper [231]. 232 3 Spherically Symmetric Space–Time Domains We observe that the physical components R.a/.b/.c/.d /./ are also defined and real analytic in the interval 0 < r 2m. This region is outside the boundary of D in (3.10). (The boundary r D 2m is called the Schwarzschild radius, a coordinate singularity.) This puzzling situation will be properly explained in Chap. 5 on black holes. Now we shall elucidate the exact interpretation of the symbol m > 0 occurring in (3.9). We have already used the symbol m > 0 in (2.19i,ii), (2.25), (2.30), (2.31i,ii), (2.32), (2.33), (2.67), (2.131), (2.141i), etc. In all these equations, we have used m > 0 to denote the mass of a test particle following a certain space–time trajectory (or world line). However, in the Schwarzschild metric in (3.9), the symbol m > 0 stands for the central mass causing the gravitational field around it. In case we reinstate temporarily the speed of light c and the Newtonian constant of gravitation G, the Schwarzschild mass m D GM=c 2 . Here, M is the total central mass in these units. Example 3.1.2. In this example, we shall explore briefly the non-Euclidean geometry of the two-dimensional spatial submanifold M2 of the Schwarzschild space–time. Let the submanifold be furnished by r D x 1 D 1 .u/ WD u1 ; D x 2 D 2 .u/ WD =2 D const. ; ' D x 3 D 3 .u/ WD u2 ; t D x 4 D 4 .u/ WD t0 D const. (Compare these with (1.252).) The corresponding metric from (3.9) is provided by 2 2m 1 1 2 g:: .u ; u / D 1 1 du1 ˝ du1 C u1 du2 ˝ du2 ; u 2m 1 .dr/2 C r 2 .d'/2 ; dl 2 D 1 r ˚ D.2/ WD .r; '/ W 0 < 2m < r < 1; < ' < : (3.13) By (2.92) and (3.13), the ratio 2 “Circumference of a circle” D4 “Radial distance” Z 3 3,2 r Z 7 6 r d' 5 .1 2m=w/1=2 dw5 4 .2m/C . hp i D .2/ 1 .2m=r/ C .m=r/ ln jr=2mj : (3.14) 3.1 Schwarzschild Solution 233 χ(2) ϕ M2 (2m, π) r 2 (2m, −π) D (2) Fig. 3.1 Two-dimensional submanifold M2 of the Schwarzschild space–time. The surface representing M2 here is known as Flamm’s paraboloid [102] Note that the above ratio is a positive-valued, monotonically decreasing function of r. Moreover, the ratio diverges in the limit r ! .2m/C . Furthermore, in the limit r ! 1, the ratio goes to 2, the Euclidean value. @ Note that @' is a Killing vector for the metric in (3.13). With all this information at hand, we construct a qualitative picture for M2 in Fig. 3.1. (Compare Figs. 3.1 and 2.8.) In the metric in (3.13), radial coordinate lines are geodesics. Since these geodesics cannot be continued for the interval 0 < r 2m, we conclude that the submanifold M2 and the Schwarzschild space–time are geodesically incomplete. Now we shall investigate timelike geodesics of the Schwarzschild space–time. These represent world lines of inertial test particles in the spherically symmetric gravitational field. We use the proper time parameter s as given in (1.186). We utilize the “squared Lagrangian” in (2.155) to express L.2/ ./ D .1=2/ gij .x/ ui uj h 2 i 2m 1 D .1=2/ 1 .ur /2 C r 2 u C sin2 .u' /2 r 2m t 2 u : (3.15) 1 r 234 3 Spherically Symmetric Space–Time Domains The corresponding Euler–Lagrange equations in (1.187) and (A1.8) yield geodesic equations as 2m d2 R.s/ m 1 2 ds R.s/ R.s/ 2 C .sin .s// 1 d˚.s/ ds 2 dR.s/ ds ) C ( 2 ŒR.s/ 2m m .R.s//2 1 2m R.s/ d.s/ ds dT .s/ ds 2 2 D 0; (3.16i) d2 .s/ dR.s/ d.s/ d˚.s/ 2 sin .s/ cos .s/ C ds 2 R.s/ ds ds ds 2 D 0 ; (3.16ii) dR.s/ d˚.s/ d.s/ d˚.s/ 2 d2 ˚.s/ C 2 cot .s/ D 0; C ds 2 R.s/ ds ds ds ds (3.16iii) d2 T .s/ 2m dR.s/ dT .s/ D 0: C 2 2 ds ds ds .R.s// Œ1 2m=R.s/ (3.16iv) The above is a complicated system of semilinear, second-order, ordinary differential equations. Fortunately, the variables ' and t are cyclic or ignorable. Therefore, (3.16iii,iv) admit two first integrals: .r sin /2j:: d˚.s/ D h D const. ; ds 2m dT .s/ 1 D E D const. r j:: ds (3.17i) (3.17ii) The physical meaning of (3.17i) is that the areal velocity h is conserved. (See Example 1.3.36.) Equation (3.17ii) implies that the total energy E of the test particle is conserved. Such conservations of canonical momenta lead to a reduction of the original Lagrangian. We shall state Routh’s theorem on this topic in an N -dimensional manifold. Theorem 3.1.3. Let the Lagrangian L.xI u/ of 2N variables be of class i h 2 function @ L./ 2 C and possess the property det @ui @uj ¤ 0. Moreover, L./ be endowed with a cyclic (or an ignorable ) variable x N such that @L./ 0; @L./ D c.N / D const. @x N @uN j:: Then, the reduced Lagrangian L./ WD L./ c.N / uN j:: implies that @L./ D @x N @L./ @uN @L./ @uN 0. Furthermore, N 1 Euler–Lagrange equations from L./, together with D c.N / , are implied by the original N Euler-Lagrangian equations. For the proof, we suggest [159]. As an example of Routh’s procedure, we apply the theorem to the Lagrangian (3.15) and conservation equations (3.17i,ii). The corresponding twice reduced Lagrangian is furnished by 3.1 Schwarzschild Solution r L.2/ r; I u ; u 235 1 D 2 ( 2m 1 r 1 2 .ur /2 C r 2 u ) h2 E2 : C .r sin /2 1 2m r (3.18) The Euler–Lagrange equation for the -coordinate from (3.18) yields h2 d.s/ cos .s/ d .R.s//2 D 0: 2 ds ds sin3 .s/ .R.s// (3.19) (The above equation is equivalent to (3.16ii).) We notice that there exists a special solution of (3.19), namely, .s/ D =2 D const. ; d.s/ 0: ds (3.20) Physically, (3.20) means that the test particle is pursuing an “equatorial orbit.” In such a case, the Euler–Lagrange equation for the r-coordinate from (3.18) implies that 8" # 9 # (" = 1 d < 2m 1 d 2m 1 r .ur /2 1 1 u ˇ ; ds : r 2 dr r ˇ:: #) " 2m 1 2h2 d 2 (3.21) 1 C 3 CE ˇ D 0: r dr r ˇ:: (We have substituted (3.20) into (3.21).) Equation (3.21) yields the first integral: ( 2m 1 r 2 h2 2m 2 1 .u / C 2 E 1 r r r 1 ) ˇ 1 : ˇ:: The above equation also follows from (1.186). Now we assume that the constant h in (3.17i) is nonzero, so that Therefore, we can reparametrize the curve by (3.22) d˚.s/ ds ¤ 0. b r D R.s/ D R.'/ ; b b dR.'/ d˚.s/ h dR.s/ dR.'/ D D h : i2 ds d' ds d' b R.'/ (3.23) 236 3 Spherically Symmetric Space–Time Domains Then, (3.22) and (3.23) yield ( )2 h h i2 dR.'/ i2 b b b C R.'/ R.'/ d' h h i3 i1 b b C 2m R.'/ D h2 E 2 1 C 2m R.'/ : (3.24) Now we make another coordinate transformation: y D .r/1 ; y D Y .'/ ; r > 2m > 0; h i2 dR.'/ b dY .'/ b D R.'/ 6 0 : d' d' (3.25) Equation (3.24) and its derivative imply that dY .'/ d' and, 2 2 3 C Y .'/ D h2 E 2 1 C 2m Y .'/ C 2m Y .'/ ; 2 d2 Y .'/ C Y .'/ D m= h2 C 3m Y .'/ : 2 d' (3.26i) (3.26ii) We shall try to investigate the above for a class of solutions given by perturbative techniques. We express the series and consequent equations as Y .'/ D Y.0/ .'/ C Y.1/ .'/ C ; (3.27i) d2 Y.0/ .'/ m C Y.0/ .'/ D 2 ; 2 d' h (3.27ii) 2 d2 Y.1/ .'/ C Y.1/ .'/ D 3m Y.0/ .'/ ; 2 d' (3.27iii) : The general solution of (3.27ii), which is the Newtonian approximation, is given by Q : Y.0/ .'/ D m= h2 1 C e cos .' !/ (3.28) Here, e and !Q are two constants of integration representing the eccentricity and the angle of perihelion of the orbit. The orbit is circular, elliptic, parabolic, or hyperbolic according to e D 0; 0 < e < 1; e D 1; 1 < e, respectively. We shall consider 3.1 Schwarzschild Solution 237 only the elliptic case 0 < e < 1 which corresponds to a planetary motion around the Sun. Putting (3.28) into (3.27iii), we obtain the differential equation: d2 Y.1/ .'/ 3m3 C Y.1/ .'/ D 4 1 C 2e cos .' !/ Q : Q C e 2 cos2 .' !/ 2 d' h (3.29) The particular integral of the above equation is Y.1/ .'/ D 1 3m3 2 1 cos 2 .' !/ Q ; 1 C e' sin .' !/ Q C e h4 2 6 Y .'/ D Y.0/ .'/ C Y.1/ .'/ C .higher order/ 3m2 m Q C 2 e' sin .' !/ Q D 2 1 C e cos .' !/ h h 3e 2 m2 1 1 cos 2 .' !/ Q C .higher order/ : C h2 2 6 (3.30i) (3.30ii) Out of the additional terms to the Newtonian approximation, the only term that can generate an observational effect is one proportional to e. Higher order terms are deemed to be ignorable. We can combine the second and the third term on the right hand side of (3.30ii) to express m˚ 1 Cb e.'/ cos .' !Q ı !.'// Q C ; 2 h s 2 2 3m ' D e C .higher order/ ; b e.'/ WD e 1 C h2 2 3m2 3m ' D 2 ' C .higher order/ : ı !.'/ Q WD Arctan 2 h h Y .'/ D (3.31) The change of the eccentricity is just about unobservable. However, the perihelion shift per single revolution is detectable and furnished by (momentarily reinstating the speed of light, c) 2 24 3 a2 3m .2/ D !Q WD ; 2 h2 .1 e 2 /c 2 T.0/ a WD semimajor axis of the orbit, e WD eccentricity of the orbit, c WD speed of light, T.0/ WD period of revolution (planet’s year). (Consult the reference-84, p. 89) (3.32) 238 3 Spherically Symmetric Space–Time Domains (2m, π) ϕ ∼{ Δω a r identify b 2 (2m, −π) x2 ∼ Δω a x1 2 b Fig. 3.2 Rosette motion of a planet and the perihelion shift For the planet Mercury, the above equation amounts to 43 0300 per century, which was previously inexplicable by Newtonian theory. We make a coordinate transformation from polar to Cartesian (of Example 1.1.1) to visualize the planetary motion in Fig. 3.2. Remark: Within the scope of the differential equation (3.26ii), there exist orbits which spiral around inward and eventually fall into the central body [35]. Inspiralling orbits are simply nonexistent in the Newtonian theory of gravitation due to a central point mass. Now we shall explore null geodesics in the Schwarzschild space–time characterized by (3.9). We use an affine parameter ˛ for the null curve. By changing from the parameter s to ˛, virtually all (3.16i–iv), (3.17i,ii), (3.18)–(3.21) can be repeated. However, (3.22) has to be changed to " 2m 1 r 1 h2 2m .u / C 2 E 2 1 r r r 2 1 # ˇ D 0: ˇ:: (3.33) 3.1 Schwarzschild Solution 239 Therefore, (3.26i,ii) are modified to dY .'/ d' 2 C ŒY .'/2 D h2 E 2 C 2m ŒY .'/3 ; d2 Y .'/ C Y .'/ D 3m ŒY .'/2 : d' 2 (3.34i) (3.34ii) We solve the equations by the same perturbative method, namely, Y .'/ D Y.0/ .'/ C Y.1/ .'/ C ; (3.35i) d2 Y.0/ .'/ C Y.0/ .'/ D 0 ; d' 2 (3.35ii) 2 d2 Y.1/ .'/ C Y.1/ .'/ D 3m Y.0/ .'/ : 2 d' (3.35iii) The general solution of (3.35ii) is given by Y.0/ .'/ D ŒR0 1 cos .' '0 / : (3.36) Here, R0 > 0 and '0 are constants of integration. For the sake of simplicity, we set '0 D 0 so that Y.0/ .'/ D ŒR0 1 cos ': (3.37) With the equation above, the particular integral (3.35iii) is furnished by Y.1/ .'/ D m ŒR0 2 cos2 ' C 2 sin2 ' : Therefore, Y .'/ D Y.0/ .'/ C Y.1/ .'/ C ; or or D ŒR0 1 cos ' C m ŒR0 2 cos2 ' C 2 sin2 ' C ; (3.38i) .rR0 / Y .'/ D r cos ' C mŒR0 1 cos ' r cos2 ' C 2r sin2 ' C ; (3.38ii) 1 1 2 2 x D r cos ' D ŒrY .'/ R0 mŒR0 r cos ' C 2r sin ' C 3 2 2 2 1 2 6 x C2 x 7 (3.38iii) D R0 m ŒR0 1 4 q 5C : .x 1 /2 C .x 2 /2 240 3 Spherically Symmetric Space–Time Domains x2 Δϕ R0 x1 2 Fig. 3.3 The deflection of light around the Sun Neglecting the higher order terms, two asymptotes for the null curve above are provided by the straight lines: x 1 D R0 2m ŒR0 1 x 2 : (3.39) Figure 3.3 depicts the deflection of light from a star around the Sun from the geometry of asymptotes. The deflection ' can be calculated from (3.39), and it is approximately given by ' D 4m : R0 (3.40) The predicted value ' in (3.40) amounts to 1:7500 for a light ray that barely misses the surface of the sun, and it has been confirmed experimentally. Now we shall deal with the third topic of physical interest. Optical or other electromagnetic wave emissions from the Sun or other distant stars reveal shifts of the standard wavelengths of known atomic spectral lines. The spectral shifts can be usefully split into a part due to relative motions (between the star and the detector) and a part due to gravitational fields. Since measured wavelengths or frequencies are related to the proper times of the sources or the observers, we look again into the Schwarzschild metric in (3.9). It will be simpler for our investigations to 3.1 Schwarzschild Solution 241 t Fig. 3.4 Two t -coordinate lines endowed with ideal clocks t=T r 2 r=2m r=r1 r=r2 study the induced metric of the submanifold M2 characterized by D =2 and ' D '0 D const. The induced metric is given by 1 4 2m 1 1 2m 1 g:: x ; x D 1 1 dx ˝ dx 1 1 dx 4 ˝ dx 4 ; x x d 2 2m D 1 r 1 2m .dt/2 : .dr/ 1 r 2 (3.41) In Fig. 3.4, we explore proper times along two straight world lines specified by r D r1 > 2m and r D r2 > r1 . By (2.91) and (3.37), proper times 1 and 2 along two t-coordinate lines are furnished by Z s 1 D T s 2m 1 dt D r1 0 Z s 2 D T 1 2m T ; r1 1 2m T ; r2 s 2m 1 dt D r2 0 v u u1 . 2 = 1/ D t 1 2m r2 2m r1 > 1: (3.42) Therefore, there is a change of proper time from one world line to another. Thus, relative frequencies (which are inversely proportional to time) or relative wavelengths (which are inversely proportional to frequency) of photons emitted 242 3 Spherically Symmetric Space–Time Domains from those two world lines are shifted. This gives rise to what is known as gravitational redshift. That is, electromagnetic waves emitted close to a gravitational source will reach distant observers with a smaller frequency (longer wavelength) than those emitted by a similar source further away from the gravitating object. This effect has been very well confirmed in many observations. For example, in the case of the dense companion of the star Sirius, there is agreement between observation and the prediction of general relativity in the frequency shift of spectral lines [15]. Remark: Figure 3.4 depicts the gravitational redshift in a coordinate chart corresponding to a submanifold of the curved space–time manifold. To summarize, there exist three critical phenomena associated with the Schwarzschild space–time. These are given by: 1. Advance of the perihelion shift of Mercury, 2. Deflection of a light ray grazing the Sun, 3. Spectral redshift of light emission from a distant star. The theory of general relativity is validated by all observations regarding the above three phenomena and other experimental tests [264, 265]. Exercises 3.1 1. Show that the following metric components belong to different coordinate charts of the Schwarzschild space–time: (i) The isotropic coordinate chart is characterized by " # m 2 2 2 2 1 2O m 4 2 2 2b r b db r Cb r d C sin db db t I ' ds D 1 C m 2b r 1 C 2Or n o b WD b D r; b ; b ' ;b t W .m=2/ < b r; 0 < b < ; < b ' < ; 1<b t<1 : 2 (ii) In another coordinate chart, the metric tensor components are furnished by 2m 2m 2 2 ˛ ˇ dt I ı˛ ıˇ x x dx dx 1 ds D ı˛ˇ C 2 r r .r 2m/ r WD q ı˛ˇ x ˛ x ˇ : 3.1 Schwarzschild Solution 243 (iii) In still another chart, the metric tensor components are given by 4 2 1 1 1 ds 2 D ex aex =2 bex =2 dx 1 C ae 2 x 1 =2 be 2 dx 2 C dx 3 x 1 =2 2 ab 1C 4 2 2 x2 C x3 2 1 ex .dt/2 : 1=2 Here, the constants satisfy m D 4a b 3 > 0. 2. Let the nonlinear, first-order ordinary differential equation (3.26i) be expressed as 0 2 y D f .y/ WD h2 E 2 1 C 2mh2 y y 2 C 2my 3 DW 2m .y y1 / .y y2 / .y y3 / : Here, the roots y1 ; y2 ; y3 of f .y/ D 0 are assumed to be real and to satisfy inequalities y1 < y2 < y3 . Prove that the general solution of (3.26i) is furnished by r i h p y y1 D sn .1=2/ 2m .y3 y1 / ' C c0 : y2 y1 Here, “sn” is the Jacobian elliptic function and c0 is the constant of integration. 3. The three-dimensional spatial hypersurface M3 (for t D t0 ) of the Schwarzschild space–time is given by the induced metric: h i 2m 1 2 .dr/2 C r 2 .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 : dl D 1 r Show that the geodesics of M3 admitting this metric are also (spacelike) geodesics of the Schwarzschild space–time with M4 . 4. Consider the static, spherically metric in (3.1). Solve the field equations Gij .x/ D gij .x/ (with the cosmological constant ). Deduce that the resulting metric can be transformed into the Kottler solution: 1 2m 1 r2 .dr/2 C r 2 .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 ds 2 D 1 r 3 2m 1 2m 1 1 r 2 .dt/2 ; 1 r 2 > 0: r 3 r 3 5. Show that a domain of the Schwarzschild space–time can be embedded locally in a six-dimensional flat manifold of signature C2. 244 3 Spherically Symmetric Space–Time Domains 6. Consider a “spherically symmetric” N -dimensional .N 4/ pseudo-Riemannian metric: 2 ds 2 D e˛.r/ .dr/2 C r 2 d˝.N 2/ e.r/ dt 2 ; d˝.N 2/ 2 WD .d2 / C 2 N 1 X nD3 " n1 Y ! # sin m .dn / 2 2 I mD2 n D.N / WD .r; 2 ; 3 ; : : : ; N 1 ; t/ W 0 < .2m/1=N 3 < r; o 0 < 2 ; 3 ; : : : ; N 2 < ; < N 1 < ; 1 < t < 1 : Prove that field equations Gij .x/ D 0 yield e˛.r/ D 1 e .r/ 2m > 0; r N 3 2m D 1 N 3 r ek > 0 : This is the higher dimensional generalization of the Schwarzschild metric. Answers and Hints to Selected Exercises 1. (i) Transformations to the usual Schwarzschild coordinates are given by m 2 r D 1C b r; Db ; ' Db '; t Db t: 2rO (iii) m 2 a b r 1 1 1C D 1 ex ; 2m 2rO b r ab 22 b x C x 32 ; D 2 Arctan 4 r 2 3 b 4 x : b ' D arc x ; x ; b tD a 2. Put 1p z WD 2m .y3 y1 / ' ; 2 r y2 y1 k WD < 1: y3 y1 r w WD y y1 ; y2 y1 3.1 Schwarzschild Solution 245 Then the nonlinear ordinary differential equation yields w0 D p dW .z/ D .1 w2 / .1 k 2 w2 / : dz 3. Consider the function F .r/ which satisfies the differential equation: dF .r/ dr 2 1 D .r 2m/ m2 Cr : r3 Let the four-dimensional Schwarzschild space–time domain be expressed as the parametrized submanifold: r 2m 1 1 y D .r; ; '; t/ WD 1 cos t; r r 2m 2 2 y D ./ WD 1 sin t ; r y 3 D 3 ./ WD F .r/ ; y 4 D 4 ./ WD r sin cos ' ; y 5 D 5 ./ WD r sin sin ' ; y 6 D 6 ./ WD r cos I gQ :: .y/ D dy 1 ˝ dy 1 dy 2 ˝ dy 2 C dy 3 ˝ dy 3 C dy 4 ˝ dy 4 C dy 5 ˝ dy 5 C dy 6 ˝ dy 6 : 4. Equations reduce to the following: .N 3/ 1 e˛.r/ C re˛.r/ @1 ˛ D 0 ; .N 3/ 1 e˛.r/ re˛.r/ @1 D 0 ; l e˛.r/ 2.N 3/ 2@1 @1 C .@1 /2 C .@1 @1 ˛/ 4 r @1 ˛ @1 C 2 2.N 3/.N 4/ .N 3/.N 4/ D 0: 2 r r2 246 3 Spherically Symmetric Space–Time Domains 3.2 Spherically Symmetric Static Interior Solutions Here we consider spherically symmetric space–time domains which are not vacuum space–times. These space–times are useful approximations to the gravitational fields produced inside of stars, for example. As we are still dealing with spherical symmetry, the metric can still be taken to be that of (3.1). The domain of consideration is now ˚ D WD .r; ; '; t/ W 0 < r1 < r < r2 ; 0 < < ; < ' < ; 1 < t < 1 : (3.43) We often consider r D r2 to be the boundary of the star so that the metric for r > r2 is given by the vacuum Schwarzschild metric (3.9). Alternatively, the matter field, as manifest in the components Tij , can fall off smoothly so that the solution asymptotically approaches the Schwarzschild solution. The interior field equations and conservation equations reduce to E 11 .r/ D r 2 1 e.˛C / @1 .re / C T 11 .r/ D 0 ; h E 22 .r/ D e˛ .1=2/ @1@1 .1=4/.@1 /2 C .1=2/ r 1 .@1 ˛ @1 / C .1=4/ @1 ˛ @1 C T 22 .r/ D 0 ; E 33 .r/ E 22 .r/ ; E 44 .r/ D r 2 1 @1 .re˛ / C T 44 .r/ D 0 ; T 33 .r/ (3.44i) i (3.44ii) (3.44iii) (3.44iv) T 22 .r/ ; (3.44v) T 12 .r/ D T 13 .r/ D T 14 .r/ D T 23 .r/ D T 24 .r/ D T 34 .r/ D 0 I .r=2/ T1 .r/ D T 22 .r/ C .r=2/ @1 T 11 C 1 C .r=4/ @1 T 11 .r/ .r=4/ @1 T 44 .r/ D 0 ; T2 .r/ D T3 .r/ D T4 .r/ 0 : (3.44vi) (3.44vii) We solve the above system of semilinear ordinary differential equations by the mixed method outlined in the following steps: (i) Prescribe T 44 .r/ and solve the equation E 44 .r/ D 0 to obtain g 11 .r/ D e˛.r/ . (ii) Prescribe T 11 .r/ and solve the equation E 11 .r/ E 44 .r/ D 0 to get g44 .r/ D e.r/ . (iii) Define T 22 .r/ by (3.44vi) namely .r=2/ T1 .r/ D 0. 3.2 Spherically Symmetric Static Interior Solutions 247 At this stage, all the field equations and conservation equations are satisfied. With the above prescriptions, we can furnish the most general solution of the system of differential equations in (3.44i–vii). It is stated in the following theorem. (See [63].) Theorem 3.2.1. Consider the spherically symmetric, static metric (3.1) and the domain D of equation (3.43). The system of semilinear ordinary differential equations (3.44i–vii) yield the most general solution as e˛.r/ 3 2 Zr 14 D 1 T 44 .y/ y 2 dy 5 > 0 ; 2m0 r (3.45i) r1 e.r/ 8 9 Zr < = T 11 .y/ T 44 .y/ e˛.y/ y dy ; D e˛.r/ exp k C : ; (3.45ii) r1 T 22 .r/ T 33 .r/ WD .r=2/ @1 T 11 C 1 C .r=4/ @1 T 11 .r/ .r=4/ @1 T 44 .r/ : (3.45iii) Here, m0 and k are two arbitrary constants of integration. Moreover, two differentiable functions T 11 .r/ and T 44 .r/ are prescribed. Proof. The field equation (3.44iv) implies that @1 .re˛ / D 1 C r 2 T 44 .r/ : The above equation is a linear, first-order, nonhomogeneous ordinary differential equation for the function re˛.r/ . The general solution of the corresponding homogeneous equation, @1 re˛.r/ D 0, is given by re˛.r/ hom. D 2m0 . (Here, m0 is the arbitrary constant of integration.) The particular integral of the same equation is Zr ˛.r/ T 44 .y/ y 2 dy : re part. D r C r1 Therefore, the most general solution is the linear combination re˛.r/ hom. C ˛.r/ re part. yielding (3.45i). Now, the field equation E 11 .r/ E 44 .r/ D 0 yields @1 D @1 ˛ C re˛.r/ T 11 .r/ T 44 .r/ : The above equation is a linear, first-order, nonhomogeneous ordinary differential equation for .r/. The most general solution is provided by (3.45ii) (where k is the arbitrary constant of integration). By the prescriptions suggested in p. 246, all other field equations are satisfied. 248 3 Spherically Symmetric Space–Time Domains x2 R1 R0 x1 R2 Fig. 3.5 Qualitative representation of a spherical body inside a concentric shell Remarks: (i) It is evident from (3.44v) that ŒT ij .r/ must be diagonalizable. Moreover, only Segre characteristic Œ1; .1; 1/; 1; Œ.1; 1; 1/; 1; Œ.1; 1; 1; 1/ and the stiff case T 11 .r/ D T 44 .r/ are allowed. (ii) Weak energy conditions (2.194i) reduce to T 44 .r/ 0 ; T 44 .r/ C T 11 .r/ 0 ; T 44 .r/ C T 22 .r/ 0 : (3.46) (iii) Synge’s junction conditions (2.170) on the outer boundary of a spherical body (at r D r2 ) imply the continuity of ˛.r/ and .r/ across r D r2 . Furthermore, the conditions imply that T 11 .r/jr2 D 0; (3.47) in the case where the boundary joins to the vacuum. For boundaries which join two different types of matter, the radial pressure must be continuous. We notice in the proof of Theorem 3.2.1 that two relevant ordinary differential equations are linear. Therefore, a superposition of distinct solutions to these equations is also a solution. This feature gives rise to interesting physical consequences. Consider two-dimensional coordinate charts of Figs. 3.2 and 3.3. In such a chart, now we represent a spherical body of mass m0 and a concentric, thick spherical shell of mass m1 as in Fig. 3.5. 3.2 Spherically Symmetric Static Interior Solutions 249 We express explicitly the metric function e˛.r/ for the above two bodies in the following: 8 2m0 for 0 < 2m0 < R0 < r < R1 ; ˆ ˆ ˆ Zr ˆ < ˛.r/ T 44 .y/ y 2 dy for R1 < r < R2 ; r e 1 D 2m0 C ˆ ˆ ˆ R1 :̂ 2.m0 C m1 / for R2 < r < 1 I ZR2 m1 WD T 44 .y/ y 2 dy : 2 (3.48) R1 Similarly, the metric function e.r/ can be determined. Usually in general relativity, the space–time metric generated by two massive bodies interacting only gravitationally cannot be static. The reason for this is that the nonlinear gravitational equations inherently imply nontrivial equations of motion for bodies. (See [17].). As well, physically, two distinct bodies interacting solely gravitationally cannot apply forces on each other which counteract the gravitational attraction. However, the spherically symmetric bodies in Fig. 3.5 are already in equilibrium (in some sense) due to the fact that the shell, if self-interacting, can support itself against the gravitational pull of the interior sphere. Hence, a static solution is possible. In Newtonian gravitational theory, the equilibrium among concentric spherically symmetric bodies is well known. It so happens that equilibria in Newtonian scenarios may lead to exact static solutions of Einstein’s field equations. (Consult Example 2.2.9.) Now we shall apply Theorem 3.2.1 to the case of a spherically symmetric, perfect fluid body. (We have touched upon the case of a perfect fluid in (2.182), (2.257i–iv), and Example 2.3.1.) We will reiterate the energy–momentum–stress tensor components in the static case as T ij .x/ D .x/ C p.x/ U i .x/ Uj .x/ C p.x/ ı ij ; (3.49i) U ˛ .x/ 0 ; (3.49ii) T 11 .x/ U 4 .x/ U4 .x/ 1 ; T 22 .x/ T 33 .x/ D p.x/ ; T 44 .x/ D .x/ : (3.49iii) With the spherically symmetric metric of (3.1), we consider the domain D WD f.r; ; '; t/ W 0 < r < b; 0 < < ; < ' < ; 1 < t < 1g : Furthermore, we obtain from (3.49i–iii), U ˛ .x/ 0 ; U 4 .x/ D U 4 .r/ D exp Œ.r/=2 > 0 ; T 11 .r/ T 22 .r/ T 33 .r/ D p.r/ ; T 44 .r/ D .r/ : (3.50) 250 3 Spherically Symmetric Space–Time Domains Solutions in (3.45i,ii) yield: 2M.r/ ; r Zr .y/ y 2 dy ; e˛.r/ D 1 M.r/ WD 2 0C e.r/ 8 r 9 < Z .y/ C p.y/ = 2M.r/ exp y 2 dy : D 1 : ; r y 2M.y/ (3.51) 0C (Here, we have set the constant k D 0.) Unlike in (3.45i,ii), the function T 11 .r/ D p.r/ is no more freely prescribable. The reason for this complication is that (3.50) now implies that T 11 .r/ D T 22 .r/. Therefore, we cannot define T 22 .r/ by (3.45iii). Instead, we have to solve the conservation equation (3.45iii) expressed as (3.52) @1 p D .1=2/ .r/ C p.r/ @1 : (This is sometimes known as the isotropy equation.) By the use of the equation for .r/ in (3.51), (3.52) above implies that dp.r/ Œ.r/ C p.r/ ŒM.r/ C . =2/ p.r/ r 3 D : dr rŒr 2M.r/ (3.53) The above equation is called the Oppenheimer–Volkoff equation of hydrostatic equilibrium. (See [184].) Example 3.2.2. Let us consider the following special case involving a constant mass density “star.” We choose .r/ D 3q D positive const. ; Zr 2M.r/ D 3q y 2 dy D qr 3 > 0 ; 0C e ˛.r/ D 1 qr 2 > 0 : (3.54) (Although constant density is not totally physical, such simple solutions help shed light on more realistic scenarios.) Assuming, .r/ C p.r/ ¤ 0, (3.52) yields @1 ln 3 or, 3 1 1 q C p.r/ D .1=2/ @1 ; q C p.r/ D K0 e.r/=2 : Here, K0 is the arbitrary constant of integration. (3.55) 3.2 Spherically Symmetric Static Interior Solutions 251 The equation E 11 .r/ E 44 .r/ D 0, with (3.55), implies that e=2 e˛ Œ@1 ˛ C @1 D K0 r ; or, or, 3=2 d =2 e .1 qr 2 /1=2 D K0 r ; 2 1 qr 2 dr p K0 C0 1 qr 2 : eŒ.r/=2 D 2q (3.56) Here, C0 ¤ 0 is the constant of integration. Substituting (3.56) into (3.55), we obtain # p q 1 qr 2 .K0 =2/ p : . K0 =2q/ C0 1 qr 2 " p.r/ D 3C0 1 (3.57) Inserting the boundary condition p.b/ D 0, (which is Synge’s junction condition in (3.47) at r D b, the stellar boundary separating the material from the vacuum), the equation above yields p . K0 =2q/ D 3C0 1 qb 2 ; p.r/ D 3q 1 "p # p 1 qr 2 1 qb 2 : p p 3 1 qb 2 1 qr 2 (3.58i) (3.58ii) Therefore, p.r/ is a positive-valued, monotonically decreasing function provided p p 3 1 qb 2 > 1 qr 2 : Putting (3.58i) into (3.56), we get i2 h p p e.r/ D .C0 /2 3 1 qb 2 1 qr 2 : (3.59) (3.60) Stipulating lim e.r/ D 1, we obtain r!0C h p i2 .C0 /2 D 3 1 qb 2 1 : (3.61) Now, the total mass of the fluid body is furnished by Zb m WD lim M.r/ D . =2/ r!b 0C .r/ r 2 dr D .qb 3 =2/ > 0: (3.62) 252 3 Spherically Symmetric Space–Time Domains By the inequality (3.59), we derive that 9 1 qb 2 > 1 ; or, 8b > qb 3 D 2m ; 9 or, b > .9=8/.2m/ > 2m : (3.63) Therefore, the radius of the fluid body must exceed the Schwarzschild radius. Otherwise, there will be instability and the exact solution will not hold. (The above inequality is sometimes known as the Buchdahl inequality [31].) The metric component g44 .r/ D e.r/ can be deduced, both in the interior and in the exterior to the fluid body, from (3.60), (3.61), and the vacuum solution (3.7). It is explicitly furnished as 8" p #2 p ˆ 3 1 qb 2 1 qr 2 ˆ ˆ p for 0 < r < b ; ˆ < 3 1 qb 2 1 .r/ D e (3.64) ˆ ˆ ˆ 2m :̂ 1 ek for b < r < 1 : r Demanding continuity of e.r/ across the boundary r D b, we derive that #2 " p 2 1 qb 2 2m .r/ .r/ lim e ek ; p D D lim e D 1 2 r!b r!b b C 3 1 qb 1 or, h p i2 e k D 4 3 1 qb 2 1 : (3.65) Summarizing, we furnish both the interior and exterior metrics as: Interior: Exterior: 1 .dr/2 C r 2 .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 ds 2 D 1 qr 2 #2 " p p 3 1 qb 2 1 qr 2 p .dt/2 I 3 1 qb 2 1 2m 1 2 .dr/2 C r 2 .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 ds D 1 r 4 1 2m r 2 h p i2 .dt/ : 2 3 1 qb 1 (3.66i) (3.66ii) 3.2 Spherically Symmetric Static Interior Solutions 253 The exterior metric in (3.66ii) can be transformed into the Schwarzschild chart by r# D r ; " t# D # D ; '# D ' ; # 2 p t: 3 1 qb 2 1 The interior solution (3.66i) is known as Schwarzschild’s interior solution.2 Remark: For the case of a static, spherically symmetric perfect fluid, many exact solutions are cited in the books [118, 239]. Example 3.2.3. Now we shall consider a domain of a spherically symmetric, static, electro-vac universe (containing gravity and electrostatic fields only). The pertinent field equations are provided by the Einstein–Maxwell equations (2.290i–vi). In the present context, we choose F.1/.4/ .x/ ¤ 0 ; F.2/.4/ .x/ D F.3/.4/ .x/ 0 ; F.˛/.ˇ/ .x/ 0 ; @4 F.i /.j / 0 D @3 F.i /.j / : (3.67) The above equations indicate that only the radial component of the electric field is nonzero. Other electromagnetic field components are assumed to vanish. Maxwell’s equations M3 ./ D M2 ./ D 0 imply that @2 F41 D 0 D @3 F41 ; or, F14 .x/ D F14 .x 1 / D F14 .r/ ¤ 0 : (3.68) The metric in (3.1) provides p g D e.˛C /=2 r 2 sin : Therefore, Maxwell’s equation M4 ./ D 0 in (2.290i) yields p g F 4j D @1 r 2 sin e.˛C /=2 F 41 D 0 0 D @j or, F 41 .r/ D e0 e.˛C /=2 ; r2 2 It should be noted that sometimes the domain 0 < r < 2m of the metric (3.9) also goes by this name. 254 3 Spherically Symmetric Space–Time Domains F.1/.4/ .r/ D e0 ¤ 0; r2 Fij .x/F ij .x/ < 0 : (3.69) Here, e0 is the constant of integration representing the charge parameter. All other Maxwell’s equations in (2.290ii,iii) are satisfied. The components of the electromagnetic energy–momentum–stress tensor from (2.290i) reduce to T 11 .r/ D T 22 .r/ D T 33 .r/ D T 44 .r/ D .e0 /2 ; 2r 4 T ij ./ 0 ; other T 11 .r/ T 44 .r/ 0 ; T ii .r/ 0 : (3.70) Note that the above components imply the Segre characteristic to be Œ.1; 1/; .1; 1/. (Consult Theorem 2.5.6.) The “energy density” of the electric field is furnished by T .4/ .4/ .r/ e02 > 0: 2r 4 D T 44 .r/ D (3.71) The “total energy” of the spherically symmetric electric field present between radii r1 < r < r2 is Zr2 . =2/ T .4/ 2 .4/ .r/ r dr D . =2/ .e02 =2/ r1 1 1 > 0: r1 r2 (3.72) The exact solutions of (2.290i–v) from (3.67), (3.69), (3.70), and (3.45i,ii) are given by e ˛.r/ De .r/ 2m0 C D1 r r 1 e2 2m0 C 0 D1 r 2r1 DW 1 Zr T 44 .y/ y 2 dy r1 C e2 2m C 2 > 0: r r (Here, we have set the constant k D 0 in (3.45ii).) e02 2r 2 (3.73) 3.2 Spherically Symmetric Static Interior Solutions 255 Thus, from (3.73), we express the exact solution as " g:: .x/ D e2 2m 1 1 C x .x 1 /2 #1 .dx 1 ˝ dx 1 / 2 C x 1 .dx 2 ˝ dx 2 / C sin2 x 2 .dx 3 ˝ dx 3 / # e2 2m .dx 4 ˝ dx 4 / ; 1 1 C x .x 1 /2 " ds 2 D 1 e2 2m C 2 r r 1 1 .dr/2 C r 2 .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 2m e2 C 2 .dt/2 : r r (3.74) The above metric for r 2 2mr Ce 2 > 0 is known as the Reissner-Nordström-Jeffery metric [145, 196, 218] (also see [84]). In the preceding considerations, we have assumed that the material energy density is strictly positive. However, in the arena of static, spherically symmetric space–time domains, assuming that energy conditions are not necessarily respected, there may exist exotic materials which open up a “hollow tunnel” between two branches of the same space–time. Such a scenario is provided by the existence of the (so-called) wormhole. (See Fig. 2.17c.) The topic of wormholes will be discussed briefly in Appendix 6. Exercises 3.2 1. Prove that for an incoherent dust (of (2.256)) with .x/ > 0 and U ˛ .x/ 0, the static metric (3.1) does not admit any solution of the gravitational field equations. Physically, why would you expect no static solutions for such a system? 2. Consider the following transformations: x 2 R; x WD r 2 > 0 ; .x/ WD e.r/=2 ; w.x/ WD M.r/ r 3 : 256 3 Spherically Symmetric Space–Time Domains (i) Prove that field equations (3.51), (3.53), and (3.44ii) go over into p e˛. x/ D 1 2x w.x/ ; p x D 6w.x/ C 4x @x w ; p p x D 2w.x/ C Œ4 8x w.x/ @x .ln / ; Œ2 4x w @x @x .2w C 2x @x w/ @x @x w D 0: (ii) Show that the last equation above remains unchanged under the transformation Z b D; b w D C0 Œ C 2x @x 2 exp 4 @x . C 2x@x /1 dx : 3. Consider the metric (3.1) and static, spherically symmetric, electromagneto-vac equations (2.290i–vi). Assume that F14 .x/ ¤ 0; F23 .x/ ¤ 0, and all other Fij .x/ 0. (i) Show that exact solutions of the electromagneto-vac equations can be transformed into e0 e0 F14 .r/ D 2 e.˛C /=2 ; F.1/.4/ .r/ D 2 D E.1/ .r/ ; r r F23 ./ D 0 sin ; ds 2 D 1 F.2/.3/ .r/ D .e 2 C 2m C r r2 1 2 .e 2 C 2m C r r2 / 0 r2 1 2 / D H.1/ .r/ ; .dr/2 C r 2 .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 .dt/2 : Here, m; e0 ; 0 , etc., are constants of integration. (ii) Determine the external domain of validity for the solutions in the preceding part. 4. Consider general solutions (3.45i–iii) of the static, spherically symmetric interior field equations in D WD f.r; ; '; t/ W 0 < r < b; 0 < < ; < ' < ; 1 < t < 1g : Let the corresponding vacuum equations be satisfied in the exterior domain D0 WD f.r; ; '; t/ W b < r < 1; 0 < < ; < ' < ; 1 < t < 1g : 3.2 Spherically Symmetric Static Interior Solutions 257 Obtain the general solution of the problem satisfying (i) Synge’s junction condition (2.170) at r D b and (ii) weak energy conditions T 44 .r/ 0 and T 44 .r/ C T 11 .r/ 0. Answers and Hints to Selected Exercises 1. Use (3.53) with p.r/ 0. (Remark: Eventual collapse is inevitable.) 3. (i) Maxwell’s equations M3 D M2 D M1 D 0 yield F14 .r/ D D E.1/ . Maxwell’s equations M4 D M2 D M3 D 0 imply F23 ./ D 0 sin ; F.2/.3/ .r/ D 0 r2 2. Let rC WD m C e.˛C /=2 D H.1/ .r/; T 11 .r/ T 44 .r/ T 22 .r/ T 33 .r/ D p (ii) Assume that m e 2 C domain of validity is e0 r2 .e02 C 20 / : 2r 4 p m2 .e 2 C 2 /. A possible D WD f.r; ; '; t/ W rC < r; 0 < < ; < ' < ; 1 < t < 1g f.r; ; '; t/ W rC < r; D =2; ' D 0; 1 < t < 1g : (Remark: This solution represents a combined electric as well as magnetic monopole source. The magnetic monopole has a massless, semi-infinite string attached [78].) 4. T 44 .r/ WD .b r/nC2 expŒF .r/ > 0 ; ˚ T 11 .r/ WD .b r/nC2 Œh.r/2 exp ŒF .r/ ; T 44 .r/ C T 11 .r/ D .b r/nC2 Œh.r/2 0 ; T 11 .b/ D 0 I Zr 2M.r/ WD .b y/nC2 expŒF .y/ y 2 dy > 0 ; 0C m WD lim M.r/ ; r!b 258 3 Spherically Symmetric Space–Time Domains e˛.r/ D 1 e.r/ 2M.r/ ; r 8 < 2M.r/ exp k C D 1 : r Zr 9 = .b y/nC2 Œh.y/2 y 2 dy : ; y 2M.y/ 0C (Here, n is a positive integer and F .r/; h.r/ are thrice differentiable arbitrary slack functions.) 3.3 Nonstatic, Spherically Symmetric Solutions The space–time metric g:: .x/ admitting three independent Killing vectors @ @ C cot x 2 cos x 3 3 ; @x 2 @x @ @ @ ; cos x 3 2 cot x 2 sin x 3 3 ; and @x @x @x 3 sin x 3 is reducible to g:: .x/ D e˛.x 1 ;x 4 / e.x 1 2 2 dx ˝ dx 1 C x 1 dx ˝ dx 2 C sin2 x 2 dx 3 ˝ dx 3 1 ;x 4 / dx 4 ˝ dx 4 : (3.75) (Rigorous proof of the above conclusion can be found in [250].) We can also express (3.75) as ds 2 D e˛.r;t / .dr/2 C r 2 .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 e.r;t / .dt/2 I i i e.1/ .r; t/ D e˛=2 ı.1/ ; i i e.2/ .r/ D r 1 ı.2/ ; i i e.3/ .r; / D .r sin /1 ı.3/ ; i i e.4/ .r; t/ D e=2 ı.4/ : (3.76) In the present case, the ten field equations (2.161i) and four conservation equations (2.166i) reduce to the following3: E 11 .r; t/ WD r 2 Œ1 e˛ .1 C r@1 / C T 11 .r; t/ D 0 ; 3 (3.77i) j To derive (3.77vii,viii), use equations for a symmetric tensor Sjk : rj S k D the following p p j jgj Sk 12 @k gij S ij . 1= jgj @j 3.3 Nonstatic, Spherically Symmetric Solutions 259 E 22 .r; t/ WD .1=2/e˛ Œ@1 @1 C .1=2r/ .r@1 C 2/ @1 .˛ / C .1=2/e Œ@4 @4 ˛ C .1=2/ @4 ˛ @4 .˛ / C T 22 .r; t/ D 0 ; (3.77ii) E 33 .r; t/ E 22 .r; t/ D 0 ; (3.77iii) E 14 .r; t/ WD r 1 @4 .e ˛ / C T 14 .r; t/ D 0 ; (3.77iv) E 44 .r; t/ WD r 2 Œ1 @1 .re ˛ / C T 44 .r; t/ D 0 ; (3.77v) T 22 .r; t/ T 33 .r; t/ ; T 12 ./ D T 13 ./ D T 23 ./ D T 24 ./ D T 34 ./ 0 ; (3.77vi) T1 .r; t/ WD @1 T 11 C @4 T 41 C .2=r/ Œ1 C .r=4/ @1 T 11 .r; t/ C .1=2/ @4.˛ C / T 41 .r; t/ .1=2/ @1 T 44 .r; t/ .2=r/ T 22 .r; t/ D 0 ; (3.77vii) T4 .r; t/ WD @1 T 14 C @4 T 44 C .2=r/ Œ1 C .r=4/ @1 .˛ C / T 14 .r; t/ C .1=2/ @4˛ T 44 .r; t/ T 11 .r; t/ D 0 ; (3.77viii) T2 .r; t/ D T3 .r; t/ 0 : (3.77ix) We investigate the above system of partial differential equations in the following two-dimensional convex domain in the coordinate plane: D W f.r; t/ W 0 < r < B.t/; t1 < t < t2 g : (3.78) Here, the boundary curve r D B.t/, representing the boundary of a nonstatic spherical body, is assumed to be twice differentiable. (See Fig. 3.6.) Now, in a convex domain,4 the general solution of the system of partial differential equations (3.77i–ix) will be provided. (See [63].) Theorem 3.3.1. Let metric functions ˛.r; t/ and .r; t/ of (3.76) be of class C 3 in the convex domain D of (3.78). Then, the general solution of the system of partial differential equations (3.77i–ix) is furnished by: 4 Counterexamples for nonconvex domains are provided in [61]. 260 3 Spherically Symmetric Space–Time Domains t Fig. 3.6 A convex domain D in a two-dimensional coordinate plane r=B(t) t2 D t1 D0 r 2 2 e˛.r;t / D 1 r 4f .t/ Zr 3 T 44 .y; t/ y 2 dy 5 > 0 ; (3.79i) 0C e.r;t / 8 2 39 Zr < = T 11 .y; t/ T 44 .y; t/ e˛.y;t / ydy5 ; D e˛.r;t / exp4h.t/ C : ; 0C 2 T 14 .r; t/ 1 df .t/ WD 2 4 r dt T 22 .r; t/ Zr 3 @4 T 44 y 2 dy 5 ; (3.79ii) (3.79iii) 0C T 33 .r; t/ WD .r=2/ @1 T 11 C @4 T 41 C Œ1 C .r=4/@1 T 11 C .r=4/ @4 .˛ C / T 41 .r=4/ @1 T 44 ; (3.79iv) where f .t/ and h.t/ are two arbitrary C 3 functions of integration. Proof. The mixed method of p. 197 is used. Prescribe T 44 .r; t/ and solve E 44 .r; t/ D 0 to obtain e˛.r;t / of (3.79i). Prescribe T 11 .r; t/ and solve E 11 .r; t/E 44 .r; t/ D 0 to get e.r;t / of (3.79ii). Define T 14 .r; t/ by the equation E 14 .r; t/ D 0 to obtain (3.79iii). Finally, define T 22 .r; t/ T 33 .r; t/ by the conservation equation T1 .r; t/ D 0 to get (3.79iv). At this stage, using (3.77vi), all other field equations are satisfied. (Remark: Auxiliary conditions, such as an equation of state or the condition of isotropy, may be imposed. These scenarios are also encompassed in the above solution.) Now we investigate the nonstatic, spherically symmetric metric (3.76) and vacuum field equations (2.164i) to derive Birkhoff’s theorem [20, 144, 184]. 3.3 Nonstatic, Spherically Symmetric Solutions 261 Theorem 3.3.2. Let metric functions ˛.r; t/ and .r; t/ of (3.76) be of class C 3 in the rectangular coordinate domain D WD f.r; t/ W 0 < r1 r; t1 < t < t2 g : Then, the general solution of the vacuum equations is transformable to the Schwarzschild metric. Proof. For vacuum equations (2.164i), we put T ij .r; t/ 0. Equation (3.79iii) yields df .t/ D 0; dt or, f .t/ D 2 1 m D const. Therefore, (3.79i,ii) imply that 2m > 0; e˛.r;t / D 1 r 2m expŒh.t/ > 0: e.r;t / D 1 r A coordinate transformation is introduced by b r Dr; b tD b D; Zt exp h.w/ 2 b ' D'; dw : t1 Dropping hats subsequently, the Schwarzschild metric (3.9) is established. Remark: One physical implication of Birkhoff’s theorem is that a pulsating, spherically symmetric body cannot generate external gravitational waves (see Appendix 5). Now we shall derive the total mass function M.r; t/ and the boundary surface of the spherical body. We notice from field equations (3.77i–ix) two additional differential identities: @1 r 2 G 14 C @4 r 2 G 44 0 ; (3.80i) @1 .˛ C / G 14 .r; t/ C @4 ˛ G 44 ./ G 11 ./ 0 : (3.80ii) j (However, since rj G 4 0, only one of above identities is independent.) Thus, from (3.80i) and field equations (3.77i–ix), we deduce the new conservation equation: . =2/ @1 r 2 T 14 C @4 r 2 T 44 D 0 : (3.81) 262 3 Spherically Symmetric Space–Time Domains This conservation equation has an immediate physical interpretation. It states that the rate of change of “energy” inside a sphere of radius r is equal to the “energy” flux through the boundary of thesame sphere. Consider the 1-form . =2/ r 2 T 14 .r; t/ dt r 2 T 44 .r; t/ dr . It is a closed form due to (3.81) in a convex coordinate domain. Therefore, by Theorem 1.2.21, there exists a differentiable function M.r; t/ such that dM.r; t/ D . r 2 =2/ T 14 .r; t/ dt T 44 .r; t/ dr ; (3.82i) @1 M D . =2/r 2 T 44 .r; t/ ; @4 M D . =2/r 2 T 14 .r; t/ : (3.82ii) The integration of the differential equation (3.82i) leads to the total mass function M.r; t/. Consider a level curve furnished by M.r; t/ D c > 0. Let an interior point .r0 ; t0 / of D, be such that M.r0 ; t0 / D c and @1 Mj.r0 ;t0 / D 2 .r0 /2 T 44 .r0 ; t0 / > 0. By the implicit function theorem (see [32]), there exists a differentiable curve r D B.tI c/ in the neighborhood of .r0 ; t0 / such that M ŒB.tI c/; t c and r0 D B.t0 I c/. Out of the one-parameter level curves r D B.tI c/, the boundary curve of a spherically symmetric body must be defined as follows: r D B.t/ WD lim B.tI c/ ; c!m @D WD f.r; t/ W r D B.t/; t1 < t < t2 g ; M ŒB.t/I t m > c > 0; ı ı dB.t/ D @4 M @1 M j@D D T 14 ./ T 44 ./ j:: : dt (3.83) The above equations are valid on the boundary curve @D of Fig. 3.6. Let us explore Synge’s junction condition (2.170) on the boundary r D B.t/. By (3.79i,ii) and (3.82ii), we deduce that 2 2M.r; t/ D 4f .t/ e˛.r;t / D 8 < Zr 3 T 44 .y; t/y 2 dy 5 > 0 ; (3.84i) 0C 2M.r; t/ for 0 < r < B.t/; t1 < t < t2 ; 1 2m r :1 > 0 for B.t/ < r; t1 < t < t2 I r (3.84ii) 3.3 Nonstatic, Spherically Symmetric Solutions e.r;t / 263 # 8" 2M.r; t/ ˆ ˆ ˆ exp Œh.t/ C .r; t/ for 0 < r < B.t/; : : : ; < 1 r D ˆ ˆ 2m :̂ 1 exp Œh.t/ C .B.t/; t/ for B.t/ < r; : : : ; r (3.84iii) Zr .r; t/ WD T 11 .y; t/ T 44 .y; t/ y 2 dy : y 2M.y; t/ (3.84iv) 0C Continuity of the functions ˛.r; t/ and .r; t/ across the boundary is obvious. Moreover, the external metric is transformable to the Schwarzschild metric. (Note that we are assuming a matter-vacuum boundary.) Junction conditions T ij ./ ni j@D D 0 reduce to T 11 ./ @1 M C T 41 ./ @4 M j@D D 0 ; (3.85i) T 14 ./ @1 M C T 44 ./ @4 M j@D D 0 : (3.85ii) The condition (3.85ii) is identically satisfied by (3.82ii,iii). In case the “velocity” of / the boundary dB.t dt ¤ 0, the other junction condition (3.85i) can be satisfied by the choice: ( ˇ) ˇ 4 ˇ T 4 .r; t/ ˇ dB.t/ 2 2m 2 h.t / ˇ e WD 1 exp Œ.r; t/ ˇˇ 1 > 0 : (3.86) dt r T 1 .r; t/ ˇ ˇˇ rDB.t / (See [63].) We notice that the energy–momentum–stress matrix ŒT ij .r; t/ in (3.79i– iv) is not necessarily diagonalizable. The criterion for diagonalization is 2 2 .r; t/ WD T 11 ./ T 44 ./ 4e˛ T 14 ./ 0 : (3.87) (In case of .r; t/ < 0, there exist complex eigenvalues and hence exotic matter.) In case .r; t/ 0, (2.194i) can be employed to investigate the weak energy conditions (2.190). Example 3.3.3. We shall generalize Schwarzschild’s interior solution of Example 3.2.2 to the nonstatic arena. (See [67].) We choose the total mass function and the domain of validity by the following: j r q ; 2 1 .t=c2 / p 0 < q < 1; 2 < j 3; 3 k ; k D Œj=.j 2/1=2 ; M.r; t/ WD 264 3 Spherically Symmetric Space–Time Domains b > 0 ; c2 WD kb > 0 ; c1 WD c2 kqb j < c2 I D WD f.r; t/ W 0 < r < B.t/; t < c1 g : By (3.82i,ii) and a linear equation of state T 44 .::/ C .k/2 T 11 .::/ D 0, we obtain T 44 .r; t/ D T 14 .r; t/ D j q r j 3 ; Œ1 .t=c2 /j j q r j 2 ; c2 Œ1 .t=c2 /j C1 .j 2/ q r j 3 ; Œ1 .t=c2 /j ˇ ˇ ˇ q r j 1 ˇˇ : .r; t/ D 2 ln ˇˇ1 Œ1 .t=c2 /j ˇ T 11 .r; t/ D By choosing f .t/ 0 and choosing h.t/ from (3.86), we get from (3.84ii,iii): e˛.r;t / D 1 q r j 1 Œ1 .t=c2 /j 1 D e.r;t / : The boundary of the spherical body is provided by c2 t r D B.t/ WD ; k ˇ ˇ ˇ ˇ ˇ dB.t/ ˇ ˇ 1 ˇ ˇ ˇ D ˇ ˇ < 1 ; ˇ dt ˇ ˇ k ˇ M ŒB.t/; t .q=2/ .c2 /j D .q=2/ .b/j DW m > 0 ; c2 c1 B.c1 / D D 2m : k Synge’s junction condition (3.85ii) is identically satisfied. The other junction condition (3.85i) is also satisfied by T 11 ./ 1 T 14 ./ D 1 ˇ k ˇrDk 1 .c2 t / .j 2/ q r j 3 j q r j 2 ˇ Œ1 .t=c2 /j k c2 Œ1 .t=c2 /j C1 ˇrDk 1 .c2 t / 0: 3.3 Nonstatic, Spherically Symmetric Solutions 265 Equation (3.87) yields .r; t/ D 2q r j 3 c2 Œ1 .t=c2 /j C1 2 ˚ .j 1/2 .c2 t/2 j 2 r 2 > 0 : Therefore, the energy–momentum–stress tensor is diagonalizable. We can identify the material with an anisotropic fluid (of (2.264)) or with a deformable solid characterized by T ij .r; t/ D . C p? / ui uj C p? ı ij C pk p? s i sj ; u1 D s 4 ; u4 D s 1 > 0 ; u2 D u3 D s 2 D s 3 0 : In this example, weak energy conditions (2.190) are satisfied. Now we shall explore the Tolman–Bondi–Lemaı̂tre metric [24, 162, 249]: g:: .x/ WD e2.x 1 ;x 4 / 2 dx 1 ˝ dx 1 C Y x 1 ; x 4 dx 2 ˝ dx 2 C sin2 x 2 dx 3 ˝ dx 3 dx 4 ˝ dx 4 ; ds 2 D e2.r;t / .dr/2 C ŒY .r; t/2 .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 .dt/2 I i i ./ D e ı.1/ ; e.1/ i i e.2/ ./ D Y 1 ı.2/ ; i i e.3/ ./ D .Y sin /1 ı.3/ ; i i e.4/ D ı.4/ I D WD f.r; ; '; t/ W r1 < r < r2 ; 0 < < ; < ' < ; t1 < t < t2 g : (3.88) (See [238, 250].) The metric above implies a geodesic normal (or Gaussian normal) coordinate chart of (1.160). The t-coordinate curves represent timelike geodesics. Let us investigate field equations (2.161i) and (2.166i) in the presence of an incoherent dust modeled by (2.256). We assume a comoving chart (see p. 193) so that the 4velocity fields are tangential to t-coordinate curves. Therefore, we can choose U ˛ ./ 0 ; U 4 ./ 1 : Moreover, we denote y D Y .r; t/ ; y 0 WD @1 Y ; yP WD @4 Y: (3.89) 266 3 Spherically Symmetric Space–Time Domains Thus, the nontrivial field equations (2.161i) and (2.166i), from (3.88) and (3.89), reduce to the following: 2 E 11 .r; t/ WD y 2 C 2y 1 yR C .yP 2 =2y/ y 2 e2 y 0 D 0 ; E 22 .r; t/ WD e2 .y 0 0 =y/ .y 00 =y/ i h 2 P R C yP =y D 0; C R C P C .y=y/ (3.90ii) E 33 .r; t/ E 22 .r; t/ D 0 ; (3.90iii) i h 2ı E 44 .r; t/ WD y 2 2 e2 =y y 00 y 0 0 C y 0 2y h i C 2y 1 yP P C yP 2 =2y .r; t/ D 0 ; h i E 41 .r; t/ WD .2=y/ yP 0 y 0 P D 0 ; : T4 .r; t/ WD ŒP C . C 2 ln jyj/ .r; t/ D 0 : (3.90i) (3.90iv) (3.90v) (3.90vi) (See [250].) Our strategy to solve the above system is the following mixed method: (i) (ii) (iii) (iv) (v) We prescribe T˛ˇ .::/ 0; T˛4 .::/ 0. We solve the equation E 41 ./ D 0. Next, we solve the equation E 11 ./ D 0. We define .r; t/ from the equation E 44 ./ D 0. At this stage T4 ./ D 0 and all other field equations are satisfied. Solving (3.90v), with an additional assumption y 0 ¤ 0, we obtain ˇ ˇ .r; t/ D ln ˇy 0 ˇ C j.r/ ; e2.r;t / D e2j.r/ .@1 Y /2 > 0 : (3.91) Here, j.r/ is the thrice differentiable, arbitrary function of integration. To cast the system in a more familiar form found in the literature [238], in terms of another arbitrary function, f .r/, we express exp Œ2j.r/ DW 1 " Œf .r/2 ; " D 0; ˙1 ; 3.3 Nonstatic, Spherically Symmetric Solutions 267 " Œf .r/2 < 1 ; g11 .r; t/ D e2.r;t / D Œ@1 Y 2 > 0: 1 "Œf .r/2 (3.92) Substituting (3.92) into (3.90i) and multiplying with y 2 y, P we derive that ı y 2 yP E 11 ./ D yP 1 1 C " f 2 .r/ C 2y yP yR C yP 2 2y D 0 ; or, h i y .y/ P 2 D " f 2 .r/ yP : (3.93) Integrating the above equation, we deduce that Œ@4 Y 2 D 2M .r/ " Œf .r/2 > 0 : Y .r; t/ (3.94) Here, M .r/ is the thrice differentiable, positive-valued, arbitrary function of integration. At this stage, all the field equations have reduced to one first-order, nonlinear differential equation (3.94). Now we shall interpret (3.94) in physical terms. In the metric (3.88), the function Y .r; t/ plays the role of a “radius.” Consider a particular point r0 in the interval .r1 ; r2 /. Equation (3.94) yields 1 @Y .r0 ; t/ 2 @t 2 " M .r0 / D Œf .r0 /2 D const. Y .r0 ; t/ 2 (3.95) It is interesting to note that the equation above resembles the Newtonian energy conservation equation for a test particle of unit mass following trajectory y D the ı Y .r0 ; t/ in a spherically symmetric gravitational potential M .r0 / Y .r0 ; t/ . Let us assume that dM .r/ > 0; dr lim M .r/ D 0 ; r!r1C y0 > 0 : (3.96) Then, it follows from (3.90iv,v) and (3.94) that " d M .r/ .r; t/ D 2 dr # 2 0 y y > 0: (3.97) 268 3 Spherically Symmetric Space–Time Domains Thus, energy conditions (2.190)–(2.192) are all satisfied. Moreover, the effective total mass function Zr Z Z M .r; t/ WD .w; t/ ŒY .w; t/2 Œ@1 Y sin dw d d' # r1 0C C D M .r/ ; @M # .r; t/ 0: @t (3.98) Now we shall solve the vacuum equations with the metric in (3.88). Example 3.3.4. The vacuum is characterized by .r; t/ 0 in (3.90iv). Equation (3.97) implies that M .r/ D m D positive const., (3.99) and (3.94) reduces to Œ@4 Y 2 D 2m " Œf .r/2 : Y .r; t/ (3.100) Out of three possible cases, let us consider the parabolic case " D 0. Equation (3.100), for the case of expansion, reduces to p (3.101) @4 Y D 2m=Y .r; t/ > 0 : Solving the equation above, we obtain Y .r; t/ D .3=2/2=3 .2m/1=3 ŒT .r/ t2=3 > 0 ; ı @1 Y D .2=3/ Y .r; t/ T 0 .r/ .T .r/ t/ : (3.102) Here, T .r/ is the thrice differentiable arbitrary function of integration. Thus, the metric (3.88) becomes n o2=3 p 2 ds 2 D .2m/ .3=2/ 2m ŒT .r/ t T 0 .r/ dr 2 n o4=3 p .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 dt 2 : C .3=2/ 2m ŒT .r/ t (3.103) Making a coordinate transformation # ; ' # ; t # D .; '; t/ ; h p i2=3 Y # r # ; t # WD .3=2/ 2m r # t # D Y .r; t/ ; r # D T .r/ ; (3.104) 3.3 Nonstatic, Spherically Symmetric Solutions 269 the metric (3.103) reduces to 2 ds 2 D 2m=Y # r # ; t # dr # 2 h 2 2 i # 2 dt C Y # r # ; t # d # C sin2 # d' # : (3.105) The above metric is known as the Lemaı̂tre metric [58, 238]. We notice that # .1=2/ g11 ./ D m=Y # ./, resembling the Newtonian gravitational potential. (Glance through the comments made on p. 198.) Now, the nonstatic Lemaı̂tre metric in (3.105) is an exact solution of the spherically symmetric vacuum field equations in a domain D0# . By Birkhoff’s Theorem 3.3.2, this metric must be transformable to the static Schwarzschild metric over a subset of D0# . The explicit transformation to the Schwarzschild chart is provided by the following equations: h p i2=3 b r D .3=2/ 2m r # t # ; b ;b ' D #; '# ; h p p i1=3 b t D t # 2 2m .3=2/ 2m r # t # 8h p i1=3 p 9 ˆ < .3=2/ 2m r # t # = C 2m > ; C 2m ln h i1=3 p p > :̂ .3=2/ 2m .r # t # / ; 2m h p i2=3 .3=2/ 2m r # t # > 2m: (3.106) Now we shall touch upon the spherically symmetric, T-domain solutions. (See [73, 222].) The T -domain corresponds, for example, to the domain 0 < r < 2m of metric (3.9). Here we have changed the notation for the coordinates, as what was the radial coordinate is now a time coordinate and what was the time coordinate is now a spatial coordinate. We also denote the stress–energy–momentum tensor components by ij ./ to avoid confusion with the components of the stress– energy–momentum tensor in the previous domain. The metric is assumed to be locally reducible to ds 2 D e.T;R/ .dR/2 C T 2 .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 e .T;R/ .dT /2 ; n o D WD .T; R/ W T1 < T < T2 ; R1 < R < R2 ; 0 < < ; < : (3.107) 270 3 Spherically Symmetric Space–Time Domains The general solution of field equations G ij ./ C ij ./ D 0 and conservation j equations rj i D 0 is furnished by 2 e .T;R/ 1 4 .R/ T D ZT 3 11 .w; R/w2 dw5 1 T1 DW e.T;R/ 2.T; R/ 1 > 0; T (3.108i) 2 ZT 2.T; R/ 4 D e 1 exp ˇ.R/C T 3 .w;R/ 44 11 wdw5; T1 (3.108ii) 41 .T; R/ WD 2 @1 .T; R/ ; 2 T (3.108iii) (3.108iv) 12 ./ D 13 ./ D 23 ./ D 42 ./ D 43 ./ 0 ; 22 ./ 33 ./ WD .T =2/ @4 44 C @1 14 C Œ1 C .T =4/ @4 44 ./ C .T =4/ @1 . C / 14 ./ .T =4/ @4 11 ./ : (3.108v) Here, .R/ and ˇ.R/ are thrice differentiable, arbitrary functions of integration. Remarks: (i) There exists a “duality” between solutions of (3.79i–iv) and the solutions of (3.108i–iv). (ii) The function .T; R/, which is the “dual” of the total mass function M.r; t/, arises from the integral of the localh tensioni of the “material.” (iii) The diagonalization of the matrix ij ./ is guaranteed if and only if 2 # ./ WD 44 ./ 11 ./ C 4 14 ./ 41 ./ 0 : Otherwise, complex eigenvalues ensue. Example 3.3.5. We study the vacuum field equations with the metric in (3.107). We set ij .T; R/ 0 in the solutions in (3.108i–v). Therefore, from (3.108i), we derive 2.T; R/ D .R/ : (3.109) 3.3 Nonstatic, Spherically Symmetric Solutions 271 By (3.108iii) and (3.109), we conclude that d.R/ D 0; dR 2 Œ.T; R/ D .R/ D 2m D const. ; or 0 < T < 2m : (3.110) From (3.108i,ii), we obtain the metric as 2m 1 eˇ.R/ .dR/2 C T 2 .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 T ds 2 D 2m 1 T 1 .dT /2 : (3.111) By the coordinate transformation bD R ZR exp ˇ.w/=2 dw ; R1 b b D .; '; T / ; ; b '; T the metric in (3.111) reduces to 1 2 2 2 2m 2m b2 db b ; b CT .db ' /2 C sin2 b dT 1 dR 1 b b T T n o b WD R; bb b W 1 < R b < 1; 0 < b b < 2m : D ;b '; T < ; < b ' < ; 0 < T ds 2 D (3.112) Remarks: (i) The metric above admits an additional Killing vector @ analogous @b R to that in Birkhoff’s Theorem 3.3.2. (ii) The metric (3.112) in the T -domain is the “dual” of the Schwarzschild metric. (iii) This metric represents one possible interior for the spherically symmetric black hole. (See the Chap. 5.) From the dual Birkhoff’s theorem, this is the only vacuum solution for such a spherical black hole interior. (See Exercise 3.3-1ii.) 272 3 Spherically Symmetric Space–Time Domains Section 3.3 is useful for the study of spherically symmetric stars according to Einstein’s theory of general relativity. Moreover, this section is a prelude to the exploration of spherically symmetric black holes in Chap. 5. Exercises 3.3 1. Consider the nonstatic, spherically symmetric metric in (3.76). (i) Investigate electromagneto-vac equations (2.290i–vi) in that metric with the additional assumptions F14 ./ ¤ 0; F23 ./ ¤ 0, and other Fij ./ 0. Prove the appropriate generalization of Birkhoff’s Theorem 3.3.2 in this case. (ii) Consider spherically symmetric field equations (3.77i–ix). Assuming one additional condition T 14 .r; t/ 0, prove the interior generalization of Birkhoff’s Theorem 3.3.2. 2. Consider the nonstatic, spherically symmetric metric in (3.76). Let the threedimensional, timelike boundary hypersurface (analogous to @.3/ D of Fig. 2.19) be furnished by r D x 1 D 1 .u2 ; u3 ; u4 / WD B.u4 / ; D x 2 D 2 . / WD u2 ; ' D x 3 D 3 . / WD u3 ; t D x 4 D 4 . / WD u4 ; ˚ D WD u2 ; u3 ; u4 W 0 < u2 < ; < u3 < ; t1 < u4 < t2 : Obtain the nontrivial, extrinsic curvature components from (1.234). 3. Consider the nonstatic, spherically symmetric metric: ds 2 D e2.r;t / .dr/2 C ŒY .r; t/2 .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 e2 .r;t / .dt/2 : Assume that the material source is a perfect fluid. Assume furthermore that a E comoving chart exists so that U./ D e .r;t / @t@ . (i) Obtain the 4-acceleration field, the vorticity tensor, expansion scalar, and the shear tensor from (2.199i–v). (ii) Assuming the energy condition .r; t/ C p.r; t/ > 0 and an equation of state D R.p/; dR.p/ ¤ 0, or equivalently p D P./; dP./ ¤ 0, integrate the dp d two nontrivial conservation equations. 3.3 Nonstatic, Spherically Symmetric Solutions 273 4. Obtain the energy–momentum–stress corresponding to the T -domain metric: tensor components ij .T; R/ #2 " p p 3 jqb 2 1j jqT 2 1j p .dR/2 C T 2 .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 ds D 2 3 jqb 1j 1 1 2 .dT /2 I qT 1 2 qb 2 > 1 ; q > 0; 0 < T < b: 5. Consider a “nonstatic, spherically symmetric” N -dimensional .N 4/ pseudoRiemannian metric: 2 ds 2 D e˛.r;t / .dr/2 C r 2 d˝.N 2/ e.r;t / .dt/2 ; d˝.N 2/ 2 WD .d2 / C 2 N 1 X nD3 " n1 Y ! sin2 m .dn / # 2 ; mD2 ˚ D.N / WD .r; 2 ; : : : ; N 1 ; t/ W r1 < r < r2 ; 0 < 2 ; 3 ; : : : ; N 2 < ; < N 1 < ; t1 < t < t2 : : : : Obtain the general solution of the system G : .x/ C T : .x/ D O : .x/. 6. Consider the nonstatic, spherically symmetric Vaidya metric: ds 2 D r 2 .d/2 C sin2 .d/2 2 du dr Œ1 2M.u/=r .du/2 : Prove that the corresponding 4 4 matrix ŒTij .::/, with respect to invariant eigenvalues, is of Segre characteristic Œ.1; 1; 1/; 1. (Remark: This metric can represent the space–time outside of a spherically symmetric object which is emitting a spherically symmetric distribution of radiation consisting of massless particles.) Answers and Hints to Selected Exercises 1. (i) Equations E 14 ./ D 0 and E 11 ./ E 44 ./ D 0 imply that @4 ˛ D 0 and .r; t/ D ˛.r/ C h.t/ : By Maxwell’s equations Mi ./ D 0 D Mi ./, one obtains F14 .r; t/ D F23 ./ D e0 h.t /=2 e ; r2 0 sin : 274 3 Spherically Symmetric Space–Time Domains With help of a coordinate transformation b r; b ; b ' D .r; ; '/ ; b tD Zt exp Œh.w/=2 dw ; t1 the static metric of p. 256 is recovered. (See [48].) 2. K22 u2 ; u3 ; u4 D ( r e˛.r;t / ) p ; e˛ e .@4 B/2 ˇˇrDB.u4 /; t Du4 K33 ./ sin2 u2 K22 ./ ; ( 1 2@4 @4 B C e ˛ @1 2K44 ./ D p ˛ 2 e e .@4 B/ C @4 B @4 .2˛ / C .@4 B/2 @1 .˛ 2 / ) .@4 B/3 e˛ @4 ˛ ˇ : ˇ:: Remark: The above equations can be utilized to satisfy I–S–L–D junction conditions in (2.171).) 3. (i) @ EP ; U./ D Œ@1 .r; t/ @r !:: ./ O:: ./ ; ./ D e @4 C 2 ln jY j ; 1 @ 1 @ 2 @ ˝ dC ˝ d' ˝ dr : : ./ D e @4 ln jY j 3 @ 3 @' 3 @r (ii) Two nontrivial conservation equations yield @1 p D . C p/ @1 ; @4 D . C p/ @4 . C 2 ln jY j/ : 3.3 Nonstatic, Spherically Symmetric Solutions 275 Integrating the above equations, one obtains Z dp D .r; t/ C F .t/ ; R.p/ C p Z d D .r; t/ C 2 ln jY .r; t/j C H.r/: C P./ Here, F .t/ and H.r/ are arbitrary functions of integration. 4. ij .T; R/ D .T; R/ 3 .T; R/ WD 3 1 q 1 q s i ./ sj ./ C ./ ı ij ; # "p p jqb 2 1j jqT 2 1j p p > 0; 3 jqb 2 1j jqT 2 1j s 2 ./ D s 3 ./ D s 4 ./ 0 ; s 1 ./ s1 ./ 1: (Remark: This metric is the “dual” solution to the Schwarzschild’s interior metric (3.66i).) 5. The general solution of the system is furnished by: 2 3 Zr 2 e˛.r;t / D 1 N 3 4f .t/ T NN .y; t/ y N 2 dy 5 r N 2 r1 DW 1 e .r;t / 2M.r; t/ > 0; r N 3 ( 2 2M.r; t/ exp h.t/ C D 1 N 3 r N 2 ) T 11 .y; t/ T NN .y; t/ y N 2 dy ; y N 3 2M.y; t/ r1 8 9 Zr < df .t/ 2 = N 2 N N 2 T 1N .r; t/ WD @ T y dy ; N N : dt ; 2r N 2 N 2 Zr T AA .r; t/ WD ( r1 r 1 @1 T 11 C @N T N1 C @N Œ˛ C T N1 N 2 2 ) 1 N 2 1 1 N @1 C T 1 @1 T N ; C 2 r 2 A 2 f2; : : : ; N 1g : (Compare with Problem # 6 of Exercise 3.1 and (3.79i–iv). See [61].) Chapter 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains 4.1 Static Axially Symmetric Space–Time Domains @ We assume that two commuting Killing vectors @x@ 3 @' and @x@ 4 @t@ exist. x4 D Furthermore, we assume discrete isometries under reflections b x 3 D x 3 and b 4 x : The metric is then locally reducible to n 1 2 1 2 g:: .x/ D e2w.x ;x / e2.x ;x / dx 1 ˝ dx 1 C dx 2 ˝ dx 2 o 1 2 Ce2ˇ.x ;x / dx 3 ˝ dx 3 e2w.x 1 ;x 2 / dx 4 ˝ dx 4 ; n h 2 2 i 2 o 1 2 1 2 1 2 ds 2 D e2w.x ;x / e2.x ;x / dx 1 C dx 2 C e2ˇ.x ;x / dx 3 2 1 2 e2w.x ;x / dx 4 ; ˚ D W D x 1 ; x 2 ; x 3 ; x 4 W %1 < x 1 < %2 ; z1 < x 2 < z2 ; < x 3 < ; 1 < x 4 < 1 : (4.1) We investigate the vacuum equations (2.164i) at the outset. We first form the linear combination [243]: 0 D R33 ./ C R44 ./ D e2.w/ˇ @1 @1 eˇ C @2 @2 eˇ : (4.2) The general solution to the above (disguised linear) equation is provided by (A2.41) of Appendix 2 as eˇ.x 1 ;x 2 / D %.x 1 ; x 2 / WD Re f .x 1 C ix 2 / ; z.x 1 ; x 2 / WD Im f .x 1 C ix 2 / ; ./ C iz./ D f .x 1 C ix 2 /: A. Das and A. DeBenedictis, The General Theory of Relativity: A Mathematical Exposition, DOI 10.1007/978-1-4614-3658-4 4, © Springer Science+Business Media, LLC 2012 (4.3) 277 278 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains Here, f is an arbitrary holomorphic function of the complex variable x 1 C ix 2 : Assuming f ./ to be a nonconstant function, we derive that h 2 2 i (4.4) .d%/2 C .dz2 / D jdf ./j2 D jf 0 ./j2 dx 1 C dx 2 : Now, we make the coordinate transformation: .%; z; '; t/ D Re f ./; Im f ./; x 3 ; x 4 : (4.5) From (4.4) and (4.5), the metric in (4.1) yields o n w.%;z/ .%;z/ ds 2 D e2b e2b .d%/2 C .dz/2 C %2 .d'/2 w.%;z/ e2b .dt/2 : (4.6) Dropping hats in the sequel, we obtain the static, axially symmetric metric in Weyl’s coordinate chart [238, 261] as ˚ ds 2 D e2w.%;z/ e2.%;z/ .d%/2 C .dz/2 C %2 .d'/2 e2w.%;z/ .dt/2 : (4.7) The nontrivial vacuum field equations (2.164i), from the metric above, are the following: .1=2/ ŒR11 ./ C R22 ./ D @1 @1 C @2 @2 C .@1 w/2 C .@2 w/2 r 2 w D 0; 1 .1=2/ ŒR11 ./ R22 ./ D .@1 w/ .@2 w/ % 2 2 (4.8i) @1 D 0; (4.8ii) R12 ./ D 2@1 w @2 w %1 @2 D 0; (4.8iii) R33 ./ R44 ./ D 2e2.w/ r 2 w D 0; (4.8iv) R33 ./ C R44 ./ 0; (4.8v) r 2 w WD @1 @1 w C %1 @1 w C @2 @2 w; (4.8vi) D WD f.%; z/ W 0 < % < %2 ; z1 < z < z2 g : (4.8vii) The two-dimensional domain D and the corresponding three-dimensional domain in “Euclidean coordinate spaces” are depicted below in Fig. 4.1. The general solution of the system of field equations (4.8i–iv) will be provided below. Theorem 4.1.1. Let the metric functions w.%; z/ and .%; z/ of (4.7) be of class C 3 in a simply connected domain D R2 of Fig. 4.1. The general solution of 4.1 Static Axially Symmetric Space–Time Domains 279 z z (2 ,z2 ) ( ,z) D Γ (y1, y2) 2 (0 ,z0) (2 ,z1 ) 3 Fig. 4.1 The two-dimensional and the corresponding axially symmetric three-dimensional domain the system of differential equations (4.8i–iv) is furnished by an arbitrary, axially symmetric Newtonian potential w.%; z/ and the following line integral: Z.%;z/ .%; z/ WD y1 ˚ .@1 w/2 .@2 w/2 dy 1 C 2.@1 w/ .@2 w/ dy 2 : (4.9) .%0 ;z0 /Œ Proof. Vacuum field equations (4.8i–v) reduce to r 2 w D @1 @1 w C %1 @1 w C @2 @2 w D 0; @1 D % .@1 w/2 .@2 w/2 ; (4.10ii) @2 D 2% .@1 w/ .@2 w/; (4.10iii) @1 @1 C @2 @2 C .@1 w/2 C .@2 w/2 D 0: (4.10iv) (4.10i) Equation (4.10i) shows that w.%; z/ is an axially symmetric Newtonian potential. The integrability condition (1.239) for the pair of first-order equations (4.10ii, 4.10iii) is @2 @1 @1 @2 D 2% r 2 w @2 w D 0: It is automatically satisfied by (4.10i). Thus, the solution (4.9) is obtained by a line integral consisting of an arbitrary constant. The remaining (4.10iv) is implied by the other three (due to the contracted Bianchi identities). 280 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains Caution: The solution (4.9) is valid only in the open-subset D which excludes points on the z-axis. To analytically extend the solution to the z-axis, we need to check the existence of tangent planes (or “local flatness”) at those points. To test the local flatness, choose a point .0; zc / as the center of a “horizontal circle” in the three-dimensional coordinate space of Fig. 4.1. The limit of the ratio of circumference divided by “radius” of the spatial geometry in (4.7) is given by h i 2% D 2 for the local flatness. Therefore, we must check the lim e.%;z c / % %!0C condition .0C ; zc / D 0 for the regularity of the solution. Example 4.1.2. We choose the Newtonian potential function as [17] m w.%; z/ WD p < 0; %2 C z2 ˚ D WD .%; z/ W 0 < %; %2 C z2 > 0 : (4.11) To evaluate the line integral in (4.9), we choose the curve as the circular arc: ˚ WD .y 1 ; y 2 / W y 1 D r0 sin ˛; y 2 D r0 cos ˛; < ˛ < : The line integral (4.9) then reduces to m2 .r0 sin ; r0 cos / D 2 r0 D .%; z/ D Z sin ˛ cos ˛ sin2 ˛ cos ˛ cos2 ˛ d˛ m2 sin2 ; 2r02 m2 %2 ; 2.%2 C z2 /2 lim .%; z/ 0 for z ¤ 0: (4.12) %!0C The space–time metric of (4.7) goes over into " 2m ds D exp p %2 C z2 2 # ( exp m2 %2 .d%/2 C .dz/2 .%2 C z2 /2 ) C % .d'/ 2 2 " 2m exp p %2 C z2 # .dt/2 : (4.13) The only singularity of the above metric is at .%; z/ D .0; 0/: There is a peculiarity about this metric in (4.13). Although the Newtonian potential w.%; z/ in (4.11) is spherically symmetric (since it is a function of the particular combination %2 Cz2 ), 4.1 Static Axially Symmetric Space–Time Domains 281 z z Γ D(b) 2 3 Fig. 4.2 Two axially symmetric bodies in “Euclidean coordinate spaces” the metric (4.13) cannot be transformed into the Schwarzschild metric (3.9). The reason for this disparity is that the potential w.%; z/ in (4.11) is spherically symmetric in the “Euclidean coordinate space.” However, the non-Euclidean spatial hypersurface induced by (4.13) for t D const. does not admit spherical symmetry. (Compare Fig. 2.8.) The axially symmetric potential equation (4.10i) is linear. Therefore, superposition of several potential functions is itself a potential function. It seems that several axially symmetric, static bodies in Newtonian gravitation can generate a corresponding exact, static solution in Einstein’s theory! But in Newtonian gravitation, several axially symmetric, massive bodies may or may not be in equilibrium. How does Einstein’s theory distinguish these different cases? One answer is the use of the criterion .0C ; z/ D 0: Now, we shall put forward another criterion that is physically more transparent. Let us consider two, axially symmetric, massive bodies. One is a spherical body, another is a solid ring. (See Fig. 4.2.) Consider the 1-form !.%; Q z/ and its exterior derivative in the following: ˚ !.%; Q z/ WD % .@1 w/2 .@2 w/2 d% C 2.@1 w/ .@2 w/ dz ; d!./ Q D 2 % r 2 w @2 w .d% ^ dz/: (4.14) Applying Stokes’ Theorem 1.2.23 on the closed curve of Fig. 4.2, we conclude that I Z 2 .1=2/ !./ r w @2 w % d% dz: Q D (4.15) Œ D.b/ 282 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains Since r 2 w is proportional to the mass density in Newtonian theory, the above equation is proportional to the net “Newtonian gravitational force” along the z-axis on a vertical section of the solid ring. (See the reference [173].) Since there is a massive sphere on top of the ring in Fig. 4.2, it is clear that the net force in (4.15) cannot vanish. Thus, from (4.14), d!./ Q 6 0:: ./: Therefore, the integrability condition for differential equations (4.10ii,iii) is violated. There exists no solution of the field equations in this static scenario. It is in this way that the nonlinear field equations of general relativity make a physically satisfying, subtle impact on the axially symmetric case. In essence, the above static scenario, which cannot exist in equilibrium in the Newtonian sense due to the fact that the net force cannot vanish, also cannot be in equilibrium in the relativistic sense due to violation of the integrability conditions. (Remarks: (i) In case the sphere and the ring are concentric, there can be equilibrium and static solutions do exist. (ii) The actual curved submanifold corresponding to Fig. 4.2 is quite different.) Example 4.1.3. Next, consider the case of two “gravitational monopoles” on the vertical axis [44]. The corresponding Newtonian potential is furnished by m2 m1 p ; w.%; z/ D p %2 C .z z1 /2 %2 C .z z2 /2 ˚ D WD .%; z/ W 0 < %; 0 < %2 C .z z1 /2 ; 0 < %2 C .z z2 /2 ; z2 > z1 : (4.16) Then, (4.9) yields m21 %2 .%; z/ D m22 %2 2 Œ%2 C .z z1 /2 2 2 Œ%2 C .z z2 /2 2 # " %2 C .z z1 /.z z2 / 2m1 m2 p 1 : (4.17) C .z1 z2 /2 Œ%2 C .z z1 /2 Œ%2 C .z z2 /2 2m1 m2 fŒsgn .z z1 / Œsgn .z z2 / 1g .z1 z2 /2 8 ˆ < 0 for z 2 .1; z1 / [ .z2 ; 1/; D 4m1 m2 < 0 for z 2 .z1 ; z2 / : :̂ .z1 z2 /2 lim .%; z/ D %!0C Therefore, exact static solutions do exist on the vertical axis on the interval .1; z1 / [ .z2 ; 1/: However, the solution does not exist on the interval .z1 ; z2 /: Mathematically, we can make the solution valid by incising the interval corresponding to .z1 ; z2 / from the manifold. (Physically speaking, this process can be viewed as placing an ignored, massless, rigid, linear strut between two massive particles at .0; z1 / and .0; z2 / in order to balance the gravitational attraction.) 4.1 Static Axially Symmetric Space–Time Domains 283 Example 4.1.4. In Example 4.1.2, the spherically symmetric Newtonian potential failed to generate the Schwarzschild metric out of the Weyl metric in (4.7). Naturally, a question arises as to which of the Newtonian potentials will generate then the Schwarzschild metric. This query will be answered shortly. Consider the Newtonian potential of a finite, massive, linear rod of length l D 2m > 0 on the z-axis. This potential is provided by ˇ ˇ 1 ˇˇ A.%; z/ C B.%; z/ 2m ˇˇ ; ln ˇ 2 A./ C B./ C 2m ˇ p A.%; z/ W D %2 C .z C m/2 > 0; p B.%; z/ W D %2 C .z m/2 > 0; w.%; z/ W D D W D f.%; z/ W 0 < %; A./ > 0; B./ > 0; A./ C B./ > 2mg : (4.18) The corresponding .%; z/ from (4.9) yields ˇ ˇ 1 ˇˇ ŒA./ C B./2 4m2 ˇˇ ln ˇ ˇ; 2 4A./ B./ ˇ ˇ ˇ 1 1 ˇˇ 1 lim .%; z/ D ln ˇ C Œsgn .z C m/ Œsgn .z m/ˇˇ %!0C 2 2 2 .%; z/ D D 0 for z 2 .1; m/ [ .m; 1/; undefined for z 2 .m; m/ : (4.19) By the coordinate transformation 1 ŒA.%; z/ C B.%; z/ C m; 2 s 4m2 tan D 1; ŒA./ B./2 rD (4.20) we can recover the Schwarzschild metric in (3.9). (See [239].) The inverse coordinate transformation of (4.20) is provided by %D p r 2 2mr sin ; z D .r m/ cos ; b W D f.r; / W 0 < 2m < r; 0 < < g : D (4.21) 284 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains Now, we shall investigate static, axially symmetric, interior solutions. The metric is given by (4.1) which we express as ˚ ds 2 D e2w.%;z/ e2.%;z/ .d%/2 C .dz/2 C e2ˇ.%;z/ .d'/2 e2w.%;z/ .dt/2 : (4.22) The field equations (2.161i) reduce to E11 .%; z/ WD @2 @2 ˇ @1 @1 ˇ C .@1 w/2 .@2 w/2 @2 @2 ˇ .@2 ˇ/2 C T11 .%; z/ D 0; (4.23i) E22 ./ WD @1 @1 ˇ @2 @2 ˇ C .@2 w/2 .@1 w/2 @1 @1 ˇ .@1 ˇ/2 C T22 ./ D 0; (4.23ii) E12 ./ WD 2 @1 w @2 w C @1 @2 ˇ C @1 ˇ @2 ˇ @1 @2 ˇ @2 @1 ˇ C T12 ./ D 0; (4.23iii) E33 ./ WD e2.ˇ/ @1 @1 C @2 @2 C .@1 w/2 C .@2 w/2 C T33 ./ D 0; (4.23iv) E44 ./ WD e2.2w/ 2 @1 @1 w C @2 @2 w C @1 ˇ @1 w C @2 ˇ @2 w .@1 w/2 .@2 w/2 @1 @1 ˇ C @2 @2 ˇ C .@1 ˇ/2 C .@2 ˇ/2 .@1 @1 C @2 @2 / C T44 ./ D 0; (4.23v) T13 ./ D T23 ./ D T14 ./ D T24 ./ D T34 ./ 0; (4.23vi) ˚ T1 ./ WD e2.w/ˇ @1 e2.w/ˇ T 11 C @2 e2.w/ˇ T 21 ˚ .1=2/ @1 e2.w/ T 11 C T 22 C @1 e2.ˇw/ T 33 (4.23vii) @1 e2w T 44 D 0; ˚ T2 ./ WD e2.w/ˇ @1 e2.w/Cˇ T 12 C @2 e2.w/Cˇ T 22 ˚ .1=2/ @2 e2.w/ T 11 C T 22 C @2 e2.ˇw/ T 33 (4.23viii) @2 e2w T 44 D 0; T3 ./ D T4 ./ 0: (4.23ix) 4.1 Static Axially Symmetric Space–Time Domains 285 The equation e4w E44 C e2 .E11 C E22 / C e2ˇ E33 D 0 corresponds to the axially symmetric Poisson’s equation (2.157i). Moreover, (4.23vii,viii) resemble conditions of axially symmetric equilibrium in the theory of elasticity [244]. Now, let us count the number of unknown functions versus the number of independent differential equations in (4.23i–ix). No. of unknown functions: 1.w/ C 1./ C 1.ˇ/ C 5.T ij / D 8: No. of differential equations: 5.E ij D 0/ C 2.T i D 0/ D 7: No. of differential identities: 2.ri E ij T j / D 2: No. of independent equations: 7 2 D 5: The system is obviously underdetermined. Therefore, three of the eight unknown functions can be prescribed. There are several mixed methods available. (However, ideally, we have to satisfy energy conditions (2.194i–iii), too!) Now, we explore the Einstein–Maxwell equations (2.290i–iv) in the static, axially symmetric case. We further restrict the analysis to static, electro-vac equations so that @4 Fij ./ 0; F˛ˇ ./ 0; @˛ Aˇ @ˇ A˛ 0: (4.24) Therefore, the 1-form A˛ ./ dx ˛ is closed in a spatial, star-shaped domain. By the Theorem 1.2.21, there exists a differentiable function ./ such that A˛ ./ D @˛ : (4.25) By the gauge transformation (1.71ii) or (2.280), b A˛ ./ D A˛ ./ @˛ 0; b A4 ./ D A4 ./ @4 6 0: (4.26) We drop hats in the sequel and denote that (new) A4 ./ DW A./; F˛4 ./ D @˛ A: (4.27) From physical considerations of axial symmetry, we set F34 ./ 0; so that A./ D A.%; z/: (4.28) 286 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains Now, we assume Weyl’s static, axially symmetric metric (4.7). The nonzero components of T ij ./ of (2.290i), with (4.24), (4.26), and (4.28), are furnished by T 11 .%; z/ D .1=2/ e2 .@2 A/2 .@1 A/2 T 22 ./; T 12 ./ D e2 @1 A @2 A; (4.29i) (4.29ii) T 33 ./ D .1=2/ e2 .@1 A/2 C .@2 A/2 T 44 ./ > 0; T ii ./ 0: (4.29iii) (4.29iv) The nontrivial Einstein–Maxwell equation Mi ./ D 0 and Rij ./ C T ij ./ D 0 reduces to the following: ˚ M4 ./ D %1 e2.w/ @1 % @1 A e2w C @2 % @2 A e2w D 0; (4.30i) R11 ./ C T 11 ./ D e2.w/ @1 @1 C @2 @2 r 2 w C 2.@1 w/2 %1 @1 C . =2/ e2 .@2 A/2 .@1 A/2 D 0; (4.30ii) E 11 ./ E 22 ./ D 2e2.w/ .@1 w/2 .@2 w/2 %1 @1 C e2 .@2 A/2 .@1 A/2 D 0; (4.30iii) R12 ./ C T 12 ./ D e2.w/ 2@1 w @2 w %1 @2 e2 @1 A @2 A D 0; (4.30iv) R33 ./ C T 33 ./ D e2.w/ r 2 w C . =2/ e2 .@1 A/2 C .@2 A/2 R44 ./ C T 44 ./ D 0: (4.30v) We shall obtain a class of exact solutions of the above system. Example 4.1.5. Equations (4.30i) and (4.30v) reduce to r 2 A D 2 Œ@1 w @1 A C @2 w @2 A ; r 2 w D . =2/ e2w .@1 A/2 C .@2 A/2 > 0: (4.31i) (4.31ii) 4.1 Static Axially Symmetric Space–Time Domains 287 Assume a functional relationship between two “potentials” w.; z/ and A.%; z/: Therefore, there exists a thrice-differentiable function F such that e2w.%;z/ D ŒF ı A .%; z/ F ŒA.%; z/ > 0; @1 e2w./ D F 0 .A/ @1 A etc.; F 0 .A/ WD dF .A/ ¤ 0: dA (4.32) With the above equations, (4.31i,ii), respectively, reduce to r 2 A D F 0 ./ F 1 .@1 A/2 C .@2 A/2 ; 0 F 00 F 2 2 C .@ : r 2A D A/ C .@ A/ 1 2 F F0 (4.33i) (4.33ii) Subtracting (4.33ii) from (4.33i) and recalling .@1 A/2 C .@2 A/2 > 0; we deduce that F 00 .A/ D ; or, F .A/ D a C bA C . =2/.A/2 > 0; or, e2w.%; z/ D a C bA.%; z/ C 2 ŒA.%; z/2 : (4.34) The above quadratic function, involving two arbitrary constants, a > 0 and b, was first discovered by Weyl [261]. Another auxiliary function is introduced by the indefinite integral r V.A/ WD Z 2 dA ; Œa C bA C . =2/A2 V .%; z/ WD V .A.%; z// ; p @1 V D =2 e2w @1 A etc.; p r 2 V D =2 e2w r 2 A 2.@1 w @1 A C @2 w @2 A/ D 0: (4.35i) (4.35ii) (4.35iii) (4.35iv) Now, let us choose the constants to satisfy b 2 D 2a > 0; (4.36i) i1 hp p a˙ =2 A ; V.A/ D ˙ (4.36ii) ŒV .%; z/2 D e2w.%;z/ ; (4.36iii) 288 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains p @1 A D 2= ŒV ./2 @1 V @1 w D ŒV ./1 @1 V etc.; etc. (4.36iv) (4.36v) Under assumptions (4.36i) and consequent equations (4.36ii–v), the axially symmetric electro-vac equations (4.30i–iv) dramatically reduce to the linear potential equation (4.35iv) and @1 D 0; @2 D 0: (4.37) Recalling lim .%; z/ D 0; (4.37) implies that %!0C .%; z/ 0: Therefore, the Weyl metric (4.7) reduces to the simple form: ds 2 D ŒV .%; z/2 .d%/2 C .dz/2 C %2 .d'/2 ŒV .%; z/2 .dt/2 ; and r 2 V D @1 @1 V C %1 @1 V C @z @z V D 0: (4.38) The above metric depends on a single axially symmetric Newtonian potential! Therefore, exact, static solutions due to several axially symmetric, massive, charged bodies are possible. What is happening to the equilibrium of different bodies? In the next section, in a more general scenario, we shall prove that in such cases, electrostatic repulsion is exactly cancelling the gravitational attraction. (The metric in (4.38) is a special case of the class first discovered by Curzon [44] and Chazy [36].) Exercise 4.1 1. Consider the Weyl metric in (4.7) satisfying the vacuum field equations. Obtain the corresponding metric function, .%; z/, from (4.10i,ii), as well as the curvature tensor R: : : ./, for the following two cases: (i) w.%; z/ D const. (ii) w.%; z/ D ln %: 2. Recall the polar coordinates given by % D r sin and z D r cos I 0 < r and 0 < < : A Newtonian potential b w.r; / D w.%; z/ is provided by the superposition 4.1 Static Axially Symmetric Space–Time Domains 289 PN .nC1/ of multipoles as b w.r; / D Pn .cos /: (Here, Pn .cos / nD0 c.n/ r denotes a Legendre polynomial.) Obtain the corresponding b .r; / which solves the vacuum equations. 3. Consider the axially symmetric, static, electro-vac equations (4.30i–v) with assumptions (4.34) and (4.35i). In case the constants satisfy the inequality b 2 ¤ 2a ; show that the electro-vac equations can be reduced to purely vacuum equations. Answers and Hints to Selected Exercises: 1. (i) R: : : ./ O: : : ./: 2. % D r sin ; z D r cos I 0 < r; b ! .r; / WD b ! .%; z/; b .r; / WD b .%; z/: Equations (4.10ii,iii) yield @rb .r; / ( " cos @ b sin @r b !C ! r D r sin2 2 sin @ b cos @r b ! ! r 2 # C 2 sin cos cos @ b ! r ) sin @ b cos @r b ! ! ; r sin @r b !C ( .r; / D r @b 2 " sin cos !C sin @r b 2 sin 2 cos @ b ! r 2 sin @ b cos @r b ! ! r 2 # cos sin @ b @ b sin @r b !C ! cos @r b ! ! r r Z b .r; / D dr C @b d/ : .@rb ) : 290 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains 3. Equation (4.35iv) yields r 2 V D 0: Equations (4.35iii), (4.34), and (4.30iv) provide @2b WD @2 n .b 2 =2 / a 1 o D 2% @1 V @2 V: Equations (4.35iii), (4.34), and (4.30iii) give @1b WD @1 n 1 o .b 2 =2 / a D % .@1 V /2 .@2 V /2 : The static vacuum metric is furnished by n o ./ ds 2 D e2V ./ e2b .d%/2 C .dz/2 C %2 .d'/2 e2V ./ .dt/2 : 4.2 The General Static Field Equations We have dealt with static, spherically symmetric equations in Sects. 3.1 and 3.2. Moreover, we have examined static, axially symmetric metrics in the preceding section. Now, we shall investigate the general, static field equations of general relativity. We assume that a timelike Killing vector field @x@ 4 exists. Furthermore, we assume that the metric admits a discrete isometry (of time reflection) b x 4 D x 4 : 1 Such a metric can be expressed as ı g:: .x/ WD e2w.x/ g ˛ˇ .x/ .dx ˛ ˝ dx ˇ / e2w.x/ .dx 4 ˝ dx 4 /; 2 ı ds 2 D e2w.x/ g ˛ˇ .x/.dx ˛ dx ˇ / e2w.x/ dx 4 ; x WD .x 1 ; x 2 ; x 3 / 2 D R3 : ı (4.39) ı The three-dimensional metric g:: .x/ WD g ˛ˇ .x/ .dx ˛ ˝ dx ˇ / is considered to be positive-definite. The field equations (2.161i) reduce to the following three-dimensional tensor field equations: 1 We shall provide a tensorial characterization of staticity. Suppose that a tangent vector field E K.x/ satisfies three conditions: (1) gij ./K i ./K j ./ < 0, (2) ri Kj C rj Ki D 0, and (3) ri rj Kl C rj rl Ki C rl ri Kj D 0. Then, the metric is transformable to (4.39). (See [239].) 4.2 The General Static Field Equations 291 ı ı ı ı ı ı ˛ˇ E .x/ WD G .x/ C 2 r w r w .1=2/g .x/ g .x/ r˛ w rˇ w ı ı C T .x/ D 0; (4.40i) h i ı ı ı ı .x/ WD g ˛ˇ .x/ r˛ rˇ w . =2/ e4w T44 ./ C g ./ T ./ ı Q D 0; DW r 2 w . =2/ .x/ (4.40ii) T˛4 .x/ 0; ı (4.40iii) ı ı T ˛ .x/ WD .x/ Q r˛ w C r ˇ T˛ˇ D 0: (4.40iv) ı (Here, covariant derivatives are defined with respect to the metric g:: .x/: Consult the answer of #1 of Exercise 4.2). Let us count now the number of unknown functions versus the number of independent equations. ı No. of unknown functions: 6.g / C 1.w/ C 6.T / C 1./ Q D 14: ı No. of equations: 6.E ı D 0/ C 1. D 0/ C 3.T ˛ D 0/ D 10: ı ı No. of identities: 3.r E T / D 3: No. of independent equations: 10 3 D 7: Thus, the system is underdetermined, and seven of the unknown functions can be prescribed. Therefore, many mixed methods are available. It must be noted that the metric (4.39) and (4.40iii) imply that the energy–momentum–stress tensor matrix Tij .x; x 4 / is diagonalizable at every event point x D .x; x 4 /: The vacuum field equations (2.164i), with the metric (4.39), reduce to the following three-dimensional tensor field equations: ı ı ı EQ.0/ .x/ WD R .x/ C 2r w r w D 0; .0/ (4.41i) ı .x/ WD r 2 w D 0: (4.41ii) Remarks: (i) In the static case, Einstein’s vacuum field equations (2.164i) have reduced to three-dimensional tensor and scalar field equations (4.41i,ii). ı ı (ii) Three coordinate conditions C.g ˛ˇ ; @ g ˛ˇ / D 0 can be imposed. 292 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains Table 4.1 Comparison between Newtonian gravity and Einstein static gravity outside matter Newtonian gravitational equations Einstein’s static gravitational equations Lagrangian in (2.153) for a unit mass Squared Lagrangian (2.156) for a timelike ı geodesic L.N / .x; v/ D .1=2/ g ˛ˇ .x/v˛ vˇ 2w.x/ L.2/ .x; u/ ı D .1=2/ e2w g ˛ˇ .x/v˛ vˇ e2w.x/ .u4 /2 ˛ ˛ 4 v WD .u =u / Flatness conditions of the Euclidean space E3 Static field equations (4.41i) in vacuum ı ı R ˛ˇ .x/ 0 R ˛ˇ .x/ C 2@˛ w @ˇ w D 0 ı Potential equation outside matter r 2 w D 0 Static field equation (4.41ii) in vacuum ı r 2w D 0 Now, Weyl’s conformal tensor in a three-dimensional manifold is identically the zero tensor. (See # 13 of Exercise 1.3.) Thus, the curvature tensor components are linear combinations of Ricci tensor components. (See (1.169i,ii.)) Therefore, an equivalent system to field equations (4.41i,ii) can be expressed as ı @ˇ w g ˇ @ w @˛ w ı ı C 2 g ˛ˇ @ w g ˛ @ˇ w @ w ı ı ı ı ı D 0; C g @ w @ w g ˛ g ˇ g ˛ˇ g ı .0/ EQ ˛ˇ .x/ WDR .0/ ˛ˇ ı .x/ C 2 g ı .x/ WD r 2 w D 0: (4.42i) (4.42ii) (Compare and contrast with the general vacuum field equations (2.165i).) We are now in a position to compare Newtonian gravitational theory with Einstein’s static theory of general relativity. For this, we refer to Table 4.1. Let us now explore the static field equations (4.40i–iii). Moreover, let us consider only the vacuum scenario by setting Tij ./ 0: We would like to derive these equations by a variational principle, as discussed in Appendix 1. An appropriate Lagrangian (A1.25) and the action integral (A1.14) for these equations can be chosen as L x; y ˛ˇ ; ˛ˇ ; wI h WD y ˛ˇ ˛ˇ y ˛ˇ ; ˛ˇ ˛ˇ ; w ˛ˇ C ˛ ˇ i C 2w˛ wˇ ; q ı ˛ˇ ı L./j:: D R˛ˇ .x/ C 2@˛ w @ˇ w g .x/ g; ı Z J.F / D D q ı R.x/ C 2g .x/ @˛ w @ˇ w g d3 x: ı ı ˛ˇ (4.43i) (4.43ii) (4.43iii) 4.2 The General Static Field Equations 293 The corresponding Euler–Lagrange equations (A1.20i) yield exactly the required static, vacuum field equations. Now, we may wonder how the reduced threedimensional action integral (4.43iii) is deduced from the original four-dimensional Einstein–Hilbert action integral from the Lagrangian in (A1.25). To answer this question, we first choose a (simplified) four-dimensional domain of Cartesian product: D WD D .t1 ; t2 /: (4.44) Moreover, the four-dimensional scalar invariant R.x/; as calculated from the static metric of (4.39), turns out to be R./ D e 2w.x/ ı ı ı ı ˛ˇ ˛ R.x/ C 2g .x/ @˛ w @ˇ w 2r˛ r w : (4.45) (Consult the answer to #1 of Exercise 4.2.) Therefore, the Einstein–Hilbert action integral reduces to Z R.x/ p g d4 x D.t1 ;t2 / D .t2 t1 / q Z ı ı ı ı ı R.x/ C 2g ˛ˇ @˛ w @ˇ w 2r˛ r ˛ w g d3 x D Z hı iq ı ı ˛ˇ R.x/ C 2g @˛ w @ˇ w g d3 x C .a boundary term/: D .const./ D (4.46) Thus, action integrals (4.43ii) and (4.46) are variationally equivalent. The second part in the action integral (4.43iii) gives rise to the general relativistic Dirichlet integral [43]: Z J.F0 / WD ı ˛ˇ g .x/ @˛ w @ˇ w q ı g d3 x: (4.47) D The above action integral leads to the “potential equation” (4.41ii). The integral above naturally induces a “metric” in a one-dimensional potential manifold by introducing the line element: d ˙ 2 D .dw/2 : (4.48) Note that the above metric remains invariant under the nonhomogeneous, linear transformation: b w D ˙w C k; (4.49) 294 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains where k is an arbitrary constant. Thus, it is clear that the action integral (4.47) remains invariant under the transformation (4.49) from w ! b w: Therefore, a ı vacuum, exact solution with g ˛ˇ .x/ and w.x/ can generate a new vacuum, exact ı solution with g ˛ˇ .x/ and b w.x/: Example 4.2.1. Consider the particular transformation 1 w.x/ D e2w.x/ e2b from (4.49). It is called an inversion [30]. Let us consider the static metric: 2 2 ds 2 D ı˛ˇ dx ˛ dx ˇ x 1 dx 4 ; x 1 > 0: It turns out that the above metric is flat. Applying the inversion to this metric, we generate another static metric: 2 4 2 4 ds 2 D x 1 ı˛ˇ dx ˛ dx ˇ x 1 dx ; x 1 > 0: It is a nonflat, static, vacuum metric. (This is the simplest of all known, nonflat vacuum solutions!) Static, Kasner metrics [239] contain this particular metric. Now, we shall classify the system of six partial differential equations (4.41i). q (See Appendix 2.) Let us choose three harmonic coordinate conditions ı ı @˛ g g ˛ˇ D 0: (Consult Problem # 10 of Exercise 2.2.) We have already used four-dimensional harmonic coordinate conditions to classify the general field equations (2.223i) in Example 2.4.6. An exactly similar analysis of the static, vacuum equations (4.41i) leads to the conclusion that the static system is elliptic. Now, let us use an alternate set of coordinate conditions, namely, ı ı ı g 12 .x/ D g 23 .x/ D g 31 .x/ 0: Therefore, we are employing an orthogonal coordinate chart to express ı g:: .x/ D e2P .x/ dx 1 ˝ dx 1 C e2Q.x/ dx 2 ˝ dx 2 C e2R.x/ dx 3 ˝ dx 3 : (4.50) Vacuum equations (4.41i) reduce to ı R12 .x/ D @1 @2 R C @1 R@2 R @1 R@2 P @1 Q@2 R D 2@1 w@2 w; (4.51i) ı R23 .x/ D @2 @3 P C @2 P @3 P @2 P @3 Q @2 R@3 P D 2@2 w@3 w; (4.51ii) ı R31 .x/ D @3 @1 Q C @3 Q@1 Q @3 Q@1 R @3 P @1 Q D 2@3 w@1 w; (4.51iii) 4.2 The General Static Field Equations 295 ı R11 .x/ D @1 @1 .Q C R/ C @1 Q @1 .Q P / C @1 R @1 .R P / C e2.P Q/ Œ@2 @2 P C @2 P @2 .P Q C R/ C e2.P R/ Œ@3 @3 P C @3 P @3 .P R C Q/ D 2.@1 w/2 ; (4.51iv) ı R22 .x/ D @2 @2 .R C P / C @2 R @2 .R Q/ C @2 P @2 .P Q/ C e2.QR/ Œ@3 @3 Q C @3 Q @3 .Q R C P / C e2.QP / Œ@1 @1 Q C @1 Q @1 .Q P C R/ D 2.@2 w/2 ; (4.51v) ı R33 .x/ D @3 @3 .P C Q/ C @3 P @3 .P R/ C @3 Q @3 .Q R/ C e2.RP / Œ@1 @1 R C @1 R @1 .R P C Q/ C e2.RQ/ Œ@2 @2 R C @2 R @2 .R Q C P / D 2.@3 w/2 : (4.51vi) Let us classify the system of three semilinear, second order p.d.e.s (4.51i–iii). Each of these three p.d.e.s is hyperbolic according to the criterion (A2.27i), (A2.49), and (A2.51). Since (principal) terms with second derivatives occur singly in each p.d.e., the system is decoupled for the purpose of classification. Therefore, the characteristic matrix and the determinant are furnished by Œ .::/ D diag Œ@1 ; @2 ; @2 ; @3 ; @3 ; @1 , det Œ .::/ D .@1 @2 @3 /2 . Thus, the system is clearly hyperbolic with characteristic surfaces governed by @1 @2 @3 D 0: (4.52) (Across any of the characteristic surfaces, there may occur jump discontinuities of the metric functions. See (A2.5).) Previously, we concluded with a harmonic coordinate chart that the system of equations (4.41i,ii) is elliptic. Now with an orthogonal coordinate chart, we infer that the system of (4.51i–vi) is mixed elliptichyperbolic. On the other hand, we have concluded after (A2.23iv) that classification of a p.d.e. remains unchanged under a coordinate transformation. To resolve this dilemma, we note that in the case of a single p.d.e. (A2.23ii), the unknown function w.x/ is treated as an invariant, scalar field. But in the case of the system of field ı equation (4.41i), the unknown metric functions g ˛ˇ .x/ undergo the transformation of a .0 C 2/th order tensor field. It is this additional set of degrees of freedom that allows the system to change character. Now, we shall deal with a star-shaped domain D RN and a second-order, linear, elliptic differential operator: L.w/ WD gij .x/ @i @j w C hj .x/ @j w; x 2 D RN : (4.53) 296 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains Here, the metric g:: .x/ is assumed to be continuous and positive-definite. Moreover, E the vector field h.x/ is assumed to be continuous. Clearly, the Laplacian operator p ij ıp g @i g g @j w (4.54) r 2 w WD r i ri w D g ij .x/ @i @j w C 1 is a special case of (4.53). A function w.x/ satisfying r 2 w D 0 is called a harmonic function. (In physical applications, we often call such a function a potential function.) We shall now state Hopf’s theorem and also the maximum–minimum principle. Theorem 4.2.2. Let a function w 2 C 2 .D RN I R/ satisfy the weak inequality LŒw.x/ 0 for all x 2 D: If there exists an interior point x0 2 D such that w.x/ w.x0 / for all x 2 D; then w.x/ w.x0 / D constant: On the other hand, if LŒw.x/ 0 and w.x/ w.x0 / for an interior point x0 ; then w.x/ w.x0 / D constant: For proof, consult [268]. Theorem 4.2.3. Let a function w.x/ be harmonic in D RN : Moreover, let the function w.x/ be continuous up to and on the boundary @D: Then its maximum and minimum are attained on boundary points. Furthermore, the maximum or the minimum are attained at an interior point if and only if w.x/ is constant-valued. For proof, see [268]. Example 4.2.4. For this example, we shall employ the same Kasner metric as in Example 4.2.1. It is furnished by 2 2 i 1 2 4 2 4 h 2 x dx ; ds 2 D x 1 dx 1 C dx 2 C dx 3 ˚ D WD x W 0 < a1 < x 1 < b1 ; a2 < x 2 < b2 ; a3 < x 3 < b3 : In this case, we have 2 e2w.x/ D x 1 ; 1 w.x/ D ln x : The function w.x/ is nonconstant, real analytic, and harmonic with respect to the non-Euclidean metric: 2 2 2 i 2 h dl 2 D x 1 dx 1 C dx 2 C dx 3 : 1 Since @1 w D x 1 < 0; according to (A1.1), the function w.x/ does not have any critical point or extrema inside D: The maximum value ln.a1 / and the minimum value ln.b1 / are attained on some points on the boundary @D: We shall now apply Theorem 4.2.3 to the static field equations (4.41i,ii). 4.2 The General Static Field Equations 297 Theorem 4.2.5. Let static field equations (4.41i) and Laplace’s equation (4.41ii) hold in a star-shaped domain D R3 : Let w.x/ be continuous up to and on @D: Moreover, let w.x/ attain an extremum at an interior point x0 2 D: Then, the fourdimensional domain D R is flat. Proof. Consider Laplace’s equation (4.41ii). By Theorem 4.2.3, w.x/ is constantı valued in D [ @D: Therefore, field equation (4.41i) implies that R˛ˇ .x/ 0 in D: ı ı Thus, the three-dimensional metric g:: .x/ yields R: : : .x/ O: : : .x/: Consequently, the four-dimensional metric in (4.39) implies that the domain D WD D R is flat. Now, we shall discuss a special class of static metrics. Consider the static metric ı given in (4.39). Let the three-dimensional, positive-definite metric g:: .x/ be conformally flat. Then, the four-dimensional metric in (4.39) is called a conformastat metric. By the definition in page 71, a conformastat metric can locally be reduced to ds 2 D ŒU.x/4 U.x/ ¤ 0 h 2 2 2 i 2 e2w.x/ dx 4 ; dx 1 C dx 2 C dx 3 for x 2 D R3 : (4.55) The criterion for conformal flatness for dimension N 4 was given in Theorem 1.3.33. We need to provide a criterion for conformal flatness for the dimension N D 3: For that reason, we introduce the Cotton-Schouten-York tensor2 [16, 42, 90, 228]: ı ı ı ı ı ı ı ı ı ı R˛ˇ .x/ WD r R˛ˇ rˇ R˛ C .1=4/ g ˛ rˇ R g ˛ˇ r R : (4.56) ı Lemma 4.2.6. Consider the thrice-differentiable metric g:: .x/ in D R3 : It is conformally flat if and only if ı R˛ˇ .x/ 0: (4.57) For proof, see [90, 171]. We shall now derive all the conformastat, vacuum solutions. Theorem 4.2.7. Consider the thrice-differentiable, static metric in equation (4.39) ı for the domain D WD D R R4 : Let the three-dimensional metric g:: .x/ be conformally flat. Moreover, let the static field equations (4.42i,ii) prevail. (i) Then, the two-dimensional level surface w.x/ D const. is a surface of constant curvature in the domain D R3 : (ii) Furthermore, the four-dimensional conformastat metric reduces to one of the (a) Kasner, (b) Schwarzschild, and (c) pseudo-Schwarzschild metrics. 2 York’s tensor is actually a rank-two tensor related to the one in (4.56) [269]. 298 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains Proof. Here, we shall provide an abridged version of the proof. (See [52].) We have to solve the three-dimensional tensor equations (4.57), (4.41i), and (4.42i). We employ three possible coordinate conditions: w.x/ D .x 1 =2/; ı ı g 12 .x/ D g 13 .x/ 0: (4.58) In this coordinate chart, (4.41i) yields ı R11 ./ D .1=2/; ı ı ı ı ı R12 ./ D R13 ./ D R22 ./ D R23 ./ D R33 ./ 0: (4.59) Equations (4.57) can be solved to obtain 2 h 2 2 ı g ˛ˇ .x/ dx ˛ dx ˇ D V x 1 dx 1 C V x 1 f x 2 ; x 3 dx 2 2 i C g x 2 ; x 3 dx 3 C 2h x 2 ; x 3 dx 2 dx 3 ; h 2 i > 0: V 4 x1 f x2 ; x3 g x2 ; x3 h x2 ; x3 (4.60) Here, V .x 1 /; f .x 2 ; x 3 /; g.x 2 ; x 3 /; and h.x 2 ; x 3 / are thrice-differentiable arbitrary functions of integration obeying the inequality above. .0/ Substituting (4.58)–(4.60) into field equations (4.42i), we derive that EQ1221 ./ D .0/ 0 D EQ1331 ./ implies i2 h 1 1 V .x 1 / D a ex =2 b ex =2 > 0: (4.61) Here, a and b are two constants of integration satisfying a2 Cb 2 > 0: The remaining .0/ nontrivial equation EQ2332 D 0 leads to 2332 .x 2 ; x 3 / D .ab/ h i 2 h.x 2 ; x 3 / f .x 2 ; x 3 / g.x 2 ; x 3 / : (4.62) Here, 2332 .x 2 ; x 3 / is a curvature tensor component of the surface metric: 2 2 d 2 D f .x 2 ; x 3 / dx 2 C g.x 2 ; x 3 / dx 3 C 2h x 2 ; x 3 dx 2 dx 3 : (4.63) By (1.164i), it follows from (4.62) that the surface metric is that of constant curvature equal to .ab/: There exist three subcases, namely, (i) ab D 0; (ii) ab > 0; and (iii) ab < 0: In subcase (i), the only nonflat solution is reducible to the Kasner metric: 4.2 The General Static Field Equations 299 4 2 4 2 ds 2 D 1 C mx 1 ı˛ˇ dx ˛ dx ˇ 1 C mx 1 dx ; 1 C mx 1 > 0: (4.64i) In the subcase ab > 0; the solution is reducible to the isotropic form of the Schwarzschild metric: 1 .m=2r/ 2 m i4 2 2 2 2 2 ds D 1 C dr C r .d/ C sin .d'/ .dt/2 ; 2r 1 C .m=2r/ 2 h 0 < m < 2r: (4.64ii) (Compare with Problem # 3.ii of Exercise 3.1.) In the subcase ab < 0; the solution is reducible to the pseudo-Schwarzschild metric: 2m 1 R ds 2 D 1 dR2 C R2 .d /2 C sinh2 .d'/2 2m 1 .dt/2 ; R 0 < R < 2m: (4.64iii) p Remarks: (i) Synge has proved earlier [243] that 4 g11 .x/ is a Newtonian potential for a conformastat vacuum solution. That conclusion is obvious for metrics (4.64i,ii). It is not so obvious for the metric in (4.64iii). (ii) In a conformastat domain of the space–time, as characterized by (4.55), the “coordinate speed” of a photon is independent of the spatial direction of propagation. Thus, the condensed proof is completed. Now, we shall study static, electrovac domains with the help of metric (4.39). For a static electric field, we have, from (4.24), (4.26), and (4.27), A˛ .x/ 0; A4 .x/ DW A.x/ ¤ 0; F˛ˇ .x/ 0; ı F˛4 .x/ D r˛ A D @˛ A 6 0: (4.65) 300 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains The nonzero components of the energy–momentum–stress tensor from (2.290i) are given by ı ı ı ı ı T˛ˇ .x/ D e2w r˛ A rˇ A C .1=2/ e2w g ˛ˇ r A r A; ı ı T44 .x/ D .1=2/ e2w r A r A > 0: (4.66) Nontrivial field equations (2.290i–vi), with the metric (4.39), electric field (4.65), and T ii ./ 0 R./; are reduced to the following: ı ı M4 .x/ D r 2 A 2 g ˛ˇ @˛ w @ˇ A D 0; ı (4.67i) ı ı ı EQ˛ˇ ./ g ˛ˇ e4w EQ44 ./ D R˛ˇ ./ C 2r˛ w rˇ w ı ı e2w r˛ A rˇ A D 0; ı (4.67ii) ı ı ı EQ44 .x/ D e4w r 2 w C . =2/ e2w g ˛ˇ r˛ A rˇ A D 0; EQ˛ˇ ./ D R˛ˇ ./ C T˛ˇ ./ 0:: D 0: (4.67iii) (4.67iv) For a special class of exact solutions, assume a functional relationship analogous to (4.32), namely, e2w.x/ D F ŒA.x/ > 0; dF ŒA ¤ 0; F 0 .A/ WD dA 2w @˛ @ˇ e D F 0 ./ @˛ @ˇ A C F 00 ./ @˛ A @ˇ A; ı 1 0 00 ı ˛ˇ 2 r ! D Œln jF ./j r A C Œln jF ./j g @˛ A @ˇ A : 2 ı 2 (4.68) Thus, (4.67i) and (4.67iii) reduce, respectively, to ı ı r 2 A D F 0 ./ F 1 ./ g ˛ˇ @˛ A @ˇ A; ı r 2 A D ŒF ./1 D F 0 ./ C F ./ ˚ (4.69i) ı ˛ˇ F ./ Œln jF ./j00 g @˛ A @ˇ A F 00 ./ ı g ˛ˇ @˛ A @ˇ A: 0 F ./ (4.69ii) 4.2 The General Static Field Equations 301 ı Subtracting (4.69i) from (4.69ii) and recalling g ˛ˇ @˛ A @ˇ A > 0; we obtain F 00 .A/ D ; or F .A/ D a C bA C . =2/ .A/2 ; or e2w.x/ D a C bA.x/ C . =2/ ŒA.x/2 > 0: (4.70) Here, a > 0 and b are arbitrary constants of integration. The equation above is the generalization of Weyl’s condition (4.34) in axial symmetry. Now, let us consider the special case: b 2 D 2a > 0; hp i2 p e2w.x/ D a˙ =2 A.x/ ; p ˙ =2 @˛ A i: @˛ w D hp p a˙ =2 A./ (4.71) The field equations (4.67ii) reduce to ı R˛ˇ .x/ D 0: (4.72) ı Therefore, the three-dimensional metric g:: .x/ is flat! The remaining field equations, with i1 hp p a˙ =2 A.x/ ; (4.73i) V .x/ WD reduce to ı ı ı r 2 V D r ˛ r ˛ V D 0: (4.73ii) Thus, V .x/ is a harmonic function in a three-dimensional Euclidean space (or it is a Newtonian potential). Using a Cartesian coordinate chart, the resulting conformastat metric and the covariant component of the electrostatic potential can be expressed as h 2 2 2 i 2 ŒV .x/2 dx 4 ; ds 2 D ŒV .x/2 dx 1 C dx 2 C dx 3 r 2 V WD ı ˛ˇ @˛ @ˇ V D 0; o n p p A4 .x/ A.x/ D ˙ 2= a C ŒV .x/1 : (4.74) This metric was discovered by Majumdar [173] and Papapetrou [204]. (Compare the above metric with the axially symmetric equation (4.38).) Equation (4.74) admits exact solutions due to many massive, charged bodies such that gravitational attractions are exactly balanced by electrostatic repulsions. 302 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains Example 4.2.8. We consider the multicenter solution: r n 2 X e.A/ ; k x x.A/ k AD1 V .x/ WD 1 C r k x x.A/ k WD " r ds D 1 C 2 2 X r 1C 2 X A A4 .x/ D " 2 X A 2 C x 2 x.A/ e.A/ k x x.A/ k A " 2 1 x 1 x.A/ 2 2 3 C x 3 x.A/ ; #2 ı˛ˇ dx ˛ dx ˇ e.A/ k x x.A/ k #2 2 dx 4 ; # " #1 r e.A/ e.A/ 2 X 1C : k x x.A/ k k x x.A/ k A (4.75) (Here, we have chosen a D 1 and the positive sign in (4.74).) At a very large coordinate distance k x x.A/ k; we obtain the expressions " ds D 2 r 1C2 2 X A " r 12 # e.A/ C ı˛ˇ dx ˛ dx ˇ k x x.A/ k 2 X A A4 .x/ D 2X A # 2 e.A/ C dx 4 ; k x x.A/ k e.A/ : k x x.A/ k Now, we shall discuss static, electromagneto-vac equations employing the metric in (4.39). (See [54].) The assumption of staticity, and Maxwell’s equations M4 ./D0; M˛ ./D0 in (2.290i–vi), implies that F˛4 .x/ D @˛ A4 DW @˛ A; ı ı 2w e r r A D 0: (4.76i) (4.76ii) 4.2 The General Static Field Equations 303 Now, we introduce the magnetic field vector by ı ı ı g ˛ˇ ./ Hˇ ./ DH ˛ .x/ WD .1=2/ e2w ˛ˇ .x/ Fˇ .x/; ı e2! F ı˛ ı˛ ./ D ./ H˛ ./: (4.77) Here, ./ are the components of antisymmetric, oriented tensor in (1.110ii). The remaining Maxwell’s equations, namely, M˛ ./ D 0 and M4 ./ D 0 yield H˛ .x/ D @˛ B; ı ı 2w r e r B D 0: (4.78) Here, B.x/ represents the magnetic potential which must satisfy the integral condition by Gauss’ Theorem 1.3.27: Z ı e2w r B n d2 D 0: (4.79) @D Here, @D is a continuous, piecewise-differentiable, orientable closed-surface outside matter with the areal element d2 : Physically speaking, (4.79), by (4.77), implies that the “total magnetic flux across a regular, closed surface must be zero.” Field equations (4.40i) and (2.290i) provide ı ˛ˇ T ˛4 ./ D e2! or ./ @ˇ A @ B; E ˛4 .x/ D 0; ı ˛ˇ .x/ @˛ A @ˇ B D 0: (4.80) The physical meaning of above equation is that the Poynting vector of a static electromagnetic field in general relativity must be the zero vector. For the nontrivial electromagneto-vac cases, (4.80) yields three possibilities: (i) @˛ A 6 0; @˛ B 0I (iii) @˛ A 6 0 (ii) @˛ A 0; @˛ B 6 0I and @˛ B 6 0: The first possibility is the electro-vac case. The second possibility is the magnetovac case. (The magneto-vac case is mathematically equivalent to the electro-vac case, except the condition in (4.79).) The third possibility is the nontrivial electromagneto-vac case. In such a scenario, let us investigate equation (4.80) more closely. It leads to the linear dependence: @˛ B .x/ @˛ A D 0; dB D ./ dA; B D B.A/; dB D B0 .A.// D ./: dA (4.81) 304 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains Here, .x/ ¤ 0 is some twice-differentiable function. Substituting (4.81) into (4.78) and subtracting it from (4.76ii), we derive that B00 .A/ D 0; k B.x/ D A.x/ C d: (4.82) Here, k ¤ 0 and d are arbitrary constants of integration. The physical meaning of (4.82) is that “the static electric field vector is a constant-multiple of the static magnetic field vector.” The electromagneto-vac equations (2.290ii–iv) with (4.82), are reduced to b B.x/ WD ı p 1 C k 2 B.x/; ı (4.83i) ı r 2b B 2r b Br b B D 0; ı ı (4.83ii) ı ı ı B rˇ b B D 0; R˛ˇ .x/ C 2r˛ w rˇ w e2w r˛ b ı ı ı (4.83iii) ı r 2 w . =2/ e2w g ˛ˇ r˛ b B rˇ b B D 0: (4.83iv) Equations (4.83ii–iv) are formally magneto-vac equations (as if the electric field has disappeared). Feynman has already noticed in special relativistic electrodynamics [97] that an E E electrically charged magnet generates a stationary Poynting vector E.x/ H.x/ around it, which implies that the space–time generated by such a system must be nonstatic (as there is energy flow around the magnet). This can be deduced from (4.82) where we can see that Einstein’s static field equations do not admit the existence of an electrically charged static magnet. (There is a possibility of experimental verification of this effect [212] in the context of conservation of angular momentum. Also, see [54].) Example 4.2.9. We shall discuss here the static, magneto-vac solution of Bonnor [26] and Melvin [180]. The metric and the magnetic potential in Weyl coordinates are furnished by h i2 h i4 ds 2 D 1 C .b%=2/2 1 C .b%=2/2 .d%/2 C .dz/2 C %2 .d'/2 b B./ D 2 1 C .b%=2/2 .dt/2 ; (4.84i) p 2= b z: (4.84ii) Here, b is a nonzero constant. By (4.82) and (4.83i), we can generate a new static, electromagneto-vac solution by the same metric (4.84i) and potentials: 4.2 The General Static Field Equations 305 s 2 kb z C const.; .1 C k 2 / A./ D s 2 b z: .1 C k 2 / B./ D (4.85) Both the electric and magnetic vector fields are along the z-axis. Another possibility of yielding the same metric is choosing the potentials as s 2 A./ D b z; .1 C k 2 / s 2 B./ D kb z: (4.86) .1 C k 2 / In the limit k ! 0; we obtain from (4.86) the same metric (4.84i) as a solution of the electro-vac equations with p A./ D 2= b z: (4.87) The metric (4.84i) with (4.87) provides an example of electro-vac solutions outside the Weyl class characterized by (4.70). Now, we shall study incoherent charged dust as discussed in (2.296i–vii). We shall use the static metric (4.39). Moreover, we assume that only the static electric field is present. Therefore, we have F˛ˇ .x/ 0; .x/ 6 0; A˛ .x/ 0; .x/ > 0; F˛4 .x/ D @˛ A4 DW @˛ A ¤ 0; U ˛ .x/ 0; U 4 .x/ D ew.x/ : Using (4.66), (4.67i–iii), the non-trivial field equations reduce to ı ı ı ı r 2 A 2 g ˛ˇ r˛ ! rˇ A .x/ ew D 0; ı ı ı ı ı R˛ˇ .x/ C 2r˛ w rˇ w e2w r˛ A rˇ A D 0; (4.88ii) ı ı ı ı e4w r 2 w C . =2/ e2w C g ˛ˇ r˛ A rˇ A D 0; (4.88iii) .x/ @˛ Œew D .x/ @˛ A; (4.88iv) .x/ d Œe! D .x/ dA: (4.88v) (4.88i) Now we shall try to solve the above system under some reasonable assumptions [49]. 306 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains Theorem 4.2.10. Consider field equations (4.88i–iv) with (4.87) in a star-shaped domain D R3 : Let functions .x/ > 0 and .x/ ¤ 0 be of class C 1 I the function ı A.x/ be of class C 2 I and functions w.x/; g ˛ˇ .x/ be of class C 3 in D: (i) Then, w.x/ and A.x/ are functionally related. (ii) In case this functional relationship is given by the quadratic equation (4.70), the relationship has to be a perfect square. ı (iii) Moreover, the three-dimensional metric g:: .x/ is flat Euclidean, and the field equations reduce to one elliptic equation: ı ı ı ı g ˛ˇ r ˛ r ˇ V DW r 2 V D . =2/ .x/ ŒV .x/3 ; V .x/ WD e!.x/ : (4.89) Proof. Equation (4.88iv) implies that w.x/ and A.x/ are functionally dependent. Therefore, there exists a function F such that e2w.x/ DF ŒA.x/ > 0; d Œe! d ŒF .A/1=2 .x/ ˇ ˇ ¤ 0: D D ˇA.x/ dA ˇA.x/ dA .x/ (4.90) The field equations (4.88i) and (4.88iii) reduce to ı ı r 2 A D ŒF ./1 F 0 ./ g ˛ˇ @˛ A @ˇ A C ./ ŒF ./1=2 ; ı r 2A D F 0 ./ C F ./ F 00 ./ ./ ı g ˛ˇ @˛ A @ˇ A C 0 : 0 F ./ F ./ (4.91i) (4.91ii) Subtracting (4.91i) from (4.91ii), we obtain h F 00 ./ i ı ˛ˇ D 0: g @ A @ A C ˛ ˇ F0 F0 F 1=2 (4.92) Assuming Weyl’s condition (4.70), the first term of the equation above becomes zero. Therefore, from the second term, and (4.90), we deduce that .x/ D .x/ 1 F0 F 1=2 ˇ D ˇ : F 0 ˇ:: 2 F 1=2 ˇ:: (4.93) Substituting F ŒA D a C bA C . =2/A2 into (4.93), we derive both equations b 2 D 2 a > 0; hp i2 p and F ŒA D a˙ =2 A : (4.94) 4.2 The General Static Field Equations 307 Putting (4.94) into (4.93), we obtain that j.x/j D .x/ r 2 D const. (4.95) Using (4.95) and (4.94), the field equation (4.88ii) yields ı R˛ˇ .x/ D 0: (4.96) ı Therefore, the three-dimensional metric g:: .x/ is flat Euclidean. Moreover, we define, as in (4.73i), V .x/ WD i1 hp p a˙ =2 A.x/ : (4.97) The remaining field equations reduce to one elliptic equation (4.89). Choosing a Cartesian chart, the metric (4.39) and (4.89) go over into 2 ds 2 DV 2 ./ ı˛ˇ dx ˛ dx ˇ V 2 ./ dx 4 r 2 V WD ı ˛ˇ @˛ @ˇ V D .x/ ŒV .x3 : 2 and Remarks: (i) In the preceding theorem, we have proved that inside a charged dust (a), a functional relationship between w.x/ and A.x/ must hold, and (b) Assuming Weyl’s equation (4.70), the Majumdar–Papapetrou condition (4.94) is a consequence and (c) the conformastat metric is valid. (Similar conclusions will be proved in Chap. 8 dealing with general relativistic wave fields, as originally shown by Das [49].) Therefore, we shall call the metric in (4.97), the Weyl–Majumdar–Papapetrou–Das (or W–M–P–D) metric. p (ii) De and Raychaudhuri [71] have proved the condition j.x/j D =2 .x/ under weaker assumptions. (iii) We can satisfy the underdetermined equation (4.89) by defining .x/ WD ı 2 ŒV ./3 r 2 V . Example 4.2.11. Let us consider a massive, charged particle and an extended massive, charged body in Newtonian physics. We use a Cartesian coordinate chart. (See Fig. 4.3.) The gravitational and electrostatic potentials W .x/ and ˚.x/ due to the particle at x.1/ are furnished by W .x/ D ˚.x/ D G m.1/ ; k x x.1/ k e.1/ 1 D A.x/: 4 k x x.1/ k (4.98) 308 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains x−x(1) x(1) x 3 Fig. 4.3 A massive, charged particle at x.1/ and a point x in the extended body (Here, we have reinstated temporarily the Newtonian gravitational constant G:) The functions W and ˚ are linearly related. The (static) equilibrium at the point x of the extended body due to external forces is governed by equations .x/ rW D .x/ r˚; or G m.1/ .x/ D .4/1 e.1/ .x/; or m.1/ .x/ D : .x/ 2 e.1/ Z Now, Z e.1/ D .x/ d x; m.1/ D 3 D Therefore, e.1/ D 2 .x/ d3x: D m.1/ e.1/ m.1/ ; or, r .x/ D˙ : .x/ 2 The last equation is the analogue of the general relativistic equation (4.95). (4.99) Now, we shall explore the static, vacuum equations (4.42i,ii) in terms of an orthonormal triad, physical or orthonormal components, and Ricci rotation coefficients [53]. The static metric is furnished by (4.39). Now, we shall consider threeı dimensional tensor field equations arising from the metric g:: .x/. The corresponding orthonormal triad and directional derivatives from (1.105) and (1.114ii) are given by Ee.˛/ .x/ D .˛/ .x/ @ ; @x (4.100i) 4.2 The General Static Field Equations ı g .x/ 309 .˛/ .x/ @.˛/ f WD .˛/ .x/ .ˇ/ .x/ D ı.˛/.ˇ/ ; (4.100ii) @f : @x (4.100iii) Equation (1.139iv) for f .x/ WD x yields metric equations .˛/ @ .ˇ/ @ .ˇ/ .˛/ D .ı/ h .ı/ .˛/.ˇ/ .ı/ .ˇ/.˛/ i : (4.101) Equation (1.138) provides the Ricci rotation coefficients ı .˛/.ˇ/.ı/ .x/ D r .˛/ .ˇ/ .x/ .ı/ .x/ .ˇ/.˛/.ı/ .x/: (4.102) Equation (1.141iv) furnishes curvature tensor components as ı R.˛/.ˇ/. /.ı/ .x/ D @.ı/ Cı .˛/.ˇ/. / . /."/ @. / .˛/.ˇ/.ı/ . /.˛/.ı/ C ."/.ˇ/. / .˛/.ˇ/. / . /.˛/. / ."/. /.ı/ ."/.ˇ/.ı/ ."/.ı/. / ; (4.103) and the potential equation (4.42ii) yields .0/ ı ı .x/ D ı .˛/.ˇ/ r.˛/ r.ˇ/ w h D ı .˛/.ˇ/ @.˛/ @.ˇ/ w C i .ı/ .ˇ/.˛/ @.ı/ w D 0: (4.104) The field equations in (4.42i) go over into .0/ EQ.˛/.ˇ/. /.ı/ .x/ ı D R.˛/.ˇ/. /.ı/ .x/ C 2 ı.˛/.ı/ @. / w ı.˛/. / @.ı/ w @.ˇ/ w C 2 ı.ˇ/. / @.ı/ w ı.ˇ/.ı/ @. / w @.˛/ w C ı . /."/ @. / w @."/ w ı.ˇ/.ı/ ı. /.˛/ ı.ˇ/. / ı.ı/.˛/ D 0: (4.105) 310 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains Let us choose a local orthogonal coordinate chart. Therefore, we have ı g:: .x/ D Œp.x/2 .dx 1 ˝ dx 1 / C Œq.x/2 .dx 2 ˝ dx 2 / C Œr.x/2 .dx 3 ˝ dx 3 /; p.x/ > 0; q.x/ > 0; .1/ .x/ D Œp.x/1 ı.1/ ; .3/ .x/ D Œr.x/1 ı.3/ I @.1/ f D p 1 @1 f; r.x/ > 0I .2/ .x/ (4.106i) D Œq.x/1 ı.2/ ; (4.106ii) @.2/ f D q 1 @2 f; @.3/ f D r 1 @3 f: (4.106iii) The nonzero Ricci rotation coefficients from (4.106ii) and (4.102) are furnished by a.x/ WD .1/.2/.1/ .x/ D q 1 @2 ln p; b.x/ WD .1/.2/.2/ .x/ D p 1 @1 ln q; l.x/ WD .1/.3/.1/ .x/ D r 1 @3 ln p; n.x/ WD .1/.3/.3/ .x/ D p 1 @1 ln r; s.x/ WD .2/.3/.2/ .x/ D r 1 @3 ln q; t.x/ WD .2/.3/.3/ .x/ D q 1 @2 ln r: (4.107) Now, we compute the nontrivial field equation (4.105) by using (4.106ii), (4.107), and (4.103). These are the following first-order p.d.e.s: .0/ EQ.1/.2/.2/.3/./ D r 1 @3 b C s.n b/ C 2r 1 p 1 @3 w @1 w D 0; (4.108i) .0/ EQ.2/.3/.3/.1/./ D p 1 @1 t C n.a C t/ C 2p 1 q 1 @1 w @2 w D 0; (4.108ii) .0/ EQ.1/.3/.1/.2/./ D q 1 @2 l C a.s l/ 2q 1 r 1 @2 w @3 w D 0; (4.108iii) .0/ EQ.1/.2/.2/.1/./ D p 1 @1 b q 1 @2 a C a2 C b 2 C ls C p 2 .@1 w/2 C q 2 .@2 w/2 r 2 .@3 w/2 D 0; (4.108iv) .0/ EQ.2/.3/.3/.2/./ D q 1 @2 t r 1 @3 s C s 2 C t 2 C bn p 2 .@1 w/2 C q 2 .@2 w/2 C r 2 .@3 w/2 D 0; (4.108v) .0/ EQ.3/.1/.1/.3/./ D p 1 @1 n r 1 @3 l C l 2 C n2 at C p 2 .@1 w/2 q 2 .@2 w/2 C r 2 .@3 w/2 D 0: (4.108vi) 4.2 The General Static Field Equations ı Algebraic identities R. equations: /.ı/.˛/.ˇ/ ./ 311 ı R.˛/.ˇ/. /.ı/ ./ yield, from (4.108i–iii), r 1 @3 b C p 1 @1 s bl C ns D 0; (4.109i) r 1 @3 a q 1 @2 l lt as D 0; (4.109ii) p 1 @1 t q 1 @2 n C bt C an D 0: (4.109iii) The potential equation (4.104) provides .0/ ./ D p 2 @1 @1 w C q 2 @2 @2 w C r 2 @3 @3 w C p 1 @1 .p 1 / C b C n @1 w C q 1 @2 .q 1 / C t a @2 w C r 1 @3 .r 1 / l s @3 w D 0: (4.110) Equations (4.108i–vi) and (4.109i–iii) are equivalent to the static, vacuum field equations (4.51i–vi). A special exact solution of this system will be investigated in the following example. Example 4.2.12. Consider the following special functions: p.x/ q.x/ r.x/ WD x 1 > 0; w.x/ WD ln.x 1 /: The nonzero Ricci rotation coefficients from (4.107) are furnished by b.x/ D .x 1 /2 > 0; n.x/ D .x 1 /2 > 0: Equations (4.108i–iii) and (4.109i–iii) are identically satisfied, and (4.108iv) reduces to ! ! ! 1 2 1 1 1 C C D 0: x1 .x 1 /3 .x 1 /4 .x 1 /2 .x 1 /2 Similarly, all other equations are satisfied. Therefore, we have a vacuum metric which is none other than the Kasner metric of Example 4.2.4. 312 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains Exercise 4.2 1. Consider the general static metric: 2 ı gij ./ dx i dx j WD e2w.x/ g ˛ˇ .x/ dx ˛ dx ˇ e2w.x/ dx 4 : Derive static field equations (4.40i–iv). 2. Prove that there exists no solution for the static metric in (4.39) in case of an incoherent dust with Tij ./ D ./ Ui ./ Uj ./ and .x/ > 0: Provide a physical reason why this is so. 3. Consider the potential equation (4.41ii). Let the two-dimensional boundary @D be a continuous, piecewise-differentiable, orientable, and closed surface. Moreover, let the boundary-value w.x/j@D D F ./ be a prescribed, continuous function. Prove that, in case this Dirichlet problem has a solution for the potential w.x/, this solution must be unique. 4. Consider static, electro-vac equations (4.67i–iii) and assume Weyl’s condition (4.70). In case the constants satisfy the inequality b 2 ¤ 2a ; show that the field equations can be formally reduced to static, vacuum equations: p ds 2 D e2 .2 ı r2 /1 .b 2 2a /V p ı g ˛ˇ dx ˛ dx ˇ e2 .2 /1 .b 2 2a /V .dx 4 /2 ; hp i .2 /1 .b 2 2a / V D 0: 5. Consider static, electro-vac equations (4.67i–iii). Let the function w.x/ attain the maximum at an interior point x0 2 D: Furthermore, let A.x/ attain a minimum at an interior point of D R3 . Then, prove that (i) Fij ./ 0 and (ii) Rij kl ./ 0 in D R: 6. Let a static, orthogonal metric be furnished by 2n=p 2 m.p2/ 1 2 1 2n.1p/=p 2 mp 2 2 ds 2 D x 1 x dx C x x dx 2n.1p/=p 2 m.p2/ 3 2 1 2n=p 2 mp 4 2 C x1 x dx x x dx ; 2 < p < 6; 0 < 2p=.p 3 p 2 C 3p C 1/ n 1=2; 4p=.p 2/3 m < 0I ˚ D WD .x 1 ; x 2 ; x 3 / W 0 < c1 < x 1 < c2 ; 0 < c3 < x 2 < c4 ; 0 < c5 < x 3 < c6 : 4.2 The General Static Field Equations 313 Show that: (i) Tij ./ is of Segre characteristic Œ1; 1; 1; 1: (ii) Strong energy conditions (2.268iii) hold. 7. Express the general, static metric as [243] 2 ds 2 D g ˛ˇ .x/ dx ˛ dx ˇ Œ1 C W .x/2 dx 4 ; x 2 D R3 : (i) Show that the vacuum field equations reduce to R˛ˇ ./ D R˛ˇ .x/ C Œ1 C W .x/1 r˛ rˇ W D 0; Œ1 C W .x/1 R44 ./ D r 2 W D 0: (ii) Prove that vacuum equations above imply that R.x/ 0: (iii) Let r˛ W dx ˛ be a Killing 1-form (with respect to the metric g:: .x/). Prove that the vacuum field equations (of part (i)) imply that the space– time domain D R is flat. 8. Consider the general, static metric of # 7. (i) Let twice-differentiable functions x ˛ D X ˛ .l/ and l1 < l < l2 satisfy geodesic equations of the metric g:: .x/: Show that the same functions, together with X 4 .l/ D t0 D const.; satisfy (spacelike) geodesic equations of the four-dimensional static metric.3 (ii) The squared Lagrangian of (2.155) for a geodesic yields o n L.2/ ./ D .1=2/ g ˛ˇ .x/ u˛ uˇ Œ1 C W .x/2 .u4 /2 : Noting that x 4 is an ignorable coordinate, reduce the Lagrangian by Routh’s Theorem 3.1.3 to o n L.2/ ./ D .1=2/ g ˛ˇ .x/ u˛ uˇ C E 2 Œ1 C W .x/2 : (Here, E is the constant representing energy.) (iii) The relativistic Hamiltonian (2.141i) (with W.x; u/ 0) corresponding to the Lagrangian in part (ii), for m D 1, is given by n o H./ D .1=2/ g ˛ˇ .x/ p˛ pˇ Œ1 C W .x/2 .p4 /2 C 1 : 3 Such a hypersurface is called a totally geodesic hypersurface [90]. 314 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains Reduce the alternate Lagrangian (2.143) given by LI . / D pi ui H./ to obtain LI .x; uI pI / DW LI ./ p4 u4 D p˛ u˛ H.x; p/; n o H.x; p/ WD .1=2/ g ˛ˇ .x/ p˛ pˇ E 2 Œ1 C W .x/2 C 1 : 9. Consider the system of the first-order partial differential equations (4.108iv–vi). Prove that the determinant of the characteristic matrix implies that the system is hyperbolic. 10. Consider the Euclidean potential equation and consequent electro-vac metric in (4.74). (i) Let f be function of the complex variable WD an arbitrary holomorphic x 1 C i cos ' x 2 C sin ' x 3 : Show that V .x/ WD Re 8 <Z : 9 = f ./ d' ; solves the potential equation and thus generates a general class of static electro-vac metrics. (ii) Define n 1 o V .x/ WD Re exp x 1 C .i=5/ .3x 2 C 4x 3 / which generates a static, electro-vac metric. Prove that V .x/ takes all real values, except zero, in the neighborhood of the line given by x 1 D 0 and 3x 2 C 4x 3 D 0: Answers and Hints to Selected Exercises: 1. The static metric is given by 2 ı gij ./ dx i dx j D e2w.x/ g ˛ˇ .x/ dx ˛ dx ˇ e2w.x/ dx 4 : Nonzero Christoffel symbols are provided by ˛ˇ ı D C b ˛ˇ ˛ˇ ı DW ˛ˇ ı g hı i ı ı g ˇ @˛ w C g ˛ @ˇ w g ˛ˇ @ w ; 4.2 The General Static Field Equations 315 4 D @˛ w; ˛4 ı ˛ D e4w g ˛ˇ @ˇ w: 44 Denoting antisymmetrization by AŒ˛ˇ WD .1=2/ A˛ˇ Aˇ˛ ; nonzero components of the curvature tensor are given by R˛ˇ ı ı D R˛ˇ ı ı C 2r Œ b ˛ıˇ C 2b ˛ Œ b ıˇ ı C 2g ˇŒı r r ˛ w C 2ı ˛Œ rı rˇ w ı D R˛ˇ ı ı ı ı ı ı ı ı ı ı ı C 2g ˇŒ ı ˛ı r w r w C 2g ˇŒı r w r ˛ w ı ı C 2ı ˛Œ rı w rˇ w; R4ˇ ı 4 ı ı ı ı ı ı ı D rˇ r w C 3rˇ w r w g ˇ g r w r w: The nonzero components of the Ricci tensor, and the curvature scalar, are furnished by ı ı ı ı ı ı Rˇ D Rˇ C 2rˇ w r w g ˇ r˛ r ˛ w; ı ı ı R44 D e4w r˛ r ˛ w D e4w r 2 w; ı ı ı ı ˛ˇ ı 2w 2 RDe R C 2g r ˛ w r ˇ w 2r w : 2. Use the comoving coordinate chart so that U ˛ .x/ 0: Then use conservation equation (4.40iv). Gravitational collapse is inevitable. 3. Assume to the contrary that there exist two solutions such that W1 .x/ 6 W2 .x/ in D with W1 .x/j@D W2 .x/j@D : ı Define the function W .x/ WD W1 .x/ W2 .x/ so that r 2 W D 0 and W .x/j@D 0: By Theorem 4.2.3, the extremum of W .x/ is attained on some boundary points in @D: Therefore, the function W .x/ D W1 .x/ W2 .x/ 0 in D [ @D: Thus, a contradiction is reached. 316 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains 4. Introduce the function V.A/ as in (4.35i): V .x/ WD V.A.x//; p @˛ V D =2 e2w @˛ A; ı r 2 V D 0; ı r2 ı hp i .2 /1 .b 2 2a / V D 0; R˛ˇ .x/ C 1 b 2 2a @˛ V @ˇ V D 0: (Compare with the answer to #3 of Exercise 4.1.) 5. Consider the static, electro-vac equation (4.67iii). It follows that ı ı r 2 w D . =2/ e2w g ˛ˇ @˛ A @ˇ A 0: Using Hopf’s Theorem 4.2.2, it follows that w.x/ is constant-valued. Equation (4.67i) implies that A.x/ is constant-valued. Therefore, (4.67ii) implies that ı R˛ˇ ı 0. Thus, from the answer to #1 of these exercises, it is implied that Rij kl 0. 6. Use the g-method of p. 197. (See [18].) 7. R˛ˇ ı ./ D RN ˛ˇ ı .x/; R˛ˇ 4 .x/ 0; R˛44ˇ ./ D Œ1 C W .x/ rN˛ rNˇ W: 8. (ii) @L.2/ ./ ˇ D Œ1 C W .x/2 u4 j:: D E D const. @u4 ˇ:: Routh’s Theorem 3.1.3 implies that LN .2/ ./ D L.2/ ./ C Eu4 o n D .1=2/ g ˛ˇ .x/ u˛ uˇ C E 2 Œ1 C W .x/2 : 10. (ii) Consider the complex variable and the holomorphic function expŒ1= in the neighborhood of the isolated, essential singularity at D 0: It takes every complex value except the value zero. (See [191].) 4.3 Axially Symmetric Stationary Space–Time Domains 317 4.3 Axially Symmetric Stationary Space–Time Domains It is assumed that an axially symmetric, stationary space–time domain admits one spacelike and another timelike Killing vector which commute. The metric can be adapted to a coordinate chart so that the Killing vectors are @x@ 3 and @x@ 4 : Thus, the metric can be expressed as n 1 2 e2.x ;x / .dx 1 ˝ dx 1 / C .dx 2 ˝ dx 2 / o 1 2 C e2ˇ.x ;x / dx 3 ˝ dx 3 n o 1 2 e2w.x ;x / ˛.x 1 ; x 2 / dx 3 C dx 4 ˝ ˛.x 1 ; x 2 / dx 3 C dx 4 ; (4.111i) g:: .x/ D e2w.x 1 ;x 2 / ˚ ds 2 D e2w.%;z/ e2.%;z/ .d%/2 C .dz/2 C e2ˇ.%;z/ .d'/2 e2w.%;z/ Œ˛.%; z/ d' C dt2 : (4.111ii) Some of the vacuum field equation (2.164i) for the metric (4.111ii) yields Weyl– Lewis–Papapetrou (WLP) charts [238] characterized by ˚ ds 2 D e2w.%;z/ e2.%;z/ .d%/2 C .dz/2 C %2 .d'/2 e2w.%;z/ Œ˛.%; z/ d' C dt2 : (4.112) Nontrivial vacuum field equations from (4.112) emerge as i e4w h i h @1 D % .@1 w/2 .@2 w/2 .@1 ˛/2 .@2 ˛/2 ; 4% @2 D 2% @1 w @2 w r 2 w WD @1 @1 w C e4w @1 ˛ @2 ˛; 2% (4.113i) (4.113ii) i 1 1 e4w h @1 w C @2 @2 w D 2 .@1 ˛/2 C .@2 ˛/2 ; (4.113iii) % 2 % @1 %1 e4w @1 ˛ C @2 %1 e4w @2 ˛ D 0: (4.113iv) Remarks: (i) Equations (4.113i–iv) reduce to static equations (4.10i–iii) in case ˛.%; z/ D const. (ii) The integrability of (4.113i,ii) is guaranteed by (4.113iii,iv). 318 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains Now, we pose pseudo-Cauchy–Riemann equations [43]: @1 D .%/1 e4w @2 ˛; @2 D .%/1 e4w @1 ˛: (4.114) The integrability of the above equations is guaranteed by (4.113iv). Substituting (4.114) into (4.113i–iv), we obtain an equivalent system: i e4w h 2 2 @1 D % .@1 w/ .@2 w/ C .@1 / .@2 / ; 4 e4w @1 @2 ; @2 D % 2@1 w @2 w C 2 i h r 2 w D .1=2/ e4w .@1 /2 C .@2 /2 : 2 2 (4.115i) (4.115ii) (4.115iii) The second integrability condition of (4.114) is @2 .@1 ˛/ @1 .@2 ˛/ D 0: By the equation above, (4.114) yields r 2 D 4 .@1 w @1 C @2 w @2 / : (4.115iv) In case the coupled potential equations, (4.115iii,iv), are satisfied, the functions .%; z/ and ˛.%; z/ can be determined by line integrals. These are furnished from (4.115i,ii) and (4.114) as Z.%;z/ .%; z/ D n y 1 .@1 w/2 .@2 w/2 C .1=4/ e4w .@1 /2 .@2 /2 j:: dy 1 .%0 ;z0 /Œ Z.%;z/ ˛.%; z/ D o C 2@1 w @2 w C .1=2/ e4w @1 @2 j:: dy 2 ; (4.116i) o n y 1 e4w @2 j:: dy 1 e4w @1 j:: dy 2 : .%0 ;z0 /Œ (Equation (4.116i) generalizes the static equation (4.9). See Fig. 4.1.) (4.116ii) 4.3 Axially Symmetric Stationary Space–Time Domains 319 Now, we shall introduce a complex potential by F .%; z/ WD e2w.%;z/ C i .%; z/: (4.117) The vacuum equations (4.115i–iv) reduce to @1 D .%=4/ .Re F /2 j@1 F j2 j@2 F j2 ; @2 D .%=4/ .Re F /2 @1 F @2 F C @2 F @1 F ; r 2 F D .Re F /1 .@1 F /2 C .@2 F /2 : (4.118i) (4.118ii) (4.118iii) Here, the bar denotes complex conjugation. We introduce another complex potential: 1 C F .%; z/ : .%; z/ WD 1 F .%; z/ (4.119) (The above potential is useful in obtaining exact solutions more easily.) The field equations (4.118i–iii) go over into 2 @1 D % jj2 1 j@1 j2 j@2 j2 ; i 2 h @2 D % jj2 1 @1 @2 C @2 @1 ; i 1 h .@1 /2 C .@2 /2 : r 2 D 2 jj2 1 (4.120i) (4.120ii) (4.120iii) Now, we introduce a prolate spheroidal coordinate chart [256, 273] by p % D k .x 2 1/.1 y 2 /; z D kxy; k D positive const.I x > 1; 0 < y < 1I .dy/2 .dx/2 d%2 C dz2 D k 2 .x 2 y 2 / 2 C : x 1 1 y2 (4.121) The inverse transformation is furnished by 2k x D A.%; z/ C B.%; z/; 2k y D A.%; z/ B.%; z/; p A.%; z/ WD %2 C .z C k/2 ; p B.%; z/ WD %2 C .z k/2 : (4.122) 320 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains Remarks: (i) The prolate spheroidal coordinate x must not be confused with the point x 2 R4 : (ii) Prolate spheroidal coordinates do facilitate extracting exact solutions of the static, axially symmetric field equations. The complex potential equation (4.120iii) is equivalent to h h i i C @y .1 y 2 / @yb @x .x 2 1/ @xb .x; y/ 2b i .x 2 1/ @xb D h ˇ ˇ2 ˇb ˇ 1 2 C .1 y 2 / @yb b .x; y/ WD .%; z/: 2 ; (4.123) This second-order semilinear elliptic equation is known as the Ernst equation [92, 93]. Example 4.3.1. We shall try to find a linear solution of the type: b .x; y/ D px C iqy: (4.124) Here, p and q are assumed to be real constants such that p 2 C q 2 > 0: The left-hand side of (4.123) yields L.H.S. D 2 .px iqy/: (4.125i) The right-hand side of (4.123) provides R.H.S. D 2 .px iqy/ p 2 x 2 C q 2 y 2 .p 2 C q 2 / : 2 2 C q y 1/ .p 2 x 2 (4.125ii) Equating (4.125i) with (4.125ii), we derive that p 2 C q 2 D 1: (4.126) (Therefore, we have jpj 1; jqj 1:) By (4.119), we deduce that " b .x; y/ D F b .x; y/ 1 b .x; y/ C 1 # px C iqy 1 D px C iqy C 1 ( ) .px/2 C .qy/2 1 C 2iqy D : Œ.px C 1/2 C .qy/2 (4.127) 4.3 Axially Symmetric Stationary Space–Time Domains 321 Using (4.117), we obtain .px/2 C .qy/2 1 ; .px C 1/2 C .qy/2 2qy b.x; y/ D : .px C 1/2 C .qy/2 w.x;y/ D e2b (4.128) For physical considerations, we identify the constants in the above as p pD m2 a 2 > 0; m a ; m p k D m2 a2 > 0: qD (4.129) Thus, (4.128) yields by (4.122), ) .m2 a2 / ŒA./CB./2 C a2 ŒA./B./2 4m2 .m2 a2 / ; e D .m2 a2 / ŒA./CB./ C 2m2 C a2 ŒA./B./2 ( ) p 4am m2 a2 ŒA./ B./ .%; z/ D : (4.130) .m2 a2 / ŒA./ C B./ C 2m2 C a2 ŒA./ B./2 ( 2w.%;z/ From (4.116i,ii), we derive the corresponding four-dimensional metric as .m2 a2 / .A C B C 2m/2 C a2 .A B/2 ds D .m2 a2 / .A C B/2 C a2 .A B/2 4m2 .m2 a2 / ( .m2 a2 / .A C B/2 C a2 .A B/2 4m2 .m2 a2 / 4.m2 a2 / A B ) 2 2 2 2 .d%/ C .dz/ C % .d'/ 2 .m2 a2 / .A C B/2 C a2 .A B/2 4m2 .m2 a2 / .m2 a2 / .A C B C 2m/2 C a2 .A B/2 ( " # )2 am .A C B C 2m/ 4.m2 a2 / .A B/2 dtC d' : .m2 a2 / .A C B/2 C a2 .A B/2 4m2 .m2 a2 / (4.131) 322 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains The metric above is the famous Kerr metric [148] expressed in the W–L–P coordinate chart. (The stationary metric in (4.131) generalizes the static metric in (4.18).) The Boyer–Lindquist coordinate chart [28] is introduced by the transformation r D .1=2/ A.%; z/ C B.%; z/ C m; p cos D 1=2 m2 a2 ŒA./ B./ ; p % D r 2 2mr C a2 sin ; z D .r m/ cos : (4.132) The Kerr metric in (4.131) goes over into ds D 1 2 2mr r 2 C a2 cos2 1 ( .r 2 2mr C a2 cos2 / ) .dr/2 2 2 2 2 2 C .d/ C .r 2mr C a / sin .d'/ .r 2 2mr C a2 / 1 " # )2 ( 2amr sin2 2mr dt C 2 d' I r 2 C a2 cos2 r 2mr C a2 cos2 n p D WD .r; ; '; t/ W r > m C m2 a2 cos2 ; o 0 < < ; < ' < ; 1 < t < 1 : (4.133) The line element above is more popularly expressed as ds 2 D ˙.r; / .dr/2 C .d/2 C .r 2 C a2 / sin2 .d'/2 .r/ 2 2mr dt a sin2 d' I .dt/ C ˙.r; / 2 ˙.r; / WD r 2 C a2 cos2 ; .r/ WD r 2 2mr C a2 : (4.134) In the limit a ! 0; the above metric reduces to the Schwarzschild metric of (3.9). The physical meanings of the parameters “m” and “ma” are taken to be the total mass and the total angular momentum of the rotating object, respectively, (so that “a” represents the angular momentum per unit mass). 4.3 Axially Symmetric Stationary Space–Time Domains 323 The linear approximation (linear in 1=r) of the metric (4.133) is provided by 1 2m C0 2 .dr/2 C r 2 .d/2 C r 2 sin2 .d'/2 ds 2 D 1 C r r 1 2m 4am 1 C0 2 sin2 C 0 2 .dt/2 d' dt: 1 r r r r (4.135) This approximate solution was considered long before the exact metric of Kerr was discovered. (Originally, this approximate metric was studied by Lense and Thirring [165] and others [39].) There are some interesting physical consequences of the metric in (4.135). Some of these are listed in the following: (i) The bending of light rays around the rotating sun are slightly asymmetric about two opposite sides. (See [46].) (ii) The orbital plane of a planet shifts very slowly. The actual nodal shift of the planet Venus was originally thought not to be totally explained by (4.135). (See [84].) However, more refined calculations and analysis of more accurate data seem to indicate that the observed value is within experimental agreement with general relativity [81, 139, 211]. (iii) An artificial satellite orbiting around the Earth can experimentally verify the time dilatation inherent in (4.135) [47]. In fact, modern Global Positioning Systems (G.P.S.) exploit (4.135)! (See [9].) (iv) The dragging of inertial frames is a consequence of (4.135). Einstein has commented: “ . . . Mach was on the right road in his thought that inertia depends on a mutual action of matter. . . A rotating hollow body must generate inside of itself a “Coriolis field,” which deflects bodies in the sense of rotation, . . . ” [89]. Now, we shall touch upon briefly the charged version of the Kerr solution. It is known as the Kerr-Newman solution [193] and is furnished by ds 2 D ˙.r; / .dr/2 C .d/2 C .r 2 C a2 / sin2 .d'/2 Q .r/ 2 2mr e 2 a sin2 d' dt I .dt/ C ˙.r; / 2 ˙.r; / WD r 2 C a2 cos2 ; Q .r/ WD r 2 2mr C a2 C e 2 ; er a sin2 d' dt ; Ai ./ dx D ˙.r; / i (4.136) 324 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains where e represents the charge parameter of the gravitating body. Note that in the limit e ! 0; the metric (4.136) reduces to the Kerr metric in (4.134). On the other hand, in the limit a ! 0; the Kerr–Newman metric of (4.136) goes over into the Reissner–Nordström–Jeffery metric of (3.74). A possible interior for the Kerr metric was originally investigated by Hogan [134]. However, junction conditions were not satisfied. Others are summarized in [40]. We explore now the same problem in the cylindrical coordinates of (4.111ii). We write the interior metric in a slightly modified form as 1 ˚ ds 2 D W.%; z/ N.%; z/ .d%/2 C .dz/2 C e2ˇ.%;z/ .d'/2 W./ Œ˛.%; z/ d' C dt2 I W.%; z/ > 0; (4.137i) N.%; z/ > 0I (4.137ii) D.2/ WD f.%; z/ W 0 < %1 % < b.z/; z1 < z < z2 g : (4.137iii) Here, % D b.z/ denotes the exterior, differentiable, boundary curve of the axially symmetric body, projected onto the % z coordinate plane. We choose for the material body an axially symmetric, deformable solid. (See (2.270).) The axially symmetric stress components ˛ˇ ./ and material current components s˛ ./ satisfy 13 ./ D 23 ./ 0; s1 ./ D s2 ./ 0: (4.138) Denoting the mass density by Q .%; z/; we can express the nonzero components of the energy–momentum–stress tensor as T11 ./ D 11 ./; T22 ./ D 22 ./; T12 ./ D 12 ./; T33 ./ D 1 ˛ W2 e2ˇ 33 C ˛ s3 C ˛ 2 W2 Q C N 1 .11 C 22 / ; T34 ./ D .1=2/ s3 C ˛ W2 Q C N 1 .11 C 22 / C e2ˇ 33 ; T44 ./ D W2 Q C N 1 .11 C 22 / C e2ˇ 33 : (4.139) (The above linear combination will be explained clearly in the next section.) 4.3 Axially Symmetric Stationary Space–Time Domains 325 The nontrivial interior field equation (2.161i) for metric (4.137i) and the energy– momentum–stress tensor components in (4.139) are furnished as follows: @2 @2 ˇ C .@2 ˇ/2 C N 1 =2 .@1 ˇ @1 N @2 ˇ @2 N / i h C W2 =4 .@1 W/2 .@2 W/2 i h C W2 =4 e2ˇ .@1 ˛/2 .@2 ˛/2 D 11 ; (4.140i) @1 @1 ˇ C @2 @2 ˇ C .@1 ˇ/2 C .@2 ˇ/2 D .11 C 22 / ; (4.140ii) 1 @1 @2 ˇ C @1 ˇ @2 ˇ N =2 .@1 ˇ @2 N C @2 ˇ @1 N / C W2 =2 @1 W @2 W W2 =2 e2ˇ @1 ˇ @2 ˇ D 12 ; (4.140iii) i nh 1 2ˇ N =2 e N 1 .@1 @1 N C @2 @2 N / N 2 .@1 N /2 C .@2 N /2 i h C W2 =2 .@1 W/2 C .@2 W/2 io h C W2 =2 e2ˇ .@1 ˛/2 C .@2 ˛/2 D 33 ; (4.140iv) n N 1 eˇ @1 eˇ W1 @1 W C @2 eˇ W1 @2 W io h C W2 eˇ .@1 ˛/2 C .@2 ˛/2 D Q; ˚ N 1 eˇ @1 W2 eˇ @1 ˛ C @2 W2 eˇ @2 ˛ D e2ˇ s3 : (4.140v) (4.140vi) The nontrivial conservation equation (2.166i) reduces to Q @1 .ln W/ D 2N 1 eˇ @1 eˇ 11 C @2 eˇ 21 C @1 N 1 .11 C 22 / C e2ˇ @1 ˛ s3 ; Q @2 .ln W/ D 2N 1 eˇ @1 eˇ 12 C @2 eˇ 22 C @2 N 1 .11 C 22 / C e2ˇ @2 ˛ s3 ; (4.141i) (4.141ii) The above equations represent the equilibrium of an axially symmetric, rotating, solid body in general relativity. 326 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains Let us represent the Kerr metric of (4.131) as ˚ ds 2 D ŒW0 1 N0 .d%/2 C .dz/2 C %2 .d'/2 ŒW0 Œdt C " ˛0 d'2 I .1 "2 / .A C B/2 C "2 .A B/2 4m2 .1 "2 / W0 ./ WD ; .1 "2 / .A C B C 2m/2 C "2 .A B/2 .1 "2 / .A C B/2 C "2 .A B/2 4m2 .1 "2 / N0 ./ WD ; 4.1 "2 / A B ( ) " .A C B C 2m/ 4m2 .1 "2 / .A B/2 "˛0 ./ WD ; .1 "2 / .A C B/2 C "2 .A B/2 4m2 .1 "2 / " WD .a=m/ D q: (4.142) We choose the parameter j"j to be a sufficiently small, positive number. Therefore, the body is assumed to rotate very slowly. Consider the interior metric: ˚ 1 n ds 2 D W0 ./ C Œb.z/ %n W# ./ N0 ./ C j"1 j .b.z/ %/n1 N # ./ o .d%/2 C .dz/2 C %2 exp 2j"2 j .b.z/ %/n2 ˇ # ./ .d'/2 ˚ W0 ./ C Œb.z/ %n W# ./ ˚ 2 dt C " ˛0 ./ C "3 .b.z/ %/n3 ˛ # ./ d' ; D.2/ WD f.%; z/ W 0 b0 .z/ < % < b.z/; z1 < z < z2 g : (4.143) j We denote by C .%; z/ 2 D.2/ I R the set of all real-valued functions possessing continuous and bounded partial derivatives up to and including the order j 1: Now, we are in a position to state and prove a theorem about a slowly rotating, deformable, solid shell, joined very smoothly across a prescribed external boundary to the vacuum Kerr metric. Theorem 4.3.2. Let the functions b; W# ; N # ; ˇ # ; and ˛ # appearing in metric 3 (4.143) belong to the class C D.2/ R2 I R : Moreover, let W0 ./ C Œb.z/ %n W# ./ > 0, and N0 ./ C j"1 j Œb.z/ %n1 N # ./ > 0: Furthermore, let positive integers n 4; n1 4; n2 4; and n3 4: Also, let positive numbers j"j; j"1 j; and j"3 j be sufficiently small. Let the interior field equation (2.161i) be satisfied with the metric in (4.143) in the domain D WD D.2/ .; / R by defining Tij ./ WD 1 Gij : Then, interior metric (4.143) joins continuously to the Kerr metric across the exterior boundary % D b.z/: Moreover, Synge’s junction conditions (2.170) and the I–S–L–D junction conditions (2.171) are satisfied on the exterior boundary. 4.3 Axially Symmetric Stationary Space–Time Domains 327 Proof. It is clear that the interior field equations (4.140i–vi) (and equilibrium conditions (4.141i,ii)) are satisfied. From the structure of the interior metric (4.143), it follows that the interior metric components and their partial derivatives (up to and including the third order) join continuously across the external boundary to those of the Kerr metric. Thus, the junction conditions are automatically satisfied. Remarks: (i) By the Riemann mapping theorem of complex analysis [191], the boundary % D b.z/ can always be mapped into a circular arc. (ii) By choosing sufficiently small positive numbers j"j; j"1 j; j"2 j; and j"4 j; the energy–momentum–stress tensor matrix Tij ./ becomes diagonalizable. (Consult Problem # 7 of Exercise 4.3.) 3 (iii) Since W# ; N # ; ˇ # ; and ˛ # are arbitrary functions of class C ./; the metric (4.143) provides a class of infinitely many interior solutions. (iv) The behavior of the metric in (4.143) on and inside the inner boundary % D b0 .z/ needs further investigations. p Example 4.3.3. Consider the external, circular boundary % D 1 z2 , jzj < 1. It generates a spherically symmetric solid body in the three-dimensional coordinate space. Let us choose positive integers as n D n1 D n2 D n3 D 4: Moreover, choose for small positive numbers as j"j D j"1 j D j"3 j D .1=9/: Furthermore, let the total mass be m D 1: Now, we choose the auxiliary functions as N # .%; z/ WD sech % C z2 ; ˇ # ./ WD tanh2 .% z/ ; ˛ # ./ WD tanh %2 z2 ; i h ıp %2 C z2 1 exp 1 W# ./ WD W0 ./ : i4 hp 1 z2 % The corresponding p metric in (4.143) joins very smoothly with the Kerr metric on the boundary % D 1 z2 : Moreover, in the interior vicinity of the boundary, the energy–momentum–stress tensor behaves regularly. Exercise 4.3 1. Let the functions !.%; z/; .%; z/; and F .%; z/ solve axially symmetric vacuum field equations (4.118i–iii). Prove that functions !.%; z/; .%; z/; and F # .%; z/ WD ŒF .%; z/1 also solve the same field equations. (Compare with the Example 4.2.1.) 2. Consider an analog of the complex, second-order, semilinear p.d.e. (4.120iii). Let it be furnished by 328 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains i 1 h r 2 W D 2W W 2 1 .@1 W/2 C .@2 W/2 : Show that a general class of exact, analytic solutions of the equation above is furnished by 2 W.%; z/ WD tanh 4 Z 3 f .z C i% cos / d 5 : 0 (Here, f is an arbitrary, holomorphic function of the complex variable z C i% cos :) 3. Consider the Kerr metric in (4.133). By investigating timelike geodesics (with proper time parameter), obtain the following first integrals: 1 " ) # ( 2 2mr 2amr sin ut C 2 u' ˇ D E D const.I r 2 Ca2 cos2 r 2mrCa2 cos2 ˇ r 2 2mr C a2 cos2 r 2 C a2 cos2 1 r 2 2mr C a2 sin2 u' ˇˇ 2amr sin2 ˇ E D const. r 2 2mr C a2 cos2 ˇ (Compare the above with (3.17i,ii).) 4. Consider the prolate spheroidal coordinate chart in (4.121). Prove that the Kerr metric of (4.131) transforms into 3 2 p 2 ( h i m2 a 2 x C m C a 2 y 2 2 7 6 2 2 2 2 2 2 ds D 4 x m a C a y m 5 .m2 a2 / x 2 C a2 y 2 m2 ) 2 2 .dx/2 .dy/2 2 2 2 C C m a x 1 1 y .d'/ .x 2 1/ .1 y 2 / 2 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 6 m a x Ca y m 7 4 p 5 2 m2 a 2 x C m C a 2 y 2 92 8 2 p 3 = < m2 a 2 x C m 1 y 2 2am 5 d' : dt C 4 ; : .m2 a2 / x 2 C a2 y 2 m2 4.3 Axially Symmetric Stationary Space–Time Domains 329 5. Consider the Ernst equation (4.123). Show explicitly that the Tomimatsu–Sato solution [239] 2 p .x 4 1/ 2ipqxy .x 2 y 2 / C q 2 .y 4 1/ b .x; y/ WD ; 2px .x 2 1/ 2iqy .1 y 2 / with p 2 C q 2 D 1; exactly solves the Ernst equation. 6. Consider the Kerr metric in the Boyer–Lindquist coordinate chart as given in (4.134). In the limit m ! 0C ; (which goes beyond the original domains of consideration), the metric reduces to the regular metric: 2 .dr/2 2 2 2 2 C .d/ C r 2 C a2 sin2 .d'/2 .dt/2 : ds D r C a cos 2 2 .r C a / Verify that the above metric yields a flat space–time domain. p 7. Consider the interior metric of (4.143) with the external boundary % D 1 z2 ; jzj < 1: Suppose that three functions N # ; ˇ # ; and ˛ # belong to the class 3 C ./: Moreover, let positive constants j"j; j"1 j; j"2 j; and j"3 j be sufficiently n p 1 z2 % W# ./ small. Furthermore, let the function W./ WD W0 C satisfy the potential equation (4.140v) for a prescribed, very large, positive mass density Q .%; z/ : Prove that the interior energy–momentum–stress tensor, in the neighborhood of the boundary, is diagonalizable satisfying the weak energy conditions. 8. The “axially symmetric” N -dimensional .N 4/ pseudo-Riemannian metric is characterized by .dr/2 2 C .d/ C r 2 C a2 sin2 .d'/2 ds 2 D ˙.r; / # .r/ 2 2 C r 2 cos2 d ˝.N 4/ .dt/2 C .r; / dt a sin2 d' : Obtain the Ricci-flatness conditions (of Myers–Perry [188]) from the above metric as ı ˙.r; / WD r 2 C a2 cos2 ; # .r/ WD r 2 C a2 2m r N 5 ; ı .r; / WD 2m r N 5 ˙.r; / : (Remarks: (i) Compare the above problem with # 6 of Exercise 3.1. 2 (ii) Caution must be taken with the N 4-sphere line element, d ˝.N 4/ . Specifically, the angle ' does not appear in this line element. (iii) The solution above is valid for rotation in a single plane. A generalization is also available for rotation in several planes [188]. (iv) This is the higher dimensional generalization of the Kerr metric.) 330 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains Answers and Hints to Selected Exercises: 2. Define a complex potential: V.%; z/ WD arg tanh ŒW.%; z/ : The partial differential equation under consideration, which is a disguised linear equation, reduces to r 2 V D @1 @1 V C .%/1 @1 V C @2 @2 V D 0: R V.%; z/ WD 0 f .z C i% cos / d solves the axially symmetric Laplace’s equation for any arbitrary holomorphic function f of the complex variable z C i% cos : (Remark: Consult Example A2.8 of Appendix 2.) 7. Introduce another potential function: h p V .%; z/ WD ln 1 C 1 z2 % n i W# = W0 ; V ./j%Dp1z2 D 0: The potential equation (4.140v) reduces to r 2 V C .lower order/ D Q .%; z/: The above axially symmetric Poisson equation, with the boundary condition, can be solved by the method of Green’s functions [77]. Field equations (4.140ii) and (4.140vi) and the metric in (4.143) yield .11 C 22 / D 0 .j"2 j/ ; e W1 s3 D 0 ."/ : Therefore, conclude that Q C N 1 .11 C 22 / e W1 s3 > 0: Invariant eigenvalues of the energy–momentum–stress tensor are furnished by the eigenvalue equation as i h det T ij ı ij D 0; 4.4 The General Stationary Field Equations " or det " and det 331 T 11 T 12 T 21 T 22 T 33 T 34 T 43 T 44 # D 0; # D 0: Therefore, real, invariant eigenvalues are given by 2 .1/ i h p D W N 1 11 C 22 C .11 22 /2 C 4 .12 /2 ; 2 .2/ i h p D W N 1 11 C 22 .11 22 /2 C 4 .12 /2 ; 2 .3/ DW 2 .4/ DW C It is clear that Q C N 1 .11 C 22 / q Œ Q C N 1 .11 C 22 /2 e2ˇ W2 s32 C 2e2ˇ 33 ; Q C N 1 .11 C 22 / q Œ Q C N 1 .11 C 22 /2 e2ˇ W2 s32 C 2e2ˇ 33 : .4/ > 0 and, moreover, .4/ dominates .1/ ; .2/ ; and .3/ : 4.4 The General Stationary Field Equations We have investigated axially symmetric, stationary field equations in the preceding section. Now, we shall deal with the general, stationary space–time domains. The only assumption is the existence of a timelike Killing vector field. Coordinate charts exist such that the metric is expressible as ı g:: .x/ D e2w.x/ g ˛ˇ .x/ dx ˛ ˝ dx ˇ e2w.x/ a˛ .x/ dx ˛ C dx 4 ˝ aˇ .x/ dx ˇ C dx 4 332 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains ı ds 2 D e2w.x/ g ˛ˇ .x/ dx ˛ dx ˇ e2w.x/ a˛ .x/ dx ˛ C dx 4 aˇ .x/ dx ˇ C dx 4 I x 2 D R3 ; x 2 D WD D R: (4.144) The above metric clearly admits the timelike Killing vector field ı @ @x 4 in the space– time domain D WD D R: (The three-dimensional metric g:: .x/ is assumed to be positive-definite.) Consider restricted coordinate transformations: b ˛ .x/; b x˛ D X b x 4 D x4 ; b w.b x / D w.x/; b a˛ .b x / db x ˛ D a˛ .x/ dx ˛ ; etc. (4.145i) The line element in (4.144) goes over into Ob x/ Ob x/ ds 2 D e2w. aˇ .Ox/ db b g ˛ˇ .b x / db x ˛ db x ˇ e2w. b a˛ .Ox/ db x ˛ C db x4 b x ˇ C db x4 : However, under another restricted transformation, x 0˛ D x ˛ ; x 04 D x 4 C .x/; a˛0 .x0 / D a˛ .x/ @˛ : (4.145ii) The line element in (4.144) goes over into i h 0 ı 0 ds 2 D e2w.x / g ˛ˇ .x0 / dx 0˛ dx 0ˇ e2w.x / a˛0 dx 0˛ dx 04 aˇ0 .x0 / dx 0ˇ dx 04 : (In both of the transformations (4.145i) and (4.145ii), the stationary form of the metric in (4.144) is preserved. The transformation (4.145ii) is reminiscent of the gauge transformation (1.71ii) of the electromagnetic 4 potential.) In the sequel, we adopt the notations ı ı a ˛ .x/ WD g ˛ˇ .x/ aˇ .x/; etc.; fˇ˛ .x/ WD @ˇ a˛ @˛ aˇ f˛ˇ .x/: (4.146i) (4.146ii) 4.4 The General Stationary Field Equations 333 The vacuum field equations in (2.169) reduce to ı ı ı ı G .x/ C 2 r w r w .1=2/ g C .1=2/ e 4w ı f ı ı r 2 w C .1=4/ e4w f ı ı 4w r e f D 0; ı r f ı ı ˛ ˛ˇ ı g ˛ˇ r˛ w rˇ w ı ı f˛ C .1=4/ g f ˛ˇ f˛ˇ D 0; f˛ˇ D 0; (4.147i) (4.147ii) (4.147iii) ı C r f C r f ı ı ı 0: (4.147iv) ı (Here, r 2 w WD r ˛ r ˛ w:) The above equations are actually three-dimensional tensor field equations derivable from the Lagrangian density in (4.165). These equations are covariant under restricted coordinate transformations q in (4.145i). ı ı Defining ˛ .x/ WD .1=2/ e4w g "˛ˇ f ˇ ; it can be shown from (4.147iii), (1.61), and Theorem 1.2.21 that ˛ .x/ D @˛ for some function .x/ called the twist potential. With the help of .x/; field equations (4.147i–iv) reduce to ı ı ı ı G .x/ C 2 r w r w .1=2/ g ı ı r .1=2/ g ı ı g ˛ˇ r˛ w rˇ w ı C .1=2/ e4w r ı ı ı ı ı ı ı g ˛ˇ r˛ r ˇ D 0; (4.148i) ı r 2 w C .1=2/ e4w g ˛ˇ r˛ rˇ D 0; ı ı ı ı r 2 4 g ˛ˇ r˛ w rˇ D 0: (4.148ii) (4.148iii) (In case .x/ const.; the equations above reduce to the general static, vacuum field equations (4.40i,ii) with .x/ 0 and T˛ˇ .x/ 0.) Next, we define a complex potential by F .x/ WD e2w.x/ C i .x/: (4.149) (Compare with (4.117).) Using (4.149), we can express field equations (4.148i–iii) as ı ı ı ı ı R .x/ C .1=4/ .Re F /2 r F r F C r F r F D 0; (4.150i) 334 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains ı ı r 2 F .Re F /1 g ı ı r F r F D 0: (4.150ii) (Equations (4.150i,ii) reduce to (4.118i–iii) for the axially symmetric case.) We denote antisymmetrization by AŒ WD .1=2/ A A : Field equations (4.150i) are equivalent to ı R .x/ hı .1=2/ .Re F /2 g Œ @ F @ F C @ F @ F ı C g Œ @ F @ F C @ F @ F i ı ı ı C g @ F @ F g Œ g D 0: (4.151) (The equations above are a generalization of the static, vacuum field equations (4.42i).) Now, we introduce an orthonormal triad and a corresponding directional derivatives as Ee.˛/ .x/ WD ı g .x/ @.˛/ f WD .˛/ .x/ .˛/ .x/ .˛/ .x/ @ ; @x .ˇ/ .x/ D ı.˛/.ˇ/ ; @f : @x (4.152) (These equations are identical to (4.100i–iii)!) The corresponding Ricci rotation coefficients and orthonormal curvature tensor components are furnished in (4.102) and (4.103). Thus, stationary field equations (4.151) and (4.150ii) go over into ı h .1=2/ .Re F /2 ı .˛/Œ. / @.ı/ F @.ˇ/ F C @.ı/ F @.ˇ/ F C ı .ˇ/Œ.ı/ @. / F @.˛/ F C @. / F @.˛/ F i (4.153i) C ı . /. / @. / F @. / F ı .˛/Œ.ı/ ı . /.ˇ/ D 0; h i .ı/ ı .˛/.ˇ/ @.˛/ @.ˇ/ F C .ˇ/.˛/ @.ı/ F R.˛/.ˇ/. /.ı/ .x/ .Re F /1 ı .˛/.ˇ/ @.˛/ F @.ˇ/ F D 0: (4.153ii) The above field equations are generalizations of static field equations (4.105) and (4.104). 4.4 The General Stationary Field Equations 335 The stationary vacuum field equations (4.148i–iii) are analogous to the static, electro-vac equations (4.67i–iii) (and static magneto-vac equations (4.83ii–iv)). Therefore, for a special class of exact solutions, we assume a functional relationship: e2w.x/ D f Œ .x/ > 0; f 0 WD df Œ ¤ 0: d (4.154) Thus, (4.148iii) and (4.148ii) reduce, respectively, to ı ı r 2 2 g ˛ˇ f 1 f 0 @˛ @ˇ D 0; 00 ı 1 f f0 ı 2 C g ˛ˇ @˛ @ˇ D 0: r C f0 f ff 0 (4.155i) (4.155ii) Subtracting (4.155i) from (4.155ii) and assuming @˛ 6 0; we derive that 1 f0 f 00 C C D 0: 0 f f ff 0 (4.156) The general solution of the second-order o.d.e. above is furnished by Œf . /2 D c0 C 2c1 2 D c0 C c12 . c1 /2 > 0; e4w.x/ D c0 C 2c1 .x/ Œ .x/2 : (4.157) Here, c0 and c1 are constants of integration satisfying c0 C c12 > 0: Assuming the functional relationship (4.157), let us try to solve stationary field equations (4.148i–iii). For that purpose, we define Z h. / WD k k WD q d Œc0 C 2c1 2 c0 C c12 > 0: ; (4.158) (Compare the equation above with (4.35i).) We infer from (4.158) and (4.157) that .x/ WD hŒ .x/; .x/ D c1 C k tanh Œ .x/ ; e2w.x/ D k sech Œ .x/ : (4.159) 336 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains Therefore, field equations (4.148i–iii) reduce to ı R .x/ C .1=2/ @ @ D 0; ı r 2 D 0: (4.160) These equations are equivalent to the static, vacuum field equations (4.41i,ii) for the metric: 2 ı ds 2 D e.x/ g ˛ˇ .x/ dx ˛ dx ˇ e.x/ dx 4 : (4.161) Thus, the static vacuum metric (4.161) can generate the stationary vacuum metric: ı ds 2 D k 1 Œcosh .x/ g ˛ˇ .x/ dx ˛ dx ˇ k Œsech .x/ a˛ .x/ dx ˛ C dx 4 aˇ .x/ dx ˇ C dx 4 : (4.162) This derivation is possible, provided we can solve4 the linear, first-order system of p.d.e.s: ı ı @˛ aˇ @ˇ a˛ D k 1 ˛ˇ r : (4.163) The class of exact, stationary vacuum solutions in (4.162) is called the PapapetrouEhlers class. Example 4.4.1. Consider the static metric (3.9) of Schwarzschild, namely, ds 2 D 1 2m r 1 1 2m r ˚ .dr/2 C .r 2 2mr/ .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 .dt/2 2 ı DW e./ g ./ .dx dx / e./ dx 4 : Therefore, we derive that q ı g D r 2 2mr sin ; 2m ; r " 1 2m cosh .r/ D 1 2 r .r/ D ln 1 4 2m C 1 r The solution technique for (4.163) is explained in [149]. 1 # : 4.4 The General Stationary Field Equations 337 Equation (4.163) yields (with a1 ./ D a2 ./ 0) ı @2 a3 0 D k 1 231 @1 D k 1 2m sin ; a3 ./ D .2m=k/ cos C const. or (We ignore the above constant of integration in the sequel.) Thus, from (4.162), we deduce a particular example of the Papapetrou-Ehlers class of stationary metrics as " ds D .2k/ 2 1 2m C 1 r 2m 1 r 1 # ˚ .dr/2 C .r 2 2mr/ .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 " .2k/ 2m 1 r 2m C 1 r # 1 1 Œdt .2m=k/ cos d'2 ; D WD f.r; ; '; t/ W 0 < 2m < r; 0 < < ; < ' < ; 1 < t < 1g : We should mention that the Papapetrou-Ehlers class of solutions can involve “exotic sources.” This is because, for this class, either the “total mass” is zero, or there exist wire (or string) singularities. (See Problem #4ii of Exercise 4.4.) Now, consider the quadratic function of in (4.157). Let us try to pursue the Majumdar-Papapetrou “perfect square” condition in (4.73i) for (4.157). If we set k 2 D c0 C c12 D 0 in (4.157), then we obtain e4w D . c1 /2 < 0: But this condition is impossible in the realm of real numbers. However, in case the four-dimensional differential manifold is a positive-definite Riemannian manifold, such exact solutions are mathematically viable. Such solutions can give rise to gravitational instantons, to be discussed in Appendix 7. (These solutions are important for some approaches to quantum gravity, as well as in some aspects of cosmology [127].) Now, we shall explore an exact solution of the stationary field equations (4.153i,ii) employing an orthonormal triad. Example 4.4.2. Consider the three-dimensional metric furnished by 2 ı g:: .x/ WD x 1 ı .dx ˝ dx / I x 1 > 1; k D 1; e./ D .x 1 /2 : 338 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains The natural orthonormal triad and directional derivatives are provided by 1 @ Ee.˛/ .x/ D x 1 ˛; @x 1 1 @f ˛: @.˛/ f D x @x (See (4.106i–iii) and (4.107).) The nonvanishing Ricci rotation coefficients are given by 2 D x1 > 0; 1 2 n.x/ WD .1/.3/.3/.x/ D x > 0: b.x/ WD .1/.2/.2/ .x/ A particular, orthonormal component of the curvature tensor is provided by ı 1 2 R.1/.2/.2/.1/./ D x 1 @1 b C b.x 1 / C 0 4 : D x1 Let us choose the complex potential as h 8 i9 < 2 i x 1 2 x 1 2 = h i F .x 1 / WD : ; : .x 1 /2 C .x 1 /2 Then, n .1=2/ ŒRe.F /2 ı .1/Œ.2/ @.1/ F @.2/ F C @.1/ F @.2/ F C ı .2/Œ.1/ @.2/ F @.1/ F C @.2/ F @.1/ F o @.1/ F @.1/ F ı .1/Œ.1/ ı .2/.2/ D 1 8 1 2 2 2 6 x1 4 4 D x1 : h x1 16 .x 1 /2 ! 2 2 i2 C x1 0 B @ 4C 1 2 1 2 x x .x 1 /2 C .x 1 /2 4 2 13 C7 A5 4.4 The General Stationary Field Equations 339 Therefore, among the field equations in (4.153i), this particular one vanishes, namely, ı R.1/.2/.2/.1/./ . / D 0: Similarly, all other field equations are satisfied. The corresponding four-dimensional metric is furnished by ds 2 D h 2 2 i1 4 i 1h ı .dx dx / 2 x 1 C x 1 1 C x1 2 2 dx 4 C .x 3 dx 2 x 2 dx 3 / : The above metric is of the Papapetrou-Ehlers class, which is generated from the static, Kasner metric in Example 4.2.1. Now, we shall investigate variational derivations of stationary field equations (4.148i–iii) and (4.150i,ii). We need to use the variational equation (A1.20i) of Appendix 1. The appropriate Lagrangian is furnished by q ı ı ˛ˇ ı 4w @˛ @ˇ g .x/ g L./j:: D R˛ˇ .x/ C 2 @˛ w @ˇ w C .1=2/e q ı ı ı D R˛ˇ .x/ C .1=2/ .Re F /2 @˛ F @ˇ F g ˛ˇ .x/ g: (4.164) (The above Lagrangian is a generalization of the static Lagrangian in (4.43ii).5) Now, we inquire how the reduced action integral corresponding to (4.164) is deduced from the original Einstein–Hilbert action integral corresponding to (A1.25). Using the stationary metric in (4.144), the Einstein–Hilbert action integral reduces to Z Z hı ı ı ı ı p 4 R.x/ g d x D .t2 t1 / R.x/ C 2 r˛ w r ˛ w 2 r˛ r ˛ w D D.t1 ;t2 / i qı ı .1=4/ e4w f˛ˇ .x/ f ˛ˇ .x/ g d3 x q Z ı ı ı ı ı ˛ 4w ˛ˇ R.x/ C 2 r˛ w r w .1=4/ e f˛ˇ .x/ f .x/ g d3 x D .const./ D C boundary terms. 5 (4.165) We use the following variational formula for the N -dimensional, pseudo-Riemannian manifold: p p jgj g ij D jgj ıg ij 12 gkl g ij ı.g kl / . ı 340 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains Now, field equation (4.147iii) has been solved to obtain ı ı f˛ˇ .x/ D e4w.x/ ˛ˇ r : (4.166) (Here, .x/ is the twist potential.) We refer to Routh’s Theorem 3.1.3 on the reduction of a Lagrangian in case of a cyclic or ignorable coordinate. Similarly, a Lagrangian for partial differential equations admits reductions in case some of the field equations are solved. (See [65].) The reduced Lagrangian from (4.164) and (4.166) is provided by the use of the Legendre transformation of Example A2.4 as @L./ L./ D L./ f˛ˇ ./ ˇ @f˛ˇ ˇf˛ˇ De4w ı ˛ˇ ı r ı ı 4w D R˛ˇ .x/ C 2 @˛ w @ˇ w C .1=2/ e @˛ @ˇ g ˛ˇ .x/ ı ı D R˛ˇ .x/ C .1=2/ .Re F /2 @˛ F @ˇ F g ˛ˇ .x/: (4.167) Thus, we have recovered the Lagrangian’s in (4.164) from the original Einstein– Hilbert Lagrangian. The “potential manifold,” inherent in the Lagrangian (4.167), induces the metric: d ˙ 2 D .Re F /2 dF dF D W2 .d W/2 C .d /2 ; W WD e2w > 0: (4.168) It represents a non-Euclidean (Riemannian) surface of constant negative curvature. The metric in the above equation is attributable to Poincaré. Obviously, @@ is a Killing vector field. Now, we shall explore the group of transformations which leave (4.168) invariant. Theorem 4.4.3. Let stationary field equations (4.150i,ii) hold in a regular domain ı D R3 : Moreover, let the metric field g:: .x/ and the complex potential F .x/ belong to the class C 3 .D/: Let h.F / be a differentiable function that preserves solutions in (4.150i,ii). (i) If, furthermore, h.F / is holomorphic, then h.F / D aF C ib icF C d such that real constants a; b; and d satisfy ad C bc > 0: 4.4 The General Stationary Field Equations 341 (ii) On the other hand, if h is a conjugate holomorphic function, then " h./ D aF C ib # with icF C d ad C bc > 0 (iii) In case f is neither holomorphic, nor non-conjugate-holomorphic, there does not exist any such non-constant-valued f: Proof. For part (i), we have to integrate the nonlinear, first-order differential equation: h0 .F / h0 .F / 1 h 2 : i2 D F CF h./ C h./ (Consult (A2.38), (A2.39i,ii), and (A2.41) of Appendix 2.) Integrating with respect to the complex variable F ; we obtain h h0 .F / h.F / C h.F / iD 1 F CF 0 C ln K.F / : Here, K is an arbitrary holomorphic function. Integrating with respect to F; we conclude that F C F K.F / G.F / D h.F / C h.F /: Here, G.F / is an arbitrary conjugate-holomorphic function. Since h.F / C h.F / is real, we conclude that G.F / D cK.F O / where cO ¤ 0 is a real constant. Now, differentiating with respect to F and then F ; we derive that K.F / K.F / D F C 0 D i dO D imaginary const. FC 0 K .F / K .F / Thus, we deduce that ŒK.F /1 K 0 .F / D .ib d F /1 ; K.F / D ˛0 ŒF ib d 1 ; h.F / C h.F / D b c j˛0 j2 jF C F j jF ib d j2 n o Db c j˛0 j2 .F ib d /1 C .F C ib d /1 ; aF C ib ; or, h.F / D i cF C d ad C bc > 0: 342 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains (ii) The proof of this part is exactly similar to that of part (i). (iii) For the proof of this part, we refer to [149] . Remarks: (i) In complex analysis, the set of all Möbius conformal transformations, ˛F C ˇ ; ˛ı ˇ ¤ 0; h.F / WD F Cı forms a group isomorphic to GL .2; C/: The transformations derived in Theorem 4.4.3 constitute a subgroup of the Möbius group [191]. (ii) These transformations can generate new exact solutions from the old ones. (Compare with Example 4.2.1 in the static case.) Now, we shall deal with the stationary case of the Einstein–Maxwell equations (or electromagneto-vac equations) of (2.290i–iii). For this, we adopt the general stationary metric (4.144). The electromagnetic field tensor can be adapted to the Killing vector @x@ 4 so that @4 Fij 0: It has been proved that in such a scenario [65], there exist two potentials A and B so that F˛4 .x/ D @˛ A; (4.169i) ı ı F˛ˇ .x/ D e2w ˛ˇ r B: (4.169ii) We introduce the complex electromagnetic potential by ˚.x/ WD A.x/ C i B.x/: (4.170) Now, we define two three-dimensional vector fields by ı ˛ .x/ WD .1=2/ e4w ˛ˇ fˇ ; ˛ .x/ WD ˛ .x/ C i . =2/ ˚ @˛ ˚ ˚ @˛ ˚ : (4.171i) (4.171ii) Equation E ˛4 D 0 in (2.290iv) implies the existence of the twist potential .x/ such that ˛ .x/ D @˛ : (4.172) Now, we introduce the complex gravo-electromagnetic potential by: .x/ WD e2w.x/ . =2/ j˚.x/j2 C i .x/: (4.173) The nontrivial, stationary electromagneto-vac equations reduce to [65] ı R˛ˇ .x/ C .1=2/ e4w Re @˛ C ˚ @˛ ˚ @ˇ C ˚ @˛ ˚ (4.174i) e2w Re @˛ ˚ @ˇ ˚ D 0; 4.4 The General Stationary Field Equations 343 ı ı r 2 e2w g ˛ˇ @˛ @ˇ C ˚ @ˇ ˚ D 0; (4.174ii) ı ı r 2 ˚ e2w g ˛ˇ @˛ ˚ @ˇ C ˚ @ˇ ˚ D 0: (4.174iii) Example 4.4.4. We shall try to derive a special class of solutions of the system of field equations in (4.174i–iii). We assume a linear, functional relationship [142, 208]: .x/ D ˚.x/ C ı: (4.175) Here, ¤ 0 and ı are some complex constants. The assumption (4.175) reduces both (4.174ii,iii) into ı r 2 ˚ e2w ı C ˚ g ˛ˇ @˛ ˚ @ˇ ˚ D 0: (4.176) Moreover, field equations (4.174i) imply that i h ı R˛ˇ .x/ C .1=2/ e4w j C ˚j2 e2w Œ D 0: Choosing e 2w.x/ r ˇ2 ˇ ˇ ˇ ˇ ˚.x/ˇˇ ; D ˇp C 2 2 ı (4.177) (4.178) ı we obtain that R˛ˇ .x/ 0: Thus, the metric g:: .x/ is flat. Introducing another complex potential by W.x/ WD p 2 Œ C ˚.x/1 ; (4.179) the equation (4.177) boils down to the Euclidean-Laplace’s equation: ı r 2 W D r 2 W D 0: (4.180) ı (Here, we have used a Cartesian coordinate chart so that g ˛ˇ .x/ D ı˛ˇ :) To obtain the full metric, we need to satisfy the linear system: h i E aE D curl aE D i W rW E W rW E r : (4.181) The integrability of above equations requires W 1 r 2 W D W 1 r 2 W: (4.182) This class of exact solutions represents the case of many spinning, charged bodies. However, wire or string singularities may be present. (See # 4(ii) of Exercise 4.4.) 344 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains This class of stationary solutions was discovered by Neugebaur [192], Perjes [208], and Israel–Wilson [142], (or N–P–I–W). These are generalizations of the Majumdar-Papapetrou solutions of (4.74). We shall now define a conformastationary metric by 2 ds 2 D ŒU.x/4 ı .dx dx / e2w.x/ a˛ .x/ dx ˛ C dx 4 ; U.x/ ¤ 0 for x 2 D R3 : (4.183) (It is the stationary generalization of the conformastat metric in (4.55).) The N–P–I– W solutions of the preceding Example 4.4.4 constitute a class of conformastationary metrics (emerging out of the Einstein–Maxwell field equations). Now, we propose to furnish stationary field equations inside a material continuum. We use the general stationary metric in (4.144). Moreover, we generate ten physically relevant material tensor components of continuum mechanics out of the ten components of Tij ./: These are provided by .x/ WD T .x/ a .x/ a .x/ T44 .x/ C a .x/ T4 .x/ C a .x/ T 4 .x/ .x/; s .x/ WD 2 T 4 .x/ a .x/ T44 .x/ ; (4.184i) (4.184ii) i h ı Q .x/ WD e4w.x/ C a .x/ a .x/ T44 .x/ ı ı C g .x/ T .x/ 2a .x/ T 4 .x/: (4.184iii) Here, Q .x/; s .x/; and .x/ represent respectively the mass density, the material current density, and stress components of a deformable solid body. (Caution: is different from the rate of strain tensor ij in (2.199v).) (Compare with the corresponding axially symmetric equation (4.139).) The interior field equation (2.161i) in the stationary arena yields the following: h ı ı G .x/ C 2 @ w @ w .1=2/ g ı 4wı C e 2 f ˛ i ı g ˛ˇ @˛ w @ˇ w f˛ C .1=4/ g ı ı r e4w f ı ı ı r 2 w C e4w 4 f ı ı f ˛ˇ f˛ˇ D .x/; (4.185i) D s .x/; f D . =2/ Q .x/: (These equations are generalizations of static equations (4.40i–iii).) (4.185ii) (4.185iii) 4.4 The General Stationary Field Equations 345 The conservation equation (2.166i) leads to ı ı Q .x/ r w C r ı C .1=2/ s .x/ f .x/ D 0: (4.186) The equations above have direct physical interpretations. Consider the three terms in the left-hand side of the equations in (4.186). The first term corresponds to the “gravitational force density.” The second term stands for the elastic force density. The third term indicates the “gravo-magnetic force density.” Therefore, (4.186) represents general relativistic equilibrium conditions for a deformable solid body in a state of steady motion. These equations are consequences of the Einstein’s field equations. We have now completed investigations of the stationary field equations of general relativity. In closing, we want to emphasize that the whole of this chapter deals only with local solutions of Einstein’s field equations. Exercise 4.4 1. Consider the stationary metric of (4.144): ı (i) Express det gij in terms of g ˛ˇ ; a˛ ; w etc. ı (ii) Express components g ij ./ in terms of g ˛ˇ ; a˛ ; w etc. 2. Examine stationary vacuum field equations (4.147i–iii). Let the function w.x/ attain the minimum at an interior point x0 2 D: Then, prove that the curvature tensor R .x/ D O .x/ for all x 2 D R: ı 3. Consider the three-dimensional invariant eigenvalue problem det R.˛/.ˇ/ .x/ .x/ ı.˛/.ˇ/ D 0 in a domain D where vacuum field equations (4.150i,ii) hold. Show that real, invariant eigenvalues are furnished by .1/ .x/ 0; .2/ .x/ D .1=4/ .Re F /2 ı .˛/.ˇ/ @.˛/ F @.ˇ/ F C j@.˛/ F @.ˇ/ F j 0; .3/ .x/ h D .1=4/ .Re F /2 ı .˛/.ˇ/ @.˛/ F @.ˇ/ F i jı .˛/.ˇ/ @.˛/ F @.ˇ/ F j 0: 346 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains 4. Investigate the Papapetrou-Ehlers class of stationary metrics given by (4.162): (i) Prove that in case the invariant eigenvalue .3/ .x/ of the preceding example is identically zero, the metric must be of the Papapetrou-Ehlers q class. R ı2 ı (ii) Moreover, the total mass defined by the integral D .r / g d3 x must either vanish, or else, there must exist a wire singularity. 5. Obtain every nonflat, stationary vacuum metric which is both conformastationary and of the Papapetrou-Ehlers class. 6. Consider the system of second-order, semilinear partial differential equation (4.150i): q ı ı (i) In case a harmonic coordinate chart is used (so that @ Œ g g D 0), show that the system is elliptic. (ii) In case an orthogonal coordinate chart is used, prove that the subsystem ı ı ı R12 ./ C ./ D R23 ./ C ./ D R31 ./ C ./ D 0 is hyperbolic. 7. Consider the stationary Einstein–Maxwell equations (4.174i–iii): (i) Show that these equations are variationally derivable from the Lagrangian density: L. /j:: D ı 2 R.x/ C .1=2/ Re C . =2/ j˚j2 ı ı @˛ C ˚ @˛ ˚ r ˛ C ˚ r ˛ ˚ Re C 2 j˚j 2 1 q ı @˛ ˚ r ˚ g : ı ˛ (ii) Prove that corresponding metric of the four-dimensional potential manifold, given by 2 d˙ 2 D .1=2/ Re C. =2/ j˚j2 d C ˚ d ˚ d C ˚ d ˚ Re C 2 j˚j2 1 d˚ d˚ ; yields a four-dimensional pseudo-Riemannian manifold. (Remark: The isometry group of this space generates new solutions out of old ones. Consult the references of [65, 152].) 4.4 The General Stationary Field Equations 347 Answers and Hints to Selected Exercises: 1. ı g D e4w g. (i) (ii) ı g ˛ˇ D e2w g ˛ˇ ; ı g ˛4 D e2w a˛ ; ı g 44 D e2w C e2w a˛ a˛ : 2. The potential equation (4.147ii) implies that ı ı r 2 w D .1=4/ e4w f ˛ˇ f˛ˇ 0: Using Hopf’s Theorem 4.2.2, it follows that w.x/ is constant-valued. Therefore, ı ı by (4.147ii), f ˛ˇ f˛ˇ D 0, f˛ˇ D 0, and a˛ D @˛ . By (4.147i), G ˛ˇ D 0; ı D 0. (Consult [166].) The metric in (4.144) reduces to ds 2 D e2c 2 db x ˛ db x ˇ e2c d. ./ C x 4 / which is flat. thus, R˛ˇ ı˛ˇ ı 3. ı det R.˛/.ˇ/ ı.˛/.ˇ/ ( D 2 h i C .1=2/ .Re F /2 ı .˛/.ˇ/ @.˛/ F @.ˇ/ F 2 C .1=16/ .Re F /4 ı .˛/.ˇ/ @.˛/ F @.ˇ/ F ) ˇ ˇ2 ˇı .˛/.ˇ/ @.˛/ F @.ˇ/ F ˇ .3/ .x/ 4. (i) Note that ˚ : D 0 implies ˇ ˇ2 2 ı .˛/.ˇ/ @.˛/ F @.ˇ/ F D ı .˛/.ˇ/ ˇ@.˛/ F @.ˇ/ F ˇ : Therefore, .˛/.ˇ/ 2 ı @.˛/ .ReF / @.ˇ/ .ReF / ı . /./ 2 D ı .˛/.ˇ/ @.˛/ .ReF / @.ˇ/ .ImF / ; @. / .ImF / @./ .ImF / 2 348 4 Static and Stationary Space–Time Domains or .˛/.ˇ/ ı @.˛/ .ReF / @.ˇ/ .ReF / ı . /./ @. / .ImF / @./ .ImF / D ı .˛/.ˇ/ @.˛/ .ReF / @.ˇ/ .ImF / : By the Cauchy–Schwartz (weak) inequality in (1.94) and (1.95), it follows that the Re.F / and Im.F / are functionally related: @.˛/ .ReF / D ./ @.˛/ .ImF /; for some scalar function ./. Thus, by (4.154) and (4.157), the desired conclusion is reached. (ii) Assume that the boundary @D is a continuous, piecewise-smooth, orientable, simply connected surface so that Gauss’ Theorem 1.3.27 can be applied. The “total mass” reduces to Z ı Z ı r 2 d3 v D r ˛ n˛ d2 v @D D Z Z k ı ˛ˇ fˇ n˛ d2 v D k d a dx 2 @D @D Z Dk a dx D 0: D @2 D The last equation follows from (1.206), Stokes’ Theorem 1.2.23, and the topological fact that the boundary of a closed boundary, @D, is the null subset! The only way to avoid this conclusion is to attach a massless semiinfinite wire singularity to the material body so that there exists no closed surface enclosing the material body. 5. Use (4.64i–iii) and Example 4.4.1. There exist exactly three such metrics shown below: (i) " ds D .2k/ 2 1 2m 1 r 2m C 1 r 1 # ˚ .dr/2 C .r 2 2mr/ .d/2 C .sin /2 .d'/2 " .2k/ 2m 1 r 2m C 1 r # 1 1 Œdt .2m=k/ cos d'2 I 4.4 The General Stationary Field Equations 349 (ii) h 4 i ı ds 2 D .2k/1 1 C 1 C mx 1 .2k/ .dx dx / h 2 2 i1 2 1Cmx 1 C 1 C mx 1 dt C .m=k/ x 3 dx 2 x 2 dx 3 I (iii) " ds 2 D .2k/1 2m 1 C R 2m 1 R 1 # ˚ .dR/2 C .2mR R2 / .d /2 C .sinh /2 .d'/2 " .2k/ 2m 1 C R 2m 1 R # 1 1 Œdt .2m=k/ cosh d'2 : Chapter 5 Black Holes 5.1 Spherically Symmetric Black Holes The phenomenon of a massive body imploding into a black hole is a fascinating topic to investigate. Nowadays, the possible detection of supermassive black holes in the centers of galaxies [96,187] makes these studies extremely relevant. A historical survey and review of current research in black hole physics may be found in [72]. Investigations on black holes historically started from the Schwarzschild metric of (3.9) expressed, with slightly different notation, as 2 2 2m 2 2m 1 .db ' /2 1 db t ; ds 2 D 1 .db r /2 C b r db C sin2 b b r b r n o bWD b D r; b ; b ' ;b t W 0 < 2m < b r; 0 < b < ; < b ' < ; 1 < b t < 1 : (5.1) Clearly, some of the metric tensor components in (5.1) are undefined for b r D 2m; the Schwarzschild radius. However, the corresponding orthonormal components of the curvature tensor in (3.12) are real-analytic for 0 < b r : Therefore, the space–time geometry is completely smooth at b r D 2m; but the Schwarzschild coordinate chart is unable to cover b r D 2m: (Recall that the spherical polar coordinate chart of Example 1.1.2 cannot cover the North or the South pole.) Eddington [82], Painlevé [203], and Gullstrand [119] extended the Schwarzschild chart on and beyond the Schwarzschild radius. Eddington employed one null coordinate in his construction. (Finkelstein [100] also similarly extended the same with one null coordinate.) Lemaı̂tre [163] used the geodesic normal time coordinate (or comoving coordinates) for the extension whereas Synge [241] devised a doubly null coordinate chart to extend all the previous charts for the maximal extension of the original Schwarzschild chart. A modification of Synge’s chart was constructed independently by Kruskal [153] and Szekeres [245]. It is the commonly used chart now for the maximal extension of the Schwarzschild chart. A. Das and A. DeBenedictis, The General Theory of Relativity: A Mathematical Exposition, DOI 10.1007/978-1-4614-3658-4 5, © Springer Science+Business Media New York 2012 351 352 5 Black Holes We shall start our investigations on black holes with the Lemaı̂tre metric of (3.105), with a change of notation, given by i h 2m .dr/2 C ŒY .r; t/2 .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 .dt/2 ; Y .r; t/ h i2=3 p Y .r; t/ W D .3=2/ 2m .r t/ > 0; ds 2 D D W D f.r; ; '; t/ W 0 < r t; 0 < < ; < ' < g : (5.2) The above metric and the orthonormal components of the curvature tensor diverge in the limit .r t/ ! 0C : The transformation from a subset of the Lemaı̂tre chart to the Schwarzschild chart is furnished by b r D Y .r; t/; b ;b ' D .; '/; ˇ ˇp ˇ Y .r; t/ C p2m ˇ p p ˇ ˇ b t D t 2 2m Y .r; t/ C .2m/ ln ˇ p p ˇ; ˇ Y .r; t/ 2m ˇ Ds W D f.r; ; '; t/ W .4m=3/ < r t; 0 < < ; < ' < g ; n o bs W D b r; b ; b ' ;b t W 2m < b r; 0 < b < ; < b ' < ; b t2R ; D r @ b r ;b t 2m D > 0: @.r; t/ b r (5.3) From the sub-Jacobian above (which has the same value as the Jacobian), it is clear that the mapping is one-to-one. (Compare the transformation in (5.3) with (3.106).) Now, consider the subset: ˚ b s D .r; ; '; t/ W 0 < r t < .4m=3/; Ds0 WD D D 0 < < ; < ' < : A coordinate mapping from Ds0 onto Ds# of a T -domain chart is provided by ˇ ˇp ˇ 2m C pY .r; t/ ˇ p p ˇ ˇ R D t 2 2m Y .r; t/ C .2m/ ln ˇ p p ˇ; ˇ 2m Y .r; t/ ˇ T D Y .r; t/; (5.4) 5.1 Spherically Symmetric Black Holes 353 t r=t (singularity) 2 r − t = 4m (event horizon) 3 r Ds T Ds ^ t T=2m (event horizon) ^ Ds Ds# 2 R (singularity) T=0 ^r 2 r^ =2m (event horizon) Fig. 5.1 Qualitative picture depicting two mappings from the Lemaı̂tre chart # # ; ' D .; '/; ˚ Ds# W D R; # ; ' # ; T W R 2 R; 0 < # < ; < ' # < ; 0 < T < 2m ; r @.T; R/ 2m D < 0: @.r; t/ T (5.5) From the sub-Jacobian above, it is evident that the mapping is one-to-one. In Ds# ; the metric (5.2) goes over into (3.112), namely (in a different notation), ds 2 D h 2 2 i 2m 1 .dR/2 C T 2 d # C sin2 # d' # T 2m 1 T 1 .dT /2 : (5.6) Figure 5.1 depicts mappings (5.3) and (5.5) from the Lemaı̂tre chart into the Schwarzschild chart and the T -domain chart (with D const.; ' D const.). Let us elaborate more on the physical aspects of Fig. 5.1. There is an oriented, semi-infinite, straight line segment in the Lemaı̂tre chart. It is parallel to the t-axis. Thus, it can represent a test particle following a timelike geodesic. The segment between two solid dots is a finite interval, physically representing the finite proper time elapsed between those two events. The part of the line segment that is mapped into the Schwarzschild chart is a semi-infinite curve asymptotic to the vertical line b r D 2m: Thus, an observer in the Schwarzschild universe concludes that the test 354 5 Black Holes particle takes “ infinite coordinate time b t ” to reach b r D 2m: (But from the preimage in the Lemaı̂tre chart, it is evident that only a finite proper time is involved.) Therefore, an observer “at infinity” of the Schwarzschild space–time never sees a massive particle freely falling into the region characterized by b r 2m. Similarly, the other finite part of the line segment is mapped into a semi-infinite curve in the T -domain chart. It is asymptotic to the horizontal straight line T D 2m: The curve terminates on the R-axis where there is a singularity of the curvature tensor. The proper time along this curve is also finite. Now, we shall explore the inclined straight line r t D .4m=3/ in the Lemaı̂tre chart. It is the image of the parametrized curve: r D X 1 .˛/ WD f .˛/; D X 2 .˛/ WD 0 D const.; ' D X 3 .˛/ WD '0 D const.; t D X 4 .˛/ WD f .˛/ .4m=3/; ˛ 2 R: (5.7) It is assumed that dfd˛.˛/ exists and nonzero for ˛ 2 R: Using the Lemaı̂tre metric in (5.2), we conclude that df .˛/ dX i .˛/ dX j .˛/ D gij .X .˛// d˛ d˛ d˛ 2 C0C0 df .˛/ d˛ 2 0: Therefore, r t D .4m=3/ in the Lemaı̂tre chart represents a null hypersurface N3 : The metric (5.2) restricted to N3 yields g:: ./jN3 D .2m/2 d ˝ d C sin2 .d' ˝ d'/ : (5.8) The above equation reveals a loss of one dimension as in the null hypersurface of Example 2.1.17. This null hypersurface N3 is called an event horizon.1 We shall show later that some massive particles propagating in the Schwarzschild space–time can cross the event horizon N3 only to eventually end their journey into the ultimate singularity at r D t: Moreover, we shall demonstrate later that from the domain Ds0 in Fig. 5.1, photons pursuing null geodesics cannot come out of event horizon N3 into the external Schwarzschild universe. That is why the domain Ds0 is called a (spherically symmetric) black hole. 1 Note that by (3.42), the event horizon is a null hypersurface of “infinite redshift.” 5.1 Spherically Symmetric Black Holes 355 r r=2m 3/2 3/2 (−(2m) , 0) ((2m) , 0) 3 ν 2 Fig. 5.2 The graph of the semicubical parabola .Or / D .O / Now, let us go back to (5.2) and (5.3). We can derive that h i2=3 p b r D .3=2/ 2m .r t/ D Y .r; t/; b W D .3=2/ p 2m .r t/; /2 : .b r /3 D .b (5.9) The function Y .r; t/ is one of the solutions of the differential equation: @4 Y D ˙ p Œ2m=Y .r; t/ : (5.10) In Newtonian gravitation, the above equation represents the radial velocity of a test particle in the vicinity of a spherically symmetric gravitating body. (Consult (3.101).) This equation also indicates that the “Newtonian kinetic energy” is exactly balanced by the “gravitational potential energy.” A possible graph of such a motion can be provided by (5.9). Particularly, the equation .b r /3 D .b /2 yields the continuous, piecewise real-analytic, semi-cubical parabola (with a cusp). (See Fig. 5.2.) In the graph of Fig. 5.2, the segment for b > 0 represents a particle coming from “infinity” that merges with a (idealized) central body. However, the segment of the curve for b < 0 indicates the trajectory of a particle, ejected from the center, which possesses exactly the “escape velocity” (reaches “infinity” with zero kinetic energy). The mathematics of Newtonian gravitation coincides with that of the general relativity in this scenario. However, in general relativity, there exist four distinct domains corresponding to (1) .2m/3=2 < b ; (2) 0 < b < .2m/3=2 ; (3) 3=2 3=2 .2m/ < b < 0; and b < .2m/ : The first domain with 0 < 2m < b r corresponds to the Schwarzschild space–time. The second domain with 0 < b < .2m/3=2 indicates a spherically symmetric black hole. The other two domains will be explained later. 356 5 Black Holes Let us go back to the T -domain metric (5.6). Two Killing vectors are The corresponding squared Lagrangian is given by ( L.2/ ./ D.1=2/ 2m 1 T 1 u T 2 and @ : @R # 2 # 2 u C sin2 # u' 2 2m 1 uR C T 2 T @ @' ) : (5.11) Timelike geodesics admit a class of solutions with R D R0 D const.; # D =2; ' # D '0# D const. The T -geodesic equation implies that or 2m 1 T 1 dT .s/ ds 2m T dT .s/ D˙ ds T 2 D 1; 1=2 ; 0 < T < 2m: (5.12) By Example A2.10, it is evident that a particle pursuing a geodesic along a T coordinate line toward the singularity T D 0C , exhibits chaotic behavior. (See [151].) Example 5.1.1. Historically, the first chart that extended the Schwarzschild chart into b r 2m was due to Painlevé [203] and Gullstrand [119]. It is obtained via the coordinate transformation: Q 'Q D b rQ ; ; r; b ; b ' ; tQ D b t C f .b r /; r df .b r/ 2m 1 2m where, D 1 : db r b r b r 5.1 Spherically Symmetric Black Holes 357 The Schwarzschild metric goes over into 2 dQ C sin2 Q .d'/ Q 2 ds 2 D .drQ /2 C .Qr /2 r 2m 2 2m dtQ C 2 .drQ / dtQ : 1 rQ rQ It is a nonorthogonal coordinate chart known as the Painlevé–Gullstrand coordinate chart. For the three-dimensional hypersurface defined by rQ D 2m; the above equation yields the two-dimensional metric: 2 ds jrQD2m 2 D .2m/ dQ C sin2 Q .d'/ Q 2 : 2 Thus, the hypersurface is null (and represents the event horizon). The nontrivial curvature components are furnished by q R1212 m D ; rQ R1224 D m sin2 Q ; rQ 2m D 3 ; rQ .Qr 2m/ m D ; rQ 2 2m rQ q rQ 2m rQ m ; m sin2 Q R1313 D R1334 D R1414 R2323 D 2m rQ sin2 Q ; R2424 R3434 D rQ ; .Qr 2m/ m sin2 Q : rQ 2 Therefore, the space–time geometry is very smooth for rQ > 0: Now, we shall introduce null coordinates into the picture. Consider a radial, null geodesic in the Schwarzschild metric (5.1). It is governed by the ordinary differential equations: 2m 1 db t db r 1 D˙ ; b r d˛ d˛ Z or or b r b r 2m db r D ˙b t C const.; ˇ ˇ ˇ ˇ b r b r WD b 1ˇˇ D ˙b r C .2m/ ln ˇˇ t C const. 2m (5.13) 358 5 Black Holes (Here, b r is called the Regge-Wheeler tortoise coordinate [217].) We introduce the retarded null coordinate b u and the advanced null coordinate b v by the transformations: b u Db t b r ; b v Db t Cb r : (5.14) Remarks: (i) In the lim m ! 0C ; we obtain the null coordinates of Example 2.1.17. (ii) Compare with the Example A2.6. The Schwarzschild’s metric, in terms of each of the null coordinates introduced above, can be transformed into 2m 2 .db u/2 2 .db ds D 1 r / .db u/ b r 2 C sin2 b C .b r / db .db ' /2 ; 2 or (5.15i) 2m .db v/2 C 2 .db r / .db v/ ds 2 D 1 b r C .b r /2 2 .db ' /2 : db C sin2 b (5.15ii) The metrics (5.15i) and (5.15ii) were studied by Eddington [82] and Finkelstein [100]. Both of the metrics in (5.15i) and (5.15ii) are regular on the event horizon, b r D 2m, with a loss of two dimensions. Now, we shall introduce both of the null coordinates b u and b v: Note that by (5.13) and (5.14) we obtain b t D .1=2/ .b u Cb v/ ; b r D .1=2/ .b v b u/ ; ˇ ˇ ˇ b ˇ r 1 b r C ln ˇˇ 1ˇˇ D .b v b u/ ; 2m 2m 4m b .b b r DY u;b v/ : Here, b Y .b u;b v/ is an implicitly defined function. (5.16) 5.1 Spherically Symmetric Black Holes 359 The Schwarzschild metric (5.1), with the use of (5.16), transforms into 2 2m .db u/ .db v/ C .b r /2 db ds 2 D 1 C sin2 b .db ' /2 (5.17i) b r " # h i2 2 2m b D 1 Œdb ' /2 ; db C sin2 b .db u/ .db v/ C Y .b u;b v/ b Y .b u;b v/ 2 2 dsjO2r D2m D 4m2 db : (5.17ii) C sin2 b db The above metric was first derived by Synge [241]. It is regular at b r D 2m: Moreover, the metric represented the maximal extension of the Schwarzschild chart for the first time (as far as we know).2 There is a loss of two dimensions on the hypersurface b r D 2m, indicating that it is null. (Compare with (3.8).) We now introduce another transformation by u D e vDe b u=4m b v=4m ; ; b .b Y.u; v/ Y u;b v/ : (5.18) With help of (5.18) and (5.16), the Schwarzschild metric (5.1) goes over into Y.u; v/ 32 .m/3 2 ds D .du/ .dv/ exp Y.u; v/ 2m C ŒY.u; v/2 .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 ; b r D Y.u; v/ > 2m > 0: (5.19) Suppressing the and ' coordinates for simplicity, the transformation of the doubly null coordinate chart from the Schwarzschild chart can be summarized below as r ı b r 1 exp b r b t 4m < 0; uD 2m r ı b r 1 exp b r Cb t 4m > 0; vD 2m ı @.u; v/ b r D exp b r 2m < 0; 3 16 m @ b r;b t ˚ codomain DI WD .u; v/ 2 R2 W u < 0; v > 0 : (5.20) 2 Consult the reference of Schmidt [227]. 360 5 Black Holes u uv = −e c+1 X .. v 0 e c x 0 2 e c x X .. uv = −e c+1 Fig. 5.3 The mapping X and its restrictions Xj:: The above transformation is one-to-one. The inverse transformation is furnished by ı b r 1 exp b r 2m D uv; 2m b r D Y.u; v/; b t D .2m/ ln Œ.v=u/ : (5.21) Note that the function b r D Y.u; v/ is implicitly defined above.3 However, it can be expressed explicitly in terms of known functions. Consider firstly the polynomial function from R to R2 as x D X.u; v/ WD .e/1 uv; .u; v/ 2 R2 ; e WD exp.1/: (5.22) It is not a one-to-one function from R into R2 . The function X maps the rectangular hyperbola uv D k (of two branches) into the single point x D k .e/1 D const. (See Fig. 5.3 with k D ecC1 .) Note that from (5.21), we can derive that Y .u; v/ D b r D 2m,u 0; and/or v 0 ) du 0; O . and/or dv 0; thus, du ˝ dv 3 b jr D2m b ::jrD2m 5.1 Spherically Symmetric Black Holes 361 Fig. 5.4 The graph of the Lambert W-function x (−e−1, −1) We need another function, namely, the Lambert W-Function. (See [41].) This function has the following properties: W.x/ exp Œ W.x/ x; W.0/ D 0; lim x!.e1 /C Œ W.x/ D 1; lim Œ W.x/ ! 1; x!1 dW.x/ D eW.x/ Œ1 C W.x/1 > 0; dx x 2 e1 ; 1 : (5.23) The graph of the above function is displayed in Fig. 5.4. Now we introduce another real-analytic function by rQ D e Y.u; v/ WD .2m/ f1 C W ŒX.u; v/g D .2m/ 1 C W e1 uv > 0; ˚ e WD .u; v/ 2 R2 W 1 < uv < 1 ; D tQ D 2m ln jv=uj for uv ¤ 0 and uv < 1: (5.24) 362 5 Black Holes Four restrictions on the above function over four domains of validity will be presented in the following. The first domain and a related (one-to-one) coordinate transformation are given by ˚ DI WD .u; v/ 2 R2 W u < 0; v > 0 I e v/ D .2m/ 1 C W e1 uv b r D Y.u; v/ WD Y.u; jDI jDI ; b t D .2m/ ln Œ.v=u/j:: : (5.25) According to (5.21), the above transformation leads to the Schwarzschild metric (5.1). The second domain and a related (one-to-one) coordinate transformation are provided by ˚ DII WD .u; v/ 2 R2 W u > 0; v > 0; uv < 1 I 1 e v/ T D Y # .u; v/ WD Y.u; jDII D .2m/ 1 C W e uv jDII ; R D .2m/ ln.v=u/j:: : (5.26) Equation (5.26) leads to the four-dimensional, T -domain metric in (5.6). The third domain and a related (one-to-one) coordinate transformation are furnished by ˚ DIII WD .u; v/ 2 R2 W u > 0; v < 0 I r 0 D Y 0 .u; v/ WD e Y.u; v/jDIII D .2m/ 1 C W e1 uv jDIII ; t 0 D .2m/ ln Œ.v=u/j:: : (5.27) The above transformation leads to the (dual) Schwarzschild metric: 2m 1 ds D 1 0 .dr 0 /2 C .r 0 /2 .d 0 /2 C sin2 0 .d' 0 /2 r 2m 1 0 .dt 0 /2 : r 2 (5.28) 5.1 Spherically Symmetric Black Holes 363 Finally, the fourth domain and the corresponding coordinate transformation are given by ˚ DIV WD .u; v/ 2 R2 W u < 0; v < 0; uv < 1 I 1 e v/ T 0 D Y 0# .u; v/ WD Y.u; jDIV D .2m/ 1 C W e uv jDIV ; R0 D .2m/ ln.v=u/j:: : (5.29) The above equations imply the four-dimensional, (dual) T -domain metric: ds 2 D 2m 1 .dR0 /2 C .T 0 /2 .d 0 /2 C sin2 0 .d' 0 /2 T0 1 2m 1 .dT 0 /2 : T0 (5.30) The four domains of (5.25)–(5.27), and (5.29) and the corresponding coordinate transformations are succinctly depicted in Fig. 5.5. Remarks: (i) In Fig. 5.5, the const. " > 0 denotes a sufficiently small, positive constant. (ii) An equation like “b r D 2m” indicates the image of some boundary points in the corresponding b r b t plane. Now, we shall interpret Fig. 5.5 in physical terms. For that purpose, we make another coordinate transformation by ı x D .1=2/ .v u/; ı t D .1=2/ .v C u/; ı ı ı 2 ı2 2 D WD x; t 2 R W 1 < x t < 1 : ı ı ı (5.31) ı ı Evidently, x is a spacelike coordinate and, t is a timelike coordinate for .x/2 > .t/2 ı in D R2 : ı The domain D can be obtained from Fig. 5.5 by rotating the whole figure by 45ı and relabelling four subsets. Thus, Fig. 5.6 below originates. 364 5 Black Holes " "T=0" "R=− " 8 8 "t"=− u "uv=1" r "=2m+ ε t"=0 D III R=0 D II "r "=2m" "T=2m" T"=2m− ε D IV "T=2m" ^ "r=2m" ^ r=2m+ ε ^ "T"=2m" "r=2m" "R= " 8 T=2m−ε 8 " "r "=2m" "T "=2m" ^ "t= " 8 "R"= " 8 "t"= v DI R"=0 "T "=0" ^ "t=− 8 " 8 "R"=− " ^ t=0 "uv=1" Fig. 5.5 Four domains covered by the doubly null, u v coordinate chart We shall now physically interpret Fig. 5.6. We note that radial, null geodesics from (5.19) and (5.31) are governed by the differential equations: 82 32 2 ı 32 9 ˆ > < dXı .˛/ dT .˛/ 5 = 4 4 5 D 0; . /j:: > d˛ d˛ :̂ ; or and ı ı u D t x D const.; ı ı v D t C x D const. (5.32) Therefore, straight lines, parallel to u-axis or v-axis in Fig. 5.6, represent all possible radial, null geodesics. Among these, straight lines parallel to the u-axis (oriented upward) represent incoming null rays falling toward the center. On the 5.1 Spherically Symmetric Black Holes 365 singularity D III :‘dual‘ external universe outgoing D II ^ const. r=k= :black hole ingoing x D IV :white hole D I :external universe t singularity 2 Fig. 5.6 The maximal extension of the Schwarzschild chart other hand, straight lines parallel to the v-axis represent outgoing null rays. (These interpretations of “incoming” and “outgoing” are valid only on the right-hand side of the u-axis.) If an (idealized) observer (not necessarily geodesic) is represented by the oriented vertical line (on the right-hand side of the u-axis in Fig. 5.6), then it is clear to visualize forward light cones, incoming light rays, and outgoing light rays emanating along this timelike world line. It is evident from Fig. 5.6 that all incoming ı rays originating in D I and crossing the event horizon end up at the singularity ı ı ı at .x/2 . t /2 D 1: On the other hand, outgoing rays emitted in D I ; cannot cross the event horizon and remain forever in the external (Schwarzschild) universe. ı However, an incoming ray or an outgoing ray, emitted in the domain D II , remains ı inside the domain D II : Or, in other words, neither incoming nor outgoing rays can ı cross the event horizon to come out of the domain D II into the external universe. Now, consult Fig. 5.1 in the Lemaı̂tre chart. There, timelike radial geodesics cross the event horizon to terminate on the singularity. Also, in Fig. 5.6, the world line ı (parallel to the t -axis) crosses the event horizon never to come out of the domain ı ı D II : Therefore, this domain D II is appropriately called a black hole. However, not 366 5 Black Holes ı ı all timelike world lines originating in D I end up inside the black hole D II : For example, consider an accelerated observer in a rocket who traverses the world line b r D k > 2m; b D const.; b ' D const. His or her world line is depicted by ı a rectangular hyperbola with asymptote b r D 2m in D I . (Compare the image of b r D 2m C " in Fig. 5.5.) Let the world line start from the event b r D k; b t D 0: The proper time along the world line is given by (3.42) as 2m 1=2 b DT t D 1 b t: k Therefore, lim T b t ! 1: Thus, this observer will never reach the event horizon b t !1 nor will he observe the black hole in his life time! (This statement is pictorially obvious in Fig. 5.5.) ı Now, let us discuss the domain D IV : Light rays come out into both external ı ı ı universes D I and D III : However, no light ray can enter into D IV from other domains. Similarly, massive particles can only come out of this domain and cannot enter ı into it. Therefore, the domain D IV is appropriately named as a white hole. ı Every photon originating inside the black hole D II must end up into the ı ı ı ı singularity (at .x/2 . t /2 D 1). No photon or massive particle from D I or D II can ı ı travel into the dual universe D III or the white hole D IV : (However, in case tachyons exist in nature, they can cross these causal barriers!) ı ı Finally, we note that the singularities in the black hole D II and the white hole D IV are spacelike. Now let us express explicitly the four-dimensional, maximal extension of the Schwarzschild chart. We use (5.19), (5.24)–(5.27), and (5.29) to write i h rQ 32 .m/3 2 ds D exp .du/.dv/ C .Qr /2 dQ C sin2 Q .d'/ Q 2 ; rQ 2m 2 " D # (5.33i) e 32 .m/3 Y.u; v/ exp .du/.dv/ e v/ 2m Y.u; i h 2 2 (5.33ii) Q 2 ; C e Y.u; v/ dQ C sin2 Q .d'/ n o Q 'Q W 1 < uv < 1; 0 < Q < ; < 'Q < ; (5.33iii) e 4 WD u; v; ; D i h 2 2 (5.33iv) D D 4m2 dQ C sin2 Q .d'/ Q 2 : dsjuvD0 5.1 Spherically Symmetric Black Holes 367 Remarks: (i) The symbol rQ in (5.33i) can be misconstrued as a spacelike coordinate. In fact, rQ is spacelike for 0 < 2m < rQ and timelike for 0 < rQ < 2m: (ii) There is a loss of two dimensions in (5.33iv) since the event horizon characterized by uv D 0 is a null hypersurface. (Compare with (5.8) and (5.17i).) (iii) By the footnote on page 360, (5.33iv) can be deduced. Now, we use the coordinate transformation in (5.31) to obtain from (5.33ii): 3 ı ı ı 2 Y x; t ı 32 .m/ ı 2 7 6 ds 2 D ı ı exp 4 d t C dx 5 ı 2m Y x; t 2 3 ı ı ı C Y x; t ı D 4 WD " 2 ı d 2 ı ı C sin d' 2 2 # ; (5.34i) ı 2 ı2 ı ı ı ı ı ı t ; x; ; ' W 1 < x t < 1; 0 < < ; < ' < : (5.34ii) ı Remarks: (i) The domain D 4 is an unbounded, simply connected, proper subset of the coordinate space R4 : (ii) The metrics in (5.33i,ii) and (5.34i) are all called the Kruskal–Szekeres metrics. (See [184].) (iii) The Kruskal–Szekeres extensions of the Schwarzschild chart are all non-static. ı ı However, both the domains corresponding to D I and D III (of Fig. 5.6) are transformable to static metrics by Birkhoff’s Theorem 3.3.2. (iv) The Kruskal–Szekeres metric (5.33i) is not asymptotically flat in the sense that guv ! 0 as rQ ! 1. However, Synge’s doubly null coordinate chart in (5.17i) is asymptotically flat in the sense that guO vO ! 1 as b r ! 1. Finally, we express the metric (5.34i) explicitly in terms of the Lambert W-Function of (5.24) as iio n h h ı 16 .m/2 1 ı 2 2 h ı io exp 1 C W e x t ı 1 C W e1 x 2 t 2 2 ı io2 h n ı ı ı 2 d t C dx C 4 m2 1 C W e1 x 2 t 2 ds 2 D n " ı d 2 # ı 2 : C sin d' 2 ı (5.35) (The domain of validity of the metric above is exactly the same as in (5.34ii).) 368 5 Black Holes Figures 5.1, 5.5, and 5.6 are all drawn in coordinate planes R2 : Thus, these figures “appear” as if they belong to “Euclidean planes.” The actual curved geometries, associated with these domains, are worthwhile to visualize. (Compare Figs. 1.4, 2.8, and 3.1.) That is why we shall investigate various, two-dimensional, curved submanifolds of the four-dimensional pseudo-Riemannian manifold corresponding to the metric in (5.35). ı ı Firstly, consider the two-dimensional submanifold characterized by D =2 and t D 0: It is constructed from (5.35), (1.205), (1.217), and (A6.3) as the (positivedefinite) Riemannian surface metric: 2 ı 2 16 .m/2 2 1 ı d D dx x ı 2 exp 1 C W e 1 C W e1 x ı 2 2 ı 2 C 4 m2 1 C W e1 x d' I ı D WD n ı ı o ı ı x; ' W 1 < x < 1; < ' < : (5.36) The metric above yields a surface of revolution around the x 3 -axis in R3 by the following profile curve: ı 1 2 3 ı x ; x ; x D f x ; 0; h x 2 R3 ; ı ı 2 > 0; f x WD .2m/ 1 C W e1 x ı Zx .1=2/.1CW/ q ı e h x WD .4m/ 1 C W y 2 e.1CW/ dy: Œ1 C W (5.37) 0 The qualitative picture of the surface is provided by a wormhole in Fig. A6.2. Now, consider the two-dimensional, pseudo-Riemannian surface of revolution ı ı characterized by D =2; x D 0: The metric is provided by ı2 16 .m/2 exp 1 C W e1 t d D ı2 1 C W e1 t 2 C 4m 2 ı2 2 ı 2 1 1 C W e t d' : 2 ı dt (5.38) 5.1 Spherically Symmetric Black Holes Fig. 5.7 Intersection of two surfaces of revolution in the maximally extended Schwarzschild universe 369 singularity external Schwarzschild space−time white hole event horizon black hole (dual) external Schwarzschild space−time singularity The two surfaces associated with the metrics in (5.36) and (5.38) intersect along the ı ı curve characterized by x D t D 0, providing the one-dimensional metric: ı 2 ˚ 2 dl 2 D 4 m2 1 C WŒ0 d' ı 2 D .2m/2 d' : (5.39) The above yields a closed “circle,” after we topologically identify the end points of ı the interval .; / for the coordinate ': (In higher dimension, the intersection is on a “sphere” belonging to the event horizon.) Therefore, we can represent qualitatively the intersecting surfaces of revolution in Fig. 5.7 Now, we go back to the Eddington–Finkelstein metric of (5.15ii) for some physical clarification of the spherically symmetric black hole. The two-dimensional pseudo-Riemannian metric arising out of (5.15ii), under the restrictions D =2 and D const., is furnished by 2m .d/2 D 1 .db v/2 C 2 .db r/.db v/: (5.40) b r Radial null geodesics parametrized by b r are provided by the ordinary differential equations: 2 db v 2m db v D 0; (5.41i) 1 C2 b r db r db r db v D 0; db r or 2m 1 db v D2 1 : db r b r (5.41ii) (5.41iii) 370 5 Black Holes timelike radial path ^u= const. singularity v^ ^v= const. ^r ^r=0 ^r=2m Fig. 5.8 Eddington–Finkelstein coordinates .Ou; vO / describing the black hole. The vertical lines rO D 2m and rO D 0 indicate the event horizon and the singularity, respectively Equation (5.41ii) yielding b v D const. provides ingoing null geodesics. On the other hand, the solutions of (5.41iii) provide outgoing null geodesics. We shall depict the phenomenon of the spherically symmetric black hole in Eddington– Finkelstein coordinates .b u; b v/ in Fig. 5.8. Now, we shall investigate a spherically symmetric stellar body collapsing into a black hole. For the sake of simplicity, we choose the material content of the body as an incoherent dust of (2.256). A convenient coordinate chart for this investigation is the Tolman–Bondi–Lemaı̂tre chart (3.88) yielding ds 2 D e2 .r;t / .dr/2 C ŒY .r; t/2 .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 .dt/2 ; D4 WD f.r; ; '; t/ W c < r < b; 0 < < ; < ' < ; t1 < t < t2 g: (5.42) We choose comoving coordinates (3.89) for the incoherent dust so that Tij ./ D ./ Ui ./ Uj ./; U ˛ .r; t/ 0; U 4 .r; t/ 1: (5.43) 5.1 Spherically Symmetric Black Holes 371 The corresponding field equations are already written in (3.90i–vi). A general class of solutions are characterized in (3.92), dropping the bar on M .r/, as e2 .r;t / .@1 Y /2 1 "Œf .r/2 D > 0; (5.44i) 1 " M.r/ .@4 Y /2 D Œf .r/2 ; 2 Y .r; t/ 2 " D 0; ˙1; .r; t/ WD 2 Œ@1 M.r/ ŒY ./2 Œ@1 Y (5.44ii) (5.44iii) > 0: (5.44iv) Here, f 2 C 3 ./; M 2 C 4 ./ are arbitrary functions of integration. Moreover, all the field equations have reduced to one differential equation (5.44ii). (This equation physically implies the conservation of the total energy for a unit mass test particle.) We consider here only the parabolic case with " D 0: (Physically, it means that the potential energy exactly cancels the kinetic energy.) The field equation (5.44ii) reduces to two first-order differential equations: p @4 Y D ˙ 2M.r/=Y .r; t/ : (5.45) For the phenomenon of gravitational collapse, we must choose the negative sign for the right-hand side of (5.45). Thus, the general solution of the differential equation is furnished by Y .r; t/ D .3=2/2=3 Œ2M.r/1=3 ŒT .r/ t2=3 : (5.46) Here, T 2 C 3 ./ is the arbitrary function of integration. For the sake of simplicity, we choose T .r/ D r so that (5.46) yields Y .r; t/ D .3=2/2=3 Œ2M.r/1=3 .r t/2=3 ; @4 Y D .3=2/1=3 Œ2M.r/1=3 .r t/1=3 ; (5.47i) (5.47ii) 1 dM.r/ 2 C @1 Y D .3=2/ Œ2M.r/ .r t/ 3.r t/ 3M.r/ dr 1 2 D Y .r; t/ Œln M.r/0 C > 0; (5.47iii) 3 .r t/ 2=3 1=3 2=3 372 5 Black Holes M(r) Fig. 5.9 Qualitative graph of M.r/ (b, m) r (b, 0) 1 2M.r/ 1 C .r t/ Œln M.r/0 .@1 Y / D Y .r; t/ 2 2 lim Y .r; t/ 0; r!0C lim .rt /!0C Y .r; t/ 0; 2 ; (5.47iv) lim ŒY .r; t/ ! 1: t !1 (5.47v) Here, we have assumed that the total mass function M.r/ is a positive-valued, monotone-increasing function of class C 4 in the interval .0; b/ R with the following properties: lim ŒM.r/ D 0; r!0C lim M 0 .r/ > 0; r!0C lim M 0 .r/ D 0; r!b lim ŒM.r/ D m D positive const. r!b (5.48) (See Fig. 5.9.) Now, we shall extend the interior mass function M.r/ and the interior solution Y .r; t/ to the exterior domains by the following: f M .r/ WD M.r/ for 0 < r < b; (5.49i) m for b < r < 1 I 8 <.3=2/2=3 Œ2M.r/1=3 .r t/2=3 for 0 < r < b and r > t; e.r; t/ WD Y (5.49ii) :.3=2/2=3 Œ2m1=3 .r t/2=3 for b < r < 1 and r > t I ˚ Dint WD .r; t/ 2 R2 W 0 < r < b; r > t I (5.49iii) 5.1 Spherically Symmetric Black Holes t 373 r=t (singularity) (Black hole) r−t = 4m/ 3 (event horizon) r 2 r=0 (center of the body) (External Universe) r = b (boundary of the body) Fig. 5.10 Collapse of a dust ball into a black hole in a Tolman-Bondi-Lemaı̂tre chart ˚ Dext WD .r; t/ 2 R2 W b < r < 1; r > t I ˚ D WD .r; t/ 2 R2 W 0 < r < 1; r > t D Dint [ Dext [ fboundaryg: (5.49iv) (5.49v) The four-dimensional metric (5.42) reduces to " ds D 2 # 2 2f M .r/ 1 0 M .r/ .dr/2 1 C .r t/ ln f e.r; t/ 2 Y e.r; t/ 2 .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 .dt/2 ; C Y (5.50) D4 WD f.r; ; '; t/ W 0 < r < 1; 0 < < ; < ' < ; 1 < t < rg : Note that the above metric, restricted to the external domain Dext of (5.49iv), reduces exactly to the Lemaı̂tre metric in (5.2). Moreover, the interior metric components, and their derivatives up to the third order, join continuously to those of the exterior metric components. Now, we utilize (5.42), (5.43), (5.49i)–(5.49iii), and (5.50) to depict the collapse of a general class of dust balls into black holes in Fig. 5.10. 374 5 Black Holes Remarks: (i) The coordinates r and t are spacelike and timelike, respectively, everywhere in the space–time domain D4 of (5.50). (ii) The congruence of oriented, vertical lines in Fig. 5.10 indicate timelike, radial geodesics. These represent world lines of a special class of dust particles collapsing into a black hole and eventually ending up into the singularity at e.r; t/ 0:) r D t: (Note that lim Y t !r (iii) By (5.48) and (5.47i), it is clear that lim ŒY .r; t/ 0 for t < 0. Therefore, r!0C the corresponding interval on the t-axis represents physically the center of the material body. (iv) The spherically symmetric body is starting to collapse from rest in the “infinite past.” Next we shall investigate coordinate transformations in the external universe. Using the inverse coordinate transformation of (5.3), the coordinate transformation from the Kruskal–Szekeres coordinate chart of equation (5.33ii) (suppressing angular coordinates) into the Lemaı̂tre chart (5.2) is furnished by: p 4m 1 Œ1 C W./3=2 r D .4m/ 1 C W .e uv/ C 3 i9 8 h p < v 1 1 C W./ = h i C .2m/ ln for u ¤ 0; v > 0; : u 1 C p1 C W./ ; 10m 3 C .4m/ ln.v=2/ for u D 0; v > 0 I (5.51) i9 8 h p < v 1 1 C W./ = p h i t D .4m/ 1 C W./ C .2m/ ln for u ¤ 0; v > 0; : u 1 C p1 C W./ ; .2m/ C .4m/ ln.v=2/ for u D 0; v > 0: Using (5.51) and Fig. 5.10, we demonstrate the implosion of the spherically symmetric stellar body into a black hole in the arena of the Kruskal–Szekeres coordinate chart (with suppressed angular coordinates) in Fig. 5.11. Remark: In the Kruskal–Szekeres chart of Fig. 5.11, the collapse into a black hole is fully covered in domain DI [ DII [ fboundaryg: The domains DIII and DIV of Fig. 5.5 are not needed. Figures 5.10 and 5.11 are drawn in domains of the (Euclidean) coordinate plane R2 : The actual curved geometry of the corresponding space–time is not revealed. For that purpose, consider the two-dimensional (positive-definite) surface of revolution characterized by D =2 and t D t0 < 0: The corresponding metric 5.1 Spherically Symmetric Black Holes 375 u Fig. 5.11 Collapse of a dust ball into a black hole in Kruskal–Szekeres coordinates "r−t=0+" "r=0 " "uv=1" DII v 2 DI r=b from (5.50) is given by " d D 2 # 2 2f M .r/ 1 0 e.r; t0 / .dr/2 C Y 1 C .r t0 / ln M.r/ e.r; t0 / 2 Y 2 .d'/2 : (5.52) By Example 3.1.2, we can work out, from (5.52), the following ratio: “Circumference of a circle” “Radial distance” D Zr r e.r; t0 / .2/ Y n e.w/ 1 C 2M e Y .w;t0 / 1 2 f.w/ .w t0 / ln M o 0 : (5.53) dw 0C The qualitative pictures of the surface of revolution from (5.53) in three different “times” are plotted in Fig. 5.12. The spherically symmetric boundary of the collapsing star and the event horizon are furnished, respectively, by metrics (recall D =2): d 2 D ŒY .b; t/2 .d'/2 dt 2 ; and dl 2 D .2m/2 .d'/2 : (5.54i) (5.54ii) 376 5 Black Holes Fig. 5.12 Qualitative representation of a collapsing spherically symmetric star in three instants Time Event horizon Singularity Event horizon Remarks: (i) In Fig. 5.13, the spherically symmetric body is collapsing from the “infinite past.” (ii) We have tacitly assumed that there exists no curvature singularity at the center of the body at early times. We have a general class of space–time metrics in (5.50) representing the collapse of a dust ball into a black hole. To check the regularity of the space–time domain, we need to examine the orthonormal components of the curvature tensor. The nonzero components are furnished by the following: 2 2 ; 3.r t/ 2 1 R.2/.4/.2/.4/.r; t/ D 2 3.r t/ R.2/.3/.2/.3/.r; t/ D R.1/.4/.1/.4/.r; t/ D 2 3.r t/ (5.55i) 2 2 D R.3/.4/.3/.4/.r; t/; (5.55ii) 2M 0 .r/ ; 3.r t/ Œ2M.r/ C .r t/ M 0 .r/ (5.55iii) 2R.1/.2/.1/.2/.r; t/ D 2 3.r t/ 2 4M 0 .r/ 3.r t/ Œ2M C .r t/ M 0 D 2R.1/.3/.1/.3/.r; t/: (5.55iv) 5.1 Spherically Symmetric Black Holes 377 t Fig. 5.13 Boundary of the collapsing surface and the (absolute) event horizon singularity y=2m event horizon y=Y(b, t) y Moreover, the mass density is provided by (3.97) as 2 .r; t/ D 2M 0 .r/ > 0: 3 Œ2 .r t/ M C .r t/2 M 0 (5.56) Every orthonormal component of the curvature tensor and the mass density remain very smooth functions in the domain of consideration Dint given in (5.49iii). The conditions lim M.r/ D 0 and lim M 0 .r/ > 0 suffice to ensure the r!0C r!0C regularities of the curvature tensor and the mass density at the center of the body. It is interesting to note that every nonzero component of the curvature tensor, and the mass density, diverges in the limit lim .r t/ ! 0C ; indicating the existence of the ultimate singularity! Consider a bounded function: F .r/ WD ek1 tanh Œh.r/2 C ek2 sech Œ g.r/ : (5.57) 378 5 Black Holes Here, k1 is an arbitrary constant of integration and two slack functions h.r/ and g.r/ are assumed to be continuous in 0 r b but otherwise arbitrary. We generate another function of class C 4 by successive integrations: Zr V .r/ WD 2 Zw4 6 4 0C 2 6 4 0C Zw3 2 6 4 0C Zw2 3 3 3 7 7 7 F .w1 / dw1 5 dw2 5 dw3 5 dw4 : (5.58) 0C Finally, we define a class of total mass functions by M.r/ WD m sin r 2b 1 C ".b r/nC5 V .r/ ; n 2 f0; 1; 2; : : :g ; " > 0: (5.59) We shall now state and prove a theorem about the class of mass functions in (5.59). Theorem 5.1.2. Let the total mass function M.r/ be defined by (5.59) (which involves one arbitrary constant and two arbitrary slack functions). Then in the open interval .0; b/, the following equations and inequalities hold: .ii/ lim M.r/ D 0; .i/ M.r/ > 0; r!0C .iv/ lim M.r/ D m; r!b .iii/ M 0 .r/ > 0; .v/ lim M 0 .r/ D 0: r!b ˇ ˇ Moreover, lim ˇR.a/.b/.c/.d /.r; t/ˇ < eˇ , thus, are bounded for t < 0: Furthermore, r!0C the resulting interior metric inherent in (5.50) joins very smoothly to the external Lemaı̂tre metric in (5.2) at the boundary r D b, t < b: Synge’s junction conditions (2.170) and I–S–L–D jump conditions (2.171) are all satisfied on the boundary. Finally, all three energy conditions (2.190)– (2.192) are valid inside the material body collapsing into a black hole. Proof. The parts (i)–(v) can be proved from the definition in (5.59) and (5.57) and (5.58). The part involving boundedness of the curvature tensor is provable from equations (5.55i–iv). Smooth joining of the interior to the exterior is evident from (5.59), (5.49i–v), and the resultant metric in (5.50). Now, we shall check Synge’s junction conditions at the boundary. The unit normal to this hypersurface is given by s ni ./j:: D 2m .1/ ı i: e Y .b; t/ 5.1 Spherically Symmetric Black Holes 379 But the four-velocity components are provided by U i ./j:: D ı i .4/ : Thus, by (5.56), s T ij ./ nj ./j:: D ./j:: 2m ı .1/ .4/ 0: e Y .b; t/ To check the I–S–L–D junction conditions, we need to express boundary hypersurface parametrically as r D 1 u1 ; u2 ; u3 WD b; D 2 WD u1 ; ' D 3 WD u2 ; t D 4 WD u3 : The induced hypersurface metric is furnished by i h e b; u3 2 du1 2 C sin2 u1 du2 2 du3 2 : g ˛ˇ u1 ; u2 ; u3 .du˛ / duˇ D Y By (1.234), the nonvanishing components of the extrinsic curvature components are provided by e b; u3 ; K11 u1 ; u2 ; u3 D Y 2 e b; u3 : K22 u1 ; u2 ; u3 D sin u1 Y Obviously, the above functions are continuous across the boundary. Thus, I-S-L-D jump conditions hold. Finally, to check the three energy conditions of (2.190)–(2.192), we note from (5.43) that the only nonzero component of Tij ./ is given by T44 .r; t/ D .r; t/: By (5.56)˚ and the function M.r/ defined in (5.59), clearly .r; t/ > 0 in Dint WD .r; t/ 2 R2 W 0 < r < b; r > t : Thus, all three energy conditions are validated. Exercises 5.1 1. Consider the spherically symmetric doubly null coordinate chart specified by 2 ds 2 D 4 Œf .u; v/2 .du/.dv/ C e Y.u; v/ .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 : 380 5 Black Holes (i) Solve the vacuum field equations explicitly to obtain the Synge metric of (5.17i). (ii) In the same coordinate chart, express Einstein’s interior field equations for the case of a perfect fluid. (iii) Show that the preceding field equations (of part (ii)) imply that the 1-form 2 e du C @u e f ./ @v Y Y dv is closed. 2. Consider the elliptic case of the Tolman–Bondi–Lemaı̂tre metric in (3.92) (with " D C1) yielding g11 .r; t/ D e2 .r;t / D Œ@1 Y 2 ; 1 Œf .r/2 0 < f .r/ < 1: (i) Show that the remaining field equation (3.94) (for the collapse) is given by s @4 Y D 2M.r/ Œf .r/2 < 0: Y .r; t/ (ii) Derive the general solution of the above differential equation in the implicit form as t T0 .r/ D s 2M.r/ 1 Œf .r/2 Y .r; t/ Y .r; t/ f .r/ s 2M.r/ C Arctan Œf .r/3 2M.r/ 1: Œf .r/2 Y .r; t/ (Here, T0 .r/ is a smooth, arbitrary function arising out of integration.) (iii) Smoothly join the interior black hole solution of part (ii) to the exterior Schwarzschild universe. 3. Consider the particular Tolman–Bondi–Lemaı̂tre metric e ds 2 D @1 Y 2 e.r; t/ .dr/2 C Y 2 .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 .dt/2 5.1 Spherically Symmetric Black Holes 381 with 8 2=3 r 3 ˆ 1=3 ˆ ˆ Œr t q .b r/n .t ln cosh.t//2=3 .2m/ sin ˆ ˆ 2 2b ˆ ˆ ˆ ˆ < for Dint WD f.r; t/ W 0 < r < b; 1 < t < T .r/g ; e.r; t/ WD Y ˆ h i2=3 ˆ p ˆ ˆ ˆ .3=2/ 2m .r t/ ˆ ˆ ˆ :̂ for Dext WD f.r; t/ W b < r; 1 < t < T .r/g : 1 Here, n 5; 0 < q < 2nb n , and the curve t D T .r/ is defined implicitly by r t C q .b r/n Œt ln cosh.t/ D 0: (i) Define a total mass function by ( 3 r f1 q .b r/n Œ1 tanh.t/g2 for Dint ; m sin f M .r; t/ WD 2b m for Dext : e.r; t/ satisfies the collapse equation: Show that the function Y s eD @4 Y 2f M .r; t/ < 0: e Y .r; t/ (ii) Prove that the Tolman–Bondi–Lemaı̂tre metric of this problem represents the collapse of a spherically symmetric body of Segre characteristic Œ1; .1; 1/; 1 into a black hole. 4. Consider the Reissner–Nordström–Jeffery metric in (3.74), written with a different notation as 2m e 2 C ds D 1 b r b r 2 1 2 .db r / C .b r / db C sin2 b .db ' /2 2 2 2m e 2 2 C db t 1 b r b r for 0 < jej < m: (i) Prove that orthonormal components of the corresponding curvature tensor r Db r : (Here, b r C and b r are are regular and differentiable at b r Db r C and b two, distinct real roots of the quadratic equation .b r /2 2m b r C .e/2 D 0:) (ii) Construct the generalization of the Synge’s doubly null coordinate chart in (5.17i) for the present metric. 382 5 Black Holes Answers and Hints to Selected Exercises 1. (i) To obtain the vacuum field equations, put ./ D p./ 0 into the following answer to part (ii). The equations G11 ./ D G22 ./ D 0 can be solved to obtain Œf .u; v/2 D A.u/ @v e Y D B.v/ @u e Y, where A.u/ and B.v/ are arbitrary functions of integration. Other field equations yield Y./ A.u/ B.v/. Œf ./2 D Œ1 2m=e (ii) G11 4 @u e Y .@u f / 2 @u @u e Y D D Œ ./ C p./ Œf ./2 ; e e Y./ f ./ Y./ G22 D G12 4 @v e Y .@v f / 2 @v @v e Y D Œ ./ C p./ Œf ./2 ; e f ./ e Y./ Y./ e @v e e 2 @u Y Y 2 Œf ./2 2 @u @v Y D C C 2 2 e e e Y./ Y./ Y./ D Œ ./ p./ Œf ./2 ; G33 D e Y./ @u @v e Y Œf ./2 C 2 e Y./ .@u f / .@v f / Œf ./4 2 e Y./ .@u @v f / Œf ./3 e 2: D p./ Y./ (Comment: The above equations have been studied in detail in [19].) 2. (iii) Extend the function M.r/ into the external domain by (5.49i). Extend functions f .r/; T0 .r/ very smoothly similarly. Thus, extend the solution in part (ii) outside too. Make a coordinate transformation in the outside domain by D r; v u D 2 Arctan u th 2m 1: i2 e.r; t/ fQ.r/ Y 5.1 Spherically Symmetric Black Holes 383 Make another successive transformation by b rD b tD m .1 C cos / ; h i2 fQ. / Z b e T 00 .x/ r h i2 dx C m 1 fQ.x/ r h 1 fQ. / i2 2 3 2 7 6 C sin 4h i3 C Q 5 f. / fQ. / tan . h . /=2/ C tan. =2/ ; tan . h . /=2/ tan. =2/ h h i1 r i2 Q tan . h . /=2/ WD f . / 1 fQ. / ; C .2m/ ln ı D ext WD f. ; / W b < ; 0 < < h < g : The corresponding coordinate chart exactly yields the Schwarzschild metric in (5.1). 3. (ii) The nonzero components of the energy–momentum–stress tensor are provided by T 11 ./ D T 22 ./ M 2 @4 f e./ Y T 33 ./ T 44 ./ D 2 e @4 Y ; " # f @4 M 1 @ ; D e./ @1 Y e 1 @4 Y e Y M 2 @1 f e./ Y 2 e @1 Y < 0: (Comment: To visualize many graphs on this collapse, see [66].) 4. (ii) b r WD Z e2 2m C 2 1 b r b r Db rC 1 db r .b r C /2 .b r /2 ln jb r b r Cj ln jb r b r j ; .b r C b r / .b r C b r / r˙ WD m ˙ p m 2 e2 b u Db t b r ; b v Db t Cb r ; 384 5 Black Holes b rDb Y .b u;b v/; 8 " #2 9 = < 2m e .db u / .db v/ ds 2 D 1 C : b b Y .b u;b v/ Y .b u;b v/ ; h i2 2 b .b .db ' /2 : C Y u;b v / db C sin2 b Remark: Two horizons of the Reissner–Nordström–Jeffery black hole are given by b .b b r D b Y .b u;b v/ D b r C and b r D Y u;b v/ D b r : These are solutions of the special Hamilton–Jacobi equation of page 591 from the R–N–J metric as b g ij .x/ O e2 @b r @b r 2m 11 C 2 D 0: D b g .b x / D 1 i j @b x @b x b r b r 5.2 Kerr Black Holes One of the most important axially symmetric, stationary vacuum solutions is provided by the Kerr metric in Sect. 4.3. In the Boyer–Lindquist coordinate chart, the Kerr metric is furnished by (4.134) as .dr/2 C .d/2 C r 2 C a2 sin2 .d'/2 .r/ 2 2mr dt a sin2 d' ; .dt/2 C ˙.r; / ds 2 D ˙.r; / ˙.r; / WD r 2 C a2 cos2 > 0; (5.60i) .r/ WD r 2 2mr C a2 ; 0 < jaj < m; (5.60ii) (5.60iii) p ˚ D4 WD .r; ; '; t/ W 0 < m C m2 a2 cos2 < r < 1; 0 < < ; < ' < ; 1 < t < 1 : (5.60iv) The above metric may represent the gravitational field outside of certain rotating, axially symmetric, massive stars. Moreover, it can stand for the external metric due to a rotating, axially symmetric, black hole. This metric admits two, commuting @ Killing vectors @' and @t@ : (Caution: The r and t coordinates of (5.60i) differ from Lemaı̂tre’s r and t coordinates of the preceding section.) 5.2 Kerr Black Holes 385 Now, we shall explore the curvature tensor components of the Kerr metric of (5.60i) in the following example. Example 5.2.1. Let us express (5.60i) in a different coordinate chart given by y D cos ; jyj < 1; ḃ .r; y/ WD ˙.r; /: Also, using .r; '; t/ for the new coordinates (for the sake of simplicity), we get .dy/2 .dr/2 ds 2 D r 2 C a2 y 2 C .r 2 C a2 /.1 y 2 / d' 2 .dt/2 C .r/ .1 y 2 / (5.61i) 2mr 2 dt a .1 y 2 / d' ; C a2 y 2 / 2 g WD det gij ./ D r 2 C a2 y 2 1 y 2 : C (5.61ii) .r 2 (5.61iii) Thus, the metric in (5.61ii) is given by polynomial functions. The Kerr space–time in various coordinate systems is also reviewed in [255]. Remark: Computer-based, symbolic computation is easier with polynomial functions than with trigonometric functions. (See the Appendix 8.)) The nonzero, orthonormal components of the curvature tensor from (5.61ii) are furnished by R.1/.4/.1/.4/./ D 2R.2/.4/.2/.4/./ D 2R.3/.4/.3/.4/./ D 2R.1/.2/.1/.2/./ D 2R.1/.3/.1/.3/./ D R.2/.3/.2/.3/./ D R.2/.3/.4/.1/./ D R.1/.3/.4/.2/./ D R.1/.2/.4/.3/./ D 2mr .r 2 3a2 y 2 / .r 2 C a2 y 2 /3 2ma y .3r 2 a2 y 2 / .r 2 C a2 y 2 /3 ; : (5.62) Remarks: (i) In the limit a ! 0; the above expressions reduce to those of the Schwarzschild metric. (See (3.12).) (ii) In the limit m ! 0C ; the curvature tensor vanishes. (See the Problem # 6 of the Exercise 4.3.) The Kretschmann scalar for the Kerr metric reduces to R.a/.b/.c/.d /./ R.a/.b/.c/.d /./ D 48 m2 .r 2 a2 y 2 / h r 2 C a2 y 2 .r 2 C a2 y 2 /6 2 16r 2 a2 y 2 i : (5.63) 386 5 Black Holes Note that the above orthonormal components in (5.62) and the Kretschmann scalar in (5.63) are undefined for points satisfying r 2 C a2 y 2 D 0; or r D 0 and y D 0 for a ¤ 0; or r D 0 and D =2 for a ¤ 0: (5.64) These points constitute singularities. Now consider the two roots of the quadratic equation4 .r/ D r 2 2mr C a2 D 0; p or r D r˙ WD m ˙ m2 a2 D consts: (5.65) Similarly, two solutions of the second-degree equation ˙.r; / 2mr D r 2 2mr C a2 cos2 D 0 (5.66) are provided by functions r D R˙ ./ WD m ˙ p m2 a2 cos2 : (5.67) Assuming the physically reasonable inequality 0 < jaj < m; we derive from (5.65) and (5.67) more inequalities: 0 < R ./ < r < rC < RC ./: (5.68) In terms of r˙ and R˙ ./; the nonzero metric tensor components in (5.60i) are provided by g11 ./ D ˙./ ; .r rC / .r r / g22 ./ D ˙./ > 0; " g33 ./ D 4 2ma2 r sin2 r Ca C ˙./ 2 # 2 g34 ./ D 2ma r sin2 ; ˙./ g44 ./ D Œr RC ./ Œr R ./ : ˙./ sin2 > 0; (5.69) Caution: The two roots r˙ in (5.66) are different from r˙ in Problem #4 of Exercise 5.1 (regarding the Reissner–Nordström–Jeffery metric). 5.2 Kerr Black Holes 387 x3 r r= R + (θ) r= R + (θ) r=r+ r=r+ r=r− r= R – (θ) r= R – (θ) x2 r=r− θ π 2 2 Fig. 5.14 Various profile curves representing horizons in the submanifold ' D =2; t D const in the Kerr space–time Furthermore, real, usual eigenvalues of gij ./ , characterized by detŒgij ./ ıij D 0; are furnished by ˙./ ; .r rC / .r r / .1/ ./ D .2/ ./ D ˙./ > 0; q 2 .3/ ./ D g33 ./ C g44 ./ C .g33 g44 /2 C 4 .g34 /2 ; q 2 .4/ ./ D g33 ./ C g44 ./ .g33 g44 /2 C 4 .g34 /2 : (5.70) We notice in the domain (5.60iv) that the signature of the metric is C2: However, some of the metric tensor components and some of the eigenvalues change sign in the interior domains but in such a way that the signature remains the same! Now let us try to visualize the various functions in (5.68) and the corresponding graphs in the r coordinate plane. Moreover, we also map these graphs into the x 2 x 3 plane by the transformation x 2 D r sin ; x 3 D r cos : The resulting graphs are exhibited in Fig. 5.14. Now let us explore the physical interpretations of the various horizons. Consider the Killing vector field @t@ @x@ 4 for the Kerr metric in (5.60i). We derive from (5.69) that @ @ Œr RC ./ Œr R ./ : (5.71) D g44 ./ D g:: ./ ; @x 4 @x 4 ˙./ 388 5 Black Holes Therefore, the Killing vector @x@ 4 becomes spacelike inside R ./ < r < RC ./: Thus, the hypersurface r D RC ./ is called the stationary limit surface. (It is also called the outer ergosurface.) The domain denoted as the ergosphere is characterized by inequalities rC < r < RC ./: (See [106, 253].) Next, let us derive the event horizons for the Kerr space–time. It is well known that a three-dimensional null hypersurface S./ D const. (with a two-dimensional metric) must satisfy the Hamilton–Jacobi equation (A2.19ii): g:: ./ ŒdS; dS D g ij ./ @i S @j S D 0 with ı ij @i S @j S > 0: (5.72) From the Kerr space–time metric in (5.60i), the hypersurface r DW S./ D const. satisfies the null condition in (5.72), provided g 11 ./ .@1 r/2 D .r rC / .r r / D 0: ˙./ (5.73) Therefore, the three-dimensional hypersurfaces r D rC and r D r are null. The null hypersurface r D rC turns out to be the event horizon.5 Now, let us go back to Example 5.2.1 and (5.64). The curvature singularity of the Kerr metric in (5.60i) is given by r D 0C ; D =2: The restriction of the metric (5.60i) for the submanifold r D 0C ; D =2; t x 4 D const. yields the one-dimensional metric: .dl/2 D a2 .d'/2 : (5.74) The above metric is that of a “ring” of radius “a” in the equatorial plane of the three-dimensional coordinate space R3 : In the three-dimensional submanifold x 4 D t D const.; we can visualize various horizons as surfaces of revolution and the singularity. Profile curves for four surfaces of revolution are already shown in Fig. 5.14. The equations governing the outer event horizon, inner horizon, outer ergosurface (or stationary limit surface), and inner ergosurface are furnished, respectively, by the following: 1 2 3 x ; x ; x D .rC sin cos '; rC sin sin '; rC cos /; (5.75i) 1 2 3 x ; x ; x D .r sin cos '; r sin sin '; r cos /; (5.75ii) 1 2 3 x ; x ; x D .RC ./ sin cos '; RC ./ sin sin '; RC ./ cos /; (5.75iii) 5 For a precise definition of an event horizon, consult the book by Hawking and Ellis [126]. The other horizon, at r D r , is called a Cauchy horizon. 5.2 Kerr Black Holes 389 x3 Ergosphere x2 Inner Horizon (r=r−) Outer Ergosurface Outer Event Horizon (r=r+) Inner Ergosurface Ring Singularity 3 x1 Fig. 5.15 Locations of horizons, ergosphere, ring singularity, etc., in the Kerr-submanifold x 4 D const 1 2 3 x ; x ; x D .R ./ sin cos '; R ./ sin sin '; R ./ cos /; (5.75iv) ˚ D2 WD .; '/ 2 R2 W 0 < < ; < ' < : (5.75v) Following Example 1.4.1, four surfaces of revolution are depicted in Fig. 5.15. (Recall that this figure is depicted in a coordinate chart.) Particles entering into the ergosphere from the external domain in (5.60iv) can go back to the external universe. That is why r D RC ./ is not an event horizon. (However, r D rC is an event horizon [126].) Consider two two-dimensional domains defined by D2C WD D2 WD ˚ r; ; '; x 4 W r D 0C ; 0 < < =2; < ' < ; x 4 D const. ; ˚ r; ; '; x 4 W r D 0C ; =2 < < ; < ' < ; x 4 D const. : (5.76) 390 5 Black Holes In both of these mutually disconnected domains, the two-dimensional metric induced by (5.60i) is given as d 2 WD ds 2 j:: D ˙0 ./ .d/2 C a2 sin2 .d'/2 ; ˙0 ./ WD a2 cos2 : (5.77) The two-dimensional metric in (5.77) is flat. The r-coordinate curves can be analytically extended through domains D2˙ into negative values r < 0: The preceding treatments of the Kerr black hole are mathematically unsatisfactory due to the use of the Boyer–Lindquist coordinate chart beyond its valid domain D4 in (5.60iv). In the case of the spherically symmetric black hole of the preceding section, the original Schwarzschild chart had to be extended to the Kruskal–Szekeres chart of (5.33i) and (5.35). Similarly, we need to extend the Boyer–Lindquist chart in a suitable manner into the Kerr black hole. For that purpose, we extend (5.13) into6 Z r WD pC WD 1 1 .r 2 C a2 / dr D r C ln jr rC j C ln jr r j C const.; .r/ 2pC 2p .rC r / D const.; 2 2.rC C a2 / p WD .r rC / D const. 2.r2 C a2 / (5.78) One generalization of (5.14) is provided by Z .r 2 C a2 / dr : .r/ b v D t C r D t C (5.79) The remaining coordinate transformations are furnished by Z b ' D 'Ca b D : dr ; .r/ (5.80) 6 Consider the two-dimensional submanifold of the Kerr space–time characterized by D 2 D 0 and ' D const. The corresponding metric from (5.61ii–v) is furnished by dsj:: .r 2 C a2 /=.r/ .dr/2 .r/=.r 2 C a2 / .dt /2 . The null geodesics from the preceeding metric yield (5.78), (5.79), and (5.82). 5.2 Kerr Black Holes 391 The metric (5.60i), under transformations (5.79) and (5.80), goes over into ds 2 D i2 h .r/ db db ' ; v a sin2 b ˙ r; b sin2 b r 2 C a2 db ' adb v ˙ r; b i h db ' : C 2dr db v a sin2 b C 2 2 C ˙./ db (5.81) The above is the generalization of the spherically symmetric Eddington–Finkelstein metric in (5.15ii). The metric in (5.81) is very smooth in the neighborhood of the event horizon r D rC : We can make another transformation, namely, u # D t r ; '# D ' a Z dr ; .r/ (5.82) # D : The metric in (5.60i) transforms into ds 2 D .r/ du# a sin2 # d' # ˙ .r; # / 2 sin2 # 2 2 r C a2 d' # a du# ˙./ 2 C ˙./ d # 2dr du# a sin2 # d' # : C (5.83) that (5.83) can be obtained from (5.82) by the transformation b v; b ' ! (Note u# ; ' # :) Equation (5.83) generalizes the equation of the Eddington–Finkelstein metric (5.15i). v Now, let us try to express the metric (5.60i) in terms of both b u u# and b coordinates. For that purpose, it is convenient to write (5.60i) as ds 2 D 2 ˙.r; / ./ .dr/2 C ˙.r; / .d/2 dt a sin2 d' .r/ ˙./ C sin2 2 r C a2 d' a dt ˙./ 2 : (5.84) 392 5 Black Holes We next make the following coordinate transformation: b u D t r ; b v D t C r ; e 'D' at ; 2mrC e D : (5.85) The inverse transformation is characterized by dr D .r/ 1 .r/ dr D 2 .db v db u/ ; .r 2 C a2 / 2 .r C a2 / dt D 1 .db v C db u/ ; 2 D de 'C d' D de 'C a dt 2mrC a .db v C db u/ ; 4mrC d D de : (5.86) By (5.85) and (5.86), it follows that 3 e ; ˙ r C 1 5 .db de '; dt a sin2 d' D 4 2 u C db v/ a sin2 e 2 rC C a 2 2 r2 C a 2 " # 2 2 2 r r a C d' a dt D r C a2 de 'C 2 .db u C db v /: 2 rC C a 2 (5.87) Therefore, the Kerr metric in (5.84) goes over into 2 2 ˙ r; e .r/ .db v db u / ds 2 D C ˙./ de 4.r/ .r 2 C a2 / ! #2 " 2 2 r 2 rC 1 sin2 e 2 'C a C .db u C db v/ r C a de 2 ˙./ 2 rC C a2 ! )2 ( 2 C a2 cos2 e ./ 1 rC .db u C db v / a sin2 e de ' : (5.88) 2 ˙./ 2 rC C a2 The above metric reduces to Synge’s chart in (5.17i,ii) for a ! 0: 5.2 Kerr Black Holes 393 Now, we make another coordinate transformation7 for uv < 0 by u D epC .r t / < 0; De ; v D epC .r Ct / > 0; ' De ': (5.89) The inverse transformation for r > rC > r is furnished by r D r C tD 1 1 1 ln .r rC / C ln .r r / D ln.uv/; 2pC 2p 2pC 1 ln.v=u/; 2pC etc. (5.90) Note that the function r D Y.u; v/ (5.91) e2pC r .r rC / .r r /.pC =p / D .uv/: (5.92) is implicitly defined by The metric in (5.88) goes over into " # ˙./ a2 ŒGC ./2 sin2 .r r / .r C rC / ˙.rC ; / ds D 2 2 C 2 2 2 r C a2 4pC ˙./ .r C a2 / .rC C a2 / rC C a 2 2 u2 dv2 C v2 du2 " # .˙.//2 .˙.rC ; //2 GC ./ .r r / C C 2 du dv 2 2 2pC ˙./ .r 2 C a2 /2 rC C a2 C a2 ŒGC ./2 sin2 .r C rC /2 2 2 .udv vdu/ 2 2 2 4pC ˙./ rC C a C a GC ./ sin2 ˙.rC ; / .r r / C .r 2 C a2 / .r C rC / 2 pC ˙./ .rC C a2 / .udv vdu/ d' 7 Caution: The '-coordinate in (5.89) is different from the '-coordinate in (5.60i)! 394 5 Black Holes " # 2 2 2 2 2 r C a a .r/ sin C ˙.r; / .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 ; ˙./ GC .u; v/ WD Y.u; v/ rC r rC D : uv uv (5.93) The metric above is the generalization of the Kruskal–Szekeres chart in (5.19) [198]. Moreover, the function r D Y.u; v/ in (5.91) admits natural, analytic extensions beyond the original domain characterized by u < 0 and v > 0: Thus, in case e in the metric of (5.93), we obtain the function Y of (5.91) is extended to Y the generalization of the Kruskal–Szekeres chart in (5.33ii) for the Kerr metric. However, the Kerr metric can be analytically extended also for negative values of e v/: (See the discussions after (5.77).) r D Y.u; To depict the maximal analytic extension of the Kerr metric in (5.93), let us restrict our analysis to the two-dimensional submanifold characterized by D const. and ' D const. In the degenerate case of D 0C (and ' D const.), the induced metric from (5.93) drastically reduces to d 2 WD ds 2 j D0C ; 'Dconst. D 2 pC .r/ .du/ .dv/; .r 2 C a2 / uv e v/: r D Y.u; (5.94) It is more convenient to extend the simpler metric above [35]. To continue the analysis, we shall now have to digress to a relevant topic. We shall discuss briefly the Penrose-Carter compactification of a space–time manifold. Let us consider a toy model, namely, the real-analytic function “Arctan.” It can be summarized as Arctan W R ! R; Domain (Arctan) D R; Codomain (Arctan) D .=2; =2/ R: (5.95) The codomain (Arctan) is an open subset and, thus, noncompact [32]. We want to extend both the domain and the function “Arctan” to obtain a compact domain. For that purpose, we define the set of extended real numbers as R WD R [ f1; 1g : (5.96) The extended function “Arctan ” is defined by Arctan W R ! R ; Domain (Arctan ) D R ; Codomain (Arctan) D Œ=2; =2 R : Thus, the codomain is a closed subset and compact. (5.97) 5.2 Kerr Black Holes 395 The two-dimensional submanifold characterized by (5.94) is compactified by the transformations: UC D Arctan .u/ 2 Œ=2; =2; VC D Arctan .v/ 2 Œ=2; =2: (5.98) The line element in (5.94) then goes over into 2 dC D 4 Œcosec .2UC / Œcosec .2VC / " # .r/ .dUC / .dVC /; 2 pC .r 2 C a2 / e .tan UC ; tan VC / : r D Y .UC ; VC / WD Y (5.99) We can express the conformally flat metric in (5.99) as 2 2 dC D ˝./ dN ; ˝./ WD 2 pC 4.r/ Œcosec .2UC / Œcosec .2VC / ; .r 2 C a2 / (5.100i) (5.100ii) 2 dN WD .dUC / .dVC /; (5.100iii) .UC ; VC / 2 DI [ DII [ DI0 [ DII0 [ fsome bd. pointsg : (5.100iv) The region8 of validity in (5.100iv) is depicted in Fig. 5.16. Note that the metrics in (5.93), (5.99), and (5.100iii) are valid on the outer horizon at r D rC : However, these metrics do not cover the inner horizon at r D r : The chart that covers the domain corresponding to 1 < r < rC ; including the inner horizon, can be obtained from (5.93) by interchanging “C” by “.” The corresponding metric for the two-dimensional submanifold (characterized by D 0C ) is furnished by 2 d D 4 .r/ .cosec 2U / .cosec 2V / .dU / .dV /; 2 .r 2 C a2 / p .U ; V / 2 DII [ DIII [ DII0 [ DIII0 [ fsome boundary pointsg : (5.101) The corresponding region of validity is shown in Fig. 5.17. 8 We define a region as a domain plus some (or all) of its boundary points. Dashed line segments in Fig. 5.16 indicate nonexistence of boundary points. 396 5 Black Holes r=r− D II "r =∞ " r=r+ r=r+ DI DI "r =∞ " D II r=r− Fig. 5.16 The region of validity for the metric in (5.100iii) and (5.99) r=r + D II r=r− "r =−∞ " r=0 D r=0 III r=r− D II r=r+ Fig. 5.17 The region of validity for the metric in (5.101) D III "r =−∞ " 5.2 Kerr Black Holes 397 II III III II χ− I χ+ I II DII D II D D III III M 2* DII D D I I D II Fig. 5.18 The submanifold M2 and its two coordinate charts Remarks: (i) The geometry along the curve r D 0 (in Fig. 5.17) is smooth. (ii) However, the geometry along r D 0 for the case of D =2 is singular. (iii) In subsets of DIII [ DIII0 ; corresponding to r < 0; closed timelike curves exist! (See [197] and Appendix 6.) Consider now the two-dimensional Kerr submanifold M2 with D 0C and ' D const. In case it is also compactified by (5.97), we denote it by the symbol M2 : Two distinct coordinate charts, with some overlap, are provided by (5.99) and (5.101). Using Figs. 1.2, 5.16, and 5.17, we exhibit the submanifold M2 and two coordinate charts in Fig. 5.18. Remarks: (i) Note that in the shaded domain DII of M2 in Fig. 5.18, two coordinate charts overlap. (ii) In Fig. 5.18, the intrinsic curvature of the submanifold M2 is not evident. (Consult Figs. 1.4 and 2.8.) (iii) In Fig. 5.18, we note that some of boundary points (along dashed line segments) are missing. (iv) We can take two exact replicas of M2 and (topologically) glue them on the top and bottom of M2 in Fig. 5.18 to complete boundary points and further extend the manifold. (v) However, to obtain the maximally extended Kerr submanifold (and the corresponding Kerr manifold), we must add a denumerably infinite number of exact replicas of M2 and glue them together on the top and bottom of M2 in Fig. 5.18. 398 5 Black Holes Fig. 5.19 The maximally extended Kerr submanifold Q 2 M II I I II III III II I I II III III II ~ M2* f is qualitatively (vi) The resulting maximally extended Kerr submanifold M 2 demonstrated in Fig. 5.19. Before concluding this section, we would like to make some comments on the black holes discussed in Sects. 5.1 and 5.2. The extended Schwarzschild black hole in the preceding section, and the extended Kerr black hole, enjoys privileged status. Among all externally static, asymptotically flat vacuum solutions yielding black holes, the only possibility is the case of the (extended) Schwarzschild black hole involving one parameter m > 0: (See [35, 141].) Similarly, among all stationary asymptotically flat vacuum solutions yielding black holes, the only possibility is the extended Kerr black hole with two parameters 0 < jaj < m: (See [35].) Similar uniqueness theorems hold for stationary, asymptotically flat electromagneto-vac black holes. The only solution admitted must be an extended Kerr–Newman black hole (of Problem #8 of Exercises 5.2) with three parameters m; “a,” and e [35,220]. An external observer can determine these three parameters by observing trajectories of uncharged and charged test particles outside a Kerr–Newman black hole. All other physical informations of the charged, material body before the collapse are lost after the collapse of the body inside the event horizon! This fact is popularly known as the no hair theorem. (See [141, 220].) 5.2 Kerr Black Holes 399 Exercises 5.2 1. Show that for the Kerr metric in (5.60i–iv) an orthonormal 1-form basis set is provided by s eQ 1 ./ WD ˙./ dr; ./ eQ 2 ./ WD p ˙./ d; sin eQ 3 ./ WD p r 2 C a2 d' a dt ; ˙./ s ./ 4 eQ ./ WD dt a sin2 d' : ˙./ 2. Prove that for eigenvalues in (5.70), the following equation det gij ./ D .1/ ./ .2/ ./ .3/ ./ .4/ ./ D Œ˙./2 sin2 must hold. 3. A second-order Killing tensor field kij ./ dx i ˝ dx j satisfies: kij ./ kj i ./; rl kij C ri kj l C rj kli D 0: Show that the Kerr metric in (5.60i,iv) admits a Killing tensor with nonzero components: k11 ./ D a2 cos2 ˙./ ; ./ k22 ./ D r 2 ˙./; 2 1 sin2 r 2 r 2 C a2 C a4 ./ sin2 2 ; k33 ./ D ˙./ 4 a sin2 a2 ./ cos2 C r 2 r 2 C a2 ; ˙./ 2mr cos2 : k44 ./ D a2 1 ˙./ k34 ./ D 400 5 Black Holes 4. (i) Transform the Kerr metric in (5.60i,iv) into the Kerr–Schild coordinate chart: ds 2 D dij C li lj dx i dx j WD dij dx i dx j C 2mr r 4 a2 .x 3 /2 " #2 r x 1 dx 1 C x 2 dx 2 a x 1 dx 2 x 2 dx 1 x 3 dx 3 4 C dx C : r 2 C a2 r Here, r D R x 1 ; x 2 ; x 3 is defined implicitly by the roots of the equation: q 2 r 2 D ı˛ˇ x ˛ x ˇ C ı˛ˇ x ˛ x ˇ 2 C 4a2 Œ.x 3 /2 r 2 : (ii) Show that for li in part (i), the “null condition” dij l i l j D 0 holds. 5. The Doran coordinate chart [80] for the Kerr metric is furnished by ds D 2 " #2 p 2mr .r 2 C a2 / ˙./ 2 dt a sin d' dr C r 2 C a2 ˙./ C ˙./ .d/2 C r 2 C a2 sin2 .d'/2 .dt/2 : Prove that in the limit a ! 0; the above metric goes over into the Painlevé– Gullstrand chart (of Example 5.1.1). 6. Show that the event horizon at r D rC (which is a three-dimensional, null hypersurface of two-dimensional metric) has the area p 2 2 2 a2 : D 8 m m C AC D 4 r C a m C H 7. Consider the extended mapping of the set of extended real numbers furnished by tanh W R ! R ; codomain tanh D Œ1; 1 R : Let a two-dimensional compactification be defined by UC D tanh .u/; VC D tanh .v/; .u; v/ 2 R R : 5.2 Kerr Black Holes 401 Show that metric (5.94) of the two-dimensional submanifold yields 2 dC D 2 pC .r 2 C a2 / .r/ .dUC / .dVC / : Arg tanh .UC / Arg tanh .VC / 1 UC2 1 VC2 8. Consider the Kerr–Newman metric of (4.136) stating ds 2 D ˙./ .dr/2 C .d/2 C r 2 C a2 sin2 .d'/2 e ./ .dt/2 C 2mr e 2 a sin2 d' dt ˙./ ˙./ WD r 2 C a2 cos2 ; 0< 2 ; e .r/ WD r 2 2mr C a2 C e 2 ; p a2 C e 2 < m; p ˚ D4 WD .r; ; '; t/ W m C m2 e 2 a2 cos2 < r; 0 < < ; < ' < ; 1 < t < 1 : (Recall that e is the charge parameter here.) (i) Prove that two horizons and two ergosurfaces are furnished by r D r˙ WD m ˙ p m2 a 2 e 2 ; r D R˙ ./ WD m ˙ p m2 e 2 a2 cos2 : (ii) Show that Kerr–Newman metric can be analytically extended by two charts (covering r D rC and r D r , respectively) characterized in the following: .ds˙ /2 D a2 ŒG˙ ./2 sin2 .r r / .r C r˙ / 2 2 4p˙ ˙./ .r 2 C a2 / .r˙ C a2 / ˙./ ˙.r˙ ; / 2 u˙ dv2˙ C v2˙ du2˙ 2 C 2 2 2 r Ca r˙ C a " # .˙.//2 .˙.r˙ ; //2 G˙ ./ .r r / C C 2 .du˙ / .dv˙ / 2 2p˙ ˙./ .r 2 C a2 /2 r 2 C a2 ˙ C a2 ŒG˙ ./2 sin2 .r C r˙ /2 2 .u˙ dv˙ v˙ du˙ /2 2 4p˙ ˙./ r˙ C a2 402 5 Black Holes C a G˙ ./ sin2 ˙.r˙ ; / .r r / 2 p˙ ˙./ r˙ C a2 C .r 2 C a2 / .r C r˙ / .u˙ dv˙ v˙ du˙ / d'˙ " # 2 2 2 2 2 e r C a a .r/ sin C ˙./ .d/2 C sin2 .d'˙ /2 I ˙./ G˙ ./ WD r r˙ : u ˙ v˙ Remarks: (i) The upper p and lower signs are to be read separately. (ii) Here, r˙ D m ˙ m2 a2 e2 are different from those in (5.66). (iii) Here, r D rC denotes an event horizon of the Kerr–Newman solution, whereas r D r represents a Cauchy horizon [106]. Answers and Hints to Selected Exercises 2. .3/ ./ .4/ ./ D g33 g44 .g34 /2 D ./ sin2 : 4. (i) Z x 1 C ix 2 D .r C ia/ sin exp i d' C a 1 dr ; x 3 D r cos ; Z 4 x D dt C r 2 C a2 1 dr r: 6. Consider the metric in (5.93). Noting that .rC / D 0 D G./jrC , the induced metric is given by " d 2 WD ds 2 jrDrC D ˙.rC ; / .d/2 C 2 # 2 rC C a2 sin2 .d'/2 : ˙.rC ; / 5.3 Exotic Black Holes 403 Therefore, AC H Z Z p Z Z 2 rC C a2 sin d d': D g d d' D 0C C 7. 0C C 1 .dUC / .dVC /: .du/ .dv/ D 2 1 UC 1 VC2 8. (ii) r WD r C 1 1 ln jr rC j C ln jr r j; 2pC 2p jU˙ j D exp Œp˙ .r t/ ; jV˙ j D exp Œp˙ .r C t/ ; '˙ D ' at ; C a2 2 r˙ ˙ D : 5.3 Exotic Black Holes This section lies outside the main focus of this chapter and may be considered optional for an introductory curriculum. Several of the models presented in this section may apparently not seem particularly physical. However, one example we present below may represent one class of elastic body, an anisotropic fluid, or a perfect fluid with charge. This section also serves to illustrate how many of the techniques studied earlier are employed when considering the T -domain of a black hole space–time and such models are therefore pedagogically useful. Another important issue illustrated here is that physical measurements are local. For example, it is shown below that demanding a well-behaved space–time structure in the exterior of the event horizon does not preclude exotic material with bizarre properties as the source of the gravitational field is inside the event horizon. From the preceding sections, it is evident that cases of massive objects imploding into black holes may be physically plausible, according to the theory of general relativity. (Compare Figs. 5.10–5.13.) However, there are examples of eternal black holes and eternal white holes [106], where only “singularities” reside inside horizons for all time. Thus, these “material contents” are always completely hidden 404 5 Black Holes from the view of external observers. The prime example of an eternal black hole (together with an eternal white hole) is provided by the maximally extended Schwarzschild metric. (See Figs. 5.5 and 5.6.) Furthermore, there exist maximally extended Kerr metrics for which horizons hide denumerably infinite number of connected universes (containing black holes) from any observer in the external space–time vacuum. (See Fig. 5.19.) We have other examples of eternal black holes, where the “material” inside the event horizon may be exotic (violating energy conditions in some way). To explore such black holes, let us go back to T -domain solutions in (3.107) and (3.108i–v). (See, e.g., [73].) The corresponding spherically symmetric metric is furnished by ds 2 D e .T;R/ .dR/2 C T 2 .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 e.T;R/ .dT /2 ; (5.102i) ˚ D4 WD .R; ; '; T / W R1 < R < R2 ; 0 < < ; < ' < ; T1 < T < T2 : (5.102ii) Consider Einstein’s interior field equations containing exotic material as E ij ./ WD G ij ./ C ij ./ D 0; (5.103i) T i ./ WD rj ij D 0: (5.103ii) The spherically symmetric metric in (5.102i) yields, from (5.103i,ii), the following nontrivial differential equations: 1 e./ 1 D 11 .T; R/; @4 2 T T T e./ 1 1 D 44 ./; @4 C 2 T T T 1 @1 e D 41 ./; T 1 @4 C .@4 @4 / T 1 e @4 @4 C .@4 /2 @4 2 2 1 e @1 @1 C .@1 /2 @1 @1 2 2 (5.104i) (5.104ii) (5.104iii) D 22 ./ 33 ./: (5.104iv) The conservation equation (5.103ii) leads to 1 .@1 C @1 / 14 ./ 2 2 1 2 @4 C 44 ./ D 0; 11 ./ 22 ./ C T 2 T @4 44 C @1 14 C 1 @4 2 (5.105i) 5.3 Exotic Black Holes 405 @1 11 C @4 41 C 1 2 .@4 C @4 / C 2 T 41 ./ 1 C @1 11 ./ 44 ./ D 0: 2 (5.105ii) The general solution of the system of partial differential equations (5.104i–iv) and (5.105i,ii) is furnished by e.T;R/ 2 3 ZT 1 4 2 .R/ D 11 ./ T 0 dT 0 5 1 T T0 DW 2.T; R/ 1; T (5.106i) 9 8 ZT 4 = < 0 2 4 11 2./ 0 1 exp ˇ.R/ C T D dT ; ; : T 2./ T 0 e .T;R/ T0 (5.106ii) 41 .T; R/ WD 2 @1 ; T2 12 ./ D 13 ./ D 23 ./ D 42 ./ D 43 ./ D 0; 22 .T; R/ 33 .T; R/ C (5.106iii) (5.106iv) T T 4 1 @4 4 C @1 4 C 1 C @4 WD 44 ./ 2 4 T T .@1 C @1 / 14 ./ @4 11 ./ I 4 4 (5.106v) ˚ D4 WD .R; ; '; T / W R1 < R < R2 ; 0 < < ; < ' < ; 0 < T1 T0 < T < T2 < 2.T; R/ : (5.106vi) Here, two functions of integration .R/ and ˇ.R/ are of class C 4 and otherwise arbitrary. We note that the arbitrary function ˇ.R/ can be eliminated by the coordinate transformation: Z b D exp ˇ.R/=2 dR; R b b D .; '; T /: ; b '; T (5.107) 406 5 Black Holes Subsequently, we will be dropping hats on the coordinates. We now have for (5.106ii): 8 T 9 < Z 4 1 = 2./ 2 0 0 4 1 1 exp T D dT : : ; T 2./ T 0 e .T;R/ (5.108) T0 It is evident that there exist dualities between the set of solutions in (5.106i–iv) and the “R-domain” solutions of the Theorem 3.3.1. However, the present T -domain solutions in (5.106i–iv) yield completely new, exotic physics. We shall discuss a special case of such a black hole inherent in # 4 of Exercises 3.3. We recapitulate the metric as #2 " p p 21 21 qb qT 3 p .dR/2 C T 2 .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 ds 2 D 3 qb 2 1 1 qT 2 1 D4b 1 .dT /2 I (5.109i) q > 0; qb 2 > 1 I ˚ WD .R; ; '; T / W 1 < R < 1; 0 < < ; < ' < ; ıp q/ < T < b : .1 (5.109ii) (5.109iii) The metric in (5.109i) satisfies Einstein’s interior field equations: Eij ./ WD Gij ./ C ij ./ D 0; (5.110i) T i ./ WD rj j i D 0; (5.110ii) ij ./ WD ./ C 3 s 1 ./s1 ./ 1; .T / WD 3 1 q s i ./ s j ./ C ./g ij ./; s 2 ./ D s 3 ./ D s 4 ./ 0; 1 # "p p qb 2 1 qT 2 1 p : q p 3 qb 2 1 qT 2 1 (5.110iii) (5.110iv) (5.110v) It is clear from (5.110iv) that s i ./ @x@ i is a spacelike vector field, and thus, no energy condition is satisfied. We are dealing with an exotic material of Segre characteristic Œ1; .1; 1/; 1: For the outside vacuum metric, we choose 5.3 Exotic Black Holes " ds D 2 407 #2 2m 1 .dR/2 C T 2 .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 p 2 T 3 qb 1 1 1 2m .dT /2 ; (5.111i) 1 T 2 ˚ D4 WD .R; ; '; T / W 1 < R < 1; 0 < < ; < ' < ; b < T < 2m ; 2m WD qb 3 > 0: (5.111ii) (5.111iii) It is evident that the metric tensor components from (5.109i) and (5.111i) are continuous across the boundary T D b: This boundary is now spacelike and denotes an instant in time. Although a spacelike matter-vacuum boundary such as this may not be particularly physical, this boundary is inside the event horizon. It may also be noted that these techniques (the implementation of these boundary conditions) could be used to join two different matter fields at a spacelike boundary. This could be useful, for example, if the material undergoes an abrupt phase transition at some instant in time. Synge’s junction conditions (2.170) on the boundary hypersurface T D b reduce to 44 .b / D .b / D 0: (5.112) Thus, Synge’s junction conditions are satisfied on the hypersurface of jump discontinuities by (5.110v). Now, let us examine I–S–L–D junction conditions (2.171) on the boundary T D b: The nonzero components of the extrinsic curvature tensor from the interior metric (5.109i) are furnished by (1.249) as K11 ./jb K22 ./jb p 2qb qb 2 1 Dh p i2 ; 3 qb 2 1 1 p D b qb 2 1; K33 ./jb D sin2 K22 ./jbC : (5.113i) (5.113ii) On the other hand, from the vacuum metric in (5.111i), the nonzero components of the extrinsic curvature, in the limit T ! bC , are provided by K11 ./jb C K22 ./jbC " r #2 r 2m 2m 4m 1 3 11 D 2 ; b b b r 2m 1; K33 ./jbC D sin2 K22 ./jbC : Db b (5.114i) (5.114ii) 408 5 Black Holes Comparing (5.113i,ii) with (5.114i,ii), noting that 2m D qb 3 ; we conclude that the I–S–L–D junction conditions are satisfied on T D b: Now, we shall transform the T -domain vacuum metric of (5.111i,ii) into the black hole metric in the Kruskal–Szekeres charts of (5.19) and (5.26). It is easier to work out the details in the case of the two-dimensional submanifold for D const.; ' D const. The corresponding two-dimensional metric from (5.109i,iii) is #2 " p p 3 qb 2 1 qT 2 1 dR2 qT 2 1 .d/ WD p 3 qb 2 1 1 2 1 .dT /2 ; ˚ ıp Db# WD .T; R/ 2 R2 W 1 < R < 1; 1 q <T <b : (5.115i) (5.115ii) Similarly, the vacuum metric in (5.111i,ii) reduces to " .d/ D 2 #2 2m 2m 1 .dR/2 1 p 2 T T 3 qb 1 1 2 ˚ DII WD .T; R/ 2 R2 W 1 < R < 1; b < T < 2m : 1 .dT /2 ; (5.116i) (5.116ii) Now, using (5.26), we make the following coordinate transformation from the Kruskal–Szekeres chart: i h p (5.117i) R D m 3 qb 2 1 1 ln.v=u/; T D .2m/ 1 C W e1 uv I (5.117ii) ˚ DII WD .u; v/ 2 R2 W u > 0; v > 0; uv < b # ; (5.117iii) b 1 : 2m (5.117iv) b # WD e W1 Here, W is the Lambert W-Function of Fig. 5.4, and W1 is its inverse. We can analytically continue the Kruskal–Szekeres chart into the usual domain DI characterized by u < 0 and v > 0: (See Fig. 5.5.) We summarize the spherically symmetric, eternal, exotic black hole of (5.115i,ii) and (5.116i,ii) with this analytic extension in Fig. 5.20. (In the preceding example, we have not explored the maximal analytical extension of the manifold or the chart.) Now we shall investigate another case of spherically symmetric, exotic black hole, namely, a fluid or an elastic body collapsing to form a black hole [67]. We assume that the energy–momentum–stress tensor is due to an anisotropic fluid (or an elastic body with symmetries). This class of fluid has been discussed in (2.181) 5.3 Exotic Black Holes T 409 "T=2m" # II (event horizon) (black hole) T=b # b (exotic matter) u R 2 uv=b # (exotic matter) DII (black hole) 2 (event horizon) DI v (external universe) Fig. 5.20 Qualitative representation of an exotic black hole in the T -domain and the Kruskal– Szekeres chart and (2.264). We choose a special exact solution mentioned in Example 3.3.3. It is furnished by the following equations: 8 q < r h M.r; t/ WD 2 : 1 qr j 1 ds D 1 Œ1 .t=c2 /j t c2 i ; ; (5.118i) 1 2 1 9j = qr j 1 Œ1 .t=c2 /j .dr/2 C r 2 .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 1 .dt/2 ; 0 < q < 1; 2 < j 3; p p 3 k < 1; k WD j=.j 2/; b > 0; c2 WD kb > 0; 2m WD qb j > 0; c1 WD c2 2mk < c2 : (5.118ii) (5.118iii) (5.118iv) (5.118v) 410 5 Black Holes The two-dimensional, conformally flat metric for the submanifold characterized by D const.; ' D const. (and interior to the body) is given by .d/2b D qr j 1 1 Œ1 .t=c2 /j 1 .dr/2 .dt/2 ; (5.119i) Db WD f.r; t/ W 0 < r < B.t/; 1 < t < c1 g [ f.r; t/ W 0 < r < ˙.t/; c1 < t < c2 g [ fboundary pt.sg ; ˇ ˇ B.t/ WD k 1 .c2 t/; ˇB 0 .t/ˇ D k 1 < 1; (5.119iii) ˚ ˙.t/ WD q 1 Œ1 .t=c2 /j (5.119iv) 1=j 1 : (5.119ii) Here, r D B.t/ represents the boundary of the spherical body, and r D ˙.t/ stands for the curvature singularity (to be discussed later). The exterior metric joining continuously with (5.119i) is provided by .d/2I 2m D 1 r 1 c2 t 2m .dr/ 1 r c1 t 2 2 DI WD f.r; t/ W 0 < B.t/ < r < 1; 1 < t < c1 g : .dt/2 ; (5.120i) (5.120ii) Note that the vacuum metric from (5.120i), according to Birkhoff’s Theorem 3.3.2, is locally transformable to the Schwarzschild metric by the coordinate transformation: b r; b ; b ' D .r; ; '/; (5.121) b t D t .c2 c1 / ln j1 .t=c1 /j C const. Now, the nonzero components of the energy–momentum–stress tensor from (5.118ii) are furnished by T 11 .r; t/ D T 14 ./ D .j 2/ q r j 3 j q r j 2 c2 Œ1 .t=c2 /j C1 T 44 ./ D > 0; Œ1 .t=c2 /j j q r j 3 Œ1 .t=c2 /j T 41 ./; < 0; (5.122i) (5.122ii) (5.122iii) T 44 ./ C k 2 T 11 ./ 0; (5.122iv) ZB.t / T 44 .r; t/ r 2 @r D qb j D 2m: (5.122v) 0C 5.3 Exotic Black Holes 411 As well, from the energy–momentum–stress tensor of (2.181) and (2.264), we derive that Tij ./ D . C p? / ui uj C p? gij C pk p? si sj ; ui ui D 1; s i si D 1; ui si D 0; (5.123i) (5.123ii) j Tij ./ u D ./ gij u ; (5.123iii) Tij ./ s j D pk ./ gij s j : (5.123iv) j The above equations illustrate that the invariant eigenvalues of ŒT ij are ; pk , and p? , respectively. Moreover, we satisfy a particular field equation by defining p? .r; t/ T 22 .r; t/ WD G 22 .r; t/: (5.124) Using (5.122i–iii), (5.123i–iv), and (5.124), we deduce that .r; t/ D pk ./ D p? ./ D qr j 3 qr j 3 hp i .j 1/2 .c2 t/2 .jr/2 C c2 t c2 Œ1 .t=c2 /j C1 ; (5.125i) c2 Œ1 .t=c2 /j C1 ; (5.125ii) hp i .j 1/2 .c2 t/2 .jr/2 c2 C t qr j 3 .j 1/ .j 2/ .c2 t/2 j.j C 1/ r 2 2 .c2 /2 Œ1 .t=c2 /j C2 C q 2 r 2.j 2/ .j 1/2 .c2 t/2 .jr/2 2 .c2 /2 Œ1 .t=c2 /2j C2 Œ1 .qr j 1 /=.1 t=c2 /j : (5.125iii) Using (5.125i–iii), we can prove that, in this case, the weak energy conditions of (2.268i), namely, 0; C p? 0; C pk 0 are satisfied by ./; p? ./; and pk ./ in (5.125i–iii). Now, we shall investigate Synge’s junction conditions (2.170) and (3.85i,ii). The four equations reduce to the following two nontrivial conditions: T 11 .r; t/ 1 C T 41 ./ k 1 jrDB.t / D .j 2/ q r j 3 Œ1 .t=c2 /j j q r j 2 k c2 Œ1 .t=c2 /j C1 jrDk 1 .c2 t / 0; (5.126i) 412 5 Black Holes T 14 ./ 1 C T 44 ./ k 1 j:: 1 q r j 2 D c2 Œ1 .t=c2 /j C1 j q r j 3 k Œ1 .t=c2 /j j:: 0: (5.126ii) Thus, Synge’s junction conditions hold on the boundary of the collapsing body. Let us consider the two-dimensional submanifold metric outside matter, joining continuously with the interior metric of (5.119i). It is provided by c2 t 2 2m 1 2m .d/2I D 1 .dr/2 1 .dt/2 ; r r c1 t DI WD f.r; t/ W 0 < B.t/ < r; 1 < t < c1 g : (5.127i) (5.127ii) It follows from (5.119ii) and (5.119iii) that lim ŒB.t/ D k 1 .c2 c1 / D 2m: (5.128) t !c1 Thus, the collapsing spherical body reaches the event horizon in the limit t ! c1 : Other horizons are furnished from the equations: g ij ./ .@i r/ .@j r/ D 1 qr j 1 Œ1 .t=c2 /j g ./ .@i t/ .@j t/ D 1 qr j 1 ij or D 0; Œ1 .t=c2 /j ˚ r D ˙.t/ WD q 1 Œ1 .t=c2 /j 1=j 1 (5.129i) D 0; : (5.129ii) (5.129iii) ˇ ˇ We shall call this the singular horizon. (In the lim ˇRij kl ./ Rij kl ./ˇ ! 1:) r!˙.t / We now analytically extend the two-dimensional manifold and the chart in (5.119i) and (5.127i). The metric (5.127i) is obviously undefined for t D c1 and t D c2 : Extending beyond “t D c1 ,” we have a metric: .d/2III DIII 2 2 c2 t # 2m 1 # 2 2m WD 1 # dr 1 # # dt # ; r r t c1 ˚ # # # # WD r ; t W 2m < r < 1; c1 < t < c2 : (5.130i) (5.130ii) (See Fig. 5.21 for different domains.) Extending beyond “t # D c2 # ,” we have another external vacuum domain characterized by 5.3 Exotic Black Holes 413 u T=0 (singularity) DIV DV t=c2 t=∞ uv=1 R=∞ R=c2 t # =c2 DIII (Black hole) t # =c1 r # =2m R=c2 T=B(R) T=2m R=c1 DII v 2 R DIV T=B(R) DII T=Σ(R) DV t# DII b T 2 DIII r #=2m t # =c 2 t # =c1 D DII b III Db DI t b 2 r# M2 r=Σ(t) D 2 t=c1 DI (external universe) r=B(t) r Fig. 5.21 Collapse into an exotic black hole depicted by four coordinate charts !2 ı ı2 t c2 2m 1 ı2 2m WD 1 ı dr 1 ı ı dt ; r r t c1 n ı ı o ı ı DV WD r; t W 2m < r < 1; c2 < t < 1 : .d/2V (5.131i) (5.131ii) Now, let us investigate the domains representing the black hole. The vacuum black hole domain DII is characterized by 414 5 Black Holes .d/2II WD 2m 1 T 1 1 c2 R 2 2m 1 .dR/2 .dT /2 ; R c1 T DII WD f.T; R/ W c1 < R < c2 ; B.R/ < T < 2mg : (5.132i) (5.132ii) The domain representing collapsing material inside the black hole is provided by .d/2IIb WD q T j 1 Œ1 .R=c2 /j 1 1 .dR/2 .dT /2 ; DIIb WD f.T; R/ W c1 < R < c2 ; ˙.R/ < T < B.R/g : (5.133i) (5.133ii) The other vacuum domain DIV ; inside the black hole, is described by .d/2IV WD 2m 1 b T b c2 R b c1 R !2 2 b dR 1 2 2m b ; dT 1 b T n o b < 1; 0 < T b < 2m : b T b W c2 < R WD R; DIV (5.134i) (5.134ii) Finally, we shall introduce the Kruskal–Szekeres chart for the vacuum domain DII [ DIII [ DIV [ DV [ fsome boundary pointsg : The coordinate transformation from the domain DIII into the K–S chart is furnished by uD q ı ı r # 2m 1 t # c1 1 k=2 q ı ı v D r # 2m 1 t # c1 1 e .r k=2 # t # e .r Y.u; v/ D .2m/ 1 C W e1 uv ; r# D e et # =2m Œ. t # =c1 / 1k D .v=u/ : /=4m ; # Ct # /=4m ; (5.135i) (5.135ii) (5.135iii) (5.135iv) The transformation from the domain DII into the K–S chart is accomplished by uD p 1 .T =2m/ Œ.R=c1 / 1k=2 e.T R/=4m ; (5.136i) vD p 1 .T =2m/ Œ.R=c1 / 1k=2 e.T CR/=4m ; (5.136ii) 5.3 Exotic Black Holes 415 T D .2m/ 1 C W e1 uv ; eR=2m Œ.R=c1 / 1k (5.136iii) D .v=u/; (5.136iv) ˚ DII0 WD .u; v/ W 0 < u < ˇ 0 .v/; 0 < v < .u/ ; (5.136v) ˇ.v/ WD ec2 =2m Œ.c2 =c1 / 1k v; (5.136vi) v D .u/ W (5.136vii) p 2 v D eR=4m Œ.R=c1 / 1k=2 p 1 .c2 R=2mk/ e.c2 R/=4km ; 4 u D eR=4m Œ.R=c1 / 1Ck=2 1 .c2 R=2mk/ e.c2 R/=4km ; c1 < R < c2 : (5.136viii) Similarly, the transformation from DIV is furnished by r ı h ı ik=2 b T b R =4m b 2m R b c1 1 uD 1 T e ; r vD ı h ı ik=2 b T Cb R =4m b c1 1 1 b T 2m R e ; ˚ DIV0 WD .u; v/ W 0 < u < 1; 0 < v < u1 : (5.137i) (5.137ii) (5.137iii) The two-dimensional metric in the K–S chart for all the above domains is given by (5.33ii) as .d/2 D 16.m/2 exp f Œ1 C W.euv/g .du/ .dv/; Œ1 C W.euv/ D 0 WD DII0 [ DIII0 [ DIV0 [ DV0 [ fsome boundary pts.g : (5.138i) (5.138ii) Coordinate transformations, starting from the (5.127i) and ending with (5.137iii), are depicted in Fig. 5.21. Let us try to understand this complicated collapse into an exotic black hole in physical terms. In this solution of Einstein’s equations, a spherically symmetric anisotropic fluid (or elastic) body, satisfying energy and jump conditions, is imploding under its own gravitational attraction. As soon as the external boundary hypersurface contracts into the Schwarzschild radius r D 2m; a singularity appears. The singular hypersurface starts to collapse faster than the outer boundary surface (inside the black hole). However, both of the hypersurfaces collapse with superluminous speed! Moreover, the interior to the singular hypersurface still holds regular, anisotropic fluid. Thus, the singular hypersurface keeps on absorbing regular fluid from the inside and the tachyonic fluid from the outer shell. Eventually, the whole of the exotic material inside the event horizon contracts into the ultimate b D 0: (See Fig. 5.21.) singularity at T 416 5 Black Holes In the realm of exotic black holes, we briefly mention the fact that, with the addition of a negative cosmological constant, black hole solutions to the field equations also exist with cylindrical, planar, toroidal, and higher genus topology [164, 235, 252]. The black holes considered so far all possess curvature singularities. One might be tempted to believe that all T -domain solutions must be singular. However, this is not necessarily the case. One example of a nonsingular T -domain is that present in the Reissner–Nordström–Jeffery solution (see Problem 4 in the exercises of Sect. 5.1) where, although there is a singularity, the singularity is not in the T -domain. There also exist examples of exotic, spherically symmetric T -domain solutions without curvature singularities. We cite the following as a simple example [73]: ds 2 D 2k T 2C 1 .dR/2 C T 2 .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 1 2k T 2C 1 .dT /2 ; k > 0; > 0; (5.139i) (5.139ii) ˚ D WD .R; ; '; T / W 1 < R < 1; 0 < < ; < ' < ; .2k/1=.2C/ < T < 1 : (5.139iii) The nonzero, natural orthonormal components of the Riemann tensor are given by R.1/.4/.1/.4/./ D k .2 C / .1 C / T ; (5.140i) R.2/.4/.2/.4/./ D k .2 C / T ; (5.140ii) R.1/.2/.1/.2/./ D k .2 C / T ; (5.140iii) R.2/.3/.2/.3/./ D 2k T ; (5.140iv) as well as those related by symmetry. The above components are all defined inside the T -domain of the manifold (for > 0) and therefore provide an example of a regular T -domain solution with a horizon (not necessarily a black hole, however). It can be shown that the matter field supporting the solution obeys an extreme (stiff) anisotropic polytropic equation of state 9 between .T / and the pressures. In the limit that ! 0, one retrieves the de Sitter space–time of constant curvature. 9 A polytropic equation of state is of the form p / 0 , with 0 constant. 5.3 Exotic Black Holes 417 In regard to singularities, we have only considered curvature singularities. However, in general relativity, subtler criteria for the existence of singularities, involving incompleteness of timelike, null, or spacelike geodesics exist. There are many singularity theorems in the literature (see [126]). We shall conclude this section and this chapter by stating and proving one of many singularity theorems involving the collapse of material bodies satisfying energy conditions. Theorem 5.3.1. Let field equations Gij .x/ C Tij .x/ D 0 be satisfied in a domain D R4 such that the energy–momentum–tensor is diagonalizable. Moreover, let strong energy conditions prevail. Furthermore, let the vorticity tensor !ij .x/ dx i ^ dx j O:: .x/: Suppose that a timelike geodesic congruence has a negative expansion scalar .x/ < 0 in a neighborhood of D R4 : Then, each of the timelike geodesic x D X .s/ will terminate at a singularity x D X .s / 2 @D after a finite proper time. Proof. We consider the Raychaudhuri–Landau equation (2.202ii). In case of a timelike geodesic and vanishing vorticity, (2.202ii) reduces to ˚ d.s/ D j k .x/ j k .x/ .1=3/ Œ.x/2 ds C Rj k .x/ U j .x/ U k .x/ jxDX .s/ ; (5.141i) y 1 D .s/ WD Œ ı X .s/; (5.141ii) y D Œ.s/1 ; (5.141iii) s 2 0; s : (5.141iv) Recalling the strong energy conditions (2.194iii) for a diagonalizable energy-momentum-tensor, we obtain from (5.141i) and #5.ii of Exercises 2.3 " ( #) X d.s/ 1 2 jk C Œ.s/ D .x/ j k .x/ C .x/ C p./ .x/ ds 3 2 jxDX .s/ DW Œf .s/2 0; 1 d Œ.s/1 D C Œf .s/2 Œ.s/2 0: ds 3 (5.142) We impose an initial condition: .s0 / D .y0 /1 < 0; s0 2 .0; s /: (5.143) 418 5 Black Holes y Fig. 5.22 Qualitative graphs of y D Œ.s/1 and the straight line y D ˝.s/ WD y0 C .1=3/ .s s0 / y=[θ(s)]−1 y= Ω(s) s* so s (so,yo) The differential equation (5.142) and the initial condition (5.143) can be incorporated in the following nonlinear, integral equation: 1 y D Œ.s/ Zs D .y0 / C .1=3/ .s s0 / C Œf .w/2 Œ.w/2 dw; s0 .y0 / C .1=3/ .s s0 / DW ˝.s/ Œ.s/1 ; y0 D Œ.s0 /1 D ˝.s0 / < 0: (5.144) The graphs of the function y D Œ.s/1 and the straight line y D ˝.s/ are depicted in Fig. 5.22. It is evident from the continuity, differentiability, monotonicity, and the mean value theorem [32] that there exists a point s > s0 0 such that Œ.s /1 D 0. Therefore, we can conclude that lim Œ.s/1 D 0; s!s and lim Œ.s/ ! 1: s!s Thus, the timelike geodesic reaches a singularity in a finite proper time. (5.145i) (5.145ii) Chapter 6 Cosmology 6.1 Big Bang Models General relativity has impacted the physical sciences in the most profound way with its cosmological models. Einstein himself proposed the first cosmological model [88]. The main motivations behind his static model were the following aspects of cosmology: 1. Isotropy of the spatial submanifold is dictated from large-scale observations. (This assumption is part of what is known as the cosmological principle.) 2. A finite average mass density is a reasonable expectation. 3. Moreover, a finite spatial volume is aesthetically appealing and a real possibility. With these considerations, Einstein put forward the following “hypercylindrical,” static metric [88]: ˚ ds 2 D .R0 /2 .d/2 C sin2 .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 .dt/2 ; (6.1i) D WD f.; ; '; t/ W 0 < < ; 0 < < ; < ' < ; 1 < t < 1g : (6.1ii) The three-dimensional spatial hypersurface for t D const. is a space of (positive) constant curvature as governed by (1.164i,ii). The finite total volume of the spatial hypersurface is given by Z Z Z .R0 /3 sin2 sin .d/.d/.d'/ D 2./2 .R0 /3 > 0: (6.2) 0C 0C C Metric (6.1i) yields a three-dimensional spatial hypersurface admitting a sixparameter group of isometries. Moreover, the hypercylindrical universe is A. Das and A. DeBenedictis, The General Theory of Relativity: A Mathematical Exposition, DOI 10.1007/978-1-4614-3658-4 6, © Springer Science+Business Media New York 2012 419 420 6 Cosmology (topologically) homeomorphic to S 3 R: The nontrivial Einstein tensor components from (6.1i) are provided by G11 ./ D .R0 /2 g11 ./; (6.3i) G22 ./ D .R0 /2 g22 ./; (6.3ii) G33 ./ D .R0 /2 g33 ./; (6.3iii) G44 ./ D 3 .R0 /2 g44 ./; (6.3iv) G˛4 ./ 0: (6.3v) The interior field equations for a perfect fluid (2.257ii), Gij ./ D ../ C p.// ui ./ uj ./ C p./ gij ./ ; yield, from (6.3i–v) (noting that equation (6.3v) yields the comoving condition u˛ 0), that .x/ C 3p.x/ 0: (6.4) The above equation seemed to be physically unacceptable at the time, due to the fact that neither negative energy densities nor large negative pressures are observed in ordinary matter. Therefore, rather than relaxing the assumption of staticity, Einstein modified his equations to the following: Eij0 ./ WD Gij ./ gij ./ C Tij ./ D 0: (6.5) Here, is called the cosmological constant.1 (Note that this modification is permissible by Theorem 2.2.8.) One possibility is choosing the cosmological constant D .R0 /2 . Then, the field equations (6.5) with metric (6.1i) yield T˛ˇ ./ 0; T˛4 ./ 0; T44 ./ D 2 .R0 /2 > 0: (6.6) The above energy–momentum–stress tensor is due to an acceptable incoherent dust. This reasonable energy–momentum–stress tensor, supplemented with the cosmological constant, would still yield a static universe as desired by Einstein at the time. (However, it was later discovered that this state of static equilibrium is unstable to small perturbations [83].) 1 Later, with the discovery that the universe was expanding (and therefore not static), Einstein retracted the cosmological constant from the field equation (6.5). He also supposedly stated that introducing it was the biggest blunder of his life. Interestingly, today, the cosmological constant is again in vogue as a possible mechanism to drive the observed accelerating expansion of the universe [13, 34, 209]. 6.1 Big Bang Models 421 In 1927 and 1929, observations revealed that the universe is not static [136,161]. In the meanwhile, Friedmann had already discovered in 1922 [105], from Einstein’s usual field equations, a nonstatic metric which yields a finite (positive) mass density of the universe without the use of a cosmological constant : He introduced the metric n 1 o ds 2 D Œa.t/2 1 k0 r 2 .dr/2 C r 2 .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 .dt/2 ; (6.7i) k0 2 f1; 0; 1g ; (6.7ii) 8 f.r; ; '; t/ W 0 < r < 1; 0 < < ; < ' < ; t > 0g ˆ ˆ ˆ < for k0 2 f1; 0g; D WD ˚ ˆ ˆ .r; ; '; t/ W 0 < r < .k0 /1=2 ; 0 < < ; < ' < ; t > 0 :̂ for k0 D 1: (6.7iii) Remarks: (i) In the metric (6.7i), t is a geodesic normal coordinate (of (1.160)). Therefore, t-coordinate curves represent timelike geodesics. (ii) The metric (6.7i) is a special case of the Tolman–Bondi–Lemaı̂tre metric of (3.88). (iii) The function a.t/ governs the proper distance between points on a spatial (t D const.) hypersurface. Therefore, this function is sometimes known as the scale factor. When working with these types of metrics, one is often interested in solving for this function, as it dictates the time evolution of the universe. (iv) The constant k0 governs the spatial curvature of the spatial hypersurfaces. By a simple rescaling of the r coordinate, it can always be taken to have one of the values C1 (positive curvature), 1 (negative curvature), or 0 (flat). Note that in the k0 D 0 case, although the spatial sections are flat, the space– time is not flat, as can be seen by calculating the Riemann curvature tensor components. Example 6.1.1. Consider the “flat spatial case” of (6.7i), characterized by k0 D 0: Thus, (6.7i) yields ˚ ds 2 D Œa.t/2 .dr/2 C r 2 .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 .dt/2 : (6.8) Using a Cartesian coordinate chart for the spatial hypersurface, we obtain ds 2 D Œa.t/2 ı˛ˇ .dx ˛ / dx ˇ .dt/2 : (6.9) 422 6 Cosmology The nonvanishing components of the Christoffel symbols of the second kind, from (6.9), are computed to be da.t/ 4 D a.t/ (6.10i) ı˛ˇ ; ˛ˇ dt 1 da.t/ ˛ ˛ D ı ˇ: (6.10ii) ˇ4 a.t/ dt We make the following abbreviations: aP WD aR WD da.t/ ; dt d2 a.t/ : dt 2 (6.11) The nonzero components of the Ricci tensor, the scalar invariant, and the Einstein tensor from (6.9) and (6.10i,ii) are provided by i h R˛ˇ ./ D a aR C 2 .a/ P 2 ı˛ˇ ; (6.12i) R44 ./ D 3 a1 a; R (6.12ii) " aR R./ D 6 C a aP a 2 # ; i h G˛ˇ ./ D 2a aR C .a/ P 2 ı˛ˇ ; G44 ./ D 3 aP a (6.12iii) (6.12iv) 2 : (6.12v) Now, consider an incoherent dust as the idealized material filling the cosmos. Stream lines, which are timelike geodesics, are chosen to pursue t-coordinate lines. Thus, we choose the energy–momentum–stress tensor with Tij ./ D ./ Ui ./ Uj ./; (6.13i) U ˛ ./ 0; (6.13ii) U 4 ./ 1: (The comoving conditions (6.13ii) follow from the field equation E˛4 D 0.) The interior field equations Eij ./ WD Gij ./ C Tij ./ D 0 reduce to i h P 2 ı˛ˇ D 0; (6.14i) E˛ˇ ./ D 2a aR C .a/ 6.1 Big Bang Models 423 E44 ./ D 3 aP a 2 C ./ D 0: (6.14ii) As well, the conservation equations T i ./ WD rj T ij D 0 reduce to T4 ./ D d ln ./ C 3 ln ja./j .t/ D 0: dt (6.15) The above equation can be integrated to obtain .t/ Œa.t/3 D M D positive const. (6.16) Here, M > 0 is interpreted as the “total mass” of the universe. Substituting (6.16) into (6.14ii), we deduce that M .a/ P 2D : (6.17) 3a Compare the above equation with (3.101). Assuming aP > 0; the general solution of (6.17) is furnished by a.t/ D .3=2/2=3 .M=3/1=3 .t t0 /2=3 : (6.18) (Compare the solution above with (5.9).) The function a.t/ is a semi-cubical parabola, and its qualitative graph is depicted in Fig. 5.2. We put t0 D 0 for simplicity to write h i2=3 p a.t/ D .3=2/ .M/=3 t > 0; aP D 2M da.t/ D dt 9t (6.19i) 1=3 > 0; lim Œa.t/ D 0: (6.19ii) (6.19iii) t !0C Therefore, in this (flat) model, from (6.9), (6.16), and (6.19i), we derive that ˚ lim g˛ˇ ./ D lim Œa.t/2 ı˛ˇ D 0; t !0C t !0C lim .t/ D lim t !0C t !0C 4 1 ! 1: 3 t 2 (6.20i) (6.20ii) Thus, we have a big bang cosmological model! That is, an expanding model that emerged from a (singular) event of infinite density at some finite time in the past. 424 6 Cosmology Now, we shall go back to the more general metric in (6.7i). We shall investigate the field equations with the metric in (6.7i) in the presence of an incoherent dust of equations (6.13i,ii). The nontrivial field equations and conservation equations turn out to be # " .a/ P 2 C k0 aR ˛ E ˇ ./ D 2 C ı ˛ˇ D 0; (6.21i) a a2 " E 44 ./ .a/ P 2 C k0 D3 a2 # ./ D 0; (6.21ii) d flnŒ .t/ C 3 ln ja.t/jg D 0: dt (6.21iii) Equation (6.21iii) can be integrated to obtain .t/ Œa.t/3 D M D positive const. (6.22) (This equation is identical to (6.16).) Substituting (6.22) into (6.21ii), we get .a/2 D k0 ; 3 M 1 .a/ P 2 D .k0 =2/ : 2 6 a.t/ .a/ P 2 (6.23i) (6.23ii) The above equation is an exact analogue of the nonrelativistic conservation of energy (of a unit mass particle) in the presence of a spherically symmetric gravitating mass M: (Compare (6.23ii) with (3.95).) Now, differentiating (6.23ii) with respect to t; and cancelling aP ¤ 0; we derive that aR D d2 a.t/ M D : dt 2 6 Œa.t/2 (6.24) The above equation is analogous to Newton’s inverse square law of gravitation! Let us solve (6.23i) for the case of positive spatial curvature characterized by k0 D 1 with aP > 0: The general solution is implicitly provided by2 r t0 t D a M 1C 3a M 3 r Arctan M 1: 3a (6.25) Here, t0 is an arbitrary constant of integration. To cast the solution in a more recognizable form, we introduce the parameter 2 Compare (6.25) with Problem #2 ii of Exercises 5.1. 6.1 Big Bang Models 425 r WD 2 Arc cot M 1: 3a (6.26) Choosing the constant t0 D M ; (6.25) and (6.26) yield the parametric 6 representation a D A. / WD M .1 cos /; 6 (6.27i) t D T . / WD M . sin /; 6 (6.27ii) 2 .0; 2/: (6.27iii) The graph of (6.27i,ii) is a cycloid. Similarly, for the case of negative constant spatial curvature, that is, k0 D 1; the ordinary differential equation to be solved is r aP D M C 1: 3a (6.28) The implicitly defined general solution is furnished by r t t0 D a M C1 3a M 3 r arg coth M C 1: 3a (6.29) By suitable choices of the parameter and the constant t0 ; the graph of the function a.t/ can be parametrically expressed as a D A. / WD M .cosh 1/; 6 (6.30i) t D T . / WD M .sinh /; 6 (6.30ii) 2 .0; 1/: (6.30iii) Graphs of the three functions in (6.19i), (6.27i,ii), and (6.30i,ii) are shown in Fig. 6.1. The two-dimensional submanifold M2 ; characterized by r D r0 ; D =2; and k0 D 1, is given by the metric from (6.7i) as d 2 D .r0 /2 Œa.t/2 .d'/2 .dt/2 ; (6.31i) 426 6 Cosmology a(t) k0 =1 k0 =−1 k0 =0 0 0 t Fig. 6.1 Qualitative graphs for the “radius of the universe” as a function of time in three Friedmann (or standard) models Fig. 6.2 Qualitative representation of a submanifold M2 of the spatially closed space–time M4 { Big−Crunch Big−Bang M2 D2 WD f.'; t/ W < ' < ; 0 < t < .M=3g : (6.31ii) Using Fig. 6.1, a qualitative representation of this manifold M2 is provided in Fig. 6.2. In Fig. 6.2 above, oriented longitudinal curves represent timelike geodesics which are trajectories of the dust particles. Moreover, closed horizontal circles represent three-dimensional hyperspheres S 3 with “evolving radii.” Note that this universe emerges from a big bang, expands, and eventually recollapses to an event of infinite density known as the big crunch. After their studies of the above models, Friedmann and Lemaı̂tre studied field equations (6.5) with the cosmological constant reinserted, using the same metric as (6.7i) for the field equations. Next, Robertson [219] and Walker [259] investigated 6.1 Big Bang Models 427 cosmological models from the point of view of isotropy and homogeneity. Let us try to explain the concepts of isotropy and homogeneity, both intuitively and mathematically. In case we look at a star-studded, dark night sky, all directions seem to look alike. This observation is the basis for isotropy. Again, if we make similar observations from different locations of the entire globe, the same notion of isotropy persists. In other words, in the spatial fabric of the cosmos, no single point appears to be privileged. That is the intuitive notion of homogeneity. In an N -dimensional Riemannian or pseudo-Riemannian manifold, the mathematical condition of a point x0 2 D RN to be of isotropic sectional curvature [56, 90, 244] is that Rlij k .x0 / D .x0 / glj .x0 / gi k .x0 / glk .x0 / gij .x0 / : (6.32) Now, we shall state and prove a theorem due to Schur [56, 90, 244] on this topic. Theorem 6.1.2. Let MN be a Riemannian or a pseudo-Riemannian manifold with N > 2: Moreover, let the metric field g:: .x/ in a chart be of class C 3 : Furthermore, let every point x 2 D RN be endowed with the isotropic sectional curvature .x/: Then, .x/ must be constant-valued. Proof. From (6.32), it is deduced that Rlij k .x/ D .x/ glj .x/ gi k .x/ glk .x/ gij .x/ ; x 2 D RN : (6.33) By Bianchi’s identities (1.143i), it can be derived that .@m / glj gi k glk gij C @j .glk gi m glm gi k / C .@k / glm gij glj gi m 0: By multiplying glj .x/g i k .x/ and contracting, the above differential identities yield .N 1/ .N 2/ .@m / 0: Thus, for N > 2; @m 0 and .x/ must be constant-valued. Remarks: (i) The constancy of sectional curvatures is a sufficient mathematical criterion of homogeneity.3 (ii) With .x/ D K0 D const.; (6.33) yields a space of constant curvature (discussed in (1.164i,ii)). A domain D RN is homogeneous in case there exists a chart there with N Killing vectors: @ ; : : : ; @x@N . @x 1 3 428 6 Cosmology Thus, by the assumption of spatial isotropy everywhere, we conclude that the three-dimensional hypersurface of the cosmological universe admits a sixparameter group of isometries (or group of motions) by a theorem discussed in [90, 171]. The three-dimensional spatial metric g#:: .x/ of constant curvature is characterized by (6.33) as # # # # # R˛ˇ ı .x/ D K0 g˛ .x/ gˇı .x/ g˛ı .x/ gˇ .x/ : (6.34) By a suitable scale transformation, we can simplify (6.34) to # # # # # R˛ˇ ı .x/ D k0 g˛ .x/ gˇı .x/ g˛ı .x/ gˇ .x/ ; k0 2 f1; 0; 1g : (6.35) Another assumption made about the cosmological metric is that the time coordinate t is a geodesic normal coordinate of (1.160). Therefore, the metric for the cosmological universe is chosen to be 2 g:: .x/ D a x 4 g#:: .x/ dx 4 ˝ dx 4 ; # ds 2 D Œa.t/2 g˛ˇ .x/ .dx ˛ / dx ˇ .dt/2 : (6.36i) (6.36ii) (Here, g#:: .x/ is assumed to satisfy (6.35).) Now, we shall compute the Einstein tensor from the metric in (6.36i,ii). We shall state and prove the following theorem on this topic. 3 Theorem 6.1.3. Let the metric g:: .x/ in (6.36i) be a Lorentz metric of class C in 4 a domain D R : Then, the corresponding 4 4 Einstein matrix Gij .x/ must be of Segre characteristic Œ.1; 1; 1/; 1 : Proof. Define g:: .x/ WD Œa.t/2 g#:: .x/: Using (2.226), (2.228), (2.230), (6.34), and (6.36i), the following equations are derived: i h P 2 g # .x/ G .x/ D G # .x/ C 2a.t/ aR C .a/ i h D k0 C 2a.t/ aR C .a/ P 2 g # .x/; G 4 .x/ 0; (6.37ii) " G44 .x/ D 3 (6.37i) k0 .a.t//2 C aP a 2 # : (6.37iii) 6.1 Big Bang Models 429 Consider the invariant eigenvalue problem det Gij ./ ./ gij ./ D 0: (6.38) Using (6.36ii), (6.38) reduces to and i h det G .x/ ./ .a.t//2 g # .x/ D 0; (6.39i) G44 .x/ C ./ D 0: (6.39ii) Therefore, using (6.39i,ii) and (6.37i–iii), four, real, invariant eigenvalues are furnished by i h .1/ ./ .2/ ./ .3/ ./ D k0 C 2 a aR C .a/ P 2 ; (6.40i) " # P 2 k0 C .a/ .4/ ./ D 3 : a2 (6.40ii) Thus, the theorem is proven. The metric (6.36ii), with help of (6.35) and Theorem 1.3.30, can be expressed as 2 ds 2 D Œa.t/2 1 C .k0 =4/ ı x x ı˛ˇ dx ˛ dx ˇ .dt/2 ; ˚ D WD x W x 2 D R3 ; t > 0 : (6.41) Example 6.1.4. Consider metric (6.41) for the case k0 D 0: It reduces to the metric in (6.9), which can be transformed to the flat Friedmann metric in (6.8). Now, consider the metric (6.41) for the case k0 D 1 of positive spatial curvature. In spherical polar coordinates, it can be transformed into 2 h ı 2 i2 ds 2 D b a b t 1C b r 2 .db r /2 C .b r /2 db 2 C sin2 b .db ' /2 2 db t : (6.42) Making another coordinate transformation h ı 2 i1 r Db r 1C b r 2 ; .; '; t/ D b ; b ' ;b t ; (6.43) 430 6 Cosmology the metric (6.42) goes over into n 1 o ds 2 D Œa.t/2 1 r 2 .dr/2 C r 2 .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 .dt/2 : (6.44) Similarly, in the case of k0 D 1; the metric in (6.41) is transformable to n 1 o ds 2 D Œa.t/2 1 C r 2 .dr/2 C r 2 .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 .dt/2 : (6.45) Thus, metrics in (6.41) are transformable to metrics in (6.7i–iii) (for appropriate domains). Metrics in (6.7i), as well as in (6.41) are called Friedmann–Lemaı̂tre–Robertson– Walker (or in short, F–L–R–W) metrics. By Theorem 6.1.3 and the usual field equations, it follows that the corresponding 4 4 energy–momentum–stress matrix Tij .x/ must be of Segre characteristic Œ.1; 1; 1/; 1: The most popular example of such an energy–momentum–stress tensor is that of a perfect fluid (in (2.257ii) and (3.49i)). Therefore, in the cosmological universe, the usual field equations considered are ˚ Eij ./ WD Gij ./ C Œ ./ C p./ Ui ./ Uj ./ C p./ gij ./ D 0: (6.46) With help of the metric (6.7i) (or, (6.41)), and the comoving conditions U ˛ ./ 0; U 4 ./ 1; implied by E˛4 ./ D 0, the field equations (6.46) and conservation equations T i ./ D 0 yield the following nontrivial equations: " E 11 ./ E 22 ./ E 33 ./ " .a/ P 2 C k0 E 44 ./ D 3 a2 T 4 ./ D P C 3 aP a D .a/ P 2 C k0 2aR C a a2 # C p.t/ D 0; (6.47i) # .t/ D 0; . C p/ D 0: (6.47ii) (6.47iii) There exists one differential identity 4 E 4 3 aP a E 11 E 44 C T 4 0 (6.48) among three coupled ordinary differential equations (6.47i–iii). Since there exist three unknown functions a.t/; .t/; and p.t/; the system is underdetermined. One of these three functions can be prescribed to make the system determinate. In the present matter-dominated era it is common to set p.t/ 0, as the average pressure 6.1 Big Bang Models 431 of galactic clusters is negligibly small compared to the energy density. Otherwise, one equation of state can be imposed to render the system (6.47i–iii) determinate. Note that in every F–L–R–W universe, all the events have some material present. An interesting linear combination of (6.47i–iii) can be expressed as or, a 1 3E 1 E 44 D aR C .=6/ . C 3p/ a D 0; 6 (6.49i) a.t/ R D .=6/ Œ .t/ C 3p.t/ a.t/: (6.49ii) Equation (6.49ii) is called the Raychaudhuri equation (as it is a consequence of (2.202ii)). Assuming the strong energy condition .t/ C 3p.t/ > 0; (6.49ii) reveals that the acceleration is negative and the “gravitational force” is attractive. Let us consider now what is commonly known as the radiation era [27,201,202] which has preceded the present matter-dominated era. It is characterized by the equation of state p.t/ D .1=3/ .t/: (6.50) Substituting (6.50) into the continuity equation (6.47iii), we obtain P C or, aP a .4/ D 0; (6.51i) .t/ Œa.t/4 D C D positive const. (6.51ii) Putting (6.51ii) back into (6.47ii), we obtain the differential equation .a/ P 2D C k0 : 3a2 (6.52) Integrating the above, we have three explicit solutions: 2 6 6 6 6 6 6 2 Œa.t/ D 6 6 6 6 6 6 4 r 2 r 2 r 2 C .t t0 / 3 for k0 D 0; (6.53i) C .t t0 / C .t t0 /2 3 for k0 D 1; (6.53ii) C .t t0 / .t t0 /2 3 for k0 D 1: (6.53iii) Needless to say, the above solutions have physical consequences [190,200,238,260]. After the big bang and before the radiation era, it is commonly believed that there may have existed an extremely short inflationary era [27,206]. One of various speculations about this era, and which is also mathematically the simplest, is to 432 6 Cosmology set the exotic condition .x/ C p.x/ 0: Field equations (6.47i–iii) and (6.49ii) reduce to # " .a/ P 2 C k0 2aR C .t/ D 0; (6.54i) a a2 3 aP 2 C k0 .t/ D 0; a2 d.t/ D 0; dt aR D a.t/: 3 P D (6.54ii) (6.54iii) (6.54iv) Integrating (6.54iii), we conclude that .t/ D 0 D positive const. (6.55) Substituting (6.55) into (6.54iv), we can integrate to obtain or, a.t/ D c1 ek t C c2 ek t ; (6.56i) c 2 sinh .kt/; a.t/ D b c 1 cosh .kt/ Cb (6.56ii) r k WD 0 > 0: 3 (6.56iii) Here, c1 ; c2 (or b c 1 ;b c 2 ) are arbitrary constants of integration. Example 6.1.5. Choosing the constants c1 D 1 and c2 D 0, we get, from (6.56i), a.t/ D ek t > 0: (6.57) The above function causes exponential inflation, as the proper spatial distance between two points increases exponentially with time. Putting (6.57) into (6.54ii), we deduce that (6.58) 3 k 2 C k0 e2k t D 0 : Differentiating the equation above, we obtain that or, 6k0 k e2k t 0; (6.59i) k0 D 0: (6.59ii) Thus, for the case of exponential inflation (6.57), we must have the flat F–L–R–W model. 6.1 Big Bang Models 433 Studies of the cosmological universe are greatly facilitated by the following two functions derivable from a.t/: H.t/ WD a.t/ P ; a.t/ q.t/ WD a.t/ > 0; (6.60i) a.t/ a.t/ R ; (6.60ii) a.t/ P > 0: (6.60iii) 2 Œa.t/ P The function in (6.60i) is called the Hubble function (or the Hubble parameter). The other function q.t/ in (6.60ii) is called the deceleration function (or the deceleration parameter). Note that in an (positive) accelerating phase of the universe, q.t/ < 0: Field equations (6.47i,ii) and (6.49ii) imply that 6 q.t/ ŒH.t/2 D aP a 2 3k0 ; a2 (6.61i) 6aR D .t/ C 3p.t/ : a (6.61ii) 3 ŒH.t/2 D 3 D .t/ In the case of an incoherent dust, (6.61ii) reduces to 6 q.t/ ŒH.t/2 D .t/: (6.62) Subtracting (6.61i) from (6.62), we deduce that ŒH.t/2 Œ2q.t/ 1 D k0 : Œa.t/2 (6.63) Therefore, in the dust model, the constant value q.t/ 1=2; the critical value, yields an open spatial universe with k0 D 0: Moreover, for q.t/ < 1=2; we must have k0 D 1 and another open spatial universe. However, for q.t/ > 1=2; the spatial universe is finite and closed with k0 D 1 corresponding to Fig. 6.2. Present observations and recent theories cannot definitely predict the ultimate future of the universe. The critical energy density for which k0 D 0 is given by c WD 3 ŒH.t/2 =. There exist other cosmological models which are not isotropic. Consider, for example, Bianchi type-I models [126, 238], admitting three commuting (independent) Killing vector fields indicating spatial homogeneity. The metric can be expressed in an orthogonal coordinate chart, with a hybrid notation, as 434 6 Cosmology 2 2 2 ds 2 D g11 .t/ dx 1 C g22 .t/ dx 2 C g33 .t/ dx 3 .dt/2 ; (6.64i) g11 .t/ > 0; g22 .t/ > 0; g33 .t/ > 0; p g.t/ > 0: (6.64ii) (Note that t D const: hypersurfaces are flat.) In the case of an incoherent dust, the usual field equations in a comoving frame can be integrated to obtain .t/ t mt C c0 .4=3/sin ˛ g11 .t/ D .g/1=3 t mt C c0 .4=3/sinŒ˛C.2=3/ g22 .t/ D .g/1=3 t mt C c0 .4=3/sinŒ˛C.4=3/ g33 .t/ D .g/1=3 ; p g.t/ m D positive const.; p g.t/ D .3=4/ t .mt C c0 /; ˛ 2 .=6/; .=2/ : (6.65i) ; (6.65ii) ; (6.65iii) (6.65iv) (6.65v) (6.65vi) Here, c0 > 0 is the constant determining the magnitude of the anisotropy. The expansion scalar .x/ of (2.199iv) in such a universe (with properties UP i ./ D !ij ./ 0) is furnished by .t/ D .2mt C c0 / : t.mt C c0 / (6.66) Obviously, lim Œ.t/ ! 1; or there exists an initial singularity. In fact, t !0C with a positive expansion rate, in any cosmological model obeying strong energy conditions, the initial singularity (or big bang) cannot be avoided. We shall now state a theorem which is dual (or a mirror-image) to the Singularity Theorem 5.3.1. Theorem 6.1.6. Let field equations Gij .x/ C Tij .x/ D 0 prevail in a domain D R4 such that the energy–momentum–stress tensor is diagonalizable. Moreover, let the strong energy conditions hold. Furthermore, let the vorticity tensor !ij .x/ dx i ^ dx j O:: .x/: Suppose that a timelike geodesic congruence has a positive 6.1 Big Bang Models 435 y Fig. 6.3 Qualitative graphs of y D Œ.s/1 and the straight line y D y0 C 13 .s s0 / y= yo + 1 (s−so ) 3 y=[θ(s)]−1 (so,yo) s* so s expansion scalar .x/ > 0 in a neighborhood of D R4 : Then, each of the timelike geodesics x D X .s/ had an initial singularity at x D X .s / 2 @D before a finite proper time. Proof of this is exactly analogous to that of Theorem 5.3.1 and will be skipped. However, we shall provide Fig. 6.3, which is similar to Fig. 5.22 and depicts the initial singularity at s D s . It is interesting to note that (6.23ii) yields r M k0 DW F .t; a/; 3a (6.67i) @F ./ M D M 1=2 ; @a 3=2 6a k0 a (6.67ii) aP D 3 ˚ D2 WD .t; a/ 2 R2 W 0 < t; 0 < a : h Therefore, the lim a!0C @F ./ @a i (6.67iii) ! 1 is thus undefined. So, we conclude that solutions of (6.67i) are unstable and chaotic near the initial singularity. (Compare with the Example A2.10 and (5.12) governing a black hole.) Finally, we note in the F–L–R–W metrics of (6.7i) and (6.41) that the space and time coordinates are not on equal footings. The ten-parameter Poincaré group IO.3; 1I R/ of special relativity (and its minimal extension to the de Sitter or antide Sitter universes) is not a valid group of isometries for F–L–R–W universes. (For the definition of a de Sitter metric, consult # 1 of Exercises 6.1.) However, the sixparameter isometry group IO.3; R/ is still a valid local isometry in a F–L–R–W universe. 436 6 Cosmology Exercise 6.1 1. Consider the de Sitter universe of constant curvature K0 > 0 characterized by the metric 2 ds 2 D 1 C .K0 =4/ dkl x k x l dij dx i dx j : (i) Prove that the above metric satisfies the field equations Gij .x/ D gij .x/ for some cosmological constant : (ii) Show that the de Sitter metric can be transformed into another chart as ˚ ds 2 D.K0 /1 cosh2 t .d/2 C sin2 .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 .dt/2 : (iii) Consider a five-dimensional, flat manifold M5 with the metric 2 2 2 2 2 .dQs /2 D dy 1 C dy 2 C dy 3 C dy 4 dy 5 : Let a four-dimensional hyper-hyperboloid, characterized by the constraint y1 2 2 2 2 2 C y 2 C y 3 C y 4 y 5 D .K0 /1 ; be embedded in M5 : Prove that the de Sitter metric in part (ii) can locally represent this hyperhyperboloid. 2. (i) Show that the F–L–R–W metric (6.7i) for k0 D 1; can be transformed into 2 b ds D b a t .db /2 C sin2 b 2 db 2 2b C sin .db '/ 2 2 db t which is conformal to the Einstein metric in (6.1i). (ii) Prove that the F–L–R–W metric of part (i) is transformable to the conformally flat form: ds 2 D i h io2 ı 1 # # 2 nh ı a t cos r # ; t # C cos t r # ; t # 4 n 2 2 h 2 2 i # 2 o dt I dr # C r # d # C sin2 # d' # ı ı b D r #; t # ; b t D t r #; t # : 6.1 Big Bang Models 437 3. Consider a mixture of n distinct perfect fluids obeying simultaneous comoving conditions: .A/ U˛.A/ .x/ 0; U4 .x/ 1 Denote .x/ WD n X .A/ .x/; for all A 2 f1; 2; : : : ; ng : p.x/ WD AD1 n X p .A/ .x/: AD1 Consider the energy–momentum–stress tensor of the mixture Tij .x/ WD n n o X .A/ .A/ .A/ ./ C p .A/ ./ Ui ./ Uj ./ C p .A/ ./ gij ./ : AD1 Assuming the F–L–R–W metric (6.7i), deduce that the interior field equations Gij ./ C Tij .x/ D 0 exactly reduce to (6.47i–iii). 4. Suppose that a perfect fluid is endowed with an equation of state p D P./ > 0; where P./ is a differentiable function for > 0: (i) Imposing the above equation of state, derive from field equations (6.47i–iii), M .t/ Œa.t/3 D m0 D positive const.; hR i d where M./ WD exp ŒCP./ : (ii) Solve the system of field equations (6.47i–iii) with the help of part (i) to obtain the implicit form of the general solution as Za a1 dy Œ.=3/ y2 M1 .m0 y 3 / k0 1=2 D t t1 ; a1 D a.t1 /: 5. Consider the exponential inflationary model of (6.57) in a spatially flat F– L–R–W universe. By considering the trajectories of nearby galaxies and the trajectory of light emitted by the galaxies, argue that, although this scenario can represent an enormous rate of expansion, the expansion is not superluminal in the following sense: Any two sufficiently nearby fluid elements in this space–time are traveling away from each other at less than the speed of massless particles (speed of light). 6. Consider an inhomogeneous generalization of the F–L–R–W metric as n o 1 ds 2 D Œa.t/2 1k0 r 2 Ck1 f .r/ .dr/2 Cr 2 .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 .dt/2 : 438 6 Cosmology Let the material source be a mixture of an incoherent dust and a tachyonic dust characterized by Tij .r; t/ WD ./ Ui ./ Uj ./ C ˛./ Wi ./ Wj ./; U ./ 0; U4 ./ 1 I W1 ./ D p g11 ./; W2 ./ D W3 ./ D W4 ./ 0: Show that integrations of (the usual) field equations lead to k1 f .r/ D .k0 C0 / r 2 C k1 C1 ; and .a/ P 2D 2M0 C0 : a (Here, C0 ; C1 ; and M0 > 0 are constants of integration.) Answers and Hints to Selected Exercises 1. (i) Consult Theorem 1.3.30. D 3 K0 : (iii) A parametric representation of the hyper-hyperboloid is furnished by y 1 D .K0 /1=2 cosh t sin sin cos '; y 2 D .K0 /1=2 cosh t sin sin sin '; y 3 D .K0 /1=2 cosh t sin cos ; y 4 D .K0 /1=2 cosh t cos ; y 5 D .K0 /1=2 sinh t I 2. (i) D4 WD f.; ; '; t/ W 0 < < ; 0 < < ; <'<; 1 < t < 1g: b D Arc sin r; b ; b ' D .; '/; b tD Z dt I a.t/ b a b t WD a.t/: 6.1 Big Bang Models 439 (ii) The coordinate transformation and its inverse (for cosb C cosb t ¤ 0) are furnished by 2 sin b ; r# D cosb C cosb t # # ;' D b ; b ' ; 2 sinb t t# D cosb C cosb t and, ı b D r #; t # ; b ; b ' D . # ; ' # /; ı b t D t r #; t # ; b a.b t/ DW a# .t # /: (See the reference of Stephani [238].) 4. (i) Field equations (6.47iii) can be integrated to obtain Z d C ln a3 D const. Œ C P./ (ii) From part (i), it can be deduced that dM./ M./ D > 0: d Œ C P./ Since Œ C P./1 is continuous for > 0; there exists a unique, inverse function M1 which (See [32].) Thus, it can be concluded is differentiable. that D M1 m0 a3 : Substituting the last equation into the field equation (6.47ii), it follows that (for aP > 0) aP D p .=3/ a2 M1 .m0 a3 / k0 > 0: 5. Use a space–time diagram and the chart of metric (6.7i) with k0 D 0. Note that nearby t-coordinate lines represent stream lines for the two adjacent fluid elements (or galaxies). Also, consider the equation for a null (massless) particle, ds 2 D 0, on a null trajectory on the same space–time diagram and, for simplicity, consider motion in the r direction only. This equation can be integrated to obtain the trajectory, r.t/, for a massless particle. By plotting two nearby fluid (galaxy) 440 6 Cosmology stream lines, and a null trajectory originating from a point on one of these stream lines, note that the null trajectory can cross the other galaxy’s stream line at a later time and hence will overtake the other galaxy. 6. Denoting by f 0 .r/ WD dfdr.r/ , etc., the nontrivial field equations are [62] " .a/ P 2 C k0 2aR C a a2 " .a/ P 2 C k0 3 a2 # # k1 f 0 .r/ D 0; 2r a2 k1 Œr f .r/0 D .r; t/; r 2 a2 k1 r f .r/ 2a2 r2 P C 0 D ˛.r; t/; aP .3 C ˛/ D 0; a ˛0 C 2˛ D 0: r 6.2 Scalar Fields in Cosmology This section may be considered optional for an introductory curriculum. In the preceding section, we encountered the cosmological constant that Einstein introduced and later withdrew from the field equations. The cosmological constant can be interpreted as a constant-valued scalar field. Hoyle and Narlikar [135] introduced a scalar C -field in cosmology for steady-state models. Das and Agrawal [57] investigated (1) a massless, real scalar field and (2) a massive, real scalar field in F–L–R–W universes. Today, various types of scalar fields are commonplace in many studies of cosmology. Now, let us discuss the case of a massless, real scalar field, .x/, in general relativity. The coupled scalar and gravitational field equations are the following: Eij .x/ WD Gij .x/ C Tij .x/ D 0; (6.68i) Tij ./ WD ri rj .1=2/ gij ./ r k rk ; (6.68ii) ./ WD r i ri D 0; j Ti ./ WD rj T i D 0; C i gij ; @k gij D 0: (6.68iii) (6.68iv) (6.68v) 6.2 Scalar Fields in Cosmology 441 Eight differential identities in the system above are j rj E i Ti ./; (6.69i) Ti ./ ./ ri 0: (6.69ii) Let us count the number of unknown functions versus the number of independent equations. No. of unknown functions: 10 gij C 1./ D 11: No. of equations: 10 Eij D 0 C 1. D 0/ C 4 .Ti D 0/ C 4 C i D 0 D 19: j No. of differential identities: 4 rj E i Ti C 4 .Ti ri 0/ D 8: No. of independent equations: 11: Thus, the system of equations (6.68i–v) is determinate. Now, consider the F–L–R–W metric in (6.7i–iii). For convenience, we rewrite it here: n 1 o ds 2 D Œa.t/2 1 k0 r 2 .dr/2 C r 2 .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 .dt/2 ; (6.70i) p 1=2 g D r 2 1 k0 r 2 sin a3 : (6.70ii) Field equations (6.68i,ii), for the metric (6.70i), yield 1 E˛4 ./ D @˛ @4 D 0; (6.71i) 1 E12 ./ D @1 @2 D 0; (6.71ii) 1 E23 ./ D @2 @3 D 0; (6.71iii) 1 E31 ./ D @3 @1 D 0; (6.71iv) @˛ G ij 0: (6.71v) Therefore, a time-dependent, nonconstant scalar field ./ must satisfy @˛ 0; (6.72i) P WD @4 ¤ 0: (6.72ii) 442 6 Cosmology The scalar wave equation ./ D 0 in (6.68iii) with the F–L–R–W metric of (6.70i) reduces to a3 P D 0; (6.73i) P D c1 D nonzero const. Œa.t/3 .t/ or, Z .t/ D c1 or, Œa.t/3 dt: (6.73ii) (6.73iii) Here, c1 ¤ 0 is the arbitrary constant of integration. The field equation E 44 ./ D 0 provides " # .a/ P 2 C k0 2 3 P D 0: (6.74) 2 a 2 Using (6.73ii) and (6.74), we obtain that P 2 D .=6/ c12 k0 a4 > 0; a4 .a/ Za q or, a1 where, y 2 dy .=6/ c12 k0 y 4 D t t1 ; a1 D a .t1 / : (6.75i) (6.75ii) (6.75iii) Equations (6.75ii,iii) and (6.73ii) yield general solutions of all field equations and the wave equation implicitly. Equations (6.75ii) and (6.73iii) provide, in the flat F–L–R–W case with k0 D 0; if we choose the constants t1 D a1 D 0; the following explicit solutions: h p i1=3 a.t/ D 3 =6 jc1 j .t/1=3 ; .t/ D .1=3/ p 6= sgn .c1 / ln jtj: (6.76i) (6.76ii) The equations above yield a big bang model of cosmology. The integral in the left-hand side of (6.75ii) can be furnished explicitly for the cases k0 D C1 and k0 D 1: The following equations provide those scenarios. In case k0 D 1; (6.75ii) implies that h h i 1=4 i 1=4 E Arc sin 6= c12 a ; 1 F Arc sin 6= c12 a ; 1 1=4 t C const. D c12 =6 (6.77i) 6.2 Scalar Fields in Cosmology 443 Here, EŒ; and F Œ; are elliptic functions [91]. In case k0 D 1; we can deduce that h i h i 1=4 1=4 E i Arg sinh 6= c12 a ; 1 C F i Arg sinh 6= c12 a ; 1 1=4 t C const: D c12 =6 (6.77ii) Now, we shall investigate the real, massive scalar field (of mass m) in general relativity. The field equations and conservation equations are furnished by Eij .x/ WD Gij ./ C Tij ./ D 0; (6.78i) Tij ./ WD ri rj .1=2/ gij ./ r k rk C m2 2 D 0; (6.78ii) ./ WD r i ri m2 ./ D 0; (6.78iii) j Ti ./ WD rj T i D 0; (6.78iv) C i gij ; @k gij D 0: (6.78v) The eight differential identities existing in the system are the following: j rj E i Ti ./; (6.79i) Ti ./ ./ ri : (6.79ii) Thus, the system of partial differential equations (6.78i–v) is determinate. Let us now investigate the invariant eigenvalue problem for the 4 4 energy– momentum–stress matrix ŒTij ./ from (6.78ii). Theorem 6.2.1. Let the real, differentiable, massive scalar field .x/ in (6.77i,ii) satisfy g ij ./ ri rj < 0 in D R4 : Then, the 4 4 energy–momentum–stress matrix ŒTij .x/ is of the Segre characteristic Œ.1; 1; 1/; 1 in D R4 : Proof. The assumption g ij ./ ri rj < 0 implies that r i (6.78ii), it can be deduced that @ @x i Tij ./ r j D .1=2/ r k rk m2 2 ./ gij ./ r j : E ¤ 0.x/: By (6.80) 444 6 Cosmology ˚ At each x 2 D; there exist three other spacelike vectors such that Es.1/ .x/; Es.2/ .x/; Es.3/ .x/; r i @i is an orthogonal basis set for the tangent vector space at x: Therefore, it follows that j s.˛/ ./ rj 0; (6.81i) j j Tij ./ s.˛/ ./ D .1=2/ r k rk C m2 2 gij ./ s.˛/ ./: (6.81ii) Thus, four invariant eigenvalues are given by .1/ ./ .2/ ./ .3/ ./ D .1=2/ r k rk C m2 2 ; .4/ ./ D .1=2/ r k rk m2 2 : (6.82) Therefore, the theorem is proven. Remark: By Theorems 6.1.2 and 6.2.1, the energy–momentum–stress tensor of a massive, real scalar field is algebraically compatible to F–L–R–W metrics of (6.70i). Let us investigate field equations (6.78i–iii) and the conservation equation (6.78iv) using F–L–R–W metrics in (6.70i). Equations (6.71i–v) are still valid. Therefore, for a nonconstant scalar field, we must choose @˛ 0; P WD @4 ¤ 0; which are the same as in (6.72i,ii). The massive scalar field equation (6.78iii) yields or, 3 a P C m2 a3 .t/ D 0; 3 a P C a3 R C m2 D 0: (6.83i) (6.83ii) Equation (6.83ii) is a linear, ordinary differential equation for the function .t/ and also for the function Œa.t/3 : Integrating (6.83ii), we obtain 8 # 9 Zt " R = < .y/ C m2 .y/ dy ; a.t/ D a1 exp .1=3/ P ; : .y/ t1 a1 D a.t1 /: (6.84) Field equations E 11 ./ D 0 and E 44 ./ D 0, from (6.78i,ii) with F–L–R–W metrics in (6.70i), yield 6.2 Scalar Fields in Cosmology " E 11 ./ D .a/ P 2 C k0 2aR C a a2 " E 44 ./ 445 .a/ P 2 C k0 D3 a2 # C .=2/ # .=2/ h 2 i P m2 ./2 D 0; h 2 i P C m2 ./2 D 0: (6.85i) (6.85ii) The Raychaudhuri equation (6.49i,ii) implies that a.t/ R D 2 i h 2 P a.t/: m ..t//2 2 .t/ 6 (6.86) The above equation shows that in the right hand side of (6.86), the term 2 P m2 ..t//2 causes repulsion, but the term 2 .t/ produces attraction! Rainich showed [213] how to eliminate electromagnetic field components from the Einstein–Maxwell equations (2.290i–iv) and write an equivalent system involving only the metric tensor and its derivatives. In the much easier setting of the coupled F–L–R–W and scalar field equations (6.82) and (6.85i,ii), we shall accomplish a similar goal by eliminating the ./ field. First, we take linear combinations of (6.85i) and (6.85ii) to derive # " aR .a/ P 2 C k0 D .=2/ m2 2 > 0; C2 a a2 (6.87i) 2 .a/ P 2 C k0 aR D .=2/ P > 0: 2 a a (6.87ii) Extracting square roots of both of the above equations, differentiating the first one and eliminating P from both, we deduce that ( aP 2 C k0 aR C2 a a2 1=2 ) m aP 2 C k0 a2 aR a 1=2 D 0: (6.88) The above nonlinear equation is equivalent to the system (6.83i) and (6.85i,ii). Clearly, (6.88) is formidable. However, in the case of a flat F–L–R–W metric, with k0 D 0; it is possible to simplify (6.88). Recall the Hubble function H.t/ of (6.60i). Its derivative is provided by 2 P D aR aP : H (6.89) a a Therefore, (6.88), in the k0 D 0 case, reduces to q p P D 0: P C 3.H/2 m H H (6.90) 446 6 Cosmology The above equation is a nonlinear, autonomous, second-order equation. We make the usual substitution: P < 0; GŒH WD H R D GŒH G 0 ŒH: H (6.91i) (6.91ii) Then, (6.90) reduces to the first-order o.d.e.: p 1 fG.H/ G 0 ŒH C 6H GŒHg p m G.H/ D 0: 2 GŒH C 3.H/2 (6.92) We have to solve the above equation for the function GŒH. At this stage, only numerical solutions seem to be possible. (Note that in the lim m ! 0C , (6.92) reduces drastically to G 0 ŒH C 6ŒH D 0; and the solutions (6.76i,ii) can be recovered.) Now, we shall introduce the quintessence scalar field to explain the phenomenon of dark energy in the cosmological universe. (For a thorough mathematical analysis, see [76].) Dark energy is the generic name given to the “material” which is thought to cause a repulsive acceleration of the expansion of the universe [225]. (An indepth study of quintessence related to cosmic acceleration may be found in [174].) The coupled perfect fluid (of (2.257i,ii)) and quintessence scalar field equations in general relativity are furnished by [76]: Eij .x/ WD Gij ./ C Tij ./ D 0; (6.93i) Tij ./ WD ./ C p./ Ui ./ Uj ./ C p./ gij ./ C ri rj .1=2/ gij ./ r k rk C 2V ./ ; (6.93ii) j Ti ./ WD rj T i D 0; (6.93iii) U./ WD U i ./ Ui ./ C 1 D 0; (6.93iv) ./ WD r i ri V 0 ./ D 0; (6.93v) K./ WD r i Œ. C p/ Ui U i ./ ri p D 0; (6.93vi) j Fi ./ WD . C p/ U j rj Ui C ı i C U j Ui rj p D 0; (6.93vii) C i gij ; @k gij D 0: (6.93viii) Here, V ./ is a scalar function of known as the scalar field potential. 6.2 Scalar Fields in Cosmology 447 The corresponding differential and algebraic identities are the following: j rj E i Ti ./; U i Ti C K./ U i ri ./ 0; j Fi ./ ı i C U j Ui Tj rj : (6.94i) (6.94ii) (6.94iii) Remark: Physically speaking, it is obvious from (6.93i–viii) that the dark energy (represented by the scalar field .x/) does not interact directly with the perfect fluid. The only interaction is via the metric, or equivalently, the interaction is strictly gravitational. Now, we shall count the number of unknown functions versus the number of independent equations. No. of unknown functions: 10.gij /C1./C1.p/C4.U i /C1./C1.V .// D 18: No. of equations: 10.Eij D 0/ C 4.Ti D 0/ C 1.U D 0/ C 1. D 0/ C1.K D 0/ C 4.Fi D 0/ C 4.C i D 0/ D 25: No. of identities: j 4 rj E i Ti C1 U i Ti C K .U i ri / 0 j C4 Fi ı i CU j Ui Tj rj 0 D 9: No. of independent equations: 25 9 D 16: The system of partial differential equations is clearly underdetermined. We can impose one equation of state (as in (2.258)). The system still remains underdetermined with one degree of freedom. Therefore, we can prescribe one of the unknown functions; for example, V ./; or else, the expansion function a.t/, in order to render the system determinate. We shall now explore the invariant eigenvalues of the 4 4 matrix Tij .x/ from the definition (6.93ii). We assume that the scalar field .x/ is nonconstant or, in E other words, the vector field r i @x@ i ¤ 0.x/: We choose an orthonormal basis set ˚ E Es.1/ .x/; Es.2/ .x/; Es.3/ .x/; U.x/ : We obtain from (6.93ii) and the orthonormal basis vectors that ˚ T ji U j D C .1=2/ r k rk C V ./ U i C U j rj r i ; (6.95i) ˚ T ji r j D . C p/ Uj r j U i C p C .1=2/ r k rk V ./ r i ; (6.95ii) i h i j j C rj s.˛/ r i : (6.95iii) T ji s.˛/ D p .1=2/ r k rk V ./ s.˛/ 448 6 Cosmology E Es.˛/ ./; r i @x@ i are eigenvectors in the It is obvious that none of the vectors U./; general setting. However, in special cases, some of these vectors are eigenvectors, as will be shown in the following theorem. (See [76].) Theorem 6.2.2. Let field equations (6.93i,ii) hold in a domain D R4 : Let an ˚ E orthonormal basis set Es.1/ .x/; Es.2/ .x/; Es.3/ .x/; U.x/ exist in the same domain. @ i E Moreover, let r @x i D l .x/ U.x/ for some nonzero, differentiable scalar field l .x/: Then, the 4 4 energy–momentum–stress matrix Tij .x/ of (6.93ii) must be of Segre characteristic Œ.1; 1; 1/; 1: Proof. Using (6.93ii) and (6.95i–iii) it follows that i j T ij s.˛/ D p .1=2/ r k rk V ./ s.˛/ i DW .˛/ s.˛/ ; (6.96i) T ij U j D .1=2/ r k rk C V ./ U i DW .4/ U i : (6.96ii) Remarks: (i) Three repeated eigenvalues .˛/ D p .1=2/ r k rk V ./ consist of the fluid pressure plus the isotropic pressure due to the scalar field. (ii) The negative of the fourth eigenvalue .4/ D .1=2/ r k rk C V ./ denotes the energy density of the fluid plus the energy density of the scalar field. Thus, the theorem is proven. Now, we shall study the F–L–R–W universes containing a perfect fluid and the quintessence scalar field. We employ the usual comoving coordinate frame. The relevant assumptions are n 1 o ds 2 D Œa.t/2 1 k0 r 2 .dr/2 C r 2 .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 .dt/2 ; (6.97i) U ˛ ./ 0; @˛ 0; U 4 ./ 1; (6.97ii) @./ ¤ 0: P WD @t (6.97iii) The nontrivial field equations from (6.93i–vi) reduce to ./ D a3 a3 P C V 0 ./ D 0; " E 11 ./ D .a/ P 2 C k0 2aR C a a2 # i h 2 C p C .1=2/ P V ./ D 0; (6.98i) (6.98ii) 6.2 Scalar Fields in Cosmology " E 44 ./ .a/ P 2 C k0 D3 a2 # 449 h i 2 C .1=2/ P C V ./ D 0; K./ D P C 3 . C p/ ln jaj D 0: The Raychaudhuri equation in (6.86) generalizes into o n 2 aR D .=6/ . C 3p/ C 2 P 2V ./ a: (6.98iii) (6.98iv) (6.99) 2 In the equation above, C 3p C 2 P > 0 contributes to gravitational attraction. However, the term 2V ./ > 0 enhances repulsive gravitation! Thus, the dark energy (in the form of the potential term V ./) accelerates the expansion. Linear combinations of field equations (6.98ii) and (6.98iii) are easier to investigate. These are furnished by " .a/ P 2 C k0 a2 # 2 i aR h ; D C p C P a 2 " # aR .a/ P 2 C k0 C2 p C 2V ./ : D 2 a a 2 (6.100i) (6.100ii) Firstly, we explore the inflationary scenario with ./ D p./ 0: We shall cite some exact solutions of (6.100i,ii) with these special assumptions. The first example is that of an exponential expansion (similar to that of (6.57)). It is provided for the case k0 D 1 as a.t/ D et ; p .t/ D 2= et ; V ./ D 1 3 C ./2 : (6.101i) (6.101ii) (6.101iii) Another exact solution is furnished for cos-hyperbolic expansion as a.t/ D .2/1=2 cosh t; .t/ D .2=/1=2 Arc sin.tanh t/; hp n io V ./ D 1 3 C 2 cos2 =2 : (6.102i) (6.102ii) (6.102iii) 450 6 Cosmology Now, we shall investigate the matter phase scenario for the coupled field equations (6.98i–iv). The system simplifies here by neglecting the fluid pressure therefore setting p./ 0: The continuity equation (6.98iv) can be readily integrated to obtain .=6/ .t/ Œa.t/3 D M0 D positive const. (6.103) Physically speaking, M0 is proportional to the component of the total mass of the universe which is not attributable to the scalar field .t/: In this phase, using (6.103), other field equations (6.100i,ii) reduce to " # .a/ P 2 C k0 3M0 aR V ./ DW V .t/ D C 2 3 ; a a2 a " # 2 .a/ P 2 C k0 aR 3M0 P .=2/ .t/ D 3 > 0: a2 a a # (6.104i) (6.104ii) (In case a.t/ is prescribed, .t/ can be obtained by integration of (6.104ii). Moreover, the function V # .t/ can be determined from (6.104i). Thus, the function V ./ can be expressed parametrically in terms of t:) Now, we shall cite an exact solution of the system (6.104i,ii). It is characterized by the following power law of expansion: a.t/ D 1 C .t/nC2 ; n > 0; (6.105i) " V # .t/ D .n C 2/2 t 2.nC1/ C k0 .n C 1/ .n C 2/ t n C 2 .1 C t nC2 / .1 C t nC2 /2 Z p =2 Œ.t/ 1 D t1 t (" .n C 2/2 y 2.nC1/ C k0 # 3M0 ; .1 C t nC2 /3 (6.105ii) # .1 C y nC2 /2 3M0 .n C 1/ .n C 2/ y n nC2 .1 C y / .1 C y nC2 /3 ) 1=2 dy: (6.105iii) Caution: In the integral above, the interval .t1 ; t/ is to be carefully chosen so that the “curly bracket” inside the integrand is nonnegative. Before proceeding, we shall furnish an example illustrating the utility of the initial value formalism introduced in Sect. 2.4. Example 6.2.3. We consider the evolution of a constant quintessence scalar field in an otherwise empty, spatially flat (k0 D 0) FLRW space–time. Recall that the line element of such a space–time is given by (6.9) as 6.2 Scalar Fields in Cosmology 451 ds 2 D Œa.t/2 ı˛ˇ .dx ˛ / .dx ˇ / .dt/2 ; x 2 D WD D .t0 ; t1 / R4 : The scenario will be one of exponential expansion, a.t/ D et . Since the scalar field is constant, the only contribution to the energy–momentum–stress tensor is from the (constant) potential function V .0 /. (Refer to (6.93ii). Note that this is equivalent to a vacuum solution with a cosmological constant.) For this, we choose a value V .0 / D 3=. The initial data on the surface t D t0 is as follows: # g˛ˇ .x/ D e2t0 ı˛ˇ ; ˛ˇ D 2e2t0 ı˛ˇ ; i .x/ D 3 3 # ı4i ; T˛ˇ .x/ D e2t0 ı˛ˇ : It can be shown that the above initial data satisfies the constraints of (2.251) on the initial hypersurface and that the scalar field equation of motion (6.93v) is trivially satisfied. (Compare with Problem #5 of Exercises 2.4) The Einstein equations can be solved analytically for the scale factor a.t/. (In fact, it is very simple to do so in this case.) However, here, we wish to utilize the initial value formalism of Sect. 2.4 and compare it to the analytic solution. This example is another illustration of how to utilize the initial value scheme, and its simplicity allows us to test the scheme’s convergence properties to an exact analytic result. To solve for the scale factor, it is sufficient to just evolve one nonzero # component of g˛ˇ .x/, as all nonzero components of g˛ˇ in this case are equal to the scale factor squared. With the above information, we can form the Taylor series for g ˛ˇ .x/ as in (2.252) (utilizing the previous formalism in that section for the higher order time derivatives of the metric on the initial surface). The results are displayed in Fig. 6.4 where the dotted lines indicate the approximation at quadratic, cubic, and quartic order in .t t0 / of the Taylor series. The solid line in the figure represents the analytic result a2 .t/ D e2t . One can see that retaining higher-order terms in the expansion yields better agreement with the analytic result. Now, we shall discuss what is often called the tachyonic scalar field (or BornInfeld scalar field), denoted by ˚, gravitationally coupled with a perfect fluid. (See [76, 232, 233].) The general relativistic field equations are governed by the following: E ij .x/ WD G ij ./ C T ij ./ D 0; (6.106i) T ij ./ WD Œ./ C p./ U i ./ Uj ./ C p./ ı ij C V .˚/ h 1=2 i 1=2 i i 1 C r k ˚ rk ˚ r ˚ rj ˚ 1 C r k ˚ rk ˚ ıj ; (6.106ii) j Ti ./ WD rj T i D 0; (6.106iii) 452 6 Cosmology 70 60 50 a^2(t) 40 30 20 10 1 1.2 1.4 1.6 t 1.8 2 quadratic cubic quartic analytic Fig. 6.4 Comparison of the square of the cosmological scale factor, a2 .t /. The dotted lines represent the numerically evolved Cauchy data utilizing the scheme outlined in Sect. 2.4 to various orders in t t0 (quadratic, cubic, quartic). The solid line represents the analytic result .e2t / U./ WD U i ./ Ui ./ C 1 D 0; h i 1=2 ri ˚ ./ WD r i V .˚/ 1 C r k rk ˚ (6.106iv) 1=2 D 0; V 0 .˚/ 1 C r k ˚ rk ˚ (6.106v) K./ WD r i Œ. C p/ Ui U i ./ ri p D 0; (6.106vi) j Fi ./ WD . C p/ U j rj Ui C ı i C U j Ui rj p D 0; (6.106vii) C i gij ; @k gij D 0: (6.106viii) Algebraic and differential identities are provided by j rj E i Ti ./; (6.107i) U i Ti C K./ U i ri ˚ ./ 0; (6.107ii) j Fi ./ ı i C U j Ui Tj rj ˚ ./ : (6.107iii) 6.2 Scalar Fields in Cosmology 453 Just like with the quintessence scalar field, the system of the coupled perfect fluid and tachyonic fluid field equations is underdetermined (by two degrees of freedom).4 Let us now work out the invariant eigenvalue problem for the 4 4 energy– ˚ E be an ormomentum–stress matrix T ij .x/ : Let Es.1/ .x/; Es.2/ .x/; Es.3/ .x/; U.x/ thonormal basis field. For the purpose of cosmological applications, we restrict to E E the case for which r i ˚ @x@ i D l .x/ U.x/ ¤ 0.x/: Thus, we can deduce from (6.106ii) that h 1=2 i i j T ij ./ s.˛/ ./ D p./ V .˚/ 1 C r k ˚ rk ˚ s.˛/ ./; (6.108i) h 1=2 i U i ./: T ij ./ U j ./ D ./ C V .˚/ 1 C r k ˚ rk ˚ (6.108ii) Therefore, in the restricted case, the invariant eigenvalues are 1=2 .1/ ./ .2/ ./ .3/ ./ D p./ V .˚/ 1 C r k ˚ rk ˚ ; h 1=2 i .4/ ./ D ./ C V .˚/ 1 C r k ˚ rk ˚ : (6.109i) (6.109ii) Clearly, the Segre characteristic is given by Œ.1; 1; 1/; 1: We now impose the F–L–R–W metric and the comoving frame of (6.97i–iii). The coupled field equations (6.106i,iii,v,vi) reduce to " E 11 .t/ D .a/ P 2 C k0 2aR C a a2 " E 44 .t/ 4 .a/ P 2 C k0 D3 a2 # # 2 1=2 D 0; (6.110i) C p V .˚/ 1 ˚P 2 1=2 D 0; C V .˚/ 1 ˚P (6.110ii) The scalar field component of the energy–momentum–stress tensor (6.106ii) and the equation of p motion in (6.106v) may be derived from a Lagrangian density of the form L˚ D g V .˚/ p 1 C r i ˚ ri ˚ , which is inspired by the “square-root” particle Lagrangian of classical special p relativistic mechanics of the form L.v/ D m 1 ı˛ˇ v˛ vˇ . However, the tachyonic scalar field ˚ is also utilized in string theory, and some string theoretic arguments place extra restrictions on V .˚/ which need to be enforced if the solutions are to decribe the phenomenon of tachyon condensation. (See [154, 232, 233].) 454 6 Cosmology 2 1=2 .t/ D a3 a3 V .˚/ 1 ˚P ˚P 2 1=2 0 V .˚/ D 0; C 1 ˚P (6.110iii) K.t/ D P C 3 . C p/ ln jaj D 0: (6.110iv) P 2 0.) (It is assumed that 1 .˚/ The Raychaudhuri equation is furnished by ( " 2 1=2 2 1 ˚P aR D a C 3p C V .˚/ ˚P 6 #) 2 1=2 2 1 ˚P : (6.111) Now, we explore a special class of tachyonic inflationary phases by setting .t/ D p.t/ 0: Linear combinations of field equations (6.110i,ii) lead to 2 1=2 .a/ P 2 C k0 2aR C V .˚/ 1 ˚P D ; a a2 # " 2 2 1=2 C k . a/ P 0 : D3 V .˚/ 1 ˚P a2 (6.112i) (6.112ii) We now provide some special solutions of (6.112i,ii). (Recall the footnote on page 453.) Exponential inflation for the case of k0 D 1 is furnished by a.t/ D et ; r ˚.t/ D V .˚/ D (6.113i) ˇ ˇp ˇ 1 C e2t 1 ˇ 1 ˇ ˇ ln ˇ p ˇ; ˇ 1 C e2t C 1 ˇ 6 h i1=2 p p p 3 cosh 3=2 ˚ 2 C cosh2 3=2 ˚ : (6.113ii) (6.113iii) The cos-hyperbolic inflation for k0 D 1 is provided by the (simpler) equations a.t/ D cosh t; (6.114i) ˚.t/ D ˚0 D const.; (6.114ii) V .˚/ D 3: (6.114iii) 6.2 Scalar Fields in Cosmology 455 Now, we shall touch upon the tachyonic-scalar matter phase. In this regime, we adopt the assumption of an incoherent dust plus the scalar field. Therefore, the continuity equation (6.110iv) yields the same integration constant M0 > 0 as in (6.103). Thus, the coupled field equations (6.110i,ii) reduce to # " #1 " 2 2 2 . a/ P 3M C k C k . a/ P a R 2M 0 0 0 0 ˚P D .2=3/ 3 3 ; a2 a a a2 a (6.115i) " # " # 2 .a/ P 2 C k0 .a/ P 2 C k0 2M0 2aR # V .t/ D 3 C 3 : a2 a a a2 (6.115ii) Here, we have tacitly assumed that .a/ P 2 C k0 2M0 > 3 ; 2 a a (6.116i) 3M0 .a/ P 2 C k0 aR > 3 : 2 a a a (6.116ii) We shall now provide an exact solution of the system in (6.115i,ii) involving the following power law of expansion: a.t/ D t nC2 ; n > 0; (6.117i) ıp # ıp 3 V .t/ DW 3 V Œ˚.t/ ( 2M0 .n C 2/2 t 2.nC1/ C k0 3.nC2/ D t 2.nC2/ t 2.n C 1/.n C 2/ .n C 2/2 t 2.nC1/ C k0 C 2 t t 2.nC2/ ) 1=2 ; (6.117ii) r ˚.t/ ˚1 D 2 3 Zt t1 k0 y nC2 C .n C 2/2 y 3nC4 3M0 k0 y nC2 C .n C 2/2 y 3nC4 2M0 1=2 dy: (6.117iii) Caution: In the integral above, the interval .t1 ; t/ is to be so chosen that the “curly bracket” inside the integral remains nonnegative. 456 6 Cosmology In Sects. 6.1 and 6.2, we have dealt many times with the conformally flat F–L– R–W metrics. A more in-depth analysis of conformally flat space–times is provided in Appendix 4. 6.3 Five-Dimensional Cosmological Models This section lies outside the main focus of this chapter and may be considered optional for an introductory curriculum. Theoretical and observational difficulties with standard F–L–R–W big bang models can be partially resolved in cosmological models with a period of inflation (either exponential or cos-hyperbolic). Inflationary models contain self-interacting scalar fields coupled with gravity. Of particular interest in elementary particle physics are scalars that are known as Higgs fields [120, 178]. Section 6.2 dealt with models involving various different scalar fields. Here, we present another popular extension to standard cosmology, namely, the addition of extra spatial dimensions. Coincident with the renewal of interest sparked by inflationary models, there has been a revival of Kaluza-Klein theory which was an attempt at unifying gravity with electromagnetic fields in a five-dimensional “space–time.” (For a review of the topic, consult [6, 12].) Also, modern string theories [117, 274] employ ten-dimensional or eleven-dimensional differential manifolds. There are some cosmological implications of these higher dimensional theories. (See, e.g., [108, 167], and references therein.) However, we shall restrict ourselves in this section only to the five-dimensional manifold for the sake of simplicity and as an introduction to higher dimensional models. We consider a five-dimensional pseudo-Riemannian signature manifold M5 with e R5 : C3: In a general coordinate chart, we denote y D y 1 ; y 2 ; y 3 ; y 4 ; y 5 2 D The capital Roman indices take values from f1; 2; 3; 4; 5g with the usual summation convention over repeated indices. We consider the coupled Einstein equations (five-dimensional now) with a massless scalar field and no fluid in the five-dimensional arena [111] in what follows: e g:: .y/ WD e g AB .y/ dy A ˝ dy B ; (6.118i) eB .1=2/ e eC r eC D 0; (6.118ii) e eA r e AB .y/ C e r g AB ./ r E AB .y/ WD G eB D 0: eA r e.y/ WD e g AB .y/ r (6.118iii) Here, e is the “five-dimensional” gravitational constant. The simplest, nontrivial five-dimensional models (compatible with the previous equations (6.7i) and (6.70i)) are furnished by the metric: 6.3 Five-Dimensional Cosmological Models 457 2 2 e g:: ./ D a x 4 1 C .k0 =4/ ı x x ı˛ˇ dx ˛ ˝ dx ˇ 2 dx 4 ˝ dx 4 C ˇ x 4 dx 5 ˝ dx 5 ; (6.119i) n 1 o .dr/2 C r 2 .d/2 C sin2 .d'/2 .de s /2 D Œa.t/2 1 k0 r 2 ! /2 : .dt/2 C Œˇ.t/2 .de (6.119ii) ! ) in this chart, is Here, the fifth dimension, characterized by the coordinate x 5 (or e assumed to be homeomorphic to a (small) circle S 1 : Therefore, the five-dimensional pseudo-Riemannian manifold M5 is assumed to be locally homeomorphic to K3 R S 1 : (Here, K3 denotes a three-dimensional space of constant curvature.) The exterior radial function a.t/ > 0 and the interior radial function ˇ.t/ > 0 are scale factors which specify the “sizes” of the external three-dimensional space K3 and the internal compactified space S 1 (the fifth dimension), respectively, at the time t. To be consistent with observations at the present time t0 ; it must be that a.t P 0/ D da.t / > 0 and ˇ.t / must yield a diameter for the fifth dimension that is smaller 0 dt jt0 than what can be probed with current high-energy accelerator experiments. (The size of the extra dimension may even be as small as of the order of the Planck length, the smallest scale at which classical gravity is commonly believed to apply [175].) The metric in (6.119i,ii) admits locally seven independent Killing vectors including @x@ 5 @ : To be consistent with these isometries, we choose the scalar @e ! field to satisfy @˛ 0; @5 0; ./ D .t/; P ¤ 0: (6.120) The coupled field equations (6.118ii,iii), with the cosmological assumptions made in (6.119ii) and (6.120), boil down to the following nontrivial equations: " # .a/ P 2 C k0 1 e4 aR aP ˇP 5 e E 4 CE 5 D C2 D 0; C 3 a a2 a ˇ 2 1 e1 ˇR 3aR 3 E 1 2e C Ce P D 0; E 44 C e E 55 D 3 a ˇ h i 1 1 2 1 e E 44 e E 55 D 3 a3 ˇP D 0; E 11 C e 3 3 ˇ a ! ˇP 1 3 P P D 0: e./ D 3 a C a ˇ (6.121i) (6.121ii) (6.121iii) (6.121iv) 458 6 Cosmology Field equations (6.121iii) and (6.121iv) yield the following solutions as first integrals: Œa.t/3 Œˇ.t/ D c1 D const.; (6.122i) Œa.t/3 Œˇ.t/ Œ.t/ D c2 D const. (6.122ii) Here, c1 ¤ 0 and c2 ¤ 0 are otherwise arbitrary constants of integration. Hence, ˇ.t/ and .t/ are functionally dependent via the equations: ˇ.t/ D c3 exp Œ.c1 =c2 / .t/ ; ˚.ˇ.t// WD .t/; ˚.ˇ/ D .c2 =c1 / ln jˇ=c3 j: (6.123i) (6.123ii) (6.123iii) Here, c3 ¤ 0 is another arbitrary constant. Further simplifications result when the remaining field equations (6.122i) and (6.122ii) are rewritten with ˇ as the new independent variable instead of t: Using (6.122i), we convert derivatives as follows: A.ˇ.t// WD a.t/; a.t/ P D c1 ŒA.ˇ/3 A0 .ˇ/ ¤ 0: (6.124) Here, the prime denotes the derivative with respect to ˇ: Moreover, from (6.122i) and (6.123i–iii) we deduce that Œ.t/ D c2 ŒA.ˇ/3 .ˇ/1 : (6.125) Let us denote another function (related to the Hubble function) by the following: 0 h.ˇ/ WD ln jA.ˇ/j : (6.126) Hence, field equations (6.121i) and (6.121ii) reduce respectively to h0 .ˇ/ C 2 k0 =c12 ŒA.ˇ/4 C ˇ 1 h.ˇ/ D 0; (6.127i) h0 .ˇ/ 2 Œh.ˇ/2 ˇ 1 h.ˇ/ C .e =3/ .c2 =c1 /2 ˇ 2 D 0: (6.127ii) 6.3 Five-Dimensional Cosmological Models 459 Equation (6.127ii) can be integrated to obtain 1 C .ˇ=ˇ0 /4 1 ; 1 .ˇ=ˇ0 /4 2 ˇ ˇ ˇ h.ˇ/ C .1=2/ 1 2 ln .ˇ=ˇ0 / D ln ˇˇ 2 ˇ h.ˇ/ C .1=2/ C s c2 2 1 e WD C : 6 c1 4 h.ˇ/ D or, 1 ˇ Q c1 2 > 0; 3 c2 r 1 1 K C > : D 2 4 2 K WD (6.128i) ˇ ˇ ˇ; ˇ (6.128ii) (6.128iii) (6.128iv) (6.128v) (Here, ˇ0 is the nonzero, otherwise arbitrary constant of integration.) Next, we analyze the exact solutions in (6.128i–v) quite exhaustively. For that purpose, we introduce a couple of new functions to use in the sequel: .ˇ/ D ˇ h.ˇ/; (6.129) and 1 1 D ˇ h.ˇ/ C : (6.130) 2 2 We have mentioned after (6.119ii) that we choose ˇ > 0. Moreover, from physical considerations of the Hubble function in (6.126), we restrict h.ˇ/ > 0. Therefore, (6.129) and (6.130) yield z.ˇ/ WD .ˇ/ C .ˇ/ D ˇ h.ˇ/ > 0; z.ˇ/ D .ˇ/ C 1 1 > : 2 2 (6.131i) (6.131ii) Therefore, by choosing a sufficiently small positive constant " > 0, we can obtain the following estimates: .ˇ/ D " > 0; z.ˇ/ D 1 1 C"> : 2 2 (6.132i) (6.132ii) We shall next depict the qualitative graphs of the related two-dimensional mappings in Fig. 6.5 for a special function h.ˇ/ WD " ˇ 1 . 460 6 Cosmology ζ z 1 1 z(β) = 2 + ε > 2 ζ(β)=ε >0 β β h h (β)= ε β−1 β (rectangular hyperbola) Fig. 6.5 Qualitative graphs of two functions .ˇ/ and z.ˇ/ corresponding to the particular function h.ˇ/ WD " ˇ 1 In the general solutions in (6.128i–v), we choose the arbitrary constant ˇ0 D 1 (without jeopardizing the physical contents of the solutions.) Therefore, general solutions of (6.128i–v), with the new functions in (6.131i,ii), can be cast into the forms: 1 1 C ˇ4 1 h.ˇ/ D ; (6.133i) ˇ 1 ˇ4 2 .ˇ/ D ˇ h.ˇ/ D z.ˇ/ D .ˇ/ C 1 D 2 1 C ˇ4 1 ˇ4 1 C ˇ4 1 ˇ4 1 ; 2 (6.133ii) : (6.133iii) For the sake of graphing exact equations, we set the numerical values of two of the parameters as " D 0:1; (6.134i) D 0:6: (6.134ii) 6.3 Five-Dimensional Cosmological Models 461 Fig. 6.6 The qualitative graph of the function .ˇ/ for 0<ˇ<1 ζ (0+, 0.1) (1, 0) β Then, the function in (6.133ii) is explicitly furnished as .ˇ/ D 0:6 1 C ˇ 2:4 0:5; 1 ˇ 2:4 (6.135i) lim .ˇ/ D 0:1; (6.135ii) lim .ˇ/ ! 1: (6.135iii) ˇ!0C ˇ!1 Moreover, the derivative of the function .ˇ/ is provided by 0 .ˇ/ D 8 2 ˇ 4 1 d.ˇ/ 8 .0:6/2 ˇ 1:4 D D > 0; dˇ .ˇ 4 1/2 .ˇ 2:4 1/2 (6.136i) d.ˇ/ ! 1: dˇ (6.136ii) lim ˇ!1 With information for (6.135i–iii) and (6.136i,ii), we now plot the graph for the function .ˇ/ in Fig. 6.6. We note that the graph of .ˇ/ in the figure is positive-valued. Since .ˇ/ D ˇ h.ˇ/ is the product of the expansion parameter of the compact dimension and the Hubble parameter, such a behavior is expected. Furthermore, the function .ˇ/ in Fig. 6.6 does not reveal any critical point in the interval .0; 1/. We shall see later that this indicates that the function .ˇ/ implies monotonic expansion of the universe. However, let us investigate the general solutions in (6.128i) involving one parameter (with ˇ0 D 1). These are furnished by 462 6 Cosmology Fig. 6.7 Qualitative graphs of a typical function h.ˇ/ and the curve comprising of minima for the one-parameter family of such functions βm h(β m )=const. h(β) (β m ,h(β m )) 1 h.ˇ/ D ˇ (1, 0) ( βm , 0) (0, 0) 1 C ˇ4 1 ˇ4 1 : 2 β (6.137) Let us examine possible critical points of this class of Hubble functions h.ˇ/, expressed explicitly as functions of ˇ in (6.137). We obtain from (6.127ii) that h0 .ˇ/ D d .ˇ/ h.ˇ/ Q D 2Œh.ˇ/2 C dˇ ˇ ˇ 3 2 c1 c2 ˇ 2 D 0; ˇ 2 h0 .ˇ/ D 2 Œˇ h.ˇ/2 C Œˇ h.ˇ/ K: or, (6.138i) (6.138ii) For the critical points ˇm of the one-parameter family of functions in (6.137), we set h0 .ˇm / D 0 and thus deduce that 2 Œˇm h.ˇm /2 C Œˇm h.ˇm / D K: (6.139) Solving the above quadratic equation, we obtain the family of allowable minima as: r 2 ˇm h.ˇm / D 1 1 C2K D 4 2 r or, ˇm h.ˇm / D 2 r 4 1 3 D const. 16 4 2 3 1 ; 4 2 (6.140) We depict the behaviors of the function h.ˇ/ and the one-parameter family of minima in Fig. 6.7. 6.3 Five-Dimensional Cosmological Models 463 Now, we shall discuss general solutions of coupled field equations (6.121i–iv). In case h0 .ˇ/ is eliminated between (6.127i) and (6.127ii) (with k0 D 0), we can deduce the algebraic equation K ˇ 2 D 0; 2 K D 0: Œˇ h.ˇ/2 C ˇ h.ˇ/ 2 Œh.ˇ/2 C ˇ 1 h.ˇ/ or, (6.141i) (6.141ii) Solving the quadratic equation (6.141ii), and discarding the negative root, we derive, from (6.126), that ˇ h.ˇ/ D ˇ fln ŒA.ˇ/g0 D or, A.ˇ/ D C1 ˇ . 1=2/ 1 > 0; 2 (6.142i) : (6.142ii) Here, C1 > 0 is a positive, but otherwise arbitrary constant of integration. We now define a new parameter w via 1 1 C1 w WD 3 ; 2 w 2 .0; 1/ R: (6.143) The general solutions of field equations (6.12i–iv) (for the subcase k0 D 0) are furnished by h ˇ D b̌.t; w/ WD w .t t0 / C .ˇ0 /1=w h b w/ WD C1 A.ˇ/ D A.t; w iw ; .t t0 / C .ˇ0 /1=w (6.144i) i.1w/=3 ; ˇ ˇ c1 c1 ˇ ˇ b .t; w/ D w ln ˇ .t t0 / C .ˇ0 /1=w ˇ C 0 ln jˇ0 j: c2 w c2 (6.144ii) (6.144iii) Here, < 0 and C1 > 0 are arbitrary constants of integration. We can note the initial values from (6.144i–iii) as b̌.t0 ; w/ D ˇ0 ; b 0 ; w/ D C1 .ˇ0 / A.t 1=2 ; b .t0 ; w/ D 0 : (6.145) We compute the derivatives of the functions in (6.144i–iii) here as @ j j ˇP WD b̌.t; w/ D j j .t t0 / C .ˇ0 /1=w > 0; @t w (6.146i) 464 6 Cosmology Fig. 6.8 Graphs of evolutions of functions depicting the scale factors O w/. (Note AO.t; w/ and ˇ.t; that at late times the compact dimension expands at a slower rate than the noncompact dimensions) A(t,w) β(t,w) t @b 1w j j .t t0 / C .ˇ0 /1=w aP WD A.t; w/ D C1 j j @t 3w w wC2 3 > 0; (6.146ii) j j @ c1 .t t0 / C .ˇ0 /1=w P D b .t; w/ D j j @t c2 w 1 : (6.146iii) O w/ of the above equations are depicted in O w/ and ˇ.t; The time evolutions of A.t; Fig. 6.8. Remarks: (i) General solutions in (6.141i–iii) satisfy field equations b 0 ; w/ D (6.121i,iii,iv). The initial values satisfy b̌.t0 ; w/ D ˇ0 , A.t 1=2 b C1 .ˇ0 / , and .t0 ; w/ D 0 . b w/ (ii) In the solution in (6.141i), it is evident that the function a.t/ D A.t; increases monotonically and at late times increases at a greater rate than the function ˇ.t/ D b̌ .t; w/. (Compare to Fig. 6.8.) Therefore, in this five-dimensional cosmological model of the universe, the noncompact threedimensional submanifold is expanding in size at a greater rate than the compact one-dimensional submanifold! The fifth dimension may therefore be arbitrarily “small” compared to the usual three spatial dimensions. The different expansion rate of higher dimensions is often employed in theories such as Kaluza-Klein theory and string theory. Chapter 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations 7.1 The Petrov Classification of the Curvature Tensor Some background material for this chapter is covered in Appendix 3. Glancing through that appendix may be worthwhile before reading this chapter for those who would like a review. Let us recall the holonomic coordinate basis field f@i g41 or the nonholonomic ˚ 4 orthonormal basis field Ee.a/ .x/ 1 for a domain D R4 corresponding to a 4 ˚ coordinate chart of the space–time manifold. (The basis field Ee.a/ .x/ 1 is also called a tetrad field.) The relevant equations are obtained from (1.36), (1.97), (1.100), (1.101), and (1.103)–(1.105). We summarize these equations here for the suitable exposition of this chapter: gij .x/ WD g:: ./ @i ; @j gj i ./; (7.1i) g:: ./ D gij ./ dx i ˝ dx j D d.a/.b/ e e.a/ ./ ˝ e e.b/ ./; (7.1ii) g:: ./ D gij ./ @i ˝ @j D d .a/.b/ Ee.a/ ./ ˝ Ee.b/ ./; (7.1iii) g i k ./ gkj ./ D ı ij ; d .a/.c/ d.c/.b/ D ı .a/ .b/ : (7.1iv) The transformation rules from one basis set to another are summarized below: bk b E 0 @=@x i D @X ./ @ ; X @x i @b xk (7.2i) @X i ./ b e X0 .dx i / D db xj ; @b xj (7.2ii) .a/ b e e .a/ ./ D A .b/ ./ e e .b/ ./; A. Das and A. DeBenedictis, The General Theory of Relativity: A Mathematical Exposition, DOI 10.1007/978-1-4614-3658-4 7, © Springer Science+Business Media New York 2012 (7.2iii) 465 466 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations .b/ b Ee.a/ ./ D L .a/ ./ Ee.b/ ./; h .b/ .a/ ./ i A .a/ .b/ ./ L h i1 .a/ WD L .b/ ./ ; .c/ .e/ ./ d.a/.c/ L Ee.a/ ./ D i.a/ ./ @i ; D d.b/.e/ ; .a/ i ./ (7.2vi) Ee.a/ ./; dx i D i.a/ ./ e e .a/ ./; (7.2vii) (7.2viii) h i1 WD i.a/ ./ : (7.2ix) It follows from (7.1i–iv) and (7.2i–ix) that j d.a/.b/ D g:: ./ Ee.a/ ./; Ee.b/./ D gij ./ i.a/ ./ .b/ ./; (7.3i) .a/ i (7.2v) @i D .a/ e e .a/ ./ D i ./ dx i ; h (7.2iv) i ./ .a/ .a/ .b/ d .a/.b/ D g:: ./ e e ./;e e .b/ ./ D g ij ./ i ./ j ./; (7.3ii) .a/ .b/ gij ./ D g:: ./ @i ; @j D d.a/.b/ i ./ j ./; (7.3iii) j g ij ./ D g:: ./ dx i ; dx j D d .a/.b/ i.a/ ./ .b/ ./; .a/ ı ij D g:: ./ dx i ; @j D i.a/ ./ j ./ DW I: dx i ; @j ; .a/ .a/ .a/ .a/ e ./; Ee.b/./ D i ./ i.b/ ./ DW I: e e ./; Ee.b/./ : ı .b/ D g: e (7.3iv) (7.3v) (7.3vi) Here, I: ./ is the identity tensor field. Example 7.1.1. Consider the flat space–time manifold and the spherical polar spatial coordinate chart. The space–time metric is furnished by i 2 2 h g:: ./ D dx 1 ˝ dx 1 C x 1 dx 2 ˝ dx 2 C sin x 2 .dx 3 ˝ dx 3 / dx 4 ˝ dx 4 D d.a/.b/ e e .a/ ./ ˝ e e.b/ ./; i 2 2 h .@2 ˝ @2 / C sin x 2 .@3 ˝ @3 / .@4 ˝ @4 / g:: ./ D .@1 ˝ @1 / C x 1 D d .a/.b/ Ee.a/ ./ ˝ Ee.b/ ./; 2 4 g./ D x 1 sin x 2 < 0; ˚ D WD x 2 R4 W 0 < x 1 ; 0 < x 2 < ; < x 3 < ; 1 < x 4 < 1 : 7.1 The Petrov Classification of the Curvature Tensor 467 Transformations between the various basis sets are obtained as 1 1 Ee.1/ ./ D @1 ; Ee.2/ ./ D x 1 @2 ; Ee.3/ ./ D x 1 sin x 2 @3 ; Ee.4/ D @4 I e e .1/ ./ D dx 1 ; e e .2/ ./ D x 1 dx 2 ; e e .3/ ./ D x 1 sin x 2 dx 3 ; e e 4 ./ D dx 4 : Therefore, from (7.2vii) and (7.2viii), 4 4 diagonal transformation matrices are provided by 2 3 1 0 0 0 1 6 7 h i 0 07 6 0 x1 1 i.a/ ./ D 6 7; 1 40 05 0 x sin x 2 0 0 0 1 3 2 1 0 0 0 h i 1 6 0 07 0 x .a/ 7 i ./ D 6 4 0 0 x 1 sin x 2 0 5 : 0 0 0 1 Now, we shall introduce two null vector fields by p E 2 k./ WD Ee.4/ ./ C Ee.3/ ./; p 2 El./ WD Ee.4/ ./ Ee.3/ ./; E E k./ D 0; g:: ./ El./; El./ D g:: k./; E g:: ./ El./; k./ D 1: (7.4i) (7.4ii) (7.4iii) (7.4iv) n o E We depict the basis field Ee.1/ ./; Ee.2/ ./; El./; k./ ; involving two spacelike vector fields and two null vector fields in Fig. 7.1. To solve a wave equation in a space–time domain, it is convenient to use two null coordinates (as discussed in Example 2.1.17 and in (A2.26)). Moreover, in Appendix 2, we have used complex conjugate coordinates to solve elliptic partial differential equations. Furthermore, for the Petrov classification of the conformal tensor, the use of a tetrad consisting of two null vectors and two complex conjugate vectors is technically convenient. Therefore, we are motivated to introduce two complex conjugate null vector fields by the following: p E 2 m./ WD Ee.1/ ./ i Ee.2/ ./; p E 2 m./ D Ee.1/ ./ C i Ee.2/ ./; E E E E m./ D 0; g:: ./ m./; m./ D g:: ./ m./; E E m./ D 1: g:: ./ m./; E E E g:: .El./; m.// D g:: .k./; m.// D 0: (7.5i) (7.5ii) (7.5iii) (7.5iv) (7.5v) 468 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations e(4)(x) 2 l(x) 2 k(x) e(3)(x) x e(2)(x) e(1)(x) Fig. 7.1 A tetrad field containing two spacelike and two null vector fields E defined Thus, we can construct a complex null tetrad field together with El./; k./ in (7.4i,ii), by n o4 n o E E .a/ .x/ WD m./; El./; k./ E E E m./; ; (7.6i) E .a/ .x/ D i.a/ @i ; E (7.6ii) 1 j g.a/.b/ ./ D gij .::/ i.a/ ./ .b/ ./ D m.a/ ./ m.b/ ./ C m.b/ ./ m.a/ ./ l.a/ ./ k.b/ ./ l.b/ ./ k.a/ ./ DW .a/.b/ ; g .a/.b/ ./ D .a/.b/ ; .a/.b/ D .a/.b/ D 44 44 (7.6iii) (7.6iv) 3 2 01 610 6 4 0 0 7 7: 0 1 5 1 0 (7.6v) Here the transformation between the holonomic and the complex null basis sets is provided by i.a/ , as shown in (7.6ii). (Caution: The metric tensor components above must not be identified with components of the totally antisymmetric oriented tensor .a/.b/.c/.d / of (1.110i–iv)!) n Now, let us consider mappings of the complex null tetrad o n o b b b E E El./; k./ E El./; b E E E m./; into another m./; m./; k./ : These mappings, m./; 7.1 The Petrov Classification of the Curvature Tensor 469 by (7.2iv) and (7.2vi), must be mediated by linear combinations of elements of the Lorentz group 0.3; 1I R/: (See [55, 239].) Example 7.1.2. We shall consider special Lorentz mappings in 0.3; 1I R/ and consequent implications on the mappings of the complex null tetrads. Case (i): Rotations restricted to the two-dimensional vector subspace spanned by Ee.1/ .x/ and Ee.2/ .x/ in Fig. 7.1 are characterized by b Ee.1/ .x/ D Œcos .x/ Ee.1/ ./ sin Œ.x/ Ee.2/ ./; b Ee.2/ .x/ D Œsin .x/ Ee.1/ ./ C cos Œ.x/ Ee.2/ ./; b b b E E E E m.x/ D Œexp .i .x// m.x/; m.x/ D exp Œi.x/ m.x/: (7.7i) (Here, .x/ is a real-valued function.) Case (ii): Proper, orthochronous Lorentz mappings (boosts) in the two-dimensional vector subspace spanned by Ee.3/ .x/ and Ee.4/ .x/: The consequent induced mappings E on null vectors El.x/ and k.x/ are characterized by b El.x/ D e˛.::/ El.x/ ; b E E ; k.x/ D e˛.::/ k.x/ s 1 C v.::/ ˛.::/ e ; WD 1 v.::/ jv.::/j < 1: (7.7ii) The above transformation can be recognized as a variable boost. Case (iii): Null rotations, leaving the vector El.x/ invariant, induce the following mappings: b El.x/ D El.x/; b E E m.x/ D m.x/ C E.x/ El.x/; b E E E C E./ m./ E k.x/ D k./ C E./ m./ C E./ E./ El./: (Here, E.x/ is a complex-valued function.) (7.7iii) 470 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations E Case (iv): Null rotations, leaving the vector k.x/ invariant, induce the following mappings: b E E k.x/ D k.x/; b E E E m.x/ D m.x/ C B.x/ k.x/; b E El.x/ D El./ C B./ m./ E E C B./ m./ C B./ B./ k.x/: (7.7iv) (Here, B.x/ is a complex-valued function.) Now, we shall introduce the six-dimensional bivector space spanned by the set of all (real) 2-forms defined in the space–time manifold. (Recall that a general p-form and wedge products were dealt with in (1.45), (1.46), and (1.59), Example 1.2.18, ˚ 4 etc.) For this purpose, we can choose either the 1-form basis set dx i 1 or a dual ˚ .a/ 4 orthonormal basis set e e .x/ 1 : Such basis sets induce the following basis sets for the (real) bivector space: ˚ B WD dx 1 ^ dx 2 ; dx 1 ^ dx 3 ; dx 1 ^ dx 4 ; dx 2 ^ dx 3 ; dx 2 ^ dx 4 ; dx 3 ^ dx 4 ; (7.8i) ˚ .1/ B.0/ WD e e ./ ^e e.2/ ./; e e.1/ ./ ^e e.3/ ./; e e.1/ ./ ^e e.4/ ./ e e.2/ ./ ^e e.3/ ./; e e.2/ ./ ^e e.4/ ./; e e.3/ ./ ^e e.4/ ./ : (7.8ii) Remark: Note that there exist infinitely many more basis sets for the bivector fields! Let W:: .x/ be an arbitrary 2-form belonging to the bivector fields. It is expressible as a linear combination of basis bivectors in (7.8i) or (7.8ii). Therefore, it is permissible to write W:: .x/ D .1=2/ Wij ./ dx i ^ dx j D 4 X 4 X Wij ./ dx i ^ dx j ; 1i <j Wj i .x/ Wij .x/ I (7.9i) W:: .x/ D .1=2/ W.a/.b/./ e e.a/ ./ ^e e.b/ ./ D 4 X 4 X W.a/.b/./ e e.a/ ./ ^e e.b/ ./; 1a<b W.b/.a/ .x/ W.a/.b/ .x/: (7.9ii) The metric tensor g:: .x/ in (7.1i) and (7.1ii) induces a metric tensor g:::: .x/ of order .0 C 4/ for the bivector fields. (See [56, 210].) It is explicitly furnished by 7.1 The Petrov Classification of the Curvature Tensor g:::: .x/ WD 471 XX XX gij kl ./ dx i ^ dx j ˝ dx k ^ dx l ; 1i <j 1k<l gij kl .x/ WD gi k ./ gj l ./ gi l ./ gj k ./ I (7.10i) XX XX g:::: .x/ WD d.a/.b/.c/.d / e e.a/ ./ ^e e.b/ ./ ˝e e.c/ ./ ^e e.d / ./; 1a<b 1c<d d.a/.b/.c/.d / WD d.a/.c/ d.b/.d / d.a/.d / d.b/.c/ : (7.10ii) Now we shall discuss the invariant eigenvalue problem for various 6 6 matrices arising out of the six-dimensional bivector space. (We have touched upon invariant eigenvalue problems in (1.213) and Examples A3.6 and A3.8.) Suppose that a tensor field belonging to the bivector space is denoted by M:::: .x/ WD XX XX mij kl ./ dx i ^ dx j ˝ dx k ^ dx l ; i <j k<l mj i kl ./ mij kl ./; mij lk ./ mij kl ./: (7.11) A 6 6 matrix ŒM.x/; out of entries mij kl .x/; ŒM.x/ WD mij kl ./ ; 66 i < j; k<l (7.12) can be constructed. The eigenbivector is expressed as E:: .x/ WD .1=2/Ekl ./ dx k ^ dx l D XX Ekl ./ dx k ^ dx l ; (7.13i) k<l Elk .x/ Ekl .x/ I (7.13ii) e.a/ ./ ^e e.b/ ./ E:: .x/ WD .1=2/E.a/.b/./ e XX D E.a/.b/./ e e.a/ ./ ^e e.b/ ./; (7.13iii) a<b E.b/.a/ .x/ E.a/.b/ .x/: (7.13iv) The invariant eigenvalue problem for the 66 matrix in (7.12) is posed as follows: m ij kl .x/ WD g ip ./ g j q ./ mpqkl ./; m ji kl .x/ m ij kl .x/ m ij lk .x/; (7.14i) (7.14ii) 472 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations ij .1=2/m kl ./ E kl ./ D ./ E ij ./; X X ij m kl ./ E kl ./ D ./ E ij ./; (7.14iii) (7.14iv) k<l h i ij ij det m kl ./ ./ ı kl D 0; ı ij kl ˇ WD ˇˇ ı ik ˇ j ˇı k (7.14v) ˇ ı il ˇˇ j ˇ; ı ˇ (7.14vi) l i < j; k < l; det mij kl ./ ./ gij kl ./ D 0 I .1=2/ m XX .a/.b/ m .c/.d / ./ .a/.b/ (7.14vii) (7.14viii) E .c/.d /./ D ./ E .a/.b/ ./; .c/.d / ./ E .c/.d / ./ D ./ E .a/.b/./; (7.14ix) (7.14x) c<d h i .a/.b/ .a/.b/ det m ./ ./ ı .c/.d / .c/.d / D 0; (7.14xi) a < b; c < d; det m.a/.b/.c/.d /./ ./ d.a/.b/.c/.d / D 0: (7.14xii) ij (Here, ı kl are components of the generalized Kronecker delta 22 ı ı discussed in Example 1.2.13.) It is rather cumbersome to deal with multi-indices in (7.14i–xii), so we devise the following notations for brevity: 12 ! 1; 13 ! 2; 14 ! 3; 23 ! 4; 24 ! 5; 34 ! 6; I; J; K; LI A; B; C; D 2 f1; 2; 3; 4; 5; 6g: (7.15) (We also follow summation conventions in regards to capital Roman indices.) We also express metric tensors pertaining to the bivector space as gij kl ./! IJ ./; d.a/.b/.c/.d /!D.A/.B/ : (7.16) 7.1 The Petrov Classification of the Curvature Tensor 473 With this new notation, the invariant eigenvalue problems in (7.14viii) and (7.14xii) can be cast into the following neater equations: det ŒmIJ ./ ./ IJ ./ D 0; (7.17i) det m.A/.B/./ ./ D.A/.B/ D 0; (7.17ii) i h .A/ .A/ det m .B/ ./ ./ ı .B/ D 0: (7.17iii) .A/ (Here, m .B/ ./ WD D .A/.C / m.C /.B/./.) The above equations facilitate solving the determinantal equations for 6 6 matrices! Example 7.1.3. Let us work out explicitly the numerical metric tensor components DAB given by (7.16) and (7.10ii). They are given by the symmetric 6 6 matrix 2 3 1 6 7 1 6 7 6 7 6 1 7 D.A/.B/ D 6 (7.18) 7: 6 7 1 6 7 4 5 1 1 The numerical matrix above is already diagonal. The induced metric structure of the bivector fields is governed by (7.18). For this bivector space, the corresponding metric is of zero signature. Explicitly (p WD positive, n WD negative), p D 3; n D 3; p C n D 6; and p n D 0: Moreover, .A/.B/ D.A/.B/ ; D D .A/.C / D.C /.B/ D ı .A/ .B/ : (7.19) Now we shall discuss canonical forms of the 6 6 matrices with real entries. (Consult Appendix 3 on this topic.) The Jordan canonical form of a 6 6 matrix .A/ field ŒM.x/ ŒM .B/ .x/; according to Theorems A3.7 and A3.9 and (A3.10), is furnished by 3 :: A ./ : 7 6 .1/ : : :: 7 6 : : :: 7 6 : :: 7 6 : 6 D 6 : 7 7; 7 6 ::: B.1/ ./ 7 6 :: : 4 :: 5 :: :: : : 2 ŒM.x/.J / 66 (7.20i) 474 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations 3 2 6 6 A.1/ .x/ WD 6 4 h .1/ J.1/ ./ :: :: :: :: 7 7 7; 5 (7.20ii) : i .1/ J.1/ .x/ WD .1/ .x/ ; or 11 2 3 ./ 1 0 0 0 0 .1/ 6 7 6 7 0 0 0 7 6 0 .1/ ./ 1 7 h i 6 6 0 0 .1/ ./ 1 0 0 7 .1/ 7 etc., J.1/ .x/ D 6 6 7 6 0 7 0 0 ./ 1 0 .1/ 6 7 6 0 0 0 0 .1/ ./ 1 7 4 5 0 0 0 0 0 .1/ ./ 3 2 6 6 B.1/ .x/ WD 6 4 .1/ C.1/ ./ :: :: :: :: 7 7 7; 5 (7.20iv) : 3 2 6 6 6 6 h i 6 .1/ C.1/ .x/ WD 6 6 6 6 6 4 (7.20iii) a.1/ b.1/ 0 0 0 0 b.1/ j1 j a.1/ j0 j 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 a.1/ b.1/ 0 0 7 7 7 7 7 0 7 etc. 7 1 7 7 b.1/ 7 5 a.1/ (7.20v) In (7.20v), the complex eigenvalue is given by .x/ D a.1/ .x/ C i b.1/ .x/ with b.1/ .x/ ¤ 0. Example 7.1.4. Let the Jordan canonical form (7.20i) of a 6 6 matrix field be provided by 3 2 2 1 7 6 7 6 7 6 0 2 7 6 7 6 1 2 x x 0 7 6 ŒM.x/.J / D 6 7: 3 4 7 6 0 x x 7 6 7 6 a.1/ 1 7 6 5 4 1 a.1/ 7.1 The Petrov Classification of the Curvature Tensor 475 In this example, eigenvalues are given by .1/ .x/ D 2; .2/ .x/ D x 1 x 2 ; .3/ .x/ D x 3 x 4 ; .x/ D a.1/ i; .x/ D a.1/ C i: The corresponding Segre characteristic of the matrix is furnished from Appendix 3 as 2; 1; 1I 1; 1 : Now, we shall investigate canonical forms of the Riemann–Christoffel curvature tensor field R:::: .x/: Following the notational abbreviations introduced in (7.15), we denote R:::: .x/ D 4 X 4 X R.a/.b/.c/.d /./ e e.a/ ./ ^e e.b/ ./ ˝e e.c/ ./ ^e e.d / ./; c<d a<b R.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/ ! R.A/.B/ .x/; 1 a < b; 1 c < d: (7.21) The invariant eigenvalues from (7.16) and (7.21) are furnished by det R.A/.B/ .x/ .x/ D.A/.B/ D 0: (7.22) We note from the algebraic identities in (1.142vii) that R.c/.d /.a/.b/.x/ R.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/; (7.23i) R.B/.A/ .x/ R.A/.B/ .x/: (7.23ii) However, the 6 6 matrix h i .A/ R .B/ .x/ WD D .A/.C / R.C /.B/ .x/ (7.24) is not necessarily symmetric. (Consult i the Example A3.8.) The Jordan canonical h .A/ forms of the matrix R .B/ .x/ are analogous to those in (7.20i). But, there exist many other algebraic identities (1.142v,vi,viii) for the components R.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/: Moreover, Einstein’s fieldhequations i(2.163ii) provide additional .A/ restrictions to the Jordan forms of R .B/ .x/ . General reductions of i h .A/ R .B/ .x/ to canonical forms are too involved for the scope of this book. (The reader is referred to Petrov’s book [210] for detailed discussions.) Weyl’s conformal tensor C:::.x/ of (1.169i,ii) turns out to be very useful in regards to applications in the field of general relativity. (In fact, the next section, involving the Newman–Penrose equations, extensively deals with the conformal tensor.) Therefore, let us delve into the task of the algebraic classifications of the conformal tensor more exhaustively. 476 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations The components of the conformal tensor, relative to a coordinate basis and a (real ) orthonormal dual basis, satisfy the following algebraic identities: Cj i kl .x/ Cij lk .x/ Cij kl .x/; (7.25i) Cklij .x/ Cij kl .x/; (7.25ii) Cij kl ./ C Ci klj ./ C Ci lj k ./ 0; (7.25iii) C kij k .x/ 0 I (7.25iv) C.b/.a/.c/.d /.x/ C.a/.b/.d /.c/.x/ C.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/; (7.25v) C.c/.d /.a/.b/.x/ C.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/; (7.25vi) C.a/.b/.c/.d /./ C C.a/.c/.d /.b/./ C C.a/.d /.b/.c/./ 0; (7.25vii) C .d / .a/.b/.d / .x/ 0: (7.25viii) The number of linearly independent (real) components of the conformal tensor is exactly ten. (Consult Problem # 14 of Exercises 1.3, as well as Problem # 3 of Exercises 2.4.) We can express the conformal tensor, analogous to (7.11) and (7.14i,ii), as C::::.x/ D .1=4/ Cij kl ./ dx i ^ dx j ˝ dx k ^ dx l D .1=4/ C.a/.b/.c/.d /./ e e.a/ ./ ^e e.b/ ./ ˝e e.c/ ./ ^e e.d / ./: (7.26) We express the equivalent equations, in the six-dimensional bivector space, as C::::.x/ D D 4 X 4 4 X 4 X X Cij kl ./ dx i ^ dx j ˝ dx k ^ dx l i <j k<l 4 X 4 X 4 X 4 X a<b C.a/.b/.c/.d /./ e e.a/ ./ ^e e.b/ ./ ˝e e.c/ ./ ^e e.d / ./: c<d (7.27) We define the corresponding mixed components from (7.14i) as C C .a/.b/ ij kl .x/ .c/.d / .x/ WD g ip ./ g j q ./ Cpqkl ./; (7.28i) WD d .a/.p/ d .b/.q/ C.p/.q/.c/.d / ./: (7.28ii) 7.1 The Petrov Classification of the Curvature Tensor 477 We next define eigenbivectors E::.x/; exactly like in (7.13i–iv), to pose the invariant eigenvalue problem for the conformal tensor. The following equations summarize this eigenvalue problem: X X ij ij .1=2/ C kl ./ E kl ./ D C kl ./ E kl ./ D ./ E ij ./; (7.29i) h det ij C kl ./ 1 i < j; .1=2/ C .a/.b/ ./ ij ı kl i k<l D 0; (7.29ii) 1k <lI .c/.d / ./ E .c/.d / ./ D XX C .a/.b/ .c/.d / ./ E .c/.d /./ c<d D ./ E .a/.b/./; i h .a/.b/ .a/.b/ ./ ./ ı det C .c/.d / .c/.d / D 0; (7.29iii) 1 a < b; (7.29iv) 1 c < d: Now, we shall adopt the notations of (7.15) and (7.16) for the sake of simplicity. With these abbreviations, the invariant eigenvalue problems of (7.29ii) and (7.29iv) reduce to the following: Cij kl .x/ ! CIJ .x/; (7.30i) C.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/ ! C.A/.B/ .x/; (7.30ii) det ŒCIJ ./ ./ (7.30iii) IJ ./ D 0; det C.A/.B/ ./ ./ D.A/.B/ D 0; h det C .A/ .B/ ./ ./ ı .A/ .B/ i D 0: (7.30iv) (7.30v) The algebraic identities in (7.25ii), (7.25iv), (7.25vi), and (7.25viii) imply the identities: CJI .x/ CIJ .x/; CII .x/ 0; (7.31i) Trace CIJ ./ 0; (7.31ii) 66 C.B/.A/ .x/ C.A/.B/ .x/; h i .A/ .A/ C .A/ .x/ 0; Trace C .B/ ./ 0: 66 (7.31iii) (7.31iv) 478 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations However, the remaining identities of (7.25iii,vii) and (7.25iv,viii) are not fully incorporated in identities (7.31i–iv). (All these identities do not imply Einstein’s field equations (2.163i,ii).) Example 7.1.5. Consider a specific example of the four-dimensional space–time where the components of the curvature tensor are given by: R .a/.b/ .c/.d / .x/ WD K0 ı .a/.b/ .c/.d / : (7.32) (Here, K0 is a constant.) By (1.164ii), the above equation indicates a domain of space–time that is of constant curvature. The invariant eigenvalue problem of the curvature tensor in (7.32) boils down, by (7.14x,xi), to 4 X 4 h X R .a/.b/ i ./ E .c/.d / ./ D ./ E .a/.b/ ./; .c/.d / (7.33i) e<d o n .a/.b/ det ŒK0 ./ ı .c/.d / D 0; 1 a < b; 1 c < d: (7.33ii) With the notational abbreviations in (7.15) and (7.16), (7.32) and (7.33i) reduce to R .A/ .B/ .x/ D K0 ı .A/ .B/ : (7.34) h i .A/ Thus, the 6 6 matrix R .B/ .x/ is already diagonalized with repeated eigenvalues. We can see that the Segre characteristic of this curvature tensor is provided by Œ.1; 1; 1; 1; 1; 1/: Now, by (1.169ii), Problem # 3 of Exercises 2.4, and Theorem 1.3.30, the conformal tensor components corresponding to (7.32) reduce to C.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/ 0; C .A/ .B/ .x/ 0ı .A/ .B/ : (7.35i) (7.35ii) Therefore, every invariant eigenvalue vanishes, and the corresponding Segre chari h .A/ acteristic of the 6 6 matrix C .B/ .x/ is furnished by Œ.1; 1; 1; 1; 1; 1/ as well. It is worthwhile to look back into the definition of 2-forms in (7.9i,ii) for i h .A/ characterizing canonical forms of 6 6 matrices C .B/ .x/ : 7.1 The Petrov Classification of the Curvature Tensor 479 Now, the invariant eigenvalue problem for a 2-form W:: .x/ is stated below as Wij ./ Ej ./ D ./ gij ./ Ej ./; (7.36i) W.a/.b/ ./ E.b/ ./ D ./ d.a/.b/ E.b/ ./: (7.36ii) We conclude from (7.36i,ii) and (7.9i,ii) that eigenvectors must satisfy ./ gij ./ Ei ./ Ej ./ D ./ d.a/.b/ E.a/ ./ E.b/ ./ D 0: (7.37) Therefore, either the invariant eigenvalue .x/ D 0 or the (nonzero) eigenvector E E.x/ is a null vector, or both. This conclusion immediately shows the importance of null eigenvectors associated with 2-forms. (Compare (2.300) and (2.301) for eigenvectors of the electromagnetic 2-form F:: .x/:) Now let us go back to the definition of the Hodge star operation or Hodgedual operation on p-forms in (1.113). Particularly, for the 2-form W:: .x/; it is furnished by .a/.b/ W.c/.d / .x/ WD .1=2/ D .c/.d / W.a/.b/ .x/; 1 1 .a/.b/ W.a/.b/ .x/ D ".c/.d /.p/.q/ W .p/.q/ .x/: 2 .c/.d / 2 (7.38) Example 7.1.6. Consider the contravariant orthonormal components W .c/.d / .x/ W .d /.c/ .x/: The Hodge-dual components from (7.38) emerge explicitly as W .1/.2/ ./ D W.3/.4/ ./; W .2/.3/ ./ D W.1/.4/ ./; W .3/.1/ ./ D W.2/.4/ ./; W .1/.4/ ./ D W.2/.3/ ./; W .2/.4/ ./ D W.3/.1/ ./; W .3/.4/ ./ D W.1/.2/ ./: (7.39) Furthermore, it follows from (7.38) and (7.39) that the double-dual components are provided by W.a/.b/ .x/ D W.a/.b/ .x/: (Compare with the Example 1.3.6 and Problem # 5 of Exercises 1.3.) (7.40) Now we shall investigate complex-valued 2-forms. We study the special class of complex-valued 2-forms given by the following: S.a/.b/ .x/ WD W.a/.b/ .x/ i W.a/.b/ .x/ S.b/.a/ .x/: (Here, we assume that W:: .x/ is a real 2-form.) (7.41) 480 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations We define the Hodge duality for a complex 2-form exactly as that in (7.37). Therefore, we express .a/.b/ S.c/.d / .x/ WD .1=2/ .c/.d / S.a/.b/ .x/: (7.42) It follows from (7.41) and (7.42) that the Hodge dual of components S.a/.b/ .x/ must satisfy, by use of (7.40) and (7.41), S.a/.b/ .x/ D W.a/.b/ ./ i W.a/.b/ ./ D W.a/.b/ ./ C i W.a/.b/ ./ D i S.a/.b/ .x/: (7.43) Equation above is called1 the self-duality of the corresponding complex bivector S.a/.b/ .x/: A real or complex bivector X:: .x/ is called null provided X.a/.b/ ./ X .a/.b/ ./ D X.a/.b/ ./ X.a/.b/ ./ D 0: (7.44) Therefore, a bivector X:: .x/ is nonnull provided X.a/.b/ ./ X .a/.b/ ./ ¤ 0 or X.a/.b/ X .a/.b/ ¤ 0. A complex bivector field 1=2 ˙.a/.b/ ./ e e.a/ ./ ^e e.b/ ./ is defined by ˙.a/.b/ .x/ WD X.a/.b/ ./ i X.a/.b/ ./ (7.45) and is self-dual on account of (7.43). E Now, suppose that U.x/ is a future-pointing, timelike vector field. It follows that U.a/ ./ U .a/ ./ 1; (7.46i) U .4/ ./ 1; (7.46ii) ˙.a/.b/ ./ U .a/ ./ U .b/ ./ 0: (7.46iii) A pertinent covariant vector field e X.x/; defined below, satisfies X.a/ .x/ WD ˙.a/.b/ ./ U .b/ ./; (7.47i) X.a/ ./ U .a/ ./ 0: (7.47ii) Here, it follows from (7.47ii) that either X.a/ X .a/ > 0 or e X.x/ D e 0.x/. 1 Equation (7.43) differs from those in (7.39) for a real bivector. To call the condition (7.43) as self-duality is a misnomer. However, due to the popularity of this nomenclature, we will keep on using the same name in this chapter. 7.1 The Petrov Classification of the Curvature Tensor 481 Now we shall provide an example. Example 7.1.7. In a domain D R4 of a coordinate chart, let a continuous vector E field U.x/ and a nonzero covariant vector field e Y.x/ exist. We define a self-dual complex bivector field by ˙.a/.b/ .x/ D U.a/ ./ Y.b/ ./ U.b/ ./ Y.a/ ./ i U.a/ ./ Y.b/ ./ U.b/ ./ Y.a/ ./ D U.a/ ./ Y.b/ ./ U.b/ ./ Y.a/ ./ i .a/.b/.c/.d / U .c/ ./ Y .d / ./ U .d / ./ Y .c/ ./ ; 2 X.a/ WD ˙.a/.b/ ./ U .b/ ./ D U.a/ ./ Y.b/ ./ U .b/ C Y.a/ ./ 0: Moreover, using the equation .a/.b/.p/.q/ .a/.b/.c/.d / D 2 ı derive that .p/.q/ .c/.d / , we can ˙.a/.b/ ./ ˙ .a/.b/ ./ D U.a/ ./ Y.b/ ./ U.b/ ./ Y.a/ ./ U .a/ ./ Y .b/ ./ U .b/ ./ Y .a/ ./ .a/.b/.p/.q/ .a/.b/.c/.d / U.p/ ./ Y.q/ ./ U .c/ ./ Y.d / ./ 2 D 2Y.b/ Y .b/ 2 Y.a/ U .a/ C 2 U.c/ Y.d / U .c/ Y .d / U.d / Y.c/ U .c/ Y .d / 2 D 4 Y.a/ Y .a/ 4 Y.a/ U .a/ : n o E El./; k./ E E We shall now use the set of null tetrad fields m./; m./; of (7.6i) for further investigations. We define three complex bivector fields in the following: e ^e l./; U:: .x/ WD 2 m./ (7.48i) U.a/.b/ ./ D l.a/ ./ m.b/ ./ C l.b/ ./ m.a/ ./; (7.48ii) e ./; V:: .x/ WD 2 e k./ ^ m (7.48iii) V.a/.b/ ./ D k.a/ ./ m.b/ ./ k.b/ ./ m.a/ ./; (7.48iv) e e e ./ ^ m./ W:: .x/ WD 2 m k./ ^e l./ ; (7.48v) 482 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations W.a/.b/ ./ D m.a/ ./ m.b/ ./ m.b/ ./ m.a/ ./ k.a/ ./ l.b/ ./ C k.b/ ./ l.a/ ./: (7.48vi) It can be proved that U.a/.b/ ./ D i U.a/.b/ ./; (7.49i) V.a/.b/ ./ D i V.a/.b/ ./; (7.49ii) W.a/.b/ ./ D i W.a/.b/ ./: (7.49iii) (See Problem #6 of Exercises 7.1.) Therefore, each of these complex 2-forms is self-dual, according to the definition in (7.43). Here we work out the double contractions as the following: U.a/.b/ ./ U.a/.b/ ./ D l.a/ ./ m.b/ ./ C l.b/ ./ m.a/ ./ i h l .a/ ./ m.b/ ./ C l .b/ ./ m.a/ ./ D 2 l.a/ ./ l .a/ ./ m.b/ ./ m.b/ ./ 2 2 l.a/ ./ m.a/ ./ 0; (7.50i) V.a/.b/ ./ V.a/.b/ ./ 0; (7.50ii) W.a/.b/ ./ W.a/.b/ ./ 4; (7.50iii) U.a/.b/ ./ V.a/.b/ ./ 2; (7.50iv) U.a/.b/ ./ W.a/.b/ ./ 0; (7.50v) V.a/.b/ ./ W.a/.b/ ./ 0: (7.50vi) Consider the set of all complex bivector fields which are self-dual in the sense of equations (7.49i–iii). We shall prove a useful theorem about the set of three bivector fields fU:: ./; V:: ./; W:: ./g here. Theorem 7.1.8. Let the set of three bivector fields fU:: ./; V:: ./; W:: ./g be defined in a coordinate domain D R4 : (i) This set comprises of three linearly independent bivector fields. (ii) Every linear combination of . U:: ./; V:: ./; W:: ./ yields a self-dual bivector. 7.1 The Petrov Classification of the Curvature Tensor 483 (iii) These three bivectors generate, by all possible linear combinations, a proper subset of all self-dual bivectors which is isomorphic to a three-dimensional, complex vector space. Proof. (i) Consider linear equations ˛.x/ U.a/.b/ ./ C ˇ./ V.a/.b/ ./ C ./ W.a/.b/ ./ D 0; where, ˛.x/; ˇ.x/; .x/ are complex scalar fields. Multiplying the above equations by U.a/.b/ ./; V.a/.b/ ./; W.a/.b/ ./ and double contracting (with use of (7.50i–vi)), it follows that ˛.x/ D ˇ.x/ D .x/ 0: Thus, the 2-forms corresponding to U.a/.b/ ./; V.a/.b/ ./; and W.a/.b/ ./ are linearly independent. (ii) Consider a bivector field expressed as Y:: .x/ WD .x/ U:: ./ C ./ V:: ./ C ./ W:: ./: Here, .x/; .x/; and .x/ are arbitrary complex scalar fields. By use of (7.49i–iii), we derive that Y.a/.b/ ./ D i Y.a/.b/ ./: Therefore, the bivector field Y:: .x/ is self-dual. (iii) Consider the three-dimensional complex vector space C3 .x/ of ordered, triple, complex scalar fields .x/; .x/; .x/. An isomorphism (linear and one-toone mapping) can be established by I.x/ ŒY:: .x/ WD . .x/; .x/; .x// : Equation above essentially proves part (iii) of the theorem. Now, we shall apply the preceding theoretical considerations first to electromagnetic fields and then to general relativity. Recall Maxwell’s equations (1.69), (1.70), (2.290i,ii), (2.300), (2.309), (2.5), and (2.314). In Problem # 8 of Exercises 2.5, we introduced the complex-valued electromagnetic field as ' kj .x/ WD F kj .x/ i F kj .x/ ' j k .x/: (7.51) Remark: Since F kj .x/ is an oriented or pseudotensor of (1.112ii), the antisymmetric field ' kj .x/ is not an (absolute) tensor field! 484 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations Let us summarize Maxwell’s equations here: F .b/.a/ .x/ F .a/.b/ .x/; (7.52i) r.b/ F .a/.b/ D 0; (7.52ii) r.a/ F.b/.c/ C r.b/ F.c/.a/ C r.c/ F.a/.b/ D 0; (7.52iii) r.b/ F .a/.b/ D 0: (7.52iv) Equation (7.52iv) is exactly equivalent to (7.52iii). However, (7.52iv) is oriented tensor field equations, whereas (7.52iii) is (absolute) tensor field equations! Now we shall introduce complex-valued, electromagnetic bivector field equations: r.b/ ' .a/.b/ D 0: (7.53) Remarks: (i) The set of equations above are exactly equivalent to Maxwell’s equations (7.52i–iv). However, these equations are not (absolute) tensor field equations. (ii) Equation (7.53) can represent Maxwell’s equations in a curvilinear coordinate chart of flat space–time. Also, these equations are valid in a curved space– time with a background metric. Moreover, (7.53) can be part of the Einstein– Maxwell (or electromagneto-vac) equations in (2.277i,ii) and (2.290i–vi). By the definition in (7.51) and (7.40) and (7.41), we obtain '.a/.b/.x/ D i '.a/.b/ .x/: (7.54) Thus, the complex electromagnetic bivector field is self-dual. According to Theorem 7.1.8, the bivector components of (7.51) admit the following linear combination: '.a/.b/ .x/ D .0/ .x/U.a/.b/ ./ C .1/ ./W.a/.b/./ C .2/ ./V.a/.b/./: (7.55) Here, .0/ .x/; .1/ .x/; and .2/ .x/ are suitable complex scalar fields. It can be noted that the three complex-valued fields .0/ ./; .1/ ./; and .2/ ./ provide the same number of degrees of freedom as the six linearly independent, real-valued fields F.a/.b/ .x/: By (7.50i–vi) and (7.48ii,iv,vi) we can explicitly deduce that .0/ .x/ D .1=2/ ' .a/.b/ ./ V.a/.b/ ./ D .1=2/ ' .a/.b/ ./ k.a/ ./ m.b/ ./ k.b/ ./ m.a/ ./ ; (7.56i) 7.1 The Petrov Classification of the Curvature Tensor .1/ .x/ .2/ .x/ 485 D .1=4/ ' .a/.b/ ./ W.a/.b/ ./ D .1=4/ ' .a/.b/ m.a/ ./ m.b/ ./ m.b/ ./ m.a/ ./ k.a/ ./ l.b/ ./ C k.b/ ./ l.a/ ./ ; (7.56ii) D .1=2/ ' .a/.b/ ./ U.a/.b/ ./ D .1=2/ ' .a/.b/ ./ l.a/ ./ m.b/ ./ C l.b/ ./ m.a/ ./ : (7.56iii) Direct computations from (7.50i–vi) and (7.55) lead to '.a/.b/ ' .a/.b/ D 4 .0/ .2/ 2 .1/ : (7.57) We characterize a nonnull or nondegenerate electromagnetic field by the criterion '.a/.b/ ./ ' .a/.b/ ./ ¤ 0; or .1/ ./ 2 ¤ .0/ ./ (7.58i) .2/ ./: (7.58ii) Therefore, we define a degenerate or null electromagnetic field by the condition 1 '.a/.b/./' .a/.b/./ D 4 .0/ ./ .2/ ./ .1/ ./ 2 D 0; (7.59i) which is implied by F.a/.b/ ./ F .a/.b/ ./ D F.a/.b/ ./ F .a/.b/ ./ D F.a/.b/ ./ F .a/.b/ ./ D 0: (7.59ii) (Compare (7.59i,ii) with (2.5) and (7.44).) By a transformation of the complex tetrad, as in (7.7iii) or (7.7iv), we can obtain the new coefficient b.0/ .x/ 0. Dropping the hats in the sequel, the degeneracy condition (7.59ii) reduces to .0/ .x/ D .1/ .x/ 0: (7.60) By the use of (7.55), we conclude in this case '.a/.b/.x/ D .2/ ./ V.a/.b/ ./ D .2/ ./ k.a/ ./ m.b/ ./ k.b/ ./ m.a/ ./ : (7.61) Example 7.1.9. We choose the space–time to be flat. Moreover, choosing the global Minkowski coordinate chart of (2.8), we write 486 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations g:: .x/ D dij dx i ˝ dx j ; (7.62i) g:: .x/ D d ij @i ˝ @j : (7.62ii) The (natural) orthonormal basis set (or tetrad) is provided by Ee.a/ .x/ D ı i.a/ @i ; e e.a/ .x/ D ı .a/ i (7.63i) dx i : (7.63ii) The Ricci rotation coefficients reduce to .a/.b/.c/ .x/ 0; and the covariant derivatives of (1.124ii) are furnished by .a1 /;:::;.ar / .b1 /;:::;.br / : (7.64) We choose the electromagnetic 4-potential as a plane wave: .c/ A.b/ .x/ D a.b/ cos .c/ ı i x i ; (7.65i) r.c/ T .a1 /;:::;.ar / .b1 /;:::;.br / .c/ .b/ a.b/ D 0: .c/ D 0; D @.c/ T 2 .4/ D ı .˛/.ˇ/ .˛/ .ˇ/ ; (7.65ii) (7.65iii) The constants a.b/ represent the amplitudes of the waves, whereas .˛/ and .4/ represent the wave numbers and frequency of the plane wave inherent in the choice (7.65i–iii). Equation (7.65iii) follows from the Lorentz gauge condition (2.282). The electromagnetic field, from (7.65i), emerges as .c/ (7.66) F.a/.b/ .x/ D .b/ a.a/ .a/ a.b/ sin .c/ ı i x i : We can verify explicitly that F.a/.b/ ./ F .a/.b/ ./ D a.a/ .a/ a.b/ .b/ a.a/ i2 h .c/ 0: sin .c/ ı i x i .b/ .a/ Moreover, 2 F.a/.b/ ./ F .a/.b/ ./ D .d / a.c/ D .c/.a/.b/.d / .b/ .c/ .b/ a.a/ h a.d / sin .d / .a/ .e/ .e/ ı i a.b/ .a/.b/.c/.d / xi i2 a.a/ a.c/ C a.b/ a.d / .a/ .c/ a.b/ (7.67i) 7.1 The Petrov Classification of the Curvature Tensor .b/.c/.a/.d / a.a/ a.d / h sin .e/ .e/ ı i xi i2 .b/ .c/ 487 C .a/ .d / a.b/ a.c/ 0: (7.67ii) Now we shall investigate “gravitational waves” in general relativity. For that purpose, the classification of Weyl’s conformal tensor is essential. We have already discussed such topics in (7.25i–viii), (7.26), (7.27), (7.28i,ii), (7.29i–iv), (7.30i–iv), and (7.31i–iv). However, for a more concise analysis, the complex version of the conformal tensor is required. For that purpose, let us define the Hodge dual of the conformal tensor as follows: C .a/.b/ .c/.d / ./ WD 1 .a/.b/ .p/.q/ C .c/.d / ./ 2 .p/.q/ .a/.b/ D .1=2/ .p/.q/ C .p/.q/ .c/.d / ./: (7.68) We define2 a complex-valued conformal tensor as .a/.b/ .c/.d / ./ WD C .a/.b/ .c/.d / ./ i C .a/.b/ .c/.d / ./: (7.69) Remark: The gravitational equation (7.69) resembles the electromagnetic version in (7.51). It follows from (7.43) and (7.69) that the self-duality conditions .a/.b/.c/.d / ./ D C.a/.b/.c/.d /./ C i C.a/.b/.c/.d /./ Di .a/.b/.c/.d /./ (7.70) hold. Consider a complex-valued “tensor field” :::: .x/ that admits the following algebraic identities: .b/.a/.c/.d / ./ .a/.b/.d /.c/ ./ .c/.d /.a/.b/ ./ .a/.b/.c/.d / ./; .a/.b/.c/.d / ./ C .a/.c/.d /.b/ ./ C .a/.d /.b/.c/ ./ .d / .a/.b/.d / ./ 0: .a/.b/.c/.d / ./; (7.71i) (7.71ii) 0; (7.71iii) (7.71iv) These identities hold for .a/.b/.c/.d /./ in (7.69), due to the identities (7.25v–viii) of the real-valued conformal tensor components. 2 This definition differs from that in [239]. 488 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations Now, we introduce the following complex-valued, self-dual “tensor field” components: E .0/ .a/.b/.c/.d / ./ WD U.a/.b/ ./ U.c/.d / ./; (7.72i) E .1/ .a/.b/.c/.d / ./ WD U.a/.b/ ./ W.c/.d / ./ C W.a/.b/ ./ U.c/.d / ./; (7.72ii) E .2/ .a/.b/.c/.d / ./ WD V.a/.b/ ./ U.c/.d / ./ C U.a/.b/ ./ V.c/.d / ./ C W.a/.b/ ./ W.c/.d / ./; (7.72iii) E .3/ .a/.b/.c/.d / ./ WD V.a/.b/ ./ W.c/.d / ./ C W.a/.b/ ./ V.c/.d / ./; (7.72iv) E .4/ .a/.b/.c/.d / ./ WD V.a/.b/ ./ V.c/.d / ./: (7.72v) It is essential to note that each of above five complex, self-dual, “tensor components” satisfies identities (7.71i–iv). (See Problem #4 of Exercises 7.1.) Therefore, analo˚ gous to Theorem 7.1.8, we can prove that the set E.0/:::: ./; : : : ; E.4/:::: ./ jxDx0 constitutes a basis set which is isomorphic to a basis set of the five-dimensional complex vector space C5.x0 / : Thus, the “tensor field” in (7.69) admits the following linear combination: .1=2/ .a/.b/.c/.d /./ D 4 X .J / ./ E .J / .a/.b/.c/.d / ./: (7.73) J D0 Here, .0/ .x/; : : : ; .4/ .x/ are five suitable, complex-valued scalar fields. These coefficient functions can be explicitly determined by use of (7.72i–v), (7.48ii,iv,vi), (7.50i–vi), and (7.73). Thus, these five functions are furnished by: .0/ .x/ D .1=8/ .a/.b/.c/.d / ./ V.a/.b/ ./ V.c/.d / ./ D C.a/.b/.c/.d /./ k .a/ ./ m.b/ ./ k .c/ ./ m.d / ./; .1/ .x/ D .1=16/ D .a/.b/.c/.d / ./ (7.74i) V.a/.b/ ./ W.c/.d / ./ h i 1 C.a/.b/.c/.d /./ k .a/ ./ m.b/ k .c/ ./ l .d / ./ m.c/ ./ m.d / ./ 2 D C.a/.b/.c/.d /./ k .a/ ./ l .b/ ./ k .c/ ./ m.d / ./; .2/ .x/ D .1=8/ .a/.b/.c/.d / ./ (7.74ii) U.a/.b/ ./ V.c/.d / ./ D C.a/.b/.c/.d /./ k .a/ ./ m.b/ ./ m.c/ ./ l .d / ./; (7.74iii) 7.1 The Petrov Classification of the Curvature Tensor .3/ .x/ D .1=16/ D .a/.b/.c/.d / ./ 489 U.a/.b/ ./ W.c/.d / ./ h i 1 .d / C.a/.b/.c/.d /./ l .a/ ./ m.b/ m.c/ ./ m.d / ./ k .c/ ./ l ./ 2 D C.a/.b/.c/.d /./ k .a/ ./ l .b/ ./ m.c/ ./ l .d / ./; .4/ .x/ D .1=8/ .a/.b/.c/.d / ./ (7.74iv) U.a/.b/ ./ U.c/.d / ./ D C.a/.b/.c/.d /./ m.a/ ./ l .b/ ./ m.c/ ./ l .d / ./: (7.74v) Remarks: (i) The number of five, independent complex-valued functions .0/ .x/; : : : ; .4/ .x/ matches exactly with the number of independent realvalued components of the conformal tensor C:::: .x/ (i.e., ten). (ii) These five, complex-valued functions for gravitational fields are exact analogues of the three, complex-valued components .0/ .x/; .1/ .x/; and .2/ .x/ of the complex electromagnetic field ':: .x/ in (7.55). (iii) In (7.74i–v), the factor .1=2/ .a/.b/.c/.d /./ can be replaced with C.a/.b/.c/.d /./. (Consult the hint to #7 of Exercises 7.1.) Now we shall proceed to classify algebraically the complex-valued conformal tensor. The relevant invariant eigenvalue problem to be investigated is given by .1=4/ .a/.b/.c/.d / ./ E .c/.d / ./ D ./ E.a/.b/ ./; (7.75i) E.a/.b/ ./ D i E.a/.b/./; (7.75ii) i C.a/.b/.c/.d /./ E .c/.d / ./ D C.a/.b/.c/.d /./ E .c/.d / ./; (7.75iii) 1 C.a/.b/.c/.d /./ E .c/.d / ./ D ./ E.a/.b/ ./: 2 (7.75iv) (Compare (7.75iv) with (7.29iii).) We choose a comoving frame to render the analysis of (7.75i,ii) more tractable. E Recall the future-pointing, timelike vector field U.x/ discussed in (7.46i,ii). We define the complex second-order tensor field Q:: .x/ and some related identities in the following3: Q.a/.d / .x/ WD .a/.b/.c/.d /./ Q.d /.a/ ./ D .d /.b/.c/.a/./ .c/.a/.d /.b/ ./ Q.a/.d / ./; 3 U .b/ ./ U .c/ ./; (7.76i) U .b/ ./ U .c/ ./ U .b/ ./ U .c/ ./ (7.76ii) We have inserted the negative sign in the left-hand sides of (7.76i–iv) so that the subsequent equations coincide with popular versions. 490 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations Q .a/ .a/ ./ D .a/ .b/.c/.a/ ./ U .b/ ./ U .c/ ./ 0; (7.76iii) Q.a/.d / ./ U .d / ./ D .a/.b/.c/.d /./ U .b/ ./ U .c/ ./ U .d / ./ D .a/.b/.c/.d /./ U .c/ ./ U .d / ./ U .b/ ./ 0: (7.76iv) Using (7.73), the definition (7.76i) yields 1 Q.a/.d / .x/ D .1=2/ .a/.b/.c/.d /./ U .b/ ./ U .c/ ./ 2 n D .0/ ./ U.a/.b/./ U.c/.d / ./ C .1/ ./ U.a/.b/ ./ W.c/.d / ./ C W.a/.b/ ./ U.c/.d / ./ C .2/ ./ V.a/.b/ ./ U.c/.d / ./ C U.a/.b/ ./ V.c/.d / ./ C W.a/.b/ ./ W.c/.d / ./ C .3/ ./ V.a/.b/ ./ W.c/.d / ./ C W.a/.b/ ./ V.c/.d / ./ o C .4/ ./ V.a/.b/ V.c/.d / U .b/ ./ U .c/ ./: (7.77) Using the comoving frame characterized by U .a/ .x/ D ı .a/ .4/ ; (7.78) we can compute the components Q.a/.b/ ./ in (7.77) in terms of the five functions .0/ ./; : : : ; .4/ ./: We summarize these (long) calculations in the following: Q.1/.1/./ D .2/ ./ .1=2/ .0/ ./ C .4/ ./ ; Q.1/.2/./ D .i=2/ .4/ ./ .0/ ./ Q.2/.1/./; (7.79i) (7.79ii) Q.1/.3/./ D .1/ ./ .3/ ./ Q.3/.1/./; Q.2/.2/./ D .2/ ./ C .1=2/ .0/ ./ C .4/ ./ ; Q.2/.3/./ D .i / .1/ ./ C .3/ ./ Q.3/.2/./; (7.79iii) Q.3/.3/./ D .2/ .2/ ./; (7.79vi) Q.˛/.4/ ./ Q.4/.˛/ ./ 0; (7.79vii) Q.4/.4/./ 0: (7.79viii) (7.79iv) (7.79v) 7.1 The Petrov Classification of the Curvature Tensor 491 (See the answer to Problem #5 of Exercise 7.1 for explicit computations.) From (7.79i–viii), we observe the following block diagonalization: Q.˛/.ˇ/ ./ WD Q.˛/.ˇ/ ./ ; 2 6 ŒQ./ D 6 4 Q 44 0 0 0 3 0 07 7: 05 0 (7.80i) (7.80ii) Now, from (7.79i–vi), we can explicitly express the symmetric 3 3 complex matrix as ŒQ./ D Q.˛/.ˇ/ ./ 33 (7.81i) 3 2 .2/ .1=2/ .0/ C .4/ ; .i=2/ .4/ .0/ ; .1/ .3/ D4 .2/ C .1=2/ .0/ C .4/ ; i .1/ C .3/ 5; 2 .2/ Q.ˇ/.˛/ ./ Q.˛/.ˇ/ ./ ; h i .˛/ Q .˛/ ./ D Trace ŒQ./ 0: (7.81ii) (7.81iii) Remark: The 3 3 complex matrix ŒQ./ involving five complex functions .0/ ./; : : : ; .4/ ./ contains exactly the information in the ten, real, independent components of the conformal tensor field C:::: ./: The algebraic classification of the conformal tensor field hinges on the classification of the complex 3 3 matrix Q.˛/.ˇ/ ./ in (7.81i). In constructing this matrix, we have made use of a comoving frame characterized by (7.46i,ii). What we need to note now is that the Segre characteristic of a real or complex matrix is invariant with respect to the choice of the underlying basis set. Therefore, the algebraic analysis of the matrix Q.˛/.ˇ/ ./ in (7.81i) yields an invariant classification of the conformal tensor. Firstly, we notice that there exist two classes of the 4 4 complex matrices Q.a/.b/./ given by ŒQ./ 6 Œ 0 ; 44 or else, ŒQ./ Œ 0 : 44 (7.82i) 44 44 (7.82ii) 492 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations For the class referred to in (7.82i), we must have Œ Q D Q.˛/.ˇ/ ./ 6 Œ 0 : 33 (7.83) 33 33 So, for this class, we need to obtain canonical or normal forms of 3 3 complex matrices. In Appendix 3, we have discussed Jordan canonical forms of N N real matrices. Presently, we need to investigate canonical or normal forms of N N complex matrices (specially for N D 3). For the sake of generality, we shall present the normal forms of an N N complex matrix [133, 177] in the following4: 3 2 A 7 6 .1/ 6 0 7 7 6 A.2/ Œ M .J / D6 (7.84i) 7; 7 6 : :: N N 5 4 0 A.k/ 2 ŒA.l/ 6 6 6 6 WD 6 6 6 6 4 3 .1/ J.l/ 0 .2/ J.l/ :: : 0 h .i / J.l/ i 6 6 6 WD 6 6 4 0 :: ::: : 0 i 2 f1; : : : ; .ql /g ; .q / 0 0 1 .ql / X .i / n.l/ D n.l/ ; n.l/ D N: lD1 Here, eigenvalues .l/ are either real or complex. 4 3 7 .l/ 1 0 7 7 ; :: 7 :: : : : :: : 7 5 ::: :: :: 1 : 0 .l/ i D1 k X (7.84ii) J.l/l 2 .l/ 7 7 7 7 7; 7 7 7 5 In Appendix 3, only real matrices of size N N are discussed. (7.84iii) 7.1 The Petrov Classification of the Curvature Tensor 493 In our present case with 3 3 complex matrix Q.˛/.ˇ/ ./ in (7.83), the class characterized by the condition (7.81iii) implies that three eigenvalues must satisfy: .1/ ./ C .2/ ./ C .3/ ./ 0: (7.85) The class of complex matrices, representing the conformal tensor and satisfying (7.83) belongs to Petrov types-I, D, II, N, and III. We shall elaborate these types in greater detail below. (See [210, 239].) The Petrov type I is characterized by the following equations: 3 2 .1/ ./ 7 6 (7.86) ŒQ./.J / D 4 .2/ ./ 5: .3/ ./ (Here, eigenvalues .1/ ./; .2/ ./; and .3/ ./ are distinct.) Complex eigenbivectors from (7.75i) yield E .1/ D V.a/.b/ ./ U.a/.b/ ./; .2/ E .a/.b/ ./ D i V.a/.b/ ./ C U.a/.b/ ./ ; E .3/ .a/.b/ ./ .a/.b/ ./ D W.a/.b/ ./: (7.87i) (7.87ii) (7.87iii) Complex coefficient functions: .0/ ./ D .4/ ./ D .1=2/ .2/ ./ .1/ ./ ¤ 0; .1/ ./ D .3/ ./ 0; .2/ ./ D .1=2/ .3/ ./: Complex Segre characteristic D Œ1; 1; 1 : (7.88) (7.89) The Petrov type D is specified by the following conditions: 2 6 ŒQ./.J / D 4 3 .1/ ./ 7 5: .1/ ./ (7.90) .3/ ./ (Here, the relation 2.1/ ./ D .3/ ./ holds.) Eigenbivectors: E .1/ .a/.b/ ./ D V.a/.b/ ./ U.a/.b/ ./; E./ WD c.1/ E E .3/ .a/.b/ ./ .1/ .a/.b/ ./ C c.2/ D W.a/.b/ ./: E .2/ .a/.b/ ./; (7.91i) (7.91ii) (7.91iii) 494 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations Complex coefficient functions: .0/ ./ D .1/ ./ D .3/ ./ D .4/ ./ 0; .2/ ./ D .1=2/ .3/ ./ ¤ 0: (7.92) Complex Segre characteristic D Œ.1; 1/; 1 : (7.93) For the Petrov type II, we have the criteria 2 3 .=2/ 1 0 .=2/ 0 5 : ŒQ./.J / D 4 0 0 0 However, we shall investigate the equivalent symmetric matrix 2 3 1 .=2/ i 0 i 1 .=2/ 0 5 : ŒQ./ D 4 0 0 (7.94i) (7.94ii) Eigenbivectors: E .1/ .a/.b/ ./ D V.a/.b/ ./; (7.95i) E .3/ .a/.b/ ./ D W.a/.b/ ./: (7.95ii) Complex coefficient functions: .0/ ./ D .1/ ./ D .3/ ./ 0; .2/ ./ D .=2/ ¤ 0; .4/ ./ 2: Complex Segre characteristic D Œ2; 1 : (7.96) (7.97) Now we shall deal with Petrov type N. The required equations are furnished here. ŒQ./.J / D 0 1 0 0 0 0 : 0 0 0 The equivalent symmetric matrix is given by 2 3 ŒQ./ D 1 i 0 6 7 4 i 1 0 5 : (7.98i) (7.98ii) 0 0 0 Eigenbivectors: E .1/ .a/.b/ ./ D V.a/.b/ ./; (7.99i) E .3/ .a/.b/ ./ D W.a/.b/ ./: (7.99ii) 7.1 The Petrov Classification of the Curvature Tensor 495 Complex coefficient functions: .0/ ./ D .1/ ./ D .2/ ./ D .3/ ./ 0; .4/ ./ 2: (7.100) Complex Segre characteristic D Œ.2; 1/ : (7.101) The Petrov type III requires the following conditions: 2 ŒQ./.J / D 0 1 6 40 0 0 0 0 3 7 15: (7.102i) 0 The equivalent symmetric matrix can be represented by 2 3 ŒQ./ D 0 0 i 6 7 40 0 15: i 1 (7.102ii) 0 Eigenbivectors: E .1/ .a/.b/ ./ D V.a.b/ ./: (7.103) Complex coefficient functions: .0/ ./ D .1/ ./ D .2/ ./ D .4/ ./ 0; .3/ ./ i: (7.104) Complex Segre characteristic D Œ3: (7.105) The remaining Petrov type 0 is governed by condition (7.82ii). In this case, the conformal tensor has the properties C:::: .x/ 0:::: .x/; ŒQ./ Œ 0 ; 44 44 ŒQ./ Œ 0 : 33 (7.106i) 33 .0/ ./ D .1/ ./ D .2/ ./ D .3/ ./ D .4/ ./ 0: (7.106ii) Every nonzero complex three-dimensional vector is an eigenbivector for ŒQ Œ 0 : Moreover, the complex Segre characteristic is provided by Œ.1; 1; 1/: Example 7.1.10. Let us consider the Brinkman–Robinson–Trautman metric provided by ds 2 D 2 d d 2 du dv 2 h ; ; u .du/2 2 DW 2 dx 1 dx 2 2 dx 3 dx 4 2 h x 1 ; x 2 ; x 3 dx 3 : (Here, x 1 and x 2 are complex conjugate coordinates of (A2.38).) (7.107) 496 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations The corresponding (natural) null tetrads are furnished by E m./ D @.1/ D @1 D @ ; (7.108i) E m./ D @.2/ D @2 D @ ; (7.108ii) El./ D @3 h./ @4 D @u h./ @v ; (7.108iii) E k./ D @.4/ D @4 D @v : (7.108iv) The nonzero Christoffel symbols, Riemann and Ricci tensor components, and curvature scalar for this metric are provided by @h./ 4 1 D ; D 23 33 @x 2 @h./ @h./ 2 4 D ; D ; 33 13 @x 1 @x 2 @h./ 4 D : 33 @x 3 R1313 D (7.109i) @2 h./ @2 h./ @2 h./ ; R D ; R D ; 1323 2323 .@x 1 /2 @x 2 @x 1 .@x 2 /2 R33 D 2 @2 h./ ; @x 2 @x 1 R D 0: (7.109ii) (7.109iii) The complex conformal tensor components, from (7.107), (7.69), (7.73), (7.74i–iv), and (7.77), are given by In case .0/ ./ D .1/ ./ D .2/ ./ D .3/ ./ 0; (7.110i) 1 2 (7.110ii) .a/.b/.c/.d /./ D .4/ ./ V.a/.b/ ./ V.c/.d / ./; .4/ ./ D @2 @2 h./ D @ @ h./; (7.110iii) V.a/.b/ ./ D k.a/ m.b/ k.b/ m.a/ : (7.110iv) ˇ ˇ ˇ ˇ ˇ@ @ h./ˇ > 0; (7.111) E we have the Petrov type N with the principal null direction along k./ (from (7.100) and (7.99i,ii)). The differential inequality (7.111) can be solved with help of a real-valued, arbitrary slack function ; ; u; v as Z h./ D ˙ exp Œ./ d d C c1 . / C c2 ; (7.112) 7.1 The Petrov Classification of the Curvature Tensor Table 7.1 Complex Segre characteristics and principal null directions for various Petrov types or 497 I Complex Segre characteristics Œ1; 1; 1 D Œ.1; 1/; 1 II Œ2; 1 III Œ3 N Œ.2; 1/ Petrov types Multiplicity of null E.x/ eigenvector k ˇ ˇ ˇ ˇ ˇ@ @ hˇ D expŒ./ > 0: Here, c1 and c2 are two arbitrary real constants of integration. The nonvanishing E .4/ ./ implies that the null eigenvector k.x/ is of multiplicity four. Thus, the metric under consideration physically describes (non-vacuum) transverse gravitational waves. (More detailed discussions on the metric will be provided in Example 7.2.5.) The invariant eigenvalue problem for the complex-valued conformal tensor components .a/.b/.c/.d /./ is posed in (7.75i,ii). The corresponding eigenbivectors E.a/.b/ ./ are explicitly provided in (7.87i–iii), (7.91i–iii), (7.95i,ii), (7.99i,ii), and (7.103). (We are not considering the Petrov type n0.) These eigenbivectors are o E E E E m; l; k . Therefore, each furnished by the wedge products of null vectors of m; of the Petrov type is intricately associated with four-dimensional (real or complex) null vectors. The Jordan canonical forms of the complex 3 3 matrix Q.˛/.ˇ/ ./ in (7.86), (7.90), (7.94i), (7.98i), and (7.102i) are adapted to the preferred, real E null vector k.x/. This null vector also physically represents the direction of propagation of the corresponding “gravitational wave” disturbance. Table 7.1, we depict the Petrov type, together with the corresponding multiplicity of the null E vector k.x/. 498 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations Now, we shall explore the canonical forms of the 4 4 real, symmetric matrix R.a/.b/ ./ arising out of the Ricci tensor. There exist nineteen Segre characteristics related to this matrix, which are symbolically exhibited below (from Examples A3.8 and A3.12): Œ1; 1; 1; 1 ; Œ.1; 1/; 1; 1 ; Œ.1; 1/; .1; 1/ ; Œ.1; 1; 1/; 1 ; Œ.1; 1; 1; 1/ I Œ1; 1; 2 ; Œ.1; 1/; 2 ; Œ1; .1; 2/ ; Œ.1; 1; 2/ I Œ2; 2 ; Œ.2; 2/ I Œ1; 3 ; Œ.1; 3/ I Œ4 I 1; 1I 1; 1 ; .1; 1/I 1; 1 ; Œ2I 1; 1; Œ1; 1I 1; 1; Œ.1; 1I 1; 1/: (7.113) Example 7.1.11. We will explicitly show the Jordan canonical form of a matrix endowed with Segre characteristic 1; 1I 1; 1 : It is furnished by 2 d .a/.c/ R.c/.b/ h .J / D R .a/ .b/ i .J / 6 6 6 6 D6 6 6 4 .1/ ./ 0 0 .2/ ./ 0 3 7 7 7 7 7: 7 a./ b./ 7 5 b./ a./ 0 (7.114) Here, we have assumed that .1/ .x/ ¤ .2/ .x/, and the complex conjugate eigenvalues are .x/ D a./ C i b./; .x/ D a./ i b./; b./ ¤ 0. Now, Einstein’s field equations (2.162ii) state that h i .c/ R.a/.b/ ./ D T.a/.b/ ./ .1=2/ d.a/.b/ T .c/ ./ : Let the invariant eigenvalue problem for T h T .a/ .b/ ./ ./ ı .a/ .b/ ./ .a/ .b/ i (7.115) be furnished by E .b/ ./ D 0: (7.116) From (7.115) and (7.116), we can derive that n R .a/ .b/ ./ o h i .c/ .a/ C T .c/ ./ C ./ ı .b/ E .b/ D 0: 2 (7.117) 7.1 The Petrov Classification of the Curvature Tensor 499 .a/ Equation iabove demonstrates that E ./ is also an eigenvector for the matrix h .a/ .c/ R .b/ ./ with invariant eigenvalue ./C 2 T .c/ ./. Of course, the correspond .c/ ing invariant eigenvalue of the matrix R.a/.b/ ./ is exactly ./ C 2 T .c/ ./. (We have discussed some of the canonical forms of the energy–momentum stress tensor in Example A3.11.) Therefore, the Segre characteristic of ŒRab is exactly the same as that of the corresponding ŒTab provided the field equations hold. Next, we shall present a useful decomposition of the curvature tensor with the help of the conformal tensor of (1.169ii). It is given by R.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/ D C.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/ C E.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/ C G.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/; (7.118i) S.a/.b/.x/ WD R.a/.b/ ./ .1=4/ R./ d.a/.b/ S.b/.a/ ./; S .a/ .a/ ./ 0; (7.118ii) E.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/ WD .1=2/ d.a/.d / S.b/.c/ ./ C d.b/.c/ S.a/.d / ./ d.a/.c/ S.b/.d / ./ d.b/.d / S.a/.c/./ ; (7.118iii) G.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/ WD .1=12/ R./ d.a/.c/ d.b/.d / d.a/.d / d.b/.c/ : (7.118iv) Now, analogous to (7.74i–v), we shall introduce complex components ˚.:/.:/ ./ which are related to the components S.a/.b/.x/: These are furnished by ˚.0/.0/ ./ WD .1=2/ S.a/.b/./ k .a/ ./ k .b/ ./ D ˚ .0/.0/ ./; (7.119i) ˚.0/.1/ ./ WD .1=2/ S.a/.b/./ k .a/ ./ m.b/ ./ D ˚ .1/.0/ ./; (7.119ii) ˚.0/.2/ ./ WD .1=2/ S.a/.b/./ m.a/ ./ m.b/ ./ D ˚ .2/.0/ ./; (7.119iii) h i ˚.1/.1/ ./ WD .1=4/ S.a/.b/ ./ k .a/ ./ l .b/ ./ C m.a/ ./ m.b/ ./ D ˚ .1/.1/ ./; (7.119iv) ˚.1/.2/ ./ WD .1=2/ S.a/.b/./ l .a/ ./ m.b/ ./ D ˚ .2/.1/ ./; (7.119v) ˚.2/.2/ ./ WD .1=2/ S.a/.b/./ l .a/ ./ l .b/ ./ D ˚ .2/.2/ ./: (7.119vi) Caution: Complex field components ˚.0/.0/ ./; ˚.0/.1/./; : : : ; ˚.2/.2/ ./ must not be confused with electromagnetic complex field components .0/ ./; .1/ ./; and .2/ ./ of (7.56i–iii), or complex field '.a/.b/ ./. We shall use the decomposition and definitions above to derive the Newman– Penrose equations in the next section. 500 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations Exercises 7.1 1. Consider the metric tensor components d.a/.b/.c/.d / D d.a/.c/ d.b/.d / d.a/.d / d.b/.c/ for the bivector space given in (7.10ii). These components can be mapped by (7.15) into D.A/.B/ with 1 A < B 6: Obtain explicitly the 6 6 matrix D.A/.B/ in terms of d.a/.b/ . 2. Consider a real 2-form .1=2/ W.a/.b/ ./ e e.a/ ./ ^e e.b/ ./ and the corresponding invariant eigenvalue equation (7.36ii). Now, pose the usual, noninvariant eigenvalue problem: W.a/.b/./ ".b/ ./ D ./ ı.a/.b/ ".b/ ./: Show that every, real eigenvalue .x/ 0: 3. Using definition (7.41) of the complex 2-form .1=2/ S.a/.b/./ e e.a/ ./ ^e e.b/ ./; prove that S.a/.b/ ./ D iS.a/.b/ ./: 4.Consider the basic self-dual tensor field components provided in .7.72i–v/: Prove .J / that each of the tensor field components E .a/.b/.c/.d /./ satisfies the algebraic identities in (7.71i–iv). 5. Compute explicitly the complex-valued components Q.a/.b/ ./ of (7.79i–viii) from (7.82i), (7.83), (7.77), and (7.78). 6. Prove (7.49i–iii) for self-duality. 7. Verify (7.74i–v) for the five complex scalar fields .0/ ./; .1/ ./; .2/ ./; .3/ ./; and .4/ ./. 8. Verify the eigenbivectors in (7.87i–iii) for the Petrov type I. Answers and Hints to Selected Exercises 1. The diagonal matrix D.A/.B/ is furnished by 2 6 6 6 6 6 6 D.A/.B/ D 6 6 6 6 6 4 3 d.1/.1/ d.2/.2/ d.1/.1/ d.3/.3/ d.1/.1/ d.4/.4/ d.2/.2/ d.3/.3/ d.2/.2/ d.4/.4/ 7 7 7 7 7 7 7: 7 7 7 7 5 d.3/.3/ d.4/.4/ (Note that the above matrix is identical to that in (7.18).) 2. 0 W.a/.b/ ./ ".b/ ./ ".a/ ./ D ./ ı.a/.b/ ".a/ ./ ".b/ ./: Dividing equation above by the positive-valued function ı.a/.b/ ".a/ ./ ".b/./; the conclusion can be reached. 7.1 The Petrov Classification of the Curvature Tensor 501 .4/ 4. Try out E .a/.b/.c/.d /./ D V.a/.b/ ./ V.c/.d / ./ for the sake of simplicity. From V.b/.a/ ./ V.a/.b/ ./; the identity (7.71i) is satisfied. By V.c/.d / ./ V.a/.b/ ./ V.a/.b/ ./ V.c/.d / ./; the identity (7.71ii) can be established. Now, V.a/.b/ ./ D k.a/ ./ m.b/ ./ k.b/ ./ m.a/ ./: Therefore, k.a/ m.b/ k.b/ m.a/ k.c/ m.d / k.d / m.c/ C k.a/ m.c/ k.c/ m.a/ k.d / m.b/ k.b/ m.d / C k.a/ m.d / k.d / m.a/ k.b/ m.c/ k.c/ m.b/ 0 .d / .a/ ./ proves identity (7.71iii). Now, V Therefore, .d / V .a/ ./ D k .d / ./ m.a/ ./ k.a/ ./ m.d / ./: V.b/.d / ./ D k .d / m.a/ k.a/ m.d / k.b/ m.d / k.d / m.b/ D m.a/ k.b/ k .d / m.d / k .d / k.d / m.a/ m.b/ k.a/ k.b/ m.d / m.d / C k.a/ m.b/ m.d / k.d / 0: Thus, we have proved the identity (7.71iv). Similarly, the identities (7.71i–iv) .0/ .1/ can be proved for the tensor field components E.a/.b/.c/.d /./; E.a/.b/.c/.d /./; .2/ .3/ E.a/.b/.c/.d /./ , and E.a/.b/.c/.d /./. 5. Recall (consulting the answer to the next Problem #6) that .a/ .a/ U.a/.4/ ./ D .1=2/ ı .1/ C i ı .2/ ; .a/ .a/ V.a/.4/ ./ D .1=2/ ı .1/ i ı .2/ ; W.a/.4/ ./ D ı Suspending . provided: .a/ .3/ : / around indices for simplicity, the following equation is .1=2/ Qad ./ ˚ D 0 ./ .1=4/ ı a1 ı d1 ı a2 ı d2 C i ı a1 ı d2 C ı d1 ı a2 ˚ C 1 ./ .1=2/ ı a1 ı d3 C ı d1 ı a3 C i ı a2 ı d3 C ı d2 ı a3 ˚ C 2 ./ .1=2/ ı a1 ı d1 C ı a2 ı d2 2 ı a3 ı d3 502 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations ˚ C 3 ./ .1=2/ ı a1 ı d3 C ı d1 ı a3 i ı a2 ı d3 C ı d2 ı a3 ˚ C 4 ./ .1=4/ ı a1 ı d1 ı a2 ı d2 i ı a1 ı d2 C ı d1 ı a2 : 6. Note that (7.4i,ii) and (7.5i,ii) imply that p .a/ p .a/ .a/ .a/ .a/ 2 l Dı .4/ ı .3/ ; 2 k .a/ D ı .4/ C ı .3/ ; p .a/ p .a/ .a/ .a/ .a/ 2 m Dı .1/ iı .2/ ; 2 m.a/ D ı .1/ C iı .2/ : Consider the complex bivector i h .a/ .b/ .a/ .b/ .b/ .a/ .b/ .a/ 2V.a/.b/ ./ D ı .4/ ı .1/ C ı .3/ ı .1/ ı .4/ ı .1/ ı .3/ ı .4/ i h .a/ .b/ .a/ .b/ .b/ .a/ .b/ .a/ C i ı .2/ ı .3/ C ı .2/ ı .4/ ı .2/ ı .3/ ı .2/ ı .3/ ; DW W .a/.b/ ./ i W .a/.b/ ./: Therefore, by the self-duality condition in (7.43), (7.49ii) is derived. Similarly, the other equations (7.49i, iii) are proven. 7. By (7.73), (7.77), and (7.50i–iv), .a/.b/.c/.d / ./ V.a/.b/ ./ V.c/.d / ./ ˚ D 2 .0/ U.a/.b/ U.c/.d / V.a/.b/ V.c/.d / C 0 C 0 C 0 C 0 D 8 .0/ Now, C.a/.b/.c/.d / V.a/.b/ V.c/.d / D 4 C.a/.b/.c/.d / k .a/ m.b/ k .c/ m.d / : Moreover, i C.a/.b/.c/.d / V.a/.b/ V.c/.d / i .p/.q/ .a/.b/ D .a/.b/.p/.q/ C V.c/.d / .c/.d / V 2 D iC .p/.q/ .c/.d / V.p/.q/ V .c/.d / D C.p/.q/.c/.d /V.p/.q/ V.c/.d / : Thus, .0/ ./ D D .a/.b/.c/.d / V.a/.b/ V.c/.d / 1 C.a/.b/.c/.d / i C.a/.b/.c/.d / V.a/.b/ V.c/.d / 8 7.2 Newman–Penrose Equations D 503 1 Œ4 C 4 C.a/.b/.c/.d /k .a/ m.b/ k .c/ m.d / 8 D C.a/.b/.c/.d /k .a/ m.b/ k .c/ m.d / : Thus, (7.74i) is proven. Similarly, other equations (7.74ii–v) can be established. 8. Equations (7.75i) and (7.77) imply that ˚ .0/ Uab Ucd C .1/ ŒUab Wcd C Wab Ucd C .2/ ŒVab Ucd C Uab Vcd C Wab Wcd C .3/ ŒVab Wcd C Wab Vcd C .4/ Vab Vcd E cd D 2 Eab : .1/ Consider the eigenbivector E ab WD Vab Uab . The eigenvalue equation above yields the following (by use of (7.50i–vi)): .4/ Vab C.0/ Uab C.2/ .Vab Uab /C .1/ .3/ Wab D .1/ .Vab Uab / : By the linear independence of bivectors in (7.48i, iii, v), conclude that .1/ D .4/ C .2/ D .0/ C .2/ and .1/ .3/ 0 . Using the eigenvector .3/ E ab WD Wab , one can deduce from equations above that .3/ D 2 .2/ and .2/ .1/ D .3/ 0 . Similarly, employing the eigenbivector E ab WD i ŒVab C Uab , one can prove that .2/ D .0/ C .2/ D .2/ C .4/ and .1/ C .3/ 0 . Thus, (7.86), (7.87i–iii), and (7.88) are directly verified. 7.2 Newman–Penrose Equations The Newman–Penrose equations [194] are exactly equivalent to Einstein’s field equations of (2.163ii). However, (1) these are a set of first-order partial differential equations, and (2) instead of a real orthonormal tetrad, the complex null tetrad of the equations (7.6i) is used. (3) These equations explicitly involve the Petrov classification of the conformal tensor. Equations are particularly suited for extracting exact solutions involving “gravitational waves.” Moreover, the Newman–Penrose equations have been exploited to discover a plethora of exact solutions in general relativity. (See [35, 118, 239].) We have already investigated a (real) first-order version of the field equations in a harmonic coordinate chart for the classification of the partial differential equations representing the field equations in Example 2.4.6. Moreover, we have also discussed a first-order system, equivalent to the field equations, without employing special coordinates, in the answer for question # 4 of Exercises 2.4. We shall recapitulate this formulation subsequently to investigate in greater depth the first-order version of 504 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations the real field equations. This system of partial differential equations for the unknown k functions gij .x/ and is furnished by ij First-order p.d.e.s for h h unknown functions: @k gij D gj h ./ C gih ./ ; ki kj Integrability conditions: @l gj h Field equations: @k i ij h h Cgih ki kj @i Œl $ k D 0; (7.120i) (7.120ii) i i h i h C kj kh ij ih kj or, first-order p.d.e.’s for ! 8 hl ˆ ˆ Tkj ./.1=2/gkj ./g ./Thl ./ < inside sources, (7.120iii) D ˆ :̂ 0 outside sources; i unknown: jk Contracted Bianchi identities ) rj T ij D 1 rj G ij 0; Coordinate conditions: (7.120iv) C i gj k ; @l gj k D 0: (7.120v) The above system of first-order equations is exactly equivalent to field equations (2.162i). Now, we shall provide an example of exact solutions for the system (7.120i–v). Example 7.2.1. Consider the static, spherically symmetric metric (3.1) expressed as 2 2 h 2 2 2 i 1 ds 2 D e˛.x / dx 1 C x 1 dx 2 C sin x 2 dx 3 e .x 1 / 2 dx 4 ; (7.121i) 2 2 1 g11 ./ D e˛.x / ; g22 ./ D x 1 ; g33 ./ D x 1 sin x 2 ; g44 ./ D e other gij ./ 0: .x 1 / ; (7.121ii) 7.2 Newman–Penrose Equations 505 The nonzero components of the Christoffel symbols from (3.2) are given by 1 D .1=2/ @1 ˛; 11 1 3 D x1 ; 13 3 D cot x 2 ; 23 1 2 D x1 ; 12 1 D x 1 e˛ ; 22 2 1 D x 1 sin x 2 e˛ ; 33 2 D sin x 2 cos x 2 ; 33 4 D .1=2/ @1 ; 14 1 D .1=2/ e 44 ˛ @1 : (7.122) Now, consider one of the equations in (7.120i), namely, @1 g11 D 2g11 ./ 1 : 11 By (7.121ii) and (7.122), we deduce that @1 g11 D e˛./ @1 ˛; 2g11 1 D 2 e˛./ Œ.1=2/ @1 ˛ : 11 Thus, in this case, (7.120i) is satisfied. Now consider (7.120ii) for the case i Dj D 1: These reduce to the following equation: 1 11 @2 2g11 @1 g12 2 1 C g11 21 21 D 0: Thus, (7.120ii) is verified for i D j D 1. Similarly, the other equations in (7.120ii) are satisfied. Now consider the vacuum field equations by choosing Tij .x/ 0 in (7.120iii), so that Rij .x/ D 0: Let us try to compute the particular component R22 ./ from (7.120iii) and (7.122). It is provided by explicit computation as R22 ./ D @2 3 1 3 @1 C 23 22 23 2 1 1 4 2 3 C C C 22 11 14 12 13 2 D @2 cot x 2 C @1 x 1 e˛ C cot x 2 C x 1 e˛ 506 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations .1=2/@1˛ C .1=2/@4 C 2 x1 D e˛./ 1 C x 1 =2 .@1 @1 ˛/ 1; 2 R33 ./ sin x 2 R22 ./: Similarly, the other nonzero components, R11 ./ and R44 ./m can be computed. Solving the partial differential equations inherent in the Ricci-flat conditions, Rij ./ D 0, the well-known Schwarzschild metric of (3.9) emerges. Now we shall consider another first-order system of equations equivalent to field equations (2.163ii). These equations involve a (real) orthonormal basis and orthonormal components of tensor fields. Equations (1.104) provide a real tetrad ˚ 4 Ee.a/ ./ 1 characterized by Ee.a/ .x/ WD i.a/ ./ @i ; .a/ e e.a/ .x/ WD h .a/ i ./ (7.123i) dx i ; (7.123ii) i h i1 i ./ WD ./ : .a/ i (7.123iii) Here, we treat the 16 components of i.a/ .x/ as unknown functions. The metric tensor components satisfy j d.a/.b/ D gij ./ i.a/ ./ .b/ ./; .a/ gij .x/ D d.a/.b/ i ./ .b/ j ./; (7.124i) (7.124ii) and are thus determined by the functions i.a/ .x/. The directional derivatives are defined from (1.114ii) as @.a/ f WD i.a/ ./ @i f D Ee.a/ ./Œf : (7.125) The covariant derivatives of the energy–momentum–stress tensor field components from (1.124ii) are provided by r.c/ T .a1 /.ar / .b1 /.bs / WD @.c/ T .a1 /.ar / r X .b1 /.bs / T .a1 /.a˛1 /.d /.a˛C1 /.ar / .d /.c/ .d / .bˇ /.c/ T .a1 /.ar / .a˛ / .b1 /.bs / ˛D1 C s X .b1 /.bˇ1 /.d /.bˇC1 /.bs / : ˇD1 (7.126) 7.2 Newman–Penrose Equations 507 The (real) Ricci rotation coefficients, which are also unknown functions, are furnished from (1.138) and (1.139i,ii,iii) as .a/.b/.c/ .x/ WD d.a/.e/ .b/.a/.c/ .x/ .e/ .b/.c/ ./; (7.127i) .a/.b/.c/ .x/; (7.127ii) j l k .a/.b/.c/ .x/ D gj l ./ rk .a/ .b/ ./ .c/ ./: (7.127iii) The 24 components .a/.b/.c/ are also treated as unknown functions. Next, we have integrability conditions (1.139iv) @.a/ @.b/ f @.b/ @.a/ f D d .c/.e/ .e/.a/.b/ .e/.b/.a/ @.c/ f; h i h i @.a/ @.b/ k.c/ @.b/ @.a/ k.c/ D d .e/.h/ .e/.a/.b/ .e/.b/.a/ (7.128i) h i @.h/ k.c/ : (7.128ii) The field equations (2.163ii) yield R .d / .a/.b/.c/ .x/ DC .d / .a/.b/.c/ .x/ n .d / .d / C .=2/ ı .b/ T.a/.c/ ı .c/ T.a/.b/ .d / .d / C d.a/.c/ T .b/ d.a/.b/ T .c/ i o h .d / .d / .e/ C .2=3/ ı .c/ d.a/.b/ ı .b/ d.a/.c/ T .e/ inside material sources, R .d / .a/.b/.c/ .x/ DC .d / .a/.b/.c/ .x/ (7.129i) outside material sources. (7.129ii) Bianchi’s differential identities of (1.143ii) imply that the following equations hold: h i h i .d / .d / .d / .d / r.e/ R .a/.b/.c/ C .a/.b/.c/ C r.b/ R .a/.c/.e/ C .a/.c/.e/ h i .d / .d / C r.c/ R .a/.e/.b/ C .a/.e/.b/ h i .d / .d / .d / r.e/ C .a/.b/.c/ C r.b/ C .a/.c/.e/ C r.c/ C .a/.e/.b/ 2 = 6 6 6 4 o n .d / .d / .d / .=2/ r.e/ T .a/.b/.c/ C r.b/ T .a/.c/.e/ C r.c/ T .a/.e/.b/ inside material sources, 0 outside material sources. (7.130) 508 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations Here, T .d / .a/.b/.c/ WD ı .d / .b/ T.a/.c/ ı .d / .c/ T.a/.b/ .d / C d.a/.c/ T .b/ d.a/.b/ T 2 .d / .d / .f / C ı .c/ d.a/.b/ ı .b/ d.a/.c/ T .f / : 3 Four possible coordinate conditions can be stated as C .a/ k.b/ ; @.c/ k.b/ D 0: .d / .c/ (7.131) Thus, the field equations relative to a (real) orthonormal tetrad are completely stated. Now we verify the first-order system above by substituting a known metric. Example 7.2.2. The spatially flat F–L–R–W cosmological metric of (6.9) is examined. Recall that it is provided by 2 2 ds 2 D a x 4 ı˛ˇ dx ˛ dx ˇ dx 4 ; x 4 > 0; a x 4 > 0: (7.132) The metric above implies that e.˛/ ./ ˝e e.ˇ/ ./ e e.4/ ./ ˝e e.4/ ./; g:: ./ D ı.˛/.ˇ/ e .˛/ .˛/ e e.˛/ ./ D i ./ dx i D a x 4 ı i dx i ; .4/ e e.4/ ./ D .4/ dx i D ı i dx i ; 1 i Ee.˛/ ./ D i.˛/ ./ @i D a x 4 ı .˛/ @i ; i ./ (7.133i) (7.133ii) (7.133iii) (7.133iv) Ee.4/ ./ D i.4/ ./ @i D ı i.4/ @i : (7.133v) The directional derivatives of (7.125) imply that 1 @.˛/ f D a x 4 @˛ f; (7.134i) @.4/ f D @4 f; h i @.˛/ i.a/ ./ 0: (7.134ii) (7.134iii) The nonzero components of the Ricci rotation coefficients from (7.127i–iii), (7.132), and (7.133i–v) are calculated to be .4/.˛/.ˇ/ ./ .˛/.4/.ˇ/ ./ o n j D 0 C Œkh; j ı h.4/ .a2 / ı .˛/ ı k.ˇ/ D Œa=a P ı.˛/.ˇ/ ; aP WD d a x4 : 4 dx (7.135) 7.2 Newman–Penrose Equations 509 The nonzero components of the directional derivatives of the Ricci rotation coefficients are given by @.4/ .4/.˛/.ˇ/ @.4/ .˛/.4/.ˇ/ D d dx 4 aP a ı.˛/.ˇ/ : (7.136) The integrability conditions (7.128ii) are identically satisfied due to (7.135) and (7.136). The nonzero, orthonormal components of the curvature tensor, from (1.141i,ii), (7.135), and (7.136), are provided by R R ./ ./ .4/.4/. / ./ D 0 @.4/ .˛/. /.ˇ/ ./ aP a D aR WD ./ .4/. / C ./ .˛/ .4/.˛/ .4/. / C 0 D Œa=a R ı ./ . / ; 2 h i ./ ./ ı . / ı.˛/.ˇ/ ı .ˇ/ ı.˛/. / ; d2 .dx 4 /2 a x4 : (7.137) By the prior knowledge of (6.13i,ii) and (6.14i,ii) and the assumption of an incoherent dust model, we obtain C .a/ .b/.c/.d / ./ 0; (7.138i) T.˛/.b/ ./ 0; (7.138ii) T.4/.4/ ./ > 0: (7.138iii) Field equation (7.129i), with (7.137) and (7.138i–iii), boils down to R ./ .4/.4/. / ./ D R ./ .˛/. /.ˇ/ ./ D h aR ./ ./ ı . / D T.4/.4/ ı . / ; a 6 i aP 2 h ./ ./ ı . / ı.˛/.ˇ/ ı .ˇ/ ı.˛/. / a i h ./ ./ D ı . / ı.˛/.ˇ/ ı .ˇ/ ı.˛/. / T.4/.4/ ./; 3 i 2a aR C .a/ P 2 ı.˛/.ˇ/ D 0; 3 .a=a/ P 2 D T.4/.4/./: (7.139i) (7.139ii) (7.139iii) (7.139iv) 510 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations Bianchi’s differential identities (7.130) reduce to the conservation equation io d n h 3 ln T D 0: ./ .a.// .4/.4/ dx 4 (7.140) By (6.21i–iii), it is clear that (7.138ii,iii), (7.139i,ii), and (7.140) are exactly equivalent to (6.12i,ii,iv) and (6.15) governing the F–L–R–W cosmological models containing incoherent dust. Now, we shall introduce the complex, null tetrad of (7.5i–iv) and (7.6i–v). We summarize the relevant equations in the following: n E .a/ ./ E o4 1 n o E El./; k./ E E WD m./; m./; ; ˚ .a/ 4 ˚ e e e ./; e E ./ 1 D m./; m k./; e l./ ; 3 2 0 1 0 7 6 7 61 0 .a/.b/ .a/.b/ D 6 7; 0 1 5 4 44 44 0 1 0 E .a/ ./ D i.a/ ./ @i ; E h .a/ M .a/ e E.a/ ./ D M i ./ dx i ; i h i1 i ./ WD ./ ; .a/ i j .a/ i ./ .a/ i ./ .b/ j ./; .a/ .b/ DM i ./ (7.141vi) j (7.141viii) .b/ j ./; M .a/ j ./; .a/ (7.141iv) (7.141vii) ı ij D i.a/ ./ M ı (7.141iii) M g ij ./ D .a/.b/ i.a/ ./ .b/ ./; gij ./ D .a/.b/ M (7.141ii) (7.141v) .a/.b/ D gij ./ i.a/ ./ .b/ ./; .a/.b/ D g ij ./ M (7.141i) i.b/ ./: (7.141ix) (7.141x) (7.141xi) The directional derivatives involving complex-valued functions i.a/ .x/ are defined similar to (7.125) as @.a/ f WD i.a/ ./ @i f: Here, f may be a real or a complex-valued differentiable function. (7.142) 7.2 Newman–Penrose Equations 511 The covariant derivatives of complex-valued components related to a complex tensor field are defined analogous to (7.126) as: .a1 /.ar / r.c/ T .a1 /.ar / .b1 /.bs / WD @.c/ T .b1 /.bs / r X L.a˛ / .a1 /.a˛1 /.d /.a˛C1 /.ar / .d /.c/ T .bˇ /.c/ T .b1 /.bs / ˛D1 C s X L.d / .a1 /.ar / .b1 /.bˇ1 /.d /.bˇC1 /.bs / : ˇD1 (7.143) The complex-valued Ricci rotation coefficients are furnished by: L.e/ .b/.c/ ./ D .e/.a/ L .a/.b/.c/ ./; (7.144i) L L.d / D .a/.d / .b/.c/ ./; L L .b/.a/.c/ ./ .a/.b/.c/ ./; L j l k ./ D g ./ r .a/.b/.c/ jl k .a/ .b/ ./ .c/ ./: .a/.b/.c/ ./ (7.144ii) (7.144iii) (7.144iv) We treat as unknown functions the 16 complex components i.a/ .x/ and the 24 L complex components .a/.b/.c/ .x/: Next, we present complex integrability conditions for the first-order partial differential equations (7.144iv) as L L @.a/ @.b/ f @.b/ @.a/ f D .c/.e/ .e/.a/.b/ .e/.b/.a/ @.c/ f; h i h i L L @.a/ @.b/ k.c/ @.b/ @.a/ k.c/ D .h/.e/ .e/.a/.b/ .e/.b/.a/ h i @.h/ k.c/ : (7.145i) (7.145ii) (See #3 of Exercises 7.2 for the derivation of the integrability conditions (7.145i).) Field equations (2.163ii) and (7.129i,ii) yield complex-valued field equations: n R.d /.a/.b/.c/.x/ D C.d /.a/.b/.c/./ C .=2/ .d /.b/ T.a/.c/ .d /.c/ T.a/.b/ C .a/.c/ T.d /.b/ .a/.b/ T.d /.c/ .e/ o C .2=3/ .d /.c/ .a/.b/ .d /.b/ .a/.c/ T .e/ R.d /.a/.b/.c/.x/ D C.d /.a/.b/.c/.x/ inside material sources, (7.146i) outside material sources. (7.146ii) 512 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations The complex-valued Bianchi’s differential identities from (1.143ii), (7.130), and consequent equations are furnished by: r.e/ R.d /.a/.b/.c/ C.d /.a/.b/.c/ C r.b/ Œ C r.c/ Œ r.e/ C.d /.a/.b/.c/ C r.b/ C.d /.a/.c/.e/ C r.c/ C.d /.a/.e/.b/ n 2 .=2/ r.e/ T.d /.b/.a/.c/ 6 o D6 4 Cr.b/ ŒT.d /.a/.c/.e/ C r.c/ ŒT.d /.a/.e/.b/ ; inside material sources; 0; outside material sources. (7.147) Here, T.d /.a/.b/.c/ WD .d /.b/ T.a/.c/ .d /.c/ T.a/.b/ C .a/.c/ T.d /.b/ .f / .a/.b/ T.d /.c/ C .2=3/ .d /.c/ .a/.b/ .d /.b/ .a/.c/ T .f / : (According to the T-method of Sect. 2.4, the functions T.a/.b/ .x/ can be prescribed.) At most four possible coordinate conditions, which can be imposed, are stated as C .a/ k.b/ ; @.c/ k.b/ D 0: (7.148) Now, we should mention that there exist other alternative ways to express the complex-valued field equations by using R.a/.b/ ./ .1=2/ .a/.b/ R./ D T.a/.b/ ./; .a/ R./ D T .a/ ./; h i .c/ R.a/.b/ ./ D T.a/.b/ ./ .1=2/ .a/.b/ T .c/ ./ : (7.149i) (7.149ii) (7.149iii) (Consult [53, 271].) We now go back to (7.146i,ii). The field equations (7.146i,ii) with (7.149i–iii) go over into R.d /.a/.b/.c/.x/ D C.d /.a/.b/.c/./ n C .1=2/ .d /.c/ R.a/.b/ .d /.b/ R.a/.c/ C .a/.b/ R.d /.c/ .a/.c/ R.d /.b/ o (7.150) C .1=3/ .a/.c/ .d /.b/ .a/.b/ .d /.c/ R : Bianchi’s differential identities from (7.147) yield 7.2 Newman–Penrose Equations 513 n 0 D r.e/ C.d /.a/.b/.c/./ C .1=2/ .d /.c/ R.a/.b/ .d /.b/ R.a/.c/ C .a/.b/ R.d /.c/ .a/.c/ R.d /.b/ o C .1=6/ .a/.c/ .d /.b/ .a/.b/ .d /.c/ R C r.b/ f g C r.c/ f g: (7.151) There exists still another way to express (7.150) and equations originating from Bianchi’s differential identities. Recall (7.118ii). We define analogous complex tensor components via ˙.a/.b/ .x/ WD R.a/.b/ ./ .1=4/ .a/.b/ R./; ˙ .a/ .a/ .x/ 0; (7.152i) (7.152ii) R.a/.b/ .x/ D ˙.a/.b/ ./ C .1=4/ .a/.b/ R./: (7.152iii) Equations (7.150) with (7.152i–iii) yield a newer form of the field equations; namely, R.d /.a/.b/.c/.x/ D C.d /.a/.b/.c/./ n C .1=2/ .d /.c/ ˙.a/.b/ .d /.b/ ˙.a/.c/ C .a/.b/ ˙.d /.c/ .a/.c/ ˙.d /.b/ o (7.153) C .1=6/ .a/.b/ .d /.c/ .a/.c/ .d /.b/ R ; ˙.a/.b/ ./ D T.a/.b/ ./ 1 .c/ .a/.b/ T .c/ ./ : 4 Bianchi’s differential identities (7.151) yield equations5 n 0 Dr.e/ C.d /.a/.b/.c/./ C .1=2/ .d /.c/ ˙.a/.b/ .d /.b/ ˙.a/.c/ C .a/.b/ ˙.d /.c/ .a/.c/ ˙.d /.b/ o C .1=12/ .a/.b/ .d /.c/ .d /.b/ .a/.c/ R C r.b/ f g C r.c/ f g: 5 (7.154) Note that 1 .d /.c/ r.e/ ˙.a/.b/ .d /.b/ r.e/ ˙.a/.c/ 2 1 r.e/ ˙.d /.b/ C .a/.b/ .d /.c/ .a/.c/ .d /.b/ r.e/ R: 12 r.e/ R.d /.a/.b/.c/ D r.e/ C.d /.a/.b/.c/ C C .a/.b/ r.e/ ˙.d /.c/ .a/.c/ This equation is useful in the derivation of eight of the Bianchi identities (7.182i–viii) later on. 514 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations Now, consider the set of transformations of the complex null tetrad such that integrability conditions (7.145i,ii), field equations (7.146i,ii), and Bianchi’s differential identities (7.147) all transform covariantly. We will provide this class of transformations in the following equations: 4 b E .a/ ./ E b b b E El./; b E E WD m./; m./; k./ ; (7.155i) 1 b E .b/ ./; E .a/ ./ D L.b/ ./ E E .a/ .a/ .a/.b/ L .c/ ./ .b/ L .d / ./ (7.155ii) D .c/.d / ; ŒL./T Œ ŒL./ D Œ: (7.155iii) (7.155iv) We shall give an example of such a set of transformations in the following example. Example 7.2.3. We consider a transformation already discussed in (7.7i). It is specified by b E E m.x/ D exp Œi .x/ m.x/; b E E m.x/ D exp Œi .x/ m.x/; b El.x/ D El.x/; b E E k.x/ D k.x/: The corresponding complex, Lorentz matrix from (7.155i,ii), is given by 2 6 6 ŒL./ D 6 4 44 ei 0 ei 0 0 3 0 7 7 7: 1 05 0 1 Now we shall discuss another example, which involves the null complex tetrad, complex integrability conditions, complex field equations, and complex Bianchi’s differential identities. Example 7.2.4. The following metric is investigated: 2 1 2 ds 2 D 2 1 C .1=2/ x 1 x 2 dx dx 2 dx 3 dx 4 ; (7.156i) 2 D 2 1 C .1=2/ j j2 .d / d 2 .du/ .dv/ ; (7.156ii) 7.2 Newman–Penrose Equations 2 0 Œ2 ij 6 6 Œ2 0 g ./ D 6 4 0 515 3 0 7 7 7: 0 1 5 (7.156iii) 1 0 (Here, x 1 and x 2 are complex conjugate coordinates of (A2.38) and (A2.39i,ii).) The corresponding natural, complex null tetrad is provided by E .1/ ./ m./ E D Œ @1 ; E E .3/ ./ El./ D @3 ; E E E .2/ ./ m./ E D Œ @2 ; E .4/ ./ k./ E E D @4 : Therefore, from (7.141i–xi) and (7.156iii), we derive the complex valued components as k.1/ ./ D 1 C .1=2/ x 1 x 2 ı k.1/ ; (7.157i) k.2/ ./ D 1 C .1=2/ x 1 x 2 ı k.2/ ; (7.157ii) k.3/ ./ D ı k.3/ ; (7.157iii) k.4/ ./ D ı k.4/ : (7.157iv) With help of (7.142) and (7.157i–iv), directional derivations are deduced as @.1/ f D 1 C .1=2/ x 1 x 2 @1 f; @.2/ f D 1 C .1=2/ x 1 x 2 @2 f; (7.158ii) @.3/ f D @3 f; (7.158iii) @.4/ f D @4 f: (7.158iv) (7.158i) From (7.144iv), the four, nonzero, complex-valued Ricci rotation coefficients are furnished by L .1/.2/.1/ .x/ L .1/.2/.2/ .x/ L D @1 g21 1.1/ Œ D .1=2/ x 2 .2/.1/.1/ .x/; D .1=2/ x 1 L .2/.1/.2/ .x/: (7.159i) (7.159ii) (The other twenty Ricci rotation coefficients are identically zero!) The complexvalued integrability conditions (7.145i,ii) are exactly satisfied from (7.156i), (7.157i–iv), (7.158i–iv), and (7.159i,ii). 516 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations Now, we shall compute the complex-valued curvature tensor components from generalizations of (1.141iv) as: L L R.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/ D @.d / .a/.b/.c/ @.c/ .a/.b/.d / C .h/.e/ L L L L .h/.a/.d / .e/.b/.c/ .h/.a/.c/ .e/.b/.d / L L L C .a/.b/.h/ .e/.c/.d / .e/.d /.c/ ; R.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/ D I.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/ C II.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/; L L I.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/ WD @.d / .a/.b/.c/ @.c/ .a/.b/.d / ; L L L L II.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/ WD .h/.e/ .h/.a/.d / .e/.b/.c/ .h/.a/.c/ .e/.b/.d / L L L C .a/.b/.h/ .e/.c/.d / .e/.d /.c/ : (7.160i) (7.160ii) (7.160iii) (7.160iv) Computation of the quantities I.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/ and II.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/ in (7.160iii,iv), from (7.158i–iv) and (7.159i,ii), leads to the nonzero components: I.1/.2/.1/.2/.x/ D 1 C .1=2/ x 1 x 2 ; II.1/.2/.1/.2/.x/ D 2 L .1/.2/.2/ ./ L .1/.2/.1/ ./ (7.161i) D .1=2/ x 1 x 2 ; R.1/.2/.1/.2/.x/ D I.1/.2/.1/.2/.x/ C II.1/.2/.1/.2/.x/ D 1: (7.161ii) (7.161iii) Other, linearly dependent, nonzero components of R.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/ can be determined from (7.161iii) from the algebraic identities (1.142iv–viii). The complex-valued Riemann tensor components satisfy the following equations: R.1/.2/.1/.2/.x/ D 1 D .1/.1/ .2/.2/ .1/.2/ .2/.1/ : (7.162i) Moreover, R.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/ D .a/.c/ .b/.d / .a/.d / .b/.c/ for a; b; c; d 2 f1; 2gI 0 otherwise. (7.162ii) Therefore, (7.162ii), with reference to (1.164ii), reveal that the universe represented by the metric (7.156i) is topologically homeomorphic to S 2 R2 : Remarks: (i) We have used complex conjugate coordinates ; in Examples 7.1.10 and 7.2.4. (We have mentioned these coordinates also in (A2.38).) These coordinates are very effective in solving some partial differential equations. However, the complex conjugate coordinate is not independent of the complex variable : Therefore, there exists a logical gap in using such coordinates. 7.2 Newman–Penrose Equations 517 p E (ii) Similarly, the complex vectors m./ WD 1= 2 Ee.1/ ./ i Ee.2/ ./ and p E m./ D 1= 2 Ee.1/ ./ C i Ee.2/ ./ are not independent. However, these vectors are used quite effectively as two basis vectors of a null, complex tetrad! (iii) The metric of (7.156i) represents a special metric in a regular pseudoRiemannian manifold. However, it is not explicitly connected with the gravitational field equations as such. To render the metric as a solution of Einstein’s field equations, we have to compute the tensor field components R.a/.b/ ./ 1=2 .a/.b/ R./. Next, we need to define T.a/.b/ ./ from (7.149i). Now, we shall proceed to derive the Newman–Penrose equations. (See [35, 194, 239].) For that purpose, we introduce new notations which are used only in this section of the book. (This notation is often used in the literature when discussing the Newman–Penrose formalism.) The directional derivatives are denoted by the following: E .1/ ./ D m./ E ı WD E D mi ./ @i D m.a/ ./ @.a/ ; (7.163i) E E .2/ ./ D m./ ı WD E D mi ./ @i D m.a/ ./ @.a/ ; (7.163ii) E .3/ ./ D El./ D l i ./ @i D l .a/ ./ @.a/ ; WD E (7.163iii) E E .4/ ./ D k./ D k i ./ @i D k .a/ ./ @.a/ : D WD E (7.163iv) We denote complex-valued Ricci rotation coefficients (also called spin coefficients) as .0/ ./ WD L L .1/.4/.4/ ./ D r.b/ k.a/ m.a/./k .b/./ D m.a/ ./Dk.a/; (7.164i) .0/ ./ D .2/.4/.4/./; (7.164ii) L (7.164iii) ./ WD .1/.4/.2/./ D r.b/ k.a/ m.a/ ./m.b/ ./ D m.a/ ./ık.a/ ; L ./ D .2/.4/.1/ ./; (7.164iv) .a/ L (7.164v) ./ WD .1/.4/.1/./ D r.b/ k.a/ m ./m.b/./ D m.a/ ./ık.a/ ; L ./ D .2/.4/.2/ ./; (7.164vi) .a/ L (7.164vii) ./ WD .1/.4/.3/ ./ D r.b/ k.a/ m ./l .b/./ D m.a/ ./k.a/ ; L ./ D .2/.4/.3/./; (7.164viii) .a/ L ./ WD .2/.3/.3/./ D r.b/ l.a/ m ./l .b/./ D m.a/ ./l.a/ ; (7.164ix) L (7.164x) ./ D .1/.3/.3/ ./; .a/ L ./ WD .2/.3/.1/ ./ D r.b/ l.a/ m ./m.b/./ D m.a/ ./ıl.a/ ; (7.164xi) L ./ D .1/.3/.2/ ./; (7.164xii) 518 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations ./ WD ./ D L .2/.3/.2/ ./ D r.b/ l.a/ m.a/ ./m.b/ ./ D m.a/ ./ıl.a/ ; (7.164xiii) L .1/.3/.1/ ./; (7.164xiv) L .0/ ./ WD .2/.3/.4/./ D r.b/ l.a/ m.a/ ./k .b/./ D m.a/ ./Dl.a/; (7.164xv) L .0/ ./ D .1/.3/.4/./; (7.164xvi) L L "./ WD .1=2/ .3/.4/.4/ .2/.1/.4/ h i D .1=2/ r.b/ k.a/ l .a/ k .b/ r.b/ m.a/ m.a/ k .b/ i h (7.164xvii) D .1=2/ l .a/ Dk.a/ m.a/ Dm.a/ ; L L (7.164xviii) "./ D .1=2/ .3/.4/.4/ .1/.2/.4/ ; L L ˇ./ WD .1=2/ .3/.4/.1/ .2/.1/.1/ i h D .1=2/ r.b/ k.a/ l .a/ m.b/ r.b/ m.a/ m.a/ m.b/ i h (7.164xix) D .1=2/ l .a/ ık.a/ m.a/ ım.a/ ; L L ˇ./ D .1=2/ .3/.4/.2/ .1/.2/.2/ ; (7.164xx) L L ./ WD .1=2/ .4/.3/.3/ .1/.2/.3/ D .1=2/ r.b/ l.a/ k .a/ l .b/ r.b/ m.a/ m.a/ l .b/ (7.164xxi) D .1=2/ k .a/ l.a/ m.a/ m.a/ ; L L (7.164xxii) ./ D .1=2/ .4/.3/.3/ .2/.1/.3/ ; L L ˛./ WD .1=2/ .4/.3/.2/ .1/.2/.2/ i h D .1=2/ r.b/ l.a/ k .a/ m.b/ r.b/ m.a/ m.a/ m.b/ (7.164xxiii) D .1=2/ k .a/ ıl.a/ m.a/ ım.a/ ; L L (7.164xxiv) ˛./ D .1=2/ .3/.4/.1/ C .1/.2/.1/ : Now, we shall compute integrability conditions (7.145i) with help of the new symbols (7.163i–iv) for directional derivatives and the spin coefficients defined in (7.164i–xxiv). Let us work out from (7.145i) the integrability condition ıDf Dıf L L [email protected]/ @.4/ f @.4/ @.1/ f D .e/.1/.4/ @.e/ f .e/.4/.1/ @.e/ f L L L D .2/.1/.4/ @.2/ f C .3/.1/.4/ @.3/ f C .4/.1/.4/ @.4/ f 7.2 Newman–Penrose Equations L L @.1/ f .2/.4/.1/ @.2/ f .3/.4/.1/ @.3/ f L L L D .1/.2/.4/ ıf C .1/.3/.4/ Df C .1/.4/.4/ f L L L .1/.4/.1/ ıf .2/.4/.1/ ıf C .3/.4/.1/ Df L L L L D .1/.2/.4/ C .2/.4/.1/ ıf C .1/.3/.4/ C .3/.4/.1/ Df L L C .1/.4/.4/ f .1/.4/.1/ ıf D . C " "/ ıf C ˛ C ˇ .0/ Df C .0/ f ıf: 519 L .1/.4/.1/ (7.165) Similarly, the other three nontrivial integrability conditions can be worked out. We list all four conditions in the sequel. ŒD D Œf D . C / D C ." C "/ C .0/ ı C .0/ ı Œf ; (7.166i) ŒıD Dı Œf D ˛ C ˇ .0/ D C .0/ ı . C " "/ ı Œf ; Œı ı Œf h i D D C . ˛ ˇ/ C ı C . C / ı Œf ; h i ıı ıı Œf h i D . / D C . / .˛ ˇ/ ı ˇ ˛ ı Œf : (7.166ii) (7.166iii) (7.166iv) Now, the complex-valued components of the conformal tensor C.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/ will be computed from (7.25viii), (7.74i–v), and (7.141i–iv). These are furnished by .0/ .x/ D C.a/.b/.c/.d /./ k .a/ ./ m.b/ ./ k .c/ ./ m.d / ./ E .1/ ; E E .4/ ; E E .1/ D C.4/.1/.4/.1/.x/; E .4/ ; E D C:::: E (7.167i) .1/ .x/ D C.a/.b/.c/.d /./ k .a/ ./ l .b/ ./ k .c/ ./ m.d / ./ D C.4/.3/.4/.1/.x/; (7.167ii) .2/ .x/ D C.a/.b/.c/.d /./ k .a/ ./ m.b/ ./ m.c/ ./ l .d / ./ D C.4/.1/.2/.3/.x/; (7.167iii) .3/ .x/ D C.a/.b/.c/.d /./ k .a/ ./ l .b/ ./ m.c/ ./ l .d / ./ D C.4/.3/.2/.3/.x/; (7.167iv) 520 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations .4/ .x/ D C.a/.b/.c/.d /./ m.a/ ./ l .b/ ./ m.c/ ./ l .d / ./ D C.2/.3/.2/.3/.x/; 0C .a/ .b/.c/.a/ ./ (7.167v) D C.2/.b/.c/.1/.x/ C C.1/.b/.c/.2/.x/ C.4/.b/.c/.3/.x/ C.3/.b/.c/.4/.x/ (7.167vi) C.3/.1/.1/.4/.x/ D C.3/.2/.2/.4/.x/ D C.1/.3/.3/.2/.x/ D C.1/.4/.4/.2/.x/ D 0; (7.167vii) C.1/.2/.3/.1/.x/ D C.1/.3/.3/.4/.x/; C.1/.2/.2/.3/.x/ D C.2/.3/.3/.4/.x/; (7.167viii) C.1/.2/.2/.4/.x/ D C.2/.4/.4/.3/.x/; C.4/.1/.1/.2/.x/ D C.1/.4/.4/.3/.x/; (7.167ix) 1 C.1/.2/.2/.1/.x/ C.1/.2/.3/.4/.x/ 2 1 C.3/.4/.3/.4/.x/ C C.1/.2/.3/.4/.x/ ; D 2 C.1/.4/.2/.3/.x/ D (7.167x) 2 .2/ .x/ C C.3/.4/.2/.1/.x/ C C.1/.2/.2/.1/.x/ D 2 .2/ C C.1/.2/.3/.4/.x/ C C.3/.4/.3/.4/.x/ D 0: (7.167xi) Now we shall compute the components R.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/ and C.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/ from (7.160i), (1.169ii), (7.25i–viii), (7.150), and (7.167i–v). Let us work out the particular component C.4/.1/.4/.1/./: We obtain C.4/.1/.4/.1/.x/ D R.4/.1/.4/.1/./ C .1=2/ .4/.4/ R.1/.1/ .4/.1/ R.1/.4/ C .1/.1/ R.4/.4/ .1/.4/ R.4/.1/ C .1=6/ .4/.1/ .1/.4/ .4/.4/ .1/.1/ R./ D R.4/.1/.4/.1/./ C 0 C 0 D R.4/.1/.4/.1/./: (7.168i) From (7.167i) and (7.160i), we derive that .0/ ./ D C.4/.1/.4/.1/./ D R.4/.1/.4/.1/./ L L D @.1/ .4/.1/.4/ @.4/ .4/.1/.1/ C .h/.e/ L L L L .h/.4/.1/ .e/.1/.4/ .h/.4/.4/ .e/.1/.1/ L L L C .4/.1/.h/ .e/.4/.1/ .e/.1/.4/ : (7.168ii) 7.2 Newman–Penrose Equations 521 Thus, using (7.163i,iv) and (7.164i–xxiv), we obtain L L D ı.0/ D .0/ ./ .h/.e/ .h/.4/.1/ .e/.1/.4/ L L L L C .h/.e/ .h/.4/.4/ .e/.1/.1/ .h/.e/ .4/.1/.h/ .e/.4/.1/ L L C .h/.e/ .4/.1/.h/ .e/.1/.4/ L L L L D .0/ ./ .1/.2/ .1/.4/.1/ .2/.1/.4/ C .3/.4/ .3/.4/.1/ .4/.1/.4/ L L L L C .1/.2/ .1/.4/.4/ .2/.1/.1/ C .3/.4/ .3/.4/.4/ .4/.1/.1/ L L L L .1/.2/ .4/.1/.1/ .2/.4/.1/ C .2/.1/ .4/.1/.2/ .1/.4/.1/ L L L L C .4/.3/ .4/.1/.4/ .3/.4/.1/ C .1/.2/ .4/.1/.1/ .2/.1/.4/ L L L L C .3/.4/ .4/.1/.3/ .4/.1/.4/ C .4/.3/ .4/.1/.4/ .3/.1/.4/ L L L L L D .0/ ./ C .1/.4/.2/ C .2/.4/.1/ C .3/.4/.4/ C 2 .1/.2/.4/ .1/.4/.1/ L L L L L .1/.4/.3/ C .1/.3/.4/ C 2 .3/.4/.1/ C .1/.2/.1/ .1/.4/.4/ D . C / C .3" "/ .0/ C ˛ C 3ˇ .0/ C .0/ ./: (7.169) We have just deduced one of the Newman–Penrose equations! To derive all of these equations, we need to obtain components of the complex-valued Ricci tensor R.a/.b/ ./ or ˙.a/.b/ ./ from (7.119i–vi) and (7.152i). Let us calculate the component ˚.1/.1/ ./ D .1=4/ R.a/.b/ .1=4/ .a/.b/ R k .a/ l .b/ C m.a/ m.b/ D .1=4/ R.4/.3/ .1=4/ .4/.3/ R C R.1/.2/ .1=4/ .1/.2/ R D .1=4/ R.4/.3/ C .1=4/ R C R.1/.2/ .1=4/ .R/ D .1=4/ R.4/.3/ C R.1/.2/ D ˚.1/.1/ ./: Similarly, we compute the other components and display all of them in the following6: ˚.0/.0/ ./ D .1=2/ ˙.a/.b/ ./ k .a/ ./ k .b/ ./ D ˚.0/.0/ ./ D .1=2/ R.4/.4/ ./; 6 The notation R.a/.b/ ./ in this section differs from R.A/.B/ ./ of the preceding section. (7.170i) 522 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations ˚.0/.1/ ./ D .1=2/ ˙.a/.b/ ./ k .c/ ./ m.b/ ./ D ˚.1/.0/ ./ D .1=2/ R.4/.1/ ./; (7.170ii) ˚.1/.0/ ./ D .1=2/ ˙.a/.b/ ./ m.a/ ./ k .b/ ./ D .1=2/ R.2/.4/ ./; (7.170iii) ˚.0/.2/ ./ D .1=2/ ˙.a/.b/ ./ m.a/ ./ m.b/ ./ D ˚.2/.0/ ./ D .1=2/ R.1/.1/ ./; (7.170iv) ˚.2/.0/ ./ D .1=2/ ˙.a/.b/ ./ m.a/ ./ m.b/ ./ D .1=2/ R.2/.2/ ./; (7.170v) ˚.1/.1/ ./ D .1=4/ ˙.a/.b/ ./ k .a/ l .b/ C m.a/ m.b/ D ˚.1/.1/ ./ D .1=4/ R.4/.3/ C R.1/.2/ ; (7.170vi) ˚.1/.2/ ./ D .1=2/ ˙.a/.b/ ./ l .a/ ./ m.b/ ./ D ˚.2/.1/ ./ D .1=2/ R.3/.1/ ./; (7.170vii) ˚.2/.1/ ./ D .1=2/ ˙.a/.b/ ./ l .a/ ./ m.b/ ./ D .1=2/ R.3/.2/ ./; (7.170viii) ˚.2/.2/ ./ D .1=2/ ˙.a/.b/ ./ l .a/ ./ l .b/ ./ D ˚.2/.2/ ./ D .1=2/ R.3/.3/ ./; (7.170ix) 0 .a/.b/ ˙.a/.b/ D 2 ˙.1/.2/ ˙.3/.4/ D 0; R D .a/.b/ R.a/.b/ D 2 R.1/.2/ R.3/.4/ : (7.170x) (7.170xi) Here, we note that ˚.0/.0/ ./; ˚.1/.1/ ./; and ˚.2/.2/ ./ are real-valued, whereas ˚.0/.1/ ./; ˚.1/.0/ ./; ˚.0/.2/ ./; ˚.2/.0/ ./; ˚.1/.2/ ./; and ˚.2/.1/ ./ are complexvalued. Now, recall the components R.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/ from (7.160i). These are provided by R.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/ D @.d / L .a/.b/.c/ C .h/.e/ C L @.c/ L .a/.b/.h/ L .h/.a/.d / L .a/.b/.d / L .e/.c/.d / .e/.b/.c/ L L .e/.d /.c/ .h/.a/.c/ : L .e/.b/.d / (7.171) 7.2 Newman–Penrose Equations 523 From (7.150) and (7.153), we have R.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/ D C.a/.b/.c/.d /./ C .1=2/ .a/.d / R.b/.c/ .a/.c/ R.b/.d / C .b/.c/ R.a/.d / .b/.d / R.a/.c/ (7.172i) C .1=3/ .a/.c/ .b/.d / .a/.d / .b/.c/ R./ ; R.a/.b/.c/.d /.x/ D C.a/.b/.c/.d /./ C .1=2/ .a/.d / ˙.b/.c/ .a/.c/ ˙.b/.d / C .b/.c/ ˙.a/.d / .b/.d / ˙.a/.c/ (7.172ii) C .1=6/ .a/.d / .b/.c/ .a/.c/ .b/.d / R./ : Also, from (7.171) and (7.172i,ii) , we have that @.d / L .a/.b/.c/ L @.c/ .h/.a/.d / L .a/.b/.d / L .e/.b/.c/ C L D C.a/.b/.c/.d /./ C .h/.e/ .a/.b/.h/ L .e/.d /.c/ L L .h/.a/.c/ L .e/.b/.d / .e/.c/.d / C .1=2/ .a/.d / ˙.b/.c/ .a/.c/ ˙.b/.d / C .b/.c/ ˙.a/.d / .b/.d / ˙.a/.c/ C .1=6/ .a/.d / .b/.c/ .a/.c/ .b/.d / R./ : (7.173) Multiplying the above equations with the “orthonormal components” of E El./; and k./; E E m./; m./; and using (7.163i–iv), (7.164i–xxiv), (7.167i–vi), (7.170i–ix), and (7.173) (and with occasional linear combinations), we can derive the Newman–Penrose equations. All of these equations are furnished here7 : D ı.0/ D 2 C C ." C "/ .0/ .0/ 3˛ C ˇ .0/ C ˚.0/.0/ ; D ı.0/ D . C / C .3" "/ .0/ C ˛ C 3ˇ .0/ C .0/ ; D .0/ D C .0/ C C .0/ C ." "/ .3 C / .0/ C .1/ C ˚.0/.1/ ; (7.174i) (7.174ii) (7.174iii) D˛ ı" D . C " 2"/ ˛ C ˇ ˇ " .0/ .0/ 7 C ." C / .0/ C ˚.1/.0/ ; (7.174iv) The following equations (7.174i–xviii) coincide with those cited in most of the literature. Compared to some sources, the sign of certain components (especially R.x/) is different. This discrepancy occurs due to the usage of different conventions. 524 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations Dˇ ı" D ˛ C .0/ C . "/ ˇ . C / .0/ ˛ .0/ " C .1/ ; D " D C .0/ ˛ C C .0/ ˇ ." C "/ D ı.0/ (7.174v) . C / " C .0/ .0/ C .2/ C ˚.1/.1/ C .R=24/ ; (7.174vi) 2 D C C .0/ C ˛ ˇ .0/ .0/ .3" "/ C ˚.2/.0/ ; (7.174vii) D ı.0/ D C C .0/ .0/ ." C "/ D .0/ .0/ .˛ ˇ/ .0/ C .2/ .R=12/ ; D .0/ C C .0/ C C . / .0/ .3" C "/ C .3/ C ˚.2/.1/ ; ı D . C / .3 / C 3˛ C ˇ C .0/ .4/ ; ı ı D .˛ C ˇ/ 3˛ ˇ C . / C . / .0/ .1/ C ˚.0/.1/ ; (7.174viii) (7.174ix) (7.174x) (7.174xi) ı˛ ıˇ D C ˛ ˛ C ˇ ˇ 2˛ ˇ C . / C " . / .2/ C ˚.1/.1/ .R=24/ ; (7.174xii) ı ı D . / C . / .0/ C ˛ C ˇ C .˛ 3ˇ/ .3/ C ˚.2/.1/ ; (7.174xiii) ı D 2 C C . C / .0/ C . 3ˇ ˛/ C ˚.2/.2/ ; ı ˇ D . ˛ ˇ/ ˇ. (7.174xiv) C " / C ˛ C ˚.1/.2/ ; (7.174xv) ı D C C . C ˇ ˛/ .3 / .0/ C ˚.0/.2/ ; ı D . C / C ˇ ˛ C . C / C .0/ .2/ C .R=12/ ; (7.174xvi) (7.174xvii) 7.2 Newman–Penrose Equations 525 ˛ ı D . C "/ . C ˇ/ C . / ˛ C ˇ .3/ : (7.174xviii) Remarks: (i) The 12 equations (7.174i–iii,vii,viii,ix–xi,xiii,xiv,xvi,xvii) follow directly from (7.173). (ii) Each of the 6 equations (7.174iv–vi,xii,xv,xviii) follows from a linear combination of two equations in (7.173). (iii) Each of the 18 Newman–Penrose equations follows naturally from spinor algebra and spinor analysis [122, 207]. (iv) The spinor algebra and spinor analysis justify the eighteen complex-valued partial differential equations (7.174i–xviii) in a mathematically rigorous way. (Compare remarks (i) and (ii) after (7.162ii).) Now, we shall work out an example involving the Newman–Penrose equations. Example 7.2.5. Here we explore Example 7.1.10 in greater detail with spin coefficients. The metric representing plane-fronted gravitational waves [126, 239] is provided by ds 2 D 2 .d / d 2 .du/ .dv/ 2 h ; ; u .du/2 ; DW 2 dx 1 dx 2 2 dx 3 dx 4 C h./ dx 3 : (7.175ii) E m./ D i.1/ ./ @i D ı i.1/ @i D @1 ; (7.176i) (7.175i) E m./ D i.2/ ./ @i D ı i.2/ @i D @2 ; i h El./ D i.3/ ./ @i D ı i.3/ h./ ı i.4/ @i D Œ@3 h./ @4 ; (7.176iii) E k./ D i.4/ ./ @i D ı i.4/ @i D @4 ; (7.176iv) .1/ e ./ D M m i ./ dx i D ı .1/ (7.176ii) dx i D dx 1 ; (7.176v) .2/ .2/ e m./ D M i ./ dx i D ı i dx i D dx 2 ; (7.176vi) i .3/ .3/ e l./ D M i ./ dx i D ı i dx i D dx 3 ; i h .4/ .3/ .4/ e k./ D M i ./ dx i D h./ ı i C ı i dx i D h./ dx 3 C dx 4 : (7.176vii) (7.176viii) 526 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations The contravariant metric tensor components g ij .x/ can be generated from (7.176i–iv) as 2 0 6 h i ij 61 g ./ D .a/.b/ i.a/ ./ i.b/ ./ D 6 4 44 1 0 0 3 0 7 7 7: 0 1 5 1 (7.177) 2h Directional derivatives from (7.163i–iv) are provided by ı D i.1/ ./ @i D @1 D @ ; (7.178i) ı D i.2/ ./ @i D @2 D @ N ; (7.178ii) D i.3/ ./ @i D Œ@3 h./ @4 D Œ@u h./ @v ; (7.178iii) D D i.4/ ./ @i D ı i.4/ @i D @4 D @v : (7.178iv) Now we shall work out integrability conditions (7.166i–iv). Let us examine (7.166iii) carefully. Using (7.178i–iv), we deduce that Œı ı Œf D f@1 Œ@3 h./ @4 Œ@3 h./ @4 @1 g Œf D .@1 h/ .@4 f / D .@1 h/ .Df / D ./ .Df / ; or also, ./ D @1 h and ./ D @2 h; ./ ˛./ ˇ./ D ./ D ./ ./ C ./ 0: We work out the other three integrability conditions in a similar fashion. We summarize the final conclusions as .0/ ./ D .0/ ./ D ./ D ./ D ./ D ./ D ./ D ./ D ./ D ./ D ./ D ./ D .0/ ./ D .0/ ./ D "./ D "./ D ˇ./ D ˇ./ D ˛./ D ˛./ D ./ D ./ 0; ./ D @2 h D @ h; ./ D @1 h D @ h: (7.179) 7.2 Newman–Penrose Equations 527 Now, Newman–Penrose equation (7.174x), with help of (7.179), implies that 0 ı D .4/ ./ 6 0; or @2 D @ N D @2 @2 h D @ N @ N h D .4/ ./: (7.180) By (7.109ii) and (7.170i–xi), the only nonzero component for this metric is ˚.2/.2/ ./. Moreover, the Newman–Penrose equation (7.174xiv) implies that ı 0 D 0 C ˚.2/.2/ ./; or ˚.2/.2/ ./ D @1 @2 h D @ @ N h: (7.181) In this example, (with R./ 0 from (7.109iii)), the complex scalar functions .0/ ./ D .1/ ./ D .2/ ./ D .3/ ./ 0. In case @2 @2 h D @ N @ N h ¤ 0; the metrics (7.175i,ii) belong to the complex Segre characteristic Œ.2; 1/ by (7.101) and (7.110i). Thus, the Brinkman–Robinson–Trautman metric is of Petrov type N (for @2 @2 h ¤ 0). We have provided (7.147), which are consequences of the complex-valued Bianchi’s differential identities. We shall now express consequences of Bianchi’s identities in terms of directional derivatives (7.163i–iv) and spin coefficients (7.164i–xxiv). (See [35, 239].) These equations, which take very long calculations to derive, are furnished in the following: ı.0/ D.1/ C D˚.0/.1/ ı˚.0/.0/ D 4˛ .0/ .0/ 2 .2 C "/ .1/ C 3.0/ .2/ C .0/ 2˛ 2ˇ ˚.0/.0/ C 2 ." C / ˚.0/.1/ C 2 ˚.1/.0/ 2.0/ ˚.1/.1/ .0/ ˚.0/.2/ ; (7.182i) .0/ ı.1/ C D˚.0/.2/ ı˚.0/.1/ D .4 / .0/ 2 .2 C ˇ/ .1/ C 3 .2/ C.2" 2" C / ˚.0/.2/ C 2 .0/ ˇ ˚.0/.1/ C 2 ˚.1/.1/ 2.0/ ˚.1/.2/ ˚.0/.0/ ; (7.182ii) ı.3/ D.4/ C ı˚.2/.1/ ˚.2/.0/ D .4" / .4/ 2 2.0/ C ˛ .3/ C 3 .2/ C.2 2 C / ˚.2/.0/ C 2 . ˛/ ˚.2/.1/ C 2 ˚.1/.1/ 2 ˚.1/.0/ ˚.2/.2/ ; (7.182iii) 528 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations .3/ ı.4/ C ı˚.2/.2/ ˚.2/.1/ D .4ˇ / .4/ 2 .2 C / .3/ C 3 .2/ C 2ˇ 2˛ ˚.2/.2/ C 2 . C / ˚.2/.1/ C 2 ˚.1/.2/ 2 ˚.1/.1/ ˚.2/.0/ ; (7.182iv) D.2/ ı.1/ C ˚.0/.0/ ı˚.0/.1/ .1=12/ DR D .0/ C 2 .0/ ˛ .1/ C 3 .2/ 2.0/ .3/ C.2 C 2 / ˚.0/.0/ 2 . C ˛/ ˚.0/.1/ 2 ˚.1/.0/ C 2 ˚.1/.1/ C ˚.0/.2/ ; (7.182v) .2/ ı.3/ C D˚.2/.2/ ı˚.2/.1/ .1=12/ R D .4/ C 2 .ˇ / .3/ 3 .2/ C 2 .1/ C. 2" 2"/ ˚.2/.2/ C 2 .0/ C ˇ ˚.2/.1/ C 2.0/ ˚.1/.2/ 2 ˚.1/.1/ ˚.2/.0/ ; (7.182vi) D.3/ ı.2/ D˚.2/.1/ C ı˚.2/.0/ C .1=12/ ıR D .0/ .4/ C 2 . "/ .3/ C 3.0/ .2/ 2 .1/ C 2˛ 2ˇ .0/ ˚.2/.0/ 2 . "/ ˚.2/.1/ 2.0/ ˚.1/.1/ C 2 ˚.1/.0/ C .0/ ˚.2/.2/ ; (7.182vii) .1/ ı.2/ ˚.0/.1/ C ı˚.0/.2/ C .1=12/ ıR D .0/ C 2 . / .1/ 3 .2/ C 2 .3/ C 2ˇ C 2˛ ˚.0/.2/ C 2 . / ˚.0/.1/ C 2 ˚.1/.1/ 2 ˚.1/.2/ ˚.0/.0/ ; (7.182viii) D˚.1/.1/ ı˚.1/.0/ ı˚.0/.1/ C ˚.0/.0/ .1=8/ DR D .2 C 2 / ˚.0/.0/ C .0/ 2˛ 2 ˚.0/.1/ C .0/ 2˛ 2 ˚.1/.0/ C 2 . C / ˚.1/.1/ C ˚.0/.2/ C ˚.2/.0/ .0/ ˚.1/.2/ .0/ ˚.2/.1/ ; (7.182ix) N .0/.2/ C ˚.0/.1/ .1=8/ ıR D˚.1/.2/ ı˚.1/.1/ ı˚ D 2˛ C 2ˇ C .0/ ˚.0/.2/ C. C 2 2"/ ˚.1/.2/ C 2 .0/ ˚.1/.1/ C .2 2 / ˚.0/.1/ C ˚.0/.0/ ˚.1/.0/ C ˚.2/.1/ .0/ ˚.2/.2/ ; (7.182x) 7.2 Newman–Penrose Equations 529 D˚.2/.2/ ı˚.2/.1/ ı˚.1/.2/ C ˚.1/.1/ .1=8/ R D . C 2" 2"/ ˚.2/.2/ C 2ˇ C 2.0/ ˚.1/.2/ C 2ˇ C 2 .0/ ˚.2/.1/ 2 . C / ˚.1/.1/ C ˚.0/.1/ C ˚.1/.0/ ˚.2/.0/ ˚.0/.2/ : (7.182xi) Now we shall carefully interpret the N–P equations (7.174i–xviii) and also (7.182i–xi) (which are consequences of Bianchi’s differential identities). In N–P equations (7.174i–xviii), if we represent ˚.0/.0/ ./; ˚.0/.1/ ./; ::: etc., and R./ in terms of R.a/.b/ ./ according to (7.170i–xi), then the N–P equations are mathematically equivalent to C.d /.a/.b/.c/./ WD R.d /.a/.b/.c/./ C 1n Œ .d /.b/ R.a/.c/ .d /.c/ R.a/.b/ 2 C .a/.c/ R.d /.b/ .a/.b/ R.d /.c/ C o 1 .a/.b/ .d /.c/ .a/.c/ .d /.b/ R : 3 (7.183) (Compare equation above with (1.169ii) and (7.150).) However, the above equation (7.183) is really an algebraic identity involving the tetrad components C.d /.a/.b/.c/ n o ./, R.d /.a/.b/.c/./, R.a/.b/ ./, and R./ (relative E E E E m; l; k ) in a general, four-dimensional pseudo-Riemannian to the null tetrad m; differential manifold of signature C2. Thus, (7.183) does not necessarily imply Einstein’s gravitational field equations (2.163ii). Similarly, with geometrical interpretations of ˚.0/.0/ ./; ˚.0/.1/ ./; ::: etc., and R./ according to (7.170i–ix), (7.182i–xi) are mathematically equivalent to n 1 r.e/ C.d /.a/.b/.c/ .d /.c/ R.a/.b/ .d /.b/ R.a/.c/ 2 1 o C .a/.b/ R.d /.c/ .a/.c/ R.d /.b/ C .a/.c/ .d /.b/ .a/.b/ .d /.c/ R 3 n o n o C r.b/ ::: C r.c/ ::: n n n o o o D r.e/ R.d /.a/.b/.c/./ C r.b/ R.d /.a/.c/.e/./ C r.c/ R.d /.a/.e/.b/./ 0: (7.184) The equations above are obviously equivalent to Bianchi’s differential identities in (1.143ii) and (7.151) for a general pseudo-Riemannian manifold. Again, there are no compelling gravitational implications as such in (7.184)! To apply the N–P equation 530 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations (7.174i–xviii) and (7.182i–xi) for gravitational field equations and conservations laws, the following (physical) equations must be imposed: T.4/.4/ ./; ˚.0/.0/ ./ D (7.185i) 2 ˚.0/.1/ ./ D ˚ .1/.0/ D T.1/.4/ ./; (7.185ii) 2 T.2/.4/ ./; (7.185iii) ˚.1/.0/ ./ D 2 ˚.0/.2/ ./ D ˚ .2/.0/ D T.1/.1/ ./; (7.185iv) 2 ˚.2/.0/ ./ D (7.185v) T.2/.2/ ./; 2 (7.185vi) ˚.1/.1/ ./ D ˚ .1/.1/ D T.1/.2/ ./ C T.3/.4/ ./ ; 4 T.1/.3/ ./; (7.185vii) ˚.1/.2/ ./ D 2 T.2/.3/ ./; (7.185viii) ˚.2/.1/ ./ D 2 (7.185ix) ˚.2/.2/ ./ D ˚ .2/.2/ D T.3/.3/ ./; 2 .a/ .a/ ./: R./ D T (7.185x) Exercises 7.2 1. Consider the first-order, real field equations (7.120i–v) with Tij ./ ¤ 0: Count the number of unknown functions versus the number of equations. 2. Consider the complex Lorentz transformation of (7.7iv) given by: b E E k./ D k./; b E E E m./ D m./ C B./ k./; b E E E m./ D m./ C B./ k./; b E E El./ D El./ C B./ m./ E C B./ m./ C jB./j2 k./: Construct the corresponding 44 complex Lorentz matrix ŒL./ of (7.155iii,iv) such that the matrix equation ŒL./T Œ ŒL./ D Œ is satisfied. 3. Let f be a real or complex-valued function of class C 2 in the coordinate domain D R4 of consideration. Prove the integrability conditions (7.145i) stating 7.2 Newman–Penrose Equations 531 L L @.a/ @.b/ f @.b/ @.a/ f D .c/.e/ .e/.a/.b/ .e/.b/.a/ @.c/ f .c/ L L DW .c/.a/.b/ ./ .c/.b/.a/ ./ @ f: 4. Prove that another alternative formulation of a system of the first-order, complex partial differential equations equivalent to the field equations (2.161ii) is the following: L .b/ .c/ rk j.a/ D .a/.b/.c/ ./ M j ./ M k ./ I L L @.a/ @.b/ @.b/ @.a/ k.c/ D .e/.a/.b/ ./ .e/.b/.a/ ./ @.e/ k.c/ I R.a/.b/ ./ .1=2/ .a/.b/ R./ D T.a/.b/ ./ I r.b/ T.a/.b/ D ./1 r.b/ G.a/.b/ 0 I C .a/ k.b/ ; @.c/ k.b/ D 0: E 5. (i) Let k.x/ be a null geodesic congruence. Moreover, let the null geodesic E congruence k.x/ be affinely parameterized. Show that the spin coefficients .0/ ./ D "./ C "N./ n 0. o EN ; El; k E is parallely transported along the null E m; (ii) In case the null tetrad m; E geodesic congruence k.x/, show that the spin-coefficients .0/ ./ D "./ D .0/ ./ 0. 6. Consider the vacuum field equations R.a/.b/.c/.d /./ D C.a/.b/.c/.d /./ inherent in (7.150). For such equations, simplify Newman–Penrose equations (7.174i– xviii). 7. Using (7.56i–iii), prove that Maxwell’s equations (7.53) are equivalent to the following: D .1/ ı .0/ D .0/ 2˛ D .2/ ı .1/ D ı .1/ .0/ D . 2 / ı .2/ .1/ D .0/ .0/ .0/ C 2 C 2.0/ .0/ .1/ C 2 C 2 .1/ .0/ .2/ ; C . 2"/ .2/ ; .1/ .1/ C . 2ˇ/ .2/ ; .2/ : 8. Obtain Newman–Penrose equations (7.174i–xviii) corresponding to Einstein– Maxwell (or electromagneto-vac) equations (2.290i–vi). 9. (i) Simplify the Newman–Penrose equations (7.174i–xviii) for the algebraically special case of Petrov type 0. (ii) Solve the Newman–Penrose equations for the Einstein–Maxwell fields (or, electromagento-vac) for the case of a null electromagnetic field. 10. Prove (7.182i) which is a consequence of Bianchi’s identities (7.115) or (7.184). 532 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations Answers and Hints to Selected Exercises 1. No. of unknown functions: 10 gij C 40 k ij C 10 Tij D 60: No. of equations: 40 .7.120i/ C 60 . 7.120ii/ C 10 .7.120iii/ C 4 .7.120iv/ C 4 .7.120v/ D 118: 2. 2 3 1 0 B 0 6 7 6 0 1 B 0 7 7: ŒL./ D 6 6 7 44 05 4 0 0 1 B B jBj2 1 3. It is known that coordinate components satisfy identities ri rj f rj ri f 0: Therefore, it follows that r.a/ r.b/ f r.b/ r.a/ f 0: Using the rules (7.143) for covariant derivatives, the integrability conditions (7.145i) ensue. (Compare (7.145i) with (1.139iv).) 4. This system is mathematically equivalent to the following system of real, firstorder p.d.e.s: .b/ .c/ rk j.a/ D .a/.b/.c/./ j ./ k ./ I @.a/ @.b/ @.b/ @.a/ k.c/ D .e/.a/.b/ ./ .e/.b/.a/ ./ d .e/.f / @.f / k.c/ I G.a/.b/ ./ D T.a/.b/ ./ I r.b/ T .a/.b/ D ./1 r.b/ G .a/.b/ 0 I C .a/ k.b/ ; @.c/ k.b/ D 0: (See [271, 272].) 5. (i) k .b/ ./ r.b/ k .a/ D 0 ) .0/ ./ D k .b/ r.b/ k .a/ m.a/ 0, etc. (ii) k .b/ r.b/ k.a/ D k .b/ r.b/ l.a/ D k .b/ r.b/ m.a/ 0: 7.2 Newman–Penrose Equations 533 6. Set ˚.0/.0/ ./ D ˚.0/.1/ ./ D ˚.1/.0/ ./ D ˚.2/.0/ ./ D ˚.0/.2/ ./ D ˚.1/.1/ ./ D ˚.1/.2/ ./ D ˚.2/.1/ ./ D ˚.2/.2/ ./ D R./ 0: Thus, T.a/.b/ ./ 0. (Remark: Vacuum field equations can be rendered still simpler by employing the four coordinate conditions of # 5.) 7. Recall from (7.56i–iii) that D '.a/.b/ ./ k .a/ ./ m.b/ ./ D '.4/.1/ ; i 1 h 1 '.a/.b/ ./ k .a/ l .b/ C m.a/ m.b/ D '.4/.3/./ C '.2/.1/ ./ ; .1/ ./ D 2 2 .0/ ./ .2/ ./ D '.a/.b/ ./ m.a/ ./ l .b/ ./ D '.2/.3/ ./: Using Maxwell’s equations r.a/ '.b/.c/ C r.b/ '.c/.a/ C r.c/ '.a/.b/ D 0, the following four equations can be derived: r.1/ '.2/.3/ C r.2/ '.3/.1/ C r.3/ '.1/.2/ D 0; r.1/ '.2/.4/ C r.2/ '.4/.1/ C r.4/ '.1/.2/ D 0; r.1/ '.3/.4/ C r.3/ '.4/.1/ C r.4/ '.1/.3/ D 0; r.2/ '.3/.4/ C r.3/ '.4/.2/ C r.4/ '.2/.3/ D 0: On the other hand, using ' .a/.b/ ./ D .a/.c/ .b/.d / '.c/.d / ./ and the Maxwell equations r.b/ ' .a/.b/ D 0, the following four equations can be obtained: r.2/ '.1/.2/ r.3/ '.2/.4/ r.4/ '.2/.3/ D 0; r.1/ '.1/.2/ r.3/ '.1/.4/ r.4/ '.1/.3/ D 0; r.1/ '.2/.4/ C r.2/ '.1/.4/ r.4/ '.3/.4/ D 0; r.1/ '.2/.3/ C r.2/ '.1/.3/ C r.3/ '.3/.4/ D 0: By linear combinations of the preceding eight equations, the following four equations can be deduced: 2 r.1/ '.2/.3/ C r.3/ '.1/.2/ C '.3/.4/ D 0; r.4/ '.1/.2/ C '.3/.4/ 2 r.2/ '.4/.1/ D 0; 534 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations r.1/ '.3/.4/ C '.1/.2/ 2 r.3/ '.4/.1/ D 0; 2 r.4/ '.2/.3/ C r.2/ '.3/.4/ C '.1/.2/ D 0: The four equations above imply the original Maxwell’s equations (7.53). Now, the rules for covariant differentiations in (7.143) imply that r.c/ '.a/.b/ D @.c/ '.a/.b/ C .d /.e/ L .e/.a/.c/ '.d /.b/ C L .e/.b/.c/ '.a/.d / : The above equations exactly yield, from the preceding four Maxwell’s equations, equations mentioned in #7. (Of course, Newman–Penrose symbols have to be used!) 8. The Einstein–Maxwell (or electromagneto-vac) equations imply that R.a/.b/ ./ D T.a/.b/ ./; R./ D T./ 0; ˙.a/.b/ ./ D R.a/.b/./: From (7.119i–vi) and (7.185i–x), it can be concluded that ˚.0/.0/ ./ D .1=2/ ˙.a/.b/ k .a/ k .b/ D .=2/ T.a/.b/ k .a/ k .b/ ; ˚.0/.1/ ./ D .1=2/ ˙.a/.b/ k .a/ m.b/ D .=2/ T.a/.b/ k .a/ m.b/ ; ˚.0/.2/ ./ D .1=2/ ˙.a/.b/ m.a/ m.b/ D .=2/ T.a/.b/ m.a/ m.b/ ; ˚.1/.1/ ./ D .1=4/ ˙.a/.b/ k .a/ l .b/ C m.a/ m.b/ D .=4/ T.a/.b/ k .a/ l .b/ C m.a/ m.b/ ; ˚.1/.2/ ./ D .1=2/ ˙.a/.b/ l .a/ m.b/ D .=2/ T.a/.b/ l .a/ m.b/ ; ˚.2/.2/ ./ D .1=2/ ˙.a/.b/ l .a/ l .b/ D .=2/ T.a/.b/ l .a/ l .b/ : From (2.290i) and the answer to Problem 8-ii of Exercises 2.5, it follows that i 1 h .c/ : T.a/.b/ ./ D Re ' .a/.c/ '.b/ 2 Thus, it can be deduced that ˚.A/.B/ ./ D .=4/ .A/ ./ .B/ ./; A; B 2 f0; 1; 2g: Substituting the above and R./ 0 into the Newman–Penrose equations, the required answers are obtained. 7.2 Newman–Penrose Equations 535 9. (i) Set .0/ ./ D .1/ ./ D .2/ ./ D .3/ ./ D .4/ 0: (ii) ds 2 D 2d% d% 2 du dv 2 H.%; %; u/ .du/2 DW 2 dx 1 dx 2 2 dx 3 dx 4 2 H.x 1 ; x 2 ; x 3 / .dx 3 /2 ; H.x 1 ; x 2 ; x 3 / H.%; %; u/ D f .%; u/ C f .%; u/ C jF .%; u/j2 : Here, f .%; u/ and F .%; u/ are holomorphic in the variable % and of class C 3 in the variable u, but otherwise arbitrary. The electromagnetic field is furnished by .0/ ./ D .1/ ./ 0; D 2 @% F: .2/ ./ (See [239].) 10. Consider the Bianchi identity r.2/ R.4/.1/.4/.1/ C r.4/ R.4/.1/.1/.2/ C r.1/ R.4/.1/.2/.4/ 0: Equations (7.153), (7.168i), and (7.141ii) imply that r.2/ C.4/.1/.4/.1/ C r.4/ C.4/.1/.1/.2/ 1 1 R.4/.1/ C r.1/ R.4/.4/ D 0: 2 2 Now, by (7.143), it can be deduced that r.2/ C.4/.1/.4/.1/ D @.2/ C.4/.1/.4/.1/ C .d /.e/ L .e/.4/.2/ C.d /.1/.4/.1/ L C C.4/.1/.d /.1/ C .e/.1/.2/ C.4/.d /.4/.1/ C C.4/.1/.4/.d / : Using (7.163i–iv), (7.164i–xxiv), and (7.168i–xi), it can be derived that r.2/ C.4/.1/.4/.1/ D ı .0/ 4˛ .0/ C 4 .1/ : Similarly, one can show that r.4/ C.4/.1/.1/.2/ D @.4/ C.4/.1/.1/.2/ C .d /.e/ C L .e/.1/.4/ L .e/.4/.4/ C.d /.1/.1/.2/ L C.4/.d /.1/.2/ C C.4/.1/.d /.2/ C .e/.2/.4/ C.4/.1/.1/.d / D D.1/ C 2" .1/ 3.0/ .2/ C .0/ .0/ : 536 7 Algebraic Classification of Field Equations Now, consider the equation 1 r.4/ R.4/.1/ r.1/ R.4/.4/ 2 D L 1 n @.4/ R.4/.1/ @.1/ R.4/.4/ C .d /.e/ .e/.4/.4/ R.d /.1/ 2 o L L C .e/.1/.4/ R.4/.d / 2 .e/.4/.1/ R.d /.4/ D D ˚.0/.1/ Cı ˚.0/.0/ 2.0/ ˚.1/.1/ C2" ˚.0/.1/ C2 ˚.0/.1/ C2 ˚.1/.0/ C .0/ 2˛2ˇ ˚.0/.0/ .0/ ˚.0/.2/ : Combining all these equations, (7.182i) is proven. (Consult [35].) Chapter 8 The Coupled Einstein–Maxwell–Klein–Gordon Equations 8.1 The General E–M–K–G Field Equations The contents of this chapter generally lie outside the focus of an introductory curriculum, and therefore, this chapter may be considered optional for an introductory course. Various attempts have been made in the past to arrive at a completely fieldtheoretic description of microscopic material objects. For example, Wheeler and his collaborators [183, 263] offered a completely geometrical description of classical matter. Heisenberg and his associates [128] presented a nonlinear Dirac equation for unification of various matter fields. Finkelstein [99] has presented extended models of particles with internal rotational motions. Lanczos [158] has constructed nonsingular field-theoretical models from a quadratic action principle. Jackiw et al. [143] have shown that certain exact solutions of nonlinear field equations provide approximations of vacuum expectation values of quantized fields. In recent years, string theory has gained a lot of advances toward the ultimate unification of fields. (See [117, 274].) Das [50] introduced the massive, complex scalar field in general relativity to replace phenomenological descriptions of matter in the right-hand sides of Einstein’s field equations. Although the coupled Einstein–Maxwell–Klein– Gordon equations (E–M–K–G equations) do not qualify as a unified field theory of matter, the exact solutions of the system do provide some insights on the possible nonsingular models of the complex scalar wave fields under gravitational and electromagnetic self-interactions. Moreover, relativistic wave fields are utilized extensively in the gravitational research literature. Therefore, a complete introduction to this field is appropriate. The Maxwell and Klein–Gordon fields here are treated in their “first-quantized forms” and therefore are treated as “classical fields.” Second-quantized fields, where the fields themselves (and their canonical momenta) are subject to the Lie algebra of quantum mechanics, and in the standard representations become operators, are not considered here. The coupling of second-quantized fields to gravity gives rise to the A. Das and A. DeBenedictis, The General Theory of Relativity: A Mathematical Exposition, DOI 10.1007/978-1-4614-3658-4 8, © Springer Science+Business Media New York 2012 537 538 8 The Coupled Einstein–Maxwell–Klein–Gordon Equations interesting subject of quantum field theory in curved space–times or semiclassical gravity, which is beyond the scope of this text. There are several well-written texts on this subject [22, 115, 186, 258]. We shall now investigate the coupled E–M–K–G field equations in what follows. We choose the physical units such that c D G D „ D 1: (Here, 2„ is Planck’s constant.)1 This system of units is sometimes referred to as natural units, Planck units, or fundamental units. We denote the mass and charge parameters, associated with the complex scalar field, by m and e, respectively. Now, we introduce a few notations in the following: Dj WD rj C ie Aj ./ ; D j WD rj ie Aj ./ : (8.1i) (8.1ii) (These are known as gauge covariant derivatives.) Here, .x/ is the complex scalar field and Aj .x/ are components of the electromagnetic 4-potential. Moreover, we denote the electromagnetic field tensor via Fij .x/ D ri Aj rj Ai . The system of coupled Einstein–Maxwell–Klein–Gordon equations is furnished as K./ WD D j Dj m2 ./ D 0; j K./ WD D D j m2 ./ D 0; h i j M j ./ WD rk F j k i e ./ D j ./ D D 0; nh Eij ./ WD Gij ./ C D i Dj C D j Di (8.2i) (8.2ii) (8.2iii) k i gij ./ D Dk C m2 io h C Fi k Fj k .1=4/ gij Fkl F kl D 0; C j .gi k ; @l gi k / D 0; S Ai ; @j Ai D 0: (8.2iv) (8.2v) (8.2vi) The last equation (8.2vi) indicates one possible subsidiary condition for the electromagnetic 4-potential Ai .x/: This reflects the gauge freedom discussed in (1.71i,ii). Among the coupled equations (8.2i–vi), assuming usual differentiability conditions, the following five differential identities exist: 1 In this chapter, all physical quantities are expressed as dimensionless pure numbers. (Therefore, as usual, D 8 in this chapter.) 8.1 The General E–M–K–G Field Equations 539 rj M j 0; (8.3i) rj E ij 0: (8.3ii) Now, we are in a position to count the number of unknown functions versus the number of independent equations in the system (8.2i–vi). No. of unknown functions: 1 ŒRe . / C 1 ŒIm . / C 4.Aj / C 10.gij / D 16: No. of equations: 1.K D 0/ C 1 K D 0 C 4 M j D 0 C 10 Eij D 0 C 4 C j D 0 C 1.S D 0/ D 21: No. of differential identities: 1 rj M j 0 C 4 rj E ij 0 D 5: No. of independent equations: 21 5 D 16: Thus, the system of (8.2i–vi) is determinate. Now, we shall derive field equations (8.2i–iv) from a variational principle. (Consult Example 2.5.5.) The appropriate Lagrangian density for this problem is the following (notations are made clear in (8.5) ): L ij ; yi ; ; ; kij I yij ; i ; i I kij l q i n h l kij C il k klj WD detŒij ij kkij kij k lk h C 2 .1=4/ i k j l yij yj i .ykl ylk / C .1=2/ ij .i ie yi / j C ie yj o (8.4i) C j ie yj i C ie yi C m2 ; n p L./j:: D g R./ C 2 .1=4/ Fij ./ F ij ./ io j (8.4ii) CD Dj C m2 ./ ./ : 540 8 The Coupled Einstein–Maxwell–Klein–Gordon Equations In equation (8.4ii), we denote ˚k ./j:: WD ./ˇˇ ij ij k ˚ k k ˇ Dg ; ij D ij ; ij l D@l ij ; ˇ (8.5) : yj DAj ; yij D@j Ai ; D; D ; j D@j ; j D@j (Here, notations differ slightly with (A1.25).) Now, let us derive Euler–Lagrange equations (A1.20i) from the Lagrangian density (8.4i,ii). The Euler–Lagrange equation for the complex scalar field is furnished by @L./ p ˇ D 2 g K./ D 0: @j ˇ:: @L./ d ˇ @ ˇ:: dx j (8.6) Now we shall obtain the Euler–Lagrange equations for the electromagnetic field from the Lagrangian density (8.4i,ii). These are provided by: @L./ d ˇ @yi ˇ:: dx j " # @L./ p ˇ D 2 g M i ./ D 0: @yij ˇ:: (8.7) (Compare with Example 2.5.5.) Next, we shall derive Einstein’s field equations (8.2iv) from the Lagrangian density (8.4i,ii). We shall follow the derivation mentioned in (A1.25) with slight changes of notation. The action integral arising from (8.4i,ii) is denoted by Z L./j:: d4 x: J./ WD (8.8) D4 We also consider variations of the relevant functions in the following: b ij D g ij ./ C " hij ./; (8.9i) b kij D k C " hkij ./; ij (8.9ii) b kij l D @l k C " @l hkij ; ij (8.9iii) Using (A1.26), (A1.27), (8.4i,ii), (8.8), and (8.9i–iii), we obtain, after a long calculation Z h J./ D Gij ./ C Fi k Fj k .1=4/ gij Fkl F kl " D4 k C D i Dj C D j Di gij D Dk C m2 hij .x/ p g d4 x C (boundary terms): (8.10) 8.1 The General E–M–K–G Field Equations 541 Choosing variationally h i admissible boundary conditions of (A1.20ii), the functional D 0, from (8.10), yields Einstein’s field equations (8.2iv). derivative lim J./ " "!0 Remarks: (i) Consider the Lagrangian from (8.4ii) given by 1 L./j:: L./j:: WD p g h i j D R./ C 2 .1=4/ Fij ./ F ij ./ C D Dj C m2 ./ ./ : It is an invariant (or a scalar field) under general coordinate transformations. Moreover, it is invariant under the following combined gauge transformations: b Aj .x/ D Aj .x/ rj b.x/ D exp Œie b.x/ D exp Œie bj b D exp Œie D b b D exp Œie D j ; .x/ .x/; .x/ .x/; ./ Dj ; ./ D j : (ii) The invariances of part (i) give rise to identities (8.3i,ii) via Noether’s theorem [56]. Physically speaking, these identities are related to differential conservations of the charge–current and the energy–momentum density of the complex scalar field. Now we shall express gravitational field equations (8.2iv) in alternate forms. Using (2.162i), (8.2iv) yield n e E ij ./ WD Rij ./ C D i Dj C D j Di o C m2 gij C Fi k Fj k .1=4/ gij Fkl F kl D 0: (8.11) Next, we provide the coupled Einstein–Maxwell–Klein–Gordon field equations with orthonormal components. These are more relevant from a physical perspective. Equations (8.2i–vi) can be expressed equivalently as D.a/ WD r.a/ C ie A.a/ ./ ./; (8.12i) D .a/ WD r.a/ ie A.a/ ./ ./; (8.12ii) K./ WD D .a/ D.a/ m2 ./ D 0; (8.12iii) K./ WD D .a/ D .a/ m2 ./ D 0; (8.12iv) 542 8 The Coupled Einstein–Maxwell–Klein–Gordon Equations h i .a/ M .a/ ./ WD r.b/ F .a/.b/ ie ./D .a/ ./D D 0; nh E.a/.b/./ WD G.a/.b/ ./ C D .a/ D.b/ C D .b/ D.a/ (8.12v) .c/ i d.a/.b/ D D.c/ C m2 io h .c/ C F.a/.c/ F.b/ .1=4/ d.a/.b/ F.c/.d / F .c/.d / D 0; (8.12vi) C .a/ i.b/ ; @.c/ i.b/ D 0; (8.12vii) S A.a/ ; @.b/ A.a/ D 0: (8.12viii) Gravitational field equations (8.12vi) can be furnished equivalently by (2.163ii) as E .d / .a/.b/.c/ ./ .d / .d / WD R .a/.b/.c/ ./ C .a/.b/.c/ ./ n .d / .d / C .=2/ ı .c/ T.a/.b/ ./ ı .b/ T.a/.c/ ./ .d / .d / C d.a/.b/ T .c/ ./ d.a/.c/ T .b/ ./ i o h .d / .d / .e/ C .2=3/ ı .b/ d.a/.c/ ı .c/ d.a/.b/ T .e/ ./ D 0; T.a/.b/ ./ WD D .a/ D.b/ C D .b/ D.a/ .c/ d.a/.b/ D D.c/ C m2 i h .c/ C F.a/.c/ F.b/ .1=4/ d.a/.b/ F.c/.d / F .c/.d / : (8.13i) (8.13ii) The Cauchy problem or the initial value problem for the system of partial differential equations (8.2i–iv) has been investigated in [50]. (Consult Theorems 2.4.7 and 2.4.9.) The Rainich problem for this system of field equations has been examined in [70]. 8.2 Static Space–Time Domains and the E–M–K–G Equations We investigate in this section the Einstein–Maxwell–Klein–Gordon (E–M–K–G) equations with the general static metric. Moreover, we assume the existence of a static electric field and absence of any magnetic field. Furthermore, the complex scalar wave field is assumed to be in an eigenstate of energy according to the usual 8.2 Static Space–Time Domains and the E–M–K–G Equations 543 wave mechanics (or quantum mechanics), as this “time-harmonic” form is quite useful in physics. We express these physical assumptions mathematically as the following: .x/ D .x/ eiEx ; 4 4 .x/ D .x/ eiEx ; .x/ D .x/ I (8.14i) (8.14ii) A˛ .x/ 0; A4 .x/ DW A.x/ ¤ 0; (8.14iii) F˛ˇ .x/ 0; F˛4 .x/ D @˛ A 6 0 I (8.14iv) 2 ds 2 D g˛ˇ .x/ .dx ˛ / dx ˇ C g44 .x/ dx 4 2 # DW g˛ˇ .x/ .dx ˛ / dx ˇ f .x/ dx 4 ; g˛4 .x/ 0; f .x/ > 0; p p g D f 1=2 g # > 0: (8.14v) (8.14vi) Here, the constant E represents the eigenvalue of energy associated with the wave field .x/: Moreover, (8.14ii) and (8.14iii) guarantee that there is no magnetic field. Furthermore, (8.14iv) implies that the static electric field under consideration is not trivial. (See [60].) Now let us work out some of the field equations (8.2i–iv) with the assumptions made in (8.14i–v). p 1 @˛ g g ˛ˇ @ˇ A f 2 g ˛ˇ @˛ f @ˇ A M 4 ./ D f 1 p g C 2e f 1 .E eA/ 2 D 0: (8.15) By the field equations (8.2iv) and (8.11), with help of the metric in (8.14v,vi), we derive that p 1 @˛ g g ˛ˇ @ˇ f f 1 g ˛ˇ @˛ f @ˇ f e E 44 ./ D .1=2/ p g nh i o 2 .E eA/2 m2 f 2 C .1=2/ g ˛ˇ @˛ A @ˇ A D 0: (8.16) We shall next simplify the field equations by imposing the W–M–P–D condition (4.94) (with a different notation) as f D F .A/ WD m2 ŒE e A2 ; (8.17i) f .x/ D m2 ŒE e A.x/2 ; (8.17ii) 544 8 The Coupled Einstein–Maxwell–Klein–Gordon Equations f 1=2 .x/ D m1 ŒE e A.x/ > 0; (8.17iii) @˛ f D 2 .e=m/ f 1=2 @˛ A: (8.17iv) The following linear combination of the field equations (8.15) and (8.16) yields: E 44 f M 4 .m=e/ f 1=2 e ˚ D .m=e/ .e=m/2 C .=2/ f 1=2 2.e=m/ f 1=2 g ˛ˇ @˛ A @ˇ A ˚ (8.18) C m3 e 1 f 1=2 2e .E eA/ 2 D 0: We satisfy the equation above by setting the quantities in the above two curly brackets separately to zero. Thus, we deduce that and m3 e 1 f 1=2 2e .E eA/ D 0; (8.19i) .m=e/ .e=m/2 C .=2/ 2.e=m/ D 0: (8.19ii) Substituting (8.17iii) into (8.19i), we deduce that .e=m/2 D .=2/: (8.20) (Compare the equation above with the static, equilibrium condition (4.95).) Putting (8.20) into (8.19i), we obtain the identity .m=e/ .e=m/2 C .=2/ 2 .e=m/ D .m=e/ Œ 0: (8.21) Employing conditions (8.17ii,iii) and (8.20), let us compute other field equations. From (8.2i), (8.11), (8.14i–vi), (8.17i–iv), and (8.20), we derive that p 1 4 @˛ g g ˛ˇ @ˇ C f 1 .E eA/2 m2 K eiEx D p g p 1 @˛ g g ˛ˇ @ˇ C 0 D 0: Dp g (8.22) Equation (8.16), with the help of (8.17i–iv), yields p 1 e @˛ E 44 ./ D .e=m/ f 1=2 p g g ˛ˇ @ˇ A g C g ˛ˇ @˛ A @ˇ A C m2 f 2 D 0: (8.23) 8.2 Static Space–Time Domains and the E–M–K–G Equations 545 Moreover, the remaining field equations, from (8.11), reduce to h e E ˛ˇ ./ D R˛ˇ ./ C 2 @˛ @ˇ C m2 g˛ˇ 2 i C f 1 .1=2/ g˛ˇ g ı @ A @ı A @˛ A @ˇ A D 0; (8.24i) e E ˛4 ./ 0: (8.24ii) Next, we use the metric tensor of (8.14v,vi). The Klein–Gordon equation of (8.22) reduces to h i p 1 4 D 0: f 1=2 K eiEx D p @˛ f 1=2 g # g #˛ˇ @ˇ g# (8.25i) The field equation (8.23) goes over into p i h p e E 44 ./ D .e=m/ 1= g # @˛ f 1=2 g # g #˛ˇ @ˇ A C g #˛ˇ @˛ A @ˇ A C m2 f 2 D 0; (8.25ii) Furthermore, field equations (8.24i) transform into h e E ˛ˇ ./ D R˛ˇ C 2@˛ @ˇ # C m2 g˛ˇ 2 i # C f 1 .1=2/ g˛ˇ g # ı @ A @ı A @˛ A @ı A D 0; (8.25iii) # C .1=2/ r˛# f 1 rˇ# f C .1=4/ f 2 r˛# f rˇ# f: where, R˛ˇ D R˛ˇ (8.25iv) The linear combination of the preceding field equations yields # e E ˛ˇ ./ f 1 g˛ˇ e E 44 ./ h i # D R˛ˇ C .1=2/ r˛# f 1 rˇ# f C .1=4/ f 2 r˛# f rˇ# f h p # 1= g # C 2 @˛ @ˇ f 1=2 .e=m/ g˛ˇ p i @ g # g # ı @ı A C 2 .e=m/ f 1=2 @˛ A @ˇ A D 0: (8.26) 546 8 The Coupled Einstein–Maxwell–Klein–Gordon Equations Now we shall use a new coordinate chart for which 2 ı ds 2 D ŒV .x/2 g ˛ˇ .x/ dx ˛ dx ˇ ŒV .x/2 dx 4 ; (8.27i) V .x/ WD m ŒE e A.x/1 > 0; (8.27ii) ı # g˛ˇ .x/ D ŒV .x/2 g ˛ˇ .x/; p g # D ŒV .x/3 q ı g: (Compare the equation above with (4.97).) It is clear from (8.27ii) that @˛ V D e m .E e A/2 @˛ A; (8.28i) @˛ A D .e m/1 .E e A/2 @˛ V: D .m=e/ V 2 @˛ V: (8.28ii) Substituting (8.27i,ii) and (8.28i,ii) into (8.25i–iii), we obtain the following simpler field equations: 1 4 V 2 K eiEx D q @˛ ı g 1 V5 e E 44 ./ D q @˛ ı g q ı ı g g ˛ˇ @ˇ D 0; q ı ı g g ˛ˇ @ˇ V C 2e 2 ı ı e E ˛ˇ ./ V 4 g ˛ˇ ./ e E 44 ./ D R˛ˇ ./ C 2 @˛ (8.29i) 2 V 3 D 0; @ˇ D 0: (8.29ii) (8.29iii) We notice from (8.29i) that the function .x/ is harmonic in the positive-definite, ı three-dimensional metric g:: .x/: Therefore, we can apply Hopf’s Theorem 4.2.2 for the function .x/. Thus, we state and prove the following relevant theorem for field equations (8.29i–iii). Theorem 8.2.1. Let the function 2 C 2 D R3 I R satisfy the harmonic condition (8.29i) for all x 2 D R3 : If there exists an interior point x0 2 D such that .x/ .x0 / DW 0 , or, 0 D .x0 / .x/ for all x 2 D; then ı .x/ .x0 / D 0 D constant: Moreover, the metric g:: .x/ becomes (flat ) Euclidean. Furthermore, the field equation (8.29ii) reduces to 1 ı q q ı ı ı g @˛ g g ˛ˇ @ˇ V C 2e 2 . The proof of the above theorem is left to the reader. 0/ 2 V 3 D 0: (8.30) 8.2 Static Space–Time Domains and the E–M–K–G Equations 547 Before continuing, we present here an interesting digression. Motivated by the above theorem, we define the homogeneous state of the complex wave function .x/ by the following: .x/ D eiEx ; 4 0 .x/ D eiEx .x/ D eiEx .x/ D 4 4 0 4 0 eiEx ; D real constant: (8.31) Thus, attaining an interior maximum or an interior minimum, the real wave function .x/ of (8.31) must belong to a homogeneous state by Theorem 8.2.1. Moreover, the corresponding static metric in (8.27i) is of the conformastat class of (4.55). Furthermore, the system of eight, complicated partial differential equations (8.22), (8.23), and (8.24i) reduce to one second order, semilinear partial differential equation (8.30)! Now let us make a slight digression on the consequences of a more general homogeneous wave function provided by .x/ D 0 eiEx ; 4 0 .x/ D 4 0 eiEx ; D a complex constant; (8.32) with a general electromagnetic field. We shall investigate the implications of (8.32) on the system of general E–M–K– G field equations (8.2i–iv). The Klein–Gordon equation (8.2i) goes over into and e 2 A˛ A˛ C m2 C g 44 .E e A4 /2 D 0; (8.33i) p p g g j 4 C e rj Aj D 0: E= g @j (8.33ii) Two equations (8.33i) and (8.33ii) emerge from the real and the imaginary parts of the Klein–Gordon equation. The condition (8.33i) can be aptly called the generalized W–M–P–D condition. The second equation is a linear combination of the Lorentz gauge and harmonic gauge conditions. Now, the Maxwell equation (8.2iii), with assumptions in (8.32), yields ıp p 1 g @k g F j k D 2eE j 0j 2 g j 4 ./ 2e 2 j 2 0j Aj ./: (8.34) The equation above is the general relativistic, nonhomogeneous, Proca equation for a massive vector boson field. The mass parameter for the vector boson field p E in (8.34) is provided by M0 D 2e j 0 j > 0: The vector boson field A.x/ in (8.34) can induce short-ranged self-interactions for the complex wave field .x/: This interaction, implicit in (8.34), is a generalization of the London equation and the Meissner effect in superconductivity [169, 179]. 548 8 The Coupled Einstein–Maxwell–Klein–Gordon Equations Remarks: (i) Reference [59] deals with special relativistic, coupled Maxwell– 4 Klein–Gordon equations. For a homogeneous wave field ./ D 0 eiEx ; the special relativistic versions of (8.33i), (8.33ii), and (8.34) are derived in that paper. (ii) Compare and contrast the vector boson equation (8.34) with the shortranged gravitation (which is gravitation with vanishing Weyl tensor) in Appendix 4. (iii) The thesis by Gegenberg [109] also deals with vector boson field equations 4 associated with a homogeneous complex wave function .x/ D 0 eiEx : Now we shall go back to static field equations (8.29i–iii) and explore some effective solution strategies. Without loss of generality, we consider the static metric: p ı ds02 D exp 2 .x/ g ˛ˇ .x/ .dx ˛ / dx ˇ p 2 exp 2 .x/ dx 4 : (8.35) The static, vacuum field equations from (4.41i), (4.41ii), and (8.35) are furnished by ı R˛ˇ .x/ C 2 @˛ @ˇ D 0; q .q ı ı ı 1 g @˛ g g ˛ˇ @ˇ (8.36i) D 0: (8.36ii) Equations (8.36i) and (8.36ii) above are exactly the same equations as (8.29iii) and (8.29i)! Thus, we are able to devise a solution strategy for (8.29i–iii) in the following theorem. Theorem 8.2.2. Let the function 2 C 2 D R3 I R and the metric tensor ı components g ˛ˇ 2 C 3 D R3 I R satisfy the static, vacuum field equations (8.36i) and (8.36ii) for all x 2 D R3 : Then, the metric tensor components in (8.35) satisfy field equations (8.29i) and (8.29ii). Moreover, (8.29ii) remains unchanged as 1 q .q ı ı ı g @˛ g g ˛ˇ @ˇ V C 2e 2 Œ ./2 ŒV ./3 D 0: (8.37) The proof is again left to the reader. Now we shall investigate a consequence of this theorem. Corollary 8.2.3. Let the complex wave function .x/ be in a homogeneous state, ı that is .x/ D 0 D a real constant. Then, the metric g:: .x/ must be (flat ) Euclidean. Furthermore, the single nontrivial field equation (8.37), with help of a Cartesian coordinate chart, reduces to 8.2 Static Space–Time Domains and the E–M–K–G Equations r 2 V WD ı ˛ˇ @˛ @ˇ V D 2e 2 . 0/ 2 549 ŒV ./3 : (8.38) The proof is straightforward. Remark: If we express ŒV ./2 D Œ1 C 2W ./ from Example then for a 2.2.9, weak gravitational field we can represent V .x/ D 1 W .x/ C 0 W 2 : In that case, the field equation (8.38) goes over into r 2 W C 6e 2 . 0/ 2 W ./ D 2e 2 Œ 2 0 C0 W2 : The equation above is somewhat similar to a nonhomogeneous Yukawa equation for the effective short-ranged nuclear force that binds nucleons. Now, we shall provide two examples of exact solutions of the partial differential equation (8.38) and the consequent exact solutions of the static E–M–K–G equations (8.29i–iii). Example 8.2.4. Consider the plane symmetric solution of (8.38) with the assumptions @1 V ¤ 0; @2 V D @3 V 0: The exact solution is furnished by V x1 D sˇ ˇ c0 ˇ ˇe 0 ˇ hp ˇ ˇ dn je ˇ 0 c0 j p i x 1 x0 ; 2 : (8.39) Here, dn.::; ::/ is one of the Jacobian elliptic functions [91]. The function (8.39) is plotted2 in Fig. 8.1. The corresponding metric, complex wave function, and electrostatic potential are given by (recall Corollary 8.2.3) 2 4 2 2 .ds/2 D V x 1 ı˛ˇ .dx ˛ / dx ˇ V x 1 dx ; iEx 4 iEx 4 ; ./ D 0 e ; ./ D 0 e n 1 1 1 o : A x D A4 x D .e/1 E m V x 1 (8.40i) (8.40ii) (8.40iii) (It is of course assumed that the equilibrium condition e 2 D .=2/ m2 holds.) Example 8.2.5. This example deals with the static, axially symmetric metric and electrostatic field. (Consult Example 4.1.5. Moreover, De [69] has investigated the E–M–K–G equations with the static, axially symmetric metric and an electrostatic field.) The vacuum metric under consideration is furnished by (4.7), (4.9), and (4.10i–iv) as The space–time geometry at the events corresponding to the roots of V .x 1 / D 0 needs to be investigated. 2 550 8 The Coupled Einstein–Maxwell–Klein–Gordon Equations 1 V(x1) 0.5 0 5 10 15 x1 –0.5 –1 Fig. 8.1 A plot of the function in (8.39) with the following parameters: c0 D 1, e D 1, and x0 D 0 .ds0 /2 D e2!.x 1 ;x 2 / e2!.x 1 2 x ;x D n e2 1 ;x 2 / .x 1 ;x 2 / h dx 1 2 y1 nh D1 2 i 1 2 3 2 o C x dx C dx 2 2 dx 4 ; .xZ1 ;x 2 / 0 (8.41i) i o .@1 !/2 .@2 !/2 dy 1 C 2 .@1 !/ .@2 !/ dy 2 : .0 ;z0 /Œ @1 @1 ! C 1=x By (8.35), we set 1 (8.41ii) @1 ! C @2 @2 ! D 0: ıp ! x1 ; x2 : x 1 ; x 2 WD 1 (8.41iii) (8.42) Also, by Theorem 8.2.2 and (8.37), the exact solutions of the E–M–K–G equations are provided by 1 2 iEx 4 4 x ;x e ; ./ D x 1 ; x 2 eiEx ; (8.43i) i o n h 2 2 2 2 2 C x 1 dx 3 .ds/2 D V x 1 ; x 2 e2 ./ dx 1 C dx 2 ./ D 2 4 2 V x1 ; x2 dx ; @1 @1 V C 1=x 1 @1 V C @2 @2 V C 2.e/2 Œ ./2 ŒV ./3 D 0; n 1 o A x 1 ; x 2 A4 x 1 ; x 2 D .e/1 E m V x 1 ; x 2 ; (8.43ii) (8.43iii) (8.43iv) 8.3 Spherical Symmetry and a Nonlinear Eigenvalue Problem: : : ı g ˛ˇ .x/ dx ˛ dx ˇ D e2 .x 1 ; x 2 / .dx 1 /2 C .dx 2 /2 C .x 1 /2 .dx 3 /2 : 551 (8.43v) The metric above is not conformally flat. We have assumed the equilibrium condition e 2 D .=2/ m2 : Furthermore, the axially symmetric, exact solutions of the E–M–K–G equations depend solely on the exact solution of the nonlinear potential equation (8.43iii). 8.3 Spherical Symmetry and a Nonlinear Eigenvalue Problem for a Theoretical Fine-Structure Constant In this section, we investigate the E–M–K–G equations, assuming spherical symmetry for the static metric and the electrostatic potential. Firstly, let us consider the case of the homogeneous state for the complex wave field and the corresponding partial differential equations for the metric and electromagnetic potential in the following: .x/ eiEx D .x/ eiEx D 0 D a real constant; n 1 o ; A x 1 D A4 x 1 D .e/1 E m V x 1 2 2 h 2 2 2 io 2 n ds 2 D V x 1 dx 1 C x 1 dx 2 C sin x 2 dx 3 4 4 2 4 2 V x1 dx ; ˚ 1 2 3 D WD x ; x ; x 2 R3 W 0 < r0 < x 1 ; 0 < x 2 < ; < x 3 < ; 3 D 0; @1 @1 V C 2=x 1 @1 V C 2.e/2 . 0 /2 V x 1 p .e=m/ D ˙ =2; ı g ˛ˇ .x/ dx ˛ dx ˇ D .dx 1 /2 C .x 1 /2 .dx 2 /2 C sin2 .x 2 / .dx 3 /2 : (8.44i) (8.44ii) (8.44iii) (8.44iv) (8.44v) (8.44vi) (8.44vii) The second order, semilinear, ordinary differential equation (8.44v) is known as one of the Lane-Emden equations. (See [275].) By making the transformation W .x 1 / WD x 1 V .x 1 /, we can analytically reduce (8.44v) to a simpler equation: @1 @1 W C 0 W D 0; .x 1 /2 known as a modified Emden equation with 0 WD 2.e/2 . 0 /2 . We analyze the function W instead of V as it more closely resembles functions later in this chapter. The function W .x 1 /, for various boundary conditions, is plotted in Fig. 8.2. The 552 8 The Coupled Einstein–Maxwell–Klein–Gordon Equations 6 4 W (x ) 2 0 20 40 –2 x 60 80 100 –4 –6 Fig. 8.2 A plot of the function W .x 1 / D x 1 V .x 1 / subject to the boundary conditions W .0/ D 0, @1 W .x 1 /jx1 D0 D 0:5; 1; and 5 representing increasing frequency respectively. The constant .0/ is set to unity corresponding spatial universe, governed by the metric in (8.44iii,iv), is finite and closed [49]. Now, we shall examine more general spherical symmetric cases. First, consider the Schwarzschild universe in the isotropic coordinate chart. By Problem # 1(i) of Exercises 3.1 and the corresponding answer, it is furnished by 3 2 io k 4 n 1 2 1 2 h 2 2 2 2 dx C x dx C sin x dx x1 " #2 2 1 k=x 1 dx 4 ; (8.45i) 1 1 C .k=x / .ds0 /2 D 1 C D WD ˚ x 1 ; x 2 ; x 3 2 R3 W 0 < k < x 1 ; 0 < x 2 < ; < x 3 < : (8.45ii) We assume the complex wave field is spherically symmetric and time-harmonic: ./ D 4 x 1 eiEx ; ./ D 1 iEx 4 x e : Next, (8.35) as well as Theorem 8.2.2 are applied to determine the function in (8.46) as 1 x 2 1 .k=x 1 / ; 1 C .k=x 1 / 1 ıp ˚ ln 1 k=x 1 ln 1 C k=x 1 : x D 1 p e2 (8.46) D (8.47) The spherically symmetric metrics from (8.45i), (8.27i), and (8.35) and the Theorem 8.2.2 can be summarized as 8.3 Spherical Symmetry and a Nonlinear Eigenvalue Problem: : : 553 #2 h i2 n 1 2 1 2 1 C k=x 1 1 2 .ds0 / D 1 k=x dx C x 1 .k=x 1 / " #2 1 io h 2 2 1 k=x 2 2 dx 2 C sin x 2 dx 3 dx 4 : (8.48i) 1 C .k=x 1 / h 2 i2 n 1 2 1 2 ı g ˛ˇ ./ .dx ˛ / dx ˇ D 1 k=x 1 dx C x h 2 2 2 i o ; (8.48ii) dx 2 C sin x 2 dx 3 " 2 2 i2 n 1 2 1 2 2 h .ds/2 D V x 1 1 k=x 1 dx C x h 2 2 2 i o 1 2 4 2 V x dx 2 C sin x 2 dx 3 dx : (8.48iii) The function V x 1 ; by (8.37) and (8.48ii), satisfies the second order, semilinear, ordinary differential equation: @1 @1 V C 2 x1 " 1C # .k/2 .x 1 /2 .k/2 @1 V 2 i2 h x1 k ln 1 C 2e 2 = 1 k=x 1 x Ck 2 3 V x1 D 0: (8.49) Now, we make the following coordinate transformation3: ı 1 x D ln x 1 C k x k ; x 1 D k coth .x=2/; x 1 > k > 0; x > 0; b.x/ WD V x 1 ; V b.x/ dV x 1 dV : D .2=k/ Œsinh .x=2/2 1 dx dx 3 In the sequel x 2 R and x 62 R4 : (8.50i) (8.50ii) (8.50iii) (8.50iv) 554 8 The Coupled Einstein–Maxwell–Klein–Gordon Equations With the help of (8.50i–iv), the ordinary differential equation (8.49) reduces to .2=k/2 h i3 b.x/ d2 V 2 4 2 4 b.x/ D 0: C 2e = .2/ .x/ .cosech x/ V dx 2 (8.51) Defining b.x/; U.x/ WD .2k/ V U 0 .x/ WD b.x/ dV dU.x/ D .2k/ ; dx dx (8.52) the ordinary differential equation (8.51) reduces to or, 2 ı U 00 .x/ C 2e 2 x .cosech x/2 ŒU.x/3 D 0; 2 2 e x .cosechx/2 ŒU.x/3 D 0: U 00 .x/ C 4 (8.53) The corresponding metric of (8.48ii), associated electrostatic potential, and the wave function of (8.14i) go over into4 n .ds 2 / D ŒU.x/2 .cosech x/4 .dx/2 C .cosech x/2 h 2 2 2 io 2 ŒU.x/2 2k dx 4 dx 2 C sin x 2 dx 3 n DW ŒU.x/2 .cosech x/4 .dx/2 C .cosech x/2 o .d/2 C .sin /2 .d'/2 ŒU.x/2 .dt/2 ; (8.54i) o n b (8.54ii) A.x/ D .e/1 E m ŒU.x/1 ; ıp 4 b./ D 1 x eiEx ; ıp 4 b./ D 1 x eiEx : (8.54iii) (8.54iv) In quantum mechanics, the wave function representing a localizable particle is square-integrable. In general relativity, the appropriate square-integrability emerges from the existence of the invariant integral representing the total charge of a material source. It is furnished by (8.2iii) and (8.54iii,iv) as The complete coordinate transformation is provided by (8.50i) together with .b x2; b x3/ D ; b / D .; /, b x 4 D 2k x 4 D t . (However, we have dropped hats on the coordinates .b subsequently.) 4 8.3 Spherical Symmetry and a Nonlinear Eigenvalue Problem: : : Z Q WD D D ie 555 p J4 x; x 4 n4 x; x 4 g # dx 1 dx 2 dx 3 Z h i p ./ D4 ./ D 4 n4 ./ g # dx 1 dx 2 dx 3 ; D (8.55) n # where, g˛ˇ ./dx ˛ dx ˇ D ŒU./2 Œcosech.x/4 .dx/2 o C Œcosech.x/2 .dx 2 /2 C .sin.x 2 //2 .dx 3 /2 : (Here, n4 .x; x 4 / D jU.x/j.) Let us calculate the right-hand side of the above equation, utilizing (8.54i–iv) and (8.17iii), we obtain q Z j ./j2 ŒE e A./ ŒU./4 Q D .i e/ .2i / D q Z D 2.e m/ j ./j ŒU./ 2 3 ı g dx 1 dx 2 dx 3 ı g dx 1 dx 2 dx 3 : D Using (8.54i) and (8.54iii), we deduce that Z1 Q D 2 .e m=/ .4/ .x/2 ŒU./3 .cosech x/4 dx; 0C for U./ > 0: Now we use the differential equation (8.53) to derive that Q D .8/ .e m/= 2e 2 Z1 U 00 .x/ dx 0C D 4 m e lim U 0 .L/ U 0 .0C / : L!1 Due to physical considerations, we set the total charge as5 5 We can set Q DW e for the case U./ < 0. 556 8 The Coupled Einstein–Maxwell–Klein–Gordon Equations r 4 r=coth(x)−1 2 –2 0 –1 1 2 x 2 f(x)=−2 –4 Fig. 8.3 The graph of the function r D coth x 1 > 0 Q DW e D 4 m e lim U 0 .L/ U 0 .0C / : L!1 (8.56) The equation above is a consequence of the square-integrability of the wave function in the E–M–K–G equations. Now, we make another coordinate transformation in the following: r D coth x 1; x > 0; (8.57i) dr D .cosech x/2 < 0; dx (8.57ii) x D .1=2/ ln j.r C 2/=rj ; r > 0; .cosech x/ D r .r C 2/: 2 (8.57iii) (8.57iv) (See Fig. 8.3 depicting the function r D coth x 1:) The metric (8.54i) and the ordinary differential equation (8.53) go over into u.r/ WD U.x/; (8.58i) ˚ .ds/2 D Œu.r/2 .dr/2 C r .r C 2/ .d/2 C .sin /2 .d'/2 Œu.r/2 .dt/2 ; (8.58ii) ı g ˛ˇ ./ .dx ˛ / .dx ˇ / D .dr 2 / C r .r C 2/ .d/2 C .sin /2 d' 2 ; (8.58iii) 8.3 Spherical Symmetry and a Nonlinear Eigenvalue Problem: : : 557 u00 .r/ C 2.r C 1/ Œr .r C 2/1 u0 .r/ C e 2 =.4/ 2 .1=2/ ln j.r C 2/=rj Œu.r/3 D 0: (8.58iv) ı The three-dimensional metric g ˛ˇ ./ .dx ˛ / .dx ˇ / inherent in (8.58iii) can be expressed as6 ı g ˛ˇ ./ .dx ˛ / .dx ˇ / D .dr/2 C r 2 Œ1 C .2=r/ .d/2 C .sin /2 .d'/2 : (8.59) In the limit r ! 1; the metric above asymptotically approaches a spherical polar chart for the (flat) Euclidean geometry. Therefore, in the limit r ! 1; the fourdimensional metric in (8.58ii) asymptotically approaches a conformastat electrovac, or, charged-dust metric of the W–M–P–D class. (See (4.71) and (4.97).) Thus, the modification of the conformastat metric in (8.58ii) must be due to the presence of the localizable complex wave field. Using the coordinate transformation in (8.57i– iv), and assuming the lim u0 .r/ exists, we conclude that r!0C U 0 .x/ D r .r C 2/ u0 .r/; lim U 0 .L// D lim r .r C 2/ u0 .r/ D 0: L!1 r!0C (8.60i) (8.60ii) Substituting (8.60ii) into (8.56), we determine that the total charge is given by Q D e D 4 m 0 U .0C /; e or U 0 .0C / D e e2 D m D ˙p : 4 m 4 (8.61) (We choose the positive sign in the sequel.) The coordinate chart discussed in (8.57i–iv) makes it simpler to analyze the physical properties of the solutions. However, the corresponding ordinary differential equation (8.58iv) is mathematically more complicated and difficult to explore rigorously. Therefore, for mathematical analysis, we revert back to the coordinate chart in (8.53) and (8.54i). To investigate the second order, ordinary differential equation (8.53), we need another initial condition besides the one in (8.61). We assume U 2 C 2 .Œ0; 1/ RI R/ ; so that lim U 00 .x/ exists. Therefore, by the x!0C differential equation (8.53), and L’Hospital’s rule, we must have 6 Note that (8.59) is different from the corresponding equation in (8.54i). 558 8 The Coupled Einstein–Maxwell–Klein–Gordon Equations ˇ n oˇˇ ˇ ˇ lim x .cosech x/2 2 ŒU.x/3 ˇ D a positive constant; ˇx!0C ˇ or, lim U.x/ D U.0C / D 0: (8.62i) (8.62ii) x!0C Now we are in a position to pose the initial-value problem for the ordinary differential equation (8.53) as the following: U 2 C 2 .Œ0; 1/ RI R/ and U.x/ > 0; 2 U 00 .x/ C .e 2 =4/ x .cosech x/2 ŒU.x/3 D 0; (8.63ii) U.0/ D 0; (8.63iii) p U 0 .0/ D m D e= 4: (8.63i) (8.63iv) Remark: We note that for every solution of (8.63i–iv), there exists panother solution 0 b b b U .x/ WD U.x/ < 0; with U .0/ D 0; and U .0/ D m D e= 4 : We also notice that the function defined by y.x/ WD p 1=4 e U.x/; (8.64i) satisfies the differential equation 2 y 00 .x/ C x .cosech x/2 Œy.x/3 D 0: (8.64ii) Next we shall investigate the initial value problem for the ordinary differential equation (8.64ii) with the notation 2 p.x/ WD x .cosech x/2 ; 00 y .x/ C p.x/ Œy.x/ D 0: 3 (8.65i) (8.65ii) A pertinent theorem will be stated before continuing. Theorem 8.3.1. Let the ordinary differential equation (8.65ii) hold in the interval 0 < x < 1: Moreover, let the initial conditions be given by y.0/ D 0 and y 0 .0/ D a D constant: (8.66) Then, there exists a unique solution of the differential equation (8.65ii) with the initial conditions (8.66). 8.3 Spherical Symmetry and a Nonlinear Eigenvalue Problem: : : 559 For the proof, the choice of a 0 suffices. By the use of the Banach space E .x/ kWD max ju.x/j; the C 0 .Œ0; x0 / RI R/ with the norm defined to be k u 0xx0 preceding theorem was proved in [60]. We shall now state a corollary. Corollary 8.3.2. Let the constant be chosen as a 0: Then, for 0 x < 1; the unique solution y.xI a/ of the initial-value problem (8.65ii) and (8.66) must satisfy the weak inequality: jy.xI a/j jaj x D a x: (8.67) Proof of the corollary above was also given in [60]. Now, we are in a position to pose a nonlinear eigenvalue problem for a theoretical fine-structure constant. (See [60].) We call this quantity a theoretical fine-structure constant or a fine-structure parameter due to the exact similarity of the constant of the same name in electrodynamics. Here, we are including electrostatic and gravitational self-interactions. We shall explore the possible, theoretical values that this analogous parameter must possess in static, spherically symmetric, localized systems. Before proceding, we have to add a third condition for U.x/; in addition to the two initial values in (8.63iii) and (8.63iv). We add as the third condition the equation (8.60ii), yielding lim U 0 .L/ D 0: Thus, we summarize the nonlinear eigenvalue L!1 problem for a theoretical fine-structure constant as: U 2 C 2 .Œ0; 1/ RI R/ and U.x/ > 0; 2 U 00 .x/ C .e 2 =4/ x .cosech x/2 ŒU.x/3 D 0; (8.68ii) U.0/ D 0; (8.68iii) p U 0 .0/ D m D e= 4; (8.68i) (8.68iv) 0 lim U .L/ D 0: (8.68v) L!1 The eigenvalue .e 2 =4/ is what we refer to as the fine-structure parameter. We are seeking here the theoretical values of this parameter from the exact solutions of (8.68i–v). (For those who have studied electrodynamics, the experimental value of the electrodynamic fine-structure constant is known to be .e 2 =4/ D 1=137.) In terms of the functions y.x/ and p.x/; defined in (8.64i) and (8.65i), respectively, (8.68i–v) go over into: y 2 C 2 .Œ0; 1/ RI R/ and y.x/ > 0; (8.69i) y 00 .x/ C p.x/ Œy.x/3 D 0; (8.69ii) y.0/ D 0; (8.69iii) 560 8 The Coupled Einstein–Maxwell–Klein–Gordon Equations 1.5 U(n) (x) U(0) (x) 1 U(2) (x) 0.5 0 1 2 x –0.5 –1 3 4 U(1) (x) –1.5 Fig. 8.4 Graphs of the eigenfunctions U.0/ .x/, U.1/ .x/ and U.2/ .x/ p y 0 .0/ D e m= 4 D e 2 =.4/; lim y 0 .L/ D 0: (8.69iv) (8.69v) L!1 Now, we shall state the existence theorem on the nonlinear eigenvalues e.n/ (for the parameter e) and the corresponding eigenfunctions U.n/ .x/ for (8.68i–v). Theorem 8.3.3. Consider the nonlinear eigenvalue problem of (8.68i–v). For each nonnegative integer n 0; there exists a constant e D e.n/ and a corresponding eigenfunction U.x/ D U.n/.x/ which has exactly n zeros in .0; 1/ R and satisfies (8.68i–v). (For the proof, see [60].) We depict the first three eigenfunctions U.0/ .x/, U.1/ .x/, and U.2/ .x/ in Fig. 8.4. Now we shall describe very briefly the numerical method to compute the nonlinear eigenvalue e D e.0/ and the corresponding eigenfunction U.0/ .x/: We consider (8.69i–v) in the interval Œ0; 1/ R: By Theorem 8.3.3, there exists a unique solution y.1/ .x/ of the problem such that 0 .L/: y.1/ .0/ D 0 D lim y.1/ L!1 (8.70) This solution must also satisfy the following differential equation, the integrodifferential equation, and the integral equation respectively: 3 00 .x/ D p.x/ y.1/ .x/ ; (8.71i) y.1/ 0 y.1/ .x/ Z1 3 D Œp.t/ y.1/ .t/ dt; x (8.71ii) 8.3 Spherical Symmetry and a Nonlinear Eigenvalue Problem: : : Zx y.1/ .x/ D 3 t Œp.t/ y.1/ .t/ dt C x Z1 561 3 Œp.t/ y.1/ .t/ dt: (8.71iii) x 0 Putting y.1/ .x/ DW x ˇ.x/; (8.72) we find that ˇ.x/ satisfies the integral equation ˇ.x/ D .x/ 1 Zx Z1 .t/ Œp.t/ Œˇ.t/ dt C .t/3 Œp.t/ Œˇ.t/3 dt: (8.73) 4 3 x 0 Now, consider the alternate nonlinear eigenvalue problem (see [94]) of the integral equation: v.x/ WD .x/ 1 Zx .t/4 Œp.t/ Œv.t/3 dt 0 Z1 C .t/3 Œp.t/ Œv.t/3 dt; (8.74i) x and Z1 .t/4 Œp.t/ Œv.t/3 dt D : (8.74ii) 0 This problem can be solved by successive approximation as follows. Beginning with a function v.0/ .x/ D .x/1 C 0.x 2 / as x ! 1; functions v.j /.x/ with same properties are defined recursively as .j C1/ v.j C1/.x/ WD .x/ 1 Zx 3 .t/4 Œp.t/ v.j /.t/ dt 0 Z1 3 C .t/3 Œp.t/ v.j / .t/ dt; (8.75i) x with .j C1/ Z1 3 WD .t/4 Œp.t/ v.j / .t/ dt: (8.75ii) 0 This procedure, when carried out numerically on a computer, proved to be convergent on the pair . ; v.x// of the nonlinear eigenvalue problem of (8.74i,ii). 562 8 The Coupled Einstein–Maxwell–Klein–Gordon Equations Recall from (8.69i–v) that 3 00 .x/ D Œp.x/ y.0/ .x/ ; y.0/ (8.76i) y.0/ .0/ D 0; (8.76ii) lim y00 .L/ D 0; (8.76iii) L!1 2 0 .0/ D e.0/ =4: y.0/ (8.76iv) Now, we define the solution as y.0/ .x/ WD y.1/ .x/ D x ˇ.x/ D Œx v.x/ : (8.77) With help of (8.70), (8.71i–iv), (8.73), and (8.76i–iv), the equation (8.77) follows. Thus, from (8.64i) and (8.77) we deduce that U.0/ .x/ D p p 1 4 e.0/ y.0/ .x/ D 4 .e0 /1 x ˇ.x/: (8.78) The graph of the eigenfunction U.0/ .x/ was already plotted in the Fig. 8.4. The corresponding theoretical eigenvalue of the fine-structure parameter and the charge, from numerical analysis via computer, turns out to be 2 e.0/ =4 p e.0/ = 4 7:28; 2:70: (8.79i) (8.79ii) U.2/ .x/ was also plotted in Fig. 8.4. This function has two isolated zeros in the open interval .0; 1/ R: It is nonnegative from the origin to the first zero at r D r.1/ : It takes negative values in the open interval r.1/ ; r.2/ between the first and the second zero. Then, the function takes positive values, approaching asymptotically to a horizontal straight line. The eigenfunction U.j /.x/ has j zeros at r D r.1/ ; : : : ; r.j / in the open interval .0; 1/ R: After the j th zero, the function U.j / .x/ approaches asymptotically to a horizontal straight line. Now, we shall explore geometrical and physical properties of the space–time universe associated with the nonlinear eigenvalue e.0/ and the corresponding eigenfunction U.0/ .x/: We shall use the coordinate chart of (8.58i,ii). Thus, we express u.0/ .r/ WD U.0/ .x/; (8.80i) 2 ˚ .ds/2 D u.0/ .r/ .dr/2 C r .r C 2/ .d/2 C .sin /2 .d'/2 2 u.0/ .r/ .dt/2 : (8.80ii) 8.3 Spherical Symmetry and a Nonlinear Eigenvalue Problem: : : 563 The t D constant hypersurface representing the spatial universe from (8.80ii) is provided by the metric 2 ˚ .dl/2 WD u.0/ .r/ .dr/2 C r .r C 2/ .d/2 C .sin /2 .d'/2 # (8.81i) DW g˛ˇ ./ .dx ˛ / dx ˇ ; p 3 g # D u.0/ .r/ r .r C 2/ sin > 0; Z p g # dx 1 dx 2 dx 3 D .4/ ( ZL lim L!1 0C D (8.81ii) ) Œu0 .r/3 r .r C 2/ dr ! 1: (8.81iii) The radial distance is defined by Zr R.r/ WD u.0/ .w/ dw; (8.82i) 0C lim R.r/ ! 1: (8.82ii) r!1 The ratio of the circumference divided by the radial distance is given by Ratio WD .2/ u.0/ .r/ Œr .r C 2/1=2 : R.r/ (8.83) The ratio above starts with “infinite slope,” decaying monotonically to zero. (Compare and contrast with the Schwarzschild case in the Example 3.1.2.) The area of a 2-sphere at the radial distance R.r/ is furnished from (8.81i) as: 2 (8.84) Spherical area WD .4/ u.0/ .r/ r .r C 2/: The spherical area above starts from zero increases asymptotically to a (positive) constant. Now, we investigate the properties of the four-dimensional universe with the metric (8.80ii). We deduce that 2 p g D u.0/ .r/ Œr .r C 2/ sin > 0; Z p g dx 1 dx 2 dx 3 dx 4 ( D D lim lim L!1 t !1 ZL Z t .4/ u.0/ .r/ 2 (8.85i) ) r .r C 2/ dr dt ! 1: (8.85ii) 0C t0 Thus, the total, invariant volume is unbounded and the universe is open. 564 8 The Coupled Einstein–Maxwell–Klein–Gordon Equations a b u(0)(r) R(r) (0, 1) r r c d 2πu(0)(r)[r(r+2)]1/2[R(r)]−1 (0, 2 π) two−sphere r Fig. 8.5 (a) Qualitative graph of eigenfunction u.0/ .r/: (b) Qualitative plot of the radial distance R.r/ versus r: (c) Qualitative plot of the ratio of circumference divided by radial distance. (d) Qualitative two-dimensional projection of the three-dimensional, spherically symmetric geometry With informations coded in (8.81i), (8.81iii), (8.82ii), (8.83), and (8.84), we interpret qualitatively the spatial geometry associated with the non-linear eigenvalue e.0/ and the corresponding eigenfunction u.0/ .r/: The Fig. 8.5a–d depict various aspects of the spherically symmetric geometry. Now, let us work out the radial, null geodesics from the metric in (8.80ii). These are provided by solutions of the ordinary differential equations: dr dt 2 4 D u.0/ .r/ > 0; 2 dr : D ˙ u.0/ .r/ dt (8.86i) (8.86ii) The slope of the outgoing, radial null geodesic increases monotonically toward the “infinite slope.” Now we shall graphically furnish the radial null geodesics of (8.86i,ii) qualitatively in Fig. 8.6. Now, as a comparison of the properties of the various eigenfunctions, we shall investigate the eigenfunction U.2/ .x/ also shown in the graph of Fig. 8.4. 8.3 Spherical Symmetry and a Nonlinear Eigenvalue Problem: : : 565 r Fig. 8.6 Qualitative plots of three null cones representing radial, null geodesics t (The interested reader can follow the analysis here and above to study the eigenfunction U.1/ .x/.) We shall examine the corresponding eigenfunction u.2/ .r/: The graphs analogous to Fig. 8.5a–d (which illustrate properties for u.0/ .r/) will be provided in Fig. 8.7a–d which depict the spherically symmetric geometry inherited from the eigenfunction u.2/ .r/: Remark: The three-dimensional, spherically symmetric geometry depicted in the Fig. 8.7d consists of three constituent pieces joint together (like in a sausage). The corresponding third Betti number is characterized by two. Now, we shall calculate the nonzero, orthonormal components of the curvature tensor for the metric in (8.60ii). These are furnished in the following: n u2 u0 2 C 2 Œ.r C 1/=.r .r C 2// u3 u0 o C u2 Œr .r C 2/2 ; n 2 R.1/.2/.1/.2/./ R.1/.3/.1/.3/./ D u3 u00 u2 u0 R.2/.3/.2/.3/./ D (8.87i) o C Œ.r C 1/=.r .r C 2// u3 u0 Œr .r C 2/2 u2 ; (8.87ii) 2 R.1/.4/.1/.4/./ D u3 u00 C 3 u2 u0 ; n 2 R.2/.4/.2/.4/./ R.3/.4/.3/.4/./ D u2 u0 o C Œ.r C 1/=.r .r C 2// u3 u0 : (8.87iii) (8.87iv) 566 8 The Coupled Einstein–Maxwell–Klein–Gordon Equations a b u(2) (r) R (r) r c r d 2πu(2)(r)[r(r+2)]1/2[R(r)]−1 r Fig. 8.7 (a) Qualitative R r ˇ graphˇ of the eigenfunction u.2/ .r/: (b) Qualitative plot of the radial distance R.r/ WD 0C ˇu.2/ .w/ˇ dw: (c) Qualitative plot of the ratio of circumference divided by radial distance. (d) Qualitative, two-dimensional projection of the three-dimensional, spherically symmetric geometry Remarks: (i) For every eigenfunction u.j / .r/; j 2 f0; 1; 2; : : :g; the orthonormal components of the curvature tensor are provided by (8.87i–iv) with modifications from u.r/ ! u.j /.r/: (ii) For the first eigenfunction u.0/ .r/; the corresponding orthonormal compo3 nents of the curvature tensor from (8.87i–iv) are all of class C ..0; 1/ RI R/: Moreover, in the limiting process, lim R.a/.b/.c/.d /./ 0: r!0C (iii) For every other eigenfunction u.j /.r/; the orthonormal components of the cur vature tensor are all of class piecewise Cp3 .0; r1 / [ .r1 ; r2 / [ : : : [ .rj 1 ; rj / RI R/, but the components of the curvature tensor in (8.87i–iv) have singularities at the zeroes of u.j / .r/. These singularities are analogous to the following: Consider the double cone .x 1 /2 C .x 2 /2 .x 3 /2 D 0 embedded in Euclidean space E3 . (Compare with Figs. 1.13 and 2.2.) This hypersurface (which is actually a topological variety) has one curvature singularity at the vertex where the two cones meet. That is why we have included the generalized differential manifold characterized by Fig. 8.7d. Now, let us go back to spherically symmetric field equations (8.44i–vi), (8.45i,ii), (8.46), (8.47), (8.48i–iii), (8.49), (8.50i–iv), (8.53), (8.54i–iv), (8.57i–iv), and 8.3 Spherical Symmetry and a Nonlinear Eigenvalue Problem: : : 567 (8.58i–iii). These equations involve only electrogravitational self-interactions and no external fields. The corresponding eigenfunctions u.j / .r/ are depicted in Figs. 8.5a–d and 8.7a–d for the scenarios when j D 0 and j D 2. We shall now make some remarks about the physical properties of these solutions in the following: Remarks: (i) The wave-mechanical models of a charged, scalar particle under consideration here are self-consistent and complete. The field equations used in this chapter emerge from the coupling of (a) Einstein’s gravitational equations, (b) Maxwell’s electromagnetic field equations, and (c) the (relativistic) Klein– Gordon wave equation. (ii) In a spherically symmetric space–time domain, rigorous techniques of solving nonlinear eigenvalue problems are employed. The existence of a denumerably infinite number of (theoretical ) eigenvalues for the charge parameter e, the “fine-structure parameter” (e 2 =4), and the (proper) mass parameter m is established. p (iii) The “equilibrium condition” e D ˙ =2 m implies that a p spectrum of particles can exist with masses of the order of the Planck mass ( „ c=G 2:17 105 gm in c.g.s. units.) Thus, these particles are remarkably similar to conjectured particles called geons [262]. Interestingly, the spectrum is discrete, a result that is qualitatively similar to the result found in elementary particle physics. (iv) The lowest, theoretical eigenvalue of the positive charge parameter is given by e.0/ D 9:57. It is worthwhile to compare this value with the experimentally measured magnitude of the elementary charge (the charge of an electron), je(e) j D 0:303. The ratio e.0/ =je(e) j D 31:59: Below we provide Table 8.1 displaying the properties (in the fundamental units specified by „ D c D G D 1; D 8) of the first five condensates (which may represent gravitationally bound charged “particles”) out of the denumerably infinite number. These values are obtained from the graphs of the eigenfunctions U.j / .x/ as depicted for a few of them in Fig. 8.4. Table 8.1 Physical quantities associated with the first five eigenfunctions of U.j / .x/. Eigenvalue of the Dimensionless Dimensionless fine-structure charge parameter mass parameter parameter Condensate 0 Condensate 1 Condensate 2 Condensate 3 Condensate 4 je.0/ j D 9:57 je.1/ j D 25:13 je.2/ j D 44:66 je.3/ j D 67:53 je.4/ j D 93:26 m.0/ m.1/ m.2/ m.3/ m.4/ D 2:70 D 7:09 D 12:60 D 19:05 D 26:31 .e.0/ /2 =4 .e.1/ /2 =4 .e.2/ /2 =4 .e.3/ /2 =4 .e.4/ /2 =4 D 7:28 D 50:26 D 158:76 D 362:90 D 692:21 Appendix 1 Variational Derivation of Differential Equations Let us recall the definition of a critical point for a function f belonging to the class C 2 ..a; b/ RI R/. Critical points are furnished by the roots of the equation f 0 .x/ WD dfdx.x/ D 0 in the interval .a; b/. Local (or relative) extrema are usually given by a critical point x0 such that f 00 .x0 / ¤ 0. In case f 0 .x0 / D 0 and f 00 .x0 / > 0, the function f has a local (or relative) minimum. Similarly, for a critical point x0 with f 00 .x0 / < 0, f has a local (or relative) maximum. In case a critical point is neither a maximum nor a minimum, it is called a stationary point (or a point of inflection). We will now provide some simple examples. (1) Consider f .x/ WD 1 for x 2 .1; 1/. Every point in the interval .1; 1/ is a critical point. (2) Consider f .x/ WD x in the open interval .2; 2/. There exist no critical points in the open interval. However, if we extend the function into the closed interval Œ2; 2, there exists an extremum at the end points (which are not critical points). (3) The function f .x/ WD .x/3 , for x 2 R, has a stationary point (or a point of inflection) at the origin. (4) The periodic function f .x/ WD sin x; x 2 R, has denumerably infinite number of local extrema, but no stationary points. (See, e.g., [32].) Now, we generalize these concepts to a function of N real variables x .x 1 ; : : : ; x N /. We assume that f 2 C 2 .D RN I R/. A local minimum x0 is defined by the property f .x/ f .x0 / for all x in the neighborhood Nı .x0 /. Similarly, a local maximum is defined by the property f .x/ f .x0 / for all x in the neighborhood. Consider f as a 0-form (see Sect. 1.2). The critical points are provided by the roots of the 1-form equation: Q df .x/ D 0.x/; @i f D 0; i 2 f1; 2; : : : ; N g: (A1.1) A local (strong) minimum at x0 is implied by the inequality N N X X i D1 j D1 x i x0i x j j x0 @2 f .x/ ˇ > 0: @x i @x j ˇx0 A. Das and A. DeBenedictis, The General Theory of Relativity: A Mathematical Exposition, DOI 10.1007/978-1-4614-3658-4, © Springer Science+Business Media New York 2012 (A1.2) 569 570 Appendix 1 Variational Derivation of Differential Equations x^ ^ χ x χ t1 t t2 N Fig. A1.1 Two twice-differentiable parametrized curves into RN Similarly, a local (strong) maximum is guaranteed by 2 N N X X i j j @ f .x/ i x x0 x x0 ˇ < 0: @x i @x j ˇx0 i D1 j D1 (A1.3) P PN i j Example A1.1. Consider the quadratic polynomial f .x/ WD N i D1 j D1 ıij x x for x 2 RN . There exists one critical point at the origin x0 WD .0; 0; : : : ; 0/. Now, 2 N N N X N X X X i j @ f .x/ xx D 2 ıij x i x j > 0: ˇ i @x j ˇ @x .0;0;:::;0/ i D1 j D1 i D1 j D1 Therefore, the origin is a local, as well as a global (strong), minimum. Consider a parametrized curve X of class C 2 Œt1 ; t2 RI RN , as furnished in equation (1.19). A Lagrangian function L W Œt1 ; t2 DN DN0 ! R is such that L.tI xI u/ is twice differentiable. The action function (or action functional) J is a mapping from the domain set C 2 Œt1 ; t2 RI RN into the range set R and is given by: Zt2 J.X / WD ŒL.tI xI u/ i i (A1.4) dX i .t / dt: i jx DX .t /; u D dt t1 We assume that the function J is of class C 2 , thus, totally differentiable in the abstract sense. (See (1.13).) b 2 C 2 Œt1 ; t2 RI RN . We consider a “slightly varied differentiable curve” X (See Fig. A1.1.) Two nearby curves are specified by the equations Appendix 1 Variational Derivation of Differential Equations 571 x i D X i .t/; b i .t/ WD X i .t/ C "hi .t/; b xi D X t 2 Œt1 ; t2 R: (A1.5) Here, j"j > 0 is a small positive number and hi .t/ is arbitrary twice-differentiable function. The “slight variation” of the action function J in (A1.4) is furnished by b J.X / J.X / WD J X ) dhi .t/ @L./ @L./ 2 h .t/ ˇ C ˇ dt C 0." / @x i ˇ:: dt @ui ˇ:: Zt2 ( D" i t1 Zt2 ( D" t1 ( ) ) ˇˇt2 @L./ @L./ ˇ i hi .t/ ˇ dt C " h .t/ ˇ ˇ @x i ˇ:: @ui ˇ:: ˇ t1 Zt2 ( " d hi .t/ dt t1 ) @L./ 2 ˇ dt C 0." /: @ui ˇ:: (A1.6) The variational derivative of the function J is given by J.X / ıJ.X / WD lim "!0 ıX " ( ) Zt2 @L./ d @L./ D hi .t/ dt ˇ ˇ @x i ˇ:: dt @ui ˇ:: t 1 C ( ) ˇt 2 ˇ @L./ ˇ i h .t/ ˇ C0 : ˇ ˇ @ui ˇ:: t1 (A1.7) The critical functions or critical curves X.0/ are defined by the solutions of the / equation ıJ.X D 0. We can prove from (A1.7) (with some more work involving the ıX Dubois-Reymond lemma [224]), that critical functions X.0/ must satisfy N Euler– Lagrange equations: ( ) @L./ d @L./ ˇ D 0: (A1.8) ˇ @x i ˇ:: dt @ui ˇ:: Moreover, we must impose variationally permissible boundary conditions (consisting partly of prescribed conditions and partly of variationally natural boundary conditions [159]) so that the equations 572 Appendix 1 ( Variational Derivation of Differential Equations ) ˇt 2 ( ) ˇ @L./ @L./ ˇ i i ˇ h .t/ ˇ D ˇ h .t/ ˇ ˇ @ui ˇ:: @ui ˇ:: ˇt 2 t1 ( ) @L./ i ˇ h .t/ ˇ D 0: @ui ˇ:: ˇ (A1.9) t1 must hold. Usually, 2N Dirichlet boundary conditions i i X i .t1 / D x.1/ D prescribed consts.; X i .t2 / D x.2/ D prescribed consts. are chosen. Such conditions imply, by (A1.5), that hi .t1 / D hi .t2 / 0. Therefore, (A1.9) will be validated. However, there are many other variationally permissible boundary conditions which imply (A1.9). Example A1.2. Consider the Newtonian mechanics of a free particle in a Cartesian coordinate chart. The Lagrangian is furnished by L.v/ WD m ı˛ˇ v˛ vˇ ; 2 m > 0; @L.v/ D m ı˛ˇ vˇ ; @v˛ @2 L.v/ D m ı˛ˇ : @v˛ @vˇ (A1.10) The Euler–Lagrange equations (A1.8), with a slight change of notation and fixed boundary conditions X .t1 / D x.1/ and X .t2 / D x.2/ , yield the unique critical curve ˛ X.0/ .t/ D ˛ ˛ x.2/ x.1/ t2 t1 ˛ .t t1 / C x.1/ : (A1.11) This is a portion of a straight line or geodesic. Substituting the above solution into the finite variation in (A1.6), we derive that Appendix 1 Variational Derivation of Differential Equations F 573 y DN (r+s) x DN π (r+s) N (r+s) N y (r+s) Fig. A1.2 The mappings corresponding to a tensor field y .rCs/ D .rCs/ .x/ J X.0/ C "h J X.0/ " Zt2 D "m ı˛ˇ # ˇ Zt2 dh˛ .t/ dX.0/ .t/ 1 2 dh˛ .t/ dhˇ .t/ dt C " m ı˛ˇ dt C 0 dt dt 2 dt dt t1 1 D 0 C "2 m 2 t1 Zt2 ı˛ˇ dh˛ .t/ dhˇ .t/ dt > 0: dt dt (A1.12) t1 Therefore, the critical curve X.0/ , which is a part of a geodesic in the Euclidean space, constitutes a strong minimum compared to other neighboring smooth curves. Remarks. (i) Local, strong minima provide stable equilibrium configurations. (ii) Timelike geodesics in a pseudo-Riemannian space–time manifold constitute strong, local maxima ! Now we shall consider .r C s/th order, differentiable tensor fields in an N dimensional manifold MN , as discussed in (1.30). (More sophisticated treatments of tensor fields employ the concepts of tensor bundles [38,56].) For the sake of brevity, we denote an .r C s/th order tensor field by the symbol .rCs/ .x/ (in this appendix). Various mappings, which are necessary for the variational formalism, are shown in Fig. A1.2. 574 Appendix 1 Variational Derivation of Differential Equations According to the mapping diagram, y .rCs/ D .rCs/ ı F .x/ DW .rCs/ .x/; x 2 D N RN : (A1.13) rCs rCsC1 The Lagrangian function L W D N R.N / R.N / ! R is such that .rCs/ .rCs/ L.xI y I y i / is twice differentiable. The action function (or functional) is defined by Z .rCs/ dN x: (A1.14) J.F / WD L xI y .rCs/ I y i ˇˇ .rCs/ .rCs/ .rCs/ .rCs/ y D .x/; y i D@i DN A “slightly varied function” is defined by b .x/ D .rCs/ .x/ C "h.rCs/ .x/; b y .rCs/ D .rCs/ ı F (A1.15) where j"j is a small positive number. The variation in the totally differentiable action function is furnished by b J.F / J.F / WD J F 8 " # 9 Z< = @L./ @L./ rCs N 2 D" h.rCs/ .x/ h C@ ˇ i ˇ ; d x C 0." /: : @y .rCs/ ˇ:: @y rCs ˇ:: i DN (A1.16) Here, indices .r C s/ are to be automatically summed appropriately. Now, we introduce the notion of a total-partial derivative by i d h .rCs/ ˇ .rCs/ f .xI y I y / j ˇ:: dx i " # @f ./ @f ./ @f ./ .rCs/ .rCs/ : WD ˇ C @i ˇ C @i @j .rCs/ @x i ˇ:: @y .rCs/ ˇ:: @y j ˇˇ:: (A1.17) By (A1.17), we can express (A1.16) as J.F / D " 8 Z < DN : @L./ .x/ ˇ @y .rCs/ ˇ:: .rCs/ h 3 " # 19 = @L./ d @L./ d A dN xC0."2 /: C @ i 4h.rCs/ .x/ .rCs/ ˇ 5h.rCs/ .x/ i ˇ ; dx dx @y rCs @y i ˇ:: ˇ:: i (A1.18) 0 2 Appendix 1 Variational Derivation of Differential Equations 575 The variational derivative is provided by ıJ.F / J.F / WD lim "!0 ıF " 8 0 " # 19 Z < = @L./ @L./ d A dN x D h.rCs/ .x/ @ ˇ ˇ ; : @y .rCs/ ˇ:: dx i @y rCs ˇ:: i DN C 8 Z < : " h.rCs/ .x/ @DN @L./ @y .rCs/ i # 9 = N 1 x: ˇ ; ni d ˇ:: (A1.19) (We have used Gauss’ theorem in (1.155) for the last term in (A1.19).) The critical .rCs/ / D or stationary functions .0/ .x/ are given by the solution of the equations ıJ.F ıF 0. We can derive, from (A1.19) [159], that critical functions must satisfy equations " # d @L./ @L./ (A1.20i) ˇ ˇ D 0; @y .rCs/ ˇ:: dx i @y .rCs/ ˇ:: i and 8 " # 9 Z < = @L./ n .x/ dN 1 x D 0: h.rCs/ .x/ .rCs/ ˇ ; i : @y i ˇ:: @DN (A1.20ii) Here, (A1.20i) yields Euler–Lagrange equations for critical tensor fields, whereas (A1.20ii) provides the variationally admissible boundary conditions. Example A1.3. Consider a background pseudo-Riemannian space–time and a scalar field y D .x/ for x 2 D4 R4 . The Lagrangian L, which is a scalar density, is furnished by p p g.x/ ij g .x/ yi yj ; g.x/ L.xI yI yi / D L.xI yI yi / WD 2 p @L./ @L./ 0; D g.x/ g kj .x/ yj : (A1.21) @y @yk Euler–Lagrange equations (A1.21), using (A1.17), yield d 0 k dx @L./ p p g g kj C @j @k g g kj ˇ D @j @k @yk ˇ:: D p p g g kj .x/rk rj D g D 0; or D 0: (A1.22) 576 Appendix 1 Variational Derivation of Differential Equations Thus, the critical functions .0/ .x/ satisfy the wave equation in the prescribed curved space–time. Consider the wave equation (A1.22) in a domain D4 WD D3 .0; T /, 0 < T < T1 . Let the prescribed metric functions gij .x/ be real-analytic and g 44 .x/ < 0 in the domain D4 . Consider the following initial value problem for the wave equation: .0/ .x; 0/ D p.x/; @4 .0/j.x;0/ D q.x/; x 2 D3 : Here, the prescribed functions p.x/ and q.x/ are assumed to be real-analytic. This initial value problem, by the Cauchy-Kowaleski Theorem 2.4.7, admits a unique, real-analytic solution .0/ .x/ for a small positive number T . The “varied function” .0/ .x/C"h.x/, which respects the initial values, must have h.x; 0/ D 0 D @4 hj.x;0/ . However, other than being real-analytic, there are no restrictions on h.x/ for 0 < x 4 < T . Thus, the integral in (A1.20ii), Z p h.x/ g ij .x/ @j ni .x/ g d3 x 6 0: @D4 Therefore, in general, initial value problems are not variationally admissible (due to the fact that on the final time hypersurface, the function h.x/ is completely arbitrary). Now, we shall investigate the variational derivation of the gravitational field equations. However, this process demands a slightly different mathematical approach. We explain the methodology by first exploring the following toy model. Example A1.4. Consider the flat space–time M4 and a Minkowskian coordinate chart. Therefore, the metric tensor field is given by gij .x/ D dij D consts., and p g.x/ 1. We explore a Lagrangian function L xI y; i I yi ; ij WD d ij @i @j W .x/ y ii ; L xI y; i I yi ; ij ˇ D . W / .x/ @i i : ˇ yD.x/; yi D@i ˇ i i i i (A1.23) D .x/; j D@j The slightly varied functions are denoted by b y D .x/ C "h.x/ and b i D i .x/ C i "h .x/. By (A1.16), we obtain that J.F / D " Z Z W h.x/ d4 x D4 D4 Z D @i hi d4 x Z W h.x/ d x 4 D4 @D4 hi .x/ ni d3 x: Appendix 1 Variational Derivation of Differential Equations Therefore, the critical functions, obeying ıJ.F / ıF 577 D 0, must satisfy: W .x/ D 0; Z hi .x/ ni d3 x D 0: and, (A1.24) @D4 Here, the coefficient function W .x/ need not satisfy any boundary condition and the i .x/ need not satisfy any differential equation! critical functions .0/ Now, we shall take up the case of general relativity. Recall that in (2.146i–iii) for relativistic mechanics, position variables and momentum variables are treated on the same footing. Similarly, in what is known as the Hilbert-Palatini approach of variation, metric functions y ij D g ij .x/ and connection coefficients kij D n o k are both treated as independent variables. We choose the following invariant ij Lagrangian function L./1 : ij L xI y ij ; kij I y k ; kij l h i WD y ij kkij kij k llk kij C li k klj DW y ij ij cab I cabd ; k k ij @ D g L. /ˇ ij ij .x/ @ j k ˇ y Dg .x/; y ijk D@k gij ; ij ij ˇ ˚k ˚k ˇ kij D ij ; kij l D@l ij C l k lk ij l k I ik lj p k k ij L./j:: D g.x/ g .x/ @j @k ij ij l k l k C : lk ij ik lj From the equations above, we can deduce the following partial derivatives: @.y/ D y y ab ; @yab p p @ y y 1p 1p ab @ DC y y ; D y yab ; @yab 2 @y ab 2 y y ab yac D y ı bc ; 1 Caution: Here, cab is not related to Ricci rotation coefficients as such. (A1.25) 578 Appendix 1 Variational Derivation of Differential Equations p @ p 1 j ij i ij I y y D y ı a ı b yab y @y ab 2 @ij ./ D ı ba cij ı bi ı cj lla C ı bi caj C ı cj bi a ; @ abc @ij ./ D ı ba ı ci ı dj ı da ı bi ı cj : @ abcd (A1.26) We denote the slightly varied functions by b y ij D g ij .x/ C "hij .x/ and b kij D n o k C "hkij .x/. (Note that hij .x/ and hkij .x/ are .2 C 0/th order and .1 C 2/th ij n o order tensor fields, respectively, even though ijk is not!)2 Using (A1.16) for the Lagrangian in (A1.25), we derive that 8 9 # p Z <" = ij y y @ J.F / ab ij ./ h D .x/ d4 x ˇ : ; " @y ab ˇ:: D4 ( Z @ij ./ p ij habc .x/ C g.x/ g .x/ @ abc ˇˇ:: D4 ) @ij ./ a @d h bc d4 x C 0."/: C @ abcd ˇˇ:: (A1.27) Therefore, for critical functions, (A1.25)–(A1.27), and a shortcut notation in regard to Gab .x/ yield Z Gab .x/ hab .x/ 0D D4 Z C p g.x/ d4 x h i j rj g j i .x/ hkki .x/ g ki .x/ h ki .x/ d4 v: (A1.28) D4 ij n o Thus, the critical functions g.0/ .x/ and k ij must satisfy Gab .x/ D 0 in D4 ; (A1.29i) p D The popular way of writing one of the variations in (A1.26) is to put ı jgj g ij p jgj ıg ij 12 gkl g ij ıg kl . (This equation holds in any Riemannian or pseudo-Riemannian manifold.) 2 Appendix 1 Variational Derivation of Differential Equations and (via the divergence theorem) Z h i j g ij .x/ hkki .x/ g ki .x/ h ki .x/ nj d3 v D 0: 579 (A1.29ii) @D4 p The variables y y ij and klij are analogous to the variables y and ij respectively of Example A1.4. Equations (A1.29i) and (A1.29ii) are exactly analogous to the equations in (A1.4). Equation (A1.29i) is obviously equivalent to the vacuum equations of (2.160i). Moreover, (A1.29ii) provides implicitly the variationally admissible boundary conditions for the vacuum equations. There is an unsatisfactory aspect in the derivation of (A1.29i,ii). In that process, we have varied the metric tensor and connection coefficients independently. However, the variational derivation does not reveal the actual relationship between these two. We can rectify this logical gap by augmenting the Lagrangian in (A1.25) ij with Lagrange multipliers k to incorporate the required constraints. Defining the 1 , we furnish the augmented Lagrangian LQ as the unique entries yij WD y ij 16 following function of .4/ variables (without assuming any symmetry): Q xI y ij ; kij ; ij I y ij ; kij l L k k h i WD y ij kkij kij k llk kij C li k klj 1 kl ij k C k ij y yj li C ylij yij l ; 2 Q L./ ˇy ij Dgij .x/; y ijk D@k gij ; ijk D ijk .x/; ˇ 8 9 8 9 ˇ < = < = ˇ k D k .x/; k D@l k ij : ij l ; : ij i j; k k l k @k .x/ .x/ D g ij .x/ @j ki ij lk ij l k C .x/ .x/ ik lj C ij k .x/ 1 k .x/ g kl .x/ @i gj l C @j gli @l gij ; ij 2 Q j:: WD py L./ Q j:: : L./ The Euler–Lagrange equation of metric tensor components. @LQ 0 ij @. k / j:: (A1.30) D 0 yield the Christoffel symbols in terms 580 Appendix 1 Variational Derivation of Differential Equations Now, the boundary term in (A1.29ii) is related to the trace of the exterior curvature of the hypersurface @D4 . To show this, consider the projection operator of p. 191, viz., P ij .x/ WD ı ij ".n/ ni .x/nj .x/: We define the extended extrinsic curvature [56, 126] by ij .x/ 1 WD P ki P lj .rk nl C rl nk / ; 2 K .u/ D @ i @ j ij ..u// : (A1.31i) (A1.31ii) (Here, the extrinsic curvature, K .u/, was defined in (1.234). The vector i was defined in the same section.) We can derive the trace from (A1.31ii) as i i .::/ The variation of ".n/.): i i .::/ D ri ni r i ni : (A1.32) is denoted by (Caution: Note that " is different from O ii .::/ i i .::/ DW "h.::/ : (A1.33) Now, (A1.32) yields two expressions: i nj ; ji k i ij nk : i .::/ D g .::/ @j ni ij i i .::/ D @i ni C (A1.34i) (A1.34ii) For a fixed boundary @D4 , the variations of ni are exactly n o zero. In consideration of the boundary term in (A1.29ii), only the variation of ijk is allowed. The variation of gij .::/ and ni .::/ is set to zero for this boundary term. Therefore, (A1.34i,ii) provide "h.::/ D 0 C "hiij .::/nj .::/; h i "h.::/ D g ij .::/ 0 "hkij .::/nk .::/ : (A1.35i) (A1.35ii) Adding the two equations above, we obtain h i 2h.::/ D g j k .::/hiij .::/ g ij .::/hkij .::/ nk .::/: (A1.36) Appendix 1 Variational Derivation of Differential Equations Therefore, the boundary term in (A1.29ii) is furnished by Z Z h i j g ij .x/hkki .x/ g ki .x/h ki .x/ nj d3 v D 2 @D4 581 h.x/ d3 v: (A1.37) @D4 A popular way to write the above is to express it as Z Z k j g ij .x/ı g ki .x/ı nj d3 v D 2 ı ki ki @D4 @D4 i i .x/ d3 v: (A1.38) (We have tacitly assumed here that ıgij .x/ 0 on the boundary.)3 Example A1.5. The invariant Lagrangians (A1.25) and (A1.30) contain secondorder derivatives of the metric tensor components. In general, for Lagrangians involving second-order derivatives of the metric, we would have obtained fourthorder field equations as the p corresponding Euler–Lagrange equations. However, for the Lagrangian density g.x/R.x/, the higher order terms are transformable into a boundary term in (A1.29ii) and thus do not contribute to the field equations. Einstein investigated a Lagrangian [84] which has only first-order derivatives of the metric tensor components. It is furnished by h i p L./ WD y y ij li k klj llk kij Y ij Fij Y klm ; p Y ij WD y y ij ; 8 9 L./ˇ < = ˇy ij Dgij .x/; kij D k : ij ; p l k l k (A1.39) D g.x/ g ij .x/ : ik lj lk ij p Note that the above Lagrangian is only a part of g.x/ R.x/, and it is not a scalar density (of weight C1). We can compute the partial derivatives as @L./ ˇ @Y ij ˇY ij Dpg gij ; Y ijk D@k .pg gij / l k l k D ; lk ij ik lj @L./ k k l : D ı i ij ˇ j l ij @Y k ˇ:: 3 (A1.40) In the metric variation approach, it is assumed that the connection is the metric connection and that only the metric is to be varied. In this scenario, the boundary term is much more complicated. The general Rcase (i.e., not assuming that ıgijR.x/ 0 on the boundary) yields R 2 @D4 ı ii .x/ d3 v C @D4 ri P ij .x/nk ıgjk .x/ d3 v @D4 g ik .x/ri nj ıgjk .x/ d3 v for the boundary term. 582 Appendix 1 Variational Derivation of Differential Equations (Consult [84].) The corresponding variational equations (A1.20i,ii) yield d @L./ ˇ @Y ij ˇ:: dx k " @L./ @Y ij k # ˇ D Rij .x/ D 0; ˇ:: Z l k kj ij h .x/ h .x/ nk d3 x D 0: jl ij (A1.41i) (A1.41ii) @D4 Thus, (A1.41i,ii) provide the gravitational field equations and variationally admissible boundary conditions outside material sources. Example A1.6. We shall now derive the Arnowitt–Deser–Misner (ADM) action integral [7], [184]. Assuming g44 .x/ < 0, we express the metric tensor in the following equations: g:: .x/ D g˛ˇ .x/ dx ˛ C N ˛ .x/ dx 4 ˝ dx ˇ C N ˇ .x/ dx 4 " gij D " # g˛ˇ g N ; g N g N N N 2 g ˛ˇ N 2 N ˛ N ˇ N 2 N g D N 2 N N 2 q q det gij D N det g˛ˇ : ij ŒN.x/2 dx 4 ˝ dx 4 I # I (A1.42) Suppose that the space–time locally admits a one-parameter family of threedimensional spacelike hypersurfaces. On the spacelike hypersurface characterized by x 4 D T , the intrinsic metric is furnished as g:: .x; T / D g˛ˇ .x; T / dx ˛ ˝ dx ˇ DW g ˛ˇ .x; T / dx ˛ ˝ dx ˇ : (A1.43) There is a slight notational difference between this equation and (1.223) because we choose here one member of the infinitely many hypersurfaces. We show the ADM decomposition schematically in Fig. A1.3. Gauss’ equation (1.242i) for a hypersurface yields in this example, with the ˛ (usual) notation A ./ WD g ˛ˇ ./ Aˇ ./, Appendix 1 Variational Derivation of Differential Equations – T2 Na(x) dx4 T1 x 583 x4=T2 4 (x+Δx, T 2 ) x4 x3 (x, T1 ) x1 4 x2 x4=T1 Fig. A1.3 Two representative spacelike hypersurfaces in an ADM decomposition of space–time R .x; T / D K .x; T /K .x; T / K .x; T /K .x; T / C R R .x; T / D R R.x; T / D R .x; T /; .x; T / C K ./ K ./ K ./ K ./; ij j i .x; T / DR ˛ˇ ˇ˛ .x; T / C 2R˛44˛ .x; T / h ˛ i2 ˛ ˇ D R.x; T / C K ˇ ./ K ˛ ./ K ˛ ./ C 2R˛44˛ ./: (A1.44) The last term in (A1.44) can be expressed as a divergence term analogous to rj Aj [184]. Therefore, the Hilbert action integral goes over into Z Z h ˛ i2 p ˛ ˇ 4 R.x/ g.x/ d x D R.x; T / C K ˇ ./ K ˛ ./ K ˛ ./ D4 D4 N.x; T / p g.x; T / d3 x d T C (boundary term): (A1.45) The above action integral is useful in several approaches to quantum gravity [10, 199, 221, 246]. Finally, we would like to make the following two mathematical comments. Firstly, consider a nonconstant Lagrangian density function L yij I yij k such that the action functional is given by Z J.F / WD L yij I yij k j:: d4 x; D4 yij D ij ı F .x/ D gij .x/; yij k D ij k ı F 0 .x/ D @k gij : (A1.46) 584 Appendix 1 Variational Derivation of Differential Equations It can be rigorously proved [171] that such an integral cannot be tensorially invariant. That is why, in Example A1.5, we had to deal with a noninvariant action integral. The second comment is about a Lagrangian scalar density of the type L yij I yij k I yij kl . It can be rigorously proved [170,171], that in a four-dimensional manifold, the most general Lagrangian density (made up of curvature invariants), which yields second-order Euler–Lagrange equations, must be of the form p p L./j:: WD c.1/ g.x/ R.x/ C c.2/ g.x/ p C c.3/ "ij kl Rmnij .x/ Rmnkl .x/ C c.4/ g.x/ h i j ij .R.x//2 4R i .x/ Rij .x/ C Rklij .x/ R kl .x/ : (A1.47) Here, c.1/ ; c.2/ ; c.3/ ; c.4/ are four arbitrary constants with just one constraint Œc.1/ 2 C Œc.3/ 2 C Œc.4/ 2 > 0. The first term is simply proportional to the Einstein-Hilbert Lagrangian density, giving rise to the equations of motion of general relativity (2.161i). The second term gives rise to a cosmological constant (proportional to c.2/ ) in the equations of motion (see (2.158)). The third term has been shown to yield trivial equations of motion in four dimensions [157]. Finally, each term in the last expression in (A1.47) produces fourth-order equations. However, their combination yields second-order equations and, in four dimensions, its integral is simply a topological number proportional to the Euler characteristic. This expression is commonly referred to as the Gauss-Bonnet term. Outside this appendix, we shall refrain from adding subscripts .0/ to critical .rCs/ functions .0/ .x/ satisfying the Euler–Lagrange equations (A1.20i). Appendix 2 Partial Differential Equations In general relativity, a considerable amount of effort is expended in attempting to solve partial differential equations. Therefore, we are including here an extremely brief review of the subject. (For extensive study, we suggest [43, 77, 94].) Consider the simplest partial differential equation known to mankind: u D U.x; y/; @x u D .x; y/ 2 D R2 I @U.x; y/ D 0: @x (A2.1) The general solution of equation above is furnished by u D U.x; y/ D f .y/; y1 < y < y2 : (A2.2) Here, f .y/ is an arbitrary differentiable function. Equation (A2.2) comprises of infinitely many solutions, and it is aptly called the most general solution of the partial differential equation (p.d.e.) (A2.1). Remarks. (i) The function f .y/ in (A2.2) may be misconstrued as a function of a single variable. Strictly speaking, it is a shortcut notation for a function F .c; y/ of two variables such that the first variable is restricted to a constant c. (ii) The function f .y/ can be chosen to be discontinuous in the interval .y1 ; y2 /, and still it will satisfy the p.d.e. (A2.1) exactly! (iii) In case the domain of validity D R2 in (A2.1) is nonconvex, the set of solutions in (A2.2) is not the most general. (See [112] for counter-examples.) A. Das and A. DeBenedictis, The General Theory of Relativity: A Mathematical Exposition, DOI 10.1007/978-1-4614-3658-4, © Springer Science+Business Media New York 2012 585 586 Appendix 2 Partial Differential Equations Now, let us consider the two-dimensional (one space and one time) wave equation given by the second order, linear p.d.e.: w D W .x; t/; .x; t/ 2 D R2 ; .x; 0/ D for x1 < x < x2 I @x @x w @t @t w D @2 W .x; t/ @2 W .x; t/ D 0: @x 2 @t 2 (A2.3) The most general solution of the equation above is furnished by W .x; t/D f .xt/C g.x C t/. Here, f; g 2 C 2 .D R2 I R/, but otherwise arbitrary. Thus, there are infinitely many solutions of the p.d.e. (A2.3). A class of general solutions containing infinitely many solutions is provided by W .x; t/ D x t C g.x C t/; g 2 C 2 .D R2 I R/. A particular solution W .x; t/ D x t C exp.x C t/ solves uniquely the initial value problem W .x; 0/ D x C ex ; @[email protected];t / jt D0 D ex 1. Let us employ a doubly null coordinate system u D x t; v D x C t. (Compare with the Example 2.1.17.) The p.d.e. in (A2.3) goes over into b .u; v/ WD W .x; y/; wDW b R2 I .u; v/ 2 D b .u; v/ @2 W D 0: @u@v (A2.4) The most general solution is provided by b .u; v/ D f .u/ C g.v/; where f; g 2 C 2 .D b R2 I R/: wDW However, we notice that the condition of C 2 differentiability on f .u/ can be comb .u; v/ D pletely relaxed. Discontinuous functions f .u/ can yield exact solutions W 2 W .u; v/ . Physically speaking, f .u/Cg.v/ for the p.d.e. (A2.4), but not for the p.d.e. @ b @v @u such solutions yield shock waves not revealed in the usual x t coordinate system. However, the definition of a solution can be generalized to a weak solution [43], which can extract rigorously discontinuous solutions in any coordinate system. Instead of the p.d.e. (A2.3), a weak solution has to satisfy the integral condition: Z W .x; t/.@x @x f @t @t f / dx dt D 0; (A2.5) D 1 for every C -function f with compact support in D. (Such functions are called distributions [270].) The second-order p.d.e. (A2.3) is exactly equivalent to the following linear, first order system: @x w D Px .x; t/; @t w D Pt .x; t/; @x Px @t Pt D 0; @t Px @x Pt D 0: (A2.6) Appendix 2 Partial Differential Equations 587 The last of the above equations is the integrability condition. (We have already discussed a system of .N 1/, first-order, linear p.d.e.s in (1.236).) In a general system of p.d.e.s in D RN , the highest derivatives that occur determine the order of the system. In a nonlinear system, the highest power (or exponent) of highest derivatives, is called the degree of the system. An N -dimensional first-order p.d.e. is called a linear equation if it has the form: N X i .x/ @i w C .x/w D h.x/; x 2 D RN : (A2.7) i D1 Here, i .x/, .x/, and h.x/ are prescribed continuous functions. (For a homogeneous p.d.e., h.x/ 0.) An N -dimensional first-order equation is called a semilinear p.d.e. provided it is given by N X i .x/ @i w C h.w; x/ D 0: (A2.8) i D1 A first-order p.d.e. is called quasilinear p.d.e. if it has the form: N X i .w; x/ @i w C h.w; x/ D 0: (A2.9) i D1 A second-order p.d.e. in an N -dimensional domain is called a linear p.d.e. provided it is furnished by N N X X .x/ @i @j w C ij i D1 j D1 N X i .x/ @i w C .x/w D h.x/: (A2.10) i D1 (The linear equation (A2.10) is homogeneous provided h.x/ 0.) A second-order p.d.e. is called a semilinear p.d.e. provided it is expressible as N N X X ij .x/ @i @j w C h.@i w; w; x/ D 0: (A2.11) i D1 j D1 A second-order p.d.e. is called a quasilinear p.d.e. if it has the form: N N X X ij .@k w; x/ @i @j w C h.@i w; w; x/ D 0: (A2.12) i D1 j D1 A system of p.d.e.s in an N -dimensional domain is a collection of coupled p.d.e.s. 588 Appendix 2 Partial Differential Equations System of p.d.e.s Linear system Homogeneous Non−linear system Non−homogeneous Disguised linear Quasi−linear Non−linear of degree ≥ 2 Semi−linear Fig. A2.1 Classification diagram of p.d.e.s We classify systems of p.d.e.s in an N -dimensional domain in Fig. A2.1. We shall now sketch very briefly some of the solution procedures for each of the type of systems mentioned in the figure. Linear systems with constant coefficients are soluble usually by employing Fourier series, Fourier integrals, or Laplace integrals. Q Speciali classes of linear p.d.e.s admit separable solutions of the type W .x/ D N i D1 W.i / .x /. Consider a single quasilinear first-order p.d.e. (A2.9). Lagrange’s solution method involves .N C 1/ characteristic ordinary differential equations (o.d.e.s): dx 1 or, 1 .w; x/ D dx 2 2 .w; x/ dX i .t/ D i .w; x/j:: ; dt D D dx N N .w; x/ D dw D dt; h.w; x/ dW.t/ D h.w; x/j:: ; dt W.t/ WD W ŒX .t/ W ŒX 1 .t/; : : : ; X N .t/: (A2.13) The general solution of (A2.13) consists of .N C 1/ arbitrary constants. Alternatively, the solution curve for (A2.13) may be furnished by the intersections of the following differentiable hypersurfaces: .i / .xI w/ D c.i / D const.; @ .1/ ; : : : ; .N / ¤ 0: @.x 1 ; : : : ; x N / (A2.14) Consider an arbitrary nonconstant function F 2 C 1 .D./ RN I R/. The most general solution of the quasilinear p.d.e. in (A2.9) is implicitly provided by F .1/ .xI w/; : : : ; .N / .xI w/ D c D const. (A2.15) Appendix 2 Partial Differential Equations 589 Remark. Lagrange’s method is valid for a linear or a semilinear p.d.e. also. Example A2.1. Consider the following first-order, quasilinear p.d.e.: w D W .x/; x 2 D R2 I w.@1 w C @2 w/ .w/3 D 0: The characteristic o.d.e.s (A2.13) reduce to dX 1 .t/ dX 2 .t/ dW.t/ D W.t/ D ; D ŒW.t/3 ; dt dt dt dW.t/ dX 1 .t/ ŒW.t/2 0: dt dt Solving the above equations, we obtain d X 1 .t/ X 2 .t/ 0; dt .1/ .xI w/ WD x 1 x 2 D c.1/ ; .2/ .xI w/ WD x 1 C .w/1 D c.2/ ; @ .1/ ; .2/ D 1: @.x 1 ; x 2 / Therefore, by (A2.14), the most general solution of the p.d.e. is implicitly provided by F x 1 x 2 ; x 1 C .w/1 D c D const. (However, there is an additional singular solution, W .x 1 ; x 2 / 0.) In case @F ..1/ ;.2/ / ¤ 0, the above yields, by the implicit function theorem [32], @.2/ x 1 C .w/1 D g.x 1 x 2 I c/; 1 or, w D W .x 1 ; x 2 / D g.x 1 x 2 I c/ x 1 or, w.@1 w C @2 w/ w3 D Œ3 Œ.g 0 C 1/ C g 0 Œ3 0: ; Here, g is an arbitrary differentiable function. The solution above furnishes a general class of infinitely many explicit solutions. (The domain of validity D must avoid the curve given by g.x 1 x 2 I c/ x 1 D 0.) The quasilinear p.d.e. of this example is a disguised linear equation. By the transformation of the variable s WD .w/1 , the p.d.e. is transformed into the linear equation: @1 s C @2 s 1 D 0: 590 Appendix 2 Partial Differential Equations The characteristic o.d.e.s are dX 2 .t/ dS.t/ dX 1 .t/ D D1D : dt dt dt The most general solution is implicitly provided by (A2.15) as F x 1 x 2 ; x 1 s D F x 1 x 2 ; x 1 C .w/1 D c: Here, F is an arbitrary, nonconstant function of class C 1 . Now we consider the nonlinear first-order p.d.e.: G x 1 ; : : : ; x N I wI p.1/ ; : : : ; p.N / D 0; @W .x/ p.i /j:: WD @i w D ; D RN R RN : @x i (A2.16) Here, G is assumed to be a nonconstant differentiable function such that at least one of p.i / occurs as Œp.i / n.i / ; n.i / 2. The associated .2N C 1/ characteristic o.d.e.s are furnished by [43, 94] dX i .t/ @G./ D ˇ ; dt @p.i / ˇ:: @G./ dPi .t/ @G./ ˇ p.i / D ˇ ; dt @x i ˇ:: @w ˇ:: N X @G./ dW.t/ D p.i / ˇ : dt @p.i / ˇ:: i D1 (A2.17) Note that along each of the characteristic curves, dŒG./ @G./ dPi .t/ @G./ dX i .t/ ˇ ˇ D C ˇ i ˇ ˇ dt @x :: dt @p.i / ˇ:: dt :: C @G./ dW.t/ ˇ 0: @w ˇ:: dt (A2.18) Therefore, the solution hypersurface for the p.d.e. (A2.16) is spanned by the congruence of characteristic curves. Example A2.2. Consider the (truly nonlinear) p.d.e.: G x 1 ; x 2 I wI p.1/ ; p.2/ WD p.1/ p.2/ w D 0; @1 w @2 w D w; W .0; x 2 / WD .x 2 /2 : Appendix 2 Partial Differential Equations 591 (This is an initial value problem of a nonlinear p.d.e.) The characteristic o.d.e.s (A2.17) reduce to dX 1 .t/ D P.2/ .t/; dt dX 2 .t/ D P.1/ .t/; dt dP.1/ .t/ D P.1/ .t/; dt dP.2/.t/ D P.2/ .t/; dt dW.t/ D 2P.1/ .t/ P.2/ .t/: dt The general solutions of the system of o.d.e.s are given by P.1/ .t/ D c.1/ et ; P.2/ .t/ D c.2/ et ; X 1 .t/ D c.2/ et C c.3/ ; X 2 .t/ D c.1/ et C c.4/ ; W.t/ D c.1/ c.2/ e2t C c.5/ : Here, c.1/ ; : : : ; c.5/ are arbitrary constants of integration with c.2/ ¤ 0. Inserting 2 initial values X 1 .0/ D 0; W.0/ D W X 1 .0/; X 2 .0/ D X 2 .0/ , etc., we finally obtain 1 X .t/; X 2 .t/ D c.2/ .et 1/; .4/1 c.2/ .et C 1/ ; W X 1 .t/; X 2 .t/ D W.t/ D .c.2/ =2/et 2 D X 1 .t/ C 4X 2 .t/ 4 2 : From equation above, we conclude that x 1 C 4x 2 w D W .x ; x / D 4 1 2 2 is the unique solution of the present p.d.e. under the imposed initial values. Example A2.3. Consider a domain of pseudo-Riemannian space–time and the relativistic Hamilton–Jacobi equation (for m > 0) furnished by G x 1 ; x 2 ; x 3 ; x 4 I sI p1 ; p2 ; p3 ; p4 WD .2m/1 g ij .x/pi pj C m2 D 0; (A2.19i) @S.x/ @S.x/ ij 2 g .x/ Cm D0 (A2.19ii) @x i @x j or g ij .x/ ri S rj S C m2 D 0: (A2.19iii) Compare (A2.19i) with the constraint of the mass shell in (2.33). (Caution: Here the parameter s is not the proper time parameter of (2.146i–iii).) 592 Appendix 2 Partial Differential Equations From (A2.19i), we deduce that @G./ D .m/1 g ij .x/ pj ; @pi @G./ D .2m/1 @i g kj pk pj ; @x i @G./ 0: @s Therefore, the characteristic equations (A2.17) yield dX i .t/ D .m/1 g ij .x/ pj j:: ; dt dPi .t/ D .2m/1 @i g j k pj pk j:: ; dt dS.t/ D m1 g ij .x/ pi pj dt j:: D m: (A2.20) Identifying the parameter t with the proper time parameter, we have just re-derived the relativistic canonical equations (2.146i–iii) for a timelike geodesic in space– time. Example A2.4. Consider the (truly) nonlinear, first-order p.d.e.: G x 1 ; x 2 I wI p.1/ ; p.2/ WD p.1/ p.2/ x 1 D 0; or, @1 w @2 w x 1 D 0; x D .x 1 ; x 2 / 2 D R2 : We shall solve the p.d.e. by a different technique. Note that the nonzero Hessian is furnished by @2 G./ D 1 ¤ 0: det @p.i / @p.j / We make a Legendre transformation (as we have done in (2.138)), by p.i / D @W .x/ ; @x i @ @W .x/ x i p.i / W .x/ D ı ik p.i / 0; k @x @x k p.1/ ; p.2/ WD x i p.i / W .x 1 ; x 2 /; Appendix 2 Partial Differential Equations 593 @./ D xi ; @p.i / W .x 1 ; x 2 / D x i p.i / .p.1/ ; p.2/ /: The p.d.e. under consideration reduces to @./ D p.1/ p.2/ : @p.1/ The most general solution of the above is provided by 2 .p.1/ ; p.2/ / D .1=2/ p.1/ p.2/ C h p.2/ : Here, h.p.2/ / is an arbitrary differentiable function. Thus, the most general solution of the original p.d.e. is implicitly given by x1 D @./ D p.1/ p.2/ ; @p.1/ x2 D 2 @./ D .1=2/ p.1/ C h0 p.2/ ; @p.2/ @./ @./ p.1/ C p.2/ ./ @p.1/ @p.2/ 2 D p.1/ p.2/ h p.2/ C p.2/ h0 p.2/ : W .x 1 ; x 2 / D p Choosing h p.2/ 0, we obtain a particular solution W .x 1 ; x 2 / D x 1 2x 2 for x 2 > 0. Remark. The technique of Legendre transformations is often employed in attempts at the canonical quantization of gravitational fields [10, 221, 246]. We shall now investigate second-order p.d.e.s in R2 . We start with a second-order, semilinear p.d.e. (in a two-dimensional domain) expressed as 2 2 X X ij .x/ @i @j w C h.xI wI @i w/ D 0; i D1 j D1 11 .x/ @1 @1 w C 2 12 .x/ @1 @2 w C 22 .x/ @2 @2 w C h.xI wI @i w/ D 0; 11 .x/ 2 C 12 .x/ x 2 D R2 : 2 C 22 .x/ 2 >0 (A2.21) 594 Appendix 2 Partial Differential Equations The coefficients ij .x/ are of class C 1 . The classification of the p.d.e. (A2.21) is based on the determinant .x/ WD det ij .x/ : (A2.22) The p.d.e. (A2.21) is said to be I. II. III. Hyperbolic p.d.e. in D, provided .x/ < 0 Elliptic p.d.e. in D, provided .x/ > 0 Parabolic p.d.e. in D, provided .x/ D 0 Example A2.5. Consider the Tricomi’s p.d.e. [43]: @1 @1 w C x 1 @2 @2 w D 0: The p.d.e. is elliptic in the half-plane x 1 > 0, and it is hyperbolic in the other half-plane x 1 < 0Š Now, we would like to simplify the p.d.e. (A2.21) for the purpose of solving it. We explore a possible coordinate transformation of class C 2 and (1.107i) to derive the following equations: b i .x/ D X b i .x 1 ; x 2 /; b xi D X b .b w D W .x/ D W x /; b ij .b x/ D 2 X 2 X kD1 lD1 b i .x/ @X b j .x/ @X kl .x/; k @x @x l 2 x2/ @.b x 1 ;b b .b x/ D .x/; @.x 1 ; x 2 / h i b x/ sgn . O D sgn Œ.x/ : (A2.23i) (A2.23ii) (A2.23iii) (A2.23iv) (A2.23v) By (A2.23ii) and (A2.23iv), it is clear that the classification of a p.d.e. remains intact under a coordinate transformation. The p.d.e. (A2.21) goes over into b 11 .b b 12 .b b 22 .b x/b @1b x/b @1b x/b @2b @1 w C 2 @2 w C @2 w C D 0; b 11 .b x/ D 2 X 2 X kD1 lD1 b 1 ./ @X b 1 ./ @X kl .x/; k @x @x l (A2.24i) (A2.24ii) Appendix 2 Partial Differential Equations b 22 .b x/ D 595 2 X 2 X b 2 ./ @X b 2 ./ @X kl .x/; @x k @x l (A2.24iii) 2 X 2 X b 1 ./ @X b 2 ./ @X b 21 .b kl .x/ x /: @x k @x l (A2.24iv) kD1 lD1 b 12 .b x/ D kD1 lD1 The characteristic surface .x/ over D R2 of p.d.e. (A2.21) is defined by the first-order, nonlinear p.d.e. of degree two: 2 2 X X ij .x/ i D1 j D1 @.x/ @.x/ D 0: @x i @x j (A2.25) b 1 .x/ and X b 2 .x/ satisfy the characteristic In case both the coordinate functions X p.d.e. (A2.25), the original p.d.e. (A2.21) reduces to b 12 .b @2 w C D 0; x/ b @1b or, b .b x2 / @2 W x 1 ;b C D 0: @b x 1 @b x2 (A2.26) The normal forms of the various p.d.e.s are listed below: I(i). Hyperbolic p.d.e. : b .b x 1 ;b x2/ b @2 W C h./ D 0: 1 2 @b x @b x I(ii). Hyperbolic p.d.e. : b .b @2 W x2/ x 1 ;b .@b x 1 /2 II. (A2.27i) b .b x2/ @2 W x 1 ;b .@b x 2 /2 Cb h./ D 0: (A2.27ii) Cb h./ D 0: (A2.27iii) Elliptic p.d.e. : b .b @2 W x 1 ;b x2 / .@b x 1 /2 C b .b x 1 ;b x2/ @2 W .@b x 2 /2 596 Appendix 2 Partial Differential Equations III. Parabolic p.d.e. : b .b @2 W x 1 ;b x2 / .@b x 1 /2 Cb h b x 1 ;b x 2 I wI b @1 w; b @2 w D 0: (A2.27iv) Example A2.6. Consider the homogeneous, linear, second-order p.d.e.: @1 @1 w c 2 @2 @2 w C @1 w c 1 @2 w D 0; .x/ D c 2 < 0: (A2.28) The parameter c is assumed to be nonzero, and the p.d.e. (A2.28) is obviously hyperbolic. The characteristic surface of p.d.e. (A2.28) is governed by the nonlinear firstorder p.d.e.: .@1 /2 c 2 .@2 /2 D 0; (A2.29i) h 2 2 i D 0: G x 1 ; x 2 I I p.1/ ; p.2/ WD .1=2/ p.1/ c 2 p.2/ (A2.29ii) The characteristic curves for equations above (which are bicharacteristic curves for the p.d.e. (A2.28)) are furnished by (A2.17) as dX 1 .t/ @G./ D ˇ D p.1/ j:: ; dt @p.1/ ˇ:: dX 2 .t/ D c 2 p.2/ j:: ; dt dP.2/ .t/ dP.1/.t/ D 0: dt dt (A2.30) The general solutions of (A2.30) and (A2.29ii) are given by P.1/ .t/ D c.1/ ; P.2/ .t/ D c.2/ ; 2 2 c.1/ D c 2 c.2/ ; c.1/ D ˙c 1 c.2/ ; X 1 .t/ D c 1 c.2/ t C c.3/ D c X 2 .t/ Cb c .3/ ; c .4/ ; or else, X 1 .t/ D c 1 c.2/ t C c.3/ D c X 2 .t/ Cb thus, .1/ .x/ WD x 1 cx 2 D b c .3/ ; .2/ .x/ WD x 1 C cx 2 D b c .4/ : (A2.31) Making a coordinate transformation b x 1 D .1/ .x/ D x 1 cx 2 ; b .b w D W .x/ D W x/ ; b x 2 D .2/ .x/ D x 1 C cx 2 ; Appendix 2 Partial Differential Equations 597 the p.d.e. (A2.28) reduces to h i b @1 b @2 w C .1=2/w D 0: (A2.32) The above second-order p.d.e. is equivalent to a pair of first-order equations b @2 w C .1=2/w D b g .b x/ ; b @1b g D 0: (A2.33) (Compare the above equations with (A2.6).) The most general solution of (A2.33) x 2 =2 0 2 g .b x /, is provided by and (A2.28), putting b g .b x 2 / D eb 2 1 x 2 =2 x 2 =2/ b .b wDW x / D eb g b x C e.b f b x D e.x 1 Ccx 2 /=2 g x 1 C cx 2 C e.x 1 Ccx 2 /=2 f x 1 cx 2 D W .x/: (A2.34) Here, f and g are of class C 2 and otherwise arbitrary. Consider now a related nonhomogeneous, linear p.d.e.: @1 @1 w c 2 @2 @2 w C @1 w c 1 @2 w D 4: (A2.35) A particular solution of this equation is given by w.p/ D 2 x 1 cx 2 : Therefore, denoting solution (A2.34) of the homogeneous equation by w.h/ , the most general solution of (A2.35) is furnished by the superposition: 1 2 w D w.p/ C w.h/ D 2 x 1 cx 2 C e.x Ccx /=2 g x 1 C cx 2 1 2 Ce.x Ccx /=2 f x 1 cx 2 : Example A2.7. Consider the elliptic Liouville equation [191]: w r 2 w D @1 @1 w C @2 @2 w D 4e2w ; x 2 D R2 : (A2.36) The above is a semilinear, second-order, elliptic p.d.e. in the normal form. The corresponding characteristic surface, as given by (A2.25), reduces to the p.d.e. .@1 /2 C .@2 /2 D 0: (A2.37) 598 Appendix 2 Partial Differential Equations Obviously, only real-valued solutions1 of (A2.37) are provided by constant-valued functions .x/! Therefore, nondegenerate, characteristic curves, analogous to the preceding hyperbolic example, do not exist in an elliptic case. However, there is an interesting device for treating elliptic equations by complex conjugate coordinates (which are formally analogous to the characteristic coordinates of hyperbolic cases). (See [191].) Let us introduce complex conjugate coordinates and complex derivatives by the following equations: WD x 1 C ix 2 ; WD x 1 ix 2 ; x 1 D Re ./ D .1=2/ C ; x 2 D Im ./ D .1=2i / ; b ; WD F x 1 ; x 2 ; F b ; WD .1=2/ @ i @ F x 1 ; x 2 ; bD @ F @ F 1 2 @ @x @x bD @ F b ; WD .1=2/ @ C i @ F x 1 ; x 2 ; @N F 1 2 @x @x @ " 2 2 # b ; @2 F @ @ F x1 ; x2 D 4 F r 2 F D : C @x 1 @x 2 @@ (A2.38) A holomorphic function f ./ and a conjugate holomorphic function g./ satisfy respectively the p.d.e.s: @f ./ @ D .1=2/ @ @ Ci 2 @x 1 @x @ @g./ @ D .1=2/ i 2 1 @ @x @x Re f x 1 C ix 2 C i Im f x 1 C ix 2 D 0; h (A2.39i) i Re g .x 1 C ix 2 / i Im g .x 1 C ix 2 / D 0: (A2.39ii) (The complex equation (A2.39i) is exactly equivalent to the Cauchy-Riemann equations.) 1 A nonlinear (real) differential equation of degree greater than one may or may not admit any solution. The p.d.e. .@1 /2 C .@2 /2 C coshŒ.x/ D 0 does not admit p any real-valued solution 2 2 / C .@ / C coshŒ.x/ 2 D 1 admits a single, function .x/. However, the p.d.e. .@ 1 2 p particular solution .x 1 ; x 2 / D 2. Appendix 2 Partial Differential Equations 599 h.; / satisfying Consider the real-valued harmonic function h x 1 ; x 2 D b h r 2 h D @1 @1 h C @2 @2 h D 0; h D 0: @ @Nb or, (A2.40) It can be proved [191] that the most general solution of (A2.40) is given by h i b h ; D .1=2/ f ./ C f ./ ; h x 1 ; x 2 D Re f x 1 C ix 2 : (A2.41) Here, f ./ is an arbitrary holomorphic function in the domain of consideration. Now let us go back to the Liouville equation (A2.36) again. The most general solution of this equation is provided by [191] jf 0 ./j b ; D log ; w D W x1 ; x2 D W 1 jf ./j2 ˚ D WD 2 C W f 0 ./ ¤ 0; jf ./j < 1 : (A2.42) Here, f 0 ./ ¤ 0, and jf ./j < 1, but the holomorphic function f ./ is otherwise arbitrary. Now, we consider second-order, semilinear p.d.e.s in an N -dimensional domain. Such p.d.e.s need not be tensor field equations. (That is why we suspended the summation convention in preceding discussions!) Let us now revert back to the usual summation convention for tensorial, as well as nontensorial p.d.e.s. Recall that the semilinear, second-order p.d.e. (A2.11), reinstating the summation convention, can be expressed as ij .x/ @i @j w C h .xI wI @i w/ D 0 I x 2 D RN : (A2.43) Here, the coefficients j i .x/ ij .x/ are continuous functions such that at least one of them is nonzero. Therefore, the symmetric matrix ij .x0 / has N real (usual) eigenvalues so that at least one of them is nonzero. The eigenvalues can be always arranged in the order: .1/ .x0 / > 0; : : : ; .p/ .x0 / > 0 I .pCnC1/ .x0 / .pC1/ .x0 / D D < 0; : : : ; .pCnC / .x0 / D 0: .pCn/ .x0 / < 0 I (A2.44) Here, p C n C D N; r WD p C n is the rank of the matrix ij .x0 / , and D N r is the nullity of the matrix. Thus, > 0 if and only if the matrix ij .x0 / 600 Appendix 2 Partial Differential Equations is singular. (Without loss of generality, we can always arrange p n 0. Compare with the metric equation (1.90).) According to Sylvester’s law of inertia [177, 240], the numbers p; n; remain invariant under a (real) coordinate transformation of the type (A2.23iii) in (A2.43). Thus, it is logical to choose the classification of the general semilinear p.d.e. (A2.43) according to the following criteria: I. II. III. IV. Elliptic p.d.e. if Hyperbolic p.d.e. if Ultrahyperbolic p.d.e. if Parabolic p.d.e. if D 0 D n, p > 0 D 0, n D 1, p D N 1 D 0, 1 < n < p < N 1 >0 Note that the .N 1/-dimensional characteristic hypersurface of equation (A2.43) is governed by the first-order, nonlinear p.d.e.: ij .x/ @i @j D 0: (A2.45) Example A2.8. Consider the following semilinear, second-order p.d.e.: @1 @1 w C @2 @2 w @3 @3 w C x 2 D R3 I h i 2w 2 2 2 D 0I .@ w/ C .@ w/ .@ w/ 1 2 3 1 w2 jwj < 1: (A2.46) In this case, N D 3; p D 2; n D 1; D 0; and r D 3. Therefore, the p.d.e. is hyperbolic in the domain of consideration. The corresponding characteristic surface is furnished by .@1 /2 C .@2 /2 .@3 /2 D 0: The bicharacteristic curves are (null ) straight lines in the three-dimensional domain. Now, we make the following transformation: ˇ ˇ 1 ˇˇ 1 C w ˇˇ ; g.w/ WD ln ˇ 2 1wˇ w D tanh.g/; jwj < 1; W x 1 ; x 2 ; x 3 WD tanh g x 1 ; x 2 ; x 3 : The p.d.e. (A2.46) reduces to the linear p.d.e.: @1 @1 g C @2 @2 g @3 @3 g D 0: Thus, the original p.d.e. (A2.46) is a disguised linear p.d.e. (A2.47) Appendix 2 Partial Differential Equations 601 A class of general solutions of (A2.47) and (A2.46) is provided by g x1 ; x2 ; x3 D Z f k1 x 1 C k2 x 2 C q k12 C k22 x 3 dk1 dk2 ; R2 2 Z 1 2 3 W x ; x ; x D tanh 4 f k1 x 1 C k2 x 2 C q 3 k12 C k22 x 3 dk1 dk2 5 : R2 Here, f is a twice-differentiable function such that the integrals converge uniformly. The function f is otherwise arbitrary. (Uniform convergences are needed to commute differentiations and the integration [32].) Let us go back to the semilinear, second-order p.d.e. (A2.43). It is equivalent to the first-order system: @i w D p.i / ; @j p.i / D @i p.j /; ij .x/ @i p.j / C h xI wI p.i / D 0: (A2.48) (Compare (A2.6) and (A2.33).) In general, a system of semilinear second-order p.d.e.s (and possibly another system of first-order p.d.e.s) can be expressed equivalently as a single first order system: i AB .x/ @i wB C hA .xI w/ D 0: (A2.49) Here, the summation convention is also carried on capital Roman indices which take values from f1; 2; : : : ; d g. We construct the characteristic matrix [43] by the following: i .x/ @i : Œ ./ ŒAB .x/ WD AB (A2.50) d d The characteristic hypersurface is furnished by the first-order p.d.e.: i det Œ ./ D det AB .x/ @i D 0: (A2.51) Example A2.9. Consider Maxwell’s equations for electromagnetic fields in flat space–time. (See (2.54i–iv).) With the notation 1 2 3 w ; w ; w WD E 1 ; E 2 ; E 3 ; 4 5 6 w ; w ; w WD H 1 ; H 2 ; H 3 ; 602 Appendix 2 Partial Differential Equations six of the Maxwell’s equations can be expressed as @3 w5 @2 w6 C @4 w1 D 0; @1 w6 @3 w4 C @4 w2 D 0; @2 w4 @1 w5 C @4 w3 D 0; @3 w2 @2 w3 @4 w4 D 0; @1 w3 @3 w1 @4 w5 D 0; @2 w1 @1 w2 @4 w6 D 0: (A2.52) By (A2.50) and (A2.51), we derive 2 @4 0 0 0 @3 @2 6 6 0 @4 0 @3 0 @1 6 6 6 @2 @1 0 0 @4 6 0 Œ D 6 6 6 0 @3 @2 @4 0 0 66 6 6 6 @3 0 @1 0 @4 0 4 @2 @1 0 0 0 @4 3 7 7 7 7 7 7 7; 7 7 7 7 7 5 i2 h det Œ D .@4 /2 .@1 /2 C .@2 /2 C .@3 /2 .@4 /2 : (A2.53i) (A2.53ii) It is clear that for @4 ¤ 0, the system of p.d.e.s in (A2.52) is hyperbolic. (We have obtained classifications of p.d.e.s in general relativity on page 202.) Now, we shall very briefly touch upon the topic of nonunique (or chaotic) solutions. Consider a system of o.d.e.s: dX i .t/ D F i .tI x/jx j DX j .t / ; dt ˚ D WD .tI x/ 2 R RN W jt t.0/ j < A; k x x.0/ k < B ; h i h i j i k x x.0/ k2 WD ıij x i x.0/ x j x.0/ : (A2.54) (Compare the equation above with (1.75).) Suppose that the functions F i ./ are continuous over D WD D [ @D. However, the entries of the Jacobian matrix 2 3 @1 F 1 @2 F 1 @N F 1 6 7 :: :: 7 6 :: 6 : : : 7 4 5 N N N @1 F @2 F @N F are continuous in D, but not continuous on @D. Then, the initial value problem Appendix 2 Partial Differential Equations 603 x (1, 1) D (0, 0) t x=ε <0 Fig. A2.2 Graphs of nonunique solutions i X i t.0/ D x.0/ ; dX i .t/ i ˇ D c.0/ ; dt ˇt Dt0 has nonunique (or chaotic) solutions2 [151]. Example A2.10. Consider the single o.d.e. : p dX .t/ D F .tI x/j:: WD X .t/ ; dt D D f.t; x/ 2 R R W 0 < t < 1; 0 < x < 1g : p The function F .tI x/ D x is continuous over D. However, @F@x./ D continuous on @D. Therefore, the solution for the specific I.V.P. X .0/ D 0; 1 p 2 x is not dX .t/ ˇ D0 dt ˇt D0 has (infinitely) many answers! We furnish these solutions explicitly in the following: ( X .t/ WD 0 for t k < 1 I .1=4/.t k/2 for 0 < k < t: The functions X .t/ are shown graphically in the Fig. A2.2. i Moreover, h i i bifurcation points will satisfy simultaneous equations: F .t I x/ @F ./ det @xj D 0. (See [138].) 2 D 0, and Appendix 3 Canonical Forms of Matrices We shall start this appendix with some very simple models. Consider 2 2 matrices with real entries (or elements). (See [5].) 31 Example A3.1. Consider the symmetric matrix ŒS WD . The characteristic 13 polynomial is given by p. / WD det ŒS I D 2 6 C 8. Therefore, the usual eigenvalues are .1/ D 4 and .2/ D 2. The corresponding eigenvectors are " Ee.1/ D p # 1= 2 p ; 1= 2 " Ee.2/ D p # 1= 2 p : 1= 2 These column vectors are orthonormal in the usual Euclidean sense. We construct a matrix ŒP (with help of eigenvectors) as " ŒP WD p # p 1= 2 1= 2 p p : 1= 2 1= 2 By the similarity transformation " ŒP 1 ŒS ŒP D 40 02 # ; p 2 p0 Example A3.2. Consider the symmetric matrix ŒS WD . The usual 2 0 p eigenvalue .1/ D 2 has the multiplicity 2. Moreover, every nonzero 2 1 column vector is an eigenvector. and the symmetric matrix is diagonalized. A. Das and A. DeBenedictis, The General Theory of Relativity: A Mathematical Exposition, DOI 10.1007/978-1-4614-3658-4, © Springer Science+Business Media New York 2012 605 606 Appendix 3 Canonical Forms of Matrices 3 2 Example A3.3. Consider the matrix ŒM WD . The (usual) characteristic 2 1 polynomial is furnished by p. / D . C 1/2 . The eigenvalue .1/ D 1 is of t multiplicity 2. The eigenvectors are of the form ; t ¤ 0. Therefore, there t is only one eigendirection and the matrix is nondiagonalizable. (This matrix has a nonlinear or nonsimple elementary divisor E.2/ . / D . C1/2 according to (A3.3).) However, consider the matrix " # 1 1=2 ŒP WD : 1 1 By the similarity transformation " ŒP 1 ŒM ŒP D 1 1 0 1 # " D 1 0 0 1 # " C 01 00 # : Thus, the matrix ŒM is reducible to an upper triangular form. Moreover, the triangular form is a diagonal matrix plus a nilpotent matrix. 0 1 Example A3.4. Consider the antisymmetric matrix ŒA WD . The character1 0 istic polynomial p. / D 2 C1. Thus, there exist no real eigenvalues. Consequently, there are no (real) eigenvectors. However, extending into the (algebraically closed) complex field, we have two complex-conjugate eigenvalues .1/ D i; .2/ D i D 11 . The similarity transformation .1/ . Consider the complex matrix ŒP WD i i i 0 ŒP 1 ŒA ŒP reduces ŒA into the complex diagonal matrix . 0 i Example A3.5. Consider the 2 2 matrix generated by the Lorentz metric (in 1 0 Example 1.3.2) ŒD WD d.i /.j / D . The Lorentz-invariant characteristic 0 1 polynomial of a matrix ŒM is defined by p # . / WD detŒM D. The invariant eigenvalues are furnished by the roots of p # . / D 0. (Compare with (1.213).) A 2a a C b symmetric matrix can be expressed as ŒS D . The corresponding a C b 2b invariant eigenvalues are given by p # . / D Œ .a b/2 D 0. There exists one (real) invariant eigenvalue .1/ D .a b/ of multiplicity 2. There exists one t eigendirection .t ¤ 0/. The Lorentz-invariant separations (of (1.86)) are t 1 0 t provided by Œt; t 0. Thus, the eigendirection is along a double 0 1 t Appendix 3 Canonical Forms of Matrices 607 null vector. Moreover, this matrix is associated with nonsimple elementary divisor E.2/ . / D . a C b/2 according to (A3.3). 01 Example A3.6. Consider the symmetric matrix ŒS WD . (This happens to be 10 one of the Pauli matrices.) The usual eigenvalues are given by .1/ D 1; .2/ D 1. The Lorentz-invariant eigenvalues are furnished by p # . / D . 2 C 1/ D 0. Therefore, we have complex-conjugate invariant eigenvalues .1/ D i; .2/ D i D .1/ . Therefore, a symmetric matrix, with real entries, can have complex, Lorentzinvariant eigenvalues! Now we shall investigate the canonical classification of an N N matrix ŒM with real entries M.a/.b/ . The (usual) characteristic polynomial is furnished by p. / WD det M.a/.b/ ı.a/.b/ D . /N C c.1/ or, N 1 C C c.N / D 0; i h .a/ det ı .a/.c/ M.c/.b/ ı .b/ D p. / D 0: The equation above admits 2s 0 complex roots and N 2s 0 real roots [21]. Now consider the same real N N matrix ŒM , together with an N N metric matrix ŒD of (1.90) (which is not positive definite). The corresponding invariant, characteristic polynomial equation is provided by # p # . / WD det M.a/.b/ d.a/.b/ D . /N C c.1/ or, N 1 # C C c.N / D 0; i h .a/ det d .a/.c/ M.c/.b/ ı .b/ D 0: Suppose that the above equation admits 2s # > 0 complex roots and N 2s # > 0 real roots. These invariant roots must differ from the roots of the usual characteristic equation p. / D 0. (Compare with Example A3.6.) However, the subsequent general theorems involving any real N N matrix ŒM D ŒM ij apply to both distinct cases p. / D 0 and p # . / D 0. In the case where there exist only real roots of detŒM ij ı ij D 0 as eigenvalues, the Jordan decomposition theorem is stated as follows: Theorem A3.7. Let ŒM D ŒM ij be an N N matrix with real entries and real eigenvalues as roots of detŒM ij ı ij D 0. Then the matrix can be transformed by a similarity transformation into the following block diagonal form: 608 Appendix 3 Canonical Forms of Matrices 3 2 ŒM .J / 0 6 A.1/ 6 6 A.2/ 6 :: 6 :: D6 :: 6 :: 6 6 : :: 6 : 4 0 A.k/ 7 7 7 7 7 7: 7 7 7 7 5 (A3.1) Here, A.l/ , for l 2 f1; : : : ; kg, is an n.l/ n.l/ matrix given by 3 2 A.l/ 6 6 6 6 6 6 WD 6 6 6 6 6 6 4 .1/ J.l/ 0 .2/ J.l/ :: :: :: : :: : 0 .q / J.l/l 2 6 6 6 h i 6 .i / J.l/ WD 6 6 .i / .i / 6 n.l/ n.l/ 4 1 0 0 ql X .i / n.l/ (A3.2i) 3 7 1 0 7 7 :: 7 ::: : : ; : :: : : : 7 7 :: 1 7 :: : 5 0 0 .l/ .l/ 0 :: :: :: .l/ 0 i 2 f1; : : : ; ql g ; :: 7 7 7 7 7 7 7; 7 7 7 7 7 5 k X DW n.l/ ; i D1 (A3.2ii) n.l/ D N: lD1 Proof of the above theorem is available in [133, 177]. .1/ .2/ .q / (i) It is usually assumed that n.l/ n.l/ n.l/l 1. i h .i / .i / (ii) In the case n.l/ D 1, the corresponding 1 1 matrix J.l/ has the single entry .l/ . It stands for a diagonal i element. h Remarks. .i / (iii) Some authors write J.l/ as a lower triangular form. (iv) In relativity theory, after solving p # . / D 0, many authors use the inequalities in the reversed order as .q / .2/ .1/ n.l/l n.l/ n.l/ 1: Appendix 3 Canonical Forms of Matrices 609 (v) The Segre characteristic of the matrix ŒM .J / is denoted ([90, 210]) by the .1/ .2/ .1/ .2/ symbol Œ.n.1/ ; n.1/ ; : : :/; .n.2/ ; n.2/ ; : : :/; : : :. The matrices ŒM .J / in (A3.1) and (A3.2i,ii) define a hierarchy of elementary divisors [113]. It is provided by the following string of equations: E.N / . / WD E.N 1/ . / WD .1/ n.1/ .1/ .1/ .2/ n.2/ .1/ n.1/ .2/ .2/ n.2/ .2/ ; ; :::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::: : (A3.3) Example A3.8. We shall discuss an example from the general theory of relativity. Consider the orthonormal components t.a/.b/ WD T.a/.b/ .x0 / D t.b/.a/ of the energy– momentum–stress tensor in (2.45) and (2.161ii) (at a particular event x0 2 D R4 ). The usual eigenvalues of the symmetric matrix t.a/.b/ are all real, and the matrix is always diagonalizable. However, the Lorentz invariant eigenvalues of t.a/.b/ are, physically speaking, much more relevant. Since detŒt.a/.b/ d.a/.b/ D 0 , .a/ detŒd .a/.c/ t.c/.b/ ı .b/ D 0, these invariant eigenvalues are identical with the usual eigenvalues of the 4 4 matrix Œ WD d .a/.c/ t.c/.b/ which need not be symmetric. (See Examples A3.5 and A3.6.) Assuming that the invariant eigenvalues are all real, we classify the allowable types of canonical forms of Œ in the following: I: 2 Type-I.a/ : .1/ Œ.J / 6 6 0 6 D6 6 0 4 0 Here, if .1/ ; .2/ ; .3/ ; specified by Œ1; 1; 1; 1. .4/ Type-I.b/: If .1/ D .2/ and specified by Œ.1; 1/; 1; 1. 0 0 .2/ 0 0 0 .3/ 0 0 0 3 7 7 7 7: 7 5 (A3.4) .4/ are all distinct. The Segre characteristic in (A3.4) is .1/ ; .3/ ; .4/ Type-I.c/: If .1/ D .2/ ; .3/ D provided by Œ.1; 1/; .1; 1/. Type-I.d /: If .1/ D .2/ D furnished by Œ.1; 1; 1/; 1. 0 .3/ .4/ and and .1/ are distinct. The Segre characteristic is .1/ ¤ ¤ .3/ . .4/ . The Segre characteristic is The Segre characteristic is 610 Appendix 3 Canonical Forms of Matrices Type-I.e/: If Œ.1; 1; 1; 1/. II: .1/ D .2/ D .3/ D .4/ . The Segre characteristic is specified by 2 Type-II.a/: .1/ Œ.J / 6 6 0 6 D6 6 0 4 0 If .1/ ; .2/ , and .3/ Type-II.d /: If III: .1/ .1/ D .2/ ¤ .2/ and .1/ and .2/ D .3/ . ¤ .2/ .2/ 0 0 .3/ 0 0 3 0 7 0 7 7 7: 1 7 5 (A3.5) .3/ .3/ D .3/ . 2 .1/ Œ.J / 6 6 0 6 D6 6 0 4 0 Here, we assume .1/ Type-III.b/: If D ¤ .2/ .2/ . 1 0 .1/ 0 0 .2/ 0 0 0 3 7 0 7 7 7: 1 7 5 (A3.6) .2/ in (A3.6). The Segre characteristic is provided by Œ.2; 2/. 2 .1/ Œ.J / 6 6 0 6 D6 6 0 4 0 .1/ The Segre characteristic is furnished The Segre characteristic is Œ2; 2. IV: Type-IV.a/: Here, we assume that in (A3.5). The Segre characteristic is The Segre characteristic is specified by Œ.1; 1; 2/. Type-III.a/: .1/ 0 are all distinct. The Segre characteristic is given by Œ1; 1; 2. Type-II.b/: If .1/ D provided by Œ.1; 1/; 2. Type-II.c/: Here, by Œ1; .1; 2/. 0 ¤ .2/ . 0 0 .2/ 1 0 .2/ 0 0 0 3 7 0 7 7 7: 1 7 5 .2/ The Segre characteristic is Œ1; 3. (A3.7) Appendix 3 Canonical Forms of Matrices Type-IV.b/: Here, we assume that istic is Œ.1; 3/. 611 .1/ D .2/ . The corresponding Segre character- 2 V: .1/ Œ.J / 6 6 0 6 D6 6 0 4 0 1 0 0 .1/ 1 0 .1/ 0 0 3 7 0 7 7 7: 1 7 5 (A3.8) .1/ The Segre characteristic is furnished by Œ4. The corresponding eigenvectors are quadrupole null vectors along a single null eigendirection. Since the signature of the Lorentz metric Œd.a/.b/ is C2 and t.b/.a/ D t.a/.b/ , the 14 cases in the equations above in this example contain all possible Segre characteristics of the energy–momentum–stress tensor (with real Lorentz-invariant eigenvalues). (See [90, 210].) Furthermore, it can be noted that an eigenvector associated with a nonsimple, elementary divisor is null. Now we shall deal with a real N N matrix ŒM D ŒM ij which possesses only 2s D N complex conjugate roots of the characteristic equation. (Thus, in this case, there are no real roots.) The following theorem elaborates the canonical form of such a matrix: Theorem A3.9. Let ŒM be a real N N matrix such that the (usual ) characteristic equation admits 2s D N complex conjugate roots .l/ D a.l/ C i b.l/ , .l/ D a.l/ i b.l/ ; l 2 f1; : : : ; sg. Then, the Jordan canonical form of the matrix is furnished by: 3 2 ŒM .J / 6 B.1/ 6 6 B.2/ 6 :: 6 :: D6 :: 6 :: 6 :: 6 :: 6 4 B.r/ 7 7 7 7 7 7; 7 7 7 7 5 2 B.l/ 2n.l / 2n.l / 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 WD 6 6 6 6 6 6 4 3 .1/ C.l/ .2/ C.l/ :: :: :: :: :: :: .s / C.l/l 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 7; 7 7 7 7 7 5 612 Appendix 3 Canonical Forms of Matrices 3 2 7 6 a.l/ b.l/ 1 0 7 6b.l/ a.l/ 0 1 7 6 7 6 7 6 a.l/ b.l/ 1 0 7 6 h i b.l/ a.l/ 0 1 7 6 .i / 7 6 C.l/ :: :: 7 6 : : WD 7; 6 : : :: :: 7 6 .i / .i / : 2n.l / 2n.l / 7 6 :: 1 0 7 6 :: 7 6 : 0 1 7 6 7 6 6 a.l/ b.l/ 7 5 4 b.l/ a.l/ i 2 f1; : : : ; sl g ; sl X .i / n.l/ DW n.l/ ; i D1 r X n.l/ D s D .N=2/: (A3.9) lD1 The proof of this theorem can be found in [133, 177]. The Segre characteristic of the matrix ŒM .J / , in (A3.9) is given by .1/ .2/ n.1/ ; n.1/ ; : : : .1/ .2/ .1/ .2/ .1/ .2/ ; n.1/ ; n.1/ ; : : : I n.2/ ; n.2/ ; : : : ; n.2/ ; n.2/ ; : : : I : : : : Finally, we consider an N N real matrix ŒM which admits both real and complex conjugate (usual) eigenvalues. The canonical or block diagonal form is provided by 2 ŒM .J / j j 6 A.1/ 6 j 6 j A.2/ 6 j 6 :: 6 j : 6 j 6 6 A.k/ j 6 j D 6 j 6 B.1/ 6 j 6 j 6 B.2/ 6 j 6 j :: 6 : j 6 4 j B.r/ j 3 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 7: 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 5 (A3.10) Here, matrices A.l/ and B.l/ are furnished by (A3.2i) and (A3.9), respectively. Appendix 3 Canonical Forms of Matrices 613 Example A3.10. Consider the 4 4 matrix 2 1=2 1=2 0 0 3 6 7 6 1=2 3=2 0 0 7 6 7: ŒM WD 6 0 0 2 1 7 4 5 0 0 1 2 The usual characteristic polynomial equation is furnished by p. / D . C 1/2 . 2 4 C 5/ D . C 1/2 . 2 i / . 2 C i / D 0: Thus, the distinct eigenvalues are .1/ D 1; a.1/ C i b.1/ D 2 C i; a.1/ i b.1/ D 2 i with multiplicities 2, 1, and 1, respectively. Therefore, the Jordan canonical form is given by the block diagonal form " ŒM .J / D # A.1/ B.1/ 2 1 1 6 0 1 DW 6 4 3 7 7: 2 15 1 2 The Segre characteristic is 2I 1; 1 . The elementary divisor for this matrix is E.4/ . / D . C 1/2 . 2 i / . 2 C i /. Example A3.11. Consider a domain of the space–time manifold and orthonormal components of the energy–momentum–stress tensor field provided by [126]: 2 6 6 T.a/.b/ .x/ WD 6 6 4 .1/ .x/ 0 0 0 .2/ .x/ 0 0 0 0 3 7 07 7; ˙.x/ 1 7 5 1 0 0 2 .1/ t.a/.b/ 0 6 6 0 WD T.a/.b/ .x0 / D 6 6 0 4 0 0 00 (A3.11i) 3 7 0 07 7; 0 17 5 0 10 .2/ (A3.11ii) 614 Appendix 3 Canonical Forms of Matrices 2 .1/ 6 6 0 Œ WD d .a/.c/ t.c/.b/ D 6 6 0 4 0 0 0 0 3 7 0 07 7 ¤ ŒT : 0 17 5 0 1 0 .2/ (A3.11iii) Four eigenvalues (invariant values for the matrix in (A3.11ii) orhusual values of i p the matrix in (A3.11iii)) are furnished by .1/ ; .2/ ; .3/ D .1=2/ C 2 4 , h i p and .4/ D .1=2/ 2 4 . Here, .1/ and .2/ are real and .3/ ; .4/ are real provided jj 2. However, the eigenvectors in this case can be spacelike! Therefore, for the case .1/ ¤ .2/ and jj > 2, we have the Segre characteristic Œ1; 1; 1; 1. In the case .1/ ¤ .2/ and jj D 2, the Segre characteristic is Œ1; 1; .1; 1/. But for .1/ ¤ .2/ and jj < 2, the Segre characteristic is 1; 1I 1; 1 . Moreover, there are corresponding Segre characteristics for the coincidence .1/ D .2/ . This example illustrates that the energy–momentum–stress tensor of an exotic material can change Segre characteristics from domain to domain! Example A3.12. In Example A3.8, we considered invariant eigenvalues of the symmetric energy–momentum–stress matrix Œt.a/.b/ WD ŒT.a/.b/ .x0 /. In that example, we restricted the classification only to the various cases of real, invariant eigenvalues. In this example, we extend the mathematical investigation to cases of complex, invariant eigenvalues of Œt.a/.b/ . (Recall that these eigenvalues are .a/ identical to the usual eigenvalues of the nonsymmetric matrix Œ D Œ .b/ WD Œd .a/.c/ t.c/.b/ .) The Jordan canonical forms of various types follow from (A3.9). The type VI is furnished below: 3 2 VI: Type-VI.a/: 0 0 .1/ 0 7 6 6 0 .2/ 0 0 7 7 6 Œ.J / D 6 (A3.12) 7: 6 0 0 a.1/ b.1/ 7 5 4 0 0 b.1/ a.1/ Here, we assume that real eigenvalues .1/ ¤ .2/ and the real number b.1/ ¤ 0. The corresponding Segre characteristic is provided by Œ1; 1I 1; 1. Type-VI.b/: If .1/ D .2/ and b.1/ ¤ 0, the Segre characteristic is given by Œ.1; 1/I 1; 1. 3 2 VII: Type-VII.a/: 0 0 .1/ 1 7 6 6 0 .1/ 0 0 7 7 6 Œ.J / D 6 (A3.13) 7: 6 0 0 a.1/ b.1/ 7 5 4 0 0 b.1/ a.1/ Appendix 3 Canonical Forms of Matrices 615 Here, we take the real number b.1/ ¤ 0. The Segre characteristic is furnished by Œ2I 1; 1. VIII: 2 Type-VIII.a/: Œ.J / a.1/ b.1/ 0 0 3 7 6 6 b.1/ a.1/ 0 0 7 7 6 D6 7: 6 0 0 a.2/ b.2/ 7 5 4 0 (A3.14) 0 b.2/ a.2/ Here, we have taken b.1/ ¤ 0, b.2/ ¤ b.1/ , and b.2/ ¤ 0. The Segre characteristic is Œ1; 1I 1; 1. Type-VIII.b/: Here, we assume that real numbers a.2/ D a.1/ and b.2/ D b.1/ ¤ 0. The corresponding Segre characteristic is Œ.1; 1I 1; 1/. Every type of Œ.J / exhibited in the previous example (involving energy– momentum–stress tensor components T.a/.b/.x0 /) violates energy conditions in (2.190)–(2.192). Therefore, in the usual conditions of the macroscopic universe, these types of energy–momentum–stress tensor components are usually deemed unphysical. However, in the quantum realm, it may be possible to violate energy conditions. An example of this is an effect known as the Casimir effect where quantum fields subject to certain boundary conditions may violate energy conditions (see, e.g., [236, 254] and references therein). Exotic solutions in general relativity usually possess energy condition violation, as may be seen in Appendix 6 and Sect. 5.3, as well as [68] where energy condition violation is shown to result inside a black hole in a certain class of gravitational collapse models. Appendix 4 Conformally Flat Space–Times and “the Fifth Force” Let us recall the criterion for conformal flatness of a Riemannian (or a pseudoRiemannian) manifold discussed in Theorem 1.3.33. We reiterate the same theorem with different notations in the following theorem. Theorem A4.1. Let D RN (with N > 3) be a domain corresponding to an open subset of an N -dimensional Riemannian (or a pseudo-Riemannian) manifold of differentiability class C 3 . Then, the domain D RN is conformally flat if and only if the tensor field C ij kl .x/ @x@ i ˝ dx j ˝ dx k ˝ dx l D O::: .x/ in D. Proof of the above theorem is provided in [56, 90, 171]. Consider a conformally flat domain of a pseudo-Riemannian (or a Riemannian) manifold MN . It is endowed with a coordinate chart such that gij .x/ D exp Œ2 .x/ dij : (A4.1) We consider another chart, intersecting the preceding one, such that x / D exp Œ2b .b x / dij : b g ij .b (A4.2) Let us consider the following set of coordinate transformations furnished by b xi D xi ; ¤ 0; b x i D xi C ci ; b x i D l ij x i ; (A4.3i) (A4.3ii) dij l ik l jm D dj m ; b x i D x i = dj k x j x k ; A. Das and A. DeBenedictis, The General Theory of Relativity: A Mathematical Exposition, DOI 10.1007/978-1-4614-3658-4, © Springer Science+Business Media New York 2012 (A4.3iii) (A4.3iv) 617 618 Appendix 4 Conformally Flat Space–Times and “the Fifth Force” b x i D x i b i xl x l 1 2.bj x j / C .bk b k / .xm x m / 1 : (A4.3v) Here, , c i , l ij , and b i are constant-valued parameters. Moreover, xi WD dij x j , and xi x i is assumed to be nonzero. The set of coordinate transformations presented above constitutes a group. It is called the conformal group C .p; nI R/ (with p C n D N ). This group involves .1=2/ .N C 1/ .N C 2/ independent parameters. The following theorem provides the importance of this group in regard to conformally flat manifolds. Theorem A4.2. A conformally flat metric g:: .x/ D expŒ2 .x/ d:: goes over into another conformally flat metric b g:: .b x / D exp Œ2b .b x / d:: for N 3 if and only if the coordinate transformation belongs to the conformal group C .p; nI R/. Partial proof of the above theorem is provided in [56]. We shall now state Willmore’s theorem [266] for a conformally flat domain of a pseudo-Riemannian (or a Riemannian) manifold. Theorem A4.3. Let a domain D RN with N > 3, corresponding to a domain of a pseudo-Riemannian (or a Riemannian) manifold of differentiability class C 3 , admit a tensor field S:: .x/ of differentiability class C 2 . Moreover, let the following tensor field equations hold: Rhij k .x/ D ghk .x/ Sij .x/ C gij .x/ Shk .x/ ghj .x/ Si k .x/ gi k .x/ Shj .x/: (A4.4) (i) The conformal tensor C::: .x/ D O::: .x/ in D. (ii) Moreover, Sj i .x/ Sij .x/ in D. Proof of the above theorem is skipped here. However, the next theorem due to Das [51] incorporates the proof of the preceding theorem. Theorem A4.4. Let the curvature tensor R::: .x/ of a pseudo-Riemannian (or a Riemannian) manifold of differentiability class C 3 and dimension N > 3 admit a twice-differentiable tensor field T:: .x/ in the domain of consideration. Moreover, let the following tensor field equations hold: Rlijk .x/ D .N 2/1 n glj .x/ Ti k .x/ C gi k .x/ Tlj .x/ glk .x/ Tij .x/ gij .x/ Tlk .x/ C 2.N 1/1 T .x/ glk .x/ gij .x/ glj .x/ gi k .x/ T .x/ WD g ij .x/ Tij .x/: o ; (A4.5) Appendix 4 Conformally Flat Space–Times and “the Fifth Force” 619 (Here, is an arbitrary non-zero constant ). Then, .i/ Gij .x/ D Tij .x/; (A4.6i) .ii/ Tj i .x/ Tij .x/ I (A4.6ii) ri T ij D 0; .iii/ rk Tij rj Ti k C .N 1/1 gi k .x/rj T gij .x/rk T D 0; (A4.6iii) .iv/ C lij k .x/ 0; (A4.6iv) .v/ Moreover, Rij k .x/ WD .N 2/1 .N 3/ rl C lij k D 0: Proof. (A4.6v) (i) By the single contraction in (A4.5), it follows that Rij .x/ D .N 2/1 T .x/ gij .x/ Tij .x/ ; R.x/ D 2 .N 2/1 T .x/; Gij .x/ D Tij .x/: (A4.7i) (A4.7ii) (A4.7iii) (ii) By the algebraic symmetry of Einstein’s tensor and the differential identities ri G ij 0, (A4.6ii) follow. (iii) By the first contracted Bianchi’s identities (1.150i), (A4.6ii), and (A4.5), the proof of (A4.6iii) follows. (iv) Substituting Rlij k .x/ from (A4.5), using (A4.7i,ii), (1.169i) yields (A4.6iv). (v) The covariant differentiation of C lij k .x/ in (1.169i), together with (A4.6iv), implies (A4.6v). In case we would like to apply the preceding theorem to general relativity, we must choose p D 3; n D 1, and N D 4 for the pseudo-Riemannian space–time manifold. The theorem, that is suited to general relativity is stated and proved in the following: Theorem A4.5. Let the curvature tensor R::: .x/ of the pseudo-Riemannian space– time manifold of differentiability class C 3 admit a twice differentiable tensor field T:: .x/ in the domain D R4 of consideration. Moreover, let the following tensor field equation hold: 620 Appendix 4 Conformally Flat Space–Times and “the Fifth Force” n Rlij k .x/ D .=2/ glj .x/ Ti k .x/ C gi k .x/ Tlj .x/ glk .x/ Tij .x/ gij .x/ Tlk .x/ C .2=3/ T .x/ glk .x/ gij .x/ glj .x/ gi k .x/ o : (A4.8) e.0/ WD Then, the following implications for gij D 2 dij , WD d ij @i @j , and T eij hold true: d ij T .i/ @i @j dij 2 1 @i @j .1=4/ dij d kl @k @l D .=2/ Tij .x/ .x/: (A4.9) .ii/ R.x/ D 6 3 : (A4.10) .iii/ Rij .x/ D 2 1 @i @j C dij 1 4 2 @i @j (A4.11) C 2 dij d kl @k @l D e T ij DW Tij .1=2/ dij d kl Tkl : .iv/ C .=6/ e T .0/ .x/ .x/ D 0: (A4.12) .v/ Field equations (A4.11) are covariant under the conformal group C .3; 1I R/ involving 15 independent parameters. Proof. (i) The proof follows by noting that gij .x/ D Œ.x/2 dij and inserting this metric into the usual expression for Rij .x/. Then, using (A4.7iii) and (1.149ii), the following equations emerge: Gij .x/ D 2 1 @i @j 4 2 @i @j dij 2 1 2 d kl @k @l D Tij .x/: (A4.13) Next, from Einstein’s field equations (A4.7iii), (A4.9) is derived. (ii) Double contraction of (A4.13) leads the (A4.10). (iii) By the equality Rij .x/ D Gij .x/ C .1=2/ gij .x/ R.x/, and (A4.9), (A4.10) and definitions eij .x/ WD Tij .x/ .1=2/gij .x/ T kk .x/; T (A4.14i) e.0/ .x/ WD d ij T eij .x/ D T.0/ .x/ DW d ij Tij .x/; T (A4.14ii) (A4.11) is deduced. (iv) Double contractions of equations (A4.11) (with d ij ) lead to (A4.12). (v) This statement can be proved by using Theorem A4.2. Appendix 4 Conformally Flat Space–Times and “the Fifth Force” 621 Remarks. (i) It is clear from (A4.5) and (A4.8) that Tij .x/ 0 implies that Rlij k .x/ 0. In other words, mathematically, the support of R:::: .x/ the support of T:: .x/ in conformally flat space–times. Therefore, the class of gravitational phenomena governed by field equation (A4.8) or (A4.9) is nontrivial only in the presence of material sources. Outside material sources, this class of gravitational forces just “switches off”! That is why we interpret gravitational force, arising from field equation (A4.9) as the “fifth force”.1 (See [101, 216].) This effect can equivalently be seen utilizing (1.169i) and field equation (2.163i). The trace of the latter implies that R.x/ D 0 and Rij .x/ D 0 when Tij .x/ D 0 holds. Then, condition (A4.6iv) for conformally flat space– times for N > 3, when used in (1.169i), implies that Rij kl .x/ D 0 whenever Tij .x/ D 0. (ii) Field equation (A4.9), governing the “fifth force”, does not admit general covariance. However, this equation does admit covariance under the 15parameter conformal group C .3; 1I R/. (iii) The system of field equations (A4.9) is highly overdetermined. (See [52].) In spite of the fact that the system of field equations is overdetermined, many exact solutions of the system do exist. In fact, many of these exact solutions turn out to be extremely important for understanding of the cosmological universe. We shall furnish some of these exact solutions in the following examples. Example A4.6. In this example, the following choice is made: Tij .x/ WD .3K0 =/ gij .x/; T .x/ D 12 1 K0 : (A4.15) (Here, K0 is a constant.) Substituting (A4.15) into (A4.8), we obtain Rhijk .x/ D K0 ghj .x/ gki .x/ ghk .x/ gj i .x/ : (A4.16) Therefore, by (1.164i), the metric is that of a space–time of constant curvature. Such a space–time is also called the de Sitter universe (for K0 > 0) and anti-de Sitter universe (for K0 < 0). (See #1 of Exercise 6.1. Also see [126].) By Theorem 1.3.30, we can transform this metric locally to the conformally flat form: 2 ds 2 D 1 C .K0 =4/ dkl x k x l dij dx i dx j : (A4.17) By the equation gij .x/ D Œ.x/2 dij , we obtain in this example .x/ D 1 C .K0 =4/ dij x i x j Thus, an explicit expression for .x/ is furnished. 1 : (A4.18) 1 It should be stressed here that this is nomenclature only. This phenomenon is still a special class of gravitational effect, and not due to some new force. 622 Appendix 4 Conformally Flat Space–Times and “the Fifth Force” The next example deals with F–L–R–W cosmological metrics of (6.7i) and (6.41). These are extremely important metrics in regard to the proper understanding of the cosmological universe. Example A4.7. In this example, we choose the energy–momentum–stress tensor for a perfect fluid from Theorem 6.1.3 and (6.46). It is provided by Tij .x/ D .x/ C p.x/ Ui .x/ Uj .x/ C p.x/ gij .x/; (A4.19i) U i .x/ Ui .x/ 1: (A4.19ii) Recall the F–L–R–W metric from (6.41) as ds 2 D a.x 4 / 2 1 C .k0 =4/ ı˛ˇ x ˛ x ˇ 2 ı 2 dx dx dx 4 ; ˚ D WD x W x 2 D R3 I x 4 > 0 ; k0 2 f0; 1; 1g : (A4.20) The corresponding fluid velocity components, in the comoving frame (derivable from field equations E ˛4 ./ D 0) are given by U ˛ .x/ 0; U 4 .x/ 1: (A4.21) Einstein’s field equations from (6.47i–iii) are furnished by " E 11 ./ E 22 ./ E 33 ./ " .a/ P 2 C k0 E 44 ./ D 3 a2 aP T ./ D P C 3 a 4 aP WD da.x 4 / ; dx 4 D .a/ P 2 C k0 2aR C a a2 # C p.x 4 / D 0; (A4.22i) # .x 4 / D 0; (A4.22ii) . C p/ D 0; (A4.22iii) etc. (A4.22iv) In the case of k0 D 0, the metric from (A4.20) goes over into ds 2 D Œa.x 4 /2 ı˛ˇ dx ˛ dx ˇ .dx 4 /2 : (A4.23) Appendix 4 Conformally Flat Space–Times and “the Fifth Force” 623 (Consult Example 7.2.2.) Now we make a transformation, b x˛ D x˛ ; Z dx 4 4 ; b x D a.x 4 / b a .b x 4 / WD a.x 4 / > 0: (A4.24) The metric in (A4.23) yields the conformally flat form: ds 2 D Œb a .b x 4 /2 ı˛ˇ db x ˛ db x ˇ .db x 4 /2 ; DW Œb .b x /2 dij db x i db xj : (A4.25) Therefore, the corresponding b .b x / field is explicitly furnished by b .b x/ D b a.b x 4 /: (A4.26) For the case of k0 D 1, (6.7i), (A4.20), and the answer to # 2i of Exercise 6.1 yield i o n h 2 x 4 /2 : (A4.27) a.b x 4 / .db/2 C sin2 b .db /2 C sin2 .db /2 .db ds 2 D b Now we make another coordinate transformation by r# D 2 sin b ; cosb C cosb x4 2 sin b x4 ; cosb C cosb x4 # # ; D b ; b ; b x4 D cosb C cosb x 4 ¤ 0I a .b x 4 / > 0: a# .x #4 / WD b (A4.28) The corresponding conformally flat metric from (A4.27) emerges as ds 2 D 1 2 2 a# .x #4 / cos # C cos x #4 4 ˚ .d# /2 C .r # /2 .d # /2 C sin2 # .d # /2 .dx #4 /2 ˚ DW Œ # .x # /2 .dr # /2 C .r # /2 .d # /2 C sin2 # .d # /2 .dx #4 /2 : (A4.29) 624 Appendix 4 Conformally Flat Space–Times and “the Fifth Force” Therefore, the corresponding field # .x # / is analytically furnished by # .x # / D 1 a# .x #4 / cos 2 # C cos x #4 : (A4.30) Thus, in an important model of cosmology, an analytic expression for the # .x # / field is explicitly provided. Appendix 5 Linearized Theory and Gravitational Waves In this appendix we briefly review the linearized theory of gravitation and discuss a class of solutions known as gravitational waves. There are currently several major experiments in progress which hope to detect gravitational waves in the near future. If they are successful, a new arena, known as gravitational wave astronomy, will potentially yield insight into many interesting astrophysical phenomena. The subject of gravitational waves and the detection of gravitational waves is vast, and we can only touch upon the subject here. The interested reader is referred to [33, 103, 172, 230], and references therein. Although wave solutions also exist in the full nonlinear theory, as mentioned in Chap. 7, we shall study here the more physically relevant scenario where the gravitational field is weak. In such a case the metric may be written as a perturbation about the flat space–time metric: gij .x/ D dij C "hij .x/ C O."2 / ; (A5.1) with ", a small parameter such that terms of order "2 or higher may be ignored.1 (We will use equalities below instead of approximate equalities, and it is understood that this implies “equal to order ".”) The flat space–time metric is known as the background metric. Of course, one could also perturb a non-flat solution to the Einstein field equations (in fact, many interesting phenomena do indeed consider non-flat backgrounds); however, (A5.1) will suffice for our purpose. In the linear approximation, the Einstein equations are computed utilizing metric (A5.1), and terms to order " are retained. The conjugate metric tensor components g ij .x/ from (A5.1) are furnished by 1 (1) Here, hij .x/ will be used to denote the perturbation of the metric. This notation should not be confused with the one of hij .x/ in Appendix 1, where it represented the variation of the metric tensor components. (2) Weak gravitational fields, up to an arbitrary order O ."n /, have been investigated in [64]. A. Das and A. DeBenedictis, The General Theory of Relativity: A Mathematical Exposition, DOI 10.1007/978-1-4614-3658-4, © Springer Science+Business Media New York 2012 625 626 Appendix 5 g ij .x/ D d ij Linearized Theory and Gravitational Waves " ik jl d d C d j k d i l hkl .x/: 2 (A5.2) Therefore, we obtain by raising indices, hkl .x/ D g km .x/ g ln .x/ hmn .x/ n " D d km d ln d ln d kp d mq C d mp d kq 2 o lp nq km C d d d C d np d lq hpq .x/ hmn .x/; dij hij .x/ DW hii .x/ o n " D d ij d i k d j l C d j k d i l hkl .x/ hij .x/; 2 det gij .x/ D 1 C "hkk .x/ : (A5.3i) (A5.3ii) (A5.3iii) Further, we shall require the Christoffel symbols, which are given as " i D d i l @k hlj .x/ C @j hlk .x/ @l hj k .x/ : jk 2 (A5.4) In addition, to form the Einstein tensor in linearized theory, we shall require the Riemann tensor and its contractions to order " which may be computed from (A5.4) as: Rij kl .x/ i i @l D @k lj kj D Rij .x/ D " @k @j hil .x/ C @l @i hj k .x/ @k @i hj l .x/ @l @j hik .x/ ; 2 (A5.5i) " @i @j hkk .x/ C @k @k hij .x/ @k @i hj k .x/ @k @j hki .x/ ; (A5.5ii) 2 R.x/ D " @k @k hii .x/ @k @i hki .x/ : (A5.5iii) (Compare the above with (2.172).) From these, the Einstein tensor is furnished as 1 Gij D Rij gij R 2 D " @i @j hkk .x/ C @k @k hij .x/ C dij @k @l hkl .x/ 2 dij @k @k hll .x/ @k @i hj k .x/ @k @j hki .x/ : (A5.6) Appendix 5 Linearized Theory and Gravitational Waves 627 At this point it is worthwhile noting that if we introduce the trace-reversed perturbation tensor, defined by 1 hij .x/ WD hij .x/ dij hkk .x/; 2 (A5.7) the expression (A5.6) simplifies greatly: i "h k k k @k @ hij .x/ C dij @k @l h l .x/ @k @i hj k .x/ @k @j h i .x/ : Gij D 2 (A5.8) One may simplify this expression even further by an appropriate choice of gauge (which is equivalent to a coordinate transformation in general relativity theory). From (A5.8) it can be seen that considerable simplification would occur if we could choose a coordinate system such that @k hkj .x/ D 0 : (A5.9) The condition in (A5.9) is known as the Lorentz gauge condition (also known as the harmonic, deDonder, or Fock-deDonder gauge condition). Establishing such a condition is always possible under an infinitesimal (and differentiable) coordinate transformation of the form x i ! x 0 i D x i C " i .x/. Under such a transformation, the metric perturbation becomes hij .x/ !h0ij .x/ D hij .x/ @i j .x/ @j i .x/; (A5.10i) 1 0 hij .x/ !hij .x/ D h0ij .x/ dij h0kk .x/ D hij .x/@i j .x/@j i .x/Cdij @k k .x/: 2 (A5.10ii) (Note that " i .x/ is of order ", and therefore, its index is raised or lowered with the background metric.) 0 By taking the four-divergence of (A5.10ii) it can be seen that hij .x/ respects the Lorentz gauge condition if @k @k i .x/ D @j hj i .x/: (A5.11) Therefore, under this gauge condition, the Einstein tensor may be written as Gij D " 0 @k @k hij .x/ ; 2 so that the linearized Einstein field equations read 0 "@k @k hij .x/ D 2"Tij .x/: Note that since the background space-time is flat, Tij .x/ is of order ". (A5.12) 628 Appendix 5 Fig. A5.1 An illustration of the quantities in (A5.13) in the three-dimensional spatial submanifold. The coordinates xs , known as the source points, span the entire source (shaded region). O represents an arbitrary origin of the coordinate system Linearized Theory and Gravitational Waves T ij ∂B 0 (x 1s , x 2s , x s3) xs O x −x s x (x 1 , x2 , x3 ) Remarks. (i) From physics, (A5.12) is the equation for a spin-two tensor field propagating on flat space–time with a source Tij .x/ [98]. Gravitons (hypothetical quanta mediating gravitational interactions) should therefore carry a spin of two in the corresponding quantum theory. (ii) In the case where Tij .x/ D 0, (A5.12) is simply the wave equation for a second0 rank tensor field hij .x/ with speed equal to unity (the speed of light, or massless particles). Therefore, in the linearized theory, it can be argued that gravitational interactions propagate at the speed of light. If Tij .x/ is known and of compact support, one may find a solution to (A5.12) utilizing the flat space–time retarded Green function for the wave operator: 0 hij .x; E x /D 2 Z 4 B Tij .x; E x 4 jxE xEs j/ 1 2 3 dxs dxs dxs ; jxE xEs j (A5.13) where the domain of integration, B, is over the source (see Fig. A5.1). For the remainder of this appendix, we concentrate on the case where Tij .x/ D 0 (i.e., away from sources). In this scenario, (A5.12) reduces to the wave equation: 0 @k @k hij .x/ D 0: (A5.14) The Lorentz gauge condition is actually a class of gauges, as i .x/ is not completely fixed. Within the Lorentz gauge it is possible to add to i .x/ a vector field, i .x/, such that the condition @k @k i .x/ D 0 (A5.15) holds, as this will not spoil (A5.11). The Lorentz gauge condition, along with the conditions (A5.15), allows us to reduce the number of components of hj i .x/ (omitting primes from now on) from ten to two. At this stage, all coordinate freedom has been exhausted, and the system of equations contains two physical (i.e., not Appendix 5 Linearized Theory and Gravitational Waves 629 arising from coordinate artifacts which do not affect the curvature) degrees of freedom. k For physical considerations, it is convenient to choose 4 .x/ such that h k D 0 and choose .x/ such that h4 .x/ D 0. This choice constitutes what is known as the traceless-transverse gauge. Note that in this coordinate system there is no distinction between hij .x/ and hij .x/. We therefore use the notation TT hij .x/ to denote metric perturbations in the traceless-transverse gauge below. A class of important solutions to (A5.14) is comprised of a superposition of plane waves. Let us consider a single wave TT i h l hij .x/ D Re Aij eikl x ; (A5.16) with Aij , the components of a symmetric, constant complex tensor (called the polarization tensor) and k l , the components of a null vector (called the wave vector). The traceless condition implies that Aii D 0, and the condition T T h4 .x/ D 0 implies A4 D 0. Without loss of generality, let us consider the wave in (A5.16) traveling in the x 3 direction. The wave vector then possesses the form Œk i D Œ0; 0; !; ! with ! representing the frequency of the wave. The conditions (A5.9) and A4 D 0 dictate that Ai 3 D 0 and A44 D 0. Assembling all the information we have gathered on the tensor, we see that the two degrees of freedom mentioned previously are encoded in the two components A11 D A22 and A12 D A21 (the first equality arising from the traceless condition and the second equality from the symmetric property of hij .x/). To determine the physical effects of these gravitational waves, let us consider two nearby test particles, located at x 2 D x 3 D 0 in the space–time of a gravitational wave. Consider a vector connecting these two particles, whose components, at some initial time, t0 , are furnished by Œi jt0 D Œ; 0; 0; 0. To the linear order considered in this appendix, the geodesic deviation equations (1.191) yield, after some calculation: @2 1 .x/ @2 D .@x 4 /2 2 .@x 4 /2 TT h11 .x/ ; (A5.17i) @2 2 .x/ @2 D 4 2 .@x / 2 .@x 4 /2 TT h12 .x/ : (A5.17ii) (Note that since the Riemann tensor is already of order ", the components of the 4velocity ( 0 i in the notation of (1.191)) are given by ı i4 .) On the other hand, if two 630 Appendix 5 Linearized Theory and Gravitational Waves a b time Fig. A5.2 The C (top) and (bottom) polarizations of gravitational waves. A loop of string is deformed as shown over time as a gravitational wave passes out of the page. Inset: a superposition of the two most extreme deformations of the string for the C and polarizations particles are located at x 1 D x 3 D 0 and the initial separation vector components are given by Œi jt0 D Œ0; ; 0; 0, then the separation vector satisfies the equations: @2 @2 2 .x/ D .@x 4 /2 2 .@x 4 /2 TT h22 .x/ ; (A5.18i) @2 1 .x/ @2 D .@x 4 /2 2 .@x 4 /2 TT h12 .x/ : (A5.18ii) From the form of TT hij .x/ in (A5.16), it is obvious that the geodesic separation vector components, i .x/, are oscillatory. There exist two polarization states of gravitational waves. One state affects particle motion, as shown in Fig. A5.2a and is characterized by TT h11 .x/ D TT h22 .x/ ¤ 0 and TT h12 .x/ D 0 D TT h21 .x/. This state is known as the C-state. The other state is characterized by TT h12 .x/ D TT h21 .x/ ¤ 0 and TT h22 .x/ D 0 D TT h11 .x/ and is known as the -state. This motion is depicted in Fig. A5.2b. These two states correspond to two independent polarizations since A11 (or equivalently A22 D A11 ) and A12 (D A21 ) are independent of each other. The two polarizations are orthogonal to each other in the sense that Aij jC Aij j D 0 (the bar here representing complex conjugation). There are currently a number of gravitational wave detectors in operation throughout the world, with several others in the advanced planning and design stages. The largest land-based detector, Laser Interferometer Gravitational Wave Observatory (LIGO), consists of two interferometers: one in Hanford, Washington, and one in Livingston, Louisiana, which have characteristic lengths of approximately 4 km. The LISA detector (Laser Interferometer Space Antenna), originally scheduled for launch in the next decade, would consist of three orbiting satellites, each separated by approximately 5 million kilometers. These mammoth devices possess the sensitivity to detect gravitational waves from various astrophysical sources (see Fig. A5.3) with amplitudes as small as 109 cm. (See, for example, [182].) The current status of the LISA project is under assessment. We have treated here only the very simplest type of gravitational wave, as a more in-depth treatment is beyond the scope of this text. A more thorough review would Appendix 5 Linearized Theory and Gravitational Waves 631 Fig. A5.3 The sensitivity of the LISA and LIGO detectors. The dark regions indicate the likely amplitudes (vertical axis, denoting change in length divided by mean length of detector) and frequencies (horizontal axis, in cycles per second) of astrophysical sources of gravitational waves. The approximately “U”-shaped lines indicate the extreme sensitivity levels of the LISA (left) and LIGO (right) detectors. BH D black hole, NS D neutron star, SN D supernova (Figure courtesy of NASA) include solutions with sources (Tij .x/ ¤ 0, such as many of the phenomena in Fig. A5.3), which are astrophysically relevant, as well as estimations of the power emitted via gravitational wave emission for various astrophysical processes such as black hole collisions and binary neutron star orbits. (In closing this appendix we note that the 1993 Nobel Prize in Physics was awarded to Russell A. Hulse and Joseph H. Taylor, Jr., for their discovery of a binary pulsar system which is observed to be losing energy at a rate in agreement with gravitational wave calculations [137].) Appendix 6 Exotic Solutions: Wormholes, Warp-Drives, and Time Machines This appendix deals with several interesting classes of exotic solutions to the gravitational field equations. The purpose of studying such solutions is several-fold: On the one hand, they are interesting in their own right, as they illustrate just how rich the arena of solutions to the field equations can be. There are no analogs of these solutions in pregeneral relativistic theories of gravity. It is therefore of great interest in gravitational field research to study just what is possible within general relativity theory under extreme situations. Secondly, there is pedagogical value in studying such solutions. As we will show below, these solutions concretely illustrate the utility of many of the topics and techniques discussed in this text in a very simple and clear fashion. Finally, the types of solutions mentioned here actually have application in specialized physical topics within general relativity theory. Wormholes, for example, provide a simplistic picture of “space–time foam,” a potential model for the vacuum in theories of quantum gravity, depicted in Fig. A6.1. (Whether this topology is allowed to fluctuate is not clear at the moment, as some arguments against topology change are indifferent to whether one is considering classical or quantum effects [126].) An in-depth review of exotic solutions of the type discussed here may be found in [168]. A6.1 Wormholes The first exotic solution we will discuss is the wormhole. This type of object has already been mentioned previously. (See Fig. 2.17c.) Qualitatively, the wormhole represents a handle (or shortcut) in space–time, which introduces a nontrivial topology. The most often studied topology is R2 S 2 . The wormhole handle may connect two otherwise disconnected universes (an interuniverse wormhole) or else connect two regions of the same universe (an intrauniverse wormhole). The two cases are depicted in Fig. A6.2. It should be noted that the near-throat region (the “narrowest” section of the handle) has an uncanny resemblance to the manifold depicted in Fig. 3.1 and, in fact, the part of the Schwarzschild manifold depicted in A. Das and A. DeBenedictis, The General Theory of Relativity: A Mathematical Exposition, DOI 10.1007/978-1-4614-3658-4, © Springer Science+Business Media New York 2012 633 634 Appendix 6 Exotic Solutions: Wormholes, Warp-Drives, and Time Machines Fig. A6.1 A possible picture for the space–time foam. Space-time that seems smooth on large scales (left) may actually be endowed with a sea of nontrivial topologies (represented by handles on the right) due to quantum gravity effects. (Note that, as discussed in the main text, this topology is not necessarily changing.) One of the simplest models for such a handle is the wormhole identify identify Fig. A6.2 A qualitative representation of an interuniverse wormhole (top) and an intra-universe wormhole (bottom). In the second scenario, the wormhole could provide a shortcut to otherwise distant parts of the universe Fig. 3.1 can actually represent one half of a type of wormhole known as an EinsteinRosen bridge. The shading in the throat region here represents the presence of some matter field, which is the source of the gravitational field supporting the wormhole. Let us now quantify the geometry represented in Fig. A6.2 . We shall be limiting our attention to the case where the wormhole exhibits spherical symmetry and, for simplicity, we will assume the space–time is static. In such a case, we may take the line element to be that of (3.1) and utilize the field equations and conservation equations given by (3.44i–vii). Note that here, r1 is equal to the coordinate radius of the throat. To avoid confusion, below we shall use coordinate indices .r; ; '; t/ instead of .1; 2; 3; 4/ as was used in Chap. 3. Appendix 6 Exotic Solutions: Wormholes, Warp-Drives, and Time Machines x3 635 x3 ϕ ϕ x 3 =P+(r) rotate x1 x1 throat throat x2 x2 x 3 =P−(r) Fig. A6.3 Left: A cross-section of the wormhole profile curve near the throat region. Right: The wormhole is generated by rotating the profile curve about the x 3 -axis Since we have a specific geometry in mind, the g or mixed methods of solving the field equations will be most useful here. To mathematically construct the wormhole, we consider Fig. A6.3 which illustrates a cross-section or profile curve of a twodimensional section, t D constant, D =2, of the wormhole near the throat (see also Fig. 1.18). The wormhole itself is constructed via the creation of a surface of revolution when one rotates this profile curve about the x 3 -axis. The surface of revolution may be parameterized as follows: ˛ xj:: D ˛ .r; '/; 1 .r; '/; 2 .r; '/; 3 .r; '/ WD .r cos '; r sin '; P .r// ; (A6.1) q where r D .x 1 /2 C .x 2 /2 and ' is shown in Fig. A6.3. Therefore, the induced metric on the surface of revolution is given by dj::2 D .dx 1 /2 C .dx 2 /2 C .dx 3 /2 j:: o n D 1 C Œ@r P .r/2 dr 2 C r 2 d' 2 : (A6.2) Note that the corresponding four-dimensional space–time metric, (3.1), may now be written as o n 2 ds˙ D 1 C Œ@r P˙ .r/2 dr 2 C r 2 d 2 C r 2 sin2 ./ d' 2 e˙ .r/ dt 2 ; (A6.3) with coordinate ranges r1 < r < r2 ; 0 < < ; < ' < ; 1 < t < 1: For the case of a wormhole throat, the coordinate chart of (A6.3) is insufficient to describe the entire wormhole. Instead, two spherical charts are required, one for 636 Appendix 6 Exotic Solutions: Wormholes, Warp-Drives, and Time Machines the upper half of the wormhole (the “+” domain) and one for the lower half (the “” domain). (See [74, 75, 107, 185, 254] for various charts which cover both the + and domains.) Hence, we use the ˙ subscript in the above line element. The constant m0 in (3.45i) can be set by the requirement that @r P˙ .r/ ! ˙1 as r ! r1 or, equivalently, that (3.45i) vanish in the limit r ! r1 . This condition implies that the constant 2m0 D r1 . We are now in a position to analyze the geometry. For now we limit the analysis to the upper half of the profile curve (the “+” region) in Fig. A6.3 since the bottom half is easily obtained once we have the upper half (for example, via reflection symmetry through the x 1 x 2 plane if one wants a wormhole symmetric on either side of the throat, although this is not required). It should also be noted that r D 0 is not part of the manifold, unlike in the case of stars studied in earlier chapters. Therefore, divergences as r tends to zero are not an issue here. From the profile curve in Fig. A6.3, it may be seen that a function P .r/ is required with the following properties: 1. The derivative, @r P .r/, must be “infinite” at the throat and finite elsewhere. 2. The derivative, @r PC .r/, must be positive at least near the throat (negative for the “” domain). 3. The function PC .r/ must possess a negative second derivative at least somewhere near the throat region (positive for the “” domain). 4. Since there will be a cutoff at some r D r2 , where the solution is joined to vacuum (Schwarzschild or Kottler solution), no specification needs to be made as r tends to infinity. From now on, we often drop the explicit r dependence in functions for brevity. In terms of the function P .r/, the field equations read .@r P /2 .@r / r h i D T rr ; 1 C .@r P /2 r 2 (A6.4i) i2 n 1 h 4 .@r P / .@r @r P / C 2 .@r / C 2 .@r / .@r P /2 1 C .@r P /2 4r Cr .@r /2 C 2 r .@r @r / .@r P /2 C 2 r .@r @r / C r .@r /2 .@r P /2 2 r .@r P / .@r @r P / .@r /g D T T '' ; h i .@r P / .@r P /3 C 2 .@r @r P / r C @r P D T tt ; h i2 2 r 2 1 C .@r P / (A6.4ii) (A6.4iii) where it is understood that these equations must hold in both the C and domain. A natural question to ask at this stage is what are the properties a matter field must possess in order to support such a wormhole space–time? Analyzing (A6.4iii) Appendix 6 Exotic Solutions: Wormholes, Warp-Drives, and Time Machines 637 by performing a careful limit as r ! r1 , and taking into account the properties of P .r/ listed above, we see that G tt .r1 / D .r1 / r12 , .r/ being the local 1 energy density as measured by static observers. (We are assuming here that the stress-tensor components are nonsingular.) To make the arguments more physical, we shall employ a mixed method as opposed to the purely geometric g-method, and therefore we will treat T rr .r/ as a function that is to be prescribed. The orthonormal Riemann tensor components are furnished by b˙ 1 1 R.t /.r/.t /.r/˙ D 2 r 1 @r @r ˙ C .@r ˙ /2 2 b @r b˙ r˙ 1 @r ˙ 2 r b˙ b˙ 1 R.t /. /.t /. /˙ D D R.t /.'/.t /.'/˙ ; @r ˙ 1 2r r 1 b˙ D R.r/.'/.r/.'/˙ ; R.r/. /.r/. /˙ D 2 @r b˙ 2r r R. /.'/. /.'/˙ D # ; b˙ ; r3 (A6.5i) (A6.5ii) (A6.5iii) (A6.5iv) .@ P /2 where we use the notation b˙ WD r 1C.@r r ˙ to simplify the expressions. P˙ /2 To continue the analysis, it is noted that to make the the orthonormal Riemann components finite in this scenario, @r .r/ must be finite. (See [74] for full details as to why this renders all components finite.) From the field equations, it can be shown that this quantity is given by i 1 1 h r @r ˙ D r T r˙ C 2 1 C .@r P˙ /2 ; r r (A6.6) from which it may be seen that a prescription of T rr compatible with T rr .r1 / D pr .r1 / D r12 must be applied. Therefore, a negative pressure (i.e., a tension) 1 must be present at the wormhole throat in order to support it. Finally, we consider the combination .˙ C pr ˙ / D G tt ˙ G rr ˙ D h i1 e˙ @r e˙ 1 C .@r P˙ /2 r (A6.7) in the immediate vicinity of the wormhole throat. This quantity is directly related to the energy conditions discussed in Chap. 2. From the discussions above, it can be seen that at the throat, nonnegativity of this combination can (barely) be met (i.e., .r1 / C pr .r1 / 0). However, as one moves away from the throat, note that the quantity in braces in (A6.7) must go from a value of zero at the throat 638 Appendix 6 Exotic Solutions: Wormholes, Warp-Drives, and Time Machines (where @r P ! 1) to a positive value away from the throat. Therefore, around the throat region, the derivative of the expression in braces is positive and thus (A6.7) is negative in a neighborhood of the throat. That is, a static wormhole throat violates the weak/null and strong energy conditions! (See, e.g., [146].) The reader interested in this topic is referred to Visser’s book on the subject of Lorentzian wormholes [254]. A6.2 Warp-Drive Space–Times We consider here briefly another interesting class of solutions to the field equations known as warp-drive space-times. The first such solution was put forward by Miguel Alcubierre in 1994 [4], and since then much analysis has been done on these types of solutions. We will present here the original Alcubierre warp-drive. The basic idea is simple. One wishes to construct a space–time in which an object (popularly, a spaceship is chosen) can be propelled between two points, such that the travel time (as measured by both the proper time of the object and external observers) is much less than the distance separating the points divided by the speed of light. Ideally, one also wishes to demand that the interval of proper time of the traveling observers is the same as the proper time interval for static external observers (so that the two observers age by the same amount!). Before beginning the analysis, it should also be noted that no object will be traveling faster than the local speed of light. It is useful to employ the ADM formalism here (see Appendix 1) utilizing the metric (A1.42). An ADM form of the metric is useful, as a space–time domain constructed from the ADM formalism will not contain any closed causal curves (to be discussed in the next section) unless one introduces a topological identification. The original warp-drive used the following quantities: N.x/ D 1 ; (A6.8i) N ˛ .x/ D s v.x 4 /f .s r.x// ı ˛1 ; (A6.8ii) g˛ˇ .x/ D ı˛ˇ ; (A6.8iii) where we are employing a Cartesian-like coordinate system in the three-dimensional spatial hypersurface. The line element therefore is the following: ds 2 D dx 1 s v.x 4 /f .s r.x// dx 4 2 2 2 2 C dx 2 C dx 3 dx 4 : (A6.9) Here, s v.x 4 / WD d s Xdx 4.x / represents the coordinate velocity of the spaceship and h i1=2 2 x 1 sX 1 .x 4 / C .x 2 /2 C .x 3 /2 . The coordinate position of the s r.x/ WD 1 4 Appendix 6 Exotic Solutions: Wormholes, Warp-Drives, and Time Machines 639 Fig. A6.4 A “top-hat” function for the warp-drive space–time with one direction (x 3 ) suppressed. The center of the ship is located at the center of the top hat, corresponding to s r D 0 ship is x 1 Ds X 1 .x 4 /; x 2 D 0; x 3 D 0 (note that we are assuming spatial motion in the x 1 direction only) and therefore s r.x/ represents the coordinate distance from the ship. For the system to function as desired, the function f .s r.x// should approximate a “top-hat” function. In the original warp-drive solution, the following function was chosen (the explicit x dependence is henceforth dropped): f .s r/ WD tanh Œ .s r C R/ tanh Œ .s r R/ ; 2 tanh .R/ (A6.10) with R > 0 and 0 but otherwise arbitrary constants. This function is displayed in Fig. A6.4 with the x 3 coordinate suppressed. This space–time possesses several interesting properties. Note from (A6.9) that x 4 D constant hypersurfaces are always flat. Also, for distances s r R2 , the full four-dimensional space–time is flat, as is the space–time anywhere where the first two derivatives of f .s r/ are zero. As well, it is not difficult to show that observers possessing 4-velocity components ui D Œs vf .s r/; 0; 0; 1 are traveling 1 along geodesics. As a concrete example, consider an observer located at xO D 1 4 2 3 X .x /; x D x D 0 and therefore traveling with the ship. It may immediately s O O be seen that, for such an observer, the invariant infinitesimal line element (A6.9) 2 yields the condition dsO D .dx 4 /2O . (Note that f .s r/ D 1 in the immediate vicinity of the ship.) Recalling that ds 2 along a world line yields minus the infinitesimal proper time squared along that world line tells us that the lapse of proper time for an observer traveling with the ship is equal to the lapse of proper time for a static observer located at some distance > R from the ship, for whom ds 2 D .dx 4 /2 also holds. Therefore, there is no relative time dilation between such observers. (We are assuming that the function f .s r/ is very close to a true top-hat function, which is a good approximation as long as is large.) Qualitatively, the top hat, often called the warp bubble, is “propelled” through the external space–time with a coordinate velocity s v, and any object enclosed in the bubble moves along with it. This velocity can be very large, the important point being that objects inside the bubble always possess 4-velocities that are timelike. This emphasizes an important point in general relativity that the structure of the light cones is a local phenomenon. As long as 4-velocities remain within their local light cone, the velocity is timelike or subluminal (in the local sense). 640 Appendix 6 Exotic Solutions: Wormholes, Warp-Drives, and Time Machines 4 2 –K 0 –2 –4 –10 –5 0 x ^2 5 10 10 5 0 x^1 –5 –10 Fig. A6.5 The expansion of spatial volume elements, (A6.12), for the warp-drive space–time with the x 3 coordinate suppressed. Note that, in this model, there is contraction of volume elements in front of the ship and an expansion of volume elements behind the ship. The ship, however, is located in a region with no expansion nor compression To glean further properties of this space–time, let us next consider the extrinsic curvature components, K ˛ˇ , of the spatial slices. A small amount of calculation reveals that K ˛ˇ D s v d f .s r/ @ s r ˛ 1 ı ı C off-diagonal terms: d s r @x 1 1 ˇ (A6.11) The negative trace of this quantity yields an expression for the expansion of volume elements in this space: K ˛˛ D s v d f .s r/ d sr x 1 s X 1 .x 4 / : sr (A6.12) This function is plotted (with the x 3 coordinate suppressed) in Fig. A6.5. It should be stressed that the contraction of volume elements in front of the spaceship is simply a “by-product” phenomenon due to the type of metric chosen. The space ship does not travel at apparent superluminal speed by moving through the compressed space. The space ship is always located inside the warp bubble, where the space is approximately flat. Finally, we briefly analyze the properties of the matter field required to support a warp bubble such as the one described here. The energy density, as measured by observers with 4-velocity components ui D Œ0; 0; 0; 1 (geodesic observers), is given by 1 Gij .x/ui .x/ uj .x/ " 1 @f .s r/ 2 2 D .s v/ C 4 @x 2 Tij .x/ui .x/ uj .x/ D @f .s r/ @x 3 2 # : (A6.13) Appendix 6 Exotic Solutions: Wormholes, Warp-Drives, and Time Machines Fig. A6.6 A plot of the distribution of negative energy density in a plane (x 3 D 0) containing the ship for a warp-drive space–time 641 0 –2 –4 rho –6 –8 –10 –10 –5 –5 0 x^ 2 5 5 10 –10 0 x^1 10 From this expression, it can be noted that a negative energy density is required in order to generate this exotic geometry. The distribution of this negative energy density is plotted in Fig. A6.6. Again, energy conditions are violated. A6.3 Time Machines We conclude our survey of exotic solutions by considering some space-times which contain closed causal (null or timelike) or closed timelike curves (CTCs). We have already briefly touched upon such phenomena when discussing the Kerr space–time. We shall present a few more such solutions here. CTCs are associated with space-times which possess some property which allows a continuous timelike curve to intersect with itself. That is, some observer may travel into his or her own past. (These definitions may be extended to include null curves as well.) Two qualitative examples of CTCs are displayed in Fig. A6.7, where “forward light cones” have been drawn to indicate the timelike nature of the curves. It should be noted that the space-times in the figures may possess an everywhere nonvanishing vector field which is timelike and continuous (and thus may be timeorientable). Also, locally, one can define a “past” and a “future” in the figures. However, globally this is not possible, as a forward-pointing timelike vector tangent to a timelike curve may be Fermi–Walker transported along the curve in the forward direction (see Fig. 2.13), only to wind up in the past of its point of origin. Causality violation refers to the violation of the premise that cause precedes effect, as would be possible in a space–time with CTCs. We define the causality violating region of a space–time point p, C.p/, as C.p/ WD C .p/ \ C C .p/; 642 Appendix 6 Exotic Solutions: Wormholes, Warp-Drives, and Time Machines a b identify Fig. A6.7 Two examples of closed timelike curves. In (a) the closure of the timelike curve is introduced by topological identification. In (b) the time coordinate is periodic where C .p/ and C C .p/ represent the causal past and causal future of p, respectively (see Fig. 2.2). For causally well-behaved space-times, this intersection is empty for all p. The causality violating region of a space–time M is C.M / D [ C.p/; p2M and a space–time whose C.M / D ; is known as a causal space–time. It is interesting to note that the source of causality violation in many space-times with closed timelike curves is the presence of large angular momentum. Several of the examples below shall reveal this phenomenon, and it will become clear that the coupling of a time coordinate with an angular coordinate (caused by the presence of rotation) can cause the angular coordinate to become timelike, and thus generate causality violating regions of the type in part b) of Fig. A6.7. We consider first the anti-de Sitter (AdS) space–time (see Exercise 10 of Sect. 2.3). AdS space–time is a constant (negative) curvature solution to the field equations which is supported by a negative cosmological constant, . The solution may be obtained from the induced metric on the hyper-hyperboloid defined by U 2 V 2 C X 2 C Y 2 C Z2 D 1 ; 2j j (A6.14) embedded in the five-dimensional flat space admitting a line element of ds52 D dU 2 dV 2 C dX 2 C dY 2 C dZ 2 : (A6.15) We show a schematic of this embedding (with 2 dimensions suppressed) in Fig. A6.8. (See Exercise #1iii of Sect. 6.1 for a discussion of the analogous diagram for de Sitter space–time.) Appendix 6 Exotic Solutions: Wormholes, Warp-Drives, and Time Machines 643 U Fig. A6.8 The embedding of anti-de Sitter space–time in a five-dimensional flat “space–time” which possesses two timelike coordinates, U and V (two dimensions suppressed) X V The topology of the AdS manifold is therefore S 1 R3 . Referring to Fig. A6.8, it can be shown that, for example, curves represented by circles orbiting around the X axis on the hyperbolic manifold are everywhere timelike. This space–time therefore exhibits closed timelike curves of the type displayed in Fig. A6.7a). Usually, when dealing with AdS space–time, one deals with the universal covering space of antide Sitter space–time, which involves unwrapping the S 1 part of the topology, thus yielding R4 topology. Next, in our brief review of causality-violating solutions, we present the Gödel universe [116]. The Gödel universe represents a rotating universe supported by a negative cosmological constant, , and a dust matter source and possessing R4 topology. The rotation is somewhat peculiar in the sense that all points in this universe may be seen as equivalent. That is, there is no preferred point about which the Gödel universe is rotating. (See [126] for details.) In one popular coordinate system, the Gödel universe metric admits a line element of ds 2 D i p 2 h 2 d% C dz2 C sinh2 % sinh4 % d' 2 C 2 2 sinh2 % d' dt dt 2 ; j j (A6.16) with < 0, 1 < t < 1, 0 < % < 1, 1 < z < 1 and < ' < . One can see from (A6.16), like in the case of the Kerr geometry, p that the t and ' coordinates are coupled. Furthermore, note that at % D % WD ln.1C 2/, the metric component g' ' switches sign. This is one indication that the ' coordinate changes character from a spacelike nature to a timelike nature.1 The ' coordinate is truly an angular coordinate, that is, it is periodic. Therefore, for values of % > ln.1 C p 2/, this “angle” is timelike. Although not a geodesic, an observer in the Gödel space–time at % > % could travel along a trajectory in the ' direction and meet 1 One has to be cautious when applying this loose criterion. A more rigorous discussion is based on the eigenvalue structure of the metric tensor as, for example, presented in various preceding chapters. 644 Appendix 6 Exotic Solutions: Wormholes, Warp-Drives, and Time Machines Fig. A6.9 The light-cone structure about an axis % D 0 in the Gödel space–time. On thep left, the light cones tip forward, and on the right, they tip backward. Note that at % D ln.1 C 2/ the light cones are sufficiently tipped over that the ' direction is null. At greater %, the ' direction is timelike, indicating the presence of a closed timelike curve up with him/herself after one complete “revolution”! This type of causal structure is similar to that depicted in Fig. A6.7b. A figure of this peculiar light-cone structure is displayed in Fig. A6.9 (also see figure caption). The final solution we discuss is the Van Stockum space–time [251]. This solution to the field equations was one of the first to exhibit the behavior of CTCs. Physically, the solution describes an infinitely long cylinder of rotating dust with a vacuum exterior, the angular momentum preventing the gravitational collapse of the dust. The interior solution admits the following line element in corotating cylindrical coordinates: ds 2 D e! 2 %2 2 2 d% C dz2 C %2 .d'/2 dt !%2 d' ; (A6.17) with 1 < t < 1, 0 < % < %0 , 1 < z < 1 and < ' < . Here, ! represents the (constant) angular velocity of the dust cylinder. Again notice that the ' and t coordinates are coupled and that for !% > 1 the periodic ' coordinate becomes timelike. One could argue that by placing the boundary of the dust cylinder at some % D %0 < !1 , the problem of CTCs would be cured, as the above interior metric is no longer valid at !% D 1. However, it has been shown that if !%0 > 12 CTCs still appear in the vacuum exterior [248]. But causality violation is avoided if !%0 12 , although there may exist other pathologies. As can be seen Appendix 6 Exotic Solutions: Wormholes, Warp-Drives, and Time Machines 645 here, strong rotation also causes the light cones to tip and a large enough value of ! will cause CTCs to occur somewhere in the space–time. This is analogous to the situation shown in Fig. A6.7b. Before closing this section, we mention that the wormholes described earlier in this appendix may also be used as a time machine. One process involves the time dilation effect when two mouths of a wormhole move with respect to each other. The interested reader is referred to [247]. Appendix 7 Gravitational Instantons Let us go back to Tricomi’s p.d.e. of Example A2.5. It is given by @1 @1 w C x 1 @2 @2 w D 0: The partial differential equation above originates in the theory of gas dynamics [43]. The p.d.e. is elliptic for the half-plane x 1 > 0, but hyperbolic for the other half-plane x 1 < 0. Thus, this equation motivates us to consider mathematically the following metric in order to introduce the subject of this appendix: g:: x 1 ; x 2 WD @ @ ˝ 1 1 @x @x C x1 @ @ ˝ 2 2 @x @x ; 1 2 g:: x 1 ; x 2 D dx 1 ˝ dx 1 C x 1 dx ˝ dx 2 ; D2 WD ˚ ˚ x 1 ; x 2 W x 1 > 0; x 2 2 R [ x 1 ; x 2 W x 1 < 0; x 2 2 R : (A7.1i) (A7.1ii) (A7.1iii) The metric above is positive definite (or Riemannian) for x 1 > 0; but pseudoRiemannian (of signature zero) for x 1 < 0: (A7.1iii) yields a union of apparently two disconnected two-dimensional differential manifolds. Let us consider another toy model of a four-dimensional metric furnished by: 4 2 4 3 4 g:: .x/ WD x 1 ı˛ˇ dx ˛ ˝ dx ˇ x 1 x dx ˝ dx 4 ; 2 4 3 4 2 4 ds 2 D x 1 ı˛ˇ dx ˛ dx ˇ x 1 x dx ; ˚ ˚ D WD x W x 1 > 0; x 2 2 R; x 3 2 R; x 4 > 0 [ x W x 1 > 0; x 2 2 R; x 3 2 R; x 4 < 0 : (A7.2) A. Das and A. DeBenedictis, The General Theory of Relativity: A Mathematical Exposition, DOI 10.1007/978-1-4614-3658-4, © Springer Science+Business Media New York 2012 647 648 Appendix 7 Gravitational Instantons In case x 4 > 0; the above metric is transformable to the Kasner metric of Example 4.2.1. However, in case x 4 < 0; the metric yields a Ricci-flat, positive definite metric. Two distinct sectors of the manifold have a common three-dimensional, positive definite hypersurface with the metric: 4 g:: .x/ WD x 1 ı˛ˇ dx ˛ ˝ dx ˇ ; ˚ D WD x W x 1 > 0; x 2 2 R; x 3 2 R : The toy model in (A7.2) goes beyond the traditional definition of either a Riemannian or else a pseudo-Riemannian manifold. The common boundary D can be called an instanton-horizon. The static, vacuum, space–time metrics can generate positive definite, Ricci-flat metrics as in (A7.2). At this point, we should mention that a gravitational instanton metric is not synonymous with a Riemannian metric. That is, the presence of a positive definite metric is necessary but not sufficient to guarantee that the solution is a gravitational instanton.1 Theorem A7.1. Let the function w.x/ and the positive definite, three-dimensional ı metric g:: .x/ be of class C 3 in D R3 : Moreover, let ı g:: .x/ WD e2w.x/ g:: .x/ e2w.x/ dx 4 ˝ dx 4 satisfy vacuum field equations R:: .x/ D O:: .x/ in D WD D R: Then, the fourdimensional, positive definite metric ı b g:: .x/ WD e2w.x/ g:: .x/ C e2w.x/ dx 4 ˝ dx 4 is Ricci flat in D R: Proof. For both of the metrics g:: .x/ and b g:: .x/; conditions of Ricci flatness reduce to the same equations (4.41i,ii). However, such an easy transition to the positive definite status is not possible from stationary, vacuum metrics (which are not static). Let us explore this situation in more detail. Consider the “stationary,” positive definite, four-dimensional metric: ı g:: .x/ WD e2u.x/ g:: .x/ C e2u.x/ w˛ .x/ dx ˛ C dx 4 ˝ wˇ .x/ dx ˇ C dx 4 I x D .x; x 4 / 2 D R: (A7.3) A gravitational instanton metric is a C 3 class of vacuum metrics in a “space–time” with a positive definite C4 signature which is geodesically complete. Often in cases of interest, they possess a self-dual or anti-self dual Riemann tensor (to be discussed shortly). 1 Appendix 7 Gravitational Instantons 649 (Obviously, the metric above admits the Killing vector @x@ 4 : Needless to say, the word timelike is undefined in this context.) Some of the Ricci-flat conditions imply the existence of potential N .x/ such that ı @˛ N D .1=2/ e4u ˛ ˇ @ wˇ @ˇ w : (A7.4) The function N .x/ is called the NUT potential. The remaining conditions of Ricci flatness reduce to the following p.d.e.s: ı R .x/ C 2 @ u @ u .1=2/ e4u @ N @ N D 0; ı ı r 2 u .1=2/ e4u g ı ı r 2N 4 g @ N @ N D 0; @ u @ N D 0: (A7.5i) (A7.5ii) (A7.5iii) Now we shall derive some conclusions about potentials u.x/ and N .x/: Theorem A7.2. Let field equations (A7.5ii,iii) hold in a star-shaped domain D R3 : (i) Moreover, let N .x/ be continuous up to and on the boundary @D: In case N .x/ attains the extremum at an interior point x0 2 D; the metric (A7.3) is transformable to the “static form.” (ii) Let the function u.x/; satisfying (A7.5ii) attain the maximum at an interior point x0 2 D: Then, the four-dimensional curvature tensor R:::: .x/ O:::: .x/ for all x 2 D R: Proof. (i) Use Theorems 4.2.2 and 4.2.3 for the function N .x/. ı ı (ii) Note that r 2 u D .1=2/ e4u g for the function u.x/. @ N @ N 0: Use Hopf’s Theorem 4.2.2 Now assume a functional relationship e2u.x/ D f ŒN .x/ > 0; f 0 WD d f ŒN ¤ 0: dN (A7.6) Substituting (A7.6) into (A7.5ii,iii), subtracting (A7.5iii) from (A7.5ii), and assuming @˛ N 6 0; we deduce that 1 f0 f 00 C D 0: 0 f f ff 0 (A7.7) 650 Appendix 7 Gravitational Instantons (Compare and contrast the equation above with (4.156.)) The general solution of (A7.7) is furnished by ˚ f ŒN 2 D c0 C 2c1 N C .N /2 ; e4u.x/ D N .x/ C c1 2 (A7.8) C c0 c12 > 0: Here, c0 and c1 are constants of integration. We now make special choices c0 D c1 D 0; e2u.x/ D N .x/ > 0: Field equations (A7.5i) yield (A7.9) ı R .x/ D 0: (A7.10) ı Thus, the three-dimensional metric g:: .x/ is (flat) Euclidean. Choosing a Cartesian chart for D R3 ; (A7.5ii,iii) boil down to the Euclidean Laplace’s equation: ˚ r 2 ŒN .x/1 WD ı @ @ ˚ ŒN .x/1 D 0: (A7.11) Equations (A7.4) reduce to ˚ @ˇ w˛ @˛ wˇ D "˛ˇ @ ŒN .x/1 ; o n E w.x/ E ŒN .x/1 : E or, r Dr ˚ E D grad ŒN .x/1 : or, curl w (A7.12) The “stationary metric” reduces to ds 2 D ŒN .x/1 ı .dx dx / C ŒN .x/ w˛ .x/ dx ˛ C dx 4 2 : (A7.13) The class of exact solutions given by (A7.13), (A7.11), and (A7.12) was discovered by Kloster, Som, and Das (K–S–D in short) in 1974 [149]. Hawking rediscovered the same metric in 1977 [125]. We shall call the metric in (A7.13) as the H–K–S–D metric. Now recall the Hodge-dual mapping in (1.113). It implies for the curvature tensor Rijkl .x/ D .1=2/ rskl .x/ Rij rs .x/: In case Rij kl .x/ Rij kl .x/; (A7.14) (A7.15) Appendix 7 Gravitational Instantons 651 the curvature tensor R:::: .x/ is called self-dual. On the other hand, if Rij kl .x/ .1=2/ rskl .x/ Rij rs .x/ D Rij kl .x/; (A7.16) the curvature tensor is called anti-self-dual. Both (A7.15) and (A7.16) can be combined into Rij kl .x/ " Rij kl .x/; " D ˙1: (A7.17) It can be proved that in case of the H–K–S–D metric of (A7.13), the condition in (A7.17) is identically satisfied by the use of (A7.9) [110]. Instantons are regular, finite-action solutions of the field equations in a fourdimensional, positive definite, flat (or curved) “space–time”. For Yang-Mills type of gauge field theories, the construction of Atiyah, Drinfield, Hitchin, and Manin [11] allows one to compute all regular, self-dual (or anti-self-dual) solutions. However, in the case of gravitation, the situation is more complicated. We define gravitational instantons as positive definite metrics of class C 3 ; which are Ricci flat and geodesically complete. There exist gravitational instantons which are neither self-dual, nor anti-self-dual. A class of these are provided by the “static metrics” of Theorem A7.1. Fortunately, H–K–S–D metrics supply infinitely many self-dual (or anti-self-dual) gravitational instantons which are useful for some path-integral approaches to quantum gravity. Example A7.3. Consider the multicenter H–K–S–D gravitational instantons furnished by the function ŒN .x/1 D a C N X 2mA > 0: k x xA k AD1 (A7.18) Here, a 0 and mA > 0 are constants. (Compare with the pseudo-Riemannian Example 4.2.8.) If mA D m for all A 2 f1; : : : ; N g and if x 4 is a periodic variable with the fundamental period in 0 x 4 . m=N /; then singularities at x D xA are removable. Such solutions qualify as gravitational instantons. In case a D 1 and N D 1; the metric is called the self-dual Taub-NUT metric [126]. In case a D 0 and N D 2; we obtain the Eguchi-Hansen gravitational instantons [85]. Appendix 8 Computational Symbolic Algebra Calculations In this appendix, we present some calculations relevant to general relativity utilizing popular symbolic algebra computer programs. Calculations in general relativity are notoriously lengthy and complicated, and therefore, computational symbolic algebra programs are very useful in this field. Two popular symbolic algebra programs are MapleTM and MathematicaTM , both of which we concentrate on here. For the sake of brevity, we do not discuss special packages, available for both programs, which are designed to supplement the ability of these programs to do general relativistic calculations. (For example, we do not discuss the use of the excellent add-on package available for both MapleTM and MathematicaTM called GRTensorII, which is available at http://grtensor.phy.queensu.ca/). A8.1 Sample MapleTM Work Sheet This work sheet deals with quantities related to the vacuum Schwarzschild metric: > #MAPLE worksheet involving the vacuum Schwarzschild metric. > restart: #The restart command clears all set variables. > with(tensor): #This loads Maple’s tensor package. > coord:=[r, theta, phi, t]; #The coord command defines˜the four coordinates. coord WD Œr; ; ; t A. Das and A. DeBenedictis, The General Theory of Relativity: A Mathematical Exposition, DOI 10.1007/978-1-4614-3658-4, © Springer Science+Business Media New York 2012 653 654 Appendix 8 Computational Symbolic Algebra Calculations > g_compts:=array(symmetric, sparse, 1..4, 1..4); #create a 4x4 sparse array, to be used for metric components. The symmetric command means that if you have non-diagonal components, you only have to enter one of the symmetric pair, the other will automatically be assumed. g compts WD array.symmetric; sparse; 1::4; 1::4; Œ/ > > g_compts[1,1]:=1/(1-2*m/r); #This is g_f11g. 1 g compts1; 1 WD 2m 1 r g_compts[2,2]:=rˆ2; #This is g_f22g. > g compts2; 2 WD r 2 g_compts[3,3]:=rˆ2*(sin(theta))ˆ2; #This is g_f33g. g compts3; 3 WD r 2 sin./2 > g_compts[4,4]:=-1/g_compts[1,1]; #This is g_f44g. 2m g compts4; 4 WD 1 C r > g:=create([-1,-1], eval(g_compts)); #This command creates the metric. The [-1,-1] indicates covariant components on both indices. g WD table.Œindex char D Œ1; 1; 3 2 1 0 0 0 7 6 2m 7 61 7 6 r 7 6 compts D 6 0 0 0 r2 7/ 7 6 7 6 0 0 0 r 2 sin./2 4 2m 5 0 0 0 1 C r > ginv:=invert(g,‘detg‘); #Creates the inverse metric. ginv WD table.Œindex D Œ1; 1; 3 2 r C 2char m 0 0 0 7 6 r 7 6 7 6 1 7 6 0 0 0 7 6 2 r 7/ 6 compts D 6 7 1 7 6 0 0 0 2 7 6 2 7 6 r sin./ 5 4 r 0 0 0 r C 2 m Appendix 8 Computational Symbolic Algebra Calculations 655 > D1g:=d1metric(g,coord): #Creates first partial derivatives of the metric. Note the colon (instead of semi-colon). This suppresses the output, which can be lengthy. > D2g:=d2metric(D1g,coord): #Creates the second partial derivatives of the metric. > Cf1:=Christoffel1(D1g): #Creates Christoffel symbols of the first kind. > Cf2:=Christoffel2(ginv,Cf1): #Creates Christoffel symbols of the second kind. > displayGR(Christoffel2, Cf2); #Display only the non-zero components of the Christoffel symbols of the second kind. The fa,bcg indicates that the first index is ‘‘contravariant’’ and the second and third indices are ‘‘covariant’’. The Christoffel Symbols of the Second Kind non zero components W m f1; 11g D .r C 2 m/ r f1; 22g D r C 2 m f1; 33g D .r C 2 m/ sin./2 .r C 2 m/ m r3 1 f2; 12g D r f2; 33g D sin./ cos./ f1; 44g D 1 r cos./ f3; 23g D sin./ m f4; 14g D .r C 2 m/ r RMN:=Riemann(ginv,D2g,Cf1): #Creates the Riemann curvature tensor. f3; 13g D > > displayGR(Riemann,RMN); #Display only the non-zero components of the Riemann tensor. The Riemann Tensor non zero components W 656 Appendix 8 Computational Symbolic Algebra Calculations R1212 D m r C 2 m m sin./2 r C 2 m 2m R1414 D 3 r R2323 D 2 r m sin./2 R1313 D .r C 2 m/ m r2 .r C 2 m/ m sin./2 R3434 D r2 character W Œ1; 1; 1; 1 RICCI:=Ricci(ginv,RMN); #Create the Ricci tensor. Maple contracts the first and fourth index of the Riemann tensor in order to create the Ricci tensor, compatible with the conventions in this book. It is zero here since we are dealing with a vacuum solution. 2 3 0000 60 0 0 07 7 RICCI WD table.Œindex char D Œ1; 1; compts D 6 4 0 0 0 0 5/ 0000 R2424 D > > RS:=Ricciscalar(ginv,RICCI); #The Ricci scalar. RS WD table.Œindex char D Œ; compts D 0/ > upRMN:=raise(ginv, RMN, 1,2,3,4): #Calculates the contravariant Riemann tensor by raising the first, second, third and fourth index using the inverse metric. > Kret:=prod(RMN,upRMN,[1,1],[2,2],[3,3],[4,4]); #Creates the Kretschmann scalar by multiplying the covariant and contravariant Riemann tensor and contracting first index with first, second with second, third with third and fourth with fourth. 48 m2 / r6 Estn:=Einstein(g,RICCI,RS): #Calculates the covariant Einstein tensor. Kret WD table.Œindex char D Œ; compts D > Appendix 8 Computational Symbolic Algebra Calculations 657 > mixeinst:=raise(ginv,Estn,1): #Raises the first index of the covariant Einstein tensor, creating the mixed-character Einstein tensor. > displayGR(Einstein,mixeinst); #Displays only the non-zero components of the mixed-character Einstein tensor. There are no non-zero components. Caution must be applied when using this command to display this tensor’s components; only components where the row-index is less than or equal to the column-index will be displayed . The Einstein Tensor non zero components W None character W Œ1; 1 A8.2 Sample MathematicaTM Notebook This notebook deals with quantities related to the vacuum Schwarzschild metric. It is based on a notebook which originally supplemented the text Gravity: An introduction to Einstein’s general relativity by Hartle [124]. Mathematica notebook involving the vacuum Schwarzschild metric. This next command clears various variables that might be Mathematica, you need to press shift set. Note that in enter after you are finished typing a cell. ClearŒcoord; metric; ginv; riemann; ricci; rs; einstein; christoffel; r; theta; phi; t This next command sets the coordinates to be used. coord D fr; theta; phi; tg Out[2]=fr; theta; phi; tg This next command creates the metric. metric D ff1=.1 2 m=r/; 0; 0; 0g; f0; r ^ 2; 0; 0g; f0; 0; r ^ 2 .SinŒtheta/^ 2; 0g; f0; 0; 0; .1 2 m=r/gg 658 Appendix 8 Computational Symbolic Algebra Calculations nn o ˚ ˚ ˚ Out[3]= 112m ; 0; 0; 0 ; 0; r 2 ; 0; 0 ; 0; 0; r 2 SinŒtheta2 ; 0 ; 0; 0; 0; 1 C r 2m r o This next command will display the metric in matrix form. metric//MatrixForm 0 B B Out[4]//MatrixForm=B @ 1 1 2m r 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 r2 0 0 r 2 SinŒtheta2 0 0 1 C C C C A 2m r This next command will create the inverse metric. ginv1 D InverseŒmetric ) ( (( Out[5]= ( 0; 0; 2mr 3 SinŒtheta2 r 4 SinŒtheta2 ; 0; 0; 0 ; 0; ) 8 < ; 0 ; 0; 0; 0; : .1 2m r / 2mr 3 SinŒtheta2 r 4 SinŒtheta2 1 2m 1 2m r r 2mr r 2 2m 2m 1 r 1 r 2mr 3 SinŒtheta2 r 4 SinŒtheta2 2m 1 r 1 2m r 2mrSinŒtheta2 r 2 SinŒtheta2 1 2m 1 2m r r 2mr 3 SinŒtheta2 r 4 SinŒtheta2 2m 1 2m 1 r r r 4 SinŒtheta2 2mr 3 SinŒtheta2 1 2m r ) ; 0; 0 ; 99 == r 4 SinŒtheta2 1 2m r ;; The last output was messy. Let’s simplify it a bit with the Simplify command. ginv D SimplifyŒginv1 n o ˚ n˚ o ˚ 2 r ; 0; 0; 0 ; 0; r12 ; 0; 0 ; 0; 0; CscŒtheta ; 0 ; 0; 0; 0; 2mr Out[6]= 1 2m r r2 We can also display the inverse metric in matrix form. ginv//MatrixForm 0 0 1 2m r B 0 1 B r2 Out[7]//MatrixForm=B @ 0 0 0 0 0 0 CscŒtheta2 r2 0 0 0 0 1 C C C A r 2mr We next calculate the Christoffel symbols of the second kind. The triplets such as fi; 1; 4g in the braces correspond to the index (i ) and the range of the index (1 to 4). The operator DŒmetricŒŒs; j ; coordŒŒk calculates the partial derivative of the s j metric component with respect to the coordinate k. christoffel D SimplifyŒTableŒ.1=2/ SumŒ.ginvŒŒi; h/ .DŒmetricŒŒh; j ; coord ŒŒk C DŒmetricŒŒh; k; coordŒŒj DŒmetricŒŒj; k; coordŒŒh/; fh; 1; 4g; fi; 1; 4g; fj; 1; 4g; fk; 1; 4g Appendix 8 Computational Symbolic Algebra Calculations 659 ˚˚˚ m ˚ Out[8]= ; 0; 0; 0 ; f0; 2m r; 0; 0g; 0; 0; .2m r/SinŒtheta2 ; 0 ; 2mrr oo2 ˚˚ n ˚ ; 0; 1r ; 0; 0 ; 1r ; 0; 0; 0 ; f0; 0; CosŒthetaSinŒtheta; 0g; 0; 0; 0; m.2mCr/ r3 ˚1 ˚˚ ; CotŒtheta; 0; 0 ; f0; 0; 0; 0g ; f0; 0; 0; 0gg ; 0; 0; 1r ; 0 ; f0; 0; CotŒtheta; 0g; r ˚˚ ˚ m m 0; 0; 0; 2mrr 2 ; f0; 0; 0; 0g; f0; 0; 0; 0g; 2mrr 2 ; 0; 0; 0 Next the Riemann tensor (first index contravariant, second through fourth index covariant) is created. Note that this differs from the one calculated in the MapleTM worksheet which was completely covariant in character . The riemann:= statement supresses the output. riemann:=riemann D SimplifyŒTableŒ DŒchristoffelŒŒi; j; l; coordŒŒk DŒchristoffelŒŒi; j; k; coordŒŒlC SumŒchristoffelŒŒs; j; lchristoffelŒŒi; k; s christoffelŒŒs; j; kchristoffelŒŒi; l; s; fs; 1; 4g; fi; 1; 4g; fj; 1; 4g; fk; 1; 4g; fl; 1; 4g This next command will display only the non - zero Riemann components. Note that these differ from the ones calculated in the MapleTM worksheet which was completely covariant in character . The output from the first command is supressed. riemannarray:=TableŒIfŒUnsameQŒriemannŒŒi; j; k; l; 0; fToStringŒRŒi; j; k; l; riemannŒŒi; j; k; lg; fi; 1; 4g; fj; 1; 4g; fk; 1; 4g; fl; 1; k 1g TableFormŒPartitionŒDeleteCasesŒFlattenŒriemannarray; Null; 2 R[1, 2, 2, 1] R[1, 3, 3, 1] R[1, 4, 4, 1] R[2, 1, 2, 1] R[2, 3, 3, 2] R[2, 4, 4, 2] Out[11]//TableForm= R[3, 1, 3, 1] R[3, 2, 3, 2] R[3, 4, 4, 3] R[4, 1, 4, 1] R[4, 2, 4, 2] R[4, 3, 4, 3] m r mSinŒtheta2 r 2m.2mCr/ r4 m .2mr/r 2 2 2mSinŒtheta r m.2mr/ r4 m .2mr/r 2 2m r m.2mr/ r4 2m .2mr/r 2 m r 2 mSinŒtheta r This next command creates the Ricci tensor. Note the summation over the index i. ricci:=ricci D SimplifyŒTableŒSumŒriemannŒŒi; j; l; i ; fi; 1; 4g; fj; 1; 4g; fl; 1; 4g 660 Appendix 8 Computational Symbolic Algebra Calculations Next we display only the non - zero components of the Ricci tensor. There are no non-zero components. ricciarray:=TableŒIfŒUnsameQŒricciŒŒj; l; 0; fToStringŒRŒj; l; ricciŒŒj; lg; fj; 1; 4g; fl; 1; j g TableFormŒPartitionŒDeleteCasesŒFlattenŒricciarray; Null; 2 Out[14]//TableForm = fg We next calculate the Ricci curvature scalar. RS D SumŒginvŒŒi; j ricciŒŒi; j ; fi; 1; 4g; fj; 1; 4g Out[15]=0 We next calculate the Einstein tensor, by explicitly creating it with the Ricci tensor, the Ricci scalar and the metric. einstein:=einstein D ricci .1=2/RS metric Display only the non - zero components of the Einstein tensor. There are no non-zero components, indicating a vacuum solution. einsteinarray:=TableŒIfŒUnsameQŒeinsteinŒŒj; l; 0; fToStringŒGŒj; l; einsteinŒŒj; lg; fj; 1; 4g; fl; 1; j g TableFormŒPartitionŒDeleteCasesŒFlattenŒeinsteinarray; Null; 2 Out[18]//TableForm=fg References 1. Abraham, R., Marsden, J.E. and Ratiu, T., Manifolds, tensor analysis, and applications, Springer-Verlag, New York, 1988. 2. Agrawal, P. and Das, A., Tensor, N.S. 28 53, 1974. 3. Aichelburg, P.C., Acta Phys. Austr. 34 279, 1971. 4. Alcubierre, M., Class. Quant. Grav. 11 L73, 1994. 5. Anton, H., Elementary linear algebra, John Wiley & Sons, New York, 2010. 6. Appelquist, T., Chodos, A. and Freund, P.G.O. (eds.), Modern Kaluza-Klein theories, Addison-Wesley Publishing Company, Menlo-Park, 1987. 7. Arnowitt, R., Deser, S. and Misner, C.W., in Gravitation: An introduction to current research, 227, John Wiley and Sons, New York - London, 1962. 8. Artin, E., in Galois theory: Lectures delivered at the University of Notre Dame. (Notre Dame Mathematical Lectures No. 2.) 1, University of Notre Dame, Notre Dame - London, 1971. 9. Ashby, N., Liv. Rev. Relat. 6 1, 2003. http://www.livingreviews.org/lrr-2003-1. 10. Ashtekar, A., Lectures on non-perturbative canonical gravity, World Scientific Publishing, Singapore, 1991. 11. Atiyah, M.F., Hitchin, N.G., Drinfeld, V.G. and Manin, I., Phys. Lett. 65A 185, 1978. 12. Bailin, D. and Love, A., Rep. Prog. Phys. 50 1087, 1987. 13. Baker, J.C., et. al Mon. Not. Roy. Ast. Soc. 308 1173, 1999. 14. Barceló, C. and Visser, M., Int. J. Mod. Phys. D11 1553, 2002. 15. Barstow, M.A., Bond, H.E., Holberg, J.B., Burleigh, M.R., Hubeny, I. and Koester, D., Mon. Not. Roy. Ast. Soc. 362 1134, 2005. 16. Baum, H. and Juhl, A., Conformal differential geometry: Q-curvature and conformal holonomy, Birkhäuser Verlag, Basel - Boston - Berlin, 2010. 17. Bergmann, P.G., Introduction to the theory of relativity, Dover Publications, Mineola NY, 1976. 18. Biech, T. and Das, A., Gen. Rel. Grav. 18 93, 1986. 19. Biech, T. and Das, A., Can. J. Phys. 68 1403, 1990. 20. Birkhoff, G.D., Relativity and modern physics, Harvard University Press, Cambridge MA, 1923. 21. Birkhoff, G.D. and MacLane, S., A survey of modern algebra, A.K. Peters/CRC Press, Natick MA - Boca-Raton Fl, 1998. 22. Birrell, N.D. and Davies, P.C.W., Quantum fields in curved space, Cambridge University Press, Cambridge - New York, 1989. 23. Bishop, R.L. and Goldberg, S.I., Tensor analysis on manifolds, Dover Publications Inc., New York, 1980. 24. Bondi, H., Mon. Not. Roy. Ast. Soc. 107 410, 1947. A. Das and A. DeBenedictis, The General Theory of Relativity: A Mathematical Exposition, DOI 10.1007/978-1-4614-3658-4, © Springer Science+Business Media New York 2012 661 662 References 25. Bondi, H., van der Burg, M.G. and Metzner, A.W.K., Proc. Roy. Soc. Lond. A269 21, 1962. 26. Bonnor, W.B., Proc. Phys. Soc. Lond. A67 225, 1954. 27. Börner, G., The early universe: Facts and fiction, Springer-Verlag, Berlin - Heidelberg New York, 1993. 28. Boyer, R.H. and Lindquist, R.W., J. Math. Phys. 8 265, 1967. 29. Brännlund, J., van den Hoogen, R. and Coley, A., Int. J. Mod. Phys. D19 1915, 2010. 30. Buchdahl, H.A., Quart. J. Math. Ox. 5 116, 1954. 31. Buchdahl, H.A., Phys. Rev. 116 1027, 1959. 32. Buck, R.C., Advanced calculus, McGraw-Hill, New York, 1965. 33. Buonanno, A., in Proceedings of Les Houches summer school, particle physics and cosmology: The fabric of spacetime, 3, Elsevier Publishing, Amsterdam, 2007. 34. Carmeli, M. and Kuzmenko, T., Int. J. Theo. Phys. 41 131, 2002. 35. Chandrasekhar, S., The mathematical theory of black holes, Oxford University Press, Oxford - New York, 1992. 36. Chazy, J., Bull. Soc. Math. France 52 17, 1924. 37. Chinn, W.G. and Steenrod, N.E., First concepts of topology, The Mathematical Associaton of America, Washington DC, 1966. 38. Choquet-Bruhat, Y., DeWitt-Morette, C. and Dillard-Bleick, M., Analysis, manifolds and physics, North-Holland, Amsterdam, 1978. 39. Clark, G.L., Phil. Mag. 39 747, 1948. 40. Collas, P., Lett. Nuovo Cim. 21 68, 1978. 41. Corless, R.M., Gonnet, G.H., Hare, D.E.G., Jeffrey, D.J. and Knuth, D.E., Adv. Comput. Math. 5 329, 1996. 42. Cotton, E., Ann. Fac. Sci. Toul. II 1 385, 1899. 43. Courant, R. and Hilbert, D., Methods of mathematical physics, republished by John Wiley and Sons, New York, 1989. 44. Curzon, H.E.J., Proc. Lond. Math. Soc. 23 477, 1924. 45. Darmois, G., Memorial des sciences mathematiques XXV, Gauthier-Villars, Paris, 1927. 46. Das, A., Prog. Theor. Phys. 17 373, 1957. 47. Das, A., Prog. Theor. Phys. 18 554, 1957. 48. Das, A., Prog. Theor. Phys. 24 915, 1960. 49. Das, A., Proc.Roy. Soc. A. 267 1, 1962. 50. Das, A., J. Math. Phys. 4 45, 1963. 51. Das, A., J. Math. Phys. 12 232, 1971. 52. Das, A., J. Math. Phys. 12 1136, 1971. 53. Das, A., J. Math. Phys. 14 1099, 1973. 54. Das, A., J. Math. Phys. 20 740, 1979. 55. Das, A., The special theory of relativity: A mathematical exposition, Springer, New York , 1993. 56. Das, A., Tensors: The mathematics of relativity theory & continuum mechanics, Springer, New York - Berlin - London, 2007. 57. Das, A. and Agrawal, P., Gen. Rel. Grav. 5 359, 1974. 58. Das, A. and Aruliah, D., PINSA-A. 64 1, 1998. 59. Das, A., Biech, T. and Kay, D., J. Math. Phys. 31 2917, 1990. 60. Das, A. and Coffman, C.V., J. Math. Phys. 8 1720, 1967. 61. Das, A. and DeBenedictis, A., Prog. Theor. Phys. 108 119, 2001. 62. Das, A. and DeBenedictis, A., Gen. Rel. Grav. 36 1741, 2004. 63. Das, A., DeBenedictis, A. and Tariq, N., J. Math. Phys. 44 5637, 2003. 64. Das, A., Florides, P.S. and Synge, J.L., Proc. Roy. Soc. A. 263 451, 1961. 65. Das, A. and Kloster, S., J. Math. Phys. 21 2248, 1980. 66. Das, A. and Kloster, S., Phys. Rev. D62 104002, 2000. 67. Das, A., Tariq, N. and Biech, T., J. Math. Phys. 36 340, 1995. 68. Das, A., Tariq, N., Aruliah, D. and Bie